Category Archives: Teachers’ Resources

Free Grade 1 Schemes Of Work Term 1, 2 And 3

Download the free Term 2 CBC Grade 1 Schemes Of Work below.

GRADE 1 TERM 2 SCHEMES OF WORK FREE DOWNLOADS.

CRE TERM 2 GRADE ONE SCHEMES OF WORK 

ENGLISH TERM 2 GRADE ONE SCHEMES OF WORK 

ART CRAFT AND MUSIC TERM 2 GRADE ONE SCHEMES OF WORK 

LITERACY ACTIVITIES TERM 2 GRADE ONE SCHEMES OF WORK 

MOVEMENT ACTIVITIES TERM 2 GRADE ONE SCHEMES OF WORK 

MUSIC TERM 2 GRADE ONE SCHEMES OF WORK 

ENVIRONMENTAL ACTIVITIES TERM 2 GRADE ONE SCHEMES OF WORK 

ART AND CRAFT TERM 2 GRADE ONE SCHEMES OF WORK 

ENGLISH UPDATED TERM 2 GRADE ONE SCHEMES OF WORK 

KISWAHILI TERM 2 GRADE ONE SCHEMES OF WORK 

MATHEMATICS ACTIVITIES TERM 2 GRADE ONE SCHEMES OF WORK 

HYGIENE TERM 2 GRADE ONE SCHEMES OF WORK 

KISWAHILI UPDATED TERM 2 GRADE ONE SCHEMES OF WORK 

LITERACY ACTIVITIES TERM 2 GRADE ONE SCHEMES OF WORK 

KISWAHILI LATEST TERM 2 GRADE ONE SCHEMES OF WORK 

MATHS TERM 2 GRADE ONE SCHEMES OF WORK 

MOVEMENT LATEST TERM 2 GRADE ONE SCHEMES OF WORK 

MUSIC UPDATED TERM 2 GRADE ONE SCHEMES OF WORK 

HOT DOWNLOADS!!!

Schemes of work grade 1 term 1 to 3

Grade 1 exams pdf download

Grade 1 Free updated schemes of work

Grade 1-6, PP1 and PP2 free notes, exams and schemes

Grade 1,2,3 and 4 free schemes of work, pdf notes and exams (Thousands of free CBC downloads)

Form 3 Maths paper 1 Exams and Marking Schemes Free

NAME…………………………………………………………………………

 

ADM NO………………………………………………………………………

 

SCHOOL………………………………….………………………………………..

 

DATE……………………………

121/1

MATHEMATICS

PAPER 1

2 HOURS

FORM THREE

121/1

MATHEMATICS

PAPER1

INSTRUCTIONS TO CANDIDATES

  1. Write your name and index number in the spaces provided at the top of this page.
  2. This paper consists of two sections: Section I and Section II.
  3. Answer all questions in section I and any five questions from Section II.
  4. Show all the steps in your calculations, giving your answers at each stage in the spaces below each question.
  5. Marks may be given for correct working even if the answer is wrong.

 

Non- programmable silent electronic calculators and KNEC Mathematical tables may be used

FOR EXAMINER’S USE ONLY

SECTION I

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 Total
 

 

                               

 

SECTION II

17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 Total
               

 

GRAND

             TOTAL

This paper consists of 13 pages.  Candidates should check the question paper to ensure that all the pages are printed as indicated and no questions are missing.

 

 

 

SECTION A (50 MARKS)

Attempt all the questions

 

  1. Without using mathematical tables or calculators, evaluate the following leaving your answer as a fraction in its simplest form.             (3mks)

 

 

 

  1. Two boys and a girl shared some money .The elder boy got of it, the younger boy got of the remainder and the girl got the rest. Find the percentage share of the younger boy to the girl’s share. (4mks)

 

 

 

 

 

  1. Solve for t in the equation

9t+1 +32t=30     (3mks)

 

 

 

  1. The exterior angle of a regular polygon is (c – 50)° and the interior angle is (2c + 20)°. Find the number of sides of the polygon.                                (3 mks)

 

 

 

  1. A salesman is paid a salary of Sh. 10,000 per month. He is also paid a commission on sales above Sh. 100,000. In one month he sold goods worth Sh. 500,000. If his total earning that month was Sh. 56,000. Calculate the rate of commission. (3 mks)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  1. In a book store, books packed in cartons are arranged in rows such that there are 50 cartons in the first row, 48 cartons in the next row, 46 in the next and so on.
  • How many cartons will there be in the 8th row? (2 mks)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  • If there are 20 rows in total, find the total number of cartons in the book store

(2 mks)

 

 

 

 

 

 

  1. A rectangle whose area is 96m2 is such that its length is 4metres longer than its width.

Find

  • It dimensions (2 mks)

 

 

 

 

 

 

  • Its perimeter (1 mk)

 

 

 

 

  1. (a) Find the gradient of a straight line joining the points P(2,3) and Q(8,-6) (1mk)

 

 

 

 

 

 

  1. b) Hence find the equation of the line through P perpendicular to line PQ. [3mks]

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  1. Given that OP = 2i + 3j and 𝑂𝑄⃗= 3i – 2j. Find the magnitude of PQ correct to three decimal spaces.

(3mks)

 

 

 

 

 

  1. Solve the following inequality and state the integral solutions.             (2mks)

 

 

 

  1. Given that is a perfect square. Find the value of k.       (3 mks)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  1. Two matrices A and B are such that A= and B =  given that the determinant of AB = 10, find the value of k.                                                 (3mks)

 

 

 

 

 

  1. Omwando borrows sh. 90,000 for 5 years at 6 ½ % simple interest p.a.What amount does he have to pay at the end of that time? (3mks)

 

 

 

 

  1. Given that log a = 0.30 and log b = 0.48 find the value of . (3mks)

 

 

 

 

  1. Find the value of x in the equation.

Cos(3x -1800) =    For the range  x 1800         (3 mks)

2

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  1. Given that the dimensions of a rectangle are 20.0cm and 25.0. Find the percentage error in calculating  the                                                                     (3 marks)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

SECTION B (50 MARKS)

Attempt  5 questions only

 

  • Water flows through a circular pipe of cross-sectional area of 6.16cm2 at a uniform speed of 10cm per second. At 6.00 a.m. water starts flowing through the pipe into an empty tank of base area are 3m2.
  1. What will be the depth of the water at 8.30 a.m.?                                  (5 marks)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  1. If the tank is 1.2m high and a hole at the bottom through which water leaks at a rate of 11.6cm3 per second. Determine the time at which the tank will be filled.                                                                                                                               (5 marks)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  • Using a ruler and a pair of compass only, construct a triangle ABC such that AB = 8cm, BC = 6cm and <ABC = 300 (2mks)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  1. Measure the length AC (1mk)

 

 

  1. Construct a circle that touches sides AB, BC and AC (2mks)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  1. Measure the radius of the circle. (1mk)

 

 

 

 

  1. Hence or otherwise calculate the area of the triangle not in the circle. (4mks)

 

 

 

 

 

  • A field was surveyed and its measurements recorded in a field book as shown below.
 

 

E 40

 

C 40

F

100

80

60

40

20

A

 

 

 

D 50

 

B 30

 

(a)Using a scale of 1cm to represent 10m, draw a map of the field.                        (4mks)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(b)       Calculate the area of the field.

(i) In square metres.                                                                           (4mks)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(ii) In hectares.                                                                                   (2mks)

 

 

 

  1. . The table below shows the income tax rates in a certain year.
Total income in

k£per annum

Rate in shs

per pound

1-3900

3901-7800

7801-11,700

11701-15600

15601-19500

Over 19500

2

3

4

5

7

7.5

 

Mrs.Masau earned a basic salary of ksh18600 per month and allowances amounting to ksh 7800 per month. She claimed a personal relief of ksh 1080 per month.

Calculate:

  1. Total taxable income in k£ p.a                      (2 marks)

 

 

 

 

 

  1. i) the tax payable in ksh per month without relief (4marks)

 

 

 

 

ii)the tax payable in ksh per month after  relief                                                     (2marks)

 

 

 

 

  1. Musau’s net monthly income                                                                   (2marks)

 

 

21 An arithmetic progression of 41 terms is such that the sum of the first five terms is 560 and the sum of the last five terms is -250. Find:

(a) The first term and the common difference                                              (5mks)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(b) The last term                                                                                                   (2mks)

 

 

 

(c) The sum of the progression                                                                      (3mks)

 

 

 

  • Three towns P, Q and R are such that P is on a bearing of 1200 and 20 km from Q, town R is on a bearing of 2200 and 12km from P.
  • Using a scale of 1cm to represent 2km draw and locate the position of the three towns (3 mks)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(b) Measure

  1. The distances between Q and R  in kilometres                                                 (2mks)

 

 

 

 

  1. The bearing of P from R (1mk)

 

 

  • The bearing of R from Q (2mks)

 

 

(c) Calculate the area of the figure bounded by PQR                       (2mks)

 

 

  1. 23.
500
8cm
2.82cm
7cm
B
C
D
A
6cm

In the figure below (not drawn to scale). AB = 8cm, AC = 6cm, AD = 7cm, CD = 2.82cm and angle CAB = 500

 

 

 

 

Calculate (to 2 decimal places)

(a) The length BC,                                                                                         (2mks)

 

 

 

(b) The size of angle ABC                                                                             (3mks)

 

 

 

(c) The size of angle CAD                                                                             (3mks)

 

(d) The area of triangle ACD.                                                                              (2mks)

 

 

 

 

 

  • The figure below shows a tumbler with diameters 6cm and 10cm and height 15cm.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  • If it is filled with water, what area is in contact with water? (7 mks)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  1. Find the volume of the tumbler. (3 mks)

 

 

__________________________________________________________________

F3 MATHS PP1 TERM 3 MARKING SCHEME

 

  1. Share of elder boy =

Share of younger boy=

=

Girls share =

% share of younger boy to girls share

 

 

 

  1. 32(t+1)+32t=30

32t . 32+32t =30

32t(32+1)=30

32t×10=30

32t=31

2t=1

t= ½

 

 

 

  1. 2x + 20 + x-50=180

3x – 30 = 180

3x = 210

3        3

x = 70

Each exterior angle = 70 – 50

= 200

No. of sides = 360

20

= 18

 

5.

Commission = 56,000 – 10 000

= Ksh. 46,000

 

Sales above 100 000 = 500 000 – 100 000

=  Ksh. 400 000

 

Rate of commission = 46000 x 100%

400 000

 

= 11.5%

 

M1

 

 

M1

 

 

 

 

 

A1

 

 

 

 

  1. 50,48,46,……………

= 50 + 7x (-2)

= 36

=  (2 x 50 + (20 – 1) (x – 2)

= 620

 

 

  1. (a) x(x + 4) = 96

+ 4x – 96 = 0

(x-8) (x + 12) = 0

x = 8

Length = 12

Width = 8

 

(b) Perimeter = 2 (8 + 12) = 40m

 

 

  1. M1 = y

x

= 3 + 6

2 – 8

= 9 = -3

-6     2

M1 x M2 = -1

–  x m2 = -1

M2 =

Taking (x,y) and P(2,3)

y-3 = 2

x- 2   5

3y – 9 = 2x -4

3y = 2x + 5

y = 2x + 5

3       3

 

  1. PQ = q – p

~   ~

= (3ɩ -2j)- (2ɩ +3j)

= 3ɩ – 2j – 2ɩ- 3j

= I – 5j

/PQ/=

=

= 5.099

 

 

  1. 12 – 2x ˃ 18x – 8

= 20x ˃ – 20

x ˂ 1

18x – 8 ≥ -28 – 2x

20x ≥ – 20

X ≥ -1

-1 ≤ x ˂ 1

 

Integral solutions: 01, 0.

 

 

 

  • b2 = a.c

2

 

 

-202 = 25k

2

100 = 25 k

K = 100

25

= 4

 

 

12

 

            AB=

-2(K+12) -9 (2K-16)=10

-2K-24-18K+144=10

-20K = -110

∵K=5.5

 

 

13 I=

90,000 x 6.5 x 5

100 x 2

= sh.29,250

A =(90,000+29,250)

=SH. 119,250

 

14

 =

2(0.48) – 0.30

0.96 – 0.30

= 0.66

 

  1. 3x – 180 = 30 or 330

3x – 180 = 30

3x = 210

x = 700

 

OR

3x – 180 = 330

3x = 510

x = 1700

16.      Min Area = (19.95( (24.95)

= 497.7525

Max. Area = (20.05)(25.05)

= 502.2525

 

502.2525 – 497.7525

2

 

2.25  x 100

  • = 0.45%

 

 

17. Time of = 2 ½ hrs

Flow

Volume in 2 ½ hrs = 6.16 x 10 x 2 ½ x 3600

= 554400 cm3

 

Volume of tank = 3h = 554400

10000

 

H =  554400 m

30000

 

= 18.48m

 

 

 

B1

 

M1

 

 

M1

 

 

M1

 

 

A1

 

 
 Volume in per sec. = 6.16 x 10 – 11.6

 

= 61.6 – 11.6 = 50cm3

 

Volume of tank = 1.2 x 30000 x 100

 

Time = 3600000  sec

50

= 72000

3600

= 20 hrs

 

M1

 

A1

 

M1

 

M1

 

 

 

A1                             (10)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

18

Triangle ABC

AC = 4.1cm

Bisecting <S

Circle

Radius = 1.2cm

Area = ½ x 8 x 6 sin 300 – x 1.22

= 4 x 6 x 0.5 – 4.5257

= 12 – 4.5257

 

= 7.4743

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

19

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

21 (a)

Sum of arithmetic progression

 

Last five terms     term is a + 40d

term is a + 39d

term is a + 38d

term is a + 37d

term is a + 36d

total

 

Solving (i) and (ii) simultenously;

 

 

(b)

Last term is  a + 40d

 

(c)

 

 

M1

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

M1

 

 

 

 

 

M1

 

 

A1

 

 

 

A1

 

M1

 

A1

 

 

 

 

 

M1

 

 

 

M1

A1

 

 

Formation of each equation

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Solving two equations simultaneously

For common difference

 

For the first term

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

22.a)

 

  1. b) i)10.8 x2 = 21.6 km

ii)0400+ 1

iii) 1530+ 1

  1. c) A = ½ a b sin

= ½ x 12 x 20 sin 800

= 118.18 km2

 

 

 

 

23 (a)

cm

(b)

Let  be

(c)

Let  be

(d)

Area of ΔACD

 

M1

A1

 

 

M1

 

 

M1

A1

 

M1

M1

A1

 

M1

A1

 

 

 

 

Accept 47.940,47.960 depending on the method

 

 

 

 

 

 

22.890 is possible.

24

 

h    =     6

15 + h   10

 

10h = 90 + 6h

4h = 90

H = 22.5

 

H = h + 15

= 37.5

 

 

 

 

 

 

L = 2 + 9

= .25

= 22.70

 

L = 2 + 25

=

= 37.83

S.A = ( 2

 

= (3.142 x 5 x 37.83 – 3.142 x3 x 22.70) + (3.142.9)

= 380.3391 + 28.278

= 408.6111 cm2

  1. b) Volume = AH – Ah

= (  x 3.142 x 25 x37.5)- (3.142 x 9 x 22.5)

= 981.875 – 212.085

= 769.79 cm3

Grade 8 Latest Term 1 CBC Schemes of Work

Get free Grade 8 Latest Term 1 CBC Schemes of Work here.

GRADE 8 CREATIVE ART AND SPORTS COMPLETE NOTES .pdf
Grade 8 Rationalized Agri-Nutrition Schemes of Work Term 1.pdf
Grade 8 Rationalized English Schemes of Work Term 1.pdf
Grade 8 Set 2 Creative Arts Schemes of Work Term 1.pdf
GRADE 8 TERM 1 CREATIVE ARTS SPORTS SCHEMES (1).docx

Grade_8_Set_1_Creative_Arts_Rationalized_Schemes_of_Work_Term_1.pdf

grade-8-cre-schemes-of-work-term-1–oxford.pdf
Grade-8-english-schemes-of-work-term-1–longhorn (1).doc
Grade-8-integrated-science-schemes-of-work-term-1 (1).docx
grade-8-kiswahili-schemes-of-work-term-1.pdf
grade-8-mathematics-schemes-of-work-term-1.pdf
grade-8-mentor-agriculture-schemes-of-work-term-1.docx
grade-8-pre-technical-studies-schemes-of-work-term-1 (1).docx
Grade-8-Pretechnical-Studies-Schemes-of-Work-Term-1-2025.pdf
Grade-8-Social -Studies-Schemes-of-Work-Term-1-2025.pdf

Grade 8 Latest Term 1 CBC Schemes of Work

Grade 8 schemes of work free download pdf

You can now download free Grade 8 Schemes of Work here:

DOWNLOAD FREE GRADE-8-TERM-2-FRENCH-SCHEMES (1).docx
DOWNLOAD FREE GRADE-8-TERM-2-SCIENCE-SCHEMES (1).docx
DOWNLOAD FREE GRADE-8-TERM-2-SCIENCE-SCHEMES-spotlight (1).docx
DOWNLOAD FREE GRADE-8-TERM-2-ENGLISH-SCHEMES (1).docx
DOWNLOAD FREE GRADE-8-TERM-2-PRETECHNICAL-SCHEMES (1).docx
DOWNLOAD FREE GRADE-8-TERM-2-SOCIAL-STUDIES-SCHEMES (1).docx
DOWNLOAD FREE GRADE-8-TERM-2-SCIENCE-SCHEMES-mentor (1).doc
DOWNLOAD FREE GRADE-8-TERM-2-SOCIAL-STUDIES-SCHEMES-1 (1).docx
DOWNLOAD FREE GRADE-8-TERM-2-ENGLISH-SCHEMES-skills (1).docx
DOWNLOAD FREE GRADE-8-TERM-2-KISWAHILI-SCHEMES (1).docx
DOWNLOAD FREE GRADE-8-TERM-2-MATHEMATICS-SCHEMES (1).doc

 

Get free Grade 8 CBC Juniour School Schemes of Work, Notes, Revision Materials, Exams, Past Papers , Lesson Plans and Lesson Notes

Grade 8 Schemes of Work

Grade 8 schemes of work free download pdf,
Grade 8 schemes of WORK free download pdf TERM 2,
Free Grade 8 schemes of WORK,
Grade 8 schemes of work 2025/2026,
Grade 8 schemes of WORK free download PDF TERM 3,
Grade 8 schemes of work 2025,
Grade 8 schemes of work term 2,
Grade 8 SCHEMES of work TERM 1,

Latest Biology Form 3 Exams and Marking Schemes Free Downloads

Latest Biology Form 3 Exams and Marking Schemes Free Downloads

Set 1

~$O P1 SET 1.docx
~WRL0003.tmp
~$O P1 MS SET 1.docx
~$O P3 SET 1.rtf
~$O P3 MS SET 1.docx
~$O P2 SET 1.docx
BIO P1 MS SET 1.docx
BIO P2 SET 1.docx
BIO P3 MS SET 1.docx
BIO P1 SET 1.docx
BIO P2 MS SET 1.docx

Set 2

BIO P3 Q MS SET 5.doc
BIO P2 Q MS SET 5.doc
BIO P1 Q MS SET 5.doc

Set  3

BIO P3 SET 10.docx
BIO P2 SET 10.docx
~$O P3 SET 10.docx
~$O P3 MS SET 10.docx
BIO P3 MS SET 10.docx
BIO P1 MS SET 10.docx
BIO P2 MS SET 10.docx
BIO P1 SET 10.docx

Set  4

BIO P2 SET 9.docx
BIO P1 SET 9.docx
BIO P1 MS SET 9.docx
~$O P3 SET 9.docx
~$O P1 MS SET 9.docx
~$O P1 SET 9.docx
BIO P3 MS SET 9.docx
BIO P3 SET 9.docx
BIO P2 SET 9.docx
BIO P1 MS SET 9.docx
BIO P1 SET 9.docx

Set  5

~$O P3 SET 3.docx
BIO P3 MS SET 3.docx
BIO P1 SET 3.docx
BIO P1 MS SET 3.docx
BIO P2 MS SET 3.docx
~$O P3 MS SET 3.docx

Set 6

~$O P3 SET 3.docx
BIO P3 MS SET 3.docx
BIO P1 SET 3.docx
BIO P1 MS SET 3.docx
BIO P2 MS SET 3.docx
~$O P3 MS SET 3.docx

Set 7

~$O P3 SET 3.docx
BIO P3 MS SET 3.docx
BIO P1 SET 3.docx
BIO P1 MS SET 3.docx
BIO P2 MS SET 3.docx
~$O P3 MS SET 3.docx

Set 8

BIO P2 SET 2.doc
BIO P1 MS SET 2.doc
BIO P2 MS SET 2.doc
BIO P3 Q MS SET 2.doc
BIO P1 SET 2.doc
~$O P1 SET 2.doc

Set 9

BIO P2 SET 2.doc
BIO P1 MS SET 2.doc
BIO P2 MS SET 2.doc
BIO P3 Q MS SET 2.doc
BIO P1 SET 2.doc
~$O P1 SET 2.doc

Set 10

BIO P2 MS SET 4.docx
~$O P1 SET 4.docx
BIO P2 SET 4.docx
BIO P1 SET 4.docx
~$O P1 MS SET 4.docx
BIO P1 MS SET 4.docx

Set 11

 

Set  12

 

 

KCPE Science Past Papers, Revision Exams Free Downloads

KCPE Science Past Papers, Revision Exams Free Downloads

science-kcpe-exam-2017.pdf
science-kcpe-question-paper-2015.pdf
science-question-paper-kcpe-2013.pdf
science-question-paper-kcpe-2014.pdf
science-questions-paper-kcpe-2006.pdf
science-questions-paper-kcpe-2007.pdf
science-questions-paper-kcpe-2011 (1).pdf
science-questions-paper-kcpe-2011.pdf
science-questions-paper-kcpe-2012 (1).pdf
science-questions-paper-kcpe-2012.pdf
science-questions-paper-kcse-2010.pdf

KCPE SCIENCE 2002.pdf
KCPE SCIENCE 2003.pdf
KCPE SCIENCE 2004 (1).pdf
KCPE SCIENCE 2004.pdf
KCPE SCIENCE 2005.pdf
KCPE SCIENCE 2006.pdf
KCPE SCIENCE 2007.pdf
KCPE SCIENCE 2008.pdf
KCPE SCIENCE 2009.pdf
KCPE SCIENCE 2010.pdf
KCPE SCIENCE 2010.pdf
KCPE SCIENCE 2011.pdf
KCPE SCIENCE 2011.pdf
KCPE SCIENCE 2012.pdf
KCPE SCIENCE 2012.pdf
KCPE SCIENCE 2013.pdf
KCPE SCIENCE 2013.pdf
KCPE SCIENCE 2013.pdf
KCPE SCIENCE 2014.pdf
KCPE SCIENCE 2014.pdf
KCPE SCIENCE 2014.pdf
KCPE SCIENCE ANSWERS.pdf
KCPE SCIENCE ANSWERS.pdf
KCPE SCIENCE ANSWERS.pdf

Free Form 2 Term 2 Exams 2025 {Comprehensive}

Free Form 2 Term 2 Exams 2025 {Comprehensive} and with marking schemes:

PHYSICS F2 MS-1

PHYSICS F2 QS-1

ENGLISH F2 MS-1

BIOLOGY F2 MS-1

CHEMISTRY F2 MS

CHEMISTRY F2 QS-1

MATHEMATICS F2 QS

HISTORY & GOVERNMENT F2 MS

AGRICULTURE F2 QS

BUSINESS STUDIES F2 MS

COMPUTER STUDIES F2 QN

F2 GEOGRAPHY QNS

GEOGRAPHY MS (2)

HOME SCIENCE F2 QS

KISWAHILI MS (3)

MATHEMATICS F2 MS

MATHS MS

CHEMISTRY MS

CHEMISTRY

AGRICULTURE

BIOLOGY MS

HOME SCIENCE F2 MS

AGRICULTURE F2 MS

CRE F2 MS-1

KISWAHILI QN

PHYSICS MS

BUSINESS

KISWAHILI 2

BUSINESS MS

HISTORY MS

PHYSICS

MATHEMATICS

BIOLOGY

AGRICULTURE MS

ENGLISH MS

ENGLISH

GEOGRAPHY MS

HISTORY

CRE

CRE F2 QS

HISTORY & GOVERNMENT F2 QS

Form 2 Physics Exams and Marking Schemes Free

NAME……………………………………………………………..ADM/NO……………………

 

DATE…………………………. ………………… ………….CLASS……………………………

 

JOINT EXAMINATIONS

FORM 2

TERM THREE

PHYSICS 232

TIME: 2HRS

 

INSTRUCTIONS TO STUDENTS

  • Write your name and admission number in the spaces provided above.
  • The paper contains two sections, section A and B
  • Answer all the questions in the spaces provided
  • All working must be clearly shown
  • Candidates should check the question paper to ascertain that all the 12 pages are printed as indicted and that no questions are missing.
  • Candidates should answer the questions in English

 

 

SECTION QUESTION MAXIMUM SCORE CANDIDATE’S

SCORE

 

A 1-12 25  
B 13-18 55  
                                                                                        TOTAL  

 

 

SECTION A (25 MARKS)

Answer all questions in the spaces provided

 

  1. The micrometer screw gauge below has a zero error of – 0.19mm.

Determine the actual thickness of the object.                                                     (2mks)

 

 

  1. Two mirrored walls stand at an angle to each other. A student standing in the room counts nine images of himself in the mirrors. Determine the angle between the walls.

(3mks)

 

 

 

 

 

  1. a) What is meant by the term anomalous expansion of water? (1mks)

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

 

  1. b) Explain any two applications of contraction and expansion in solids. (2mks)

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

  1. A body weighs 600N on the surface of the earth and 450N on the surface of another planet. Calculate the value of g in that planet (g on the earth = 10N/Kg)               (3mks)

 

 

 

 

 

 

  1. State two applications of electrostatic charges (2mks)

 

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

 

  1. 200 coulombs of charge passes through a point in a circuit for 0.6 minutes. What is the magnitude of the current flowing? (3mks)

 

 

 

 

 

 

  1. While heating water in a beaker, a wire gauze is placed below the beaker explain.(2mks)

 

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

 

  1. What is the relationship between physics and technology (2mks)

 

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

 

  1. Using the domain theory distinguish between magnetic material and a magnet (2mks)

 

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

  1. State two application of convection in fluids (2mks)

 

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

 

  1. Convert a temperature of 234K to degree celsious                                (1mk)

 

 

 

 

SECTION B (55 MARKS)

  1. (a) State Hooke’s law                                                                                         (1mk)

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

(b) In an experiment to verify Hooke’s law, a piece of rubber was fixed to a rigid support and the other end pulled with a force of ranging magnitude.  The values of force and the extension were recorded as in the table below:-

Force (N) 0 0.20 0.55 0.75 1.00 1.30 1.40
Extension(cm) 0 1.5 2.5 3.5 4.5 6.0 7.0

 

  • Plot a graph of force ( Y axis) against extension (X-axis) on the gird provided

(5mks)

  • From the graph, determine the spring constant of the rubber within elastic limit (3mks)

 

 

\

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  • What is the size of force at the elastic limit             (1mks)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  1. (a) State three characteristics of a brake fluid. (1mk)

 

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

……………………………………………………………………………………………………

(b) The height of a mercury barometer at a particular place is 70cm. given that the density of mercury is 13600kgm3, determine;

(i) The atmospheric pressure at the place.                                                                             (3mks)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(ii) The height of a water barometer at the same place. (Density of water=1g/cm3)                       (2mks)

 

 

 

 

 

 

(iii) Give a reason why mercury is preferred as a barometric liquid.                                   (1mks)

 

 

 

 

(c) Calculate the minimum pressure a block of dimensions 3cm by 10cm by 15cm and mass 12kg could exert on a horizontal surface.                                                                                          (3mks)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  • a) Differentiate between transverse waves and longitudinal waves.(2mks)

 

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

  1. The figure below shows a wave form in a string.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Given that the speed of the wave is 10m/s. With reference to this wave motion, determine;

  1.           (1mk)

 

 

  1.           (1mk)

 

 

  • (2mks)

 

 

 

  1. Period                                                   (2mks)

 

 

 

 

  1. A person standing 49.5m from the foot of a cliff claps his hands and hears an echo 0.3 seconds later. Calculate the velocity of the sound in air.           (3mks)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  1. (a) What property of light is suggested by the formation of shadows?       (1mk)

…………………………………………………………………………………………………

(b) A building standing 200m from a pinhole camera produces on the screen of the camera an image 2.5cm and high 5.0cm behind the pinhole.

Determine the actual height of the building                                                                          (3mks)

 

 

 

 

 

 

(c) An object of height 2.0cm is placed 5.0cm in front of a convex mirror of focal length 10.0cm

 

(i) On the grid provided, draw to scale a ray diagram to locate the position of the image.(4mks)

 

(ii) State two applications of concave mirrors                                                          (2mks)

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

  1. (a) When is an object said to be in stable equilibrium?       (1mk)

 

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

 

 

 

 

(b)  A uniform metal rod of length 80cm and mass 3.2kg is supported horizontally by two vertical spring’s balances C and D. Balance C is a 20cm from one end while balance D is 30cm from the other end. Find the reading on each balance.                                                   (4mks)

 

 

 

 

 

  1. (a) The figure below shows an electric bell. Briefly explain how it works.  (4mks)

 

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

  • State the right hand grip rule for straight conductor carrying current (1mks)

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

………………………………………………………………………………………………………

  1. a) State the equation of continuity (1mk)

…………………………………………………………………………………………………….

 

 

  1. b) The velocity of glycerin in a 5cm internal diameter pipe is 1.00m/s. Find the velocity in a 3cm internal diameter pipe that connects with it, both pipes flowing full. (3mks)

 

____________________________________________________________________

NAME……………………………………………………………..ADM/NO……………………

 

DATE…………………………. ………………… ………….CLASS……………………………

 

JOINT EXAMINATIONS

FORM 2

TERM THREE

PHYSICS 232

TIME: 2HRS

MARKING SCHEME

 

 

 

SECTION A (25 MARKS)

Answer all questions in the spaces provided

 

  1. The micrometer screw gauge below has a zero error of – 0.19mm.

 

 

 

 

Determine the actual thickness of the object.                                                           (2mks)

 

Reading shown is                  3.50

                                         +    0.01

                                       3.51mm

 

Actual thickness        =          3.51

                                                      +    0.19

                                                3.70mm

 

 

 

  1. Two mirrored walls stand at an angle to each other. A student standing in the room counts nine images of himself in the mirrors. Determine the angle between the walls.

(3mks)

n =– 1         9=– 1

 

Ѳ=

 

 =360

 

  1. a) What is meant by the term anomalous expansion of water? (1mks)

Anomalous expansion of water is defined as the unusual behavior of water in which it contracts when heated and expands when cooled between 0 and 40C

 

  1. b) Explain any two applications of contraction and expansion in solids. (2mks)
  2. Expansion joints in Steam Pipes

Pipes carrying steam are fitted with loops or expansion joints to allow for expansion when steam is passing through them and contraction when they are cooledFixing of Railway Line

  1. Railway lines are constructed in sections with expansion gaps and the sections held together by fishplates. The bolt holes in the rails are oval to allow free expansion and contraction of rails as the bolts move freely in the holes.

A modern method of allowing for expansion and contraction in railways is to plane slant the rails so that they overlap

  1. Installation of Telephone/ Electric Wires

They are loosely fixed to allow for contraction. Telephone or electric wires appear to be shorter and taut in the morning. When it is hot, the wires appear longer and slackened

  1. Fixing of Steel Bridges

In bridges made of steel girders, one end is fixed and the other end placed on rollers to allow for expansion and contraction.

1

  1. A body weighs 600N on the surface of the earth and 450N on the surface of another planet. Calculate the value of g in that planet (g on the earth = 10N/Kg)               (3mks)

Mass  on the earth’s surface      =          600

                                                                   10

                                                      =          60Kg

 

      Value of g in the other planet           =          450

                                                                  60

 

                                                      =          7.5N/Kg

 

  1. State two applications of electrostatic charges (2mks)

 

  • Electrostatics precipitators
  • Finger printing
  • Spray painting

Photocopying

 

 

  1. 200 coulombs of charge passes through a point in a circuit for 0.6 minutes. What is the magnitude of the current flowing? (3mks)

 

Q=It

             200=I×0.6×60

 

I=

 

=5.556A

  1. While heating water in a beaker, a wire gauze is placed below the beaker explain.(2mks)

 

The vessel is placed on a wire gauZe because the gauZe is a good conductor of heat it therefore spreads the heat to a large area of the vessel.Without gauze heat will concentrate at one point which may lead to uneven expansion of glass hence break.

  1. What is the relationship between physics and technology (2mks)

 

  • Machines used in the field of medicine such as x-rays, body scanners and lasers are all applications of physics.
  • Manufacture and use of satellites and microwave dishes used in information technology to relay information is based on physics knowledge
  • Physics knowledge is also used in defense industry in the manufacture and useof most modern and complex machines.

 

  1. Using the domain theory distinguish between magnetic material and a magnet (2mks)

 

  • For a magnet the dipoles in all domains align towards a common direction while in magnetic magnetic material dipoles in every domain are aligned in different direction.
  1. State two application of convection in fluids (2mks)
  • Domestic hot water system
  • Cooling system of car engine
  • Ventilation
  • Land and sea breeze

 

  1. Convert a temperature of 234K to degree celsious                                (1mk)

 

T=Ѳ +273

234=   Ѳ+273

Ѳ= 234-273= -39c

 

 

 

 

 

 

SECTION B (55 MARKS)

 

  1. (a) State Hooke’s law                                                                                         (1mk)

 

For a helical spring or other elastic material, the extension is directly proportional to thestretching force, provided elastic limit is not exceeded.

 

(b) In an experiment to verify Hooke’s law, a piece of rubber was fixed to a rigid support and the other end pulled with a force of ranging magnitude.  The values of force and the extension were recorded as in the table below:-

 

Force (N) 0 0.20 0.55 0.75 1.00 1.30 1.40
Extension(cm) 0 1.5 2.5 3.5 4.5 6.0 7.0

 

  • Plot a graph of force ( Y axis) against extension (X-axis) on the gird provided

(5mks)

     Plotting=2mk

Scale=1mk

Line=1mk

Axes= 1mk

  • From the graph, determine the spring constant of the rubber within elastic limit

(3mks)

 

                                   K  =         F/E

                                               

Gradient = 0.75  –  0.2

3.5  – 1.0

 

                =  0.5

                    2.5

 

              =  0.2N/cm

 

 

  • What is the size of force at the elastic limit             (1mks)

 

1.3 N  -check on student graph where the straight line starts a bend

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  1. (a) State one characteristic of a brake fluid. (1mk)

-must be incompressible

-should not corrode the parts of break system

-have high boiling point

-have  low freezing point

(b) The height of a mercury barometer at a particular place is 70cm. given that the density of mercury is 13600kgm3, determine;

(i) The atmospheric pressure at the place.                                                                             (3mks)

 

 

Pa = 0.7×13600×10

 

=95200N/m2

 

(ii) The height of a water barometer at the same place. (Density of water=1g/cm3)                       (2mks)

 

95200=h×1000×10

                        h =

                    =9.52m

 

(iii) Give a reason why mercury is preferred as a barometric liquid.                                   (1mks)

 

Mercury is much denser than water. It also supports a small and measurable column

 

 

(c) Calculate the minimum pressure a block of dimensions 3cm by 10cm by 15cm and mass 12kg could exert on a horizontal surface.                                                                                          (3mks)

 

Pmin=

 

=8000N/m2

 

  • a) Differentiate between transverse waves and longitudinal waves.(2mks)

 

Transverse waves, the vibration of the particles is a right angles to the direction of wave travel while longitudinal waves, the vibration of the particles is in a direction parallel to the direction of the wave travel.

 

b)The figure below shows a wave form in a string.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Given that the speed of the wave is 10m/s. With reference to this wave motion, determine;

  1.           (1mk)

                             50-10= 40m

 

  1.           (1mk)

 

5m

  • (2mks)

 

  f= velocity/wavelength

   =10/40 = 0.25Hz

 

  1. Period                                                   (2mks)

 

t= 1/f     =1/0.25  = 4s

 

 

 

 

 

 

  1. A person standing 49.5m from the foot of a cliff claps his hands and hears an echo 0.3 seconds later. Calculate the velocity of the sound in air.           (3mks)

 

 

  1. (a) What property of light is suggested by the formation of shadows?       (1mk)

 

Rectilinear propagation of light/light travels in a straight line

 

(b) A building standing 200m from a pinhole camera produces on the screen of the camera an image 2.5cm high 5.0cm behind the pinhole.

Determine the actual height of the building                                                                          (3mks)

 

                        hi  =  v

                        ho      u

 

                        ho  =2.5  x  20000

                                         5

                        =  10000cm  or 100m

 

 

 

 

 

 

(c) An object of height 2.0cm is placed 5.0cm in front of a convex mirror of focal length 10.0cm

(i) On the grid provided,draw to scale a ray diagram to locate the position of the image.(4mks)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  1. ii) State two applications of concave mirrors (2mks)

 -shaving mirrors

-By dentist to examine teeth

 

  1. (a) When is an object said to be in stable equilibrium?       (1mk)

 

A body is said to be in a stable equilibrium if it returns to the original position after being displaced slightly.

 

(b)  A uniform metal rod of length 80cm and mass 3.2kg is supported horizontally by two vertical spring’s balances C and D balance C is also from one end while balance D is 30cm from the other end. Find the reading on each balance                                                    (4mks)

 

 

 

 

When pivot at C:

Then C.M = (30 x 32) Ncm

A.C.M = 50D

C.M = A.C.M =>

D = 19.2N

 

C + D = 32N

C = 32 – 19.2

= 12.8N

Reading on C = 12.8N

Reading on D = 19.2N

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  1. (a) The figure below shows an electric bell. Briefly explain how it works.  (4mks)

 

 

When circuit is closed, soft iron coregets magnetized and attracts the soft iron ammarture.The hammer being attached to the armature thus strikes the gong. the contacts breaks, core looses magnetism and armature returns to normal position.The process repeats.

  • State the right hand grip rule for straight conductor carrying current (1mks)

 

When a straight conductor is held with right hand,with thumb showing the direction of current then the fingers show direction of magnetic field

  1. a) State the equation of continuity (1mk)

 

AV= constant   / A1V1=A2V2

a-area v- velocity

 

  1. b) The velocity of glycerin in a 5cm internal diameter pipe is 1.00m/s. Find the velocity in a 3cm internal diameter pipe that connects with it, both pipes flowing full. (3mks)

 

A1=   22/7*2.5*10-4

A2= 22/7* 1.5*10-4

 

A1V1=A2V2

V2=  A1V1/A2

 

22/7*2. 52*10-4 *1)/22/7* 1.52*10-4

=2.778M/S

DATA SECURITY AND CONTROL COMPUTER TEACHER NOTES NEW PDF

 DATA SECURITY AND CONTROL

Introduction

Data & Information must be protected against unauthorized access, disclosure, modification or damage.  This is because; it is a scarce & valuable resource for any business organization or government.  It is mostly used in transactions, it can be shared, and has high value attached to it.

Data & Information security:

Data security is the protection of data & information from accidental or intentional disclosure to unauthorized persons.

Data & Information privacy:

Private data or information is that which belongs to an individual & must not be accessed by or disclosed to any other person, without direct permission from the owner.

Confidential data or information – this is data or information held by a government or organization about people.  This data/information may be seen by authorized persons without the knowledge of the owner.  However, it should not be used for commercial gain or any other unofficial purpose without the owner being informed.

Review Questions

 

  1. Differentiate between private and confidential data.
  2. Why is information called a resource?
  3. (a) Explain the term ‘Information security’.

(b)  Recently, data and information security has become very important.  Explain.

 

SECURITY THREATS TO DATA & INFORMATION

 

  • COMPUTER VIRUSES

 

  • A computer virus is a destructive program that attaches itself to other files when the files are opened for use, and installs itself on the computer, without the knowledge of the user.

 

  • A computer virus is a program designed specifically to damage other programs or interfere with the proper functioning of the computer system.

 

A virus is a computer code usually designed to carry out 2 tasks:

 

  • To copy itself from one computer system to another.
  • To locate itself within a computer system enabling it to amend/destroy program & data files, by interfering with the normal processes of the operating system.

 

Types of computer viruses.

 

  1. Boot sector viruses – they destroy the booting information on storage devices.

 

  1. File viruses – they attach themselves to files either erasing or modifying them.

 

  1. Hoax viruses – they come as e-mails with an attractive subject & activate themselves when the e-mail is opened.

 

  1. Trojans – they appear to perform necessary functions, but perform other undesirable activities in the background without the knowledge of the user.

 

  1. Worms – viruses that stick in the computer memory.

 

  1. Backdoors – may be a Trojan or Worm that allows hidden access to a computer system.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Types of destructions/damages caused by a virus attack

 

  • Delete or modify data, information & files on storage devices (disks) or memory during normal program execution, e.g., may attack the format of a disk making any program or data on it impossible to recover.
  • Systematically destroy all the data in the computer memory.
  • Might lock the keyboard.
  • Can change keystroke values or data from other I/O devices, e.g., change the effect of SHIFT key.
  • Delete characters displayed on a visual display.
  • Uses up computer memory/space, hence slowing down its performance or causing the system to crash.
  • Changes colour of the display.
  • Cause boot failure.

 

Sources of viruses.

 

  1. Contact with contaminated systems:

 

If a diskette is used on a virus infected computer, it could become contaminated.  If the same diskette is used on another computer, then the virus will spread.

 

  1. Use of pirated software:

 

Pirated software may be contaminated by a virus code or it may have been amended to perform some destructive functions which may affect your computer.

 

  1. Infected proprietary software:

 

A virus could be introduced when the software is being developed in laboratories, and then copied onto diskettes containing the finished software product.

 

  1. Fake games:

 

Some virus programs behave like games software.  Since many people like playing games on computers, the virus can spread very fast.

 

  1. Freeware and Shareware:

 

Both freeware & shareware programs are commonly available in Bulletin board systems.

Such programs should first be used in controlled environment until it is clear that the program does not contain either a virus or a destructive code.

 

  1. Updates of software distributed via networks:

 

Viruses programs can be spread through software distributed via networks.

 

Symptoms of viruses in a computer system.

 

The following symptoms indicate the presence of a virus in your computer:

 

  • Boot failure.
  • Files & programs disappearing mysteriously.
  • Unfamiliar graphics or messages appearing on the screen, e.g., the virus might flash a harmless message such as “Merry Christmas” on the computer terminal.
  • Slow booting.
  • Gradual filing of the free space on the hard disk.
  • Corruption of files and programs.
  • Programs taking longer than usual to load.
  • Disk access time seeming too long for simple tasks.
  • Unusual error messages occurring more frequently.
  • Frequent read/write errors.
  • Disk access lights turning on for non-referenced devices.
  • Computer hags anytime when running a program.
  • Less memory available than usual, e.g., Base memory may read less than 640KB.
  • Size of executable files changing for no obvious reason.

 

Control measures against viruses.

 

  • Install up-to-date (or the latest) antivirus software on the computers.

 

  • Restrict the movement of foreign storage media, e.g., diskettes in the computer room.

 

If they have to be used, they must be scanned for viruses.

 

  • Avoid opening mail attachments before scanning them for viruses.

 

  • Write-protect disks after using them.

 

  • Disable floppy disk drives, if there is no need to use disks in the course of normal operation.

 

  • Backup all software & data files at regular intervals.

 

  • Do not boot your computer from disks which you are not sure are free from viruses.

 

  • Avoid pirated software. If possible, use the software from the major software houses.

 

  • Programs downloaded from Bulletin Boards & those obtained from computer clubs should be carefully evaluated & examined for any destructive code.

 

  • UNAUTHORIZED ACCESS

 

Data & information is always under constant threat from people who may want to access it without permission.  Such persons will usually have a bad intention, either to commit fraud, steal the information & destroy or corrupt the data.

 

Unauthorized access may take the following forms:

 

  • Eavesdropping:

 

This is tapping into communication channels to get information, e.g., Hackers mainly use eavesdropping to obtain credit card numbers.

 

  • Surveillance (monitoring):

 

This is where a person may monitor all computer activities done by another person or people.

The information gathered may be used for different purposes, e.g., for spreading propaganda or sabotage.

 

  • Industrial espionage:

 

Industrial espionage involves spying on a competitor so as to get or steal information that can be used to finish the competitor or for commercial gain.

The main aim of espionage is to get ideas on how to counter by developing similar approach or sabotage.

 

  • An employee who is not supposed to see some sensitive data gets it, either by mistake or design.

 

  • Strangers who may stray into the computer room when nobody is using the computers.

 

  • Forced entry into the computer room through weak access points.

 

  • Network access in case the computers are networked & connected to the external world.

 

Control measures against unauthorized access.

 

  • Enforce data & information access control policies on all employees to control access to data.
  • Keep the computer room closed when nobody is using it.
  • Reinforce weak access points, e.g., doors & windows with metallic grills & burglar alarms.
  • Use file passwords to prevent any person from getting access to the electronic files.
  • Enforce network security measures, e.g., use of firewalls.
  • Encrypt the data & information during transmission.
  • Perform frequent Audit trails to identify threats to data & information.

 

  • COMPUTER ERRORS & ACCIDENTAL ACCESS

 

Errors and accidental access to data & information may be as a result of:

 

  • Mistakes made by people, e.g., one may print sensitive reports & unsuspectingly give them to unauthorized persons.
  • People experimenting with features they are not familiar with. g., a person may innocently download a file without knowing that it is self-installing or it may be dangerous to the system.

 

Control measures against computer errors & accidents.

 

  • Restrict file access to the end-users and technical staff in the organization, i.e., deny access of certain files & computers to certain groups of end-users.

 

This is because; accidental access mistakes occur if the end-users have too much privilege that allows them to access or change sensitive files on the computer.

 

  • Set up a comprehensive error-recovery strategy in the organization.

 

  • THEFT

 

The threat of theft of data & information, hardware & software is real.  Some information is so valuable such that business competitors or some governments can decide to pay somebody a fortune so as to steal the information for them to use.

 

Control measures against theft of information, hardware, & software.

 

  • Create backups & store them in locations away from the main computing centre.
  • Reinforce weak access points, e.g., the windows, doors, & roofing with metallic grills and strong padlocks.
  • Put burglar proofs in the computer room.
  • Employ guards to keep watch over data & information centres and backups.

 

Review Questions

 

  1. Explain any three threats to data and information.
  2. Give two control measures one would take to avoid unauthorized access to data and information.
  3. Explain the meaning of ‘industrial espionage’.
  4. (a) Define a computer virus.

(b)  Give and explain two types of computer viruses.

(c)  List three types of risks that computer viruses pose.

(d) List and explain five sources of computer viruses.

(e)  Outline four symptoms of computer viruses.

(f)  Explain the measures one would take to protect computers from virus attacks

  1. How can one control the threat of user’s errors to data and information?

 

 

 

 

 

 

COMPUTER CRIMES

 

  • A computer crime is a deliberate theft or criminal destruction of computerized data.

 

  • The use of computer hardware, software, or data for illegal activities, e.g., stealing, forgery, defrauding, etc.

 

  • Committing of illegal acts using a computer or against a computer system.

 

Types of computer crimes.

 

The following are the major types of computer crimes:

 

  1. Fraud (Theft of money)
  2. Alteration of data.
  3. Theft of computer time / Theft of service.
  4. Theft of data, information or programs.
  5. Damage of software.

 

Trespass.

 

  • Trespass refers to the illegal physical entry to restricted places where computer hardware, software & backed up data is kept.

 

  • It can also refer to the act of accessing information illegally on a local or remote computer over a network.

 

Trespass is not allowed and should be discouraged.

 

Hacking.

 

Hacking is an attempt to invade the privacy of a system, either by tapping messages being transmitted along a public telephone line, or through breaking security codes & passwords to gain unauthorized entry to the system data and information files in a computer.

 

Reasons for hacking.

 

  • To copy or corrupt the information.
  • As a hobby to test their expertise. Some people like the challenge & they feel great after successful hacking.
  • Some do it for computer & software producing companies that want to secure their systems by reducing weaknesses discovered after professional hacking.

 

Hacking is done by skilled programmers referred to as HackersHacker is a person who gains unauthorised access to a computer network for profit, criminal mischief, or personal gain.

 

Such people are able to break through passwords or find weak access points in software.  They are involved in propagating computer viruses.

 

Tapping.

 

Tapping involves listening to a transmission line to gain a copy of the message being transmitted.

 

Tapping may take place through the following ways:

 

  1. A person may send an intelligent program to a host computer that sends him/her information from the computer.
  2. Spying on a networked computer using special programs that are able to intercept messages being sent & received by the unsuspecting computer.

 

Cracking.

 

Cracking is the use of guesswork by a person trying to look for a weakness in the security codes of a software in order to get access to data & information.

 

These weak access points can only be sealed using sealed using special corrective programs called Patches, which are prepared by the manufacturing company.

A program patch is a software update that when incorporated in the current software makes it better.

 

NB: Cracking is usually done by people who have some idea of passwords or user names of the authorized staff.

 

Piracy.

 

Software, information & data are protected by copyright laws. Piracy means making illegal copies of copyrighted software, data, or information either for personal use or for re-sale.

 

Ways of reducing piracy:

 

  1. Enact & enforce copyright laws that protect the owners of data & information against piracy.
  2. Make software cheap enough to increase affordability.
  • Use licenses and certificates of authenticity to identify originals.
  1. Set installation passwords that prevent illegal installation of software.

 

Fraud.

 

Fraud is the use of computers to conceal information or cheat other people with the intention of gaining money or information.

 

Fraud may take the following forms:

 

  • Input manipulation:

 

Data input clerks can manipulate input transactions, e.g., they can create dummy (ghost) employees on the Salary file or a ghost supplier on the Purchases file.

 

  • Production & use of fake documents:

 

E.g., a person created an intelligent program in the Tax department that could credit his account with cents from all the tax payers.  He ended up becoming very rich before he was discovered.

 

Fraudsters can either be employees in the company or outsiders who are smart enough to defraud unsuspecting people.

 

Reasons that may lead to computer fraud.

 

  • For economic gain (i.e., to gain money or information).
  • To gain respect (self-worth)

 

Security measures to prevent fraud:

 

  1. Careful recruitment of staff.
  2. Set up a clear & firm management policy on crimes & frauds.
  • Restrict access to computer room or terminal.
  1. Use transaction & fill logs to monitor access to sensitive areas of the system.
  2. Monitor & investigate error logs and reports on regular basis.
  3. Carry out risk analysis to examine the exposure of the organization to possible fraud.

 

 

 

Sabotage.

 

Sabotage is the illegal or malicious destruction of the system, data or information by employees or other people with grudges with the aim of crippling service delivery or causing great loss to an organization.

 

Sabotage is usually carried out by discontented employees or those sent by competitors to cause harm to the organization.

 

The following are some acts of saboteurs which can result in great damage to the computer centres:

 

  • Using Magnets to mix up (mess up) codes on tapes.
  • Planting of bombs.
  • Cutting of communication lines.

 

Alteration.

 

Alteration is the illegal changing of stored data & information without permission with the aim of gaining or misinforming the authorized users.

 

Alteration is usually done by those people who wish to hide the truth.  It makes the data irrelevant and unreliable.

 

Alteration may take place through the following ways:

 

  • Program alteration:

 

This is done by people with excellent programming skills.  They do this out of malice or they may liaise with others for selfish gains.

 

  • Alteration of data in a database:

 

This is normally done by authorized database users, e.g., one can adjust prices on Invoices, increase prices on selling products, etc, and then pocket the surplus amounts.

 

Security measures to prevent alteration:

 

  1. Do not give data editing capabilities to anybody without vetting.
  2. The person altering the data may be forced to sign in order for the system to accept altering the information.

 

Theft of computer time.

 

Employees may use the computers of an organization to do their own work, e.g., they may produce publications for selling using the computers of the company.

 

Theft of data (i.e., commercial espionage).

 

Employees steal sensitive information or copy packages and sell them to outsiders or competitors for profit.

This may lead to a leakage of important information, e.g., information on marketing strategies used by the organization, research information, or medical reports.

 

Review Questions

 

  1. (a) Define the term ‘Computer crime’.

(b)  State and explain various types of computer crimes.

  1. Differentiate between Hacking and Cracking with reference to computer crimes.
  2. What is a program patch? Why are patches important?
  3. Give two reasons that may lead to computer fraud.
  4. How can piracy be prevented in regard to data and information.
  5. What is data alteration? Explain its effects on data.
  6. Explain the meaning of Tapping while dealing with computer crimes.

 

DETECTION & PROTECTION AGAINST COMPUTER CRIMES

The following measures can be taken to detect & prevent computer crimes, and also seal security loopholes.

 

Audit trails

 

This is a careful study of an information system by experts in order to establish (or, find out) all the weaknesses in the system that could lead to security threats or act as weak access points for criminals.

 

An audit of the information system may seek to answer the following questions: –

 

  1. Is the information system meeting all the design objectives as originally intended?
  2. Have all the security measures been put in place to reduce the risk of computer crimes?
  3. Are the computers secured in physically restricted areas?
  4. Is there backup for data & information of the system that can ensure continuity of services even when something serious happens to the current system?
  5. What real risks face the system at present or in future?

 

Data encryption

 

Data being transmitted over a network faces the dangers of being tapped, listened to, or copied to unauthorized destinations.

To protect such data, it is mixed up into a form that only the sender & the receiver can be able to understand by reconstructing the original message from the mix.  This is called Data encryption.

 

The flow diagram below shows how a message can be encrypted and decrypted to enhance security.

 

 

 

 

Cyphertext

 

 

Plain text                                                                                          Plain text

Encryption key                        Decryption key

The message to be encrypted is called the Plain text document.  After encryption using a particular order (or, algorithm) called encryption key, it is sent as Cyphertext on the network.

After the recipient receives the message, he/she decrypts it using a reverse algorithm to the one used during encryption called decryption key to get the original plain text document.

This means that, without the decryption key, it is not possible to reconstruct the original message.

 

Log files

 

These are special system files that keep a record (log) of events on the use of the computers and resources of the information system.

 

Each user is usually assigned a username & password or account.  The information system administrator can therefore easily track who accessed the system, when and what they did on the system.  This information can help monitor & track people who are likely to violate system security policies.

 

Firewalls

 

A Firewall is a device or software system that filters the data & information exchanged between different networks by enforcing the access control policy of the host network.

 

A firewall monitors & controls access to or from protected networks.  People (remote users) who do not have permission cannot access the network, and those within cannot access sites outside the network restricted by firewalls.

LAWS GOVERNING PROTECTION OF INFORMATION

Laws have been developed that govern the handling of data & information in order to ensure that there is ‘right of privacy’ for all people.

 

The following rules must be observed in order to keep within the law when working with data and information.

 

  1. Data & information should be kept secure against loss or exposure.
  2. Data & information should not be kept longer than necessary.
  3. Data & information should be accurate and up-to-date.
  4. Data & information should be collected, used & kept for specified lawful purposes (i.e., it should not be used for unlawful gain).
  5. The owner of the data has a right to know what data is held by the person or organization having it.
  6. Data should not be transferred to other countries without the owner’s permission.
  7. Do not collect irrelevant and overly too much information for a purpose.

 

 

WEEKEND ASSIGNMENT 2015

FORM 3 AND 4

 

  1. What do the following control measures against computer crimes involve?
  • Audit trail.
  • Data encryption.
  • Log files.
  1. Give four rules that must be observed to keep within the law when working with data and information.
  2. Explain any three threats to data and information.
  3. Give two control measures one would take to avoid unauthorized access to data and information.
  4. Explain the meaning of ‘industrial espionage’.
  5. (a) Define a computer virus.

(b)  Give and explain two types of computer viruses.

(c)  List three types of risks that computer viruses pose.

(d) List and explain five sources of computer viruses.

(e)  Outline four symptoms of computer viruses.

(f)  Explain the measures one would take to protect computers from virus attacks

  1. How can one control the threat of user’s errors to data and information?
  2. (a) Define the term ‘Computer crime’.
  3. State and explain various types of computer crimes.
  4. Differentiate between Hacking and Cracking with reference to computer crimes.
  5. What is a program patch? Why are patches important?
  6. Give two reasons that may lead to computer fraud.
  7. How can piracy be prevented in regard to data and information.
  8. What is data alteration? Explain its effects on data.
  9. Explain the meaning of Tapping while dealing with computer crimes.
  10. (a) What is Computer security?

(b)  Mention various threats to computer security.

  1. Discuss the environmental problems affecting the operation of computers.
  2. State and discuss four causes of data loss in a computer system.
  3. a) Discuss two methods used to restrict unauthorised access to computer systems.
  4. b) What is a Password? Give its main importance.

 

 

 

 

 

GOOD LUCK

 

 

 

COMPUTER SECURITY

What is Computer security?

 

  • Safeguarding the computer & the related equipments from the risk of damage or fraud.

 

  • Protection of data & information against accidental or deliberate threats which might cause unauthorised modification, disclosure, or destruction.

 

A computer system can only be claimed to be secure if precautions are taken to safeguard it against damage or threats such as accidents, errors & omissions.

 

The security measures to be undertaken by the organization should be able to protect:

 

  1. Computer hardware against damage.
  2. Data, information & programs against accidental alteration or deletion.
  • Data & information against hazards.
  1. The computer against unauthorised use.
  2. Data, information & programs against piracy or unauthorised copying.
  3. Data & programs used by the computer system against illegal or unauthorised modification.
  • Storage media, e.g., diskettes, tapes, etc against accidental destruction.
  • Policies of the organization.
  1. Accidental interruption of power supply or communication lines.
  2. Disclosure of confidential data or information.
  • Ensure that both hardware & software have longer life span.

 

Environmental threats to computers & Information systems.

 

 

Fire destroys data, information, software & hardware.

 

Security measures against fire:

 

  • Use fire-proof cabinets & lockable metal boxes for floppy disks.
  • Use of backups.
  • Install fire fighting equipments, e.g., fire extinguishers.
  • Have some detectors.
  • Training of fire-fighting officers.
  • Observe safety procedures, e.g., avoid smoking in the computer rooms.
  • Have well placed exit signs.
  • Contingency plans.

 

  • Water, floods & moisture.

 

This causes rusting of the metallic components of the computer.

 

Security measures against water, floods & moisture:

 

  • Set up computer rooms on higher grounds to avoid floods & humidity.
  • Avoid installing computer components in the basement.
  • There should be adequate drainage system.
  • Use water-proof ceilings & floors.

 

  • Lightening, electricity & electrical storms.

 

This causes power failure that can cause damage to data, which has not been transferred to permanent storage devices.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Security measures:

 

  • Install facilities to control power fluctuations, e.g., use of Uninterrupted power source (UPS)
  • Use power stabilizers.
  • Have standby power generators/sources.
  • Have lightening arresters in the building.

 

  • Excessive Heat or Temperature.

 

Excessive heat or temperature from the computer itself or from the surrounding environment can destroy computer storage media or devices.

 

Security measures:

 

  • There should be efficient ventilation system.
  • Use a cooling system in the computer rooms, e.g., cooling fans & air conditioners.

 

  • Computer virus attack.

 

A virus is a rogue software program that spreads rampantly through computer systems, destroying data or causing the system to break down.

 

Security measures against computer virus:

 

  • Make backup copies of software, and store the copies off-site.
  • Restrict access to programs & data on a ‘need-to-use’ basis.
  • Check all programs regularly for change of size, as this could be a sign of virus infiltration.
  • Be careful with ‘Shareware’ and ‘Freeware’ programs, as they are the major entry points for viruses.
  • Make sure all purchased software is in its original sealed-disk containers.

 

  • Smoke and Dust.

 

Dust and Smoke particles settle on storage devices and may scratch them during Read/write operation.

 

Security measures:

 

  • Have dust mats or carpets to prevent entry of dust.
  • Fit the computer room with special Curtains to reduce entry of dust particles.
  • Cover the devices with Dust covers when cleaning the room.
  • Remove shoes before entering the room to prevent dust.

 

  • Terrorist attack.

 

This includes activities such as:

 

  • Political terrorists,
  • Criminal type of activities,
  • Individuals with grudges, or
  • People intending to cause general destruction.

 

Security measures:

 

  • Hiring of security guards to control physical access to the building housing the computer room.
  • Activities that can cause terrorism should be avoided, e.g., exploitation of workers.
  • Have double door & monitoring devices.
  • Use of policies.
  • System auditing / use of log files.
  • Use of passwords.
  • Punitive measures.
  • Encryption of data.
  • Use of firewalls.
  • Consult & co-operate with the Police and Fire authorities on potential risks.

 

 

People threats include:

 

  • Accidental deletion of data, information or programs.
  • Vandalism, i.e., theft or destruction of data, information or programs & hardware.
  • Piracy of copyrighted data & software.

 

Security measures against Carelessness & Clumsiness:

 

  • Better selection of personnel.
  • Have a good office layout.
  • Improve employee training and education.
  • Limit access to data and computers.
  • Regular backups.
  • Use of Undelete & Unformat utilities.

 

Security measures against Vandalism:

 

  • Should have a sensitive attitude to office behaviour.
  • Tighten security measures, e.g., install alarm systems, burglar-proof doors/windows, & roofs).
  • Limit access to sensitive company information.
  • Use Keyboard lock on terminals used by authorised users.
  • Use of disk locks.
  • Punitive measures.

 

 

Review Questions

 

  1. (a) What is Computer security?

(b)  Mention various threats to computer security.

  1. Discuss the environmental problems affecting the operation of computers.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

CAUSES OF DATA LOSS IN COMPUTERS

  1. Power failure:

Momentary interruptions or fluctuations of electrical power may cause:

 

  • Crashing of computers.
  • Loss of data or information that had not been saved before the power disruption.
  • Damage to computer’s secondary storage media. This may result to loss of data & Application software stored on the media.

 

The main cause of power disruptions are:

  • Amplitude fluctuations,
  • Power line noise,
  • Low voltage sages,
  • High voltage surges,
  • Voltage outages,
  • Voltage spikes,
  • Waveform distortions,
  • Power frequency variations.

 

Precautions against data loss due to Power failure:

 

  1. Regular saving of documents.

 

Frequent saving of documents ensures that minimum data is lost in case of any power failure.

Some application packages have an AutoSave feature, which should be activated to automatically save work after a specified time interval.

 

  1. Use of Uninterruptible Power Supply (UPS).

 

To eliminate any power quality defects or fluctuation, use power correction equipment such as a Stabilizer or Uninterruptible Power Supply (UPS).  These equipments ensure a steady flow of input power to the computer system.

 

  1. Computer viruses:

A computer virus destroys all the data files & programs in the computer memory by interfering with the normal processes of the operating system.

 

Precautions against computer viruses:

 

  1. Anti-virus software.

 

Use Antivirus software to detect & remove known viruses from infected files.

 

Some of the commonly used Antivirus software are: Dr. Solomon’s Toolkit, Norton Antivirus, AVG Antivirus, PC-Cillin, etc

 

NB:  The best way to prevent virus is to have a memory-resident antivirus software, which will detect the virus before it can affect the system.  This can be achieved by installing a GUARD program in the RAM every time the computer boots up.  Once in the RAM, the antivirus software will automatically check diskettes inserted in the drives & warn the user immediately if a disk is found to have a virus.

 

  • For an antivirus to be able to detect a virus, it must know its signature. Since virus writers keep writing new viruses with new signatures all the time, it is recommended that you update your antivirus product regularly so as to include the latest virus signatures in the industry.

 

  • The Antivirus software installed in your computer should be enabled/activated at all times.

 

  • You should also perform virus scans of your disks on a regular basis.

 

  • Evaluate the security procedures to ensure that the risk of future virus attack is minimized.

 

Review Questions

 

  1. Describe two ways of preventing data loss due to power outage.
  2. (a) What is a Computer virus?

(b)  What are Anti-viruses?  Explain how they detect and remove viruses.

 

  1. Accidental erasure:

Commands such as DELETE & FORMAT can be dangerous to the computer if used wrongly.

Both commands wipe out the information stored on the specified secondary storage media, e.g., formatting the Hard disk (drive C:) will destroy all the software on that system.

 

Precautions against Accidental erasure:

 

  1. Use of Undelete utilities.

 

Use the Undelete facilities in case you accidentally delete your files.

 

There are two Undelete facilities depending on the operating system you are using.

  • MS-DOS 6.0 Undelete facility:

 

To undelete at the DOS prompt, change to the drive & directory whose files were deleted, then type, e.g.,

C:\>UNDELETE <directory that contain the deleted file>

A list of all deleted files will be displayed with the first letter missing.  Type in the first letter and the file will be recovered.

 

  • Norton utilities & PC Tools:

 

Norton utilities & PC Tools also have an undelete facility, which is similar to the DOS Undelete facility.

 

  • Windows Recycle Bin:

 

The Recycle Bin temporarily stores all deleted files & can be used to recover your files.

 

  1. Double-click the Recycle Bin on the desktop.
  2. Click on the files you want to undelete.
  3. Click on File, choose Restore.

The Recycle Bin will restore all selected files to their original folders and disks.

 

NB:  If you delete a file accidentally, don’t copy any files or install any applications to the disk that contains the deleted file.  If you write anything to the disk, you might destroy parts of the deleted file, making it unrecoverable.

 

  1. Use of Unformat utilities.

 

MS-DOS 6.0 has an Unformat facility which can be used to recover information stored on disks that have been accidentally formatted.

 

  1. Use of Backups.

 

All data must be backed up periodically either on diskettes, tapes or CDs so that in case of any accidental loss, the backed up copy can be used to recover the data.

For small files, use the Copy command to make a copy of the data on a diskette.  For larger amounts of data, use the Backup command to copy the data to several diskettes or to a tape drive.

 

Review Questions

 

  1. Name two commands that can erase the information from a disk.
  2. Define ‘Data backup’ and state its importance.

 

  1. Crashing of hard disks:

When a hard disk crashes, the data or information on the disk cannot be accessed.  The effect is the same as formatting the hard disk.

 

Crashing of a hard disk can occur due to the following reasons:

 

  1. Mishandling of the computer system, e.g.,
  • Moving the system unit while the computer is on.
  • Accumulation of dust.

 

  1. Computer virus attack.
  • Physical damage to the System unit caused by dropping or banging when being moved.

 

Precautions against crashing of Hard disks:

 

  1. Use of Backups.

 

All data must be backed up regularly.  In addition, all application programs & operating system software should also be kept safely so that in case of a complete system crash, everything can be re-installed/restored.

 

  1. Use of Recovery tools.

 

System tools such as Norton Utilities, PC Tools, QAPlus, etc can be used to revive a disk that has crashed.

 

Review Questions

 

  1. List two possible causes of a hard disk crash.

 

  1. Unauthorised access:

Unauthorised access refers to access to data & information without permission.

 

Computer criminals can do the following harms:

 

  • Steal large amounts of funds belonging to various companies by transferring them out of their computer accounts illegally.
  • Steal or destroy data & information from companies, bringing their operations to a standstill.
  • Spread destruction from one computer to another using virus programs. This can cripple the entire system of computer networks.
  • Spread computer worm programs. Worm programs are less harmful in the beginning, but render the computer almost useless in the long-run.

 

Precautions against Unauthorised access:

 

  1. Restrict physical access.

 

Physical access to computer systems should be restricted to ensure that no unauthorised person gets access to the system.

 

Some of the ways of restricting physical access include:

 

  • Locking of doors.
  • Use of personal identification cards.
  • Use of fingerprint identification.
  • Use of special voice-recorders. They analyse the voice of a trespasser & checks against the database containing the voice patterns of valid users.

 

  1. Password protection.

 

Install a password to restrict access to the computer system.

 

A Password is a secret code that can be used to prevent unauthorised access of data in a computer.

 

Passwords can be put in at various levels:

 

  • At the point of switching on the computer – to restrict access to the computer.
  • On folders/directories – to restrict access to entire folders/directories.
  • On files – to restrict access to individual files within a directory.
  • On database systems – to restrict access to individual data elements.

When a valid password is entered, the user gets access to the computer system.  Usually, the user is allowed three (3) attempts to get the password correct.  If an invalid password is entered, access is denied after the 3 attempts.

 

Some computer security systems may generate an alarm if someone tries to use a fake password.

 

NB:  You should never use passwords that can easily be linked to you, e.g., your name, birth date, or names of people close to you.

Review Questions

  1. State and discuss four causes of data loss in a computer system.
  2. (a) Discuss two methods used to restrict unauthorised access to computer systems.

(b)  What is a Password?  Give its main importance.

Free IRE Form 1-4 Notes, Revision Questions And Answers

FORM ONE IRE NOTES

CHAPTER 1

QURAN

Read [Q: 36:2]; [Q: 85:21];[Q: 17:9]
Meaning of the Quran

The Quran is a religious book used by Muslims all over the world as a book of guidance. Most of the
world religions have their specific books which they use for reference. Do you know any religious
books used by members other faiths? Can you mention any of them? Just as every religion has its
own religious book, Muslims have the Quran as their main source of reference and they have a duty
to learn, understand and constantly refer to it. As a Muslim, have you read the Quran? Muslims
believe that the Holy Quran is the last book to be revealed by Allah. It is because of its important
position in the Islamic faith that throughout our course we shall be using the Quran as our immediate
source of reference.

 

Can you remember the meaning of the word Quran from your Islamic Religious Education in Primary school?

This word comes from an Arabic root qara’a which means “to read or to recite.” Quran in Arabic
therefore literally means recitation or something that is continuously recited. It is equivalent in

meaning         to                                    qira’ah,           as         both         come         from         the           same                                                                verb                ‘qara’a.’

This name is specifically mentioned in the text of the Quran as a reference to itself in several places. From the verses you have read, you will learn that the Quran has been referred as a book of guidance, a book full of wisdom and a Glorious. Read the following verses:

In Islam the word Quran is defined as the divine speech of Allah Subhanahu Wa Taala (S.W.T), sent down upon the last Prophet Muhammad Peace be Upon Him (P.B.U.H), through the Angel Jibril Aleihi Swalatu wa Salaam(A.S) to human kind. Since its revelation the Quran has remained the same without being distorted.

 

 

 

 

| P a g e 1

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Other Names of the Quran

Do you know that the Quran is referred to with other different names? Mention some of these names. For the names you have mentioned, it can be seen that some of the names of the Quran have been referred to in the Quran itself while others are derived from the functions of the Quran. Among these names are:

  Furqaan (criterion)                                “Blessed is He Who sent down the Criterion to His servant, that it

may be an admonition to all creatures.”                                       [Q: 25: 1]

  Nadhir (warner) “Verily this Quran Doth guide to that which is most right (or stable), and
giveth the Glad tidings to the believers who work deeds of righteousness, that they have a
magnificent reward.”[Q: 17:9]

  Rahma (mercy) “A guide and a Mercy to the doers of good”[Q: 31:3]

  Tanzil (revelation) “Verily this is a Revelation from the Lord of the Worlds.”[Q: 26: 192]   Dhikr (reminder) “We have without doubt, send down the message; And We will assuredly
guard it (from corruption)[Q: 15: 9]

  Kitab (The book) “We have revealed for you (O men) a Book in which is a message for
you: will you not then understand.”[Q : 21:10]

  Hudan (Guidance) “We gave Moses the book, and made it a Guide to the children of Israel,
(commanding): “Take not other than Me as disposer of (your) affair.”[Q:17: 2:5]
All these names reflect one of the various aspects of the revealed words of Allah. Other

names include Nur (Light), Majid (Glorious), and Mubarak (Blessed) Bashir (Announcer),
among others. Can you mention the other names of the Holy Quran that have not been listed
above?

 

 

 

  1. a) Ulumul Quran

The term Ulum means ‘a science.’Itrefers to the detailed scientific study of a subject. If you look at

the various subjects you are offered in Form one, you will notice that each of them has a different approach of studying it.These approaches are what we refer to as Ulum (theScience).The Quran, being a wide subject area of study also has its unique features that must be studied in a particular way. Therefore, Ulumul Quran is a scientific study that includes a variety of fields related to Al –
Quran such as it’s:

  Revelation.

  Collection and compilation.

  Order and arrangement of suras.

 

| P a g e 2

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  Translation of the Quran (tafsir).

  Reasons for the translation of the suras ( Asbaabu Nnuzul)   Characteristics of language

  Style of writing and theme

  Recitation (Tajweed) among other

We are going to look at one of the above areas in our next discussion.

 

Need for the revelation of the Quran.

In life everything has a reason and a purpose for its being, just as we have a purpose for coming to school. Why do you think the Quran was revealed to humankind? Revelation of the Quran came at a time when there was ignorance and the socity was full of social vices, a period referred to as Jahiliya. Someof the reasons for revelation of the Quran are as follows:

  • The earlier scriptures were tampered and interfered with by man thus losing their
    authenticity. Hence the revelation of the Quran was to correct the wrong message.
  • The Quran was given to Prophet Muhammad, the seal of the prophet with a universal

message unlike the other books which were sent to particular generations at specific time. For example The Torah (Taurat) was sent to the Children of Israel through Prophet Musa (A.S) while Zabur was sent to the followers of Prophet Daud.

Read the following two verses from the Holy Quran:

 

Almighty Allah (S.W.T) Says:“To the Thamud people (We sent) Salih, one of their own
brethren: He said: ‘O my people! Worship Allah; ye have no other god but Him.Now has
come unto you a clear signfrom your Lord! This she camel of Allah is a sign unto you…”

[Q: 7:73]

 

Almighty Allah  (S.W.T) Says:“To the Ad  people,  (We  send) Hud, one of their  own brethren: He said: ‘O my people! Worship Allah! You have No other god but Him. Will you not fear (Allah)?”[Q: 7:65]

 

  • To fulfill Allah’s promise as well as prophesies of the other earlier revealed scriptures on the
    coming of the Quran and that of prophet Muhammad (P.B.U.H).

Almighty Allah (S.W.T)Says:“And remember, Jesus, the son of Mary, said: ‘O children of

Israel! I am the messenger of Allah (sent) to you confirming the law (which came) before

 

| P a g e 3

 

 

 

 

 

me and giving Glad Tidings  of a messenger to  come after mewhose name shall  be
Ahmad.But when he came to them with clear signs, they said, ‘This is evident sorcery.”[Q:
61:6]

  • To narrate and summarizestories and events of the earlier generation in order to offer
    teachings, lessons, warnings and guidance to shape community.

Almighty Allah (S.W.T)Says:“There is in, their stories,instructions for men endued with

understanding.It is not a tale invented,but a confirmation of what went before it-A detailed exposition of all things,and a guide and a mercy to any such as believe.” [Q: 12: 111]

  • Believe in One True God: The most important topic mentioned throughout the Quran is the
    belief in the One, True God. God informs us that He has no partner, no son, no equal, and
    that none has the right to be worshipped except Him alone. Nothing is comparable to God
    and none of His creation resembles Him. The Qur’an also rejects the notion of attributing
    human qualities and limitations to Allah (SWT).

Almighty Allah (S.W.T) says, “And your god is One God. There is no god but He, the Most Gracious, the Most Merciful.” [Q 2:163]

  • Rejection All False Gods: Since Allah alone is the only One worthy of worship, false gods
    must be rejected. The Quranalso rejects the notion of attributing divine qualities to anyone or
    anything other than Allah.

Almighty Allah (S.W.T) Says: “And worship Allah and associate none with Him…”                                                                                                                                                [Q:

4:36]

  • To remind us of the Day of Judgment:This Holy Quranreminds us that everyone will taste
    death and will be held accountable for all their actions and sayings:

Almighty Allah (S.W.T) says: “We shall set up scales of justice for the Day of Judgment, so that not a soul will be dealt with unjustly in the least…”[Q: 21:47]

  • Fulfilling the Intended Way of Life: The purpose of life is to worship Allah alone, and live
    one’s life  according  to  the  way  of  life  prescribed  by  Allah.  In  Islam,  worship  is  a
    comprehensive term that includes all actions and sayings (whether private or public) that
    Allah loves and is pleased with. Therefore, by doing what Allah commands, a Muslim is
    worshipping God and fulfilling his purpose in life.

Almighty Allah (S.W.T) says, “I have only created Jinns and men, that they may serve

Me.”[Q: 51:56]

 

 

 

 

| P a g e 4

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

REVELATION

Revelation is the divine communication of Allah (S.W.T) to his creatures. In this communication, Allah (S.W.T) either uses the Arch Angel Jibril or any by other methods which shall be studies in Form Two. An example of this communication is when Allah (S.W.T) revealed to the Holy Prophet (P.B.U.H) the first five verses of Sura al-Alaqa through Angel Jibril. Refer to [Q: 96:1-5]
The above paragraph shows us thatthe Almighty Allah (S.W.T) communicates to his Prophets in the form of revelations. Allah (S.W.T) says in the Holy Quran that;

“It is not fitting for a man that Allah should speak to him except by inspiration, or from behind a veil, or by sending of a messenger to reveal, with Allah’s permission, what Allah will; for He is most High, Most Wise.”[Q: 42:51] From the verse we have readwe see the Arch Angel Jibril acting as an intermediary between Allah (S.W.T) andthe prophets as the bearer of the revelation.Angel Jibril undertook the following duties in the revelation of the Qur’an:

  1. a) The role of Angel Jibril
  2. He lowered the Quran from Lauhil Mahfudh (well preserved tablet), the seventh heaven to

Baitul- Izza; the lowest heaven.

  1. He lowered the Quran from Baitul-Izza to earthand revealedit in portions to the prophet

throughout his 23 years of prophet hood.

  1. He taught the prophet how to recite the Holy Quran correctly. He would
  2. He assisted the prophet in the order and arrangement of the Quran. He used to appear before
    the prophet at the beginning of every month of Ramadhan and the prophet used to recite all
    the chapters while Jibril would guide him on the order and arrangement.
    5. He played an intermediary role between the Almighty Allah to the prophet (P.B.U.H).
    6. He assisted the prophet in memorizing the Quran during revelation; he would only leave after
    the prophet had grasped the verses.
  3. Assisted the prophet in interpreting and understanding the QuranHe was the comforter of the
    prophet because revelation was a difficult experience.Aisha (R.A.) reported thatAl – Harith
    bin Hisham asked Allah Apostle (P.B.U.H) how the divine inspiration was revealed to Him.
    Allah’s Apostle replied; “sometimes it is revealed like the ringing of a bell, this form of
    inspiration (wahyi) is the hardest of all and then this state passes off after I have grasped
    what is inspired. Sometimes the Angel comes in the form of a man and talks to me and I
    grasp whatever he says.”

What are the other duties that Angel Jibril played in the life of the prophet apart from revealing the

Qur’an?

 

 

 

| P a g e 5

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

b)REASON WHY THE QURAN WAS REVEALED IN PORTIONS.

We have just learnt that Arch Angel Jibril lowered the Quran from Baitul-Izza and revealed it in portions. What do you think are the reasons why the Quran was revealed in portions? Let us consider the following points:

  1. To address the prophet continuouslyin order to strengthen his heart.
    Almighty Allah(S.W.T) says:

“You and those who disbelieve say “why is the Quran not revealed to him all at once?” but it is like that in order that we may steady your heart with it, and I have arranged its component parts in an orderly, consistent manner.”[Q: 25:3]

 

(It is) a Quran which we have divided (into parts from time to time) in order that you might recite it to men at intervals: We have revealed it by stages.”[Q: 17:106]

 

  1. The process of revelation was a very difficult experience considering human ability and
    limitations; therefore it was revealed in portions to ease the task.
  2. To provide room for spiritual growth and development for the prophet and his companions.
  3. To progressively implement the sharia of Allah(S.W.T) that is providing continuous
    guidance.
  4. To make it easy for the believers to understand and apply the rules of the Quran.
  5. To make itsmemorization easier because the Arabs chiefly relied on memory to preserve
    information.

Allah says (S.W.T) “(These are) the ones who wait and watch about you, if you do gain a

victory from Allah, they say: were we not with you? But if the unbelievers gain an advantage over you, and did we not guard you from the believers?” [Q: 4:141]

  1. Dealing with problems as they arise whenever a new happening emerges the Quran was there
    to provide the necessary solutions and answer. Example of this is when the Almighty Allah
    says(S.W.T):

“And they ask you about Dhul Qarnayn tell them I will read to you a report.”[Q: 18:83]

  1. An indication of the true source of the Quran as it was revealed in a period of 23 years

without any contradictions.

The Almighty Allah says (S.W.T):“Won’t they contemplate the Quran if it had come from

other than Allah; they would have found in it many contradictions?” [Q: 4:82]

 

 

SURAT UL FATIHA

| P a g e 6

 

 

 

 

 

 

Al-Fâtiha is the first sûrah (chapter) of the Quran, and was one of the earliest portions of the Quran
revealed to the prophet Muhammad by the angel Jibril. The word ‘Fatiha’ comes from the Arabic
root verb ‘Fataha’ which means an opening, beginning or commencement. Therefore it is referred to
as “Fatihat ul Kitab” (the opening chapter of the Book) or simply Surat ul Fatiha (The Opening
Chapter). The idea of opening or beginning is significant in several ways: first, this is the opening
verse of the Quran, secondly, this is said to be the first complete sûrah that was revealed to the
Prophet, but more importantly this name also symbolizes the fact that the grace of Allâh has opened
the doors of Life to us and that as we begin to live our lives in harmony with the ways of Allâh, the
heart  truly  begins  to  open,  thereby  allowing  us  to  begin  to  allow  the  Divine  Presence  of
Allah(S.W.T) to consciously manifest openly through our daily lives, and thus, it is we that have
been opened by His Power.

 

It is also called ‘sab al mathani’ .i.e. the seven ayahs as these are seven ayahs that no equivalent of them has ever been sent to the previous prophets before. It is called ‘Umm ul Kitab’ i.e. ‘the mother of the whole book’ because it encompasses the theme of recognition of Allah, belief in Him and worshipping Him only and genuinely.

 

Let us now look at the Arabic transliteration and meaning of its verses.

 

 

 

Bismillāhi r-raḥmāni r-raḥīm

1:1 In the name of Allah, Most Gracious, Most Merciful.

 

 

 

Al ḥamdu lillāhi rabbi l-’ālamīn

The r herisher and ,hraise and thanks be to Allah 1:2Sustainer of the worlds,

 

 

 

Ar raḥmāni r-raḥīm

,Most Merciful ,Most aracious 1:3

 

 

 

 

| P a g e 7

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Māliki yawmi d-dīn

.Master of the aay of Judgement 1:1

 

 

 

Iyyāka na’budu wa iyyāka nasta’īn

worship eou alone we 1:1 and You alone we ask for help.

 

 

 

Ihdinā ṣ-ṣirāṭ al-mustaqīm

:auide us to the straight path 1:6

 

 

 

 

Ṣirāṭ al-laḏīna an’amta ‘alayhim ġayril maġḍūbi ‘alayhim walāḍ ḍāllīn

1:7 The path of those on whom you have bestowed your Grace, and not the path of those who earned your anger, nor of those who went astray.

 

Teachings of the surah

  1. Allah is the most Gracious and most Merciful.
  2. We should praise Allah for all the favors He has bestowed to us.
  3. He is the controller and overall judge of everything during the Day of Judgment.
  4. He is the only one worth of our devotion so all our prayers should be directed to Him.
  5. Whoever needs any help should seek divine intervention of Allah.
  6. Man should ask for Allah’s guidance to the path of righteousness.
  7. The path of righteousness is a favor from Allah(S.W.T).
  8. Man should shun all evils to avoid the wrath of Allah. The worshipper is reminded not to
    transgress.
  9. Mankind should follow the teachings of Allah (S.W.T) in order to avoid His anger.

10.The recognition of the oneness of Allah brings us closer to Allah and keeps us far from Iblis.

 

Importance of the sura

  1. Sura tul Fatiha brings us closer to Allah through the words of praise contained in it.
  2. It is a supplication (dua) that the prophet recommended to be usedoften.

 

| P a g e 8

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  1. It is the opening chapter of the Quran.
  2. It’s the foundation of faith.
  3. It is the mother of the Quran.
  4. It is one of the pillars of prayers.
  5. It’s one among the surahs that no other prophet was given except Muhammad only.

Surat Al-Fīl (The Elephant) –                       ليفل ا  ةروس(Q 105)

 

Historical back ground to the revelation of Suratul Fiil.

Suratul Fiil derived its roots from the incident of the elephants during the period of the birth of the Prophet Muhammad (P.B.U.H).

The term Fiil refers to the elephants mentioned in the first verse of the Sura. These elephants were used in the army of Abraha Al Ashram who was governor of Yemen on behalf of the King of Ethiopia. He was sent to go and destroy the Al-Kaaba.

Abraha built a shrine at a place called Sanaa and had wanted the Arabs to perform Pilgrimage at the shrine instead of the Kaaba which they refused. He became furious and decided to send an army to go and destroy the Kaaba.

We shall now look at the meaning of its verses and their transliteration.

مس  بلالهنمحرلاميحرلا

Bismillahi rrahmani rraheemi

In the name of Allah, the Beneficent, the Merciful.

 

 

 

 

 

 

Alam tara kaifa faala rabbuka bi as-haabil fiil

105:1 Have you (O Muhammad) not seen how your Lord dealt with the companions of the Elephant?

 

 

 

 

 

Alam yaj’al Kaidahum fii tadhlil

105:2 Did He not make their treacherous plan into misguidance?

 

| P a g e 9

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Wa-arsala alaihim twairan abaabila.

105:3 And He sent against them birds in flocks,

 

 

 

 

Tarmihim bihijaa-ratin min sijiil

105:4 Striking them with stones of baked clay,

 

 

 

 

Fajaa’lahum ka’asfinm ma kulin

105:5 Then did He make them like an empty field of stalks and straw, (of which the corn) has been eaten.

 

 

 

Teachings of Suratul Fiil

There are several lessons that can be learnt from this sura as follows;

  • Al-Kaaba is protected by Allah.
  • Allah is in position to destroy theplans of anybody who intends to harm others.
  • Allah is very powerful and sees everything.
  • No creature can fight the might of Allah
  • Material possession of a man cannot defeat the Allah’s property.
  • Mankind should rely on Allah for anything because Allah protects.
  • Allah does not allow evil to flourish.
  • Allah gives protection to the righteous
  • The wrong doers will always be punished by Allah.
  • No one can prevail against Allah
  • Allah has the ability to end a person’s pride and arrogance.
  • Allah wanted tohonor the birth of the prophet (P.B.U.H).

 

 

 

| P a g e 11

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Surat Al-`Aşr (The Declining Day) – رصعلا ةروس (Q 103)

 

Historical Background

The early Muslims called it Al-`Asr. Also, in most of the books dedicated to explaining the Quran (tafsir), this name is given to the surah.

The majority of scholars hold that it was sent in the Makkan Period at the early stages of Islam where the Muslim population was small. The surah consists three verses, making it the shortest chapter in the Quran but summarizes all the teachings of Islam because of its vast meaning. Imam Shafi commended that Suratul Asr would have sufficed all the other Surahs of the Quran if they had not been revealed.

 

We shall now look at the meaning of its verses and their transliteration.

Bismillahi rrahmani rraheemiميحرلا نمحرلالالهمسب

 

In the name of Allah, the Beneficent, the Merciful.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

WaalAasri

103: 1By Al-‘Asr (the time).

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

| P a g e 11

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Inna al-insana lafee khusrin

103: 2Verily! Man is in loss,

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Illa allatheena amanoo waAAamiloo alssalihati watawasaw bialhaqqi watawasaw bialssabri

103:  2Except  those  who  believe  (in  Islamic  Monotheism)  and  do  righteous  good  deeds,  and
recommend one another to the truth (i.e. order one another to perform all kinds of good deeds (Al-
Ma’ruf)which  Allah  has  ordained,  and  abstain  from  all  kinds  of  sins  and  evil  deeds (Al-

Munkar)which Allah has forbidden), and recommend one another to patience (for the sufferings, harms, and injuries which one may encounter in Allah’s Cause during preaching His religion of Islamic Monotheism or Jihad, etc.).

 

 

 

Teachings of the Surah

  1. The surah starts with an oath where Allah swears by the time (Asr) because it is only Allah
    (S.W.T) who has the sole right to swear by anything because everything belongs to Him.
  2. It affirms great loss for those who reject aod’s message after it reached them correctly, and
    for those who accepted it but failed to live according to it. Loss means losing Allah’s
    blessings and favors for the unbelievers.
  3. Those excluded from the state of loss include the believers, those who perform righteous
    deeds,
  4. It encourages one to follow the truth and enjoin one another to be patient.
  5. They are also be committed to the truth of Islam.

 

Suratul Nasr(The Divine Support) – رصنلا ةروس (Q110)

Historical Background

The Sura is called Suratul Nasr because it is a word that appears in the first verse of the chapter.It literally means help. And here it refers to Allah’s help that caused the conquest of Makkah.

 

 

| P a g e 12

 

 

 

 

 

This Sura was revealed after the conquest of Makkah. It was the time when many people were embracing Islam, thus the Sura was to remind the Prophet and the Muslims believers at large to consider the victory from Allah only. The victory in which multitudes of people from different tribes embraced Islam was the victory from Allah (S.W.T)this is believed to be the last surah given to Prophet Muhammad and a sign to his approaching death.

 

Meaning and transliteration of Surat An-Naşr

Bismillahi rrahmani rraheemiميحرلا نمحرلالاله مسب

 

 

 

 

 

 

Itha jaa nasru Allahi waalfathu

 

110:1When the victory of Allah has come and the conquest,

 

 

 

 

 

Waraayta alnnasa yadkhuloona fee deeni Allahi afwajan

 

110:2And you see the people entering into the religion of Allah in multitudes,

 

 

 

 

Fasabbih bihamdi rabbika waistaghfirhu innahu kana tawwaban

110:3Then exalt [Him] with praise of your Lord and ask forgiveness of Him. Indeed, He is ever
Accepting of repentance.

 

TEACHINGS OF SURATUL NASR

This surah has the following teachings

  It recognizes Allah as the only source of help and victory.

  It is a sign of victory when people are seen accepting Islam in multitudes.   For any victory(help) people must glorify the praises Allah.

 

 

| P a g e 13

 

 

 

 

 

 

  heople should glorify Allah’s name and also ask for forgiveness. They should also seek
Allah’s forgiveness with confidence, as he is the one who accepts people’s repentance.

 

Suggested study Questions and Activities

Answer the following Questions in your I.R.E revision exercise book.

  1. State the lessons Muslims can learn from Suratul Fiil.
  2. Define the following term Ulumul Quran.
  3. Discuss the need for the revelation of the Quran
  4. What are the teachings of surah Asr?
    Activity:

Narrate the story of Abraha Ashram in relation to Sura al Fiil.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

CHAPTER 2

 

HADITH

The literal meaning of hadith is news, statement, report, stories or narrations.

 

| P a g e 14

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Technically, the term hadith refers to the prophetic sayings, reports, statement which came forth

from the prophet’s gems or mouth. It also includes the prophet’s action and deeds.

The term hadith is sometimes used to refer to Sunnah although there is a difference between the two as follows:

 

Differences between Hadith and Sunna

 

 

Hadith

This is what the prophet said or what he taught

 

Is what the prophet kept quiet about or approved

It is the prophet’s interpretation of the Quran

 

 

Is the prophet’s treaties and declaration

 

Is the prophet’s guidance on how to behave towards others

 

Sunnah

This refers to what he did or his actions

 

Is the way in which he conducted the affairs of the Ummah.

It is his actual reading of the Quran

 

Is the implementation of those treaties and declarations

Is how he related to other people

 

 

 

This is the prophet’s instruction on how to                                      Refers   to   the   demonstrationsand   howhe

 

worship                                                                                              conducted the religious acts.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

EVOLUTION OF HADITH

The term evolution has been used to refer to the origin, beginning or emergence. Therefore, evolution of Hadith traces the origin and gradual development of hadith

 

| P a g e 15

 

 

 

 

 

It can best be looked into by studying the drivers of evolution. These are the factors that made the Prophet to come up with the volumes of hadith and sunnah Muslims today rely on as a significant code of reference after the Quran.

 

There are four ways in which contributed to the evolution of hadith:

  1. Through the prophets own initiative
  2. As a response asked by his companions
  3. As a demand of circumstances
  4. As an interpretation of the Quran

 

 

 

The prophet’s initiative

The prophet was devoted to teaching the MuslimUmma about the right way. He would come up with an issue of which he felt that there was need for the Muslims to know about. In this case he would talk to the Muslims to address it.

One instance is illustrated by the hadith below:

 

Abu Hureira (RAA) narrates that the Prophet (P.B.U.H) used to say (in supplication), “O Allah! Set right for me my religion, which is the safeguard of my affairs. And set right for me the affairs of the world wherein is my living. Decree the hereafter to be good for me. And make this life, for me, (a source of) abundance for every good and make my death (a source of) comfort to me and protection against every evil.”(Muslim)

This is an example in which the prophet took an initiative to teach the Muslims the dua they need to recite.

“Whoever speaks in the Jum’a while the Imam is delivering the khutba is like a donkey who is carrying books, and for he who tells him to be quiet, there will be no (reward for his) Jum’a prayer. “Related by Ahmad)

The objective of this hadith is to teach about the importance of keeping quiet and attentively listening to the Friday khutba when it is on.

 

The third instance is when Al Mughira bin Shu’ba said:

 

| P a g e 16

 

 

 

 

 

 

I was with the prophet (during an expedition). He started to perform ablution and I was about to remove his socks (khuff), when he said, “Leave them, for I put them on while I was in a state of purity,” and he wiped over them. (Bukahari and Muslim)

 

As a response to questions asked by his companions

The prophet was the leader and sole authority in all matters concerning the Muslims. People would  approach  him  with  questions  on  religion,  social,  political  and  any other  issues affecting them. He was the resourceof reference in addressing people’s issues. Therefore, his suggested solutions became part of hadith.

Aisha (R.A) narrated: “I asked the prophet about turning here and there in prayer. He replied: “It is a kind of theft by which Satan takes away (a portion of) the person’s prayer.”(AlBukhari and At-Tirmidhi).The latter’s wordings are,“Avoid turning while you are engaged in prayer for it leads to the destruction of your religion. If you have to do it, then do it in the voluntary prayer.”

The hadith is an example that evolved through a question that the prophet had to respond to a question that Aisha, his wife, asked on matters concerning turning during prayers. The other hadith below shows another hadith that was as a result to questions asked.

 

 

 

 

 

 

Abu Huraira narrated that the prophet was asked:

“Which kind of sadaqa was better?’ He replied, “That which is given by one who does not have much property. And begin by giving your dependents.” (Ahmad, Abu Dawoud. In Khuzaima, Ibn Hibban) Al Hakim graded it as sahih.

This hadith is another evidence of evolution of hadith as a respond to questions from the companions.

 

Ibn Abbas narrated that a woman from the tribe of Juhainah came to the prophet and said, “My
mother vowed to perform Hajj but she died before fulfilling her vow. Should I perform Hajj on

 

| P a g e 17

 

 

 

 

 

her behalf?’ The prophet said, “Yes, perform Hajj on her behalf. Had there been a debt on your mother, would you have paid it or not? So pay off her debt to Allah, for He is most deserving of settlement of His debt.”(Al- Bukhari.)

 

As a demand of circumstances

r ircumstances  and  situations  would  arise  and  the  companions  would  demand  the  prophet’s
suggestions and solutions as their leader, hence their suggestions and solutions became Hadith.
Ibn Abbas(R.A) narrated that when the prophet sent Muadh bin Jabal to Yemen (as governor); he
said to him:

“You are going to a people who are people of the scripture. Invite them to testify that none has the right to be worshipped but Allah and that I am His Messenger. If they obey you in this, then teach them that Allah, the Glorious One, has enjoined five prayers upon them in every day and night, and if they obey you in this, then tell them that Allah has made it obligatory for them to pay zakat upon their assets and it is to be taken from the wealthy among them and given to the poor among them.”(Al- Bukhari).

This hadith shows a situation where the prophet had to give instructions to a potential leader on the duties he should carry out. Another instance is explained in the hadith below:

Jabir bin Abdullah(R.A) narrated that the prophet visited a sick person and found him praying while sitting on a cushion. The prophet pushed it aside and said to him:

“Pray while sitting on the ground if you can, and if you cannot, then pray by nodding your head, and make a lower nodding for prostration than that for bowing (rukuu).”(Al- Baihaqi).

 

The other hadith below shows another circumstance that the prophet had to give decisions:

Anas narrated that the prophet narrated that the prophet passed by a fallen date in the street and
said:

“Were it not for my doubt that this might have been given for charity, I would have eaten it.”(Bukhari and Muslim

As an interpretation of the Quran

The verses of the Qura’n were revealed to the prophet (h.B.U.H).It was the duty of the prophet to explain the meaning and application of those verses to his companions. Therefore his

 

| P a g e 18

 

 

 

 

 

explanations and commentaries became Hadith. This proves that prophet had a duty of giving further clarification whenever the need arose as Allah says in the Holy Qura’n:

“With clear signs and books (We sent the messengers). And we have also sent down to you (O Muhammad ) the Dhikr [reminder] that is Quran, that you may explain clearly to men what is sent to them that they may give thought.”[Q: 16:44]

Following are examples of how the prophet interpreted the Quran using Hadith.

 

 

 

  1. Interpretation on Jumaa prayer

“Oyou, who believe, when the call is proclaimed to prayer on Friday, hasten earnestly to the

remembrance of Allah and leave off business: That is best for you but knew.”[Q: 62:9]

 

Prophet’s Hadith

  1. a) Abdullah bin Umar and Abu Huraira (R.A) narrated that they heard the messenger of
    Allah (P.B.U.H) say while standing on his pulpit, “ Those who are not attending Friday
    prayer should stop doing so, otherwise Allah the Exalted will seal their hearts and they
    will be reckoned among the heedless”(Muslim)

 

  1. b) Ibn Umar (R.A) narrated that the messenger of Allah said, “whoever catches only one
    rakat of the Jumaa prayer, or any other, he should then add to it another one, and his
    prayer will be complete” (AN-Nisai , Ibn-Maaja, Daraqutni)

 

 

 

  1. Interpretation on Ribaa

“Those who devour Ribaa will not stand except as stands one whom the Satan by his touch has driven to madness. That is because they say, “trade is like ribaa,” but Allah has permitted trade and forbidden ribaa. For who after receiving admonition from their Lord desist shall be pardoned for their past; their case is for Allah to judge; but those who repeat (the offence) are companions of the fire: they will abide therein (forever).” [Q: 2:275 -276]

 

 

 

Prophet’s Hadith

 

 

| P a g e 19

 

 

 

 

 

Abu Huraira (R.A) narrates that the messenger of Allah said: “whenever gold is exchanged with gold it should be equivalent in amount and quality, and whenever silver is exchanged for silver it should be equivalent in amount and quality. Whoever gives more or asks for more, this is considered ribaa.”(Muslim)

 

Forms of Hadith.

Hadith have been classified into four forms determined by the way they were presented by the prophet. These forms are:

  Fiil (what he did)
  Qaul (what he said)

  Iqrar (what he silently approved)
  Sifat(his attributes)

 

 

 

 

Fiil

This form of Hadith refers to the virtuous deeds or actions done by the Prophet (P.B.U.H). The following are examples of the prophets Hadith:

 

  1. Aisha (R.A) relates,” I never saw the messenger of God laughing in a way that the inside of
    his mouth is apparent, he only used to smile.” (Al-Bukhari).

 

  1. Narrated by Jaaber (God be pleased with him) relates that on the day of the Idd (feast), the
    prophet (peace be upon him) used to go to Idd prayer by one route and come back by another
    route. (Al-Bukhari).

Qaul

This form of Hadith refers to sayings, reports or what came by word of mouth from the prophet (P.B.U.H). An example of Qaul is the following:

Abu-Huraira (God be pleased with him) relates that the messenger of God peace be upon him said,

“A hypocrite has 3 signs by when he can be known: if he speaks he lies, if give a promise he never
fulfill it, if he is entrusted with something he betrays the trust.”(Al-Bukhari and Muslim)
Iqrar

 

 

| P a g e 21

 

 

 

 

 

Iqrar is also referred to as Takrir. It refers the deeds done by the Swahabas when the prophet kept quiet about them instead of disapproving them or rather he silently approved them. His silent approval was like giving them a go ahead to continue with the deeds. An example of this form of Hadith is as follows:

Ibn Abbas (R.A) narrated, “We used to pray two rak’at after sunset (before the Maghrib prayer, and the prophet would see us, but he did not order us to do so, nor did he prohibit.” (Muslim)

 

aive more examples of hadith that emerged through the prophet’s own initiative.

Sifat

This refers to general appearance and especially bodily characteristics and the physical tributes the prophet possessed.It includes the qualities and attributes that the prophet displayed in his life. The Swahabas were able to observe his general conduct and follow them. Mention any attributes of the prophet that you can see being practiced today.The following are examples of hadith that emerged as a result of his Sifat:

  1. Narrated by Abu-Huraira (R.A) relates that Al- Hassan Ibn Ali  (the prophet’s grandson
    (R.A) picked up a date from the dates set for charity and put it in his month. The messenger
    of God said, “Kikh Kikh” (dirt! Keep away!) Throw it out. Do you not know that we (the
    Prophet (P.B.U.H) and his household) do not eat from charity?” (Al-Bukhari and Muslim).
    2. Narrated by Aisha (R.A) relates that the messenger of Allah (P.B.U.H) used to like using the
    right hand-side in all his affairs: his cleansing, combing his hair, putting on his footwear…
    (Al-Bukhari and Muslim).

Contributions of hadith to Islamic thought and culture

1)                                       The content of hadith provides an explanation of the verses of the Quran thus enhancing its
understanding and application of its teachings. For example; the holy Quran gives a ruling
that Muslims should pay Zakat without outlining the details of how much, on which items or
when to give the Zakat. We learn all these details from the hadith.

2)                                       The study of Hadith has made tremendous contributions to the growth and development of
Islamic sharia. Muslim jurists like the four imams of the schools of thought studied the
sciences of hadith and simplified its understanding and application.

3)                                       Hadith have provided a clear guidance on the code of conduct expected from the Muslims.
Muslims should adhere to specific mannerisms of walking, sleeping eating among others as
taught by our prophet(P.B.U.H)

4)                              Hadith have summarised the prophets exemplary life which Muslims emulate to mould their

character.

 

| P a g e 21

 

 

 

 

 

 

5) Hadith is the second source of sharia after the Quran. This was confirmed by the prophet in
his farewell address confirmed when he said “Verily, I have left among you the book of
Allah and the sunnah of his apostle which if you hold fast you shall never go astray.”

 

REVISION QUESTION

Give a brief explanation on the following forms of Hadith.

1) Qaul

2) Fiyl

3) Iqrar

4) Sifaat

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

| P a g e 22

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

CHAPTER 3

 

Pillars of iman

The literal meaning of Iman is to belief in or to have faith in something.

There are six pillars of Iman as mentioned in the Quran: “The messenger believes in what
has  been  revealed  to  him  from  his  Lord  as  do  men  of  faith.  Each  one  (of  them)
believesinAllah, HisAngels, His books and His messengers. We make no distinctions (they
say) between one and another of His Messengers. ‘And they say ‘We hear and we obey 🙁
we seek) Your forgiveness our Lord and to you is the end of all journeys.” [Q: 2:285]

 

 

The prophet (saw) said “Iman is to believe in God, and His Angels, and His Scripture, and His  apostles, and to  believe in  the resurrection and the last  day and the divine premeasurement of good and evil, and to have faith in all these things.”(Muslim)

 

 

 

TAWHEED:

Literally  Tawheed  comes  from  the  word  Wah-hada,which  means  to  make  something Waahid(singular).

Technically-Tawheed means attributing oneness to Allah and describing Him as being one and unique.It is the first pillar of the six pillars of Iman and the most fundamental and important teaching of all the prophets and messengers who all taught the believe in the oneness of Allah’It is expressed in the hrimary Kalima“LA ILLA ILA LLAH” Meaning there is no God but Allah, or there is no one who has the right to be worshipped except Allah.Tawheed differentiate between a Muslim and a Kafir.

 

Allah says – “Say (O Muhammad). He is Allah the one. Allah, theself-sufficient master, whom all creatures need. He begets not, nor was he begotten. And there is none equal or comparable unto Him.”[Q112]

Allah says:“There is nothing like unto him and He is the All-Hearer, the All-sear.” [Q: 42: 11]

 

| P a g e 23

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Categories of tawheed

 

 

  1. Tawheed ar-rubabiyah.

This concept of Tawheed is based on the belief of unifying Allah(SWT) as the sovereign Lord(Rabbi).And that He is the sole Lord of the universe who sustains and maintains all creation with any need for it or for it.According to this category, since God is the real power in existence, it is He Who gives all things the power to move and to change. Allah mentions this concept in many Quranic verses:

 

“Say: “who is it that sustains you (in life) from sky and from the earth? Or who is it that has power over hearing and sight? And who is it that brings out the living from the dead and the dead from the living? And who is that rules and regulates all affairs? They will soon say “Allah” say, “Will you not then show piety (to him)?”[Q: 10:31]

 

Allah (S.W.T) says“And if indeed thou ask them who it is that sends down rain from the sky, and gives life therewith to the earth after its death, they will certainly reply “Allah” say “praise be to Allah!” But most of them understand not.”[Q: 29:63]

 

 

 

  1. Tawheed al-Uluhiyah

This means to believe that Allah (Swat) the most High is the one worth of true worship.

Therefore all acts of worship likeSalat, working, fasting, among others should be dedicated to
Allah alone. Hence it’s not permissible to associate anything in worship with Him.
Allah says,“To the ‘Aadpeople (we sent) Hud, one of their (own) brethren: He said,” O my
people! Worship Allah! You have no other god but him. Will you not fear (Allah)?”[Q:
7:65]

 

Allah (SWT) also says, “Say; Truly, my prayer and my service of sacrifice, my life and my death, are (all) for Allah, The cherisher of the worlds”.[Q: 6:162]

  1. Tawheed al-asma wasifat. (Names and attributes).

 

| P a g e 24

 

 

 

 

 

 

This category helps us to understand who our creator is through His names and qualities
through  which  we  know  that  Allah (SWT)  is  beyond  our  imagination  and  bears  no

resemblance.

 

Allah says  “And  (All) the most beautiful names belongs to Allah, so call on him by them.”[Q: 7: 180]

 

 

 

Attributes of Allah

 

The Prophet said “Allah has ninety nine names, i.e. one hundred minus one, and whoever guards [or counts] them (i.e. believes in their meaning and acts accordingly), will enter paradise: And Allah is witr (one) ‘and loves the witr.’

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

| P a g e 25

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

| P a g e 26

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

| P a g e 27

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

| P a g e 28

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Significance of tawheed.

 

 

  1. It is the first fundamental principal of the Islamic Faith.
  2. It assures the creatures that the creator is near them and ready to answer their request.

III.                            It distances mankind from worshipping other than Allah.

  1. It increases Taqwa since one is aware that Allah sees him wherever he may be and is aware

of even what is hidden in ones heart and mind.

  1. It leads one to ensure his respect and maintain his dignity as a respect to his creator.
  2. It gives an attitude of peace and contentment in a person since he knows that Allah will take

care of his needs if he in truly obedient and hardworking.

VII.                           It leads to unity and brotherhood amongst human beings.

VIII.                          It makes a believer to be dutiful and upright, since he knows that Allah(S.W.T) will ask

everybody of his responsibility on the day of the judgment. Therefore he does his duties
whole heatedly and this keeps him ways from neglecting his duties and from sin.
IX. It removes the fear of people since one strongly believes that not only his life but everything
is in the hands of Allah.

  1. It removes greedy and jealously and the desire to achieve success through even evil means as

one believes in the powers of Allah and not one’s endeavor.

  1. It does not allow him to be proud or arrogant.

XII.                           It makes a believer brave and courageous.

XIII.                          It makes a believer to be patient and preserving for he will know that whatever the problem

Allah(S.W.T) will have to solve it for his gradually.

 

| P a g e 29

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Shirk (polytheism)

 

The term shirk comes from the Arabic word sharaka which means to associate or form partners with. In the Islamic context shirk means ascribing a partner or rival to Allah (S.W.T) in worship or His names and attributes.

 

Allah  (S.W.T) says,“Allah forgive not that partners should set up with Him; but He forgives anything else to whom he pleases; to set up partners with god is to devise a sin most heinous indeed.”[Q: 4: 48]

 

Allah (S.W.T) says “Allah has said: ‘Take not (for worship) two gods. For He is just one God. Then fear me and me alone.”[Q: 16:51]

 

Forms of shirk.

There are three forms of shirk, namely:

 

 

  1. Shirk – al-akbar-major.
  2. Shirk al-asghar – minor.
  3. Shirk al-khafii – inconspicious/hidden.

 

  1. shirk-akbar(major shirk)

This form of shirk is manifested in the following four ways:

 

 

  1. Shirk ad-dua.
  2. Shirk a-niyaah.
  3. Shirk al-Taah.
  4. Shirk al -mahabah.

 

  1. Shirkad-dua

 

 

 

| P a g e 31

 

 

 

 

 

It implies invoking supplication or praying to others besides Allah(S.W.T) such as to supplicate to the dead in the grave or worship via the ancestors.

Allah(SWT) Says,“And when they embark on a ship, they invoke Allah, making the faith pure for him only, but when he brings them safely to land behold, they give a share of their worship to others”.[Q:29:65]

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  1. Shirk an- Niyyah wal Irada wal Qasd.

It means intention, determination or purpose in acts of worship not for Allah but towards others. Allah (S.W.T) says,“Whoever desires the life of the world and its glitters, to them shall pay in full their deed therein, and they will have no domination therein. They are those for whom there is nothing in the here after but fire and ruin is the deeds they did. And of no effect that which they used to do.”[Q: 11:15-16]

 

Allah (S.W.T) says:

“Have you seen him whom takes for his God his own passion?”[Q: 25: 43]

 

 

 

III.                            Shirk Taah.

This  type  means  obeying  any  other  authorities  against  the  willAllah.  Allah(S.W.T) says,“They Jews and Christians took their rabbis and their monks to be their Lords besides Allah, and Messiah son of Mariam while they were commanded (in Taurat and lnjil) to worship none but Allah Lailla to Huwa. Praise and glory is to him for having the partners they associate.”[Q: 9:31]

 

 

| P a g e 31

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  1. Shirk al Mahaba

 

This is showing the love that is due to Allah to others other than Him. Allah (S.W.T) says,

“And of mankind are some who take (for worship) others besides Allah as rivals. They love them as they love Allah. But those who believe love Allah more. If only those who do wrong could see, when they will see the torment that all power belongs to Allah is severe in punishment.”

 

 

  1. Shirk al-asghar (minor shirk).

 

It also termed as Ar-riya.

Ar-riya is any action which is performed in order to receive praise, fame or any other worldly gain.It is performing Ibaada to show off for example performing swalat so that you can be seen or praised.Any actions that are done out of showing off will not be rewarded by Allah(S.W.T) “Those who want but to be seen.”[Q: 107:6]

Allah says “The hypocrites seek to deceive Allah but it is Allah who deceives them. When they stand up to prayer, stand without earnestness, to be seen of men, But little do they hold Allah in remembrance.”[Q: 4:142]

 

 

  1. Shirk al khafi i.e Inconspicous Shirk.

Have you ever had a feeling of dissatistfaction n something? What are some of the things in

life that leave you dissatisfiedor makeyou keep wishing that you had better things than what Allah (S.W.T) has provided you with? Having this feeling may lead you to performing Shirk al Khafi.

This type of Shirk involves being inwardly dissatisfied with the inevitable condition that has being ordained for one by Allah (S.W.T) conscientiously lamenting that had you done or not done such and such or had you approached such and such you would have had a better status. It is one of the most dangerous forms of shirk as people cannot see when they are performing it.This Shirk is so hidden and difficult that even the one committing it cannot recognize it. The prophet said  “ashirk alkhafii in the muslim nation is more inconspicuous than the creeping of a black ant on a black rock in the pitch darkness of the night.”

 

| P a g e 32

 

 

 

 

 

While commenting on this Hadith Ibin Abbas said that kind of shirk is like when one tells his
friends. “You and God what you wished is what happened” If it was not so and so”.
Hadith narrated by Abu Sa‘id Al-Khudri that the Prophet (sallallahu alayhi wassallam) said,

“Should  I  not  inform  you  of  what  I  fear  more  for  you  than  Al-Masih-ul-Dajjal                                                                                                                                                (the

Antichrist)?” The people said, “Yes, O Messenger of Allah.” He said, “It is the hidden Shirk; a person stands up in Salah (Prayer) and tries to make it perfect when he realizes that others are looking at him.” (Related by Imam Ahmad)

 

 

 

 

 

Why Quran condemn shirk

 

  1. Shirk is the highest of the wrong doing according to the instructions given by Luqman to his
    son. “Behold, Luqman said to his son by way of instructions: ‘o my son join not in worship
    (others) with Allah: for false worship is indeed the highest wrong doing.” [Q: 31:13]

 

  1. When one attaches Allah’s attributes to any of his creations, he or she undermines Allah’s
    sovereignty yet Allah is supposed to sovereign.

 

  1. It is of all the sins, Allah (S.W.T) vows not to forgive anyone who commits it knowingly.
    This is because a person who commits such a sin undermines Allah’s function as the creator,
    sustainer and destroyer of life.Allah (S.W.T) says,“Allah forgive not that partners should
    set up with Him; but He forgives anything else to whom he pleases; to set up partners with
    god is to devise a sin most heinous indeed.”[ Q: 4: 48]

 

  1. Belief in Shirk creates amenity in the society, since people will always be suspicious of each
    other and they will divot themselves with the belief in Allah as one who predetermines
    people’s destiny.
  2. Shirk makes man to have little or no confidence in God but in other things most especially in
    times of danger which defames the status of man as Allah’s vicegerent as the best of his
    creation.
  3. Shirk makes a person to distance him or herself from Allah (S.W.T) yet man is supposed to
    always be nearest to God pray to him whenever he or she has a problem. Yet those who
    practice other objects created by Allah. “And who is more astray than one who invokes

 

| P a g e 33

 

 

 

 

 

 

,besides Allah,such  as will  not  answer to the day of judgment, and who(in  fact)are unconscious of their call(to them)” [Q: 46:5]

  1. Shirk makes an individual not to be dutiful and upright, one who performs shirk does not his
    carry out or her duties whole heartedly and this makes her or him near to sinking all the time.

 

  1. Shirk makes a person behave like a coward as he or she will always be thinking that even
    objects which have no life can protect her or him from any danger or misfortune e.g. wearing
    of emulates.

 

 

 

 

 

BELIEF IN ANGELS

The belief in the angelsis the second pillar of Iman.

Angels are holy and pure creatures of Allah(S.W.T) to whom He Has bestowed the power to perform specific divine duties.

 

“O you who believe!Save yourselves and your families from a fire whose fuel is men and stones, over which are  (appointed) angels stern  (and) severe, who flinch not  (from executing the commands they receive from Allah, but do  (precisely) what they are commanded.” [Q: 66:6]

From the above ayat, Angels do not execute their duties just for the sake of it but are dedicated to their duties for which they were created. They are characterized by the following main features:

 

 

  1. They are creatures of Allah that He created from Noor (light).Aisha(RAA)narrates

that the messenger of Allah says, ‘Angels were created from light, jinns were created from smokeless fire and Adam was created from that which was described to you (in the Quran, which is clay.)’(Sahih Muslim.)

 

 

 

 

 

| P a g e 34

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  1. Allah created them outside blood relationship, hence unlike human beings;they are

not associated with having such relations as parental  (parent to child), fraternal (brother to brother/sister) or any other blood relation.

iii.                                           They are not associated with any gender like the human beings are.“And they make

into females Angels who themselves serve Allah Did they witness their creation? Their evidence will be recorded,and they will be called to account.” [Q: 43:19]

 

  1. Allah has not bestowed unto them the feelings of hunger, thirst or such related

desires.  This  is  told  in  the  story  of  Nabii  Ibrahim  when  Allah(S.W.T)  send

messengers to him,

“There came our messengers to Abraham with glad tidings .They said, “Peace!”

He answered “peace!” and hastened to entertain them with a roasted calf. But when he saw their hands went not towards the (meal), he felt some mistrust of them, and conceived a fear of them. They said,  ‘Fear not: We have been sent against the people of Lut.”[Q 11:69-70]

  1. They were relieved by the divine powers of Allah, from fatigue, monotony and the

desire to either relax or sleep.

  1. They have no definite bodies to be identified with but Allah has bestowed them with

the ability to be in any form that is relevant with the prevailing circumstance e.g. Birds  (when they appeared to  Adam  to  teach  him  on burial), man  (when they appeared  to  prophets  Lut  and  Muhammad)  or  invisible  (when  they  helped  the Muslims during the battle of Badr).

vii.                                        Allah has prepared their abode (the place of their convergence) in heaven.

 

viii.                                       They diligently praise Allah and glorify Him in deeds and articulation.

 

 

ANGELS AND THEIR DUTIES

  1. Jibril (Gabriel)

He communicated the revelation to all prophets by taking the divine message with the order

of Allah to the relevant recipients.

“Say, (O Muhammad) the Holy Spirit (i.e. Jibril) has brought it down from your Lord in truth in order to strengthen those who believe, and as guide and glad tidings to the Muslims.”[Q: 16:102]

 

| P a g e 35

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  1. Mikail

He is in charge of rain.

“Whoever is an enemy to Allah and His Angels and His Messengers and Jibril and Mikailthen indeed Allah is an enemy to the disbelievers.”[Q: 2:98]

 

 

  1. Israfiil

Do you know about the day of judgement? On the day the horn will be blown to call every

one to accont for his deeds. The Angel in charge of blowing this trumpet is known as Israfiil. Even though his name is not mentioned in the Quran his duty has been mentioned when Allah (S.W.T) says,

“And the horn will be blown. That is the day of the threat.”[Q: 50:20]

“The trumpet shall be sounded, behold! When people will rush forth from their graves to their Lord.”[Q: 36:51]

 

 

 

  1. Israiil

Allah (S.W.T) has said in the holy Quran that every living thing shall test death. During

theremoval of the souls, a special Angel called Malakul-Maut (The Angel of death) is sent by Allah to take the soul back to its creator.

He is in charge of removing souls at the time of death.

“And He is the subjugation over His servants and He sends over you guardian Angels until, when death comes to one of you, our messengers (i.e. Angels of death) take him and they do not fail (in their duties).”[Q: 6:61]

Say: “The Angel of death, put in charge of you, will (duly) take your souls.Then shall you be brought back to your lord.”[Q: 32:11]

 

 

  1. Atid and Raqiib (Kiraman Katibun)

Islam encourage sthe doing of good always thogh at times we may commit mistakes in life.

Are we aware that all the things we do in life are recorded? Just as we keep our records in a
diary, Allah has his Angels whom he has given the responsibility of keeping every human

 

 

 

| P a g e 36

 

 

 

 

 

beings record. The Quran refers to them as Kiraman Katibun. They are angels in charge of recording good and evil deeds of individuals.

“When the two receivers (recording Angels receive), seated on the right and left….”[Q: 50:17]

 

“For each (such person, there are Angels in succession. Before him: they guard him by command of Allah.Verily never will Allah change the condition of a people until they change it themselves (with their own souls)” [Q: 13:11]

 

 

  1. Malik

He is in charge of Hell fire.

“And they will call, ’O Malik let your Lord put an end to us!’ Indeed, you will remain.”[Q: 43:77]

 

 

  1. Ridhwan

He is in charge of paradise. In the Quran, Allah (SWT) mentions them as many Angels

welcoming those who used to do good deeds in the Janna (paradise). “Gardens of perpetual bliss: They shall enter there, as well as the righteous amoung their fathers, their spouses, and  their  off  springs: And  Angels  shall  enter  unto  them  from  every  gate  (with  the salutation”) [Q: 13:23-24]

 

 

  1. Munkar and Nakir

They are Angels in charge of questioning in the grave. They also discharge severe punishment to the

dead people who had committed sin.

 

 

Suggested study questions and class activities.

 

Answer the following questions in your I.R.E revision excersise book.

  1. Explain the meaning of term Tawheed.
  2. What are the characteristics of Angels?
  3. Elaborate on the three types of shirk.

 

Activity.

 

 

| P a g e 37

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Find out how shirk is manifested in your community.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

CHAPTER 4

DEVOTIONAL ACTS
Pillars of Islam

There are five pillars of Islam which are the frame work of a Muslim life. These are the basic beliefs that shape the Muslim thought, deeds and society.

 

Diagram of the pillars of the pillars of Islam:

 

 

SHAHADA

(DECLARATI

ON)

 

 

 

HAJJ

(PILGRIMA

GE)

PILLARS OF

ISLAM

 

 

 

 

SAUM

(FASTING)

 

 

PRAYERS

(SWALAT)

 

 

 

 

 

 

ZAKAT

(ALMS)

 

SHAHADA

 

Meaning of Shahada

The word Shahada is an Arabic term which means to testify or to bear witness.

 

| P a g e 38

 

 

 

 

 

Literal meaning: Shahada is a special sentence: La illaha ila Allah wa Muhammadun rasoolollah (There is no (other) Lord except Allah and Muhammad is the Messenger of Allah.
(Lailaha illa-Allahu Muhammad rasul Allah)

 

 

 

Measuring of Shahada.

 

Shahada is the first pillar of Islam whichconsists of two main parts.

The first part of the shahada says: (Lailaha illa-Allahu Muhammad rasul Allah) That there is non worthy of worship except Allah.

Thispart declares the absolute unity of Allah, his oneness as the only one who deserves to be worshipped. Muslims are not supposed to render complete obedience for no human nor material object possess power and authority equal to Him.

It is the gateway way to Islam.

The second part of the shahada says:Muhammadun rasoolollahMuhammad(P.B.U.H) is His messenger.

The Prophet Mohammad (P.B.U.H) as the messenger of Allah.

His being mentioned in the Shahada confirms that he is the universal and final prophet sent to all mankind.

Mankind has the obligations in following the teachings and commandments of prophet Muhammad (P.B.U.H).

They have a duty to adhere to the teachings in order to seek Allah Pleasure although he is the last in the ladder of the prophets of Allah.

 

 

 

Significance of Shahada in the life of a Muslim.

 

  1. Shahada makes a believer to surrender all his/her life to God. This makes a believer to fulfill
    aod’s command.
  2. It produces in a believer a high degree of confidence and respect towards His creator.
  3. Instills in a believer feeling of contentment for he/she will know that Allah(S.W.T) willtake
    care of all his needs.

 

| P a g e 39

 

 

 

 

 

 

  1. It makes a believer to be brave and courageous as he will know that it is Allah who owns his
    life.
  2. It recognizes and re-affirms that prophet Mohammad (P.B.U.H) is the chosen messenger of
    Allah (S.W.T)
  3. It makes believers develop trust and heed to the guidelines of the prophet.
  4. It gives an opportunity to the believers to know how Allah (S.W.T) has honoredProphet
    Mohammad. (P.B.U.H).
  5. Gives Allah the absolute right to be worshipped.
  6. It affirms that prophet Muhammad(P.B.U.H) is the chosen messenger of Allah(S.W.T)

10.When uttered by a Muslim on his death will lead one to enter paradise.

 

4.22 Swalat read Q: 4:103

 

As-Salah: In the Arabic language it means prayer (Invocation).

Salat, which is the second pillar of Islam, may be defined as a special a process of worshipping A which includes supplication of duas, glorification of Allah’s name, prostrations in order to seek blessings and forgiveness.

In  this  process  ofworship,  there  are  certain  known  and  prescribed  invocations  and  acti
systematically performed starting with Takbeer  (saying Allah Akbar;God is the Great) which
ending with Tasleem  (saying: as-salaam ‘alaykum wa Rahmatul-lahi wabarakaatuh; may All
Peace, Mercy, and Blessings be upon you) do you perform swalat? Can you demonstrate how sw
is performed? If you perform swalat regularly,you will discover that there are two types of sawlat,
obligatory and the voluntary prayers. We shall now look at each of these prayers in details.

1.Fardn-ain( obligatory prayers)

These are prayers compulsory for every Muslim under the obligation by the shariah to perf

them.Failure to perform them pens one to punishment in the hereafter. Allah(S.W.T) says in

“And establish regular prayers at the two ends of the day and at the approaches of the night those things that are good remove those that evil:But that the word of the rememberance to th who remember(their Lord)” [Q:11:114]

Let us now look at the obligatory prayers and the times prescribed for there performance accordin Islamic Sharia.

 

 

| P a g e 41

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  1. Fajr

This is the morning prayer which consists of two rakats(units).It’s time occurs when a vertical

pillar of faint light appears in the east and spreads on the horizon,distinct from the darkness of night.This is just before sunrise. Quran recitation is loud for the two rakaats.

  1. Dhur

This is the early afternoon prayer.It consist of four raka’at (units) and it’s time occurs after the

sun has gone (passed over head) after reaching the highest point in the sky.)

iii.                                  Asr

This prayer is said in the late afternoon.It consist of four raka’at(units)

  1. Maghrib

This is the sunset prayer.It consists of three raka’at(units).It has the shortest duration which

starts immediately after the sun has set.Quran recitation is loud for the first two raka’ats.

  1. Isha

This prayer is performed immediately after Maghrib prayer.It consists of four raka’at in which

the first two Raka’at are recited aloud.Its time extends to the later part of the night.

 

 

2.Fardh kifaya

These are obligatory prayers which must be performed by atleast one muslim in the community.If it is

performed by a single Muslim, then the obligation is lifted from the others.Incase it’s not performed by one at all the whole society gets sin.e.g Swalatul Janaza. Can you demonstrate before your friends how this prayer is performed?

 

 

3.Sunnah prayers (optional)

These are prayers that  are not  compulsory for  the muslims.They are  performed to  follow the

exemplary teachings of the prophet(P.B.U.H) and are therefore recommended.

Can you give examples of Sunnah prayers and mention the number of rakaats for each? Some of the sunnah prayers are as follows:

  1. Tahhiyatul Masjid.

The prayer of tahhiyat al-masjid  (greeting of the masjid) is a confirmed sunna once a day, and

recommended thereafter. It consists of two rakaats and is best preformed before sitting down even
though the sunna is not lifted if one does sit first. One can intend this prayer along with their sunna or
fard if they do not have time to pray it. One should not pray the tahhiyat al-masjid during a disliked
time.

 

| P a g e 41

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  1. Tahajjud

This prayer is performed at night and it is recommended that it be performed after first going to sleep

for some part of the evening. Its time falls between the prayer times of the isha’a prayers and the Fajr
prayers. It is also recommended that the prayers be done in the last third of the night. Muslims believe that the reward is greater for those who do this prayer at a later time.

The Tahajjud prayer consists of a minimum of tworakaatand the maximum number is unlimited.

It’s reported about the Messenger of Allah (Allah bless him and give him peace) that he said: “Adhere to night prayer, for it is the habit of the righteous before you, and a means of drawing nearer to your Lord; it is an expiation for sins, and a deterrent from wrongdoing.” [Tirmidhi & al-Hakim]

 

 

III.                                      Tarawih

Tarawih is an optional prayer in that can be done only during the Muslim fasting month ofRamadhan.

This prayer can be done alone, in a group, at home, or in a mosque or other public meeting area it.
Typically, Muslims gather together and perform tarawih as a group. Others may meet in their local
mosque, a meeting hall, or even in an outdoor field. The minimum number of raka’ah of Tarawih is
eight with a maximum of Twenty. It is also customary for the Imam in the main mosque to recite the
entire Qur’an during the fasting month by reading approximately one section per day. This practice of
reading the Qur’an completely is known as khatm (complete recitation).

 

 

 

 

 

  1. Witr prayer

Witr prayer starts after a person prays the Isha prayer until dawn. Evidence for this is that the Prophet

(P.B.U.H) said: “Allah has prescribed for you a prayer (by which He may increase your reward), which is Witr; Allah has enjoined it for you during the time between ‘Isha’ prayer until dawn begins.” (Narrated by al-Tirmidhi)

It is better to pray the witr prayer in the final third of the night because prayer at this time is witnessed by the angels. However, if a person fears that he will not get up at the last third of the night then he or she can pray it straight in the beginning third so that he or she does not miss the prayer.

 

| P a g e 42

 

 

 

 

 

 

One should make the night prayers and odd number and thus the Witr prayer is an odd number of rakkats. It may consist of one, three, five, seven, nine or any other odd number. Most Muslims perform three rakaats. If you are praying the witr prayer and dawn is approaching then you should pray one rakkat so that you can pray witr before the start of dawn.

 

 

 

 

 

 

  1. Swalatu-l Istikhara

Istikhara is Arabicword which means to ask Allah to guide one to the right thing.Have you been in a

difficult situation especially when you have to choose between two permissible alternatives? Mention
some of the difficult decision you have had to choose.Allah (S.W.T) provides an answer whenever a
Muslim is in such a difficult situation. This is by offering a two rakaat prayer to seek guidance. Sa’ d
ibn Waqas reported that the hrophet(h.B.U.H) said, “Istikharah (seeking guidance from Allah) is one
of the distinct favors (of Allah) upon man, and a good fortune for the son of Adam is tobe pleased
with the judgment of Allah. And a misfortune of the son of Adam is his failure to make istikharah
(seeking Allah’s guidance), and a misfortune for the son of Adam is his displeasure with the judgment
of Allah.”

 

After completing the two-rak’ats, one praises Allah (S.W.T) and sends salutations to the hrophet (P.B.U.H) and recites the following supplication as narreted by Jabir.

“(O Allah! I ask guidance from Your knowledge, and Power from Your Might and I ask for Your great blessings. You are capable and I am not. You know and I do not and You know the unseen. O Allah! If You know that this job is good for my religion and my subsistence and in my Hereafter-(or said: If it is better for my present and later needs)-then You ordain it for me and make it easy for me to get, and then bless me in it, and if You know that this job is harmful to me in my religion and subsistence and in the Hereafter-(or said: If it is worse for my present and later needs)-then keep it away from me and let me be away from it. And ordain for me whatever is good for me, and make me satisfied with it).” (Sahih Bukhari)

 

 

| P a g e 43

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  1. Tahiyyatul-Masjid

This is the prayer of salutation to the mosque and is performed upon entering the mosque .It consists

of two rakaats. In case a person who was sitting inside the mosque went out of it, and then returned to it after a short period of time then he is not required to perform the prayer of salutation to the mosque. However, if he performs this prayer he will be rewarded for doing so.

 

 

VII.                                     Swalatu-l Dhuhaa

It is the mid-morning Prayer. Its time starts when sun risesto the height of a spear and ends close to

midday. The best time is when mid-morning heat has intensified. The minimum number of rakaat is

two but can be prayed upto eight rakaats.

 

 

 

VIII.                                    Qabliyya and Baadiya prayers

These prayers are offered before or after the Fardh prayers. The number of rakaats varies from one

prayer to another. This can be illustrated by the table below:

 

 

 

Fardh swalat                                Number of rakaat before         Number of rakaat after

Fajr                                                                      2                                            None

Dhuhr                                                                   2                                               2

Asr                                                                    None                                        None

Maghrib                                                            None                                            2

Isha                                                                      2                                               2

 

 

 

 

 

TWAHARA

The term twahara is Arabicword which means cleanliness.It is used in Islam to imply a state of ritual purity. This is a requirement in the observance of the acts of worship mention other instances where a muslim is require to be pure.

 

Ritual purity is attained through three ways;Ghusl(ritual bath),udhu(ablution)and tayammum(dry

 

| P a g e 44

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

ablution)Let us now discuss each of the three ways:

 

Ghusl

 

It’s a form of a ritual bath which involves the washing of a whole body.The following conditions makes it compulsory for a muslim to perform ghusl:

 

 

After sexual intercourse

 

After completing menstruation(Heidh)

 

Immediately after giving birth.

Ø When a person dies it’s the duty of the Muslims to wash the body.
After completing the post birth bleeding(Nifas)

 

Ejeculation of sperms when one is asleep or awake.

There Are other instances when the ritual Baath becomes optional.Can you mention any of them? Let us consider the following occasions:

 

 

Before going for Friday prayers.

 

Before going for the two Idd prayers (Idd ul adha and Idd ul Fitr)

 

After washing the deadbody.

When a non Muslim converts to Islam.
Before performing prayers for the rain.
Before praying holy city of Makka.
Before standing at Arafat during Hajj.

 

| P a g e 45

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Before going round the Kaaba.

Ø Before running between the two hillocks of swafa and marwa(Sa’i)
Before entering the Holy city of Madina.

Before throwing pebbles at Mina during the three days.  Steps of performing ghusl.

There are several essential steps that are followed in performing ghusl.These steps are also referred to as fardh or integral steps and must be followed for ones Ghusl to be valid. These include the following:

 

Niyyat (Intention)

 

  eou must declare your intention of cleansing to seek Allah’s pleasure and to perform the acts
of worship.

Removal of impurities.These are those substances that block the penetration of water into the skin. Can you give examples of such impurities?

 

Ensuring that water reaches all the parts of the body from the head to the toe.

 

Sunna acts of Ghusl

 

Apart from the Fardh steps, we have some acts that are included in the performance of ghusl but are not compulsory. These are termed as sunnah or optional acts of ghusland include th efollowing:

 

Starting with the basmallah

 

Performingudhu.

 

Washing the whole body three times.

 

 

| P a g e 46

 

 

 

 

Passing the hands all over the body.
Starting from the right then left.
Reciting a dua after Ghusl.

 

 

 

Acts forbidden while in the state of janaba(impurity)

Even though the performance of the acts of Ibada earns a Muslim reward,in the state of ritual impurity,it is forbidden for a muslim to indulge in the following:

 

Recitation of Quran

Performing of prayers
Entering the mosque
Touching the Quran

 

Performing Tawaff during Hajj.

In addition,a woman in menstruation is forbidden to perfom the following acts: Recitation of the Quran.

Holding or touching Quran.
Performing swalat

Observing any tipes of fast whether Fardh or Sunnah. Having sexual relations with the husband.

 

 

| P a g e 47

 

 

 

 

Entering the mosque.
To be divorced.

To perform tawwaf.
Wudhu’ Read [Q: 5:6]

When you go to any mosque, you will notice people sitting or standing where there are waer points o taps performing some preparations for prayers(swalat) Have you ever asked yourself why they do so.The reason is for purification. You can remember what we learnt about Twahara. What did we say about it? In this section,we shall look at wudhu as another way of attaining purity(Twahara)

Wudhu therefore is an is an Arabic word which means ablution .It involves washing ones face, hands,
head and feet in order to perform the acts of ibada.There are essential steps of performing Wudhu

 

Essential steps of wudhu

These are fardh or obligatory acts.They must be observed by however is performing wudhu. Failure to observe any of them will cosequencially render the process incomplete and your prayers null ansd void. A muslim must therefore follow the following steps while perfoming Wudhu:

 

   Making the intention to perform udhu’.

Washing the face from the top of the forehead to the chin and between the two ear lobes. Washing both arms up to and including the elbows.

Wiping a part of the head with wet hands.

Washing both feet up to and including the ankles.

Following the prescribed sequence without inter-changing any step.

 

Optional steps of performing wudhu

In the performance of Wudhu, we have some steps that we observe and have not been mentioned IN the above essentials. Could you mention any of these to you friend? The perfomance of these acts is considered as following the example of our Prophet (P.B.U.H). They are referred to as the sunna acts of wudhu and include the following:

 

| P a g e 48

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Ø          Reciting: “Bismillahir-Rahmanir-Rahim” (in the Name of aod, the All-Merciful, and the All-

Compassionate) before you starttaking wudhu.

Brushing of the teeth.

Washing the palms up to the wrists three times, including the parts between the fingers.  Cleaningthemouth with a brush or a finger and gargling three times.
Rinsing the nostrils three times.

Passing ones wet fingers through the beards.  To run water through ones fingers and toes.  Performingeach act three times.

Starting with the right hand side before the left.  Wiping the whole head and the back of the neck  Wiping the ears in and out.

Taking the entire udhu at once without breaking.  Reciting dua during and after Wudhu.
Performing the acts systematically.

Washing the parts one after the other without pausing, so that no part dries up before completion of wudhu.

Facing the direction of Qibla during the performance of wudhu.

 

 

 

 

 

 

Recommended acts (mustahab) of wudhu

Reciting the kalima(shahada)after ablution.

Avoiding worldly talk during the time for wudhu.

Avoiding extravagance (wasting water) during ablution.
Choosing a clean place for the performance of wudhu.

 

Nullifiers of wudhu

Wudhu is meant for perfomance of the acts of worship. A Muslim preparing for prayers can perform
wudhu and sustain it for the swalat of the rest of the day. However, there are certain acts that
invalidate wudhu (often referred to as “breaking wudhu”).It is therefore important to note that the
absence of wudhu will imply that those intended acts of worship will not be valid.We must therefore

 

 

| P a g e 49

 

 

 

 

 

have the knowledge of the things that will‘break wudhu’. These are what we refer to as nulliers.The following are among the acts that nullify wudhu’:

  1. Coming out of either solid, liquid or gas/wind from the two private parts (front and
    back)
  2. Emission of blood, pus or yellow matter from a wound, boil, pimple, or something
    similar to such an extent that it flows beyond the wound’s mouth.
  3. Vomiting a mouthful of matter.
  4. Physical contact for pleasure between men and women without any obstacle (e.g.,
    clothes).
  5. Loss of consciousness through sleep, drowsiness, and any such condition that may
    affect the proper functioning of the mind.
  6. Temporary insanity, fainting, hysteria, or intoxication.
  7. Touching the private parts with bear hands(without any barrier)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Tayammum

Supposing you were travelling and the time of prayer finds you at a place where there is no water, How would you purify yourself for Swalat? Taking into consideration that swalat is a must for a muslim and is performed at prescribed times; Allah  (S.W.T) has  given a solution to such an eventuality in the Quran. Almighty Allah (S.W.T) says: “…But if you are ill,or on a journey,or one of you comes from offices of nature,or you have been in contact with women and you find no water,then take for yourselves clean sand or earth and rub therewith your faces and hands.Allah does not wish to place you in a difficulty, but to make you clean…”[Q:5:6]

In reference to this verse, the use of clean sand for purification in preparation for swalat is refeerd to as tayammum.

Even though the word tayammum literally means an aim or a purpose, in this context it refers to dry ablution where clean sand is used to wipe the face and the limbs as an alternative of wudhu’.

 

Hudhaifa (R.A) narrated that the Messenger of Allah (P.B.U.H) said: “And the soil of the earth has

 

 

| P a g e 51

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

been made for us as a means with which to purify ourselves (for prayer) when we cannot find water.”

(Muslim)

 

Reasons for performing Tayammum

Even though the sharia allows the use of pure sand for purification,it is only permissible on specific occasions.This occasions may be necessitated by the following reasons:

 

  1. In case there is scarcity of water. This is when there is acute shortage of water or the available
    water is insufficient for performing ablution.
  2. For health reasons.If one is injured or ill and fears that use of water will worsen the condition.
  3. If the water is too cold and it is likely to cause physical harm to the user.
  4. If the process of getting water is dangerous or life threatening.
  5. When the available water is reserved for domestic use.
  6. Fear of missing a prayer by the time one gets to the source of water.
  7. If the the available water is impure.

 

Conditions of tayammum

 

When performing Tayammum,you should consider the following three conditions:

 

  1. One must use clean sand.
  2. It should be performed at the time of that particular prayer.
  3. The tayammum of one prayer ends at the termination of that particular prayer e.g one cannot
    use tayammum of Dhuhr for another prayer.

 

 

 

Essential steps of tayammum.

Besides the three conditions of perfoming Tayammum,the following steps should be followed while in the actual process:

 

  1. You must make the intention of performing tayammum.
  2. Strike the first heap of pure soil lightly with the palms of both hands and passing the palms
    over the face one time.
  3. Strike the second heap of pure soil with one’s palms and rubbing the right and left arms

 

| P a g e 51

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

alternately from the fingertips to the elbows.

  1. Follow the order above.

 

 

 

Nullifiers of tayammum.

As you learnt earlier, wudhu can be nullified by certain acts. Do you remember some of these acts? Similarly,thre are acts that if done will nullify tayammum.These acts include the following:

  1. All that nullifies wudhu will also nullify tayammum.
  2. As soon as the cause for performing it is removed (i.e., the sick person recovers or pure water
    is found).
  3. Performance of fardh prayer. A Muslim is not supposed to perform two fardh prayers with the
    same tayammum.
  4. When one denounces Islam.
    Significance of Swalat- (Prayers)

As already seen, Swalat is the second pillar of Islam. It is a practical pillar since it must be observed by following specific steps. The entire process of swalat which starts right from purification to its actual performance leaves a positive impact on the Muslim and society at large. What is the importance of swalat to you as a Muslim? How different is a society in which prayers are offered from one in which they are not? In this section, we shall look at how prayers benefit the society both spiritually and socially.

 

 

 

Social Benefits

  It trains a Muslim to avoid evil and shameful deeds. Allah(S.W.T) says “and established

regular prayer for prayer restrains from shameful and evil deeds.”[Q: 29:45]

Prayer is a means of leveling all differences of rank, creed, color, status and nationality, thus promoting equality. This is achieved through the use of similar facilities by all, standing side by side during swalat regardless of the differences in status, race or rank.
Promotes leadership qualities. For example the choosing of an Imam among the Muslims who is given and respect honor by all.

It encourages a Muslim to enjoin good and forbidevil.

It brings cohesion and unity among Muslim who will meet at the mosque frequently thus renewing their friendship.

 

| P a g e 52

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

It encourages a Muslim to be timeconcious since each prayer is conducted at a prescribed

time; you are expected to arrive in the mosque or area of conducting the prayers in good time. It instills self-respect, self-discipline, self-control, love, peace and harmony.

Spiritual Benefits

  It is the second pillar of Islam which therefore be observed by every Muslim.

  It makes a Muslim realize his duty is to worship Allah (S.W.T) alone.Allah (S.W.T)
says: “Verily I am Allah; there is no God but I: So serve non other than Me (only)
and establish regular player for my remembrance.”[Q:20:40]

  It is a sign of obedience for all those who perform prayers since it is a command from
Allah.

  Is a means through which Muslims communicate directly to God thus discouraging
polytheism (shirk).

  Prayers distinguish believers from non-believers since they are only performed by
those who believe in Allah (S.W.T) and if performed by the non believer, then it does
not become acceptable.

 

 

Swalat ul jamaa

Prayers are offered either individually or in congregation. When offered in congregation,it is refeered Swalat ul Jamaa.Itis the performance of prayers together by more than one person. Mention any prayers   that   are   offered   collectively.There   are   several   prayers   that   are   performed   in congregation,theseinclude the five daily prayers, Friday noon prayers, prayers during eclipse (solar and lunar), the two Idd prayers (Al Fitri and Al Adha),swalatul Janaza(funeral prayers) and Al Istisqai (prayer for seeking rain).

 

Conditions for Jamaa prayer.

You must have noted during the performance of prayers in congregation, ther are certain things that should be observed. Below, we are going to explain to you some of these conditions which you may have performed unknowingly in your mosque or when you were attending a swalat in Jamaa.

 

Ø It should be conducted at an accessible place where anybody is not deprived of the
chance to attend it ie the place should be open and accessible to all.

 

Ø The place should be such that people are neither shy nor scared from entering or

 

| P a g e 53

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

attending.

 

Ø herforming Jamaa with one’s family is highly recommended because it gives a chance
to teach the young members how to pray. It encourages members of the family to
perform prayers without laziness and enables the head of the family to monitor the
attitudes of the family members.

 

Ø The Imam should understand the steps to be followed and he should follow them.

 

Ø Both the imam and the followers must be at the same place. The followers in two
mosques can not be led by the same Imam.

 

Ø The followers should not perform any step before the Imam for example one should
follow the Imam when going for rukuu, sijda or any other step.

 

Ø A female Imam can only be allowed when leading other females otherwise she can
neither lead males nor a congregation of both males and females. Generally,  the
women are not as compelled to perform Jamaa prayers as males because of their roles
as mothers andcaretakers of the family.

Ø A  non  Muslim  is  not  allowed  to  lead  a  congregation  prayer  even  if  he  is
knowledgeable and there is no one to lead prayers.

Ø An insane cannot lead prayers. This is so because he might not comprehend the
pronunciation of words and format of the prayer.

Ø When leading the prayers, the Imam should pronounce the words clearly without
substituting the sounds and syllables.

Ø The Imam should be more knowledgeable over the rest in Fiqh (Islamic Jurisprudence)
and aspects of swalat, among other branches of Islamic knowledge. When there is
more than one knowledgeable person, other attributes like piety should be considered.
Where all of them are pious, then the oldest can be made the Imam.

 

Importance of swalat ul jamaa

In most communities you will observe that members are encouraged to do most of the activities together and in unity.Usually success is achieved when things are done in unity thus the Swahili proverb; umoja ni nguvu utengano ni udhaifu(unity is strength).Can you mention some of the

 

| P a g e 54

 

 

 

 

 

activities that are done communually in your society? Similarly, in Islam the prophet(P.B.U.H)highly recommended the Jamaat prayers as stated in the following hadiths:

Abu Huraira (R.A) narrated that a blind man came to the prophet (P.B.U.H) and said to him, “O
messenger of Allah, I have no one to guide me to the mosque.’(He was asking for the permission of
the prophet to pray in his house) the prophet (P.B.U.H) gave himpermission to pray at home, but
when he turned to go back, the prophet called him and said, “do you hear the Adhan?” the blind man
said, “Yes” the prophet then said,  “then respond to it  (by coming to the mosque)”  (related by
Muslim.)

 

IbnAbbas (R.A) narrated that the messenger of Allah said, “If any one hears the Adhan but does not cometo the congregational prayer,the prayer he offers will not be accepted unless he has an excuse” (Ibn Ma’ja,Ibn Hiban, Al Hakim)

The above two hadith can briefly illustrate to us how the prophet laid emphasis on the observance of prayers in Jamaa. Let us also consider the following benefits of Jamaa prayers:

  1. Muslims have a chance of converging five times a day to cement their brotherhood when
    the prayers are performed at the mosque behind the Imam.
  2. One can unite his family members and monitor their performance in ibadah by performing
    prayers with them in Jamaa.
  3. Muslims learn from  others  how  to  perform  prayers  correctly.  This  is  of  specific
    importance to children and new converts who need to learn religious practices from others
    who are experienced.
  4. It promotes confidence in performance of prayers.
  5. It promotes discipline since the maamumatare not supposed to preceed the Imam. Such
    discipline makes and proves the Islamic system of worship to be orderly
  6. It promotes strictness and concentration.
  7. Develops and promotes leadership qualities. For example the selection of one of the
    members to be an imam shows respect and honoraccorded to him.
  8. The reward for Jamaa prayer is twenty seven times more than praying alone.
  9. It promotesMuslims of different social, political, economic and professional background
    keep off their differences and converge together for prayers.

 

 

 

 

Prayers for special occasion

 

| P a g e 55

 

 

 

 

 

Even though we have prayers prescribed for particular times, Islam gives room for certain prayers to be offerd during special occasions. Can you mention any prayers that are offered at times other than the time for the normal daily prayers? How differently are these prayers performed? In addition to what you have mentioned we shall consider the following as special acassions:

Swalatul Musafir: (Prayer of a Traveler)

Read [Q:4:101]

In normal life situation people travel from one place to another for various reasons.Suggest some of the reasons as t why people travel. At one point you must have also travelled from your home area to another place, either far or near. Can you recall the furthest place you have travelled to?
In Arabic language, a traveler is known as a musafir. But in thecontext of special prayer,a musafir is a Muslim who sets out intending to travel for more than 77 kilometers regardless of the mode of transport. He is regarded a musafir the moment he comes out of the boundaries of his town or city.
During traveling, a muslim may not be in a position to offer the prayers in the normal way due to the conditions experienced in the journey. Allah (S.W.T) Has not left out his favors and has given the Muslim traveler privileges which include swalatul Musafir.This prayer can be performed inthree ways.These are:Jamu’ Taqdim, Jamu’ Taakhir and Qasr.

Allah says  “When you travel through the earth, there is no blame on you if you shorten the
prayers, for fear the unbelievers may attack you: For the unbelievers are unto enemies.”[Q 4:101]

 

Jamu’ Taqdim

This is to bring forward a prayer e.g. to bring forward Asr and pray it at Dhuhr time.

Muadh (R.A) narrated, “We set out with the prophet on the expedition of Tabuk and he combined Dhuhr and Asr together…” (Muslim)

 

Jamu’ Taakhir

This is delaying of one prayer and performing it at the time ofthe next prayer. For example, delaying Dhuhr and then performing it with Asr during Asr time.Anas (R.A) narrated that:“Whenever the messenger of Allah started on a journey before the sun had passed its meridian (before noon) he would delay the Dhuhr prayer till the time of Asr…”(Bukhari and Muslim)

Qasr

It is the shortening of the 4 rakaats prayer to perform then in two rakats.For example, Dhuhr, Asr and Isha can all be shortened to two rakaats.

 

| P a g e 56

 

 

 

 

 

There is no reduction of rakaats for the fajr and maghrib swalaats. One has to offer them completely as he normally does.

Anas (R.A) narrated: “We travelled with the prophet from Madina to Makka and he used to pray two rakaat prayers until we returned to Madina.” (Bukhari and Muslim)

 

Other prayers for special occasions include the following;

Kusuf wal Khusuf

Have you ever witnessed either of the eclipses? What do you normally do when there is an eclipse of the sun or the moon? Are you aware that Islam has offered a clear and definite practice to be done during any of the eclipses? This is by performing two rakaat prayers.

Aisha(RA) Narrated that , “ The messenger of Allah recited the Quran aloud during the eclipse prayer and performed a total of two rakaat” (Bukhari and Muslim)

 

Swalatul Istisqa’a

Allah (S.W.T) has created different seasons like summer, winter, spring and autumn. Some of these seasons are favourable to man while others are harsh. These seasons are associated with different conditions. Among theseconditions is drought. Have you ever experienceda drought condition? What practices do the members of your community perform to ward off the drought? You will realize that most  communities  offer  sacrifices  and  prayers  to  their  ancestors  and  other  creatures  besides Allah(S.W.T). This is shirk and is totally forbidden in Islam.In the event of a drought, Islam prescribes a special prayer to be performed. This prayer is referred to as Swalatul Istisqa’a, which isA two rakaat congregational prayer is offered.

Anas (RA) narrated that, “The messenger of Allah supplicated Allah for rain and he pointed with the back of his hand to the sky.” (Muslim)

 

Swalatul Eid

There are two Eid prayers which are performed in two different ocasions;

  1. a) Idd-ul Fitr: It is a two rakaat prayer performed to mark the end of the month of Ramadhan.
  2. b) Idd-ul Adha: It is a two rakaat prayerperformed on the tenth of Dhul Hijja to mark the end of
    the activities of Hajj.

Aisha (R.A) narrated that, the messenger of Allah said, “Breaking the fast at the end of Ramadhan is

(determined) when people break their fast and Idd ul Adha (the Idd of sacrifice)is determined when

 

| P a g e 57

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

people offer their sacrifices.” (At-Tirmidhy)

 

 

 

Swalatul JanaizaFuneral Prayer:

 

Can you recall one of the fardh al kifaya prayers which must be performed by at least one Muslim in the community? Salatul Janazah is Fardh Kafayah, that is, if one performs the prayer then all are free of the responsiblity. Jamma (congregation) is not a condition for this prayer as it is sufficient even if one person prays.This is a prayer performed for the dead. When a muslim passes on, it is the responsibility of those who are around him during the time of his or her death to wash the body and pray for it.On the prayer of Janaiza, Aisha (R.A) narrated, “By Allah, the messenger of Allah offered funeral prayer in mosque for the sons of Baida’ (Sahl and suhail).” [Muslim]

There are two parts of this Prayer:

To say Allahu Akbar

Qiyam, which has three sunna Muaqada:Sana, Durood and Duaa for the deceased

 

How to perform swalatul Janaza

  1. Niyyat: The performer should make the intention, “I make the niyyat for the prayer of this
    janaza for Allah, duaa for this deceased, behind this imam.”
  2. Takbiratul-Ihram: The perfomers shouldraise their hands to their ears and fold their hands
    underneath the navel as usual whilst saying Allahu Akbar and read Sana,

 

Sana:

 

 

 

Glory be to You Oh Allah, and praise be to You, and blessed is Your name, and exalted is Your Majesty, and there is none to be served besides You.

  1. Then raise the hands, say Allahu Akbar and read the duroode Ibraheem; Duroode Ibraheemi:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

| P a g e 58

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

O Allah! Shower Your mercy upon Muhammad and the followers of Muhammad, as You showered
Your mercy upon Ibrahim and the followers of Ibrahim. Behold, You are Praiseworthy, Glorious.

Oh Allah! Shower Your blessing upon Muhammad,  and the followers of Muhammad as You showered Your blessings upon Ibrahim and the followers of Ibrahim. Behold, You are Praiseworthy,
Glorious.

 

 

  1. Then raise the hands, say Allahu Akbar and read the duaa.

 

Duaa for an adult man or woman:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Oh Allah! Forgive those of us that are alive and those of us that are dead; those of us that are present

 

| P a g e 59

 

 

 

 

 

 

and those of us who are absent; those of us who are young and those of us who are adults; our males and our females. Oh Allah! Whomsoever You keep alive let him live as a follower of Islam and whomsoever You cause to die, let him die a Believer.

 

Duaa for a boy:

 

 

Oh! Allah, make him (this child) a source for our salvation and make him a source of reward and treasure for us and make him an intercessor for us and one whose intercession is accepted.

 

Duaa for a girl:

 

 

Oh! Allah, make her (this child) a source for our salvation and make her a source of reward and treasure for us and make her an intercessor for us and one whose intercession is accepted.

 

 

  1. After the duaa, say Allahu Akbar, drop the hands and then turn the head both sides for salaam.

 

 

 

 

Sijdat

Demonstration of a worshipper in the sujuud position.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

| P a g e 61

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Read [Q 7:206]; [Q:19:58];[Q:25:60];[Q:32:15];[Q:84:21]

Can you identify one thing that is common in all the verses you have read? It s evident that all these verses mention the word sijdah.Sijadah is a very important act of worship in the life of a muslim and that is why several verse of the Quran that mention it. You will also observe that sijdah is part of the obligatory steps in swalat.

Sijda is an act ofworship which involvesprostration and glorification where by the fore head, palms and the knees firmly touch the ground facing the direction of the Qibla.

Narrated al-Bara’ bin A-zib (R.A) that the messenger of Allah said, “Whenever you prostrate place the palms of your hand (on the ground) and raise your elbows.”  (Muslim)

 

Types of Sijdats

Besides sijda during swalat, there are other three types of Sijdat namely:-

Sijdatul Tilawa
Sijdatul Shukr
Sijdatul Sahw

| P a g e 61

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Sijdatul Tilawa

Earlier in this section, we have learnt that there are several verses in the Quran that mention the word
sijda.What do you do when you come across these verses? Definitely you will have to pause and
prostrate then continue with your recitation. This prostration is what is referred to as Tilawa.
There are fourteen places of prostration in the Holy Quran as agreed upon by all the Muslim religious

scholars, while Imam Shafi suggests prostration at Quran 22:77 to make them a total of fifteen.

Allah says in the Quran, “But fall ye down in prostration to Allah and adore Him.”[Q 53:62]

Ibn Abbas(RA)narrated , “the messenger of Allah prostrated when he recited suratul Najm[Q: 13]” Quotation of verses in the quran that require prostration

NAME      OF                                      NUMBER OF           NUMBER OF             THE WORD

SURAH                                                    SURAH                     VERSE

 

 

Al-A’raf                                                         7                              206                                                                       WalahuYasjuduuna

Ar-Rad                                                          13                              15                 Walillaahi yasjudu

An -Nahl                                                       16                              49                 Walillaahi yasjudu

Al-Isra                                                           17                             107                Yakhirruuna

lil adhqaani sujjadaa

Mary am                                                       19                              58                 Kharruu sujjadan

Al-Hajj                                                          22                              18                 Yasjudu lahu

Al-Hajj                                                          22                             77*                Wasjuduu wa’buduu

Al-Furqaan                                                   25                              60                 Wa idha qiila

Lahumusjuduu

An-Naml                                                       27                              25                 Al-la yasjuduu lillaahi

As-Sajda                                                       32                              15                 Kharruu sujjadan

Sad                                                                38                              24                                                                      Kharraraaki’an

Fussilat                                                         41                              37                 Wasjuduu lillaahi

An-Najm                                                       53                              62                 fasjuduu lillaahi

Al-Inshiqaq                                                   84                              21                 Laa yasjuduun

Al Alaq                                                         96                              19                 Wasjud

 

 

 

 

| P a g e 62

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Sijdatul Sahw

Human beings have a tendancy of frogeting. At times we forget and even skip certain steps during the performance of swalat. In such an eventuality, what do you do?

Whenever a worshipper omits by forgetting to perform an important pillar of swalat (Arkanu swalat) he is supposed to perform sijdatu-Sahwi(prostration for forgetfulness)

 

 

This type of sijda is usually performed in swalat before the first salaam and just like the ordinary

prostration.For example, if one forgets to perfor the ruku’,or sijdah or any other pillar of swalat.

Imran bin al-Hussein (R.A) narrated the messenger of Allah led them in prayer and forgot (to do something) so he made two prostrations and recited the tashahud and then said the Tasleem. (Abu Dawoud and At-Tirmidhy)

 

 

Sijdatul Shukr

Muslims should always be grateful and thankful to Allah (S.W.T) Prostration is one of the ways of
showing gratitude to Allah (S.W.T). This type of sijda is performed for the purposes of showing ones
gratefulness  and  appreciation  towards  Allah  after  attaining  any  good  thing  e.g.  passing  of
examinations, getting a new born babysit is a way of thanking Allah.It can be performed in any place
that is clean.

Abu Bakar (R.A) narrated, “Whenever the prophet received something which pleased him,he would

make the Sajda in gratitude to Allah” (Related by the six Imams except An-Nasai)

 

5.00 ZAKAT

 

Meaning of zakat

 

Every society will have people who are well off and those who need assistance. Have you met

people who may be friends, relatives, neighbours or even strangers and they needed your help? How
did you react to their request? In many cases, every society will have its own way of dealing with
such situations. Islam as a complete way of life has not been left behind. The plight of the poor and
the needy has been well taken care of by the institution of Zakat. It is one of the major religious
dutiesand the third pillar in Islam.Zakat was made obligatory on Ummahs of all prophets even before
Prophet Mohammad (P.B.U.H) this is evident when we look into the Holy Quran where we see that
from ancient times Salah and Zakat were ordained as compulsory.For example, there is mentioning
about Prophet Ibraham and the Prophets of his race when Allah says in the Quran:

 

| P a g e 63

 

 

 

 

 

“And We made them leaders of men. They guided the people according to Our command, and We inspired in them the doing of good deeds and right establishment of Salah and giving of Zakat and they were worshippers of Us.” [Q: 21:73]

 

About Prophet Ismael it is said:

“He enjoined upon his people Salah and Zakat and was acceptable in the sight of his Lord.” [Q: 19:55]

 

Prophet Moses prayed for his ummah:

 

“O God! Bestow upon us the well-being of this world as also the well-being of the Hereafter.”

 

Do you know in reply to it what Allah answered?

“I shall smite with my punishment whom I will. Although My mercy embraced all things, but I shall ordain it for those who will fear Me and give Zakat and those who will believe in Our revelations.”[Q: 7:156]

 

“And Allah said:‘O Children of Israel! I am with you, if you offer Salah, and give Zakat and

believe in My messengers and support those messengers who are to come, and lend unto Allah a nice loan surely I shall remit your sins.’”[Q: 5:12]

Before Prophet Muhammad (P.B.U.H) the last Prophet was Prophet Issa. The commandment about Salah and Zakat was given to him also by Allah, as is found in Suratul-Mariam:

“And hath made me blessed wheresoever I may be, and hath enjoined upon me Salah and Zakat so long as I remain alive.” [Q: 19:31)

This shows that the religion of Islam has been established from the beginning, in the ministry of every prophet, on the two great pillars of Salah and Zakat, and it never happened that any Ummah believing in Allah (S.W.T) was exempted from these two obligatory duties.

 

Let us now define Zakat.

Literally the term Zakat is Arabic word which means both ‘purification’ and ‘growth’. It refers to the
purification of a believer’swealth and soul. Wealth purification denotes the mobilization of assets for

| P a g e 64

 

 

 

 

 

 

the purpose of financial growth and justified distribution. Purification of the soul implies freedom from hatred, jealousy, selfishness, uneasiness and greed. Almighty Allah (S.W.T) says, “And be steatfast in prayer; practice regular charity; and bow down your heads with those who bow down (in worship).”[Q: 2:43]

Technically, it involves distributing a portion of one’s wealth to those prescribed by the Quran. OtherQuranic connotations also include the purification of sin.It is one of the most important principles of Islam andthe third pillar.

Allah  (S.WT) says,  “And they have been commanded No more than this: To worship Allah, Offering Him sincere devotion, being true in (faith); to establish regular prayers; And to practice regular charity; and that is the religion Right and Straight.”[Q: 98:5]

 

There are three types of Zakat namely; Zakatul Maal, Zakatul-Fifr and Sadaqa.

 

 

Zakatul-maal

 

Zakat-ul-Maal is the obligatory charity paid by an individual to the needy from the property which
he possesses. It is obligatory on an individual who possesses wealth equal toor above a minimum
amount  called  Nisab  for  an  entire  lunar  year.  Forthe  purpose  of  calculating  Zakat,  different

categories  of  wealth  are  defined,this  shall  be  demonstrated  by  the  table  (on  page                                                                                                                                                     )  on

specific items on which Zakat is payable.

In terms of Islamic jurisprudence  (Fiqh), Zakatul-Maal is an obligatory duty  (Fardh) on every
Muslim  possessing  wealth  equal  toor  exceeding  the  prescribed  amount  ofNisab.  It  is  a
prescribedwelfare-contribution from one’s stored wealth. It is the right of Allah  (S.W.T) on a
Muslim’s wealth. Paying Zakat-ul-Maal is the responsibility of theowner. If one fails to carry out this
obligation, he is a sinner, consequently incurring Allah’s displeasureand His punishment in the
hereafter.

 

 

 

Zakat-ul-fitr

 

 

 

 

| P a g e 65

 

 

 

 

 

Zakatu-ul-Fitr is Zakat on the individual. It is a special charity paid to the needy onor before the day of Eid -ul-Fitr, which is the first day of the month ofShawwal following the month of Ramadhan. Zakat-ul-Fitr is paid asatonement for any shortcomings in the worship of Fasting during the month of Ramadan.

 

On the day of Eid -ul-Fitr, which marks the completion of the month ofRamadhan, every Muslim possessing an amount of food in excess of his family’s need for a day (24 hours) is mandated to pay Zakat-ul-Fitr on his own behalf and for all his dependent(s).Zakat-ul-Fitr or Fitrah is “the one full meal per person or cash equivalent to the cost of one full meal, given directly to the needy ofthe community before Eid-ul-Fitr prayer. Arrangements for payingFitrah should be made ahead of time so that it reaches the eligiblerecipients in time for them to make use of it on Eid day. The quantity ofZakat-ul-Fitr traditionally amounts to one Sa`, which is equivalent to 21/2kilograms of food such as wheat, barley, rice, or the like.

Ibn Abbas (RA) narrated that, “The messenger of Allah (P.B.U.H) enjoined Zakatul Fitr on the one who fasts in the month of Ramadhan to purify him from any indecent act or speech and for the purpose of providing food fortheneedy… (Abu aawoud and Ibn Ma’jah)

 

SADAQAH

 

Sadaqah is an Arabic term widely used to cover all kinds of charity.

Although Sadaqah and Zakat are often used interchangeably, Sadaqah implies voluntary charity and is not limited to giving out money or food.

All good deeds are considered Sadaqah and are rewarded by Allah  (S.W.T)These even include practices that may look simple such as removing a thorn from the path,helping the old to cross a busy road among othersEvery Muslim is exhorted togive Sadaqah.

The Prophet Muhammad (P.B.U.H) said:“Every Muslim has to give Sadaqah.” The people asked: “OProphet of Allah, what about the one who has nothing?”Hereplied: “He should work with his hand to giveSadaqah.” They asked: “If he cannot find (work)?” Hereplied: “He should help the needy who ask for help.” Theyasked:“If he cannot do that?” He replied: “He should then do good deeds and shun evil, for this will be taken asSadaqah.”(Sahih al-Bukhari)

 

| P a g e 66

 

 

 

 

 

 

Muslims practice charity and earn rewards from Allah  (S.W.T) by doing good deeds all their
lives.They can continue earning Allah’s rewards even after their death.This is called perpetual
Sadaqah(sadaqatul-Jariyah) Abu Hurayra (R.A) narrated that the Messenger of Allah (P.B.U.H) said,
“When the son of Adam dies, his actions are cut off except for three: Sadaqah Jariyah (on-going
charity), knowledge which brought benefit, and a virtuous son who makes supplication for him.”
[Muslim]

Sadaqah Jariyah means Continuous Alms/Charity. A continuous charity is an action that someone does that remains active even after the person is dead. For example, if a person digs a well then people can use it for a very long time – even after the person dies. This type of charity is very effective and serves better than just giving money as the person who initiated the action will get thawab even after he dies.

 

DIFFERENCES BETWEEN ZAKAT AND SADAQAH

 

 

 

ZAKAT

Zakat is a pillar of Islam

Zakat has a nisab- (the minimum amount one must have before it becomes compulsory.)
There is a fixed amount to be paid on the saved money or cash.

 

Zakat is paid on specific and particular items.

 

There is fixed period within which one must pay Zakat.

 

Zakat   is   payable   to   specific   recipients mentioned in the Quran.

 

 

SADAQA

Sadaqah is an act of charity.

 

 

Sadaqah has no minimum amount.

 

 

Any amount can be given as sadaqa.

 

 

 

Sadaqah is paid on anything one wish to give from.

 

 

Sadaqah can be paid at any time.

 

 

Sadaqah can be given to any person in need whether a Muslim or a non Muslim.

 

 

 

 

| P a g e 67

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Zakat is compulsory to the Muslims who                                Sadaqah is voluntary to whoever wishes to give it.

qualify to pay it.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Conditions for zakat payment

Even though payment of Zakat is a must to the able Muslims, certain conditions have to be observed. These include the following:

  1. One paying it must be a Muslim.
  2. One must be a free man and not a slave.

iii.                            One must be of sound mind (sane.)

  1. The giver of Zakat must have attained maturity.
  2. The wealth to be paid should have reached nisab.
  3. The wealth or property must have been in ones possession for a full year.

vii.                            Zakat-ul- Fitr should be paid before one goes for the Eid prayers.

 

 

 

 

 

 

Differences between Zakat-ul-Fitr and Zakat-ul-Maal

 

Zakaat-ul -Maal

1                 The wealth must have been in

Possession for one year.

2                 The rate should be calculated

according to the property to be

given out.

3                 It should be given to recipient

prescribed in the Quran.

4                 One may also give in the form

of cash.

Zakaat-ul- Fitr

It should be given in the month of Ramadhan before one goes for Idd Prayers.

It should be given on 21/2 kg of the staple food

 

 

 

It can be given to any needy or destitute Muslim

 

This   must   represent   the   exact   equivalent   of   the
market value of the kind and quality of the staple
food which would have otherwise been offered. e.g.

 

| P a g e 68

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

cash, animals,minerals,fruits among others.

 

5                 The   nisab   depends   on   the

amount of wealth.

 

 

6                 It purifies wealth

 

 

7                 It is given at any time of the

year when it is due.

The  value  is  determined  by  the  number  of

dependants in the family.

 

 

It purifies saum

 

 

Given only in the month of Ramadhan

 

 

 

 

 

 

Condition for distribution of zakat

During the distribution of Zakat, it is very important that it is done according to the sharia.The following conditions should be considered:

  1. The intention (Niyyat) should be for the sake of fulfilling Allah’s command and not for
    any other reasons.
  2. It should be given to the recipients prescribed by the Quran.
  3. It should be given promptly, when it is due.
  4. Zakat of one place should not be transferred to another place.
  5. The item payable for Zakat should not be exchanged for another item. For example it is
    permisable to  use  the  nisab  for  animals  when  you  are  supposed  to  pay zakat  for
    mineralsbut one can convert the cows into currency and then a rate of the currency is
    given out for Zakat.

 

Items on which zakat is payable

  1. Domestic animals such as camels, sheep, oxen which are not kept as articles of trade.
  2. Agricultural produce such crops and fruits of the field like wheat, barley, dates, raisins,
    rice, maize and vegetables.
  3. Gold, silver and other mineral products.
  4. Dug out treasures whose ownership has not been identified for one year.
  5. Trade and merchandise(goods for trade)
  6. Savings from the sale of goods should be paid for Zakatafter a year.
  7. Savings from the house rent and land rates.
  8. Personal income.

| P a g e 69

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

INSERT NISAB RATES FROM INTERNET

 

Agricultural
produce

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Items on which Zakat is not payable

Even though Zakat is an obligatory Pillar in Islam and that one has to pay,there are certain items which a Muslim is not supposed to give.These items include the following:

  1. Private houses in which the owner dwells in.
  2. Animals used for transportation.
  3. Furniture, clothing Weapons or tools for daily use.
  4. Books which are not for sale.
  5. Jewellery or ornaments which have not reached nisab.
  6. Machinery used for manufacture of goods.

 

 

 

 

 

(d)Recipients of Zakat

There are those people whom the Quran has singled out to be the rightful beneficiaries of Zakat.The Quran has identified a list of deserving persons to whom Zakat should be given.
Allah says“Alms are for the poor and the needy, and those employed to administer the ( funds); For those whose hearts have been recently reconciled to the truth; and for those in bondage and in debt; in the course of Allah; and for the wayfarer:”(Thus is it) ordained by Allah, and Allah is full of knowledge and wisdom.”[Q: 9:60]

According to the above verse the recipients of Zakat are as follows:

 

 

  1. The poor(Fuqara)

 

| P a g e 71

 

 

 

 

 

These are the Muslims who do not have any means of livelihood and material possession to support themselves and their families.

 

 

  1. The needy(Masaakin)

These are the Muslims who lack sufficient means of livelihood to meet their basic

requirements.

 

 

  1. Zakat collectors(Aamil)

They are the Muslims who have been entrusted with the responsibility of collecting and

distributing Zakat.They receive it as their source of income.

 

 

  1. The new converts(Mualaf)

They are also referred to as sympathizers. They are the people who have just embraced

Islam and need help to settle down and strengthen their faith.

 

 

 

  1. The captives(Riqab)

These are prisoners of war or hostages who need to be ransomed in order to secure their

freedom.

 

 

  1. Debtors(Gharimin)

These are Muslims who have incurred debts through halal transactions. Zakat can be used

to pay off there debts which they incurred to meettheir basic needs.

 

 

  1. Those on the course of Allah(Fisabillillah)

Zakat can be used to finance any form of struggle or course for the love of Allah (S.W.T)

such as aa’wa.sponsering students educational expence among others.

 

 

 

  1. The wayfarers(Ibnu Sabil)

These are stranded travelers on lawful journey who are in difficulty and may need

assistance to cater for their travel and basic needs.

 

 

| P a g e 71

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Importance of Zakat.

Allah (S.WT) has prescribed the pillars in Islam for the benefit of humankind. These benefits
include social, spiritual and even economical. Let us now look at the importance of Zakat.

 

Spiritual Importance of Zakat.

 

 

  1. A believer gets rewards by fulfilling this third pillar of Islam.
  2. It is a commandment of Allah (S.W.T)and therefore must be observed by every Muslim who
    qualifies to give it.
  3. Giving of Zakat purifies the wealth of the giver.
  4. It blesses the wealth of the giver.
  5. The institution of Zakat enables one to fulfill his religious obligation.
  6. Develops spiritual growth and piety.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Social Importance

  1. Creates good relationship between the giver and receiver.
  2. Remove jealously/ mistrust of the rich.
  3. Restores hope, dignity and worthiness of the poor.
  4. Reduces the gap between the rich and poor
  5. Develops and fosters a healthy social relationship among members of the community.
  6. Removes pride, selfishness or greed among rich.
  7. Job creation for the Zakat collectors who secure employment.
  8. Fighting corruption
  9. Clearing debts of citizens

10.It helps foster equality among the Muslims.

11.Promotes unity and brotherhood among the Muslim Ummah.

 

| P a g e 72

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

12.It fosters love among the Muslims.

 

 

Economic importance

  1. Zakat Helps raise living standards of the poor less, fortunate and the marginalized
    communities.
  2. It helps the poor and needy by relieving their hardships and troubles.
  3. Helps create  a  self  supporting  community  which  does  not  require  financial  or
    economic  assistance  in  form  of  food  or  material.  This  enables  the  Muslim
    communityto be self reliant and independent.
  4. Zakat contributes to the national budget as it is a form of tax.
  5. It helps in the creation of job and employment opportunities.
  6. Those in debt are able to settle them from the Zakat.
  7. Zakat assists in improving the economy in the society by creating job opportunities
    for example the Zakatcollectors and distributors, clearance of debts and establishment
    of social amenities.

 

 

 

 

 

Differences between Zakat and Tax

 

ZAKAT

It is the third pillar of Islam

 

 

It is only paid annually

 

 

The rate of Zakat is fixed till the day of judgment.

 

 

It is a commandment of Allah (S.W.T) Q2: 110

TAX

It is a law of the government or rather the policies of state

It can be paid monthly, weekly, daily or even hourly.

 

Its rate keeps fluctuating or rather it is
determined by the amount of income one
earns.

 

It is authorized by the government, King or the ruler of the state.

 

 

| P a g e 73

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

It is payable on one’s saving

 

 

It is rewarded by Allah and therefore cannot be evaded

 

 

 

 

 

It is calculated from the gross salary or

net profit.

 

It  is  rewarded  by  the  state  ruler  or government hence one is fined for not giving it out.

 

 

 

 

The role played by Zakat in promoting integrity.

Zakat plays a very important role in the promotion of integrity in the society through the following ways:

1) It enhances the sense of responsibility in that the giverfeels obliged to perform the acts as an
obligatory duty upon him.

2) It also promotes loyalty which is an aspect of integrity. The giver shows loyalty to Allah who
has commanded those with wealth to give it in charity. Zakat has been mentioned eighty two

(82) times in the Quran.

3) It assists in curbing vices such as theft, by regulating the owning of resources in the society
and creating a balance.

4) Giving of Zakat helps in minimizing vices such as jealousy and envy in that the receiver feels
satisfied when he is given the share from it. And to the giver it reduces extravagance and
greed for wealth.

5) It encourages hard work because every Muslim has an incentive to work since he is expected
to give something to the needy and earn thawab.

6) Zakat reduces injustices such as unfair distribution of wealth in that only the rightful
recipients are given.

7) Zakat promotes unity in the society by bringing together both the rich and the poor.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

| P a g e 74

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Suggested study Questions andActivities.

Answer the following questions in your I.R.E revision exercise book.

 

  1. a)Describe the performance of Sijdatul Tilawa, Sijdatul Shukr and Sijdatul Sahw.

 

b)Identify the various methods of purification

 

2.a)Give the acts which invalidate wudhu.

 

b)Discuss the significance of shahada in the life of a Muslim.

3.a) Give the differences between Zakat-ul Fitr and Zakat-ul maal. b)Expalin the items on which Zakat is payable.
Activities

  1. Demonstrate the performance of udhu and identify the Sunnah acts.
  2. Demonstrate the performance of swalatul Janaza.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

| P a g e 75

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

CHAPTER 5

Akhlaq (morality)

 

Akhlaq refers to the standard behaviour or code of conduct which an individual is expected to uphold or observe according to his or her society. Therefore Islamic morality refers to the code of conduct prescribed by the Quran and Hadith which a Muslim is expected to adhere to
The Islamic moral system stems from its primary creed of belief in One God as the Creator and Sustainer of the Universe. Islam considers the human race to be a part of aod’s creation, and as His subjects. From an Islamic perspective, the purpose of human life is to worship God, by leading this worldly life in harmony with the Divine Will, and thereby achieving peace in this world, and everlasting success in the life of the hereafter. Muslims look to the Glorious Quran and the Traditions of the Prophet as their moral guides.Morality in Islam addresses every aspect of a Muslim life, from greetings to international relations. Muslims must not only be morally healthy, but also contribute to the moral health of the entire society.

The almighty Allah says:“You are the best of the nations raised up for (the benefit of) men; you enjoin what is right and forbid the wrong and believe in God; and if the followers of the book had believed it would have been better for them; of them(some) are believers and most of them are transgressors.”[Q: 3:110]

The prophet (P.B.U.H) summarized the conduct of a Muslim when he said:

“My Sustainer has given me nine commands: to remain conscious of Allah, whether in private or in public; to speak justly, whether angry or pleased; to show moderation both when poor and when rich, to reunite friendship with those who have broken off with me; to give to him who refuses me; that my silence should be occupied with thought; that my looking should be an admonition; and that I should command what is right.”

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

The alorious Qur’an says:

 

| P a g e 76

 

 

 

 

 

“It is not righteousness that ye turn your faces Towards east or West; but it is righteousness- to believe in Allah and the Last Day, and the Angels, and the Book, and the Messengers; to spend of your substance, out of love for Him, for your kin, for orphans, for the needy, for the wayfarer, for those who ask, and for the ransom of slaves; to be steadfast in prayer, and practice regular charity; to fulfill the contracts which ye have made; and to be firm and patient, in pain  (or suffering) and adversity, and throughout all periods of panic. Such are the people of truth, the Allah-fearing.”[Q: 2:177]

This verse emphasizes the Islamic belief that righteousness and piety is based on a true and sincerefaith. The key to virtue and good conduct is a strong relation with God, who sees all, at all times and everywhere. He knows the secrets of the hearts and the intentions behind all actions. Therefore, Islam enjoins moral behavior in all circumstances.It may be possible to deceive the world, but it’s not possible to deceive the r reator.

Morality in Islam centers on certain basic beliefs and principles as follows:

  1. a) Allah (S.W.T) is the creator and source of all goodness, truth and beauty.
  2. b) Man is a responsible, dignified and honorable agent of his Creator.
  3. c) Allah (SW.T) has put everything in the heavens and the earth in the service of
  4. d) By His Mercy and Wisdom, Allah (S.W.T) does not expect the impossible from man
    or hold him accountable for anything beyond his power. Nor does Allah (S.W.T)
    forbid man to enjoy the good things of life.
  5. e) Moderation, practicality and balance are guarantees of high integrity and sound
  6. f) All things are permissible in principle except what is singled out as obligatory, which
    must be observed and what is singled out as forbidden, which must be avoided.
  7. g) Man’s ultimate responsibility is to Allah (S.W.T) and his highest goal is the pleasure
    of his Creator.

 

 

Dimensions of Islamic morality

In the beginning of this chapter, we have learnt that Akhlaq involves moral values and that Allah (S.W.T) always wants us to lead a pious life.

Islamic morality is measured in two ways: Maarufat (virtues) and Munkaraat (vices)

It entirely deals with the relationship between man and the other and creatures of the universe, man
and his innermost self. The Muslim’s relationship with Allah (S.W.T) should be one of love and

| P a g e 77

 

 

 

 

 

obedience, complete trust, stead fastness and active devotion;it is this kind of behaviour that should inspire and nourish morality at the human level.

In relating to his fellow men, a Muslim should show kindness, care and respect to relatives, neighbours and strangers whatever their status in the society. He must also honor the legitimate rights of others as much as he fulfills his own.

A Muslim should also use nature for the benefit of humanity as signs of Allaah (S.W.T) without waste of humility as signs of Allaah (S.W.T) without waste or excess.

A Muslims moral obligation is also to stand for what is right and fight what is wrong, seek what is
true and abandon what is false, uphold what is wrong, seek what is beautiful and wholesome and
avoid what is indicent.To him, simplicity and compassion are his trademarks, while he keeps away
from arrogance and pride. A man once asked the prophet (S.W.T) on virtues and he replied.

“Ask your heart. Virtue is that which satisfies the soul and comforts the heart, And sin (evil), is that which perturbs the soul and troubles the heart even if people should pronounce it lawful.”(Ahmed &Dearani)

 

Islamic morality (Akhlaaq is divided into two dimensions

(a)       Maarofoat (The Virtues )

(b)      Munkaraat (The vices )

  1. a) Maaroofaat [the virtues]

These are deeds or practices which are permitted in Islam.They couldbe in the form of actions

gestures  or  statement.  A  Muslims  is  encouraged  to  acquire  these  virtues.  The  Holy  Prophet (P.B.U.H) said: “The most perfect amongst you in faith is the best of you in behavior.”
Examples of Maarufat

(i)                                   Visiting the sick and escorting the deceased to the grave.

(ii)                                  Feeding the poor.

(iii)                                 Honoring the aged.

(iv)                                 Trustworthiness: Muslims have to be people who keep their words in any promise,

contracts among others.

(v)                                  Having contentment [Qanaa]or satisfaction with whatever Allah[sw] has decreed for

him/her.

(vi)                                 Self control

(vii)                                Contentment

(viii)  Patience

 

| P a g e 78

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(ix)                                 Trust in responsibility

(x)                                  Truthfulness

Mention other things that are classified as maarufat.

 

b)Munkaraat [the vices]

These are all kinds of bad practices or deeds that are prohibited in Islam. These vices can be in the form of actions gestures or statements. Allah (S.W.T) has prohibited all forms of Munkaraat whether practiced in the open or in secrecy.

Allah (S.W.T) says: “Say: The things that May Lord has indeed forbidden are: Shameful deeds

,whether open or secret; sins and trespasses against truth or reason; assigning of partners to Allah, for which He Has given no authority and saying things about Allah of which you have no knowledge.”[Q: 7:33]

 

 

 

Examples of Munkaraat

(i)                                   Arrogance and pride.

(ii)                                  Slander and gossips.

(iii)                                 Telling lies.

(iv)                                 Calling one another by offensive nicknames.

(v)                                  Dissatisfaction and lack of contentment.

(vi)                                 Looking down upon others because, class or wealth, race etc.

(vii)                                Wishful thinking.

(viii)  Drug and substance abuse.

(ix)                                 Gambling and games of chances.

(x)                                  All forms of sexual perversions.

 

Significance of Islamic morality

Islamic morality is intended to build in a Muslim a sound mind, peaceful soul and a strong personality.

  Islamic morality is meant to build in the human being a sound mind and body and a
peaceful soul.

  It makes a Muslim have a distinctive Islamic personality when interacting with others.   Islamic moral values are meant to cultivate in a Muslim the best character in the most
whole some manner.

 

| P a g e 79

 

 

 

 

 

 

  It strengthensthe bonds between human beings and Allah thus developing a strong taqwa.   Islamic morality guards the Muslims external behaviors and his manifest deeds to be in
line with Allah (S.W.T) the teachings of Islam.

  It shields a Muslims from evil since it guards his external behavior and his manifest
deeds to be in line with Allah(S.W.T)

  It  promotes  positive  thinking  by  guiding  individual  Muslims  to  be  occupied  with
constructive ideas and serious pursuits of how to lead a positive life on this earth and the
hereafter.

  It discourages a Muslimfrom practicing prohibitions such as use of intoxicants.

  The Munkaraat have been prohibited by Allah (S.W.T) for the spiritual and mental well
being of man as well as for the moral and material benefit of humanity.
  It promotes peace and harmony in the society in that the prohibitions discourage vices.   It generates affection and respect between the members of the family and the society in
general hence promoting brotherhood.

  Allah has promised rewards for those who abide by the Islamic morals and avoid evils
deeds.

 

 

Amr bil Ma’ruf Wa Nahyi Anil Munkar. (Enjoining good and forbidding evil)

 

Allah                         (S.W.T)  commanded  Muslims  to  always  enjoin  good  and  forbid   evil  in  the
society.Commanding of good should start with self-restrain. This means avoidance of those acts
which displease Allah.Beinga practical religion, Islam teaches the Muslimsto strive to follow the religious teachings and abide by its code of conduct and ethics.

 

Allah says, “Let there arise in you a band of people inviting to all that is good,enjoining what is right and forbidding what is wrong:They arethe ones to attain felicity.”[Q: 3:104]

The prophet (P.B.U.H) also emphasize on the importance of morals in a hadith reported by Abu Sa’id Al-Khudri who says that the messenger of Allah says, “He of you who sees an abomination should change it with his hand; if he could not, then with his tongue; if he could not, then in his heart; and this is the faintest in faith.” (Muslim)

 

 

 

 

| P a g e 81

 

 

 

 

 

Islam is a complete way of life and a very practical religion.Even though it isenshrined in laws, beliefs and practices, morals form the basis of each and every act of Ibada’. For exampleIslam prohibits the use of intoxicants as they interfere with normal functioning of the body and mind hence one cannot attend to his religious duties.

 

It isalso very important to keep off evil so that we can preserve the purity of the soul and have it more concentrated on performing ibadah.Muslims should keep reminding each other of the good things expected from them and talk about the evil things and howthey can avoid them.And Allah tells us in the Quran, “And remind, for indeed, the reminder benefits the believers.”

 

What benefits do you get as a Muslim when you practice and remind each other of good deeds?

On the other hand,the soul of the human being is very subtle to temptations which arise from weaknesses to remain firm and steadfast in the path of Allah.The environment we stay in may also affect our morals and divert us from the good path.If for example you walk with friends who smoke,you need a very strong conviction and Iman(faith)so that you are not tempted to smoke.But in as  much as  you may not  be smoking,it  is  your religious  duty to  command good and forbid evil.Therefore you should remind your friend of the evils of smoking.

 

There are various ways in which a Muslim can command well and shun evil. Examples of such ways are; observing the five daily prayers, fasting during the month of Ramadhan, speaking the truth, visiting the sick, giving out charity,advising those doing the wrong among others.
Would you wish to be among the successful on the Day of Judgment? What are the things you need to in order to attain this success?

 

 

 

 

 

 

Morality based on iman and swalihat

The good morals of anybody are shaped by the faith that he possesses and the dutifulness towards his creator. Surat ul Asr supports that:

 

 

 

 

| P a g e 81

 

 

 

 

 

“I swear by the time (Asr) surely man is in great loss, save those who believe and perform good
deeds and exhort each other on truth and exhort each other to endurance[Q:103:1-3].
Iman thus takes the first preference before good deeds. Good deeds that are not accompanied with
Iman are known to have no reward before Allah. Consider those who do good things just to be seen
and praised, the corrupt people who do good things in exchange of various favors not to mention the
philanthropists who give a lot of wealth for pleasure without bringing the intention of doing it for the
sake of Allah. Such deeds usually may lead to actions that are forbidden according to the doctrine of
Islam.

Obedience of Allah’s commandments leads to righteous deeds in that in order for you to perform them,  you  should  first  fear  Allah.  Iman  and  Swalihat  cannot  be  separated  because  they  are interdependent in their functioning. Therefore in Islam, faith and good deeds go hand in hand.
Abu Said Al-Khudri (R.A) narrates that he heard the prophet (P.B.U.H) says: Whenever anyone of sees anything contrary to Allah’s approval, he should change it with his hand, or if he cannot, then by his tongue, if he cannot, then by his heart and that is the weakest faith.”

 

 

Suggested revision Questions and class activities.

Answer the following questions in your I.R.E revision exercise books.

  1. Explain the basic principles of Islamic morality.
  2. Discuss the significance of commanding good and forbidding evil. Activity

Identify the common vices you see being practiced in your neighbourhood.Suggest ways of stopping them.

 

 

 

 

 

CHAPTER 6

MUAMALAT
The family

Every living creation of Allah (S.W.T) belongs to a specific family. The idea of a family can be well
understood if we bear in mind our surrounding environment. Let us take an example of a busy city
during the day. Busy with men,women and children, moving all over.Inthe evening, during the rush
hours, you will see everyone getting into a matatu and the streets will remain empty. Where do all

 

| P a g e 82

 

 

 

 

 

these people go to? Ask yourself why they can’t remain in the streets until the next day. They must go and look for shelter, company, a good meal among other needs which are provided for within this social institution we call a family.

 

We now have an idea idea about what a family is. Can youmention the people who constitute a family?A family according to Islam isasocial institutionwhereby members are united by the same ethical values hence have responsibilities over one another.This bond starts right from marriage and includes but not limited to all the relations from either sides of the married couples. Are there any other people who may not be staying with you but are part of your family? In Islam the concept of a family stretches  far  beyond  the  father,  mother  and  children.The  following  three  factors  keep peopletogether and united in an Islamic society:

Ø Kingship and blood ties-it involves the father /mother- child relations, brother-sister among
others these are the strongest natural ties. It determines how members relatewith one another
thus  controlling their behavior.  It  binds  together the family and  assists  people  to  live
peacefully.

Ø Marital commitment-It includes husband-wife relations,the in-laws of either side. This helps
to keep the family together in that each member has defined roles to play.
Ø Faith-It is the main binding factor which enhances the achievement of family goals and
interests. It goes beyond the close relatives to include all the Muslims who are brothers and
sisters. We should therefore be ready to accommodate our fellow Muslims when they need
our help since they form part of the larger Muslim family.

 

 

 

 

 

Importance of the family

We have seen who comprise of a family.These entiremembers are kept together by a common goal which should be directed towards benefitting the entire society. The things done within the smaller unit of the society, which is the family, will have either direct or indirect impact to all the members of the community.Let us look at the importance of the family:

 

 

 

 

| P a g e 83

 

 

 

 

 

 

                               Provide room for procreation to enhance the widening of the larger society.Being a very
important unit of the society,procreation forms part of the responsibilities of those who get
married to ensure continuity of the lineage and general growth of the society.
 A family serves as strong founding unit or rather the first school for the children where the
values habit and rites are passed to the children, preparing them to fit in the wider society.
The children need to therefore allow their parents and other family members to give them
guidance and ask for their advice.

                               A family offers security needs and provides a sense of belonging and identity in that it bonds
an individual to a respective family giving him/her confidence.

                               A family serves as a foundation stone to the society. A family is founded through marriage
which  promotes  interfamily  alliance  through  matrimonial  relation.  It  brings  people  of
different social status and race together hence removing social prejudice in the society.
 A family acts as barometer to regulate the moral conduct of certain individuals in the society.
Thiscontributes topeace and harmonious as it provides a set of rules to be observed e.g.
marriage shields indecency.

                               A family promotes a sense of responsibility in that each member has specific roles to play in
order  to  achieve  the  goals  of  the  family for  example;  the  husband  is  responsible  for
livelihood of his family while the wife has to fulfillthe functions as motherhoodsuch as child
upbringing and household chores.

                              A family is a source of stability to the society, in thatstable families producemembers who fit

well in the wider society.

                               The family serves as a learning institution.Children brought up in family are taught Islamic
morals,  values,  norms  and  traditions  by the  parents.  The  knowledge  learnt  during  the
formative years is peculiar to the home environment. It happens that children brought up
from different environment swillend up with different moral behavior. This is due to the
socialization skills taught in individual families or the moral and traditional practices that
may be seen in the two environments.Are ther things that you learnt in your childhood and
are different from your friend’s? Mention some of them.

 

 

 

Nikah (Marriage)

 

Definition of Marriage (Nikah)

What is marriage? Nikah is an Arabic term used for marriage which means a contract. Marriage is a
mutual contract or legal union between a man and a woman, sane and mature who have expressed

| P a g e 84

 

 

 

 

 

their willingness to stay as a husband and wife in order to become a pious family and a society. The contract must be guided by the Quran and Sunnah of the prophet (P.B.U.H)

 

Marriage in Islam

Marriage is a vital part of a Muslim’s life. In fact marriage is so important in Islam that it is declared to be a half of a Muslim’s faith. As a Muslim one should live in accordance with the Islamic Jurisprudence in the way shown by the Holy Prophet Muhammad (P.B.U.H).

Allah (S.W.T) says,“Marry those among you who are single or the virtuous ones among your slaves male or female: if they are in poverty, Allah will give them means out of His grace: for Allah encompasses all, and He knows all things.”[Q: 24:32]

One can see from the above verse that the Creator of mankind has ordered us to marry.The Prophet married and also encouraged others to marry

Ibn Mas’ud (R.A) narrated that the messenger of Allah (h.B.U.H) said to us, “O young people! Whoever can marry among you should marry, for that will help him lower his gaze and protect his chastity. Whoever is not able to marry is recommended to fast and that will be his shield.” (Bukhari and Muslim)

 

Purpose of marriage

 

The basic objectives of marriage in Islam are:

To fulfill Allah’s (S.W.T) command.Marriage is a commandment from Allah (S.W.T) which must therefore be fullfilled by every Muslim who is able. It isconsidered as completing half of ones religion and we therefore earn Allah’s rewards.

 

 

Secondly, marriage secures a comfortable atmosphere for boththe husband and the wife.A Muslim
couple who follow the teachings of the Holy Quran willalways be a source of comfort for each other.
Their relationship should go beyond that of mere sexual enjoyment and should be based on a cordial
friendship accompanied by mutual understanding.The Holy Quran says: “One of His signs is that

 

| P a g e 85

 

 

 

 

 

He created for you spouses of your own species, so that you might find comfort with them. And He put mutual love and affection in your hearts. Surely in this there are lessons for the thinking people.” [Q: 30:21]

The other purpose is for procreation. Through marriage,a new generation of healthy, faithful and virtuous children isborn. The family is the school for morals.The Holy Prophet (P.BU.H) said. “As soon as a suitor, who is religious and who has manners that satisfy you comes to you asking for a matrimonial alliance, take action to join in marriage with him. If you do not do so, you will have deviated from the right path and may be faced with a great crisis.”

It ensures financial competence in the community. A Muslim man must provide means of living to his wife and children, even if the wife is wealthy or earns a salary.

The fourth reason is for companionship. Marriage provides close interaction between the man and the woman in mutual sharing of responsibilities and ideas. This relationship makes the husband and the wife to live together harmoniously. For example, in our homes our parents consult each other on matters related to our welfare like paying of our school fees, buying of our cloths among other responsibilities.

Marriage helps to safeguard one’s Iman (faith). It prevents one from committing immoral acts. Sins such as intermingling with members of the opposite sex or having sexual relations outside marriage are not acceptable in Islam because it creates immorality and immodesty.

 

It  promotes inter-family alliance. Through marriage, family ties  are strengthened between the
families of the couple who become relatives. This promotes peace, harmony and friendship in the
society.

The other purpose of marriage is to safeguard the legitimacy of children who if begotten through marriage are entitled to inheritance.

Marriage improves the couples’ social status through earning respect and dignity in the society.

Conditions and regulations of marriage

We have seen that the family begins with marriage. A marriage is valid only if the following conditions are observed:

 

| P a g e 86

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

The formula (Al-Ssigha’)

This is the formula of marriage which includes the offer (Ijab) and the acceptance (Qabul).

The offer may be presented directly or through an agent which then gives room for the acceptance.In this case,the process begins with the man’s proposal which presents his full identification and intention. On the other hand the woman has to state clearly her wishes and has the liberty to accept or decline the offer.This first stage enhances familiarization to instill confidence.

The contracting parties (al-Aqidaan)

This refers to the bride and the groom who must satisfy conditions of marriage such as:
  Be of sound mind

  Have attained maturity

  Must give their consent Abu Huraira(R.A) narrated that the prophet (S.A.W) said, “A woman
without a husband shall not be married until she gives consent,nor a virgin be married till her
consent is sought. They asked: How shall be her permission? He said, If she remains silent.”
(Agreed upon)

  They should not belong to the prohibited degrees of marriage.

Witnesses (as-shuhud)

The issue of witnesses has been given great importance in Islam and therefore the marriageshould be
contracted  before  two  male  Muslim  witnesses  whomust  be  mukhalaf (mature  and  sane).  In

addition,they must understand the language in which the marriage ceremony is being conducted. Regarding the witnesses, Ibn Abass reports that the prophet (S.A.W) said, “The fornicatresses are those who marry by themselves without witnesses.” (At-Tirmidhy)

 

 

Guardianship(Al-Wilayat)

The guardian is in charge of giving consent or permission for the marriage to proceed. Abu Musa
(R.A) narrates that the prophet said, “There is no marriage without a guardian.”  (Ahmad,At-

Tirmidhy,Abu Dawoud, Ibn Majah) The Shariah gives the father the first position as the guardian. In the case that the father is absent, then the guardianship will take the following order of merit:

o The grand father
o Full brother

 

| P a g e 87

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

o Uncle (the father’s brother)

In  case  the  guardian  declines  to  give  consent  for  a  reason  which  is  not  valid  according  to theSharia,then the Kadhi actsas the guardian.

Dowry (Al-Mahr)

Allah (S.W.T) says in the Quran, “And give the women (on marriage) their dowry as a free gift, but if they,of their own good pleasure emit any part of it to you, take it and enjoy it with right good cheer.”[Q: 1:1]

Dowry is the obligatory gift given to the woman in marriage.It can either include a service or other material things like money, property or any other assets.This can be paid either in full or partially on the day of Nikah.Thewoman is given the right to request for whatever dowry she wants. This should be done on measurable termswithout over burdening the groom.In the event where the woman asks for divorce she is obliged to return the dowry.

The following diagram respresents the components of an Islamic marriage.

 

Summary of the conditions for marriage:

 

 

Dowry (Al-

Mahr)

 

 

The contracting

parties (al-

Aqidaan)

 

Guardianship

(Al-Wilayat)

 

 

The formula

(Al-Ssigha’)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Witnesses (as-

shuud)

 

 

 

 

| P a g e 88

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

The Muslim marriage ceremony

The actual Muslim wedding is known as a nikah. It is a simple ceremony, in which the bride does
not have to be present so long as she sends two witnesses to the drawn-up agreement. Normally, the
ceremony consists of reading from the Qur’an, and the exchange of vows in front of witnesses for
both partners. No special religious official is necessary, but often the Imam is present and performs
the ceremony. He may give a short sermon. Let’s now briefly look at what should be included in
the sermon:

The Sermon

The assembly of nikah is addressed with a marriage sermon (khutba-tun-nikah) by the Muslim who is officiating the marriage. This should be done by a state appointed Muslim judge (Qad’i) who also keeps the record of the marriage contract. However any trust worthy practicing Muslim can conduct the nikah ceremony. The documents of marriage contract/certificate are filed with the mosque
(masjid) and local government for record.

The Prophet (S.A.W) made it his tradition to have marriage sermon delivered in the assembly to solemnize the marriage. The sermon invites the bride and the groom, as well as the participating guests in the assembly to a life of piety, mutual love, kindness, and social responsibility.

 

The Khutbah-tun-Nikah begins with the praise of Allah. His help and guidance is sought. The

Muslim confession of faith that ‘There is none worthy of worship except Allah and Muhammad is His servant and messenger” is declared. The three Quranic verses (Quran 4:1, 3:102, 33:70-71) and one Prophetic saying (hadith) form the main text of the marriage. This hadith is:

‘By Allah! Among all of you I am the most God-fearing, and among you all, I am the super most to save myself from the wrath of Allah, yet my state is that I observe prayer and sleep too. I observe fast and suspend observing them; I marry woman also. And he who turns away from my Sunnah has no relation with me”. (Bukhari)

 

The Muslim officiating the marriage ceremony concludes the ceremony with a supplication (Dua)

for bride, groom, their respective families, the local Muslim community, and the Muslim community at large (Ummah)

 

it is important for us to note here that marriage is considered as an act of worship (ibadah). It is therefore virtuous to conduct it in a Mosque keeping the ceremony simple. Islam advocates simplicity in ceremonies and celebrations.

 

 

 

There are certain things which are basic to all Muslim marriages. Marriages have to be declared

publicly. They should never be undertaken in secret. The publicity is usually achieved by having a

 

| P a g e 89

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

large feast, or walimah – a party specifically for the purpose of announcing publicly that the couple are married and entitled to each other. Aisha (R.A) narrated that the prophet said, “hroclaim this marriage and solemnize it in mosques and beat aafs over it.”(At-Tirmidhy-Rare Hadith)This is
usually held after the consummation of the marriage. The relatives, neighbours, and friends are
invited in order to make them aware of the marriage. Both rich and poor of the family and
community are invited to the marriage feasts. It is recommended that Muslims attend marriage
ceremonies and marriage feasts upon invitation.

Prophet Muhammad (S.A.W) said:

 

“…and he who refuses to accept an invitation to a marriage feast, verily disobeys Allah and His Prophet”. (Ahmad & Abu Dawood)

POLYGAMY

The word “holygamy” may not be a familiar one although it is the commonest type of marriage in most cultures and traditions. Polygamycomes from two Greek words, namely “poly” meaning many or more than, and “Gamy” which stands for marriage or a sexual union.Thus polygamy means marrying more than one wife.

Islam permits polygamy and it should be clearly understood that it is a Sunnah practiced by the prophet and his predecessors. This means that marriage to more than one wife is a continuation of the practice established by the previous religions.For example; prophet Yaqub had four wives, Prophet Ibrahim had two wives and Prophet Suleiman had several wives.

 

Islam polished and reformed the old practice that was there before the advent of Prophet Muhammad (P.B.U.H) that had a lot of violation brought in by pagans who had come after the previous prophets.This was done by setting up certain rules and regulations to control this important feature in the social life of Muslims.

 

Conditions for polygamy

 

It should be noted with great care that it is not compulsory that one marries more than one wife but it is permissible under very strict conditions.These conditions have been laid because of the challenges that arise in the polygamous family. What are some of the disadvantages that you may have seen in your society as a result of having more than one wife? Due to the reasons that you have mentioned, the shariah has restricted polygamy to the following conditions:-

  1. The number of wives must not exceed four at any one given time.

 

 

| P a g e 91

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  1. The husband should be equally fair to all his wives in relation to life’s daily needs such as

providing them with clothing, feeding and housing without favor or discrimination to any one of them. Also on the basis of emotional side such as spending the same number of nights with each one equally.

It should be noted that for a man to favor emotionally all of his wives is sometimes beyond the

human ability; however, one should not abuse this fact by unjustly mistreating any of the wives.

Abu Huraira (R.A) narrated that the prophet (P.B.U.H) said: “Whoever has two wives and inclines to
one of them, will come on the day of judgment with one of his sides paralyzed.”If one of you had two
wives and did not treat them equally according to others justly, he would come at the Day of
Judgment walking lamely.”(Related by Ahmad and the four Imams with a sound chain of narrators)

If this condition is not fulfilled, then polygamy is absolutely forbidden because in such a case it would bring injustice and means for misbehaving.

iii.                                  One should be in a position to fulfill the wives conjugal rights before he commits himself

to another one, because one of the main objectives of marriage is fulfillment of sexual

desires.

  1. One should be financially able to sustain and support the wives and the children because

it is the man’s responsibility to provide for the family.

Failure to observe the above conditions, a Muslim man is not encouraged to marry a second wife

because Allah (SWT) says:

 

“…And if you fear that you shall not be able to deal justly withthe orphaned girls marry other women of your choice, two, three or four, but if you fear that you shall not be able to deal justly (with them), then only one or (the slaves) that your right hand possess. That is never to prevent you from justice….”[Q: 4:3]

 

Reasons for polygamy

We have already discussed the conditions of polygamy. We shall now focus our attention on the following reasons for the institution of polygamy.

 

 

  1. If the wife is unable to bear children after years of marriage and it has been medically proven

that the wife is barren and there is nothing wrong with the husband then the husband is
permitted to marry another wife. It is howeverrecommended that the firs wife be provided for

 

| P a g e 91

 

 

 

 

 

 

by the husband and given all the rights she deserves.the first wife continues to enjoy her rights such as support and maintenance.

 

  1. The population of women is higher than that of men therefore polygamy provides an

opportunity to the otherwise would be unmarried women to get married. This safe guards the society against social evils like adultery and prostitution.

 

 

 

iii.                               If  the wife suffers from  contagious  or other  terminal  illness which prevents  her from

honoring her conjugal obligation, plurality of wives serves the purpose for the man.

 

  1. For the sake of preservation and maintenance of the Muslim society.When men die either

naturally or in a battle and widows are left behind, it becomes necessary that they should be taken care of.The sharia therefore provides room for polygamy so that they can be married and offered support and protection.

 

 

 

  1. To increase the Muslim population through pro-creation.

Anas bin Malik (R.A) narrated that the Messenger of Allah (P.B.U.H) used to command us to

get married and would very strictly prohibit us from remaining in celibacy and say, ‘Marry the woman who is child bearing and loving for I shall over all the nations by your number on the day of resurrection.” (Ahmad bin Hanbal. Ibn Hiban graded it as Sahih)

 

Marriage of Prophet Muhammad (p.b.u.h)

 

Prophet Mohammad (P.B.U.H) underwent a marriage life and it is from him that we emulate the best practices of marital life.

By the time of his death, he had nine wives, however, this should not be perceived as a violation of Allah’s (S.W.T) instructions as he was the only one who had been permitted to do so by Allah (S.W.T) due to the following reasons:-

  1. To continue with the practice that Allah had prescribed to his predecessors’ like prophets

Ibrahim, Yaqub and Suleiman (A.S)

 

 

 

| P a g e 92

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  1. To eradicate the Quraish traditionsand prejudices. That’s why the hrophet married from

different ethnic groups, clans and among the Quraish tribe.Before this, the Quraish used to see themselves as superior beings to other tribes.

 

iii.                               To establish and implement the Islamic law. Allah (S.W.T) ordered the prophet (P.B.U.H) to

marry Zainab bint Jaash who had been married by his adopted son Zayyid bin al-Harith so that He could put to an end the Arab practice of referring to adopted sons their own.

 

  1. For protection and security of the widows whose husbands had died in jihad wars. For

example his marriage to Saudah bint Zamah (widowed by Sakran bin Amro) and Zainab bint Khuzaimah(widow to Abdullah bin Jaash).

 

  1. To foster good relations between Muslims and non Muslims. For example his marriage to

Jurawrriya bint al Harith who was the daughter of a tribal chief of Banu Mustaliq clan of Arabia, Swafiyyah bint Huyay and Ummu Habibah.

 

  1. To disseminate Islamic knowledge and in particular enforce domestic laws. He married

Aisha Bint Abu Bakar (R.A.) and Ummu Salamah (R.A.) who memorized a number of hadith and used to train the other women on religious and family matters.

The prophet (P.B.U.H) married twelve wives whom the Muslims refer to us mothers of the believers

(Ummahaatul Mu’uminiin).The prophets wives have been given this honor because of the love, dedication and support they showed to the prophet (P.B.U.H)

The prophet’s Wives

1).                                      Khadija bint  Khuwaylid  – She  was  twice  widowed and  was  a  wealthy merchant  who

commanded respect, honor and dignity among the Quraish. She was the prophet’s wife for
nearly twenty  years  and  bore  him  four  girls;  Zainab,  Ruqayyah,  Ummu  Kulthum  and
Fatimah, as well as two sons; Qassim and Abdulla (both of whom passed away in infancy).

2).                                      SaudahbintZum’aa – She was a widow whose husband passed on while returning from exile

in Abyssinia (Ethiopia).

3).                             Aisha, the daughter of Abu- Bakar as- Swiddiq (R.A) – She was a scholar of hrophet’s Sunna

(Hadith) and other sciences.

4).                                      Hafswahbint Umar bin al- Khattab (R.A) – She was a widow. Her husband was martyred in

the battle of Badr. She married prophet Muhammad (P.B.U.H) in the second year of Hijra.

5).                                      ZainabBint Khuzaimah- She was known as the ‘mother of the poor’ because of her kindness

and special empathy to the underprivileged.

 

| P a g e 93

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

6).                             UmmuSalamah (Hind bint Abi Umayyah bin Mugheerah) – Her father was one of the famous

Quraish leaders. Her husband was martyred in the battle of Uhud.

7).                                      Juwairiyyah bint al-Harith:  – She was among the hostages during the battle between the

believers and Banu Mustaliq. Prophet Muhammad (P.B.U.H) married her so as to save her
from humiliation.Her name was Barrah before her marriage to the holy prophet (P.B.U.H)

8).                                      ZainabbintJa’sh – She was the daughter of the prophet’s paternal aunt and the divorced wife

of his adopted son,Zaid bin Al- Harith.

9).                                      Ummu Habibah – She was the daughter of Abu Sufyan. Her husband denounced Islam after

migration to Abyssinia. When he later died the prophet (P.B.U.H) married her to alleviate her from the problems she was facing.

10).                                    SwafiyyahbintHuyay – She was a daughter of a Jewish chief of Banu Nadhir. Her father was

one of the greatest opponents of Islam. Later their tribe was banished from Madina after the fall of Khaybar in the seventh year of Hijra. She was among the captives who converted to Islam and prophet Muhammad (P.B.U.H) married her.

11).                                    Maimunah bint al- Harith – She was the daughter of Harith of the Khawazin tribe. She was a

widow in Makkah and married the prophet (P.B.U.H) in the seventh year of Hijra. .

12).                                    Mariyya al- Qibtwiyyah – She was the last wife of the prophet (P.B.U.H). She was presented

to the prophet as a gift by the King of Egypt after the prophet had sent an invitation to Egypt and other countries to join Islam. She was the only one after Khadija to bear the prophet (P.B.U.H) a child called Ibrahim who also died in childhood.

 

 

 

Rights and duties of family members

The bond in the family involves mutual expectation of rights and duties that have been prescribed by the religion and enforced by the Islamic sharia. This implies, therefore, that every family member has certain commitments to meet over the other. The role of each member depends on their position in the family. Let us now look at the rights and duties of each family member.

 

Rights of the parents:

These are the duties which should be performed by the children towards their parents. Allah says in the Quran, “eour Lord Has decreed that:

 

 

  1. They should be treated with kindness.
  2. Children should take care of them when they get old or need their help.
  3. They should remember them in the prayers.

| P a g e 94

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  1. Do not turn away from them in case they need you.
  2. Obey them in whatever they ask you and are in accordance with the sharia.
  3. Pay their debts when they pass on.
  4. Show them a good send off when they die.
  5. Children should continue praying for their parents even after they have died.

 

Duties of the husband: Rights of the wife.

Islam honours the husband as the head of the family. Infact Allah (S.W.T) emphasizes in the holy
Quran thus; “Men are the protectors and maintainers of women because Allah has given the one
more strength than the other and because they support them from their means…”[Q: 4:34]There
are certain duties which as a husband you have to observe towards your wife. They include the
following:

 

 

  1. He should protect his wife from any social, physical or psychological harm.
  2. He should consult with his wife in kindness in matters relating to the family.
  3. He has the full responsibility of financially and materially supporting and maintaining his
    wife.
  4. He must be faithful to his wife and not keep any marital secrets from her.
  5. He should respect the feelings of his wife and treat her with love, sympathy and
    understanding.
  6. He should fulfill the wife’s matrimonial needs.
  7. He should establish a rich Islamic atmosphere in the home.
  8. He should keep the marriage life a secret.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Duties of a wife: The rights of the husband

Allah (S.W.T) says in the Qur’an: “And those who pray, ‘Our Lord! Grant unto us wives and off
springs who will be the comfort of our eyes, and give us (the grace) to lead the righteous.” [Q:
25:74]

 

 

 

| P a g e 95

 

 

 

 

 

Anas bin Malik (R.A)narrated that the prophet said, “If a woman says her prayers, fasts her month
(Ramadhan), guards her private parts and obeys her husband, she may enter paradise by any
door(gate)’. (Related by Abu Nu’aim).The wife is therefore expected perform the following duties;

 

  1. She should not observe any Sunnah fast when the husband is present except with his
    permission.
  2. She should not allow anybody in the house without his permission.
  3. She is answerable to her husband in ensuring that duties of worship are observed by all
    family members in the house.
  4. She should fulfill the conjugal rights of the husband.
  5. She should not leave the house for visiting friends and relatives without her husband’s
    permission.
  6. She should keep herself neat and clean to guard her husband from external temptations.
  7. She should not take advantage of her sexual obligation to manipulate her husband.
  8. She should not receive gifts or favors from other men without the consent of the husband.
  9. She should take care of the husband’s property.

 

 

 

Rights of the children: Duties of the parents

Just as thechildren should observe certain obligations towards their parents, so should the parents to their children. Some of these duties include the following:

 

 

  1. They should be provided with both religious and secular education.
  2. They should be given good names.
  3. The parents should provide them with the basic needs like food, shelter and
    clothing.
  4. They should be given security and protection from external danger and influence
    which may lead to misguidance or injury.
  5. They have a right to be loved and shown affection.
  6. They have a right to inherit from their parents after they have passed on.
  7. They have a right to legitimacy and know his rightful father and
    mother.

 

 

 

 

 

| P a g e 96

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Rights of extended family members

 

 

  1. They should be assisted when they are in need.
  2. Muslims should be kind and treat them with gentleness.
  3. We should protect them from external attacks.
  4. We should show them love and affection and talk to them nicely.
  5. We should freely interact with them so that they can get a sense of belonging.

 

 

 

 

Suggested study questions and activities.

 

Answer the following questions in your I.R.E revision exercise books.

  1. a) What is Nikah (Marriage) in Islam?

 

b)Explain the purpose of Marriage in Islam.

 

c)Give reasons why the family is the basic unit of the society.

  1. a) Highlight the conditions and regulations of marriage.

 

  1. b) Discuss the roles of each family member in the society.

 

 

Activity

 

Visit your local Kadhi’s office and find out how an Islamic marriage is conducted.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

| P a g e 97

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Map of Arabia before the advent of Islam

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Map of Arabia showing the major trade routes during the pre Islamic Arabia

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

| P a g e 98

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

CURRENT MAP OF ARABIA

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

| P a g e 99

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

CHAPTER 7

HISTORY OF ISLAM

PRE- ISLAMIC ARABIA

 

Pre Islamic Arabia refers to the period before the prophet started preaching Islam.This period was
characterized by acts of Jahiliya which means the age in which ignorance, barbarism,   darkness
from aod’s guidance were witnessed in the Arabian peninsula before the introduction of Islam.
The lives of the Arabs can be discussed in the following areas: Religious, social/moral, economic
and political.

 

 

 

1.Religious Conditions

The following religious groups and worship practices prevailed in Arabia during the pre-Islamic era;

  1. Idolatry (Idol worship)Most of the Arabs were idolatrous.They used to curve idols
    from wood and stone which they used to worship. Each clan had its own idols to
    worship. They offered sacrifices to them and sought their blessings and guidance.
    There were  360 idols in Makkah alone. The leading idols were Al  -Lata, Uzza,
    Manata and Hubbal.
  2. Christians. These were the followers of Prophet Issa (A.S) and had settled at Najran
    and followed the teachings of the Injil.
  3. Magians. These  were  the  people  who  worshipped  fire.  These  fire  worshippers
    originated from Persia.
  4. Hanifs or Hunafaa. These were the followers of prophet Ibrahim (A.S). These people
    worshiped and believed in one God as they embraced the teachings of prophet
    Ibrahim and Ismail. Most of them accepted Islam when the prophet started peaching.
  5. Jews who practiced Judaism. These were the followers of prophet Musa (A.S) and
    were the descendants of Israel (Banu Israil). They followed the teachings of the book
    of Taurat which was revealed to prophet Musa (A.S)They mostly dwelt in Yathrib
    and Khaybar.

 

 

| P a g e 111

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2.Social and moral conditions.

During pre-Islamic Arabia, the following social conditions were evident:

  1. The Arabs  engaged  in  leisure  activities  such  as  drinking,  intoxication  and
    gambling.These activities were done mostly during social gatherings.
  2. Women were denied their rights such as inheritance from their parents and
    husbands but instead were inherited as property and when a man died his son
    would inherit all his wives except his own mother.
  3. Women were denied the right to life since baby girls were buried alive because
    they were considered as weak and could not beable to defend their community
    from external aggression.
  4. The women  were  also  forced  into  sexual  pervasions  like  prostitution  and
    subjected to  rape.  They were also  forced to  marry more than one  husband
    (polyandry).
  5. Women were taken as articles of trade as they could be sold and be exchanged
    with goods or merchandise in the market.
  6. The art of poetry was highly cherished by the Arabs. They organized poetry
    competitions in open places where poems with vulgar language were recited.
  7. The Arabs practiced polygamy without any limits and they would marry and
    divorce women at will.

 

  1. Economic conditions

 

  1. a) They practiced Agriculture near the oasis where they used irrigation. This was done in

areas ofYathrib, Taif and Southern parts of Arabia.

  1. b) Makkah had many historical sites which included the Kaaba. People from

several parts of the world toured those sites making the Arabs earn profit.

  1. c) Nomadism: During this period the Arabs lived a nomadic life and wandered in the desert

with their animals in search of water and pasture. Most of them kept sheep, camels and goats as there source of livelihood.

  1. d) Barter trade. Those who settled in the town(town dwellers) practiced barter trade. They

used to exchange goods and commodities.

 

  1. Political Conditions

 

 

 

| P a g e 111

 

 

 

 

 

Arabia did not have a centralized government.There was a chieftainship political system where each
tribe was led by a tribal chief. The tribal chief was appointed on the basis of merit while age was
consideredas one of the important factors. This was because the Arabs associated old age with
wisdom and experience.The Bedouins who were in the desert led and independent life under tribal
leaders.Tribal clashes were very common among the Arabs of that time. Most of the conflicts were
as a result of revenge missions. In some of the parts, there were Kings who ruled their subjects.

 

 

 

Life history of Prophet Mohammad

 

 

FAMILY TREE OF THE PROPHET

 

 

QURAISH

 

 

 

 

QUSWAYY

 

 

 

 

 

ABD MANAF

 

 

 

HASHIM

 

 

 

ABDUL MUTWALIB (SHAYBA)

 

 

HAMZA ABU TWALIB                                                                                ABDULLAH           ABBAS            (AMIR) ABU LAHAB

(+ AMINA)

 

 

 

 

 

 

| P a g e 112

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

ALI                                                                                                                                    MUHAMMAD

+ FATMA                                                                                                                        (+KHADIJA)

 

 

 

 

HASSAN                                                    HUSSEIN    FATIMA UMM KULTHUM RUQAYYA ZAINAB ABDULLAH QASIM

 

 

 

 

It is important to note that apart from Khadija, the prophet married other wives as we have seen in the previous chapter. Among them Marria al Qibtiyya bore him a son by the name Ibrahim who died at infancy.

 

The Year of the Elephant

The coming of the settler to Kenya and other parts of East Africa brought several changes to the
country. Some of which were adopted while others were unfriendly to the natives who reacted to
them leading to the struggle for independence. The country wanted to govern itself and control its
resources without any intterferance from the forign contries like Britain.It so happened that in the
year the prophet was born, Makka had been known as a center for pilgrimage in the entire Arabian
peninsular. The city was therefore growing rapidly which caused the neighbouring territories to start
envying it.

The Ethiopian governor of Yemen, Abraha al-Ashram was among those who envied the fameof the Ka’aba among the Arabs. He thereforeconstructed a big cathedral in Sanaa (the capital of eemen) and ordered the Arabs to go there for pilgrimage instead. The order was ignored and this angered Abrahawho in fury decided to demolish the Ka’aba. He set off with a large army of 60,000 soldiers and 13 elephants towards Makka.

He was riding on a huge elephant. It was an animal which the Arabs had not seen before, thus the year came to be known as ‘Amul-Fil (the year of the elephant), and it started an era for reckoning the years in Arabia.

 

 

| P a g e 113

 

 

 

 

 

When news of the advance of Abraha’s army reached Makka, the people of Makka were frightened by the large well, equipped army and of course the elephants which they had never seen before.

Abraha sent a message toBanu Hashim who were the custodians of the Kaaba at that time led by Abdul Mutwalib and advised them to demolish the Kaaba or he would destroy the whole city. ‘Abdul-Muttalib replied to this ultimatum in these words: “By Allah, we do not want to fight him. So far as this House (the Ka’bah) is concerned, it is the House of Allah; if Allah wants to save His House, He will save it, and if He leaves it unprotected, no one can save it.”

On the second day, Abraha ordered his army to enter the Holy city of Makka and destroy the Kaaba.
‘Abdul-Muttalib told the Makkans to leave the city and to seek refuge in the surrounding hills.But
he, together with some leading members of Quraish, remained within the precincts of the Ka’bah.

Abraha advanced with his army. Seeing the walls of the Ka’bah, he ordered its demolition. No
sooner had the army reached near the Ka’bah than a dark cloud of small birds (known in Arabic as
Ababil) overshadowed the entire army of Abraha. Each bird had three pebbles: two in its claws and
one in its beak. A rain of the pebbles poured down from the birds, and in a few minutes, the whole
army was destroyed. Abraha himself was seriously wounded; he fled towards Yemen but died on the
way.

Allah (S.W.T)explains this event in the following chapter of the Quran:

 

Have you not seen how your Lord dealt with the companions of the Elephant? Did He not make their treacherous plan go astray? And He sent against them birds in flocks, striking them with stones of baked clay, so He rendered them like straw eaten up. [Qu’ran, 105]

 

 

 

Birth and early life of the prophet

Prophet Muhammad (P.B.U.H) was born on 12th of Rabiul-Awwal/22nd April 570 CE in Makkah in
the year of elephant.He belonged to the Banu Hashim clan of the Quraish tribe. Abdul Mutalib,
hisgrandfather   was   the   chief   of   Makkah   at   that   time.He   had   five   sons:Hamza,Abu
Talib,Abdullah,Abbas and Abu Lahab.The prophet’s father was Abdullah Ibn Abdul Mutalib.He
died a few days before the prophet’s birth in eathrib while he was coming from a business journey
in Syria. His mother was called Amina binti Wahab of the Banu Zuhras clan of Madina.She died on

 

| P a g e 114

 

 

 

 

 

the return journey from Madina where they had gone to visit the grave of the prophet’s father at a
place called ‘Abwa’ when he was six years old. After a few months, according to the age-long
custom of the Arabs, the child was entrusted to a Bedouin woman Halima Bint Dhuib by name, of
the tribe of Bani-Sa’d, for his upbringing. It was the practice of the Arabs to send their children to the
country-side so that they would grow up strong, healthy and learn the refined language of the
Bedouin. He lived with the Banu Sa’d clan for four years before his mother took him back under her
care.

After the death of his mother, he was raised by his paternal grandfather ‘Abdul Muttalib who was 80
years of age. ‘Abdul-Muttalib died two years later at the age of 82, leaving the care and custody of
the orphaned Muhammad (P.B.U.H) to Abu Talib his uncle who showed him affection even more
than his own children. He always kept the child in his company and travelled with him through the
caravan routes to Syria and Egypt in the north and northwest and Yemen in the south. It was during
one of this trade journeys that a Christian monk by the name Bahira noticed an applelike seal of
prophet hood below the shoulder of Muhammad (P.B.U.H). He advised his uncle to take great care
of the young Muhammad who was only twelve years and take him back to Makkah.

As a young boy he looked after his uncle’s herds and he was also fond of sitting in the circles of the elders to gain wisdom unlike other youths who indulged in social evils. Muhammad was popularly known as ‘al-Ameen’ for his unimpeachable character by the Makkans and visitors alike. The title Al-Ameen means the Honest, the Reliable and the Trustworthy, and it signified the highest standard of moral and public life.

 

Marriage to lady khadija

Upon hearing of Muhammad’s good character, Khadija Bint Khuwaylid, a rich merchant widow,
asked Muhammad (P.B.U.H) to take some merchandise for trade to Syria. It is written that in the
trade caravans, her merchandise usually equaled that of the whole tribe put together.
She was the daughter of Khuwaylid ibn Asad ibn ‘Abdul-‘Uzza ibn Qusayi. Soon after this trip
Khadija  realized  that  Muhammad  had  brought  more  profits  than  she  had  been  getting
previously.Muhammad was twenty-five when Khadija proposed marriage to him through her friend
Nafisa who immediately went to inform him. He accepted the proposal and requested his uncle to
discuss the matter with Khadija’s uncle Umar ibn Asad. At that time, Khadija was twice widowed
and forty years old. Theygot six children; four daughters and two sons. His first son Qassim died at

 

| P a g e 115

 

 

 

 

 

the age of two. His second son Abdullah died in infancy. The four daughters were:  Zainab, Ruqayyah, Umm Kulthum, and Fatimah (R.A)

 

 

 

Baath and first revelation

The hrophet’s life attracted everybody’s respect andhonor. He won the confidence of Khadija, his wife, as well as other people in Makka from his positive character. For the next fifteen years, he dedicated his life to meditation and worship contrary to the norms of social evils practiced at that time. Unknowingly, he was protected by Allah (S.W.T) from the evils that prevailed and occupied the culture of the people.

He used to go to the cave Hira at Jabal Nur (Mt. Nur) in the outskirts of Makka. In this place, he would pray to Allah (S.W.T) for deliverance from the dirty practices that were common and the darkness of worshipping idols. Every aspect of creation gave him the hope of a way of life that would exclude him from the immoral practices. He would stay there for a number of days before going home. This practice continued and became part of his programme.

One night during the month of Ramadhan, at the age of forty, while in the cave, Jibril (S.A) came in human form and told him, “I am Jibril, and you are Allah’s messenger …” Then he told the hrophet, “Read!”The prophet answered him, “I cannot read,” Jibril squeezed him hard and repeated the same words while the prophet gave the same answer. On the third time the prophet asked, “What shall I read?” Jibril told him:

“Read in the name of your lord who created
Who created man from a clot.

Read:Andthe Lord is the most Bounteous,
Who teaches by the pen,

Teaches man that which he knew not… [Q: 96:1-5]

Muhammad  repeated  the  words  until  they  permanently  stuck  in  his  memory  before  the disappearance of Jibril  (A.S). These verses marked the first revelation of the Quran that would continue for the next twenty three years of his life.

After the sudden disappearance of Jibril (A.S), he could still re-visualize him and could recall the
words. A mixture of fear and shock had engulfed him. He could not stay in the cave, so he went back
home while still having this vision his mind. At home he related what had happened to Khadija. She

 

| P a g e 116

 

 

 

 

 

had a strong belief that her husband could neither be injured nor harmed by evils and spirits because
of the record of virtues that he practiced. He was quite depressed by the occasion. More often he
would see Jibril in his vision wherever he was and he would tell Khadija, “dathiruni i.e. cover me
up.”

There was a duration in which the revelation paused after the first verses of Surat ul Alaq this period is known as Fatra, but still the prophet would see the vision of Jibril (A.S) and say, “dathiruni i.e. cover me up.” After a while Jibril appeared again, and this time with the first seven verses of Surat ul Mudathir:

 

“O you wrapped up (in a mantle).

Stand and warn (the people) Arise and deliver thy warning! And thy Lord do you magnify!

And thy garments keep free from stain!
And all abomination shun!

But for thy Lord’s (cause) be patient and constant…” [Q: 74:1-7]

 

This was an indicator of a turning point to the life of Prophet Muhammad  (P.B.U.H) from an
ordinarily  viewed  Muhammad  of  theBanu  Hashim  clan,  to  a  globally  esteemed  and  divinely
distinguished role model in the service of Allah (S.W.T). Unlike the other men of Makka, he had
been anointed as the last messenger of Allah (S.W.T.), an opportunity that never before or after
would be shared with, or seized by any other creature. He had received the honor of undertaking the
divine responsibility of leading others in the worship of Allah  (S.W.T). He had a mission of
delivering the rest of mankind from idolatry and directing them towards the worship of Allah
(S.W.T). The shape of the moral pattern of life lay in his effort as per the will of Allah (S.W.T). It
was inclusions of his name into the chain of prophets of Allah (S.W.T), and above that a seal of that
chain of Prophet Hood. Above all, he had been bestowed with the great honor of receiving the
Quran, which is the seal of the divine books of Allah (S.W.T), for the guidance of mankind and a
testimony to all creatures.

 

Early Muslim community

After receiving Wahyi, the prophet’s mission was to preach Islam to the entire Ummah. It was his
obligation to preach the oneness of Allah to the Quraish who were worshipping Idols and offering

 

| P a g e 117

 

 

 

 

 

sacrifices to them. Most of the people were unbelievers and practiced polytheism. The prophet started preaching in secret and mostly to his family members and close friends.
He managed to get a few followers who accepted to convert to Islam. Among the very first people to convert came from his family household.These included Khadija Binti Khuwaylid (hrophet’s first wife), his cousin Ali bin Abi Talib (RA),and Abubakar Assidiq(R.A), the prophets dearest friend and Zaid bin Harith (R.A), his adopted son.

Several other people in  Makka embraced  Islam and strengthened the religion making  it  gain popularity. The first early converts included among others; Uthman Bin Affan, Saad Bin Abi Waqas, Zubeir Bin Awwam, Talha Bin Ubaidullah, Abdurrahman Bin Auf and Az-Zuhri. After three years of preaching the religion in secrecy nearly forty people had converted to Islam and accepted to follow the Islamic teachings. Allah (S.W.T) commanded the prophet (P.B.U.H) to preach to the people openly and warn them against polytheism.

Almighty Allah (S.W.T) says, “Therefore expound openly what you are commanded, and turn away from those who join false gods with Allah.” [Q: 15:94]

After the prophet was commanded to preach openly, he gathered the Makkanpeople at MountSafa
and addressed them on the Oneness of Allah(S.W.T). The hrophet thus said, “eou see if I were to
tell you that there were some horse men in the valley planning to raid you, will you believe me?”
They said: “ees, we have only witnessed the truth from you.” He said, “I am a Warner to you before
a severe torment.”Although the people had known the prophet as avery honest person, they refused
to accept him as a prophet. His own uncle called Abu Lahab cursed the prophet by telling him, “May
you Perish this day. Have you called us here for such a thing (believing in one God) that you made
us to gather here?” Allah was angered by Abu Lahab’s remarks on the hrophet (h.B.U.H) and a
Surah was revealed called Suratul- Lahab. In this surah, Allah the Almighty condemned Abu Lahab
together with his wife.

Allah says in the Quran,

“Perish the hands of the father of flame! Perish he!
No profit to him from his wealth, and all his gains!
Burnt soon will he be in a fire of blazing flame!
His wife shall carry the (cracking) wood as fuel!

A twisted rope of palm leaf fibre round her (own) neck!”[Q: 111]

 

| P a g e 118

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Persecution

 

What do you understand by the word persecution? In your live experience,have you undergone any
hardships? Mention a few of these situations to your friend. Persecution refers to the subjection of
pain to an individual or group of people in order to discourage them from carrying out their
endeavors.

The Quraish were not pleased to see that several people were embracing Islam. They held meetings to plan how they would stop the prophet and his companions from preaching and practicing Islam. Under the leadership of Abu Lahab, the prophet’s own uncle, plans were put in place to stop the spread of Islam. The new and weak converts were to be subjected to intimidation, threats and physical torture. Several other methods were used to punish and discourage the Prophet of Allah and his companions for accepting Islam as the true and only religion.

 

 

 

 

 

 

Methods of persecution

 

Each of the leaders among the Quraish began persecuting any one in their clan who was following Islam.They used various methods among them were the following:

 

Ø The prophet and the early Muslims were pelted with stones as they walked in the
streets of Makka.

Ø Abu Lahab forced his two sons who had married Ruqayyah and UmmuKulthum
(daughters of the prophet) to divorce them.

Ø UmmuJamil Bint Harb, who was Abu Suffiyyan’s sister and the wife of Abu

Lahab,used to tie bundles of thorns with ropes and place them on the prophet’s path.
Ø The Makkan’s used to rebuke the Muslims and abuse them whenever they saw them.
Ø UmmulJamil recited the follwing words of disrespect;” We have disobeyed the

dispraised one, rejected his call and alienated ourselves from his religion.”

Ø Uqbah bin AbiMu’ait put the intenstines of the camel on the shoulders of the prophet
while he was in Swalat.

 

| P a g e 119

 

 

 

 

 

 

Ø Walid ibn Mughira would speak ill about the prophet’scharacter Allah (S.W.T) says,
“Heed not the type of despicable man,ready with oaths, a slanderer going about
with   calumnies, (habitually)   hindering (all)   good,transgressing   beyond

bounds,deep in sin.” [Q:68:10 – 12]

Ø The Quraish barred the prophet and the Muslims from offering prayers in the public
and in the Kaaba.

Ø Some companions of the prophet like Bilal bin Rabah and Ammar bin Yassir were
tied on donkeys and dragged through the town in the scorching sand.
Ø In other cases, iron armors were put on the companions who would then be left in the
hot sun to fry.This happened to Bilal bin Rabah.

Ø Female slaves like An-Nahdiyah and Zanirah were mistreated by their masters and
denied food for embracing Islam until Abubakar paid for their freedom.
Ø Khabbab bin Al-Arath, who was a slave would be dragged by her hair, and her neck
was twisted then she was thrown into the fire until her back was burnt.
Ø Muslims were also killed cruelly. Summaiya was bayoneted with a red hot iron by
Abu Jahal until she died.

Ø Ammar and his parents were forced to repeatedly lie on burning sand as they were
severely beaten.

Ø Bilal bin Rabah was severely beaten by his master Umayyah bin Khalaf. He would be
dragged through the streets on bear chest.A heavy stone was placed on his chest to
force him to denounce Islam.

Ø Uthman bin Affan used to be wrapped in a mat of palm leaves then fire would be set
under him.

Ø Mus’ab bin Umair was denied food and water by her mother and when she saw that
he was not ready to denounce Islam, she expelled him from her house.

 

 

 

Migration to Abyssinia (615 C.E)

Abyssinia is the current Ethiopia. Islam was getting many converts day by day despite the torture they got from the Quraish. When the persecutions became unbearable to the newly converted Muslims, the prophet (P.B.U.H) advised them to migrate to Abyssinia. It was a Christian King called Negus(Najash Ash-ham) who was known for his tolerance and knowledge about religious issues and was very hospitable.

 

 

 

 

| P a g e 111

 

 

 

 

 

Abyssinia was a peaceful country and far away from Makkah. This would help the Muslims to settle down and continue with their new faith. Fourteen men and one woman sneaked through the rough desert and fled to Abyssinia. Each day the number of the asylums gradually increased. The prophet (P.B.U.H) was left behind to continue with the propagation of Islam. The Makkans were infuriated by the news of the Muslim’s migration to Abyssinia. They sent delegations to the court of King Negus to ask him to hand the Muslims back to them. This was in the year 615 C.E. King Negus was a good listener, wise and just. He listened to both parties and disapproved the Quraish allegations against the Muslims and gave the Muslims freedom of staying in Abyssinia for as long as they would not interfere with the peace.

 

 

 

 

 

 

Results of the Muslims migration to Abyssinia

We have seen that after several persecutions, the prophet advised the Muslims to migrate. This migration was a sigh of relief for them and the following were the results:

  1. Muslims lived peacefully in Abyssinia.
  2. There was intermarriage between the Abyssinians and the Muslims.
  3. Many Abyssinians converted to Islam at that time.
  4. Trade flourished in Abyssinia.
  5. Muslims were able to practice their faith freely and peacefully.
  6. The disappointed Quraish decided to look to intensify their persecutions against the prophet
    and the Muslims who had been left in Makkah.

 

Boycott of the Banu Hashim (617-620 C.E)

The pagans were not happy to see theBanu Hashim protecting the Prophet. In their struggle to get rid
of  the  prophet  they  met  at  a  place  called  Wa’di-l  Muhassab,  an  oath  was  taken  and  an
agreementwritten by Bagheed bin Amir bin Hashim was signed. It contained the following rules:

Ø The other Arab tribes should not conduct any business dealings with the Banu Hashim. Ø No inter-marriage was to take place between them and any other tribe.
Ø There should be neither social relations norinteractions like visiting them.
Ø There should be no communication whatsoever.

Ø The Banu Hashim should not enter the Kaaba.

 

| P a g e 111

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Ø Food and water supply was not allowed to reach them.

 

This boycott took place between 617-620 C.E and the Banu Hashim and the sympathizers of the prophet were confined in a mountainous valley known as Shi’b Abu Talib which was hostile for human habitation. This lasted for a period of three years. The agreement and was attached at the Ka’aba. The prophet cursed him and his hand got paralyzed

As time went by, the Makkans developed mixed feelings and some started sympathizing with their expelled kinsmen.A special group was formed to campaign for abolishing the agreement.Abu Jahal was consulted several times but he refused.After a hot argument, it was discovered that the whole piece of paper on which the agreement had been written had been eaten by ants.The boycott was therefore lifted and the Muslims were allowed to come back to Makka.

 

Circumstances that led to the Boycott of the Banu Hashim

  1. Failure of the Makkans to convince the newly converted Muslims to go back to their
    traditional religion.
  2. Failure by the Makkans to bring back the Muslims from Abyssinia.
  3. Islam was against the Makkans religion.
  4. Makkans were alarmed by the increasing number of Muslims.
  5. The Makkans failure to stop the prophet from preaching Islam.
  6. Failure of the Makkans to persuade Abu Twalib, whohad persistently promised to protect the
    prophet, to stop his nephew from preaching Islam.
  7. The Makkans were alarmed by the conversion of Umar bin Khattab to Islam.
  8. Islam was rapidly spreading beyond Makka e.g. Abyssinia.

 

 

 

 

Effects of Boycott of the Banu Hashim

 

 

  1. It resulted in the death of Khadija and Abu Twalib (the strong pillars of the prophet

P.B.U.H).

  1. Spread of Islam came to a standstill for sometime in Makka.
  2. The Muslims suffered economic hardships.
  3. It inflicted mental torture to the prophet and the Muslims werepsychologically affected.

| P a g e 112

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  1. The Muslims became weak due to hunger and starvation.
  2. Others became seriously sick while others died.
  3. The attention of the prophet was diverted from preaching to attending to the welfare of the
    Muslims.
  4. It restricted the prophet’s audience to outsiders since they would not move outside the cave.
  5. It strengthened the prophet’s determination to continue with his mission.

 

 

 

 

 

 

The Year of Sorrow (A’m-ul Huzn)

How do you morn a berievement or a loss? It may be loss of money or any other important item in life. It is normal for any human being to feel a sense of lose once someone close to him or her dies. This was no exception for the prophet when helost two pillars of support; that is, his dear wife, Khadija who gave him financial and moral support, and his uncle Abu Twalib who always protected him from the malice of the Quraish. The prophet as a human being was bereaved, depressed and tensed. Therefore Allah (S.W.T) granted him a miraculous journey to uplift his spirit towards Islam. We shall now look at the miraculous journey also known as Isra wal Mi’raaj.

 

Israai wal mi’raaj (620 C.E)

This episode is in two parts starting with the Israai. This term literally means a night journey.It is the famous miraculous night journey embarked by the prophet (P.B.U.H) escorted by Angel Jibril (A.S) from Makkah to Jerusalem in Masjidul Maqdas. Allah (S.W.T) says:-

“Glorified  be  He  who  carried  His  servant  by  night  from  the  inviolable  place  of  worship
(Makkah)to the far distant place of worship (Jerusalem) the neighborhood where of we have
blessed that we might show him of our tokens! Lo! He only He is the hearer, the seer.”[Q: 17:1]

 

The second part which is Miiraaj literally means a ladder.This is the ascension of the prophet (P.B.U.H) from Jerusalem (BaitulMaqdis) through the space to the seventh heaven during. This remarkable journey took place in the year 620 C.E

 

 

 

Reasons for Israai wal Mi’raaj

| P a g e 113

 

 

 

 

 

 

Ø Allah wanted to console the Prophet (P.B.U.H) from the hardships he had been experiencing
from the Quraish in terms of persecutions.

Ø Allah (S.W.T) wanted to give the prophet (P.B.U.H) an opportunity to experience His great
power and Might so as to fill his heart with full confidence, belief, faith and reliance on Him.
Ø To prepare the prophet  (P.B.U.H) for the great mission that was ahead of him such as

migration (Hijra) and the everlasting confrontation with polytheism (Kufr).

Ø To give the believers hope and courage to look forward tobetter days ahead from their noble
religion of Islam.

 

Significance of Israai wal Mi’raaj

Ø It  signified  that  prophet  Muhammad                                (P.B.U.H)  was  the  leader  of  the  two  Qiblasi.e.

BaitulMaqdis and Masjidul Haraam in Makkah.

Ø It showed that prophet Muhammad (P.B.U.H) was a true successor of the messengers before
him.

Ø Prophet Muhammad  (P.B.U.H) was declared as the leader  (Imam for the generations to
come).

Ø It pre-ordained that Islamic religion was to stay up to the end of time (Yaum-ul-mahshar). Ø It clearly indicated the finality of prophet Muhammad (P.B.U.H)

Ø It distinguished between the true believers and false ones. Some Muslims denounced Islam
after the episode of Israai & Miiraaj when Abu Jahal doubted about the journey, the prophet
(P.B.U.H) confronted them in the morning with facts about his whole journey.
Ø It clearly strengthened the faith of Abu Bakr who was the first to believe in the prophet when
he came back.

Ø It signified the position and the status of Majid Aqswaa to Muslims and as the gateway to
Majid Haraam.

Ø It shows the prominence of Swalat and its position in a Muslims life. It was in the journey of
Miiraaj that the prophet was given the five daily prayers.

Ø The  journey  highlighted  the  penalties  for  certain  social  evils  in  the  society  such  as
backbiting, fornication (Zinaa), denying orphans their wealth, those who desist from paying
Zakat; among other evils.

Ø The journey underscored the importance of Masjid Aqswaa as a holy or sacred trust to all
Muslims and it is their religious obligation to guard it from any form of destruction.
Ø It signifies how Allah honors the prophet by bestowing upon him such a miraculous journey.

 

 

 

 

 

| P a g e 114

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

The Prophet’s Mission in Madina

 

Beginning of the Muslim Mission

Madinatu-Rasool (the city of the prophet) is the name of the settlement originally referred to as Yathrib. It was inhabited by the Arab tribes of Aws and Khazraj as well as certain Jewish tribes. The two tribes of Aws and Khazraj used to visit Makka during the pilgrimage season and also to attend to business affairs. The prophet (P.B.U.H) used to preach to every group that came for pilgrimage or for business in his quest to present Islam to them. It was during these visits that he met with six people from the tribe of Khazraj who accepted Islam. The prophet then asked them if they would support him in propagating Islam in Yathrib as his base. Due to the clashes between Aus and Khazraj, this group agreed with the prophet on people who would go and preach the message of Islam and peace to the other tribes in Yathrib. They requested the prophet to postpone this request till the following year. When they reached Yathrib, Allah (S.W.T) had willed the spread of Islam in Yathrib and the tribes of Aus and Khazraj sorted out most of their differences. At the end of the year, they returned to Makka with a group of ten Khazrajites and two Aws. They agreed to meet the prophet at the valley of Aqaba which is in Mina. The Yathribites then promised the prophet and Muslims their support to Yathrib- a journey referred to as Hijra.

 

 

 

Terms of the First Covenant of Aqaba (621C.E)

Have you been involved in any agreement with your friend? What were some of the reasons that led
to the two of you entering into this agreement? Thi scould be termed as a covenant. Itis an agreement
usually formal entered into by two or more persons to do or not to get involved in something. It may
contain some set of rules which we refer to as ‘terms’ that govern the conduct of those involved.
This happened when the prophet met some Yathribitesat the valley of Aqaba. They agreed on the
following:

  1. They should worship one God.
  2. They should abstain from evils.

iii.                            They should obey the laws of Allah (SWT) and His prophet.

After their discussion, the prophet chose Mus’ab bin Umair and Abdullah bin Umm Makhtum to

teach the Yathribites more about Islam. When these people returned to Yathrib, they propagated Islam to such an extent that Islam was the only topic in every home.

 

| P a g e 115

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

The Second Covenant of Aqaba (622 C.E)

 

In the year 622 C.E, during the next pilgrimage, a group of 72 Yathribites including two women
came to Makka. They met the prophet and his uncle Abbas at Aqaba, who addressed them thus, “My
nephew has always been regarded as the noblest and held in high esteem by his people. If you wish
to take him to Madina, first, be sure that you are able to uphold the agreement, fulfill your covenant,
and protect him against his enemies. If you are unable to do so, then do not take this responsibility
and leave him with his people instead.” The leader of the eathribites replied: “We are taking full
responsibility. In fact this is the very reason we are pledging this allegiance to him.”

They, therefore, promised to defend him fully and were prepared not to break this agreement under any circumstance. They also swore to worship one God and leave according to the teachings of Islam. The prophet accepted their offer to migrate to Yathrib and he appointed twelve leaders from among them saying, “eou are responsible to your people just as the disciples ofIssa bin Maryam were responsible to him and I am responsible to my people. The twelve agreed to represent the prophet in Yathrib until his arrival.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

| P a g e 116

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Muslim Emigration to Madina

The following map illustrates the route that was used by the Muslims during Hijra.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

You must have learnt in History about migration of people from one region to another. For example, the Bantu speaking people are said to have originated from Shungwaya in the Congo basin to come and settle in the parts of East Africa. What are some of the reasons that may lead to such migration? In History of Islam however, the reasons you have given may not apply. The prophet had the responsibility of ensuring that Islam spread far and wide and had to protect the few who had converted to Islam.

 

This started when the Quraish learnt of the pledge of Aqaba and intensified their torture against the
Muslims. As a result of this the prophet permitted the Muslims to secretly start migrating to Madina.
The noble swahabas (companions) obeyed immediately and they started migrating. Among the first
to migrate were Abu Salama, his wife and son. However, Ummu Salama was prevented by her

 

| P a g e 117

 

 

 

 

 

family members from migrating until a year later. Meanwhile, the other Muslims continued leaving
in small groups. They travelled for several days through the rocky and dusty villages until they
reached the first village, known as Quba’ which is  1 km south of eathrib. They were received
warmly by the Yathribites  and they stayed here for  a period of two  weeks.  The Yathribites
welcomed them into their homes selflessly and this earned the Yathribites the title Ansaar which
means ‘helpers.’

Abubakar (RA) and Ali (RA) were not among this first group that arrived in Yathrib. This is because the prophet had planned that Abubakar should migrate with him. Upon learning this, Abubakar purchased two camels in preparation for the journey.

 

Migration of the Prophet (P.B.U.H) to Madina

 

The Quraish sensed more danger when they realized that over one hundred Muslim families had already settled in Madina. They were afraid that the Muslims would join forces with the two tribes in Madina i.e. Aus and Khazraj and become very powerful. Therefore, they called for a meeting at Darun Nadwa to discuss measures that would be taken against the prophet. In the meeting, the following three suggestions were put forward:-

  1. The prophet should be tied in chains and imprisoned behind strong bars.
  2. The prophet to be banished from Makkah.

iii.                            The prophet to be eliminated by way of murdering him.

After a long discussion, they all agreed on Abu Jahal’s advice that the prophet should be killed. In
order that no single person or clan could be blamed, they chose one man from each of the twelve
tribes to participate in the murder. However, Allah had already informed the prophet about the evil
plan of the pagans and through Angel Jibril He instructed him to Madina the same night they had
plotted to kill him. He therefore, asked Abubakar to prepare for their departure.
Meanwhile, the prophet’s house had already been surrounded by a number of youth from the various
tribes of the Quraish. The prophet asked Ali (R.A) to stay behind and lay on the prophet’s bed and in
the morning return all the valuables that had been kept under the custody of the prophet to their
owners. The prophet then emerged from his house and flung a handful of sand in the direction of the
pagans while reciting the opening verses of Surat Yasin. This resulted in them falling asleep and
they did not see the prophet leave for Abubakar’s house. They then emerged from the backdoor of

 

| P a g e 118

 

 

 

 

 

Abubakar’s house and headed towards the cave of Thaur.They entered and hid in the cave. The prophet immediately went to sleep because of the long journey they had gone through. He was woken up by the tears of the Abubakar who was feeling pain because he had been stung by a poisonous insect. The prophet then immediately used his saliva to apply on Abubakar’s foot and the pain stopped immediately.

Meanwhile the Quraish leaders were very upset upon learning that the prophet had escaped and left Ali on his bed. They dispatched search parties all around Makka and promised a hundred camel reward for whoever captured the prophet dead or alive. The Makkans were motivated by the reward and they started combing the entire area until some group entered the entrance to the cave. They even employed a Bedouin fortune teller who had the skills of tracing footsteps. He trailed the Prophet and Abubakar until he reached the entrance of the cave of Thaur. Abubakar was afraid that they might be caught but the prophet comforted him by reminding him that Allah was with them. Allah hid them from being seen by the pagans when he inspired a spider to weave a web across the entrance of the cave. (This is referred to as the miracle of the cave).Furthermore a pigeon laid an egg at the entrance by the will of Allah and then a nearby tree bent its branches until they covered the entrance into the cave. Finally, the group carrying out the search with the advice ofUmayyah bin Khalaf left the place without entering the cave after arguing that there were no traces of anyone having gone into the cave.This miracle of the cave teaches us that:

  Islam is the true religion chosen by Allah(S.W.T)

  Muslimsshould always relay on Allah (S.W.T) for their protection.   All creations obey the command of Allah(S.W.T).

They remained hidden in the cave for three days. During this period, Abdullah, the son of Abubakar

used to update them at night with the news of Makkah while Asma bint Abubakar brought them food. By the end of the three days, the Makkan troupes had already given up their search. On the fourth day, the freed slave of Abubakar brought them the two camels that had been bought by Abubakar. He was accompanied by Abdullah bin Ariqeet who was to guide them through a secret route to Madina.

 

The prophet’s arrival at Quba

The Ansaars were eagerly awaiting the prophet’s arrival. They kept checking every day in the plains
but there was no sign until one day when one Jew who had been ascended a high tower spotted the

 

| P a g e 119

 

 

 

 

 

approaching group. He then shouted,  “He for whom you have been waiting has arrived.” The prophet was then hosted by Banu Aws. He remained at Quba for a few days in which the Muslims undertook the task of constructing the first mosque called ‘the mosque of piety.’ The prophet worked in participation with other Muslims until the mosque was completed. Ali (RA) joined them while they had camped at Quba.

 

Arrival in Madina

The prophet and the Muslims set out for Madina on a Friday of Rabiul Awwal  622 C.E. The inhabitants of Madina woke up early awaiting the arrival of the prophet (P.B.U.H). As he entered the city his camel was surrounded by excited Ansaar as they called out Takbeer in joy. Each of the families tried to tag at the camel’s reins so that it would stop at their homes. They were offering their homes, wealth and lives to the prophet (h.B.U.H). The prophet thus said, ‘Leave the camel as it is, for it is guided by Allah (and will stop wherever it is ordered to stop).” Finally the camel sat down in the home ofAbu Ayub Khalid Al Ansaari in an area inhabited by Banu An-Najjar. He stayed in this home until a house was built for him. The people of Yathrib agreed to change its name to Madina tun Nabi which the city of the prophet or Madinatul Munawwara; The city of light. Upon arrival in Madina, the prophet had the following tasks to perform:

 

 

 

 

 

  1. Construction of a Mosque

Have you been involved in the construction of any building? What are some of the materials

that must be available during any such construction? Among the things you have mentined is
the palce where the construction has to take place. When the Muslims came to Madina, they
did not have enough land to carry out all their activities.This therefore prompted Abubakar
to purchase the piece of land on which the prophet’s camel had rested when they first arrived
in Madina. It belonged to two orphans who had decided to give it free of charge but the
prophet insisted that they had to be paid. The construction of the prophet’s mosque began
immediately with both the Ansaar and the Muhajirun taking up various tasks. The prophet
actively took part by carrying bricks as he recited various verses of the Quran and Dua. One
of the duas he said was, “O Allah! No bliss is there but that of the hereafter I beseech you to
forgive the immigrants and the helpers.”The ninety square meter mosque was completed by

 

| P a g e 121

 

 

 

 

 

an additional two rooms to accommodate his family and aplace was also reserved to the North to cater for thehomeless.

 

 

 

  1. Rehabilitation of the Muhajirun from Makkah

It was the main test of the prophet in ensuring that Islamic brotherhood was going to be

established. The Ansaar had been taking care of the Muhajirun who left most of their belongings in Makka. The prophet united both the Ansaar and Muhajirun and the former were to continue sharing their wealth with the latter. They even adopted some of them into their homes and built homes for others. Employment was provided to them from large plantations while financial support was given to others to start up small businesses. This was a very unique and historical bond and it came to be referred t as ‘Muwakhaat’. The prophet had achieved in establishing the Muslim brotherhood within a few months.

 

 

iii.                                      Fostering Unity Among the Tribes of Madina

The prophet had an important task of regulating the lives of all the citizen of Madina who

included the Jews, Christians the paganthe two Arab tribes of Aws and Khazraj and the
Ansaar and Muhajirun in order to foster unity and harmony.He therefore it was necessary for
him to established the Madinan charter which constituted a set of rules and regulations
meant to govern all the citizens of Madina and is commonly known as  “The Madinan
constitution.”

 

Relationship between the Ansaar and Muhajirun

  1. The Ansaar and Muhajirun were united by the bond of Islamic brotherhood.
  2. The Ansaar showed charity by sharing their wealth with the Muhajirun.
  3. The Ansaar also adapted their fellow brother into their homes.
  4. They even built houses for others.
  5. Some found jobs for them to do on the plantations.
  6. Others gave the Muhajirun in support in starting their own businesses.

 

 

 

 

 

 

| P a g e 121

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Madinan Constitution

Any organization will always have its own rule and regulations to govern them. It is because of the
individual differences of the members of the society or country that it becomes necessary to
formulate laws that will harmonise all the operations of the organization. These set of rules or laws
are  included  in  the  document  we  call  a  constitution.A  constitution  can  be  defined  as  a  law
determining the fundamental political principles of a government or an organisation. In Kenya, for
example, we had a refurundum in 2007 to vote for the new constitution which was passed by the
Kenyans. It consists of a set of fundamental principles or established precedents according to which
a state or other organization is governed. These rules together make up or constitute, what the entity
is. When these principles are written down into a single collection or set of legal documents, those documents may be said to comprise a written constitution.

The Madinan constitution therefore was an agreement between the Muslims and the other Arabian tribes in Madina, the Jews, Christians and Polytheists to regulate relations and ensure peace between all of them. It was a written agreement and the first political agreement between Muslims and non Muslims whose principles were based on the Quran and Sunnah. It’s also the first constitution and the greatest political document ever known in History.

 

We shall now look at the major terms of this document:

As we have mentioned above, any constitution will comprise of rules to govern those who agree to adhere to it. The Madinan constitution also had its terms as follows:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

The Ansaar and Muhajirun shall

constitute  one  group  of  Umma to

the exclusion of others.

All  Muhajirun  shall   take   the                                                                                     2.

responsibility of their own wards,
shall pay blood among them and

 

shall also ransom their prisoners  in

the event of war.

The  people  of  Banu Aws and 3.

the   six   other   tribes   will   be

| P a g e 122

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Importance of the Madinan Constitution

 

  1. It was an attempt to bring reconciliation of all the tribes and prevent the Madinan
    tribes from frequent tribal wars.
  2. It outlined the principles for establish good relationship between the Muslims and non
    Muslims.
  3. The prophet’sposition as the supreme leader and controller of all affairs of Madina as
    a state and arbitrator of any dispute so as to bring peace was declared.
  4. The constitution summarized the rights of all the Madina citizens such as; freedom of
    speechthought and worship.
  5. Itensured protection of life and property and discouraged all types of crimes like
    murder, stealing among others.
  6. The Muslims and Islam were protected against the plots of the Jews and the

hypocrites.

  1. It proved the Prophet as a great leader. He was able to organize Madina and free it
    from tyranny, tribalism, selfishness and dictatorship.

 

 

 

 

| P a g e 123

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Challenges in Madina

 

Even though the prophet was welcomed in Madina, his stay was not peaceful because of the mayhem caused by the Quraish of Makka and a few tribes in Madina. They include the following:

  1. A clan of Khazraj headed by Abdullah ibn Ubayy who had been expecting to take over as a
    king of Yathrib. He therefore pretended to revert to Islam together with his supporters
    (Munafiqun). They had not been happy with the prophet’s advancement and started causing
    mischief among the believers.
  2. The Jews staying in Madina also opposed the prophet when the verse came directing
    Muslims to change the Qibla from Jerusalem to Makka.  (Read Q:  2:146)They secretly
    contacted the Makkan Pagans and started to work against the interest of the Muslims. They
    also rejected Prophet Mohammad because the messenger they had expected to come was to
    be from their tribe.
  3. The Quraish started sending troops to kill the prophet and his companions.
  4. Often, they interfered with business activities by looting the towns and destroyed the Arab

trade in the region by paralyzing all business activities.

  1. They also sent raiding parties with the intention of destroying fruit trees, plantations and

carrying away animals.

  1. The Makkans conspired with the Munafiqun to rebel against the prophet and Muslims.
  2. The Quraish went ahead to form alliances with other tribes with the aim of to dislodging

Islam and the Muslims.

  1. The Quraish leaders spread negative information about the prophet i.e. they said that he was
    a seeker chased from his motherland in order to discourage people from embracing Islam.

 

aespite all these challenges, the prophet remained patient awaiting Allah’s command

Hijra as a Turning Point in the History of Islam

  1. The prophet received a warm welcome from the people of Yathrib who were eager to

learn Islam as compared to the Makkan Quarish who used to persecute Muslims.

  1. There was rapid spread of Islam after Hijra as opposed to earlier on.
  2. After Hijra, Islam came to triumph over the pagan religions and was soon the religion

for the whole of Arabian Peninsula and even expanded further.

  1. Muslims were able to conduct their affairs peacefully in Yathrib Madina resulting in the

expansion of trade and an organized army.

  1. The first mosque “Masjidul Quba” was constructed and Muslims could pray freely.

 

| P a g e 124

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  1. Muslims were able to fight in defense of their religion and won in most of the battles

because of the strength they built after travelling to Madina.

  1. Hijra marks the beginning of the Islamic Calendar at the time of Umar al Khattab
  2. Muslims got a city of their own and changed the name Yathrib to Madina.

 

 

 

Importance of Hijra in the history of Islam

  1. There was rapid spread of Islam outside Makka since the Muslims were no longer in fear
    of Quraish attack.
  2. Islam came to triumph over the pagan religion and was soon considered the religion for
    the entire Arabian Peninsula.
  3. Muslims were living  in  peace  and  could  therefore  conduct  their  affairs  without
    interference.  This  resulted  in  expansion  of  trade  and  consequently stabilizing  their
    economy.
  4. Due to the prevailing peace, the prophet was able to organize the Muslim army in
    readiness for the defense of the religion.
  5. The first mosque (Masjidul Quba) was constructed and thus the Muslims were able to
    freely worship.
  6. The prophet got ample time to teach the new Muslim community Islamic laws and
    regulations to guide the affairs of the Muslim state.
  7. The prophet and the Muslims got a city of their own and changed the name Yathrib to
    Madina.
  8. The year of Hijra i.e. 622 AD marked the beginning of the Islamic calendar.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

| P a g e 125

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

The Battle of BADR(2A.H/624 C.E) 17th Ramadhan

 

The prophet’s effort to enter into peace treaties with the Jews and other tribes while in Madina was
an attempt to have a community that was founded on security, harmony and freedom. However, this did not go well with the Quraish who were bitter about the migration of the prophet and his companions.

They were not happy to see the Muslims settle in Madina where they were becoming famous in their ways of life while the Islamic faith was becoming more prominent.

Abdullah bin Ubayy bin Salul had been previously promised leadership by the Aus and the Khazraj of Madina. However, with the migration of the prophet in Madina, majority of the in habitants voluntarily became Muslims and preferred the leadership of the prophet over anybody else. This made  Abdullah  bin  Ubayy  together  with  his  sympathizers  to  be  Muslims  but  not  absolutely dedicated. They became enemies of Islam from within. They pretended to be Muslims but actually did everything to spoil Islam and secretly oppose it. These people came to bb e referred to as the Munafiqun (hypocrites). They collaborated with the Quraish to give important information and also help them weaken the Muslims.

| P a g e 126

 

 

 

 

 

The Quraish, promising support to the Munafiqun, encouraged them to get rid of the Muslims in Madina by all means.

Abdullah bin Ubayy, driven by the failed attempt for leadership, complied with the Quraish and organized themselves to fight the Muslims, but without success.

The people from Madina were threatened when they went for Umra because of the presence of
Muslims in their land. Verbal and written provocations were sent to the Muslims in Madina with all
sorts of threats and hatching of plans to expel the Muslims from this important geographical position

i.e.the passage to Syria.

Finally, permission to fight was given to the Muslims by Allah when the ayats were sent down that:

‘To those, against whom war is made, permission is given to (fight), because they were
wronged-and verily, Allah is Most powerful for their aid.”[Q: 22:39]
Reasons that made the Quraish fight in the battle of Badr;

 

 

o The Quarish were angry because the Muslims had escaped from them.

o Islam challenged the old religion of the Quarish so the Makkans did not like the
spread of the new faith.

o The Quarish feared that Muslims would block their caravans to the North.

o Confrontation between the Makkans and the Muslims who had been send to defend
the caravan.

o The Makkans were jealousy of the conversion of prominent people like Hamza and
Umar bin Khattab to Islam.

 

Muslims fought in the battle so as to:-

 

  1. Assert their might and instill fear among the Quarish who had always seen them as
    weak.
  2. Compensate for the loss the Muslims had gone through while they were in Makka.
  3. Cut off the access of the Quraish traders to Syria.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

| P a g e 127

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Events of the Battle

 

Madina was a trade link to Syria used by all the traders.In the year  624 C.E the prophet was informed of a large caravan belonging toQuraish led by Abu Sufyan that was travelling from Sham (Syria) with worthy goods and was to pass through Madina.

The prophet then told the Muslims, “Here is the caravan of the Quraish well loaded with wealth and merchandise. This is an opportunity which we cannot afford to miss” The prophet thus led to attack the caravan in revenge of what the Quraish had done to them. The prophet left Abdullah Ibu UmmiMakhtum and Lubaba Bin Abdumundhir to take care of the Muslim affairs in Madina. There were only forty people guarding this caravan.

The Muslim did not manage to intercept the caravan because the news of the Muslims plan had
reached Abu Sufyan who managed to use a different route. He even informed the Quraish through a
letter that he had managed to escape using the sea rout but Abu Jahal insisted by saying that the
Arabs should see, hear and understand that we are powerful people. The Quraish had set out more
than 1000 people with 750 camels, 100 horses, 600 of the men were wearing iron amours.

When he learnt about the plan of the Quraish, he then consulted with his companions and they agreed to go ahead and fight the Quraish army. Muslim army had only 313 men armed with swords, 76 camels and two horses. The prophet said to his companions, “Allah promised me one of the two either the caravan or the army.” This was justified by the following revelation:

 

‘Just as your Lord ordered you out of your houses in truth,even though a party among the
disbelievers dislike disputing with you concerning the truth after it was made clear,as if they were
being driven to death and they (actually)saw it. Behold God promised you one of the two parties
(enemy), that should be yours; you wished that the one unarmed should be yours but God willed
to justify the truth according to his words and the roots of the unbelievers.’ [Q: 8:5-7].

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

| P a g e 128

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

The prophet then received Wahyipermitting them to fight thus:

 

“To those against whom war is made permission is granted to fight because they are wronged and verily God is most powerful for their aid. They are who have been expelled from their homes in defiance of right (for no cause) except that they say “Our Lord is our God” [Q: 22: 29-40].

 

 

 

“Fight in the cause of God those who fight you, but do not transgress limits, for God loves not transgressors. And slay them wherever you catch them, turn them out from where they have turned you out for tumult and oppression are worse than killing but fight them not at the sacred mosque unless they first reward of those who suppress faith. But if they cease, God is oftforgiving, most merciful” [Q: 2: 190-192]

The tribes of Bani Adiy and Ibn Zuhraafter learning that their trade caravans were safe, they did not participate in this battle.The prophet sent Ali Bin Talib, Zubeir Bin Awwam and Saad Abi Waqqas to the wells of Badr to find out about the Quraish army. They found out that it consisted of Utba and Shayba sons of Rabia, Hakim Ibu Khizam, Tuamin Bin Adiy, Nufalah Bin Khuwaylid,Abdul Baghtary bin Hisham, Iraath Bin Amr, Annadhar Bin Aswad, Umayyad Bin KhalafandAmr Bin Hisham(Abu Jahal). This was a very strong army but the Muslims had to go for war. Habbab Bin Mundhir suggested that they should camp at the water source to deny the Quraish access. When the Quraish reached Badr, they rushed for water but the Muslims stopped them. The prophet allowed them access to the water, a move which touched Hakim Bin Hazath who suggested to Utba Rabin to give up the battle. However Abu Jahal opposed him.

 

Traditionally the Arab battles used to start with a combat between a few pairs were appointed from the two armies before the main battle; this is referred to as a duel. In this battle it involved Hamza Bin Abdul Muttalib, Ali Bin Abu Twalib and Ubeid Bin Harith from the Muslim’s side, againstUtba bin Rabia, his brother Shayba bin Rabia and Utba’s son al Walid from the Quraish. Shayba was defeated and killed by Hamza; Walid was also killed by Ali. Ubeid and Utba drew each dealt a death blow to the other but Ubeid died on the way back while Utba died on the sport.

 

| P a g e 129

 

 

 

 

 

 

As the Quraish army was advancing Prophet raised his hands and prayed to Allah (S.W.T) and said, “O Allah! Should this group (of Muslims) be defeated today, you will no longer be worshipped.” As a result of this dua, Allah sent angels to assist the Muslims. Allah says in theQuranthus:“Remember you implored the assistance of your Lord and He answered you; I will assist you with a thousand Angels ranks on ranks.”[Q: 8:9]

The Quraish saw the number of Muslims increasing and they started retreating.The Muslims fought
with courage and emerged victorious in this battle. The Muslims considered their victory as having
come from Allah. It is said in the Quran by Allah (S.W.T),‘It is not you who slew them; It was
Allah: When you threw (a handful of dust) it was not your act but Allah’s: Inorder that He might
test the believers by a gracious trial from Himself: For God is He who hears and knows (all
things.)’[Q8:17]

By the end of the battle, 70 enemies were killed and 70 others taken as captives. Only 14 Muslims were killed. The relatives of the 70 captives were told to pay a ransom or the captives should teach Muslims how to read and write in order to get their freedom.

 

Importance of the Battle

 

  1. It dealt a big blow to the dignity and honor of the Quarish who had considered
    themselves superior for many years.
  2. It is considered as a symbol for success of the power of truth over falsehood.
  3. The assistance that Muslims got from Allah (S.W.T) strengthened their faith.
  4. The victory of the Muslims gave assured continuity to Islamwhich would have come
    to an end had they been defeated.
  5. The prophet’s position as a spiritualand a state leaderwas confirmed by the Muslims
    victory.
  6. It strengthened the spirit and moral of the prophet to continue with his mission of
    preaching Islam.

 

 

 

 

 

| P a g e 131

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Reasons for the Muslims victory

 

Ø They had complete faith and confidence in Allah despite their number being few.On this
Allah (SWT) says,‘O ye who believe! If you will aid (The cause of Allah) He will aid you,
and plant your feet firmly.’[Q: 47:7]

Ø Unity of opinion within them.The prophet would ask for advice from the Muslim army
before they decided on any matter.

Ø They showed obedience, love and respect to the Prophet as their leader.

Ø Muslims love for the hereafter gave them courage to keep fighting,since they knew of
Allah(SWT) promise for those who fight for His course

Ø They were courageous, determined and zealous to win over the Quraish.

Ø Muslims were fighting for a proper reason that to ensure that the truth triumphs over
falsehood.

 

The battle of uhud: (3 a.h/625 c.e)
Map of the battle of uhud

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

| P a g e 131

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

This battle took place by the hill of Uhud which is about three miles outside Makka.The Quraish advanced towards the Muslims in this battle due to the following reasons;

  1. They wanted to revenge against the Muslims after a humiliating defeat at the battle Badr.
  2. The Quarish wanted to re-establish their supremacy among the Arabs which they had lost
    during the battle of Badr.
  3. They wanted to kill the prophet and bring Islam to an end before it was too late.
  4. The Quarish wanted to guarantee the safety of its caravan route to Syria which had been the
    main cause for the battle of Uhud.

 

Events of the battle

Abbas, the prophet’s uncle informed him of the plan by the Quarish to attack the Muslims.The prophet preferred to remain in Madina to wait for the Quarish to attack but after consultation with the majority. A force of 1000 men set outfor the battle. The Quarish had gathered 3000 men, well equipped and better trained than their first army. This army was being led by Abusufian.They also brought several women to cheer them as they fought.

 

| P a g e 132

 

 

 

 

 

Just before the battle began, Abdullah bin Ubayy the leaders of the hypocrites pulled out with an
army of 300 men and returned to Madina in the pretence of protecting Madina from within.As usual,
the battle began with single combats who were involved then the general attack developed.The
prophet placed 50 archives to protect the entrance into the hill with clear instructions not to leave
their outcome.

When the Quraish were being defeated, they started running away leaving their booty behind, the Muslims soldiers became greedy of the booty and they left the entrance unguarded and went for the left booty.

Khalid bin Walid, the commander of the Quarish army saw the unguarded passage and instructed a section of the enemy to make a surprise attack from behind the hill of Uhud.This sudden attack caused confusion among the Muslims such that they thought the prophet had died until when he shouted, “Iam Mohammed Bin Abdullah.Iam the messenger of Allah. I have come with the truth.” These words gave courage to the companions who started fighting again.Sayyiduna Abu-Bakr and Ali ran to the prophet and protected him from being killed. He was hit on the face by falling rocks and spears and he lost two teeth.

When the Muslims turned the tide of the battle, the Quarish started fleeing out of fear of defeat. The
Muslims suffered a great loss in this battle. Seventy Muslims lost their lives among them Hamza the
uncle of the prophet. His body was mutilated and Hind the wife of Abusufian ate his kidney. The
prophet vowed to revenge the death of his uncle but Allah(S.W.T) sent the following verse:
“And if you punish, inflict the same punishment as has been afflicted on you. But if you bear
patiently, it is certainly better for those who are patient; be patient for the reward of your patience is
from Allah (S.W.T). ao not feel sad nor distress yourself because of their plotting.”[Q: 16:127]
Only 22 Quarish were killed. Following this verse, the prophet was patient and did not revenge.

IMPORTANCE OF THE BATTLE OF UHUD

  1. It showed the significance of the Muslims to follow their leaders’ commands i.e. the

archers left the entrance unguarded disregarding the prophet’s not to leave the passage.

  1. It awakened the believers to their responsibility as protectors of their divine mission
  2. It taught Muslims to bear hardships in their mission.
  3. It explains the status of the prophet as the believed messenger of Allah and the love and

mercy Allah had towards the Muslims.

  1. The Muslims learnt that they shouldn’t be greedy for wealth
  2. They learnt that victory and defeat are in the hands of Allah
  3. They learnt never to under estimate an enemy.

| P a g e 133

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  1. The Makkans regarded it as their first defeat over the Muslims.
  2. Muslims learnt to be patient and a verse was revealed telling the prophet to show

patience to the martyrs of his uncle Hamza.

  1. It clearly differentiated the hypocrites like, Abdullah Ibn Ubayy from the true Muslims.
  2. Muslims learnt that Allah doesn’t grant victory without a proper cause.
  3. Muslims learnt the importance of consultation.
  4. It teaches leaders to accept the opinion of the majority.
  5. Women are allowed to participate in battles as long as their presence doesn’t cause an

alarm e.g. Ummu Ammarah who was injured while protecting the prophet.

 

 

 

 

 

 

The Battle of Khandaq (The Trench)

This is also called the battle of Al Ahzab (tribes) because it was planned by the Jewish tribes together with the Makkans in 5 A.H (627 C.E).The defeat of the Muslims at Uhud had lowered their prestige with the Arab tribes. Some tribes which had previously supported Muslims started drifting towards the Quarish. They even started attacking the different small Muslim groups.

The Jews, despite the treaty (Madina Constitution) with the Muslims were still very bitter and showed it openly. They had expected a prophet who would give them dominion and wealth, not one who would equate them to the Arabs. When they learnt that they could not use the prophet for their own ends, they tried to shake his mission and seduce his followers. They even declared the pagan religion as superior to Islam. They then joined forces with the Makkans and broke the treaty. The prophet had thus to take action and he expelled the two Jewish tribes; Banu Nadhir and Banu Qaynuqa from Madina.

A grand plan was now hatched to finish the Muslims. The Jews and Makkans incited all the tribes to raise arms against the Muslims in Madina. They also joined forces with the Jews of Oasis Khaybar and Banu Quraizah and had gathered an army of 24,000 men, led by Abu Sufyan. This was to bar any entrance into the city of Madina by the attacking Quraish.

 

 

 

 

 

| P a g e 134

 

 

 

 

 

The messengers from Banu Khuza’a reached the prophet afterfour days, warning him of the armies
that were to arrive in a week. The Muslims could not be able to fight such a big army in the open
field.

The prophet therefore gathered the Madinans to discuss the best strategy of overcoming the enemy.
Meeting the enemy in the open, and waiting for them inside the city were both suggested. Lastly, the
outnumbered Muslims opted to engage in a defensive battle by digging deep trenches to act as a
barrier along the northern front. This suggestion was introduced by Salman al Farsy, aPersian. Every
capable Muslimin Madina including the prophet himself contributed to the digging of large and deep
trench in six days. It was dug on the northern side only to obstruct any entry into the city. The other
parts  of  Madina  weresurrounded  by  Rocky  Mountains  and  trees,  impenetrable  to  large
armies.Muslims established their headquarters at the hillock of Sala’ a position which would give
them an advantage in case the enemy crossed the trench.The final army that would defend the city
from the invasion consisted of 3,000 men, and included all inhabitants of Madina over the age of 15,
except the Banu Qurayzawho had supplied the Muslims with some instruments for digging the
trench.

When the attacking army reached Madina, they found the 15 inch ditch obstructing. They made several attempts to cross but they could not and thus they decided to lay a siege for about 27 days. At last continuous failure and increasing difficulties like lack of food, created distrust among the allies. On the 27thday of the siege, a terrible cyclone with heavy rains created havoc in the enemy. They decided to raise the siege and return to their homes.

 

 

 

Results of this battle

  1. Muslims became victorious over the Quraish in this battle.
  2. Islam established itself as the absolute master of Madina.
  3. Muslims were able to take full control of Madina without interference from the Makkans
  4. It gave more prestige to the prophet and the Muslims making the Arab tribes to have an
    admiration of Islam.
  5. Swafiyyah, the daughter of the Jewish chief (a tribe which had bitterly opposed the Muslims)
    was married by the prophet (P.B.U.H) after this battle thus decreasing the differences
    between the Jews and the Muslims.

 

 

| P a g e 135

 

 

 

 

 

 

  1. The power of Munafiqun was finally broken and the Arabs all over the provinces started
    admiring the Muslims.

 

The Treaty of Hudaibiyah (6th Dhul Qad 6 A.H/628 C.E)

The next year after the battle of Khandaq, the prophet together with 1400 Muslims left Madina for
Makka to perform Umra (lesser pilgrimage). Muslims were instructed by the prophet not to carry
any weapons except swords since it waspurely a religious journey. Due to the strenuous relationship
with the Makkan Quraish, they could not enter Makka directly. Therefore, theycamped at the valley
of Hudaibiyah, a few milesaway from Makka and sent word to Makka that they had come for Umra
and not to wage war. The first messenger Kharash bin Umayya was arrested immediately but later
released; his camel’s legs were chopped off. Uthman was sent as a second emissary but he was
locked up in a room full of smoke for three days. Due to this, a battle almost started between the two
but was suspended when Uthman was released unharmed.At night, the Makkans used to sneak into
the Muslims army to spy but they learnt that the Muslims were carrying out their activities very
peacefully. This finally convinced the Quraish leaders that the Muslims had not come for war and
they agreed to send representativeled by Suhali Ibn Amirto sign a truce with the Muslims in which
the following terms were agreed:-

o There should be no hostilities between the Muslims and Makkans for ten years.

o The prophet and the Muslims was to return to Madina that year without performing
pilgrimage

o Makkan Muslims who left their people without permission were to be returned to
Makka and never be allowed to stay in Madina while Muslims who escaped from
Madina to Makka would be welcomed and never returned to the Muslims.
o No arms apart from swords would be carried by the Muslims when they go to Makka
the following year

o Any Arab tribe was free to befriend itself with the Muslims or pagan Quarish. o None of the terms would be changed for the next ten years.

Most of the terms of the truce were friendly to the Quarish and there was a general dissatisfaction among the Muslims until when Allah (S.W.T) revealed the following verse about the treaty,

“Lo, we have given you (Mohammad) a signal victory that Allah (S.W.T) may forgive you of the
sin that which is past and that which is to come, and may perfect his favors unto you and may
guide you on a right path, And that Allah (S.W.T) may help you with strong help”[ Q:48:1-3]

 

 

| P a g e 136

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

This verse proved to be true by the events which followed the treaty of Hudaibiyah i.e.

  1. Muslims got a break of rest from the Makkan attacks.
  2. Muslims were able to mix freely with any tribe they wanted.
  3. There were many Makkans who got a closer view of Islam through the interaction and were

able to embrace Islam e.g. Khalidbin Walid, Suhail bin Amir, Amr bin al’As.

  1. It showed that the prophet was a great leader.
  2. The Prophet was able to send teachers to other parts of Arabia.
  3. The prophet had enough time to concentrate on his divine mission because there was peace

and tranquility.

  1. It assured safe access of the Muslims to Makka their holy city the following year.
  2. It made the Makkan Quarish recognize Islam as an equal power with them as they withdrew

from the war arena.

 

Lessons from the treaty of Hudaibiyah

  1. Allah (S.W.T) is always on the side of those who are sincere.
  2. Muslims should always have faith in Allah (S.W.T).
  3. Victory always comes from Allah (S.W.T) especially to those who are pious and

determined.

  1. Muslims should always aspire to spread peace despite intimidation
  2. Muslims should be patient at all times and in all situations.
  3. Muslims cant enter into agreement with non-Muslims for sake of peace
  4. The prophet was a recognized, wise and an able leader
  5. Forgiveness should be fostered in the hearts of Muslims

 

The Prophet’s Invitation of Foreign Rulers to Islam

With peace having been established in Arabia after signing the treaty of Hudaibiyya, the prophet
decided to concentrate more on his divine mission. He started by sending envoys to the following
areas:

  1. a) Abyssinia.

The  prophet  sent  Amr  bin  Umayyah  Ad-Damri  to  the  Negus  of  Abyssinia  by  the  name

Ashamah.This delegation was warmly received and treated well. Some sources say that the king
embraced Islamsecretly since Abyssinia was a r hristian country. He replied, “In the name of Allah
the Most Gracious the Most Merciful. O prophet of Allah! And mercy and blessings from Allah
beside whom there is no god.I have received your letter in which you have mentioned about Jesus

| P a g e 137

 

 

 

 

 

and by the Lord of the heaven and the, Jesus is not more than what yousay. We fully acknowledge that which you have been sent to us and we have entertained your cousin and his companions. I bear witness that you are the messenger of Allah true and confirming (those who have come before you).I pledge to you through your cousin and surrender myself through him to the Lord of the worlds.” When this Negus later died in Rajab 9 A.H the prophet announced his death and observed the funeral prayer in absentia for him.He was succeeded by another King to whom the prophet sent a letter but however it is not confirmed as to whether he accepted Islam or not.

 

 

  1. b) Persia

Abdallah Ibn Hudhaifa was sent with a letter to Perevez the emperor of Persia inviting him to

Islam..The king was arrogant and proud and after reading it he got infuriated and mistreated the
envoy. He thought that the language in the letter was too harsh for an emperor and also the prophet’s
name should nothave appeared above his, he therefore tore the letter into pieces. He then sent his
men to arrest the prophet and bring him to his palace.When the envoy reported back to the prophet,
he prayed for the Persian Empire to disintegrate.No sooner had the Persia emperors envoy reached
Madina than the Prophet (P.B.U.H) received divine inspiration that Perevez had died.His successor
was unable to maintain the unity in the emperor leading to its complete disintegration.

  1. c) Roman Empire.

Dihya bin Khalifa al-Kalbi was sent to king Heraclius of Byzantine. He welcomed him well, read the

letter but did not embrace Islam, however he send them with many presents to take to the prophet. The tribe of Judham intercepted the convoy at a place called Husma and robed them. When the prophet heard of this, he dispersed an army and inflicted heavy losses on those people. One the prophet ordered that all the captives and spoils of war be returned.

  1. d) Egypt.

Hatiib bin Abi Baltaah was send to the king of Egypt (Muqawqis) called Juraij bin Matta.He read the

letter and accepted the message though he was disappointed that the prophet did not come from Syria as it was expected. However he sent presents two maids from noble Coptic families, Maria, and Syrin; clothing, and stead for riding on but he did not accept Islam The prophet married Maria who bore him Ibrahim while Syrin was married to Hassan bin Thabit al Ansaari.
Find out more other leaders to whom the prophet send emissaries.

 

 

 

 

| P a g e 138

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

The fall of Khaybar (7 A.H)

 

Khaybar was a strong fold of the two Jewish tribes of Banu Nadhir and Banu Qainuqa. It is about
200 miles from Madina. These Jews with the help of neibouring Arab tribes were planning to attack
Madina. They had joined forces with the Bedouins of Ghatafah.The prophet learned of their plot and
gathered 1,400 men including 200 horse men. When the Muslims reached Khaibar and saw their
opponents, the prophet prayed, “O Allah, we wish prosperity and we seek your refuge from evils
there from”.

The Muslims stopped at a place150 miles in the valley of at Raji to prevent the men of Khaibar from reinforcing the Jews. There were eight fortressess at Khaibar all garrisoned with armed men.They included; the fortresses of Na’im, Ubai, An-Nizar, AZ-Zubair, As-Sa’b bin Mu’ath, Al Watih, AsSulalim and Al- Qamus. A fierce fight took place around these fortresses and in a few days the Muslims had captured all of them. This was after a siege of 20 days. The booty was shared among the victorious Muslims. The Jews were however allowed to retain their lands on condition that they would pay half of the produce to the Islamic state. The prophet then married Swafiyyah a daughter of a leading Jewish chief in order to strengthen the friendship with the Jews.

 

The conquest of Makka. (20th Ramadhan5.A.H)

When Islam was well established in the hearts of the Muslims, Allah decided that the time had come for His Messenger and his community to enter Makkah. They would purify the Ka’bah so that it would be a blessed place of guidance for the whole world. They would restore Makkah to its previous status and the sacred city would offer security for all people once again.
The terms of the treaty of Hudaibiyah had given freedom of association to both Muslims and theQuraish.The Muslims befriended the Banu Khuza’ah while the Quraish allied with the BanuBakr. These two tribes had been enemy since the Pre Islamic time but now they were to respect the terms of the treaty of Hudaibiyah and stop attacking each other.

For some years, the Quarish respected the treaty of Hudaibiyah until when the Banu Bakr attacked
the tribe of Banu Khuza’ah which was allied to theMuslims at a place called Al-Wateer.The
Quraishsupported the tribe of BanuBakr with men and arms. They attacked the Banu Khuza’ah at
night who had to take refuge in the Holy sanctuary. This event led to the aggrieved Banu Khuza’ah
to seek for justice from the Muslims. As a result the prophet laid down three conditions for the
Quraish:

 

| P a g e 139

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

1.To pay blood money for the victims of Banu Khuza’ah.

2.To end their friendship with Banu Bakr.

3.To consider the truce of Hudaibiyah to have been nullified.

 

 

Out of the three conditions, the Quraish accepted the cancellation of the treaty.

The prophet then gathered 10,000 armed men and headed for Makkah. As they were advancing
towards Makka, more and more tribes joined them on the way. At Juufa,Al Abnas bin Abdul
Mutwalib came to join them. The army marched and camped at Marr a Zahran.When Makkans
heard of the news, they sent Abusufian to spy on the Muslim’s camp. He was however detected by
Abbas the uncle of the prophet and Muslim guards presented him to the prophet. The prophet did not
punish him but made him stand on a high ground to see the spectacle of the Muslim army marching
towards Makkah.

The prophet divided his forces into different groups with each having its leader. Abu ubaida bin jarrah led the Muhajirun accompanied by the prophet himself. Zubeir Bin Awwam was on the left moving in a parallel column. The western entrance of the city was controlled by Saad Bin Ubaid while Khalid Bin Walid with the Bedouin contingent was to circle the whole city on the west and enter it from the south.

The uncle of the prophet Abass, who had embraced Islam, was escorting Abusufyan. He adviced him
to embrace Islam which he did.Abusufyan had wanted negotiations but the Muslim army refused and
entered Makkah. The prophet instructed them not to shed any blood.tIn order to reakize this goal,and
conquer Makka peacefully,he made the following announcement; “ Those who shelter in the kaaba
are safe, those who shelter in Abu Sufyans house are safe and those who stay in their own houses are
safe.”

Despite the peaceful entry of Muslims into Makka, a group of Makkans rushed and attacked the
Muslim group under Khalidbin Walid. As a result two Muslims and twelve non believers were
killed.

The prophet then entered the Kaaba and cast down all idols while recitingthe following verse of the Quran,

“The truth has come and false hood gone, verily falsehood is ever vanishing.”

[Q: 17:81]

 

 

| P a g e 141

 

 

 

 

 

A green flag was hoisted on the Kaaba and Bilal bin Rabah then made the Adhan and the prophet led a thanks giving prayer (SwalatulShukr).The prophet then addressed a huge gathering and said,“There is no god except Allah .No one can be associated with him. He has fulfilled his promise. He has helped his servant and has shattered all bands alone. All the prides, all the prices of the family are under my heal. All the men are descendants of Adam and Adam was made of clay”.

The Makkan leaders who had been oppressing the Muslims were among the crowd and the prophet asked them, “ao you know how I am going to treat you?”They replied, “eou are a noble brother and noble nephew we expect nothing but good from you.”The prophet said, “There is no revenging against you today and you are all free.” The prophet then climbed on the hill of swafa and gave a sermon to all the Makkans to swear loyalty to Islam. Men and women came to accept Islam. Hind, the wife of Abu Jahal was among the women. The prophet forgave her. He also forgave Ikrimah Bin Abu Jahal who also accepted Islam. The prophet remained in Makkah for  15 days. After  the conquest of Makka the prophet organized his troupes to go and attack the Roman Empire at Tabuk and the Banu Khawazin and Banu Thaqif.

 

 

 

Significance of the conquest of Makkah

  1. It showed the purity of the Kaaba as the house of Allah and a place for monotheism.
  2. Victory meant the supremacy of the Great Lord rather than ambition for power. This is

why the prophet first thanked Allah and then purified the Kaaba.

  1. By the Prophets act of forgiveness, he was laying emphasis on the noble Islamic

principle of brotherhood and peace.

  1. Many Makkans embraced Islam and even women pledged to worship non but Allah and

to lead a clean life.

  1. It singles out the hrophet’s unique character of patience and wisdom.

Question: compare and contrast the conquest of Makka and the unsuccessful attack by Abraha in the year of the elephant.

 

The Battle of Hunain

The conquest of Makka triggered mass conversion of Arabs to Islam in many parts of the Arabian
Peninsula.Although a large number of Makkans and neighboring tribes embraced Islam, some only

 

| P a g e 141

 

 

 

 

 

accepted Mohammed as a ruler of Arabia but didn’t believe in his prophet hood.Among the tribes that were opposing the Muslims included: Khawazin, Thaqif, Jusham, Saad Bin Bakr and Bani Hilal .The prophet was informed that the tribes of Khawazin and Thaqif were preparing to fight the Muslims. The prophet at once proceeded towards them with an army of  12,000 men including recently converted Muslims and about 2000 non Muslim of Makka who had accompanied them as allies.   The enemies were 4000.   The Muslims were over confident because this was the biggest army they had ever raised.

 

The battle took place in the field of Hunaian on Saturday 19th of Shawwal about nineteen days after the conquest of Makka. The enemy marched at night towards the Muslimarmy under their leader Malik bin Auf and strategically hid in the valley. The next day in the morning, the prophet was organizing his forces for the battle not knowing that the enemies’ troupes were hiding in the nearby valley.The enemy then longed a surprised attack which disorganized the Muslim who scattered in all directions looking for safety passing the prophet unaware. Abass ibn Abdul Mutwilib shouted loudly unto the Muslims.

“O Ansaar, O Muhajirun O men who pledge their allegiance under the tree, where are you
going?The messenger of Allah is here. r ome back to him.” The Muslims were gripped with shame
over their cowardly conduct since they had always pledged to die with the prophet. They came back
shouting “At your command!” They lounged a counter attack. Soon the enemy realized they would
face complete defeat and they started fleeing leaving behind their children, women and property.

Even though the Muslims were victorious, they paid dearly a number of Muslims were wounded and
twelve killed. The victory however brought supremacy to the Muslims. The enemy ran and took
refuge at the city of Thaqif the capital of the tribe. The Muslims decided to lay a siege on the city.
When the help of Aws, the Muslims bombarded Taif, their Orchard were destroyed until the enemy
sent an appeal to the prophet to stop the destruction upon which he temporarily withdrew the Muslim
army.

The Muslims then went to share the booty of the Khawazin. Some of the enemies surrendered and embraced Islam. Those converts requested for the release of their women and children a request which was granted by the prophet. This gesture of mercy pleased them so much that more and more embraced Islam.

 

 

| P a g e 142

 

 

 

 

 

The prophet then sent the Khawazin to go and tell Malik bin Auf that if he converted to Islam, his family would be given back to him and an additional gift of 100 camels. He happily converted and the prophet fulfilled his promise to him.

The following verses were revealed following the events of Hunain, 9:25-28 “Assuredly Allah did help you in many battle fields and on the day of Hunain: Behold! Your great numbers elated you, but they availed you not; the land, for all that is wide, did constrain and you turned back in retreat. But Allah did pour His calm on the Messenger and on the believers, and sent down forces which you saw not: He punished the unbelievers, thus does he reward those without faith”

 

The Muslims learnt that victory is in the hands of Allah and that number is not significant to victory. They also had to be faithful to their leaders and show trust in Allah.

 

In this battle, 6000 men were taken as captives. It sohappenedthat Bani sa’ad was among the
prisoners. This was the tribe which had suckled the prophet, a woman who claimed to be Shima and
had been a foster sister to the prophet 60 year ago reminded the prophet of the scar (white mark) he had caused her when she was carrying him on the back. This memory touched the prophet and he freed all the prisoners from BanuThaqif and Banu Sa’ad. Later on he released all the other prisoners the prophet then went back to Madina.

 

The farewell address

At the age of 63 years, the prophet (P.B.U.H) went to perform pilgrimage in 10 A.H. This is called
Hijatul Widaa (The farewell pilgrimage) More than one hundred thousand Muslims camefor Hajj on
the 9th of ahul Hijja at the valley of Arafat. This was to be the prophet’s last pilgrimage. It was
during this Hajj that Sura al Nasr was revealed which was received as an announcement of the
prophets approaching death. After the pilgrimage, theprophet then made his farewell address in
which he said:

“O people, listen to me for I do not know whether you will find me amongst you next year. O people, verily, your blood, your property and your honor are sacred and inviolable until you appear before your Lord, as this day and this month is sacred for all verily you will meet your Lord and your will answerable to your action.

Have I not conveyed my message? Allah is my witness. He who has any trust on him should restore
it to the person who deposited it with him. Beware; no one committing a crime is responsible for it

| P a g e 143

 

 

 

 

 

but himself. Neither the son is responsible of the crime of the father nor is the father responsible for
the crime of the son. O people! Listen to my words and understand them. You must know that a
Muslim is a brother of the Muslim and they form one brotherhood. Nothing of his brother is lawful
for a Muslim except what he himself allows willfully. So you should not oppress one another.
Behold all practices of paganism and ignorance is under my feet. The blood revenges of the days of
ignorance are remitted. Usury is forbidden but you will be entitled to recover your principal. Do not
wrong and you shall not be wronged. Be kind to your women folk verily they have got certain rights
over you.

Verily I have left among you the book of Allah (S.W.T) and the Sunna of his apostle which if you hold fast you shall never go astray. And feed your slaves; and cloth them with the clothes that you yourselves wear.

Behold,  worship  your  lord;  offer  prayers  five  times  a  day,  observe  fast  in  the  month  of Ramadhan,make pilgrimage to the house, pay readily the Zakat on your property and obey whatever I command you only then will you get into the heaven.”

What lessons do you learn from this farewell address?

 

 

 

Demise of the prophet.(12th Rabiul-Awwal 11 A.H/632 C.E)

After the farewell address, the prophet returned to Madina at the end of the month of Dhul Hijja. On
Monday 12th Saffar the prophet felt a severe headache and his health started deteriorating.During this
period of illness, he spent most of his time in the house of Lady Aisha. Occasionally, he would go
out to meet the Muslims, advice them and ask for the congregations forgiveness.When his condition
grew worse and he could not lead the Muslims in prayer, he requested Abubakar to take charge of
the religious duties. On the last day of his life, the prophet could be heard saying, “With those on
whom you have bestowed your grace, with the prophet and the truthful ones, themartyrs and the
good doers. O Allah, forgive me and have mercy upon me and join me to the most exalted
companionship on high” He repeated the last words three times. auring all this time, Aisha (RAA)
was sprinkling water on his forehead until when finally the prophet passed on at the age of 63. His
body was washed and then a grave dug at the very place he had died and the prophet was burried.

 

 

 

 

 

| P a g e 144

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

ACHIEVEMENT OF THE PROPHET

 

 

  1. a) Brotherhood and equality of mankind

Islam is the religion of the Unity of God and the Equality of Mankind. Lineage, riches and family
pride are accidental things; virtue and the service of humanity are the real matters of merit.
Distinctions of colour, race and creed are non-existent within the bounds of Islam. All humans
comprise one family. Islam has succeeded in welding the ‘black’ and the ‘white’ into one fraternal
whole.  The  strict  rule  of  brotherhood  is  set  firm  with  the  following  saying  of  the  Prophet
Muhammad (P.B.U.H):”No one of you is a believer in God until he loves for his brother what he
loves for himself.”

 

 

 

 

  1. b) Elimination of racism

Racism is one of the severe diseases eating up the human society in this day and age. Everyone remembers how black Africans were transported across the oceans, packed in specially designed ships, thought of, and treated like livestock. They were made slaves, forced to change their names, religion and language. They were not entitled to hope for true freedom, and were denied the least of human rights: basic needs. Even though among some Western people, the attitude to non-Westerners has fortunately changed little in modern times, the political and social condition of black people often remain the same, even where they live amid the native Westerners as theoretically equal fellow-citizens; that of despised inferiors.

When Allah’s Messenger, (h.B.U.H) was raised as a hrophet, the same kind of racism, under the name of tribalism, was prevalent in Makkah. The Quraish considered themselves as peculiar, and Arabs in general, thought they weresuperior to all the other races of the world. Allah’s Messenger came with the Divine Message and proclaimed that no Arab is superior over a non-Arab, and no white is superior over black and superiority in the eyes of Allah(S.W.T) is by righteousness and fearing Him alone (Surat Al-Hujurat, 49:13). He also declared that even if an Abyssinian Black Muslim were to rule over Muslims, he should be obeyed.

 

 

 

| P a g e 145

 

 

 

 

 

Allah’s Messenger eradicated the problem of racial discrimination so successfully that superiority is not by birth or colour or blood, but by God-fearing and righteousness.

The message of Islam is for the entire human race. According to Islam, Allah (S.W.T) is the God of the entire world and Prophet Muhammad (P.B.U.H) is a messenger for the whole of mankind. Islam unites the entire human race under one banner without any kind of discrimination.

Allah (S.W.T) says “O Mankind! We have created you from a male and female, and made you into nations and tribes, that you may know one another. Verily, the most honorable of you in the sight of Allah is he who has most Taqwa among of you. Verily, Allah is All-Knowing, AllAware.”[Q: 49:13]

Allah (S.W.T) says, “And one of His signs is the creation of the heavens and the earth and the
diversity of your tongues and colors; most surely there are signs in this for the learned.”[Q: 30:22]

With this verse, Islam declares equality among people as one human race, one humanity, that is because Islam respectsa person as a creation of Allah(S.W.T) and not for any other reason; Islam does not distinguish between two races, or two groups of people, or between two colors, and the Prophet Muhammad (P.B.U.H) addressed the people signifying that concept during the farewell pilgrimage, saying: “O People! Your God is one; your father is one; no preference of an Arab over non-Arab nor of a non-Arab over an Arab or red over black nor black over red except for the most righteous. Verily the most honored of you is the most righteous.”

 

 

 

 

  1. c) Eradication of slavery

Apart from giving the slaves their rights, Islam also took a step ahead and discouraged slavery from

being practiced. It is seen in history that slaves were mistreated in the non-Islamic world. Not only were  they verbally abused,  but  also  physically  hurt.  During  the  period  of  his  prophet  hood, Muhammad worked diligently to do what he could to cut down on their numbers. Islam closed most of the doors leading to slavery and encouraged the freeing of slaves in many ways. He constantly exhorted those who owned slaves to treat them kindly and well. He insisted that they must treat the slaves fairly and with mercy. The Holy Prophet (P.B.U.H) says:

 

 

| P a g e 146

 

 

 

 

 

If the owner of a slave beat his slave or abused him, the only compensation that he could make was to set the slave free. (Sahih Muslim)

The Holy Prophet (P.B.U.H) alwaysencouraged and devised ways of freeing slaves on every pretext. He said:

“If a person  owning  a  slave sets  him free,  God will,  in  recompense save every part  of  his body.Corresponding to every part of the slave’s body from the torment of Hell.” (Sahih Muslim) Prophet Muhammad  (P.B.U.H) with Divine Inspiration from Allah  (S.W.T) forbade such acts. Masters could not abuse their slaves and had to give them the same food as they ate and dress them in the clothes they wore.

Narrated by Al-Ma’rur, “I met Abu ahar who was wearing a cloak, and his slave, too, was wearing a similar one. I asked about the reason for it. He replied, “I abused a person by calling his mother with bad names.” The Prophet said to me, ‘O Abu Dhar! Did you abuse him by calling his mother with bad names you still have some characteristics of ignorance. Your slaves are your brothers and Allah has put them under your command. So whoever has a brother under his command should feed him of what he eats and dress him of what he wears. Do not ask them (slaves) to do things beyond their capacity (power) and if you do so, then help them.’ “[Bukhari, Vol.1, Book 2, #29]

In another Hadith, The Prophet said, “Your servants and your slaves are your brothers. Anyone who has slaves should give them from what he eats and wears. He should not charge them with work beyond their capabilities. If you must set them to hard work, in any case, I advise   you   to help them” (Al-Bukhari).

 

  1. d) Improvement of status of women

The Holy Prophet (P.B.U.H) was very serious in improving the condition of women in society

and on securing for them a position of dignity and fair and equitable treatment.

Just before his death, one of the injunctions he addressed to Muslims and laid stress upon was
that they should always treat women with kindness and consideration. Holy Prophet (peace and
blessings of Allah be upon him) said: “If a man has daughters and he makes arrangement to have
them educated and takes pains with their upbringing, aod would save him from the torment of Hell.”
(Tirmidhi)

 

 

| P a g e 147

 

 

 

 

 

Before Islam, women were sold as personal commodities. Female children were buried alive
because they were considered as curse for family. It is Islam that gave every respect and honor to
women, and brought them at the level of men; otherwise women were mistreated in every sphere of
life. Islam always provides equal rights and equal opportunities for men and women, as the Holy
Quran says:

Surely, men who submit themselves to God and women who submit themselves to Him, and believing men and believing women, and obedient men and obedient women, and truthful men and truthful women, and men steadfast in their faith and steadfast women, and men who are humble and women who are humble, and men who give alms and women who give alms, and men who fast and women who fast, and men who guard their chastity and women who guard their chastity and men who remember Allah much and women who remember Him—Allah has prepared for all of them forgiveness and a great reward. (Holy Quran, 33:36)

Islam also permits equal opportunities to women to seek knowledge with men. It is entirely a wrong notion; such concept is never presented by Islam. The Holy Prophet (peace and blessings of Allah be upon him) says in this regard, “It is the duty of every Muslim man and Muslim woman to seek knowledge”.

The Holy Quran says:

He it is who created you from a single soul and made there from its mate, that he might find comfort in her. And when he knows her, she bears a light burden and goes about with it. And when she grows heavy, they both pray to Allah, their Lord, saying, ‘If thou gives us a good child, we will surely be of the thankful.’ [Q: 7:190]

In connection with the respect, honor and status of woman as a mother, the Holy Prophet (P.B.U.H) has a great regard. Once, a Companion consulted him to seek advice to participate in a war, when he askaed, “Do you have a mother?” He said, “Yes.” Then Holy Prophet (P.B.U.H) said, “Be with her, because paradise is under her feet.” (Nasa’i)
“haradise lies under the feet of your mothers.” This indicates the outstanding status of woman in Islam far superior than granted by any other religion of the world. No other religion comes close to the prominence given to women by the Holy Prophet of Islam.

Once a companion of the Holy Prophet of Islam asked, “O Apostle of Allah! To whom should I show kindness?” He replied, “eour mother, next your mother, next your mother, and then comes your father, and then your relatives in order of relationship.” (Abu aawud)

 

| P a g e 148

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  1. e) Religious Tolerance

Prophet Muhammad  (P.B.U.H) was a role model for religious freedom, for instance when the

Prophet Muhammad (P.B.U.H) entered the city of Medina, he made a formal constitution with the large Jewish population of the city, and indeed, this was a historic moment and in this constitution it guaranteed   religious     freedom   for   those   who   were   and   weren’t   Muslims.Once   the   people of Mecca said to Prophet Muhammad that if god did not want them to worship idols then why He does not forcefully prevent them from doing so. Then God sent the following message:

 

“(O Muhammad) This is not a new excuse; those who left before them made, the same excuses. Is there anything upon the messengers except the dear conveying of the message” [Q: 16: 3])

 

 

The Quran clearly says that religion cannot be forced on anyone. It says,

 

 

“There is no compulsion in (accepting) the religion (of Islam)…”

 

Why? Because:”truly the right way has become clearly distinct from error.” [Q: 2:25]

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

| P a g e 149

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Suggested study questions and activities.

 

Answer the following questions in your I.R.E revision exercise book.

1.a) Narrate the early life of the prophet.

b)Identify the methods of persecutions experienced by the early Muslims.

2.a) Give reasons why Muslims migrated to Abbysinia.

b)Outline the lessons Muslims learn from the battle of Uhud.

3.a) How did the treaty of Hudaibiyya prove a success for the Muslims?

b)Write down ten teachings we learn from the prophet’s farewell pilgrimage.

4.a) Explain the lessons the Muslims learnt in the battle of uhud.

b)Discuss the challenges faced by the Muslims when they first arrived in madina. Activities.

  1. Compare the practices of todays Muslims with that of the Arabs during the
    Jahiliya. Are there any similarities?
  2. Dramatize how the battle of Badr was fought.
  3. Compare and contrast the conquest of Makka with the unsuccessful attack by
    Abraha Ashram during the year of the elephant

 

 

 

CHAPTER 8

MUSLIM SCHOLARS

In every society we have prominent people whose prominence may be due to their leadership
positions or their general role towards the improvement of the society. Most of these personalities
are our heroes and we get motivated by them and have them as our role models. Do you know of any
such people in our contry? How have you been inspired by them? In the history of Islam, several
challenges have been met by the champions of Islam. In every century, we had leaders who
spereheaded the reforms and struggle for spread of Islam. We are therefore going to study some of
these schorlars in our secondary syllabus. In each form, two scholars will be studied starting with
Sheikh al Amin Ali bin Mazrui and Abdallah Swaleh al Farsi.Let us now look at the Sheik al Amin
Ali bin Mazrui.

Sheikh Al Amin Mazrui (1891AD-1974 AD)

| P a g e 151

 

 

 

 

 

His birth and early life.

His full name was Sheik Al-Amin bin Ali Abdallah al Mazrui from the Mazrui family. This was the
family which  had  been  given  the  guardianship  of  Mombasa  town  after  the  expulsion  of  the
Portuguese by the Sultan of Oman since they originated from Oman. His grand father,Abdallah al-
Mazrui was an Islamic scholar belonging to the Shafi School of law. He was born in Mombasa 1891
on 15th Jamadu-Thani 1380 A.H/27th January 189.His father passed away when he was four years
old and thus his paternal Uncle Sheikh Suleiman bin Ali-Mazrui took the responsibility of raising
him who later married him off to his own daughter. He died on 1st April 1947 having left behind
three children, among them two sons  (Harith Al-Amin Al-Mazrui-former Liwali of Lamu and
Professor Ali Mazrui-Jomo Kenyatta University of Agriculture and Technology) and a daughter.

 

His Educational background.

He started his elementary education under his Uncle Sheikh Suleiman bin Ali who was a great

scholar of that time and had studied various branches of knowledge. This branches included; Quran, Arabic language, Fiqh among others. His great thirst for knowledge made him travel to Zanzibar to further his education under the eminent scholars of Zanzibar likeSheikhAbdallahMohammad bin Salim Bakathir and Sayyid Ahmed Bin Abu Bakar bin Sumeyt.He later went to Lamu and graduated from Riyadh mosque under the supervision of re-known scholars of that time. He was a brilliant student and outstanding in all the subjects and he used to emerge top of the class.He was able to bring reforms in some of the Islamic scholarly works across the world.

Among the Muslim scholars who greatly influenced him are the following:

  1. Sheikh Jamalu-ddin Al-Afghani
  2. Sheikh Muhammad Abdul
  3. Sayyid Mohammad Rashid – Ridha

 

His works

  1. He wrote Hidaayatul Atfaal (Guidance of children) which is an introductory book to Islam
    for the children.
  2. He book entitled ‘Masomo ya dini’ (religious studies) is essential for the Swahili speakers.
  3. Majmaul Bahrayn (The meeting of two seas) is another essential publication in the study of
    Islamic religion.

 

 

 

| P a g e 151

 

 

 

 

 

 

  1. He wrote a weekly paper known as Al-Islah which constituted both Islamic teachings and
    political issuesin Kiswahili and Arabic using the Arabic script. The message in this paper
    was aimed at positively changing the societal way of thinking.
  2. He translated part of the Quran into Kiswahili, that is Sura al Fatiha, Al Baqara and and a few
    verse of Al-Imran.

 

Achievements and Contributions of Al Amin Ali bin Mazrui.

Ø He authoured many publications. Typical among them being,

Ø He was the first to write books in Kiswahili to cater for the learning needs of his immediate
community.

Ø He established Madrassatul Ghazali-l Islamiyya, a learning institution in which he taught
Islamic studies to students from all over East Africa.

Ø He donated most of his scholarly works to the libraries at the coast. Ø Become the Kadhi of Mombasa in 1932.

Ø He gave many Islamic lecturers in the mosques other Islamic institutions.

Ø He become the Chief Kadhi of Kenya in 1937after the death of his uncle Suleiman bin Ali al
Mazrui.

Ø He is known for his efforts in propagating Islam all over East Africa. He used move all
around East Africa giving lectures.

Ø He was a writer, poet and editor of Kiswahili and Arabic languages.

 

 

Sheikh Abdullah Swaleh al-Farsy

Birth and early life

 

He was born on 12thof February, 1912 at Jongeani village in the Island of Zanzibar. He came from a
large and well established family; respected for the servicesthey used to provide in both educational
and civil life to the citizens of Zanzibar and PembaHe was the eldest child in this family. He studied
Quran recitation from Fatma Hamid Said who was a student of a renowned scholar, Sheikh Amin
Ahmed.

At a very young age, sheikh Abdullah memorized the Quran with its correct recitation and a large portion of Hadith. He did not engage in leisurely activities as the other young people. At the age of twenty years he was so fluent and competent in Arabic Grammar and Nahwi that he could write poems in Arabic.

 

| P a g e 152

 

 

 

 

Educational back ground

After completing the first phase of Islamic traditional education at Masjid Barza,Sheikh al-Farsy joined the first government school in Zanzibar at the age of ten;the Central Primary School of Zanzibar. He was so dedicated to attaining religious and secular education and he made use of both the afternoons and evenings to study. He was always seen engrossed in any new Islamic book and spent most times in his home library reading.

Zanzibar had retained some of the centuries old Islamic educational institutions. He therefore learnt from  intellectual  scholars  like  Sheikh  Abubakar  bin  Abdullah  Bakathir,  Sheikh  Ahmed  bin Muhammad Al- Mlomry who taught him twenty five books and Sheikh Sayyid Alawy bin Abdul Wahab who taught him twelve books on Fiqh and Arabic. He then went to Kenya to seek more knowledge where he studied tafsir under Sheikh Al Amin bin Ali. He also studied Risalatul Jamiaat, a book on basicprinciples of Fiqh from Sayyid Hamid Maasab.

 

While he was in the secular school, he always emerged ahead of the other students in every subject. His excellence led him to completing eight year primary education in five years. He then joined a Teachers’ Training r ollege from which he graduated in1932.

He became a primary school teacher between 1932 and 1947 and, following a series of promotions for his good work, he was appointed the Inspector General of primary schools in Zanzibar and Pemba between 1949 and 1952. He later became the principal of Muslim Academy between 1952 and 1956, before being appointed the head teacher of the Arabic Medium School. In 1960, he went to perform Hajj after which he left the ministry of education in 1967 and became a teacher at the Teacher’s Training r ollege.

 

In 1960, he was appointed the chief Kadhi of Zanzibar, a post he held for seven years. It was after
the bloody CRUSADE incident in the name of Zanzibar Revolution in 1964 that he migrated to
Kenya. He was hosted by Sheikh Muhammad Kassim Al-Mazrui his former class mate in the class
of Al-Amin Ali Mazrui. Since his reputation as a scholar had reached far including Kenya, Sheikh
Muhammad Kassim Al-Mazrui recommended him to the late Jomo Kenyatta for the post of Chief
Kadhi of Kenya. He accepted the appointment and served for fourteen years until his retirement in
1980.

 

| P a g e 153

 

 

 

In addition to teaching and preaching, he was a prolific writer. He used mwongozo wa Zanzibari to translate the Qur’an and answer questions from the masses. He wrote the biography of the prophet and that of Imam Shaffi. He also wrote a Kiswahili translation of the Qur’an in order to counter the translation of Dr. David Living Stone and Fr.Godfrey Dale of the University Mission to Central Africa (U.M.C.A) church of Zanzibar who had written a very shallow translation that was used by the preachers to defend Christianity. This Quran translation was also to clarify the misconception of the Qadianis who preached of the coming of another Prophet after Muhammad by the name Mirza Gulam Ahmad from Qadiani village in India.

Sheikh Abdullah Swaleh al Farsy passed on (died) on 9th November, 1982, just eight months after he had left Kenya to join his family in Muscat, Oman.

 

His works

  1. He translated the Qur’an in Kiswahili i.e. “Qurani Takatifu.” Its first copy was published in
    1969.
  2. He wrote the biography of the prophet.
  3. He also wrote the biography of Imam Shaffi.
  4. His Kiswahili publication was sura za swala na tafsiri zake.
  5. He also authored upotofu wa tafsiri ya Makadiani.
  6. He used to write the translation of the Qur’an in the weekly Mwongozo wa Zanzibar
    Magazine.
  7. He wrote a book entitled Bid’a in which he fought against innovations (Bid’a).
  8. He wrote a book on mirath (inheritance).

 

His achievements and contributions

 

  1. He served in the field of education as a head teacher in Muslim Academy, Secondary School
    and Arabic Medium School.
  2. He was appointed the Inspector General of primary schools in Zanzibar and Pemba to
    spearhead the quality of education in these states.
  3. He proposed that community schools be staffed with Islamic teachers who should be paid by
    the government.

| P a g e 154

 

 

 

  1. He travelled to Nyasaland (Malawi) and Southern Rhodesia (Zimbabwe) to give lectures on
    Islamic Religious Education.
  2. In his position as a Chief Kadhi of both Zanzibar and Kenya he lodged defence against all
    accusations directed to Islam and Muslims.
  3. He called for the establishment of separate schools for the Muslims.
  4. He wrote books strongly supporting provision of education and saw illiteracy as a menace to
    both the government and its citizen.
  5. He urged the East African Muslims to adhere to the teachings of the Qur’an and the Sunnah
    of the Prophet. As a result a number of young men became interested in studying Islam.
  6. He used the voice of Kenya radio to aireducative programs about Islam.

10.He wrote several religious books in both Arabic and Kiswahili that enlightened Muslims
about their religion.

11.He travelled throughout East Africa giving public speeches and lectures about Islam which
resulted in many embracing Islam.

12.He volunteered free services to the Radio of Zanzibar to propagate Islam.

13.He started campaigns against Bid’a (innovations) and refused Qadianism.

14.In Kenya, he was exposed to public debate where he criticized some of the traditional beliefs
including shirk and traditional dances.

15.He became a catalyst to the young men by giving mosque seminars.

Suggested study questions and class activities

Answer the following questions in your I.R.E revision exercise books.

  1. Describe the early life of Sheikh Abdallah Swaleh Al-Farsy.
  2. Explain the contributions made by Abdallah Swaleh Al-Farsy to the spread of
    Islam in East Africa.
  3. Discuss the contribution made by Sheikh Al-Amin Mazrui in promoting
    education in Kenya
  4. Outline the literary works left behind by of Al-Amin Ali Mazrui.

 

Activities

  1. Compare the achievements and contributions of Sheikh Al Amin bin Mazrui
    and Abdallah Swaleh al Farsy.
  2. Find out from your immediate community some of the prominent Muslim
    scholars and identify the common factors that can be attributed to their success
    in the field of Academics.

Best Agriculture Notes Form 1 Free (Editable)

AGRICULTURE FORM 4

Livestock Production V (Poultry)

Introduction

  • Poultry industry in Kenya has developed tremendously due to the use of artificial incubation and brooding and easy availability of hybrid birds, both eggers and broilers.
  • Poultry production has become an easy source of income and food for the rural as well as the urban communities.
  • The term poultry includes domestic birds such as turkeys, ducks, geese, pheasants, doves and pigeons.
  • Of late ostrich farming has become a lucrative activity.
  • Poultry production starts with incubation of eggs.

 

 

 

Parts of an Egg

  • Shell
  • Forms 10-12% of the whole egg content.
  • Made of calcium and phosphorus.
  • Protects the inner egg contents.

 

  • Shell membrane
  • Made of inner and outer membranes.
  • Lining of the egg shell.

 

  • Constitutes 1 % of the total egg content.
    • Albumen (egg white)
  • About 55-60% of the total egg content.
  • It is divided into chalaza, thick and thin albumen.

 

  • Chalaza holds the egg yolk in position.
  • Albumen serves as food for the chick.
    • Yolk
  • 30-33% of the total egg content.

 

  • Supply embryo with nutrient
  • Germinal disc -The embryo which develops into a chick if fertilized.
  • Vitelline membrane – Gives the yolk its round shape.
  • Air sac
  • Keeps the egg fresh by allowing gaseous exchange.
  • Provides oxygen for the embryo

Egg Candling:

  • This is the practice of determining the internal qualities of an egg by examining it against a light source.

Procedure

 

  • The egg is placed on a hole made on a .cardboard box.
  • This is called a candling box.
  • A source of light is placed in the box directly under the egg.

 

  • The observer then looks through the egg against the source of light below.
  • Abnormalities on and within the egg can be seen through the translucent shell.

 

Incubation

  • Involves the provision of fertile eggs with the proper condition for embryonic development.

 

Selection of Eggs for Incubation

 

  • Should be fertile.
  • Should be of medium size about 55- 60gms in weight.
  • Should have smooth shell.
  • Should be oval shaped.
  • Should not be cracked.
  • Eggs should be clean to ensure that pores are open.
  • Should not have abnormalities such as blood spots, meat spots and double yolk.   .
  • Eggs should not be more than 5 days old.
  • Eggs should be fresh that is collected within one week.

Internal egg qualities can be determined through the egg candling process.

Methods of Incubation

Natural Incubation

  • This involves the use of a broody hen which sits on the eggs to provide them with conditions necessary for hatching.
  • Takes 20-21 days.
  • The hen is given about 10-15 eggs.

Signsof Broodiness in Poultry

  • Tendency to sit on an egg after laying.
  • Moulting of the hen.
  • Making some noise at the laying nests.
  • Feathers are raised.
  • It becomes aggressive when disturbed.
  • It stops laying.

Preparation and Management of Natural Incubation

  • The hen is given “China eggs” to sit on to induce broodiness.
  • When broody the hen should be provided with a nesting nest or a saucer­shaped nest scooped on the ground.
  • The nest shall be lined with soft bedding and fertile eggs provided.
  • The eggs are set in the evening or night.
  • The bird is dusted to control external parasites.
  • The hen is allowed t hour outside to feed and exercise everyday.
  • Broken eggs should be removed immediately.
  • The hen should not be disturbed.

Advantages of Natural Incubation

  • It is cheap.
  • High hatchability.
  • Low risk involved.
  • Useful in small scale production.
  • Less skill is required.
  • Less laborious.

Disadvantages of Natural Incubation

  • Egg production is low because the hen will not lay eggs during incubation.
  • It is not possible to plan when to incubate.
  • If the hen dies the eggs will be destroyed.
  • If the hen deserts the eggs or refuses to sit on them the farmer will incur losses.
  • Only few chicks can be hatched at a time by one hen.
  • Diseases and parasites could easily be transmitted to the chicks.

Artificial Incubation

  • This is the use of artificial device known as an incubator for hatching eggs.

Conditions Necessary for Artificial Hatching of Eggs

  • Temperature – maintain at 37.5°C-39.4 °C throughout to control the rate of embryonic development of the chick. High or low temperatures are lethal.
  • Ventilation – Good air circulation.
  • Carbon dioxide: oxygen ratio maintained at 0.03%:21 %.
  • Relative humidity – Maintained at 60%.
  • High humidity leads to marshy chicks
  • low humidity the chick may stick to the shell.
  • Turning of Eggs –
  • Done 3-4 times a day to facilitate uniform distribution of heat for uniform development of chick.
  • Turn slowly 180 ° clockwise along the axis to avoid breaking the blood v
  • Some incubators have automatic turning mechanism.
  • Cleanliness – cleaning and disinfecting the incubator with formaldehyde solution.

Advantages of Artificial Incubation

  • It facilitates large scale production of chicks.
  • Incubators are always ready when needed.
  • Artificial incubation leads to higher egg production because broodiness in the hens is not required, so there is more time for laying eggs.

 

Disadvantages of Artificial Incubation

  • High initial capital in buying an incubator.
  • High level of management and attention is required.
  • It is not economical for only a small number of eggs.
  • High risks involved in turning the eggs.

Brooding and Rearing of Chicks

  • Brooding is the rearing of day old chicks upto 8 weeks old for the layer chicks and 2 weeks for the broiler chicks.
  • For successful brooding the source of the chicks should be considered.

Sources of Chicks

The following factors should be considered:

  • The reputation of the supplier (hatchery).
  • Time taken by the chicks in transit.
  • Proper sexing and breed identification.

Brooding

Natural Brooding

  • A hen is allowed to take care of the chicks.
  • She provides them with warmth and security.
  • She stays with the chicks for 8 weeks and then rejects them.

Advantages

  • It is cheap.
  • Less labour is needed.
  • Suitable for small scale.

Disadvantages of Natural Brooding

  • Not possible to produce large numbers of chicks.
  • The hen goes off laying during brooding time.
  • Only possible when a broody hen is available.

Artificial Brooding

  • The chicks are raised artificially in a structure known as a brooder until they are 8 weeks old.

Brooder Requirements

  • Temperature – should be about 35°C in the 15th week and reduced to 21°C by the 8th week.
  • Litter – wood shavings which are capable of absorbing 60% moisture without showing wetness should be used.
  • Space confinement – Done by use of hardboards which are about 25cm high and form a circular space. A space of 1m2 for 25 chicks is required.
  • Feeders and waterers – should be enough for the chicks and evenly distributed in the brooder.
  • Ventilators – windows should be enough to allow proper air circulation but direct draught should be avoided.

Types of Heaters in the Brooder

  • Electric heaters – one ordinary bulb 100 watts can raise 30 chicks.
  • One infra­red bulb 240 watts can raise 100 chicks.
  • Kerosene burners – Hurricane lamps can raise 100 chicks.
  • Charcoal burners – these are specially made jikos with heat deflectors.

Brooder Management

Preparation Before Chicks Arrive

  • Start 2-3 days before arrival.
  • The brooder house should be cleaned to remove old litter and then disinfected.
  • New litters 5-1Ocm high should be put in and covered with absorbent materials/news papers.
  • Equipment should be cleaned, disinfected and tested to make sure that they are working.
  • The brooder is lit about 6 hours before the chicks arrive.
  • Feed and water should be placed into shallow containers.
  • Brooder space should be confined with a hard board to prevent chicks straying far from the source of heat.

Management After Arrival of the Chicks

  • Chicks are placed in the brooder during the day to familiarize with the brooder.
  • If chicks arrive stressed and weak they should be given glucose solution in the waterers.
  • In case the heat source is charcoal burners they should be covered with wire mesh.
  • Feed chicks with chick mash which is later mixed with growers mash as the chicks grow.
  • Clean water should be provided and changed regularly.
  • Constant attention should be given to the chicks for the first 2 weeks.
  • Any vices should be checked and controlled.
  • Any dead chicks should be removed as soon as seen.
  • Ventilation should be used to control the temperature and humidity in the brooder.
  • Constant disinfection is required at the entrance to avoid diseases.
  • Brooder space should be increased as the chicks grow.
  • Debeaking should be done at 10 days old.
  • Vaccination against diseases such as Gumboro after 2 weeks, New Castle at 3-4 weeks and fowl typhoid at 7 weeks.
  • Dusting to control external parasites.
  • Growers’ mash should be introduced gradually at 7 weeks old.
  • Chicks are removed from the brooder when they are 8 weeks old.
  • On average the chick uses about 1.5kg – 2.2kg of chick mash by the time it is 8 weeks old.

Temperature Control in the Brooder

If the brooder temperatures are low the following should be done:

  • Brooder space is reduced.
  • Heaters are increased.
  • Ventilators are closed.

If the brooder temperatures are too high the following should be done:

  • Brooder space is increased.
  • Heaters should be reduced.
  • Ventilators should be opened.

Management of the Growers

  • The growers are birds at the age of 9 weeks to the point of lay that is at 18 weeks.
  • Growers should be fed on growers’
  • By this time the growers should be occupying the main poultry house.
  • Sick birds should be isolated and treated.
  • A foot bath for constant disinfection should be placed at the entrance.
  • Each bird is fed 115 gms per day of growers’ mash.
  • Greens and soluble grit should also be provided.
  • Clean water should be provided all the time (adilibitum).
  • Drenching against internal parasites should be done by adding a dewormer into the water.
  • Vermins should be controlled.
  • Litter should be kept dry by turning.
  • Vaccination should be done as required.
  • Layer pullets require dimly lit house.

Management of the Layers

  • Layers’ mash should be introduced at 18 weeks and increased gradually.
  •  The birds start laying at 18-21 weeks.
  • The birds should be vaccinated against New Castle and fowl typhoid.
  • Enough floor space roosts, feeders and waterers should be provided.
  • Each hen should be given 120gms per day of layers’ mash.
  • Clean water should be provided adlibitum.
  • Eggs should be collected twice a day at noon and in the evening.
  • Green leaves should be provided to keep the birds busy thus preventing cannibalism and improve the yellow colour of the yolk.
  • Grains should be given in addition to the layers’ mash at the rate of 65gms per bird per day.
  • Soluble grit or oyster shells should be provided at all times for efficient digestion and strong shelled eggs.
  • Layers should be fed according to their body weight and the rate of egg production for example a 70kg bag should feed 100 layers for 4-5 days.
  • Enough laying nests should be provided at least 1 per 5 layers.
  • The laying boxes should be dimly lit to reduce egg eating.
  • Debeaking should be done when necessary.
  • Broken eggs and dead birds should be disposed off properly.
  • The non-layers and cannibals should be culled.

Management of Broilers

  • Broilers are table birds kept for meat production.
  • They have high growth rates or high feed conversion ratio.
  • The objective is to produce a kilogram of quality poultry meat from less than two kg of broiler feed.
  • The broiler chick requires special broiler feed from day old to 4 weeks of age.
  • Broiler starters’ mash or crumbs should be fed.
  • This contains coccidiostat, high level of protein, vitamins and trace elements for early growth.
  • From 4 weeks to 8 weeks they are given broiler follow-on mash or pellets.
  • This feed contains high level of metabolisable energy to ensure a good cover of subcutaneous fat in the finished broiler.
  • From 8 weeks until slaughter finisher pellets should be given to increase the size.
  • Adequate clean water should be provided at all times (adlibitum).
  • High level of hygiene should be maintained to reduce mortality rate.  
  • Birds should be dusted with appropriate pesticides to control external parasites.
  • Deworming should be done routinely.
  • Vaccination against common diseases should be done.
  • Dead birds should be disposed off properly.
  • Broilers should be kept under deep litter system, the house should be well ventilated and well lit.

Poultry Rearing Systems

  • extensive,
  • semi intensive
  • Intensive systems.

The Extensive Systems

Free Range

  • Birds are set free throughout the day to fend for themselves.
  • Birds are confined in night shelters for the night.
  • There is no supplementation.

Advantages

  • Birds eat insects and green leaves therefore less feed is required.
  • Cheap method.
  • Cannibalism and egg eating are reduced since the birds are not crowded.
  • Manure is evenly spread in the runs.
  • Low labour requirement.
  • Birds get plenty of exercises thus helping to keep in good health.
  • No need to provide grit as birds pick it from the soil.

Disadvantages

  • More land is required if a farmer wants to rear many birds.
  • Birds can be stolen or eaten by predators.
  • Eggs get lost in the vegetation or stolen.
  • Eggs get dirty.
  • Difficult to determine layers from non-­layers.
  • Birds get easily infected with diseases and parasites of the area.
  • Breeding programme is not easy to follow.
  • Birds can destroy crops where perimeter fencing is not constructed.
  • Low productivity per unit area.

Semi-Intensive

Fold System

  • Birds are confined in small portable structures called folds.
  • A fold measures 3.5m long, 1.5m wide and 1.5m height.
  • 1/3 of the fold is roofed while the rest is enclosed with wire mesh.
  • Birds get plenty of sunlight.
  • Birds get fresh grass as the fold is moved to new grounds.

Advantages

  • Manure is evenly spread in the field.
  • Less feed is used because birds eat grass.
  • Reduces build up of parasites and diseases since the fold is moved often.
  • Birds are protected from predators.

Disadvantages

  • Few birds are kept per fold.
  • It is laborious since the folds are moved from one place to the other.
  •  Individual egg production record is difficult to keep.
  • The fold does not last long because of
  • high frequency of handling.
  • The return per unit area of land is low.

Intensive System

Deep Litter System

  • Birds are confined in a house throughout their life.
  • The floor of the house is made up of litter which accumulates over time.
  •  Enough feeders, waterers and laying boxes are provided depending on the number of birds and space available.
  • Movable roosts and perches made of timber frames should be provided in the house.
  • Stress and vices should be watched closely and controlled.
  • Eggs should be collected as frequently as possible to prevent dirt and egg eating.
  • The house should be dimly lit.
  • The floor space requirement should be 1m2 per 2-3 birds.

Advantages

  • High stocking rate per unit area of land.
  • Low labour requirement.
  • Fast accumulation of manure.
  • There is control of feeding, egg production and movement of birds.
  • Safety of the birds is guaranteed from predators.
  • No loss of eggs.
  • Useful method when rearing breeding stock.
  • Regular cleaning of the house is not necessary since the litter absorbs the droppings.
  • Easy collection of eggs.

Disadvantages

  • High incidence of cannibalism like egg eating, feather plucking and toe pecking.
  • Pests and disease causing organisms accumulate in the litter.
  • Individual records of the birds are not possible.
  • May be difficult to find litter.
  • Eggs become dirty if laid on the floor.
  • Feeders and waterers may be contaminated by the litter.
  • The system encourages broodiness in hens.
  • High infestation of diseases if the management is below standard.
  • If there is a disease outbreak, it can spread very quickly throughout the house due to the communal housing.
  • High cost of building deep litter house.

Battery Cage System

  • Birds are confined in cages which are placed in the poultry house.
  • The cages are made of wire mesh
  • Each cage contains 1-3 birds.
  • Water and feed troughs together with eggs trays are fitted along the front side of the cages.
  • The floor of the cages should be slanting to allow the eggs to roll out of the cages.
  • Droppings from the cages fall from behind for easy cleaning.

Advantages

  • Records are easily kept therefore culling is easy.
  • Birds do not become broody.
  • More eggs are collected due to restricted movement of the hens and complete control of egg eating.
  • Tender meat is obtained from the culls because the muscles have not been toughened much.
  • Handling is easier than in the other systems and individual attention to hens is given.
  • Stocking rate is very high.
  • Vices are greatly reduced.
  • Eggs are clean because hens do not step on them.
  • The system can easily be mechanised.
  • Birds do not contaminate the food and water.
  • Sick birds can be detected easily and isolated for treatment.
  • Wire floors prevent re-infestation of parasitic worms and coccidiosis.
  • No bullying during feeding.
  • Low labour requirement.

Disadvantages

  • Initial costs for cages, equipment and house are excessively high.
  • Requires high level of management.
  • Higher maintenance costs where automation is used.
  • Birds may get fatigue due to lack of exercises thus lowering productivity.
  • In case of disease outbreak, spreading is very fast.
  • Birds develop bruises on combs, breasts and toes as they stick their necks out-to feed and walk in the cages.
  • Not useful when rearing breeding stock and the rearing of broilers.
  • Cannot be used for brooding young chicks.

Stress and Vices in Chicken

  • Stress is a condition imposed on the birds making them disturbed and uncomfortable.
  • Stress reduces production and brings about poor performance.
  • Vices are habits developed by animals.
  • These affect production and health of the birds.
  • Usually they are bad habits.

Cause of Stress in Poultry

  • Sudden changes in routine management.
  • Presence of strangers in the poultry house.
  • Presence of animals and vermins.
  • Too much noise.
  • Constant and poor handling.
  • Sudden weather changes.
  • Disturbance of the pecking order.
  • Overcrowding
  • Poor hygiene.
  • Disease and pest attack.
  • Lack of food and water.

Control of Stress

  • Poultry house should be kept quiet and constructed away from noise.
  • Poultry house should be insulated to maintain constant temperatures.
  • Parasites and diseases should be controlled.
  • Change in routine management should be gradual.
  • Enough feed and water should be provided.

Vices

  • Feather pecking.
  • Cannibalism (toe and vent pecking).
  • Egg eating.

Pecking and Cannibalism

  • Situation where birds peck at each other resulting in death or injury.

Effects:

  • Feather and body growth rate IS reduce
  • Loss of birds due to death may result from cannibalism.
  • Culling rate is increased (economic loss).
  • The appearance of the carcass is spoiled thereby reducing its market value.

Causes of Cannibalism

  • Overcrowding in the house.
  • High temperatures in the poultry house making the birds uncomfortable.
  • Too bright light.
  • External parasite infestation.
  • Inadequate and incorrect feeding.
  • Idleness of the birds.
  • Greediness of the birds.
  • Disturbances of the pecking order.
  • Prolapses of the rectum which occurs once in a while.
  • Bright light in the lying boxes.

Preventive Measures

  • Ample spacing should be provided on the floor, feeders, waterers and laying boxes.
  • Overheating should be avoided during brooding.
  • The house should be dimly lit for the layers.
  • Laying nests should be darkened and above the groun
  • Dusting should be done to control external parasites.
  • Provide enough balanced ration.
  • Birds should be kept busy.
  • New/strange birds should not be allowed in the house.

Egg Eating

A vice influenced by the following:

  • Presence of broken or soft shelled eggs.
  • Idleness of the birds.
  • Inadequate laying nests.
  • Mineral deficiencies.
  • Bright light in the laying nests.
  • Greediness of the birds.

Preventive Measures

  • Eggs should be collected regularly.
  • Laying boxes raised above the ground.
  • Laying boxes should be darkened.
  • Birds should be given balanced ration.
  • Debeaking should be done as need be.
  • Birds should be kept busy with greens.
  • Birds should be kept according to age groups.
  • Injured birds should be isolated and treated.

Marketing of Poultry Products

  • Poultry products include eggs and meat.

Marketing of Eggs

  • Eggs are delicate and perishable foods and have the highest value when fresh.

The factors considered when sorting out and grading eggs for the market include:

  • Size/weight of the egg – large eggs fetch high prices than small ones. The average weight should be about 57gms.
  • Shape of the egg – The normal egg shape is oval, with a broad end and a narrow end.
  • Cleanliness – Consumers prefer clean eggs.
  • Colour of the shell – Brown eggs are popular with the consumers.
  • Candling qualities – candling is done to determine freshness of the eggs and presence of any other egg abnormalities.
  • Shell texture – should be smooth and without cracks.

Poultry Meat

  • Broilers are slaughtered at the age of 1-2.5months old with a life weight of 1.5-2kgs.
  • The birds are killed and dressed in a clean way before being wrapped in clean bags ready for sale.
  • The meat is sold in hotels and restaurants.
  • Whole birds can be sold live in local markets.

 

 

 

Livestock Production VI (Cattle)

 

Introduction

  • Cattle production is a widely distributed enterprise in Kenya.
  • Most farming communities choose between the exotic and the’ local breeds or their crosses depending on the environmental conditions.
  • Whereas the backbone of beef industry in Kenya is made up of the indigenous animals and their crosses, and based in the somewhat drier areas, the-dairy industry is mainly based on the exotic breeds and their crosses and common in the wetter regions of Kenya.
  • Whatever production undertaken, the returns depend mostly on the management levels provided to these animals.
  • A productive herd starts with good management of the young stock.

Raising of Young· Stock.

  • The young one of cattle is known as a calf.

Feeding Dairy Calves

  • Newborn calves should be given colostrums within the first 3-5 days of their life.
  • Colostrum is important for the following reasons:
  • It is highly digestible.
  • It contains antibiotics.
  • It is highly nutritious.
  • It serves as a laxative.
  • It is highly palatable.
  • Calves can be fed using natural method (direct suckling) or artificially/bucket feeding.

Natural Method

  • In this method, calves suckle the mother directly.

Advantages

  • The calf takes milk at body temperature.
  • The milk is free from contaminants.
  • Less problems of scouring.

Disadvantages

  • Underfeeding of the calf may result.
  • Cows may not let down milk in case the calf dies.
  • Difficult to keep accurate production records.

Artificial/Bucket Feeding

  • The calf is trained to feed from the bucket immediately after birth.

 

The calf is trained as follows:

  • Well measured milk is put in a clean bucket.
  • Index finger is inserted into the mouth of the calf.
  • The head of the calf is lowered slowly into the bucket until the calf starts to drink the milk.
  • The finger is withdrawn slowly as the calf continues to drink from the bucket.
  • The procedure is repeated until the calf gets used to the process.

Advantages

  • Easy to keep accurate production record/milk yields of the cow.
  • Possible to regulate the amount of milk given to the calf
  • The cow does not need the presence of the calf in order to let down milk
  • Easy to maintain high hygiene standards.

 

Disadvantages

  • Laborious
  • Calf may be given cold milk
  • Equipment used and the stockman may be dirty leading to scours

 

Preparation of artificial colostrums

Ingredients used

  • A fresh egg whipped in 0.86 litres of warm water
  • Litre of warm water
  • One teaspoonful of cod liver oil
  • One tablespoonful of castor oil
  • Note; colostrums is fed to the calves three times a day for the first 4 days of life and thereafter twice a day.

 

Weaning of calves

Early weaning

  • Calf is fed on whole milk up to the tenth week then it is weaned
  • Calf is given milk equal to 10% of its body weight up to the 8th week
  • After 8th week, milk is reduced gradually by 1 kg until weaning
  • Calf is given early weaning concentrates and soft forage

 

Early Weaning Guide

Age in weeks Whole milk(kg/day) Concentrates(kg/day)
1 Colostrums ad libitum
2-3 5
4-5 6 0.25kg/day
6-7 6 0.5kg/day
8-9 5 0.75kg/day
10-11 4 1.00kg/day
12-3 1.50kg/day
14-15 2.ookg/day
16 2.ookg/day

 

Late weaning

  • Calf is fed on whole milk up to the 3rd week, when milk is replaced gradually with skim milk.
  • At the age of 3weeks the calf is introduced to calf pellets or pencils and green fodder.
  • The calf is given plenty of clean water.
  • The calf continues to be given additional skim milk up to the age of 14 weeks when maximum amount of milk is given.
  • Skim milk is reduced from 14 weeks to 16 weeks when weaning is done.

 

      Late weaning guide

Age in weeks Whole milk

(kg/day)

Concentrates

(kg/day)

Skim milk

(kg/day)

1 Colostrums ad libitum
2 3.5
3 4
4 4.5 0.25kg/day 1
5 4.0 0.5kg/day 3
6 3.0 0.75kg/day 5
7 1.00kg/day 7
8-14 2.00kg/day 8
15 2.00kg/day 4
16 2.00kg/day 4

 

Rearing of replacement stock

  • The replacement stock includes young heifers and bulls which have been selected for breeding to replace the old stock.

Management Practice

  • Parasite control-Spraying against external parasites and deworming against internal parasites.
  • Disease control-Calves are vaccinated routinely against diseases such as;
  • Blackquater-at 4 months old.
  • Anthrax and Blackquater at 6 months old
  • Brucellosis – 3-8 months old (heifers).
  • Castration – for male calves not selected for breeding.
  • Identification – Suitable methods are used. It allows proper record keeping.
  • Removal of Extra Teats ;
  • These teats are known as supernumerary teats which make milking of the animal difficult.
  • They are clipped off with teat clippers.
  • Dehorning/Disbudding – The removal of horn buds using suitable methods.

Calf Housing

Requirement of a Calf Pen;

  • Should be clean and easy to clean.
  • Be warm and dry.
  • Have adequate space to allow exercise and feeding.
  • Should be properly lit and allow sunlight for Vitamin D.
  • Have proper drainage to avoid dampness.
  • Draught free to prevent chilling.
  • Be well ventilated to allow fresh air.

Types of Pens

These can be;

  • permanent
  • mobile/movable.

Permanent Pens

  • Have a solid floor raised above the ground.
  • The floor should be slanted for drainage.
  • Constructed near the milking parlour.

Mobile/Movable Pens

  • Have an open floor to allow grass into the pen.
  • Easily moved from one place to another to avoid soiling.
  • Kept outdoors in the pastures to allow the calf to nibble on pastures.

Single Housing

  • Calves should be housed singly up to the age of 3 weeks, when they are put in group pens.
  • This is to avoid them licking each other and swallowing hairs which form indigestible balls.

Milk and Milking

  • Milk is the white lacteal substance secreted by the mammary glands of the female mammals.

Composition of Milk

  • Protein – Casein and whey.
  • Fat – Butter fat.
  • Carbohydrates – Lactose
  • Minerals – mainly calcium and phosphorus.
  • Water

Factors Affecting Milk Composition

  • Age of the animal.
  • Conditions of the animal.
  • Stage of lactation and pregnancy.
  • Completeness of milking.
  • Type  of breed.
  • Season of the year.
  • Type of food eaten.
  • Physiological conditions such as diseases.

 

Milk Secretion and Milk Let-down

  • Milk is secreted by the mammary glands which is an accessory gland of the reproductive system.
  • The mammary gland of a cow is known as an udder.

 

 

 

Structure of the Udder

The udder is composed of the following parts:

  • Alveolus cells – synthesize and secrete milk.
  • Lobule – a group of alveolus cells.
  • Lobe – Several lobules grouped together and drained by lactiferous ducts.
  • Gland cistern – space where milk collects from the lobes.
  • Teat cistern – A space where milk collects before emission.
  • Teat -An organ which drains each quarter of the udder.

 

Milk Secretion

 

  • The process of milk secretion is known as lactogenesis.
  • The digested food is taken to the udder via blood vessels.

 

  • In the udder the nutrients are carried into the alveoli cells where metabolic reactions take place to build up these nutrients into milk.
  • A hormone prolactine is secreted by pituitary gland which brings about lactogenesis.
  • The milk secreted is then stored in the upper parts of the udder waiting to be released.

 

Milk Let-Down

 

  • The process of milk let-down occurs naturally when the animal is stimulated.
  • Milk secreted moves from alveolar region through the ducts to the gland cistern.
  • Oxytocin, a hormone secreted by the pituitary gland causes the contraction of the udder muscles forcing the milk down the teats.
  • Oxytocin hormone lasts 7 -10 minutes in the blood stream hence fast milking is important to withdraw the milk.
  • Milk is withdrawn from the teats by gently squeezing them.

 

Factors Influencing Milk Let-Down

  • Presence of the calf.
  • Presence of the milkman/milker.
  • Rattling of the milk equipment.
  • Site of the food/feeding the animal.
  • Massaging or washing the udder.
  • Sight of the milk parlour.

Factors Inhibiting Milk Let-Down

 

  • Beating the animal/inflicting pain to the animal.
  • Presence of strangers and animals for example dogs.
  • Poor milking techniques.
  • Absence of the calf (in case the cow is used to it).

Clean Milk Production

The following factors are essential for clean milk production:

  • A healthy lactating cow.
  • A healthy and clean milker.
  • Clean and properly constructed milking parlour.
  • Clean and disinfected milking equipment.
  • Proper handling of the milk after milking.

Milking Procedure

  • The animals are brought near the milking parlour 15-20 minutes before milking to get into the mood of being milked.
  • Milking materials such as equipment, feeds, ropes, stools and salve are collected and placed near the milking parlour.
  • The animals are allowed into the milking stall one by one as the milking proceeds as follows:
  • The animal is restrained in the stall.
  • Feed is weighed and placed into the feed trough.
  • The udder is thoroughly washed, disinfected and dried with a clean cloth.
  • A strip cup is used to test for mastitis on each quarter.
  • Milking proceeds by squeezing the teats with the full hand. If machine milking the teat cups are placed on the teats.
  • For hand milking start with the hindquarters and finish with the forequarters.
  • Fast milking should take about 8 minutes then end with stripping the udder.
  • The milk is weighed and recorded.
  • The animal is then released.

Dry Cow Therapy

  • This is the infusion of antibiotics into the teat canal of a cow that is preparing for drying off.
  • It prevents bacterial infection which leads to mastitis.

Milk Products

  • Pasteurized milk – milk that is heated and cooled immediately.
  • Ultra Heat Treated (UHT) – milk heated to a temperature of 130-135C, packed and then cooled.
  • Butter – Milk butter fat separated by a process known as churning.
  • Cream -A layer of is: that collects at the top of the milk when left to stand.
  • Cheese – Milk proteins which have been compressed.
  • Ghee – Milk fat made from heating cream or butter.
  • Skim milk – Milk without butter fat.

Marketing of Milk

  • The Kenya Dairy Board regulates the production and sale of milk and milk products through various Dairy Co-operative Societies.
  • Processors and distributors of milk and milk products include;
  • KCC,
  • Brookside Dairies,
  • Tuzo,
  • Delamere Dairies
  • Limuru Dairies.

Marketing of Beef

Done by the following:

  • Individual fanners through the local slaughter house.
  • Livestock marketing division.
  • Kenya Meat Commission.
  • Farmer’s Choice.

Farm Power and Machinery

Introduction

  • Farm power is any form of energy used in the farm to do work.      .

Sources of Farm Power

Human Power

  • Performs light tasks.
  • Quality of work produced is variable.
  • Takes a long time to complete a task.

Animal Power

  • Done by draught animals such as camels, donkeys, horses and elephants.
  • Used in land preparation and transportation.

Disadvantages

  • Slow.
  • Animals are liable to sickness and get tired.
  • Need enough food.

Wind Power

 

  • To pump water from boreholes.
  • To winnow crops such as beans, finger millet and rice.
  • Generate electricity.

Disadvantages

  • Not easy to control and may not be available when needed.

Water Power

  • Irrigation.
  • Grinding mills (to grind maize grains).

Disadvantages

  • Difficult to use in the farm because it is not easy to control.

Biomas

This includes:

  • wood or charcoal
  • biogas power.

Charcoal/Wood Fuel Energy

Uses

  • Provides heat for boiling water and cooking.
  • Dehydrating of some crops.
  • Curing of tobacco.

Disadvantages

  • Exhaustible.
  • It cannot be used directly in some farm operations.
  • Large quantities are required.
  • They are bulky hence difficult to transport.

 

Biogas

Uses

  • Provides heat and light for cooking, boiling water and lighting.
  • Produces electricity.

Disadvantages

  • Only possible where there are animals under zero grazing unit.
  • It is labour-consuming.
  • Large quantities of dung are required.
  • Cannot be used directly in some farm operations.

Fossil Fuels

These include:

  • coal,
  • petroleum oils
  • natural gas.

Uses

  • Petrol or diesel is burned in internal combustion engines to produce power.
  • Kerosene is the main source of power to light rural homes.
  • Natural gas is used for cooking, heating and lighting.

Electrical Power

It includes:

  • hydro-electrical power (HEP),
  • geothermal,
  • nuclear
  • power stored in batteries.
  • Nuclear energy is a potential source of power which has not yet been used in the farms.

Uses of Electrical Power

  • Runs stationary machines such as milling machines, grinding mills, cooling machines and water pumps.
  • Supplies heat and light for operations of brooders.

Disadvantages

  • Cannot be used directly in some farm operations.
  • Lack of electricity in the rural areas.
  • Power failures can lead to high losses.
  • It is costly to install and maintain.

Solar Energy

Energy obtained from the sun.

Uses

  • Provides heat and light.
  • Used by all the plants in photosynthesis.
  • Dehydrating crops such as vegetables, maize grains, beans and hay.
  • Boils water which drives turbines to produce power for minor uses.

Disadvantage

  • Low concentration of energy on cloudy d
  • Expensive In collecting and concentrating equipment.
  • Cannot be used directly in some farm operation
  • Requires skilled labour to install and maintain.

Tractor

  • The tractor has an internal combustion engine which burns petrol or diesel to produce power.
  • This power is then passed to the gear box from where it is transmitted in various ways.
  • The common tractor engine is a four stroke cycle engine.

The four strokes are:

  • Induction stroke.
  • Compression stroke.
  • Power stroke.
  • Exhaust stroke.

Induction Stroke

  • Piston moves down.
  • Inlet valve opens.
  • Fuel and air get into the cylinder.

Compression Stroke

  • Inlet valve is closed.
  • Piston moves up the cylinder.
  • Fuel-air mixture is compressed.

Power Stroke

  • A spark is produced at spark plug, igniting the fuel-air mixture.
  • The increased pressure forces the piston down the cylinder.

Exhaust Stroke

  • Exhaust valve opens.
  • Piston moves up the cylinder.
  • Burned fuel-air mixture expelled.

Advantages of the Four Stroke Engines

  • Produce high power which can do heavy farm work.
  • Have efficient fuel and oil utilization.
  • Perform a wide range of farm operations.
  • Are effectively cooled with water thus allowing the production of large engine size.
  • Exhaust gasses are effectively expelled from the cylinders.

 

 

Disadvantages

  • Are expensive to buy and maintain
  • Their use is limited in some areas;
  • Tractor can only be used on flat or gently sloping areas
  • Require skilled personnel and support services

 

The Two Stroke Engines

 

  • Found in small machines such as mowers, motor bikes, and water pumps which do light jobs in the farm.
  • All the cycles are completed in two strokes of the piston.

        These strokes are;

Induction and compression stroke

  • The piston is at the bottom
  • Piston moves up uncovering the inlet port
  • Fuel-air mixure is drawn in
  • Ignition occurs when the piston reaches the top
  • Piston is forced downward compressing the mixture in the crank.

Power and exhaust stroke

  • The piston is at the top
  • Ignited gases produce pressure which force the piston downwards
  • The piston covers the inlet port and traps fresh fuel-air mixture in the crank case
  • Piston moves further down to uncover the exhaust port
  • Fuel-air mixture transferred from the crankcase to the combustion chamber.

 

 

What Advantages of two stroke engine?

  • Cheap to buy and easy to maintain
  • Economical in fuel consumption
  • Can be used in a wide  range of farmland, including hilly areas
  • Can do small tasks in the farm which would be un-economical to do using the four stroke engine.

What disadvantages of two stroke engine?

  • They produce less power hence cannot be used for heavy duties.
  • They are inefficient in burning fuel to produce power.
  • They are air cooled thus limiting the size of the engine.

Systems of a Tractor

The modern tractor has the following systems:

  • The fuel system.
  • Electrical system
  • Ignition system
  • Cooling system
  • Power transmission system.

The Fuel System

Supplies fuel to the engine.

Categorized into two types depending on the fuel used.

These are:

  • The petrol fuel system.
  • The diesel fuel system

The Petrol Fuel System

Consists of:

  • Fuel tank – storage of fuel.
  • Fuel filter – removes foreign particles from the fuel.
  • Carburettor
  • atomises fuel into spray.
  • introduces fuel-air mixture into the engines.
  • Regulates fuel-air into suitable proportion
  • Fuel pump – forces fuel into the carburettor.
  • Delivery pipe – connects all the devices.

 

Maintenance

  • Cleaning the carburettor regularly.
  • Cleaning the fuel filter in petrol.
  • Cleaning the hole in the fuel tank cap.

The Diesel Fuel System

Consists of:

  • Fuel tank – storage of fuel.
  • Fuel injection pump – pumps diesel through injection nozzles and breaks into fine spray.
  • Fuel filters – remove foreign particles from the fuel.
  • Delivery pipes – connect the various devices.

 

Maintenance

  • Replacing the fuel filter.
  • Bleeding in case air is trapped in the system.
  • Cleaning the sediment bowl regularly.

Structural and Functional Differences Between Petrol and Diesel Engines

Petrol engine Diesel Engine
  • 1.
· It has a carburettor
  • 1.
·     It has an injection pump.
  • 2.
· Fuel and air are mixed in the carburettor
  • 2.
·     The fuel and air are mixed within the
        before it gets into the engine.
cylinder.
  • 3.
· Fuel is ignited by an electric spark.
  • 3.
·     Fuel is ignited by compression of air and
 
fuel mixture in the cylinder.
  • 4.
· It produces little smoke because
  • 4.
·     It produces a lot of smoke since the diesel
       petrol is completely burnt.
is not completely burnt.
  • 5.
· Petrol engine is light in weight and
  • 5.
·     It is relatively heavy in weight and suited
       suited for light duties.
for heavy duties.

 

Electrical System

Consists of the following:

  • Battery
  • Converts chemical energy into electrical energy.
  • Stores electrical energy produced by the running
  • Ignition circuit – provide the electrical required by the spark plugs.

current that produces a spark in the engine.

  • Generator circuit – provide the electrical current that starts the engine.
  • Lighting circuit – supply the electrical current required for the lighting system.
  • Starter motor circuit – starts the engine.

 

Care and Maintenance of a Tractor Battery

  • The level of electrolyte should be kept just above the plate by topping with distilled water.
  • Corroded terminals should be scrapped clean and smeared with grease.
  • The battery should be tightly fixed in a box to avoid spillage and damage.
  • The battery should be fitted correctly on the tractor.
  • The battery should be charged regularly and periodically.
  • In case of long storage the battery contents should be kept upside down.
  • The generator fan belt should always be functional to ensure the battery is always charged.

 

 Ignition System

Consists of:

 

  • Ignition change the low voltage from the battery to high voltage current  required by the spark plugs.
  • Condenser – absorbs the self-induced current in the primary circuit.
  • stores current for a short time.
  • passes electric current to the distribut
  • Distributor – distributes the high voltage current to the spark plugs.
  • Contact breaker – Interrupts the normal flow of current in the primary circuit.

State the Maintenance practices carried on  the Ignition System

  • The carbon deposits on the spark plug electrodes should be removed.
  • The spark plugs whose electrodes are worn out should be replaced.
  • The contact breaker points should be cleaned.
  • The breaker points should be adjusted so that they lie between O.30mm and 0.50mm.
  • The condenser should be replaced regularly.
  • The ignition systems should always be kept dry.
  • Ignition wires with poor insulation should be replaced.

 

Cooling System

  • The cooling system aims at preventing the engine from overheating which would cause piston zeisure in the cylinder.
  • Some tractor engines are cooled by air while others are cooled by water.

State the Characteristics of Air Cooled Engines

  • They are simple in construction.
  • They have fins and a fan blade which assists the circulation.
  • They are light in weight for they have no radiators and water jack

Limitations

  • They get hot quickly and use heavy lubricating oil.
  • The cooling is not adequate under all conditions especially when carrying heavy load

Water Cooled Systems

  • It consists of the radiator, water jackets, water hoses, water pump, thermostat and a fanning mechanism.
  • Water is used to absorb heat from the engine block at a reasonable rate.

Care and Maintenance of Water Cooling system

  • The water pumps should be lubricated regularly.
  • Clean water should be used in the radiator and trash removed from the fins.
  • All pipes should be fitted tightly to avoid blockage.
  • The radiator should be filled with clean water before starting the day’s work.
  • Fan belt tension should be checked regularly and if too tight or too loose should be adjusted accordingly.

Lubrication System

  • This system is aimed at supplying oil to all parts of the engine where friction is likely to occur.

Importance of Lubrication system

  • It helps to increase the efficiency of the machine and reduces the rate of wear and tear of moving parts.
  • It reduces the heat created by the rubbing surfaces and acts as a seal between them.
  • It acts as a cleaning agent because it washes off all the dust, dirt, soot and metal chippings from the oil paths to the sump.

Types of Lubrication Systems;

  • Splash feed type
  • Force feed type
  • Oil mist type

Types of Lubricants

  • SAE 10 – This is thin engine oil which gives little protection when heated.
  • SAE 50 – This is thicker engine oil which is recommended for protecting the bearings.
  • SAE 90 – 100 – These are transmission oils which are recommended for clutch, gear box, wheel lubrication and ball bearings.

 

      Note: SAE Society of Automobile Engines.

Care and Maintenance of Lubrication Systems

  • Old or contaminated oil should not be used for lubrication.
  • Oil should be drained when still hot to avoid sticking on the walls of the sump.
  • The oil filters should be replaced when necessary.
  • The correct type of oil should be used as per the manufacturers’ instructions.

Power Transmission System

  • The function of this system is to transfer power from the tractor engine to the drive shaft, the wheel axle, the power take off shaft and the hydraulic system.
  • The system consists of the clutch, gear box, differential and the final drive.

The power transmitted from the engine is made available for use through the following:

  • The propeller shaft – it connects the gear box to the differential.
  • The power take off shaft (PTO shaft)­ -It is located at the rear part of the tractor and rotates at the same speed as the crankshaft of the engine.
  • Hydraulic system – it is operated by the use of a lever near the drivers seat.
  •  It is connected to the 3-point linkage and helps to lower or raise implements mounted on the 3-point linkages such as ploughs, mowers, planters and sprayers.
  • Draw bar –
  • It is a one-point linkage at the rear part of the tract
  • It serves for the attachment of trailed implements that can be used during harrowing, transportation or rolling.

Tractor Servicing

  • The aim of tractor servicing is to keep the tractor in good and efficient working conditions.
  • Tractor servicing is either;
  • short
  • long term.

List the Short Term Tractor Servicing

 It includes:

  • Checking the engine oil daily by use of a dip stick.
  • If the oil level is low, it should be added.
  • The fuel level should be checked at the start of every day’s work and added if necessary.
  • Water level in the radiator should be checked and if possible topped up.
  • The level of the electrolyte should be checked daily and topped up with distilled water accordingly.
  • Nuts and bolts should be tightened every day.
  • Lost nuts and bolts should be replaced before the day’s work.
  • Grease should be applied by use of grease gun through the nipples.
  • Large sediments from the sediments bowl should be removed.
  • The tyre pressure should be checked daily before the day’s work.
  • The fan belt tension should be checked to ensure that it deflects between 1.9cm and 2.5cm when pushed.
  • The brake shaft bearing should be greased.
  • The brake fluid level is maintained at the recommended level.

Long Term Services

  • The engine oil should be drained completely from the oil sump and replaced with new oil.
  • The gear box oil should be checked and refilled as recommended.
  • The oil in the differential should be replaced as recommended.
  • The linkage and the pulley attachment should be greased.
  • The pulley oil level should be checked and added if need be.
  • The dirty oil should be removed and replaced with clean one.

 

Farm Machinery

Tractor Drawn Implements

 

  • These are implements which are attached to the tractor during opera

State the two categories. Tractor Drawn Implements

 

  • Onepoint hitch implements ;
  • Are attached to the tractor at only one point that is, the draw bar.
  • They include all trailed implements such as the trailers, heavy harrows, planters and roller
  • Three point hitch implements;
  • Are implements attached to the tractor at three points that is, the top linkage point and two lower linkage point
  • They are operated by the hydraulic system.
  • They include ploughs, most harrows, sub­soiler, planters, mower, ridgers, sprayers and rotavators.

 

Trailers

  • They are one-point hitch implements.
  • They are used for transportation of goods.
  • Small ones have two wheels while big ones have four wheels.

 

Maintenance

  • All the moving parts should be lubricated.
  • Tyre pressure should be adjusted to the correct pressure.
  • Worn out tyres should be replaced.
  • Loose nuts and bolts should be tightened, worn-out ones should be replaced.
  • The implements should be kept under a shed during long storage.

 

Ploughs

 

  • They are primary tillage implements.
  • The common type of ploughs include:
  • Disc plough
  • Mould board ploughs.

Disc ploughs

 

  • It is made up of heavy steel concave discs of 60-70cm diameter.

Parts and Functions of a disc plough

  • The hitchmast:
  • Is an attachment for the three point hitch.
  • Made up of two side links and a top link.
  • These are parts connected to hydraulic system of a tractor for lifting and pulling.
  • The beam: Supports all other parts. It also adds weight for better penetrati
  • Depth wheel:
    • Used when driving on highway,
    • it also controls the depth of plou
    • May not be present in all disc ploughs.
  • The standard or leg: Connects the discs to the beam.
  • The hub: Allows the discs to rotate smoothly hence does the cutting of furrow slices.
  • The scrapers: Remove the trash and mud or soil which cling to the discs,
  • Disc blades: Cut and invert the furrow slice
  • Rear furrow wheel: Controls the depth of digging and stabilises the discs.

 

Adjustment           .

  • The cutting angle should be adjusted at 35° – 50° from the I ine of travel.

Achieved by pivoting the beam or the standard.

  • Depth of digging: This is corrected by changing the height of depth wheel or adjusting hydraulic system and adding weight

Care and Maintenance of Disc Plough

  • Check for loose nuts and bolts and replace them.
  • Sharpen the disc blades if blunt.
  • Lubricate the rotating parts by use of oil/grease to reduce friction.
  • Paint the exposed parts for example the beam/framework.
  • Clean the implement at the end of each day’s work before storage.
  • Store the implements in a shed.
  • The unpainted parts should be coated with old engine oil to prevent rust.

Uses of a Disc Plough

      Used in areas with the following conditions:

  • Virgin land with many obstacles.
  • Land with too much trash or tall vegeta
  • Opening up pasture land.

Mouldboard ploughs

  • This primary tillage implement is suited in areas without obstacles such as stones, tree stumps, and roots.
  • It gives a uniform depth of ploughing.

 

 

 

Parts and Functions Mouldboard ploughs

 

  • Share: This makes the horizontal cut and starts the turning of the furrow slices.
  • Mouldboard: Continues the turning of the furrow slices and pulverizes the soil.
  • Disc coulter: Makes a vertical cut in the soil to separate the furrow slice from the un-ploughed land.

 

  • Skim coulter: Removes any trash from between the furrow slices.
  • Frog: It is the part where the share, mould board and the landside are attach

 

  • Landside: Stabilizes the plough and absorbs the side forces created when furrow is turned.
  • Shin: Leading edge of a mouldboard.
  • Knife coulter: Is a vertical knife which cuts trash and earth ahead of the share.

 

Care and Maintenance

  • Lubricate the rolling parts for example wheel bearings and disc coulter bearings.
  • Paint scratched parts of the plough.
  • Sharpen the share or replace if worn out.
  • Check all loose nuts and bolts and replace where necessary.
  • Clean the implement after each day’s work to remove soil, mud and trash.
  • For long storage, keep under a shed and apply lubricants.

Adjustment

 

  • Depth:
  • Controlled by raising or lowering the depth wheel.

 

  • Controlled by hydraulic control lever setting.

 

  • Pitch: controlled by altering the length of the top li

 

  • Front furrow width: Controlled by cross shaft adjustment lever or by rotating the cross shaft crank.

 

  • Lateral levelling: Controlled by tractor lift rod.

 

 

Operational differences between a disc and a mouldboard

Disc Plough Mouldboard Plough
  • 1.
  • Suitable on field with stones,
  • 1.
  • Cannot be used on fields with stone,
               roots and stumps.
        roots or stumps.
  • 2.
  • Does not invert the furrow slices
  • 2.
  • Inverts the furrow slices completely.
       completely.
 
  • 3.
  • More secondary operations are
  • 3.
  • Fewer secondary operations are
        necessary after it has been used.
needed.
  • 4.
  • Cuts at varying points.
  • 4.
  • Operates at uniform depth.
  • 5.
  • Not easily broken by obstacles.
  • 5.
  • Can easily be broken by obstacles.
  • 6.
  • Requires less power to operate.
  • 6.
  • Requires more power to operate.

 

 

Harrows

 

  • They are secondary cultivation implements.
  • There are different types of harrows.
  • The common ones are:
  • disc, Harrows
  • spring tine Harrows
  • spike tooth harrows.

 

Disc Harrows

 

 

  • It comprises of a set of gangs with concave discs.

 

 

 

Uses

  • Mixing the soil particles.
  • Levelling the seedbed by breaking large
  • lumps of soil.
  • Killing weeds.

 

Disk harrows can be classified according to the arrangement of the gangs such a;

  • s tandem,
  • double tandem
  • offset tandem.

Depth Adjustment

 

  • Adding weights on the harrows.
  • Use of hydraulic force.
  • Use of light or heavy harrows.
  • Use of regulating wheels.

Care and Maintenance

  • Check for loose nuts and bolts daily.
  • Lubricate the shafts and bearings.
  • Clean and oil before storage.

 

Spring Tine Harrow

  • Is made up of flat and curved tines which act as springs.

 

 

    Uses

 

  • Levels and smoothens the seedbed.
  • Breaks the soil clods.
  • Mixes trash and soil thus preventing wind erosion.
  •  Aerates the soil.

Adjustments

 

  • Depth is controlled by the horizontal connecting link and depth wheel.
  • For individual tine, use crossbar and loosening the screws.

Care and Maintenance

  • Check for loose nuts and bolts and tighten them if necessary.
  • Clean after use.
  • Oil the lever mechanism.

Spike Tooth Harrows

 

  • Consists of a metal framework with rigid metal spikes which break up the soil by vigorously hitting large lumps of soils as it is pulled through the soil.

      Uses

  • It smoothens and compacts the soil.
  • It breaks big lumps of soil into small particles.
  • Can be used for cultivating small crops if well set.

Subsoilers

  • Heavy and require high horse power to pull.
  • Ploughing depth of 51-90cm.

 

Functions

 

  • Break up compacted soil.
  • Break up the hardpan.

Care and Maintenance

  • Clean it after use
  • Check the point and if worn out, replace it.
  • Oil when not in use.

Ridger

  • It is double mould board plough used to make ridges and furrow
  • It is used to prevent water logging and draining through furrows for easy harvesting of root crops.

 

Rollers

  • This is an equipment used to compact the soil gently especially where tiny seeds are to be planted.

 

Rotavators: (Rotary cultivators)

  • Work on the principles of high speed of revolving flail blades which beat and cut the soil together with trash.
  • It is an equipment for both primary and secondary tillage operations.
  • It is driven by the P.T.O. shaft of a tractor.

    Uses

  • Breaks up large soil particles into small ones.
  • Mixes the vegetation and the soil.
  • Achieves two operations in one pass.

    Adjustments

  • Forward speed of the tractor gives a fine tilth of the seedbed done through the gearbox.
  • Depth of work done by control of depth wheel.
  • Slip clutch may break in case the knives come across obstructions

Mowers

Uses

  • Cutting grass for hay or silage making,
  • cutting overgrown grass
  • clearing the field.

Reciprocating Mower

Parts and Functions

  • Swath stick: Keeps the cut crop falling correctly.
  • Swath board: To remove the cut crop.
  • Shoe: Has a runner to absorb the weight and wear.
  • Cutter bar: Is a flat bar which guides the fingers.
  • Wear plate: Counteracts downward force and holds the knives.

      Adjustments

  • To adjust knife register by moving the whole bar away or towards the yoke.
  • Knife lead: The outer shoe should be adjusted to be outer than the inner shoe by 4cm.

Maintenance

  • Check for loose nuts and bolts and tighten where necessary.
  • Keep knife section sharp.
  • Lubricate the knife parts.
  • Check knife to ledger plate cup for best cutting.
  • Keep all the parts tight.

 

Rotary Mowers

  • Cutting edge consists of two blades fitted opposite to each other on horizontal disc.
  • The cutting blades swing round at high speed horizontally to the ground hence cutting is affected.

Adjustment and Maintenance

  • Blades should be sharp.
  • Guards to be fitted around the blades to protect the operator from flying objects.
  • Lubricate the P.T.O. shafts.
  • Check the gear-box oil regularly and fill to the right level if necessary.

Planters

  • They are machines used for sowing seeds.
  • There are two types:
  • Row crop planters.
  • Seed drills.

 

Functions of the Planters

 

  • Meter the seed and fertilizers from seed and fertilizer
  • Open the seed furrow.
  • Deposit the seed in the furrow through the delivery tubes.
  • Cover the seed

 

Functions of Parts of a Seed Plate

 

  • Filler plate: gives proper seed depth.
  • False ring: allows the seed to fall from the seed plate into the boot.
  • Knockout pawl: pushes the seeds out of the cell by the roller action.
  • Cut-off pawl: prevents more than one seed remaining in a plate cell.
  • Cells: shaped holes to hold the seed.

 

Adjustments

  • Adjust the coulters depth for the right crop.
  • Fix the right seed plate.
  • Place the planter in the level position.
  • All the shafts should be free to turn.

 

Care and Maintenance

 

  • Check all loose nuts, bolts and tighten them.

 

  • Clean and oil the planter after use.
  • Grease the drive sprockets regularly.

 

Seeders

 

  • The grain drill sows grains of wheat, barley, oats, peas, beans and alfalfa seeds.

Parts that can be adjusted to change the sowing rate;

  • Select the side of the feed wheel recommended on the drill charts for the seed-rate.
  • Change the speed of the wheels by changing the gears or sprockets or both.
  • Change the position of the feed gate in the cup.
  • Use reducers below the feed wheel.

Care and Maintenance

 

  • Keep seed and fertilizer hoppers dry and clean after each day’s work.

 

  • Check the drive shaft and lubricate them.
  • Paint the parts for example fertilizer
  • hopper to be shiny

 

Combine Harvester

 

     Use

  • Harvesting cereal crops for example maize, wheat and barley.

It is designed to do the following:

  • Cutting
  • Threshin
  • Winnowing
  • Bagging

Parts of a Combine Harvester

  • Cutter bar – cuts the grain head.

 

  • Pick up reel- direct crop into the cutter bar,
  • Elevator – channels the cut grain to the threshing drum.

 

  • Winnowing ran – fans trash up onto a straw walker and directs it out of the combine harvester.

 

  • Delivery tube – delivers the clean .grains into a collecting tank from where it is bagged.

Maintenance of a Combine Harvester

  • Loose nuts and bolts should be tightened.
  • Remove all foreign materials stuck in the machine at the end of the day’s work.

Ridgers

  • They are used for harvesting tuber crops and for making furrows or ridges.

     Maintenance

  • Lubricate the moving parts.
  • Clean the implement after use.
  • Store under a shed.
  • Repair or replace worn-out or broken parts.
  • Loose nuts and bolts should be tightened.
  • Unpainted parts should be oiled during long storage.
  • Shares should be sharpened if blunt.

Foragers

  • They are tractor mounted and operated by power from the P.T.O. shaft .
  • Used for harvesting forage crops such as Napier grass, sorghum and maize.

    Maintenance

  • Tighten loose nuts and bolts.
  • Lubricate moving parts.
  • Store in a shed.
  • Clean after the day’s work.
  • Repair/replace worn out or broken parts.
  • Unpainted parts should be oiled to prevent rust.

 

Maize Shellers

  • These are stationary implements which are either hand or tractor driven.
  • They consist of. a rotating disc which shell maize grains from cobs.

Maintenance

  • Greasing moving parts.
  • Removing any stuck maize cobs.
  • Repair or replace worn out or broken parts.
  • Store in a shed.

Animal Drawn Implements

Ox Plough

  • Ox-plough is a simple type of a mouldboard plough which is pulled by a pair of oxen, donkeys or camels.

 

 

 

Explain the functions of the following parts of an ox-plough

 

  • Main beam – It is the main component onto which all the other parts are attached.
  • Mouldboard – It inverts the cut furrow slice upside down.
  • Plough share -It cuts the furrow slices.
  • Land wheel- It regulates the depth of plough.
  • Draft rod It is on this rod that a chain is connected on which a yoke is linked.
  • It forms the draught mechanism of the plough.

What are the Advantages of an Ox-Plough Over Tractor­ Drawn Plough ?

  • Less skill is required to operate it.
  • Useful where tractors cannot be used for example steep slopes.
  • Cheap to buy and maintain.

 What are the disadvantages of an Ox-Plough Over Tractor­ Drawn Plough ?

  • Much time is wasted in training oxen.
  • Tedious and laborious to the driver of the animals and the controller of the implement.
  • Animals can be sick or in poor physical state.
  • Extra land is required as grazing fields for the oxen.

Adjustments

  • Depth of plough is controlled by the land wheel and draft rod

 

Care and Maintenance

  • Sharpen or replacing of the worn out share
  • Replacement of worn out parts such as hooks and draw bar assembly.
  • Oiling the shiny parts e.g  mouldboard
  • Wash off the soil after use.
  • Paint the handles, beam and braces to prevent rusting.

 

Ox-Drawn Cart

  • These are small carriages harnessed to the animals by a yoke
  • The small carts have only two wheels bigger ones have four.
  • They are pulled by animals in singles or in pairs
  • Carts are used for transport.

 

Maintenance

 

  • Moving parts should be oiled
  • The yoke should be repaired when worn out or replaced if not repaired
  • Tyre pressure should be checked and adjusted accordingly
  • Repair other damages on the cart.

 

Agricultural Economics III:

(Production Economics)

 

Introduction

  • The agricultural sector is a key player in the economy of our countr
  • It is a major employer and brings a lot of national income through foreign exchan

 

National Income

  • These are the total earnings from goods and services produced by a country in a period of one year.

 Relationship Between Firm and Household

  • A household is considered to be a unit comprising a farmer and family members.
  • It produces raw materials and consumes manufactured goods.
  • A firm on the other hand, is any manufacturing or processing unit which consumes raw materials and produces manufactured good
  • Both household and firm generate income, which in turn, is used to:
  • Improve the standard of living of the household members by paying for essential goods and servi
  • The firms build more industries to create more employment and revenue through salaries and wages.
  • Finance government projects through taxes and hence further national development.

 

 Gross Domestic Product (G.D.P.)

  • This is the sum total of all goods and services produced in a country in a period of one year.

 

 Gross National Product (G.N.P.)

  • Is the sum total of G.D.P. and the difference between income inflow (revenue coming into the country from outside) and income outflow (money going out of the country by foreign investors).
  • It represents the total income earned within the country and from abroad.

 

 Per Capita Income

  • Is the Gross National Income (in terms of revenue) divided by the number of people living in the cou
  • It is not a good measure of the economic well-being of the people because of the uneven distribution of income among th

 

Contribution of Agriculture to National Development

  • The interaction between household and the firm generate income which is used to finance further expansion of the firms.
  • This creates more employment and revenue.
  • The government taxes the income to finance national development programmes such as;
  • health,
  • education,
  • water, energy
  • communication.

 

Factors of Production

  • A factor of production is anything that contributes directly to output, that is, it is a productive resource.
  • Productive resources usually employed in the production of goods and servi

Incl ude:

  • Land
  • Labour
  • Capital
  • Management

 Land

  • As a factor of production, refers to the natural characteristics and properties of a given area of land.
  • The key factor here is productivity for example soil fertility, presence of water and minerals and is always fixed and has no geographical mobility.

 

 Labor

  • Besides being a consumer, human beings are also a factor of productio
  • They provide the labour force (human power) required in the production process.
  • Labour is assessed in terms of productivity and not mere numbers of workers or labourers.
  • Labour is measured in terms of man hours, man days or man mon

The labourer’s productive capacity depends on such factors as;

  • age,
  • health,
  • state of nutrition
  • level of education.
  • The amount of work and the efficiency with which it is performed determines the quality of labour.

Capital

  • Capital refers to all man-made assets that help land and labour to produce.
  • It is categorized into:
  • Fixed/durable;
  • Working capital
  • Liquid capital

 

Fixed/durable;

      Capital for example

  • machinery,
  • buildings
  • permanent improvements on land like fences,
  • roads,
  • irrigation facilities
  • water­ supply system.

 

Working capital;

        Which include consumer goods such as;

  • fertilizers,
  • livestock feeds,
  • fuel in store,
  • pesticides.

 

Liquid capital;

       For example;

  • ready money,
  • bank deposits,
  • shares in financial i

 

Management;

  • It is a process of decision making in the farm.
  • Managers use their knowledge and judgment to decide how to combine the other three productive resources in the best way possible.
  • They make plans, execute them and bear the risks or consequences which such plans entail.

Production Function

    Definition

  • Production function is a physical relationship between inputs and outputs in a production process.
  • It tells the quantity of output (product) that may be expected from a given combination of inputs.
  • Production function may be expressed in table form or graphically as a curve.

 

Examples:

 

Feeding pigs for pork production at varying levels of concentrate feed.

 

Unit of feed Body wt. Marginal
  Gains (kg) products
    (kg)
0 212
10 222 10
20 238 16
30 251 13
30 261 10
50 269 8
60 275 6
70 280 5
80 283 3
90 285 2
100 286 1

 

Types of Production Functions

  • A production function assumes three forms which may be treated as different types:
  • Increasing Returns
  • Constant Returns
  • Decreasing (Diminishing) Returns

 

 Increasing Returns

  • In this type, each additional unit of input results in a larger increase in output than the preceding unit.
  • This shows that resources are under utilized.

Constant Returns

  • The amount of the product increases by the same amount for each additional input; that is constant returns to input factor.
  • Again here resources are under uti

Decreasing (Diminishing) Returns

  • Here, each additional unit of input results in a smaller increase in output than the preceding unit.
  • Resource use is stretched to the maxi
  • It is the most commonly encountered form in agricultural enterprises;
  • It gives rise to the law of Diminishing Returns.

Examples:

  • Feeding dairy cows for milk production with varying amounts of feed.
  • Crop responses to application of varying amounts of fertilizers.
  • Use of varying units of labour on fixed unit of land.

 

Economic Laws and Principles

The Law of Diminishing Returns

 

  • The law of diminishing returns states that;

’’if successive units of one input are added to fixed quantities of other inputs a point is eventually reached where additional product (output) per additional unit of input declines.’’

  • This law is encountered practically in all forms of agricultural production.
  • It is useful in determining the most rational and profitable level of production.

 

Example:

Production of maize at varying levels of N.P.K. fertilizer application on a fixed area of land.

 

 

Unit ofNPK Total Product Marginal
Fertilizer Yields Products
(bags)   (bags)
30 10
60 27 17
90 42 15
120 56 14
150 63 7
180 65 3
210 65 0
240 60 -5
270 52 -8
300 42 -10

 

 

 

 

 

 

Zones of a production function curves

 

 

Zones of a production function curves these are:

  • Irrational zone or Zone I.
  • Rational zone or Zone II
  • Irrational zone or Zone III.

 

  • The three zones are arrived at by drawing two perpendicular lines through the production function curve, one at MP = AP and another at MP=
  • In Zone I resources are not fully utilized while in Zone III, excessive application of resources leads to production decline or loss.
  • It is not economical to produce at these levels.
  • In Zone II resources are maximally utilized resulting in maximum production.
  • It is therefore economical (or wise) to produce at this level.

 

 Principle of Substitution

States-’’if the output in a production process is constant, it is profitable to substitute one input factor for another, as long as it is cheaper than its next alternative.’’

 

  • This principle is applicable in a situation where more than one variable input factors are used.
  • For example feeding hay and concentrates for milk production, farmyard manure and phosphatic fertilizers in the production of maize.
  • The basic problem that the producer wishes to solve when two input factors are used in combination is in what proportions must the variable inputs be combined in order to produce at a minimum cost and hence attain maximum profit.
  • To solve the above problem, the producer must determine the least cost combination of inputs used.
  • The least cost combination is attained at a point where the Marginal Rate of Substitution (MRS) equals the inverse of price ratio of the factors involved.

 

 

That is:

x2 = P X1

 

 

X1= P X2

 

X1 – first input factor

X2– second input factor

 

– change (increase or decrease)

P – price (cost of input fators)

 

Examples:

  • Producing 20 bags of maize using varying combinations of farmyard manure and phosphate fertilizers.
  • Price of farm yard manure (FYM) is KShs10/- per unit and that of phosphate fertilizer is Kshs 50/- per unit

 

 

 

X1 (P-fert) x2 (N-fert) X2(MRS)

X1

100kg units 100kg units  
I 9.00
2 4.00 5.1
3 2.80 1.20
4 2.40 0.40
5 2.00 0.40
6 1.80 0.20
7 1.65 015
8 155 0.10
9 1.45 0.10
10 1.45 0.05

 

 

In the above example, the following assumptions are made:

  • A fixed quantity of output is to be produced.
  • Input factors in combination substitute for one another at varying rates.
  • Relative prices of input factors do not change drastically during the period of production.

NOTE: one input factor substitutes for the other at diminishing varying marginal rate of substitution.

 

Principle of Equimarginal Returns

  • This principle states ;’’ That the last unit of an input factor spent in one enterprise yields a marginal return exactly equal to the marginal return earned from the last unit invested in each of the other enterprises.’’

 

Example

  • If the last shs.100/- spent buying cattle feed will return more than shs. 100/= spent on buying fertilizer for growing maize, then it is advisable to purchase more feed up to a point where the last shs.lOO/- spent on it will return exactly the same as the last shs.100/- spent on fertilizers.
  • This concept is only relevant in a situation where farmers do not have adequate capital to employ inputs up to the level where marginal revenue equals the marginal cost.

 

The principal of Profit Maximization

  • The profit is defined as the difference, in monetary terms, between the total returns (income) and total costs (expenses) in a production process.
  • Profit maximisation aims at obtaining the highest returns at a minimum cost per unit of input factor used.
  • This can be done by considering two concepts.

Marginal Concept

  • Profit is maximised when the marginal (additional or extra) revenue (MR) is equal to, or slightly higher than, the marginal cost (Mc).
  • At this point every added input factor brings in higher returns than the expenses incurred in investing it.

Net Revenue Concepts

  • Profit is said to be maximized in a production process when the Net Revenue (differences between total revenue and total costs) is the highest that is ;

NR = TR – TC.

  • This is arrived at by analyzing the total cost and total revenue earned from a particular enterprise and then subtracting the former from the latter.

 

When calculating the profit using whatever concept, the following assumptions are made:

  • Cost of inputs (such as fertilizers, labour) remains constant during the period of production.
  • Price of the produce (product) remains unchanged.
  • Fixed costs are ignored that is only varying costs directly involved are considered.

 

Farm Planning

  • Planning is the process of establishing the organizational objectives and defining the means of achieving them.

Factors to consider in drawing a farm plan.

  • Size of the farm.
  • Environmental factors.
  • The current trends in labour markets.
  • Farmer’s objectives and preferences.
  • Possible production enterprises.
  • Existing market conditions and price trends.
  • Availability and cost of farm inputs.
  • Government regulations/
  • Security.
  • Communication and transport facilities

Farm Budgeting

  • Farm budgeting is the process of estimating the future outcomes of a proposed farm plan,
  • That is; the future incomes and expenses of a farm plan.

Importance of Farm Budgeting

  • It helps the farm in decision making.
  • It helps the farmer to predict future
  • returns that is planning ahead.
  • It helps the farmer to avoid incurring losses by investing in less profitable enterprises.
  • It helps the farmer to secure loans from financial institutions such as Agricultural Finance Corporation and commercial banks.
  • It ensures a periodic analysis of the farm business.
  • It acts as a record which can be used for future reference.
  • It pinpoints strengths or weaknesses in farm operations.

 

Types of Budgets

 

Partial Budget

  • It represents financial effects on minor changes in a farm organisation.
  • It is necessary when a farmer wants to replace or reduce enterprise.

 

 Complete Budget

  • A complete budget is necessary when the farmer wants to start a new business where both the variable costs and the fixed costs are likely to be affected.
  • It involves a major change or reorganization in the farm business.

 

Agricultural Services Available to the Farmer:

  • Agricultural production efficiency is greatly increased by services rendered to the farming communities by;
  • Government institutions
  • Non-governmental organizations.

Some of these services are:

  • Extension and Training:
  • Banking Services:
  • Credit:

 

Extension and Training:

  • In the field and in farmer’s training centres.

 

Banking Services:

  • These enables the farmers to save some of their farm income and invest them in future projects.

Credit:

  • Credit is a financial assistance advanced to agricultural farmers to finance their farm projects and repay it with interest.
  • It is a borrowed resource.

 

Types of Credit

  • Credit is categorised according to;
  • Time of repayment
  • The types of projects to be financed.

   Examples are:

Short-term Credit

  • Repayable within one year and is advanced for the purchase of;
  • seeds,
  • fertilizers,
  • animal feeds .

 

Medium-term Credit

  • Repayable within 2 – 5 years and is used to finance projects such as;
  • fencing materials,
  • purchase of livestock,
  • light farm equipment .

 

Long-term Credit

  • Repayable period is up to 15 years and even more.
  • It is given for the long-term or durable projects such as;
  • purchase of land,
  • construction of soil and water conservation structures,
  • farm buildings,
  • irrigation projects for perennial cash crops for example;
  • coffee,
  • farm machinery
  • implements.

Sources of Credit

  • Co-operative societies and unions.
  • Crop boards.
  • Commercial banks.
  • Agricultural Finance Corporation.
  • Insurance companies.
  • Individual money lenders.
  • Settlement fund trustee.

Artificial Insemination Services:

  • Provides farmers with semen from improved or superior bulls to improve their livestock herds through controlled breeding.

 

Agricultural Research Organization

  • These develop and pass on to farmers, improved production techniques as well as crop and livestock species with better performance in different ecological zones.

Marketing Outlets

  • These are agencies that ensure effective and efficient conveyance of farm produce to points of processing and consumption.
  • They are largely crop marketing boards or corporations and cooperative societies.

 Veterinary Services

  • In the field are veterinary officers who help the farmer in treating and controlling livestock diseases and parasites.

Farm Input Supplies

  • Farmers are able to obtain their farm inputs from organizations such as co-operatives and private companies.
  • These organizations bring inputs closer to the farmers for example Kenya Farmers Association and private agro­vets.

 

 Tractor Hire Services

  • This involves hiring of tractors and machinery at a cost by farmers who are not privileged to own their own.

 

Sources

  • Ministry of Agriculture
  • Private contractors.
  • Individual farmers.
  • Other service providers.

Risks and Uncertainties in Farming

  • Uncertainty-is the state of not knowing about future events or outcomes.
  • Risks-is the difference (divergence) between the expected and the actual

outcome.

 

Types of Risks and Uncertainties

  • Fluctuation of commodity prices.
  • Physical yield uncertainty.
  • Ownership uncertainty.
  • Outbreak of pests and diseases.
  • Sickness and injury.
  • New production technique.
  • Obsolescence for example machinery may become outdated or obsolete within a short time.
  • Death of either farmer or lives
  • Natural catastrophies such as;
    • floods,
    • drought,
    • earthquakes,
    • storm and strong winds which may destroy crops or kill the animals.

Ways in Which Farmers Adjust to Risks and Uncertainties

  • Diversification.
  • Selecting more certain enterprises.
  • Contracting.
  • Insurance.
  • Input rationing.
  • Flexibility in production methods.
  • Adopting modern methods of production.

 

Agricultural Economics IV:

(Farm Accounts)

 

Introduction

  • Financial and physical records if accurately kept in the farm serve as very important tools in decision-maki
  • The records are kept in several books and statements as follows:

Financial Documents

They include:

  • Invoices.
  • Receipts.
  • Delivery notes
  • Purchase records.

An Invoice

  • This is a document issued by the seller to the buyer for goods taken on credit, and payment to be done later.
  • The original is given to the buyer and duplicate retained by seller.

The invoice shows the following:

  • The buyer and seller.
  • Date of transaction.
  • Amount involved.
  • Invoice number.

A Receipt

  • This is a document issued by the seller to the buyer when cash payment for goods delivered is made.

It shows the following:

  • The buyer and the seller.
  • Date of transaction.
  • Amount involved.
  • Serial number

Delivery Note

  • It is a document which shows that the goods have been delivered.
  • The receiver verifies the goods and then signs on the delivery note.

Features:

The delivery note shows the following:

  • Goods delivered as per order.
  • Quality or condition.
  • People involved in the transaction.
  • Date of delivery.

Journal:

  • It is a book of first entry showing a record of all business transactions arranged in the order in which they occur.
  • Its pages are divided vertically into five sectio
  • The information is posted to the ledger

Inventory:

  • This is a list of all the possession/assets item by item and their market value.
  • Such items are land, livestock, tools and equipment and crops in the store.
  • Valuation is an estimation of the value of each asset or item, based on market price or cost of production.

 Local Purchase Order:

  • Issued by the purchasing officer of the supplier for example school.
  • It shows people involved in the transaction, types and amounts of goods ordered and dates.
  • It should be written and signed by the authorised officer.
  • It is written in duplicate and the original is given to the supplier.

Financial Books

Ledger:

  • Is a book which contains individual accounts.
  • It is a principle book of accounts in which entries contained in all the other books are enter
  • It is a storehouse of all the transactions.
  • Each page is numbered and vertically divided into two equal parts namely credit and debit.
  • Each part is further sub-divided into four sections.

Cash Book:

  • It is a book where transactions involving cash or cheque payments are record
  • It involves cash or cheque payments and receipt
  • It is divided into two parts – debit and credit side.
  • All the receipts of cash or cheque are recorded on the debit and all payments are recorded on the credit side.

Example: Enter the following entries in the cash book.

  • 1.05 -Received shs.2,000 from Ndete by cheque.
  • 7.05-Bought D.A.P. fertilizer and paid cheque of shs. 5,000.
  • 7.05-Received shs.5,000 cash from Ngala.
  • 4.7.05 -Paid water bill for shs 400 in cas
  • 7.05-Paid telephone bill of 1,500 by cheque.
  • 11.05 -Deposited shs.2,000 in the bank.
  • 20.7.05 -Withdrew shs.2,000 from the bank for home use.

 

Cash Book record

           
  DR       CR    
Date Details Cash Bank Date Details Cash Bank
1.7.05 Received from Ndete   2,000 2.7.05 D.A.P   5,000
3.7.05 Received from Ngala 5,000   4.7.05 Water bill 400  
11.7.05 Cash 2,000   9.7.05 Telephone billl 500  
        20.7.05 Cash   2,000

 

 

Financial Statements

 

Cash Account Sheet

  • It involves the recording of sales and receipts, purchases and ex
  • Each sale or purchase is entered twice, once in the total column and once in the analysis column.
  • The sum of all the entries in the total column should always equal the sum of the entries in all the other columns.
  • The cash analysis account sheet is given above.

 The Balance Sheet

  • It is a financial statement of assets and liabilities recorded on a given date.
  • It shows the financial position of a farm business at a glance (snapshot).

Assets are items owned by the farmer,

These include:

  • Property (money, goods and buildings).
  • Debts receivable from other people.
  • Goods and services paid for in advance.

Assets can be divided into two:

  • Fixed assets: assets of permanent nature and not easily converted into cash.
  • Current assets: assets which can be easily converted into cash.
  • Liabilities are claims to the farmer’s property such as bank overdraft and debts payab

They are divided into:

  • Current liabilities – debts which must be paid within a short time.
  • Long term liabilities – debts which are payable over many years or over a long period.

Profit and Loss Account

  • Prepared at the end of a calendar year.
  • It is a final account which summarises the sale and receipts (income flowing in the business) and the purchases and expenses (flowing out of the business).

 

  • Note: If assets are more than liabilities then the balancing factor is net capital (in the liability side) hence the farm business is said to be solvent.
  • If the liabilities are more than the assets, then the balancing factor is a loss (in the asset side) hence the farm business is insolvent.
  • To calculate profit or loss, account, valuation is done by having an inventory of all the assets.
  • Valuation of the assets is determined by market price and cost of  production for machinery and buildings as depreciation factor, is attached.

 

Format of  a balance sheet

Balance sheet of Katilo school as 31-12-2009

 

Assets Shs. Cts. Liabilities Shs. Cts.
Fixed Assets     Long-term Liabilities    
Land     Long-term loan for land development    
Buildings     Loans payable over 15 years    
    Fences and other structures          
Current Assets     Current Liabilities –    
Livestock     -Debts payable    
Debts receivable     -Credits from friends    
Cash in bank     -Short-term loans    
Cash in hand          
Sub-total     Sub-total    
Total     Total    

 

Format

Profit and Loss Account of Kitheko Farm at 31122009

 

Sales and Receipts Shs. Cts. Purchase & Expenses Shs. Cts.
I. Income during the year     I. Opening valuation    
2. Debts receivable     2. Expenditure during the year    
3. Closing valuation     3. Debts payable Balance (being    
  Balance (being a loss)       farm a profit or net income)    
  TOTAL       TOTAL    

 

 

 

 

 

Agricultural Economics V

(Agricultural Marketing and Organizations)

 

Introduction

  • Agricultural marketing is an economic activity which involves the distribution of farm produce from the farm to the consumer.

Market and Marketing

  • Market is an institution for the exchange of goods and services or a place where selling and buying of goods takes place.
  • Marketing refers to the flow of goods and services from the producer to the consumers.

Marketing Functions

  • Transportation – Movement of goods from production centres to the consumption centres.
  • Buying and selling – Purchase of goods from the producer to be sold to the consumer.
  • Storage – Agricultural products are seasonal hence storage is necessary.
  • Processing-Changing of raw form into utili sable form.
  • Grading and standardisation – Sorting into uniform lots of certain qualities.
  • Assembling – Collecting the farm produce from the farm to the market centres.
  • Collecting market information – To know the prices, supply and demand of certain commodities.
  • Advertising – Making the consumers aware of the produce.
  • Bearing of risks – Such as fire risk, price fluctuation.
  • Financing or expenditure on other processe
  • Packaging or putting into small packs and labelling.
  • Packing or putting produce In containers such as bags.

 

Marketing Agencies and Institutions

  • Middlemen (itinerant trader) – are the people who buy from the producer and sell to other agencies.
  • Wholesalers – Buy in bulk and sell to the retailers.
  • Retailers – Buy from the wholesalers and sell in small units to the consumers.

Problems in Marketing Agricultural Produce

  • Farm produce are bulky, that is weight and volume are high but low in monetary value thus difficult to transport.
  • Most of the agricultural products are perishable for example milk, vegetables and fruits.
  • Storage problems (since they are bulky they require a lot of space).
  • Lack of proper transport system since agricultural products are in the rural areas and the market are situated in urban centres.
  • Lack of market information hence farmers are exploited by middlemen.

 

Price Theory

  • Price is the amount of money paid in exchange for goods or services.
  • Price theory is concerned with the determination of price of any commodity.
  • Price is determined where demand for and supply of any commodity are equal to each other.

Demand

  • It is the quantity of any commodity which is purchased at any price within a given time.
  • The law of demand states that quantity demanded changes inversely with the price.

Demand Curve

  • The curve slopes from left to right downwards.
  • This means people buy more at lower prices and vice vers

 

 

Demand Curve

 

 

 

 

Factors Affecting the Demand of a Commodity

  • Population
  • Income of the consumer.
  • New inventions.
  • Taste and preference of the individual.
  • Price of the substitute commodities.
  • Price expectations.
  • Advertisement.
  • Culture and social values of the consumers.
  • Price of commodities having joint demand for example tractors and diesel.

Elasticity of Demand

  • It is the responsiveness of demand to a change in price.
  • Elasticity of demand = Percentage change in quantity demanded

Percentage change in price

 

 

Types of Elasticity of Demand

  • Elastic demand is one where the ratio is more than 1.
  • Unitary elasticity is one where the ratio is equal to 1.
  • Inelastic demand is one where the ratio is less than 1.

 

Supply

  • Supply is the quantity of any commodity which is offered for sale at any price at a given time.
  • The law of supply states that when price rises, quantity supplied increases and when price falls quantity supplied decreases (other factors held constant).
  • The curve rises from left to right upwards.
  • This means that people are willing to offer more for sale at higher prices.

 

SUPPLY CURVE

SUPPLY CURVE

 

Factors Affecting Supply of a Commodity

  • Number of sellers
  • Price of substitute commodities.
  • New technology.
  • Price expectation.
  • Peace and security.
  • Weather conditions.
  • Policy of the government.
  • Cost of production of the commodities.

Elasticity of Supply

This refers to the rate at which quantity supplied changes due to a change in price level.

 

. .                                                           Percentage change in quantity supplied

Elasticity of Supply=    Percentage change in Price

Type of Elasticity of Supply

  • Elastic supply one where the ratio is more than 1.
  • Unitary elasticity of supply is one where the ratio is equal to 1.
  • In elastic supply is one where the ratio is less than 1.
  • One of the problems of agricultural produce is that supply does not readily adjust to price changes.

Equilibrium Price

  • Is the price at which demand and supply are equal.
  • That means whatever is offered for sale at the market is bought.
  • In the graph below, the quantity supplied and demanded are equal at a price of Shs.300 and quantity of 80kg.
  • At this point the price is higher than shs.300 then the supply will be greater than demand and there will be surplus hence price will fall.
  • If, on the other hand, the price is less than shs.300 demand will be greater than supply hence shortage and rise in price.

 

 

 

Agricultural Organization

  • Agricultural organizations are agencies which, through their activities, promote agricultural development.
  • These organizations are co-operatives and statutory boards.

Co-operatives

  • A co-operative is an organisation of people with a common aim of pooling their resources to achieve their objecti

Functions of Co-operatives

A co-operative society carries out the following functions:

  • Collecting and assembling members’ produce.
  • Processing the farm produce after collecti
  • Transportation of members’ produce to market poi
  • Negotiation of fair prices with the purchasing agencies for the members’ produc
  • Purchase and distribution to members of farm inputs.
  • Storage of members’ produce before transmission to market points.
  • Provision of credit facilities to members on easy terms.
  • Training and education of members on improved farming techniques.
  • Offering farm machinery services to their members on hire terms for farm operati
  • Co-operatives may invest in other viable ventures and the profits realised are shared among members in form of dividends or bonu

Formation and Structure of Co-operatives

   The formation of a cooperative takes the following stages:

  • Individuals with common interest collect together to form a primary co- operative society
  • At least ten (10) members qualify for registration.
  • Each primary co-operative society elect their office bearers consisting of chairman, secretary and treasu
  • Several primary co-operative societies are usually amalgamated to form a district co-operative union.
  • Tertiary co-operative unions are nation­wide organizations to which the secondary co-operative unions are affiliate
  • Examples are Kenya Planters Co-operative Union, Kenya Farmers Union, Kenya Co-operative Creameries, Co-operative Bank of Kenya, etc.
  • Apex organization This is represented in Kenya by Kenya National Federation of Co-

operatives which is an affiliate of the International Co-operative Alliance.

Problems Facing Co-operatives

Cooperatives encounter the following problems in their operations:

  • Managerial problems arising from:
  • Financial mismanagement due to poor accounting.
    • Corruption and misappropriation of co­operative resources by the personnel in the syste
    • Lack of advisory services on technical operations.
    • Inability to meet the set obligations of providing credit facilities due to malpractic
  • The nature of agricultural products and associated problems.
  • Bulkiness hence difficulties in transportation and storage.
  • Perishability of produce hence difficult to sustain quality.
  • Inadequate capital to invest in the co­operative undertakings.
  • Transport problems due to poor roads.
  • This hampers the produce getting to the market points in ti

Statutory Boards

  • A statutory board is an organization established by an Act of Parliament and charged with the running or managing of a certain industry within the government s

Marketing Boards

  • Some of the statutory boards are charged with the marketing of certain farm produce and are thus called marketing boards.
  • Examples are the Coffee Board, Pyrethrum Board, Cotton Seed and Lint Marketing Board, Tea Boards, National Cereals and Produce Board, Kenya Meat Commission, the Dairy Board of Kenya and others.
  • Their marketing functions are to look for market and better prices.

 Research Organization

  • These are research centres which among other things, carry out research and trials on:
  • Development of new varieties and cultivars of crops.
  • Breeding disease and pest resistant varieties of crops and types of animals.
  • Adaptations of crop and livestock species to ecological conditions of certain areas.
  • Use of fertilizers and pesticides on crops in specific areas.
  • Development of early maturing and high yielding species.
  • Soil testing and crop analysis. Advisory services of agro-economic aspects.

Other Organizations

Kenya National Farmers’ Union negotiates for:

  • Reasonable and affordable prices of farm inputs.
  • Better prices for farm produce.
  • Better credit facilities.
  • Better control of diseases and pest.

Agricultural Society of Kenya

  • Organizes agricultural shows in the country.
  • Encourages improvement of livestock through exhibitions and educating farmers
  • Organizes the running of young farmers’ clubs.
  • Organizes and finances the ploughing contests during which farmers learn the modern techniques of seedbed preparation.
  • Publish “Kenya Farmers” magazines.

Young Farmers and 4K Clubs.

       These are student organizations whose objectives are:

  • To expose the young students and encourage them to appreciate agriculture as a profession in their career.
  • To encourage the youth to develop leadership qualities through assignment of small farming projects.
  • Organizing students exchange programmes with other club members both locally and abroad.
  • To develop better farming skills through judging competitions, annual rallies and camps.

Agricultural Based Women Groups

  • These are self-help groups whose objective is to uplift the economic status of their members by carrying out agricultural related activities.

    

 Their success depends on the following factors:

  • Commitment of their leaders.
  • Motivation of the members.
  • Sacrifice for each other.

Agroforestry

Introduction

  • In Kenya land use is changing from extensive methods of farming to more productive and sustainable intensive methods.
  • Agroforestry is a method of farming which has become increasingly important.

Definition

  • This is the practice of integrating a variety of land use
  • It combines tree growing, pasture and crop production practice on the same piece of land to improve the output of the land.

 

Forms of Agroforestry

  • Agroforestry;
  • It is a combination of trees/shrubs and crops in agricultural production.
  • Silvopastoral:
  • It is a combination of growing tree/shrubs, pastoral and keeping of livestock.
  • Agrosilvopastoral:
  • It is a combination of growing trees/shrubs, animals, pastures, and crops.

Importance of Agroforestry

  • Environmental protection.
  • Source of income.
  • Afforestation for timber production.
  • Maintenance of soil fertility.
  • Aesthetic value.
  • Labour saving in firewood collection.
  • Source of food and feed.
  • Source of fuel wood.

 

 

Important Trees and Shrubs for Particular Purposes

  • Eucalyptus Spp;
  • Timber,
  • Bee forage,
  • Fuel wood,
  • Medicinal,
  • Production of essential oils.
  • Acacia Spp;
  • Leaves and pods eaten by animals,
  • Provision of shade.
  • Cajanus cajan (pigeon peas);
  • Proteinous feed for human,
  • Used as fodder
  • Croton megalocarpus(croton);
  • Fuel wood timber for poles
  • Handles for hand tools.
  • Erythrina abyssinica (flame tree);
  • Wood carvings,
  • Bee forage,
  • Nitrogen fixation
  • Markhamia lutea (markhamia tree)­;
  • Timber for construction,
  • Shade,
  • Soil protection,
  • Bee forage.
  • Grevillea robusta (silky oak.)
  • Timber,
  • Fuel wood,
  • Fodder,
  • Bee forage,
  • Soil protection,
  • Wind breaker
  • Sesbania sesban (sesbania);
  • Fodder,
  • Nitrogen fixation,
  • Shade,
  • Fuel wood.
  • Calliandra calothyrsus (calliandra);
  • Fuel wood,
  • Fodder,
  • Nitrogen fixation,
  • Shade,
  • Bee forage.

 

  • Persea american (avocado) ;
  • Fodder,
  • Fruit production,
  • Shade,
  • Fuel wood.
  • Mangifera indica (mango);
  • Fruit production,
  • Shade trees,
  • Wind break,
  • Soil protection,
  • Fuel wood.

Characteristics of Agroforestry Tree Species:

  • Fast growth rate.
  • Deep rooted.
  • Nitrogen fixation ability.
  • By-product production ability.
  • Be multipurpose in nature.
  • Should not possess competitive ability with main crop ..
  • Have coppicing and lopping ability.
  • Have appropriate canopy – should not shade others.
  • Nutritious and palatable.

Trees and Shrubs to Avoid at Certain Sites and Reasons

  • Eucalyptus Spp.-should not be planted near water sources because it would absorb the water.
  • Eucalyptus Spp. -should not be planted on the arable land as the roots have allelophathic effects on other vegetation including crops.
  • Tall trees should not be planted near farm buildings because they may fall and damaging the buildings, their roots will break the building stones gradually.
  • Bushy trees or shrubs should not be near farm buildings as they may harbour predators.
  • Tall trees planted with main crop of a lower canopy intercept the rainfall, affecting the growth of the main crop.
  • Cypress trees have leaves which produce acidity in the soil preventing undergrowth beneath the tree.
  • These trees should not be planted within the farm but at the periphery.

Tree Nursery

  • Tree nurseries are structures used to raise tree seedlings until they are ready for transplanting.
  • There are 2 main types:

Bare root nurseries:

These are also known as ‘Swaziland’ beds where the seedlings are raised directly into the soil.

Advantages

  • Cheap and less time consuming.
  • Require less labour
  • Occupy a small space.
  • Many seedlings are raised in a small space.
  • Transportation of seedlings is easy.

Disadvantages

  • Root damage when uprooting the seedlings.
  • Difficult to transport.
  • Lower survival rate after transplanting.

Containerized nursery:

  • The seedlings in this type of nursery are raised in containers such as pots, polythene bags or tubes and tins.

Advantages

  • Higher survival rate after transplanting.
  • No root damage.
  • Successful in arid areas.

Disadvantages

  • Labour intensive.
  • Difficult to get containers.
  • Sometimes it may be difficult to get the right type of soil to use in the containers.

Seed Collection and Preparation

Seed Collection

Seeds should be collected from;

  • Adaptable trees,
  • High yielding,
  • Healthy
  • Resistant to pests /diseases.
  • The mother plant should be identified first.

 

The following methods used to collect seeds.

  • Shaking the tree.
  • Gathering from under the tree.
  • Lopping of the tree.
  • Climbing on the trees.
  • Hooking method.

Seed Preparation

  • This done when seeds are collected from a fresh fruit, they should be soaked in water, then washed and dried.
  • Cleaning and sorting: done to remove immature seeds, rotten seeds, broken or damaged seeds.
  • Drying: Done by sun-drying or oven drying.
  • Seed testing: this determines;
  • Seed quality for percentage purity,
  • Seed weight,
  • Moisture content,
  • Germination percentage.
  • Seeds should be stored in dry containers at room temperature.
  • Seed treatment: seeds are treated first to break the seed dormancy and ensure rapid germination;
  • Hot water treatment: used to soften the seed coat to make it more permeable to water.
  • Examples of seeds which require this treatment are leucaenia, calliandra and
  • Mechanical breaking: done by nicking the seed coat with a knife for easy entrance of water for example seeds of croton
  • Light burning: applied to the wattle tree seeds.

Nursery Management

The following are the practices carried out in the nursery when the seedlings are growing:

  • Mulching:
  • Aim is to reduce excessive evaporation,
  • Moderates the soil temperature,
  • When it decays it improves the soil structure,
  • Reduces the impact of the raindrops.
  • Weeding:
  • Done to reduce competition for growth factors by uprooting the weeds,
  • Use a sharp pointed stick.
  • Watering:
  • Done by use of a watering can
  • Done twice a day in the morning and in the evening.
  • Pricking out:
  • It is the removal of seedlings in an overcrowded area to another nursery bed,
  • This allows the seedlings to grow strong and healthy.
  • Root pruning:
  • It is the cutting of the roots longer than the pots.

              Root pruning is done for the following reasons;

  • Make lifting easier
  • Encourage fast establishment.
  • Reduce damage to the seedlings.
  • Encourage development of a short dense and strong rooting system.
  • Shading:
  • Done to reduce the intensity of sunlight .
  • Dark conditions should be avoided.
  • Pest and disease control:
  • Use of appropriate chemicals,
  • Sterilization of soil through heat treatment,
  • Fencing to protect seedlings against animal damage.
  • Hardening off:
  • It is the practice of preparing seedlings to adapt to the ecological conditions prevailing in the seedbed.
  • It involves gradual reduction of shade and watering 1-2weeks before transplanting.
  • Transplanting:
  • The practice of transferring seedlings from the nursery bed to the main field where they grow to maturity.

 

Procedure of Transplanting

  • Holes are dug early before transplanting.
  • Topsoil is mixed with compost manure.
  • The seedlings are watered well a day before transplanting.
  • The seedlings are removed from the nurseries carefully with a ball of soil for the bare root seedlings and roots trimmed for the containerized seedlings.
  • The seedling is placed in the hole at the same height it was in the nursery.
  • The container is removed carefully.
  • The soil is returned into the hole and firmed around the seedling.
  • The seedling is watered and mulched.

Care and Management of Trees

  • Protection:
  • From damage by animals such as goats and cattle by eating the leaves.
  • It is done by fencing the fields or using small poles around each seedling with or without wire nettings, can be done for individual trees or an entire field.
  • Pruning and trimming:
  • Pruning is the removal of extra or unwanted parts of a plant.
  • The unwanted part may be due to breakage, overcrowding, pests or disease attacks and over production.
  • Pruning initiates growth of shoots and trains the tree to have the required shape.
  • Regular cutting back of the trees is known as coppicing,
  • It is done at the beginning of each cropping season to reduce competition for water, minerals, nutrients and sunlight with crops.
  • The materials pruned or coppiced are used as fuel wood or for fodder crops.
  • Grafting old trees:
  • This is the practice of uniting two separate woody stems.
  • The part with the rooting system is known as root stock (base)
  • The part which is grafted onto the rootstock is called a scion which has buds that develop into the future plant.
  • The ability of the scion and the rootstock to form a successful union is known as compatibility.
  • Methods of grafting include whip or tongue grafting, side grafting and approach grafting.

Agroforestry Practices

  • Alley Cropping/Hedgerow Inter­cropping:
  • The growing of multipurpose trees and shrubs together with crops.

   Benefits

  • Improve soil fertility through nitrogen fixation and organic matter.
  • Provision of green manure.
  • Used as fence and mark boundaries.
  • Acts as windbreaks.
  • Suppress weeds.
  • Source of timber and fuel wood.

 

  • Multi-storey cropping ;
  • This is the growing together of trees of different heights.
  • The system is based on crops which can tolerate shading.
  • The trees and crops form different levels of canopy which look like storey.

         Benefits

  • Increases water conservation for pastures.
  • None of the crops or trees included will be shaded.
  • Act as windbreak for crops.
  • Creates suitable micro-climate in the area.
  • Trees are used for timber, fuel wood and forage.

 

  • Woodlots (farm forests)
  • These are plots of land set aside for trees only.
  • They are established in the hilly and less productive parts of the farm.
  • Fast growing tree species such as Eucalyptus spp. should be grown.

 

Sites for Agroforestry:

  • Farm boundaries – provide live fences.
  • River banks – protect water catchment areas.
  • Homesteads – provision of shade and windbreak
  • Terraces – for soil conservation.
  • Steep slopes – as contour hedges to encourage water seepage.

 

Tree Harvesting Methods

  • Pollarding;
  • This is the extensive cutting back of the crown of the tree about 2-3 meters above the ground level to harvest all the side branches.
  • It stimulates the development of a new crown and branches.
  • Coppicing;
  • Cutting the main stem of the tree completely at a height of 10 – 50 cm above the ground.
  • The tree should be cut in a slanting angle.
  • Lopping or side pruning ;
  • The removal of selected branches of the tree
  • Done to produce fuel wood and fodder.
  • Shaking of the tree ;
  • This is a method of harvesting pods and seeds from trees without cutting the tree.
  • Cutting back;
  • The tree is cut from the base to allow new growth as done in coffee when changing the cycle.
  • Thinning;
  • The removal of some of the trees growing in lines to give the remaining trees enough space to grow.

 

 

 

FORM ONE TO FOUR HISTORY AND GOVERNMENT TEACHING NOTES

FORM ONE HISTORY AND GOVERNMENT

INTRODUCTION TO HISTORY AND GOVERNMENT

THE MEANING OF HISTORY

History is an account of events that took place in the past. History may also be defined as a branch of knowledge which deals with past events of human beings and their response to their environment over the years.R.G Collingwood, in his book The Idea of History (OUP 1994) defined history as a “science concerned with the human actions in the past, pursued by interpretation of evidence for the sake of Human self knowledge.”

That history is a science because it involves finding out things about the past Humankind. For example, the origin of Man, why he was a toolmaker, why he domesticated animals and plants.

These are questions that provoke scientific curiosity.

The three definitions of History from the above are:

 History is the past of anything; of earth, man, disease or animals

 History is a branch of knowledge dealing with past events

 History is a science concerned with past Human actions

Since History at secondary level is specifically concerned with the past as it relates to humankind and his response to his environment over the years, the working definition of history is therefore;

 History is the endless story of mankind’s actions and events affecting him in the past.

Closely related to the term history is the term PREHISTORY.Prehistory refers to the unrecorded history- those activities that humans engaged in before writing and drawing were invented as ways of storing information. Such information is gained from songs, myths, stories, artifacts, fossils and the language of a people.

A historical event needs to have recorded evidence in order to be referred to as a historical fact

Characteristics of historical events

 They must have evidence.

 Historical information must be written or unwritten.

 Historical events only concern man.

 Historical events dwell mainly on the past happenings.

 Historical events must contain elements of truth.

The study of humankind’s past can be classified systematically into three;

 Social history- dealing with the traditions, values and cultural practices of a people

 Economic history; dealing with the means of livelihood of a people, such as hunting, gathering, agriculture and trade.

 Political history; dealing with the control system in a society, for example maintenance of law and order, leadership and security.

 

THE MEANING OF GOVERNMENT

Derived from the verb govern, government means to exercise authority over. To rule or control. Or having power to direct or conduct the policies and public affairs of a country or an institution. In our study, the term government refers to a group of people within a state or a country given authority to organize, direct and control the affairs of the state or country.In Kenya, the government has three arms.

The legislature: – Commonly referred to as parliament, this is a law making arm of government.

It includes the National assembly and the president.

The executive: – this is the arm of government which implements laws. It includes the president, the cabinet and the civil service.

The judiciary: – this is the arm of government responsible for seeing that the laws made are constitutional, that they are followed and that those who break them are punished. It is commonly referred to as the courts.Jean Jacques Rousseau, in his book, The Social Contract, describes government as “an intermediate body set up by the subjects to ensure equity (fairness) and the execution of laws while maintaining social and political liberty”

In this sense, government is not dictatorial since its authority is derived from the people. People must however be free to choose their leaders, even remove those in power and replace them with others, in order to ensure the existence of the principal of fairness.

FORMS OF GOVERNMENT

There are four forms of government:

Democratic government

This is a type of government in which rulers regularly seek public mandate through popular vote. Such governments are based on the principles of free and fair elections.

According to Abraham Lincoln, an American statesman, they are “governments of the people, for the people and by the people”.In such a government, freedoms and rights are provided for in the constitution that governs the law of the nation.

Aristocratic government

Aristos – best

Kratos – powers

An aristocracy is a form of government in which a group of people from the highest social class the royalty- in a society rule over others. Any member of the nobility can seek election or appointment to a government office while other citizens who are less privileged are there to be ruled.The King or Queen is the head of government while senior positions in the gover-nment are given to the privileged members from among the nobles. The nobles are considered superior to others human beings because of the wealthy family back-ground they are born into and their superior education. They are considered a rare breed of people.

 

 

Monarchical government

This is a form of government where democracy is practiced but aristocratical power is respected. Parliament is the supreme organ but the monarchy- the royalty that are in power be it the king or queen is retained as a tradition, and respected as head of state.

Monarchical governments are classified into two;Absolute monarchy: – which refers to the unrestricted power of the Head of State. The monarchy is dictatorial.

Constitutional monarchy;- The monarchical power , which is restricted is determ-ined by what is spelt out in the constitution. Such a system of government is found in Lesotho and Britain.

Dictatorial government

Dictatorship is a system of government where the ruler has total power over his subjects. Dictators are the sole authority where they rule. They make the law and execute justice and exercise their rule forcefully, suppressing their subjects at will. They curtail freedom of other subjects and impose their will over others.Examples of world dictators; Adolf Hitler of Germany who instigated the Germans into believing they were superior race and incited them against the Jews. Idi Amin of Uganda who ruled with a ‘rod of iron’

NB; the most ideal form of government is where the subjects go to the ballot to elect the people to lead them. Governments play the important function of maintaining law and order.

Importance of studying history

  1. a) History enables us to appreciate people’s evolution, origin of cultures and development and hence further good relations and remove biases and prejudices about other people.
  2. b) When we study history, we appreciate people’s contribution to national develop-pment. E.g. freedom fighters hence the importance of mutual and social responsi-bility.
  3. c) It helps us to know the origin of mankind, his development and the progress he has made to this day.
  4. d) We are able to understand our culture and appreciate the culture of other people.
  5. e) it instills a sense of patriotism and nationalism among citizens as they learn of the past political developments of their country. Its study inspires strong feelings of one’s heritage and the sense of belonging to a particular country.
  6. f) It helps us understand the interdependence of mankind and hence the need for cooperation.
  7. g) It influences career choice. The study of history leads to various professions. E.g. law, diplomacy, church, politics, teaching, and administration.
  8. h) The study of history helps us comprehend the social, economic and political developments of our societies
  9. i) It gives time and space to past events. Through the study of history, we learn about the time and place where an event took place. E.g. we know when Mau Mau uprising broke out (1948) and know when Kenya gained independence.
  10. j) It helps us develop a critical mind as we try to explain historical events. Historians will ask why, when and how.
  11. k) It provides intellectual fulfillment to the learner. Through an in -depth study of history, one’s mind is enriched.

Importance of studying government

  1. a) It helps us to appreciate the importance of government.
  2. b) Helps us understand how laws are made and enforced
  3. c) Helps us understand the organs of the state and the powers vested in them
  4. d) Helps us understand how government raises and spends revenue.
  5. e) Helps us compare our government system with other systems of government in other countries.
  6. f) Understand how development policies are formulated and implemented.
  7. g) It makes us know our roles as citizens and the roles of the leaders who govern us. This makes better law-abiding citizens.
  8. h) Its study helps us understand our responsibilities as well as the limitations within which e must operate for the well-being of every member of the society.
  9. i) It helps us appreciate the constitution and the process of making and reviewing laws and statutes.
  10. j) It influences career choices. For example, those who choose to specialize in public administration will find the study of government very useful.

SOURCES OF INFORMATION ON HISTORY AND GOVERNMENT

There three main sources of information on history and government;

  1. a) Unwritten sources.
  2. b) Written sources.
  3. c) Electronic sources

 Unwritten sources

This refers to historical information which is not recorded in writing.Unwritten sources of historical information include oral traditions, linguistics (languages), Anthropology (culture) archaeology, paleontology and genetics.

Oral traditions

This refers to the practice of handing down historical information by word of mouth from one Generation to the next. This forms a very important source of historical information especially where exists a non-literate society who might not be able to read.

Oral traditions include folk tales, proverbs, songs and stories. Songs, proverbs folktales and stories told to a younger generation have been very instrumental in the passing of information from one generation to the other. For example, a song about our struggle for independence in Kenya passes very important information to the younger generation, who not yet had born at that time.

 

 

Advantages of oral traditions as a source of information

  1. Oral traditions hands over historical facts from one generation to another in the absence of written records.
  2. It is the best source of historical information since even the illiterate can learn their h history using oral traditions
  3. It is also a form of entertainment. For example through songs, folktales stories and proverbs, people get entertained.
  4. It complements other sources of information.
  5. The source of information is captivating especially if it is narrated by a person who participated in the event himself. For example, an Ex- World War II veteran narrating about the war.

Disadvantages of oral traditions as a source of information

  1. The truth and correctness of oral traditions become unreliable especially when the narrator deliberately conceals some information or lies. People tend to conceal their failures while talking so much about their success.
  2. Information can b exaggerated as they are transmitted by elders to successive generations.

At times it is difficult to differentiate between what is real and what is imagined.

  1. Some information or facts may be forgotten or omitted since oral traditions depend heavily on human memory. This makes the information passed unreliable.
  2. Dates of information may be lacking. The source may not give correct chronology of events because it depends on human memory. It is common that people forget important dates and information about a particular past event.
  3. It is an expensive method. One has to pay for the informant’s transportation, lunch and accommodation. A historian may also need to travel to far places to find information.
  4. It is time consuming. One requires a lot of time to interview one individual. Where many people are to be interviewed, it may take a long time.

Linguistics

This refers to the scientific study of languages.

Historical linguistics is the study of language as it changes n the course of time. It seeks to trace the principles of language change and establish the current genealogical classification of a particular language. Such a study helps in discovering language form, content, vocabulary and historical experiences of the people who speak the language.

Distribution of language and relationship between languages is important to a historian. People who speak related languages may be assumed to have a common origin, be connected, or had been in close contact at sometime in the past.Variations between languages of the same family can show how long ago the break in contact occurred.

 

 

 

Advantages of linguistics as a source of information

  1. Through linguistics, Facts can be obtained about the movement of people and their relationship. Such information helps experts to correctly group languages according to language families.
  2. It helps us understand communities better as people with a common language may have common origin. It is good for establishing facts on origin, migration and settlement.
  3. Linguistics complements other sources of historical information. For example, language as a medium of communication helps those using oral tradition to gather information from various sources.
  4. Language has enabled historical linguists to discover links between different people which were previously unknown. E.g. it is now known that the Bantus had a common origin and possibly spoke one language. However due to long periods of separation between various

Bantu groups, through migrations, these groups may not understand each other’s language today.

  1. Linguistics helps in the dating of migration of people. Language drawn from a parent language will change in a certain way and rate through time. When comparing parent language with derived language, it is possible to know how long the derived language has independently from the parent language. E.g. Sheng language and Kiswahili (parent language).

Limitations in the use of linguistics as a source of information

  1. It is time consuming/learning a language takes a long time therefore delaying acquisition of information.
  2. There is a danger of omitting a word when translating a language. In the process, vital information about a people’s history may be lost.
  3. Inaccurate information can be passed on where wrong words are borrowed from other languages.
  4. Some words may just be difficult to understand.
  5. Some languages have become archaic and irrelevant hence difficult to translate.
  6. Misinterpretation of words may make them difficult to understand.
  7. Linguistic analysis for classification purposes may fail to take into account languages with time.
  8. One word may have different meanings in different languages. This can easily confuse a researcher. For example, Nyoro in Kikuyu means ‘smooth’, while the same word in Luo means ‘yesterday’.
  9. Lack of original speakers in the language under study limits research findings.

Anthropology

This is the study of human beings, their origin, development, customs, beliefs, and social attributes like music, dance, drama, and religious beliefs and practices.

Anthropologists have to live among the people under study in order to experience their way of life in order to understand and explain structures of societies, forms of social organization, institutions, descent, marriage, forms of government, systems of inheritance, religious customs and cultural values.The anthropological description of the beliefs and customs of a people will help the historian to determine the cultural past of the people

Advantages of anthropology as a source of information

  1. By living among the people, anthropologists help to discover, understand and explain structures of societies, forms of social organization, cultures, etc.
  2. Anthropologists assist historians to determine the cultural past of the people.
  3. It also gives a deeper understanding of a particular aspect of a people’s culture.

Limitations in the use of anthropology as a source of information

  1. It is an expensive method as it involves living among the people.
  2. It is a time-consuming method of acquiring information.
  3. It is difficult for a researcher to adapt to the environment since the people they are studying may be of a totally different culture. Where they succeed in adapting, they face the risk of losing their own culture.
  4. People under study may try to behave differently when the researcher is around. A researcher may therefore miss important details.

Genetic studies

Genetics is the scientific study of the ways in which characteristics are passed from parents to their offspring. (The study of heredity and the variation of inherited characteristics.) It deals with the ay human beings adapted to the circumstances in their environment and utilized available plants and animals to meet their needs.When used in relation to pants genetic studies helps us trace the origin of various species by identifying them with the region where large numbers of them are found today. After this, interpretation of their movement is made. The appearance of new cultivated varieties can be identified with the people whose economy they form a part. Also, common genes or characteristics among a group of people may indicate some relationships.

Archaeology and paleontology

Archaeology is the study of man’s past through scientific analysis of the remains of material remains of his culture, e.g. weapons, tools, houses, clothing, utensils, paintings sculpture, pottery, coins, jewellery, cutlery, beads and work o arts.The archaeologist reconstructs the activities and way of life of people who lived in prehistoric times from various evidence remains of the material culture.Other items that can be used in archaeology include remains of charcoal and carbo-nized seeds, remains of cloth or garments, remains of dwelling laces.After studying the available artifacts, the archaeologist formulates his concept of a people’s civilization at the time the artifacts were used. The existence of artifacts in an area can enable the historian to deduce the material culture of the people who lived n the past.

Palaeontology is the scientific study of the evolution and structure of extinct plants and animals (fossils) through scientific examination of fossil remains.Historians and archaeologists work with natural scientists like paleontologists, geologists and ecologists and chemistry in discovering fossils, getting information about soil structure, interpreting man’s relationship to his environment and dating of fossils.

Methods used by archaeologists and paleontologists in discovering a historical site.

  1. a) By looking at areas where tectonic forces (faulting) or erosion have occurred. In such areas, surfaces which may give important clues to the point of finding fossils and artefacts are exposed.
  2. b) Use of vision. Sometimes vision may help them find on the surface a small part of an early settlement such as a few stones in a regular pattern.
  3. c) Use of historical research. A place that may be mentioned in a historical document or in an oral narrative may give a clue to the geography of the area and open up further inquiries into the past civilization of such a clue.e.g Omo River Valley, Olduvai Gorge, Ur and Babylon.
  4. d) Use of experience. An archaeologist may also use his long experience and skill to identify a potential site for archaeological excavation.
  5. e) During cultivation and building construction, farmers and builders may accidentally expose ancient objects that could arouse the curiosity of researchers. For example ‘Nyayo ya Mungu’ in Tanzania was a single footprint on a rock surface that was found in 1995 and became evidence of the existence of early human beings.

Advantages of using archaeology

  1. a) Archaeology gives us detailed information on material culture that other sources may not have.
  2. b) Archaeology gives a sense of time, as the artifacts are dated.
  3. c) It complements other sources of information and thus ensures authenticity of the information.
  4. d) It provides information of varied nature depending on the materials found on the site. For example, if tools, weapons, coins, bones, rock paintings and other items are located, at a site, a lot of information maybe deduced.

Limitations of using archaeology

  1. a) It is an expensive source of information. This is because one has to hire labourers to excavate the site and get artefacts and take them to laboratories for analysis.
  2. b) It is a time-consuming method. The researcher needs a lot of time to prepare for an excavation and take material for analysis in laboratories.
  3. c) It is sometime difficult for archaeologists to locate an archaeological site.
  4. d) Some artefacts and fossils are fragile and can therefore break or disintegrate during excavation. This may result in distortion of the analysis of the artefacts.
  5. e) Archaeology is only limited to the study of the ancient period and therefore cannot be used to study recent history.
  6. f) Archaeological information may sometimes be inaccurate since it is often bases on inferences (conclusions) and reconstructions.
  7. g) With archaeology, it may not be easy to accurately determine the date when events took place. It is only estimated through the method of dating fossils.
  8. h) There are very few archaeological experts and facilities for interpreting archaeological evidence in Kenya. Quite often, artefacts excavated from Kenya are taken to European countries for dating and analysis.

What things do archaeologists use to construct the activities of people who lived in pre-history times?

  1. a) Looking for regions of tectonism (faulting) associated with fossils and artifacts.
  2. b) They look for unique features e.g. stone patterns.
  3. c) Remains of fossils and artifacts dug out by farmers and constructors.
  4. d) They dig, excavate for artifacts and fossils.
  5. e) They study artifacts and fossils found.
  6. f) They make research in regions associated with evolution of man e.g. rift valley.
  7. g) They classify the artifacts and fossils.
  8. h) They use chemical and scientific methods to find ages of their findings e.g. carbon 14-dating method

What problems face archaeologists in their work of re writing history using unwritten sources?

  1. a) The exercise is too expensive.
  2. b) It is dangerous and tedious. Animals like wild dogs can attack scientists.
  3. c) Identification of the site is not easy because some artifacts are buried.
  4. d) Some artifacts can be destroyed in the process of digging.
  5. e) Dating of fossils is difficult.
  6. f) Personnel are few hence more work.
  7. g) Poor infrastructure in rural areas where their researches are mainly based
  8. h) Archaeologists may suffer from diseases caused by changes in climate.
  9. i) Sometimes the climate of their residence differs from that of the place they are taking

METHODS OF DATING FOSSILS

There are six methods through which scientists may use to arrive at the age of fossils.

  1. Geological periods

These are periods that have been given names by paleontologists and geologists for the past ages. They are characterized by the successive type of pants and animals found, and the climatic changes.The recent period is the Holocene period which began 10,000 years ago at the end of the Pleistocene.

  1. Chemical dating

They exist in two types:

(a)  Radio- carbon dating

This method involves a measure of the rate of decay of carbon -14 in fossils and organic substances. Carbon -14 is a naturally existing radioactive element (isotope) of carbon of relative atomic mass fourteen and is found in the Carbon Dioxide which is present in the atmosphere.It is absorbed by plants and consequently by all living organisms during their lifetime. When plant or animal dies, absorption stops. Carbon -14 already absorbed begins to disintegrate at a fixed rate from the time of death. If the amount of carbon -14 still remaining in an organic sample can be measured and related to the content of the isotope in the modern plant or animal, the rate of decay will be known. The date at which the sample was buried will e known. The measurement tells us how long it is since the organism died.The unit of measuring is known as half-life- the number of years it takes for half the carbon -14 to decay.However the accuracy of radio-carbon dating is limited to up to 40,000 years ago.

(b)  Potassium argon method

This is the method used to date volcanic ash. During volcanic eruptions, potassium is emitted. As soon as the potassium is deposited, the radio-active potassium-40 immediately begins to decay into the gas argon. It is assumed that the argon is retained in the mineral or rock unless there is earth movement.Given that the rate of decay of potassium is known, the amount of argon-40 compared with the amount of potassium, gives a direct measure of age.Because of the slower rate of decay of potassium than the decay of carbon-14, the potassium –argon method is used for dates ranging from hundreds of millions of years to 30,000 years.Recently methods have been developed for measuring the potassium and argon simultaneously on the same sample using nuclear.

  1. Stratigraphy

This is the study and interpretation of the layers of rock successively deposited at one place. It is useful in determining dates for areas affected by sedimentation. Through Stratigraphy, a geological time-chart is obtained showing which rock was formed earlier or later.

  1. Fission-track dating

This is a method developed for dating Pleistocene samples. The ages of glass and other mineral objects estimated by observing the tracks made in them by the fission fragments of uranium nuclei they contain. It requires that Uranium must be present. The age obtained dates from the time the object solidified. This method has been proved reliable by being able to provide same reading from a sample of glass with a lump of pumice from Olduvai Gorge corresponding with the potassium –argon dates from the same layer.

  1. Lexico-statistics dating

Lexico-statistics is the statistical study of the vocabulary of languages with the intentions of determining their ages and their historical links with other languages.The study is based on the assumption that all languages have a basic vocabulary which will change slowly at a common rate for all languages at all times. The existence of reconstructed vocabulary of the parent language in derivative languages shows the

Relationship between the two

Glottochronology, a subdivision of Lexico-statistics, attempts to establish that languages are historically related .by this method, there is an effort to express rates of language development by formulae precise enough to enable dates when change occurred to be calculated

  1. Statistical dating

Through a system of averaging, the length of a generation can be determined for a

Particular society and dates estimated for events associated with certain generations.

If the number and names of successive age-sets are remembered, the same system of averaging can be used.

Advantages of using unwritten sources of information on history and government

  1. a) Information about people’s movement and relationship is given.
  2. b) It is very efficient where there still existed illiteracy and people could not write or read.
  3. c) It informs us of events in the absence of written materials.
  4. d) Data received is primary/ firsthand so accuracy is enhanced.
  5. e) Materials collected or excavated can be stored in museums for future reference.
  6. f) They create employment in museums where they are stored.
  7. g) Information not captured by written sources can be obtained from oral traditions.
  8. h) There is a sense of reality as it involves things that are seen and touched.
  9. i) Unwritten sources especially linguistics help in discovering the links between different people, which were previously unknown.
  10. j) Detailed information on material culture may be obtained.
  11. k) Dating of the migration of people is more accurate in unwritten sources e.g. In linguistics.

Written sources

These are sources in which letters or any other symbols have been put on the surface for the purpose of communication. They include books, archives, constitutions, journals, novels, plays, newspapers, magazines, documentaries, dairies, annual reports, periodical and paintings.

Written sources are classified into two;

  1. a) Archives and early manuscripts

Archives are a collection of historical documents or records, especially those carrying classified information of a government or an organization, which after a period of time are accessible to the public.

They are also places where government, public and other historical records are kept.-they are resource centres for information.A manuscript is an author’s handwritten or typed text that has not yet been published. Early manuscripts include stone tablets and scrolls. The bible and Quran are based on these two.

 

  1. b) Printed sources

They include books, journals, novels, plays, newspapers, magazines, documentaries, dairies and annual reports. Photographs employ both electronic and printing processes but basically fall under printed sourcesWorks of fiction such as films plays and novels are important source of historical information. (Fiction is literature in form of prose, especially novels that describe imaginary events and people).Since work of fiction involves feelings and emotions, they can give more information about history. Also reading good historical novels arouses interest in history and gives the reader intellectual fulfillment. Newspapers convey new or fresh events, which with the passing of time becomes history.

Advantages of written records

  1. a) Written records preserve history since events are recorded for future reference. They are a store of information.
  2. b) Written information can reach or be distributed to all literate people all over the world.
  3. c) Written sources are less costly compared to those of anthropology or archaeology.
  4. d) Unlike oral tradition sources which are largely dependent on human memory, written sources are more accurate as information is preserved exactly as it was recorded.
  5. e) Written records may be written or translated into different languages thus reaching different people all over the world.
  6. f) Written records are in most cases reliable as biases and prejudices coming from authors can be limited. This can be done by comparing written material with statistical data from other sources.

Limitations

  1. a) Where an author omits essential information for one reason or another, a written source may be rendered quite unreliable.
  2. b) Written information may be misunderstood or misinterpreted by readers either with the intention of discrediting others or to suit one’s needs.
  3. c) Writers at times are biased since the write from their particular point of view. For example, the writings of early explorers and missionaries.
  4. d) Written records are only limited to literate people within the society. – are not useful to illiterate people in the absence of literate members of the society.
  5. e) At times, depending on the society involved, acquiring written records may be very costly.
  6. f) Reading written records is often time-consuming.

Electronic sources

These include microfilms, films, videos, radio, and television

Microfilms

These are films on which extremely small photographs (microphotography) of documents and printed matter are stored. They are tinny but when magnified can be clearly read.

The importance of converting documents into microfilms is for preservation purposes and saving storage spaces.

Radio

This is an authoritative source of historical information that captures words and emotions of an event as I was. For example radio news on the president’s speeches gives listeners the actual information on national matters. However, radio lacks the vividness found in television and films.

Audio- visual sources

These include television, films and videos.

Films carry indisputable historical facts as action is recorded live. They also give better understanding of some aspects of the social history of a given people with regard to their music, dress and leisure activities. Videos and films make the past come alive.

However, since films are acted, they can sometimes be unrealistic as they may not present facts but an exaggerated version of an event.Television on its part gives good historical information as it depicts the situation as it was.

Databanks and databases

Databanks are large stores of organized information which can be accessed in number of ways. E.g. if it is a book, information can be accessed through an index, a table of content or by browsing.Electronic databases are stored in computer and facilitate easy and faster retrieval of information. One can search for information by use of a number of search terms.Information in a database can be printed when required but can also be accessed instantly on computer.

Limitations of using electronics as a source of information in history and government

  1. a) They are Subject to bias since most audio visuals contain foreign materials carrying the bias of the producer.
  2. b) Some are limited to the literate only e.g. information in data bases and microfilms can only be accessed by literate people and even computer literate people only.
  3. c) The information may be inaccurate only giving what is appealing to the public. TV crew depict only what they want to. Censorship may leave out vital information.
  4. d) Electronic sources of information are too expensive; most people cannot afford e.g. TV, Radios.
  5. e) Some acted films are unrealistic and therefore contain exaggerated information.

EARLY MAN

In the study of early man, we will seek to answer questions that human beings have always sought to answer about how they appeared on earth, whether they were created and where the universe came from.

The origin of Human Beings

A number of theories have been put forward to explain the origin of human beings.

  1. The creation theory.
  2. The mythical/ traditional theory
  3. The evolution theory

The Creation theory

The Jews, Christians and Muslims recognize the creation story as narrated in the first book of bible and in Qur’an. That the whole universe was created by god. That God also created man, woman and all living things and all non-living creatures. Man was created in God’s own image and woman created to provide man with companionship.

The Mythical Theory

Among African communities, there are myths about their origin all of them pointing to the fact that the first man was created by God.

Examples:

Among the Agikuyu, their God (Ngai) created the first man, Gikuyu. He the provided him with a wife, Mumbi. He gave him land at Mugurwe wa Gathanga.

One of the myths among the Nandi state that the first two people, male and female came from the knees of a giant man, when the knees began swelling and later burs for the two to come out from each of the either knees.

The Evolution Theory

Charles Darwin, an English man living between 1809 and 1882 questioned the acceptance of the creation theory. Through scientific expedition to South America and the pacific islands in 1831, he developed interest in fossils (remains of plants and animals found beneath the earth’s surface.) in 1859; he published his ideas in a book titled The Origin of Species by Means of Natural Selection. The ideas enlisted instant battles from the Christian fraternity save for one supporter, Huxley.

Clearly the theory of evolution was not accepted but it helped to make people aware of the new ideas concerning the origin of man.

What is evolution?

Evolution can be defined as the process of change in living organisms over a number of years, frequently involving the beginning of new species from earlier species.

According to Charles Darwin, man transformed from simple life slowly over millions of years through environmental mutation, natural selection, isolation and adaptation.

 Mutation was a stage of abrupt change.

 Natural selection is an instinct by which the stronger species out compete the weaker for resources.

 Adaptation is where the surviving species isolate themselves from others as they adapt to new environment through body changes and technological changes e.g. ability to grow crops and make shelter.

Darwin’s theory of natural selection comprises the following points.

All organisms or creatures are uniquely different and this uniqueness is based on heredity factors which an organism has from birth.

Although many young organisms are produced, few manage to develop to maturity.

The organisms that manage to grow to maturity and reproduce are those that are able to constantly adapt to the existing environment.In view of the limited resources, even after mutation, Darwin argued that only the fittest organisms survive as the weak species become extinct. This theory is popularly known as ‘survival for the fittest’.According to Darwin, isolation and adaptation is the final stage in the evolution process. Having survived through mutation and natural selection, the merging species increase in number. This leads to search for basic needs and in the process a species may be isolated from the rest and then finally adapt to the new environment.The theory of evolution holds that Humans belong to the animal kingdom and that man has evolved over the years. Man is a primate just as apes like gorillas, chimpanzees and monkeys. However, man belongs to the family of hominidae, while apes belong to the family of pongidae.

Man according to Darwin developed over the years from his ape-like ancestors.

Evolution and adaptation of man

The earliest Mammals lived on trees for two reasons;

  1. a) There was more supply of food o trees such as insects, leaves and birds’ eggs
  2. b) Animals were more secure from their enemies while up on trees

Man evolved from this kind of animals

Archaeological evidence points at East Africa as the cradle of mankind.

Reasons why East Africa is regarded as the place where man first evolved

  1. a) Evidence from archaeologists’ show that the earliest apes first evolved around lake and rift valley areas. And if man evolved from apes, then the first man must have appeared in east Africa.
  2. b) The savanna landscapes found in east Africa favored evolution while the conditions elsewhere (forests and deserts) Were unfavourable.
  3. c) The bones and weapons and tools which archaeologists are finding are proofs to this. These findings are widespread in Olduvai Gorge, Olorgesaillie, and Ngorongoro and around lakes of east Africa.
  4. d) The discovery of remains of early hominids and their material culture which form a pattern of human evolution prove this. E.g. we can trace the evolutionary process from Dryopithecus to Ramapithecus to Australopithecus to Homo habilis to Homo erectus to Homo sapiens.

Important archaeological sites found in East Africa

In Kenya; – Rusinga Island, Fort Ternan near Kericho, Kariandusi near Elementaita, Gambles cave, Olorgesaillie, Kobi For a near Lake Turkana, Hyrax Hill and Njoro River cave.

In Tanzania; – Olduvai Gorge, Eyasi Simila, Apis Rock and Garusi

In Uganda; – Nsongezi, Napak, Magosi, Paraa, Ishanga, Mweya and Nyabusora

In Ethiopia; – Omo River Valley and Hadar.

Over a long period of time, man’s ancestors lived in thick forests. Later about 15 million years ago, the forests transformed into savanna grasslands causing man’s ancestors to change both physically and mentally so as to cope with the new environment.

The changes

  1. a) The tail which no longer had any value in the savanna disappeared.
  2. b) Man became more upright as there were no more impeding vegetation as was the case of too much foliage and intertwining vegetation in the forests and also to reduce surface area onto which solar insolation had effect. These also enabled quicker movement.
  3. c) The leg and foot formation changed to enable the weight of the body to be supported and balance to be achieved while moving or at a standstill.
  4. d) Gradual use of front limbs (hands for holding objects) enabled man to make tools which made work easier. The limbs also found another role of protection from other predators.

As the forests disappeared, competition for food intensified and humans had to change their earlier eating habits. Some fossil evidence clearly give distinctive evidence of the break-off point between apes and hominids (mans ancestors.)The changes which Homo sapiens underwent as a break-off from apes to modern man.

  1. a) The skull size of the early human beings became larger indicating bigger brains. For example, Australopithecus, who lived between 5 and 1 million years ago, had a brain capacity of

530cm3. Homo erectus who lived later on had an improved brain capacity of between 775 and 1225cm3.

  1. b) Their jaws and teeth became more powerful compared to earlier forms indicating their use in tearing and cutting tough fibres and even the need for defence as a weapon. The size of the jaws and teeth became smaller.
  2. c) They developed a refined speech as compared to earlier forms.
  3. d) They were taller with less hair on their body.
  4. e) The forearms and hands underwent some changes. They developed a thumb for grasping objects. Their arms and hands became shorter, more appropriate for an upright posture.
  5. f) Their leg and foot formation also changed. Their feet and toes were smaller than earlier hominids in order to support the weight of the rest of the body while motionless or mobile. The toes were no longer in need for holding onto branches.

From apes to homo sapien sapiens

Between 40 and 25 million years ago, the first apes appeared on earth. The first man

(Austropithecus) appeared around 4.5 million years ago.

The following are the stages through which the evolution of man passed.

1)  Aegyptopithecus – An Early African Monkey

~ Aegyptopithecus was reconstructed from a monkey like skull found at Fayum Depression in Egypt. He forms earliest evidence of probable man’s ancestors.

~ Its Teeth were those of a herbivore

~ It had a Small, about 4kg and was named Egyptian ape.

~ It was highly adapted to forest life. Had stereoscopic vision. It could jump skillfully from one tree to other using hands. It Dated 33 million years

2)  Dryopithecus Africanus (proconsul)

~ Its Remains were found at Rusinga Island within Lake Victoria by Mary and Louis Leakey in

  1. Its Skull appearance was more close to modern man than to Aegyptopithecus.

~ He had a quadrupedal movement like a chimpanzee. He had a Smooth forehead.

~ He had long teeth like other animals. The shape of his teeth and jaws indicated that He ate fruits. It is his remains that strengthen the belief that east Africa was the first homeland of mankind.

3)  Kenyapithecus (Ramapithecus)

~ He is believed to have appeared between 15 and 12 million years ago

~ First remains found Fort Ternan in Kericho District, Kenya, in 1961 by Dr. Louis Leakey and Mary. Other fossils found at Samburu Hills, near Lake Baringo as well as in the Lake Turkana basin.

~ The equivalent species found in the Siwalikis Hills in northern India near New Delhi was named Ramapithecus

~ He had small canines and could occasionally walk on twos without falling.

~ The creature was small and weighed 36kg with bigger brains than earlier hominids.

4)  Australopithecus (southern ape)

~ By 4-2m years ago a series of species known as australopithecines begin to appear. Perhaps it was the earliest homid closer to modern man.

~ The pelvis and leg were similar to that of modern humans.

~ They were bipedal and this was important in defence, grasp of objects and vision of an impending danger from a distance.

~ His Brain size was smaller than that of a human but larger than gorilla’s.

~ He was one of the most hairy hominid that ever existed.

~ He was Short but strong with a low forehead. Had large teeth and skulls

~ His remains were first discovered at Taung in Botswana by Raymond Dart in 1924.

~ The broken up skull found in East Africa at Olduvai Gorge in 1959 by Mary Leakey, was called Zinjanthropus- ‘Nut-Cracker man ‘since it had big jaws that suggest it kept on chewing.

~ Other fossils found in South Africa, Omo River Valley, Laetoli in Tanzania, near lakes Turkana and Baringo in kenya and L Natron

Four types of Australopithecines that have been identified

  1. a) Australopithecus Afarensis
  2. b) Australopithecus Anamensis
  3. c) Australopithecus africanus.
  4. d) Australopithecus Robustus
  5. e) Australopithecus Anamensis

~ He is aged between 4.2 and 3.9 million years ago and is believed to be one of the oldest

  1. Australopithecines

~ Evidence of his existence is obtained from the Reconstruction of Material consisting of 9 fossils from Kanapoi in Kenya and 12 fossils from Allia Bay in Kenya found by Dr. Meave Leakey, Dr. Allan Walker and the four fossil hunters (Kamoya Kimeu, Wambua Mangao, Nzube Mutiwa and Samuel Ngui.)

~ The fossil remains (comprising a lower jaw) were named A. Anamensis in August 1995 in a leading British Scientific journal.

~ He had relatively large canines.

 ~ The homid was aged between 3.9 and 3.0 million years ago. Its Name is derived from Afar Depression in Ethiopia.

~ He Had Apelike face and human-like teeth. He was small in stature and Bipedal, but Walked bent over, not fully upright.

~ They had very small brains -Brain capacity from 375 to 500 cc – (Its Brain was the size of an orange.)

~ They had a bony ridge over the eyes, a low forehead, a flat nose, and also they had no chin.

~ Remains found at Laetoli in Tanzania and Tugen Hills in Baringo District.

  1. c) Australopithecus Africanus (A. Gracilis)

~ A. africanus existed between 3 and 2.5 million years ago. A. africanus was slenderly built, or Gracile (Gracile means slender) with a height of 1.5m.

~ Was significantly more like modern humans than A. Afarensis, with a larger brain and more humanoid facial features.

~ Had large teeth, jaws and skull

~ A. africanus has been found at only four sites in southern Africa — Taung (1924),

Sterkfontein (1935), Makapansgat (1948) and Gladysvale (1992).

  1. d) Australopithecus Robustus

~ He Lived between 1½ – 2mya in South Africa.

~ He is the biggest and most recent Australopithecine. – weight 68kg. He had more robust

skull, jaws, and teeth.

~  He ate fruits, nuts and raw tubers- was apparently a vegetarian.

~  His Remains were found primarily in cave deposits at Swartkrans and Kromdraai in South Africa.

~  His Average brain size was  about 530 cc

~  The East African A.Robustus was named A. Boisei

5)  Homo habilis

(“Handy Man”) – “man with ability”.

~  He is the earliest known species of the genus Homo; that is, the first human species. He lived 2.5 -1.5 million years ago

~  He was the First Homo specie to create and use stone tools for hunting and daily life. Homo habilis depicted the ability to make better tools than his predecessors. That is why he was referred to as man with ability.

~  His Brain size was -500 -800 cc;-the Brain shape is more humanlike.

~  He was capable of rudimentary speech.

~  He was about 127 cm (5’0″) tall, and about 45 kg (100 lb) in weight, although females may have been smaller

~ His fossils were found in the Olduvai Gorge in Tanzania in 1964 by Dr. J. Leakey.

~  His Remains were also found at Hadar and Omo River Valley in Ethiopia and kobi fora along L. Turkana by Benerd Ngeneo in 1972.

6)  Homo erectus (“Upright Man”)

~ He was BIPEDAL- standing about 4-5 feet tall with a larger brain (700-1250cc). He lived between 2 million and 200,000 years ago.

~ He was clever as illustrated by his ability to make Acheulian tools such as the hand axe which was used as an axe, knife or even as a scraper. He was the First hominid to invent and use fire.

~ Their skeletons were larger and showed that they were quite heavily muscled

~ They were omnivorous like many other early hominids.

~ Only had hair on their head and back like are men that we have today

~ Remains found in Hardar, Ethiopia where the skeleton of a female ‘Lucy’ were found.

~ Other fossils were found near Nariokotone River on the north western shores of LakeTurkana by Kamoya Kimeu in 1984.

~ Also at Olorgesaillie near Magadi, Isimila near Iringa in TZ and Tenerife in Algeria.

~ The most famous Homo Erectus fossil was found in a cave in Zhoukoudian, China and became known as Peking Man/Java man

7)  Homo sapiens (“Wise Man” thinking man)

~ Their Main difference with their hominid ancestors is their extreme intelligence–they were the smartest hominid that ever lived with a Brain capacity of 1000-1800cc

~ They lived between 200,000 and 150,000 years ago

~ They improved their way of life by making a variety of flint, bone, wood and stone tools

(Microliths)

~ They hunted, gathered and fished. Later on, they domesticated plants and animals

~ Their Remains were found at Eliye Springs, Kanjera and Kanam in Kenya, Bodo and Omo River Valley in Ethiopia and Ngaloba in Tanzania.

Three sub-species of Homo sapiens existed;

  1. a) Rhodesian man

~  The sub-species Was discovered in Zambia , hence the name Rhodesian man

~  He had straight legs and walked with long strides.

~  Rhodesian man’s Brains and skull were very similar to those of modern man.

  1. b) Neanderthals

~  His Remains were found in Neander valley, Germany (1856). They Lived in caves and valleys

~  He was 5 feet and 5 inches tall-much stronger, heavily built and more aggressive too.

~  He Had very thick eyebrow ridges like the other hominids

~  He Made clothes from animal skins. They would scrape animal fat so they can use the skin as clothing.

~  They were probably the First humans to bury their dead. He was most likely the most intelligent hominid other than modern humans.

~  He was a nomad, gathering and hunting deer, wild pigs and wild sheep. Their weapons were used to impale animals; therefore, to kill them, they had to approach the animal and get very close. This was dangerous and probably caused injuries and even fatalities.

~ Communication was key in hunting because they had to work as a team. They had the ability to use complex speech; however, their sentences were probably basic. Instead of painting on cave walls they painted their faces.

~ Other remains were found in Asia in France, Belgium, Gibraltar, Italy and former

Yugoslavia.

~ They became extinct about 30,000 years ago.

  1. c) Homo sapiens Cro-Magnon

~ He was almost identical to modern humans although quite muscular and taller. Had long, low skull and a wide face, a sharp, rising forehead, bushy eyebrows and prominent chins

~ They had a big brain capacity and had very complex thinking

~ He was hunter-gatherer, painter and lived in caves

~ He knew how to make clothes

~ His Fossil remains were found in Western Europe. Their skeletons still remain in France today

~ They became extinct around 10,000years ago

8)  Homo sapiens sapiens

~ Homo sapiens sapiens are modern day humans. They evolved about 50,000 years ago.

~ They have big brains and a more advanced faculty for curiosity and intelligence

~ They have a large brain capacity. They do not just think, they plan ahead, make accurate forecasts, and study the star and the galaxies

~ They have made inventions that have made life more comfortable.

~ They are Around 5 feet 6 inches tall and Walk fully upright

~ They have Minimal hair on our bodies (replaced by clothing)-We have clothes that are made from brands, factories, we also sew or knit our own clothing.

The growing knowledge of genetic structure and functions has enabled human beings to clone animals using genes obtained from existing animals, thereby producing offsprings that looks exactly like the original e.g. the work of Dr. Wilmut Ian at the Roslin Institute of Edinburgh, Scotland that led to the first cloned sheep named dolly. Scientists are making attempts to even clone humans.More recent discoveries of early man include the Toumai found in Chad in 2002 dating about 6 to 7 myaIn 2000, another discovery was made in Baringo, Kenya (millennium man) and is believed todate 6mya. The discovery was made by Martin Pickford and Eustace Gitonga o the National Museums of Kenya.

Appearance of races

It has been hypothesized modern humans, using superior technology and more efficient adaption, out competed other hominid species to quickly emerge as the only surviving hominid species on the planet.Though we feature much diversity in appearance, these differences are minor compared to our biological similarities/all human beings are quite closely related.Many of our physical differences (skin, color, hair color, etc.) are relatively recent adaptations to local environment conditions. Evolutionary forces such as genetic drift have also played a role in our creating such variation as well.

Biologists and anthropologists classified humans into three different groups based on physical characteristics.

  Negroids, found in Africa.

  Caucasians found in Europe

  Mongoloids found in Asia,

Modern genetics has revealed that these categories make very little sense biologically since modern races are derived from a common stock and the different races are able to interbreed. There are also no differences in intelligence among all races of mankind.

The term “race” has traditionally been used by scientists as the equivalent of the subspecies concept when classifying humans.The Cultural and economic practices of early man

What is culture?

Culture is the way of life of a people-Customs, language and social institutions

The things that early humans made and used formed their material culture. Early man’s culture can be understood through study of Stone Age or Paleolithic periods

What is Stone Age?

This refers to the early period of human history when man’s tools and weapons were mainly made of stone and to some extend – wood and bone

There are three Stone Age periods

1)  Old stone age- Paleolithic period- 4,500,000 to 50,000years

2)  Middle stone age- Mesolithic period-50,000-15,000 years.

3)  New Stone Age – Neolithic period- 15,000- 1,500 years

The Paleolithic Age

“Paleolithic” -> “Old Stone” Age- 4,500,000 – 50,000 years ago

The Paleolithic is the longest of all stone ages, covering roughly 2 million years.

The hominid species who lived side by side were Australopithecus, Homo habilis and Homoerectus.

EARLY STONE AGE TOOLS

The hominids Made tools from stone

The Tool Traditions was called Oldowan tools / pebble tools. The tools were named after Olduvai Gorge where they were found. They were made by Australopithecus and Homo erectus. They were also known as pebble tools because they were made of stones.

Among the finds at Olduvai were the chopper, fist hatchet (core tools) and several flake tools.Such tools were also found at Kobi For a near Lake Turkana, Omo River Valley in Ethiopia, and Kafu Valley in Uganda, Shaba province in Zaire and in Algeria, Tunisia and morocco.In Kenya, the tools were found at sites in kariandusi, Olorgesaillie, Kilombe, Chesowanja, Mtongwe, Isenya and Lewa DownsAustralopithecus “Southern Ape” They didn’t have the intelligence to make sophisticated tools, so they may have made tools out of bones that they foundAustralopithecus afarensis mostly used tools that they found or that nature had created, example was a stick, which they stuck into a termite mound, then the termites clung to it letting the ape pull out the stick covered in food. He is however also credited for making Oldowan tools.

Homo habilis and the Oldowan Tradition

They made stone tools for chopping, scraping, and cutting. Making of Choppers (lower left) involved knapping a few flakes off the core. Both cores and flakes were used. The Knapper could strike a spherical piece of stone until Flake falls off opposite side. The Tool would then be flipped over and procedure repeated. Several blows would create a cutting edgeRequirements reflect Intelligence, Planning, foreknowledge of design and Knowledge of breakage pattern of rock. There must also be Hand-eye coordination

The second phase of the Old Stone Age was marked by tools called Acheulian tools, named after the site of St Acheul in France. Others found in Tanzania, Uganda, Malawi, Zambia, and Zimbabwe. In Kenya, the tools were found at Kariandusi, Olorgesaillie, Kilombe, Chesowanja, Mtongwe, Isenya and Lewa DownsThey were made by Homoerectus. Homo erectus and the Acheulian tool technology. Signature tool: a well-designed hand axe and cleavers

The Hand axe had multiple uses, from cutting, skinning, scraping animal skins, digging and sharpening bone and wood.

Characteristics of Acheulian hand axe

~ It was Bifacial: both sides were knapped

~ Symmetrical in breadth

~ Shaped to a point on one end

~ The edge is thin and sharp

~ Broad end is curved, but edge is still sharp.

Process of Manufacturing Acheulian Hand axes

Dozens of flakes were removed from the core, from 25 to 75. Each flake blow must be precisely positioned. The Core must be turned over again and again to maintain symmetry and to keep edge straight. All the exterior rind (cortex) was removed. It was a demanding task-The hand axe was Symmetrical and finely shaped.

OLD STONE AGE-HUNTING AND GATHERING

The early Stone Age people lived in small groups and were able to hunt for food using sharpened rocks and sticks. They used simple hunting methods of chasing wild animals and throwing stones at them. They also made traps by digging large pits on the paths used by animals. They ate raw meat from small animals like lizards and rodents

Women gathered edible fruits, eggs and roots- had a balanced diet.

THE OLD STONE AGE-SHELTER AND CLOTHING

Humans during this period found shelter in caves and tree-tops.

Their bodies were hairy enough to keep them warm- lack of clothing was therefore bearable during this period. Moreover, the savannahs were also warm enough.

They also preferred the grasslands because they provided them with the much needed water and foodThe Australopithecus had a very small brain and that limited the actions they could do. The Australopithecus were very hairy so they didn’t need any clothes. Australopithecus diet was mostly made up of fruits and vegetables they found. If Australopithecus found a dead animal it would scavenge of it but the Australopithecus afarensis couldn’t cook the meat and kill the germs.

Mesolithic age

Mesolithic“middle Stone” Age- 200,000– 10,000 years ago.

They period was characterized by superior brains and ability of Homo erectus and Homo sapiens. Great improvements were witnessed.

TOOLS

Signature tool; Sangoan tool made using Lavallois method

The tool was named after Sango Bay site on L. Victoria-Tz

The Lavallois technology

It involved using cores of smaller stones to hit bigger ones. The tool maker would draw outline of flake on stone module and Strike out flakes and blades of desired shape. The rock would be prepared beforehand to control how rock breaks when struck. The flakes and blades were then trimmed into a variety of knives, scrapers, spear points, choppers and daggers.Also Mousterian tools (specialized stone tools and weapons) were made.

Tang- the first tool with a handle was invented in this period- 40,000 years ago in northern Africa.Fire was also another important tool invented by Homo erectus and he used it as follows

~ For warmth at night, lighting, to cook roots and roast meat, for hunting (bushfires), tool-making to harden tips, means of communication, food preservation

~ It also enabled hominids to migrate out of savannah

MESOLITHIC – FOOD AND CLOTHES

Homo erectus was considered the first true hunters. Because of better tools

(Hand axe), fire and axes, they could hunt larger game such as deer, rhinos, pigs, elephants; buffaloes etc. and cook their food.People learnt to wear animal skins and make waist-belts and necklaces. They also painted themselves with red ochre and oil.

MESOLITHIC – SHELTER.

Man used identifiable shelter. An example was found at Orangia in South Africa. Man also used rock shelter (rocks scooped out to make hollows). Later man lived in caves with entrance covered with animal skins to keep wind and rain away (e.g. Matupi Cave in Zaire and Gambles cave near Nakuru.

MESOLITHIC – LANGUAGE AND ROCK ART

Families lived in small groups for security reasons. There were distinct languages to enhance communications.Rock paintings-Pictures of animals were painted on walls and rocks. Examples of Cave paintings were left behind at Kondoa and singida areas in north Tanzania and at Apollo II cave in S.A.  This pictures signified man’s believe in magic (arrows piercing animals he hoped to kill)

SOCIAL ORGANIZATION

There was efficient group organization as evidenced by the ability to carry out large-scale hunting. Language invention further strengthened the social bonds and cultures of early man

The Neolithic age

Neolithic  “New Stone” Age- 15,000 – 4,000 years ago

This period was marked with the Emergence of Homo sapiens and homo sapien sapiens.

THE NEOLITHIC TOOLS

Man became a Very skilled toolmaker-they made tools known as microliths- (small piece of sharp stone tool). For example, a crescent or a lunate which had a straight sharp cutting edge and a curved blunted back.Their weapons include stone axes, knives, spears, harpoons, wooden bows, and sharp, stone tipped arrows, hooks, needles, and bone fish hooks.NEANDERTHALS were the first to create the pointed tip on hunting spears and harpoons

THE NEOLITHIC SHELTER

Earlier sapiens used caves as their homes instead of building one. Later, they made permanent homes that looked like tents or tepees, out of tree branches, grass, mammoth bones, and animal skins. They used or made some sort of paint to use on their cave paintings.

FOOD AND AGRICULTURE

Man domesticated plants and animals though he continued to hunt and gather.

Man changed as from Nomadic lifestyle to settled stationary lifestyle; a.k.a.sedentary

Population also increased due to balanced diet and adequate food

 

 

THE NEOLITHIC GOVERNMENT

Due to settled life and improved settlement, rules and laws were set up as a basis of government. Some people also specialized in leadership, religious activities as well as making of crafts.

THE NEOLITHIC RELIGION

Man’s language and religious beliefs developed as a result of depending on natural forces like rain. They began to ponder over issues like life and death.Evidence is found at Hyrax Hill and Njoro river Cave where human fossil remains were found buried with items such as tools and seeds or foodThe practice of burying someone with his possessions implied a belief in life after death.Neanderthals were the first to bury their dead. They also seemed to have a conception of an afterlife as shown by the actual burial site at La Ferrassie, France, with seven tombs including a man, a woman and several children’s graves lying side by side.

THE NEOLITHIC ART AND CRAFT

Humans specialized in crafts such as basketry, pottery and later smelting

Evidenced by this horse’ head carving to the right.

DEVELOPMENT OF AGRICULTURE

Definition of agriculture

It is the cultivation of crops. The modern definition of agriculture includes animal husbandry, fish farming and bee-keeping.

The beginning of Agriculture

The domestication of plants and animals began over 10,000 years ago during the Neolithic period

Why man domesticated plants and animals

  1. The increase of human population needed regular food supply -natural environment could no longer provide sufficient food.
  2. Climatic changes-increased drought, threatened plant life and animal life making natural food scarce.
  3. Competition for existing food in the natural resulted in inadequate wild food/over hunting of animals.
  4. Hunting and gathering was increasingly becoming tiresome.
  5. Calamities such as forest fires or floods sometimes destroyed vegetation or drove wild animals away.
  6. Development of settled life. Man had to stop a life of movement in search of food and water.
  7. Development of tools (microliths) e.g. sickles wooden plough, etc.
  8. Availability of varieties of indigenous crops e.g. wheat and barley.

There are two theories that explain how agriculture started;

  1. The Independent theory. Agriculture developed independently in different parts of the world especially along river valleys.
  2. One Place Theory/Diffusion Theory-Crop growing and animal keeping developed among people of south East Asia. Then the idea spread to the rest of the world; Middle East, India, Central America, China, Southeast Asia 8,000 BC 7,000 BC 6,500 BC 6,000 BC 5,000 BC

CROP GROWING

The transformation from hunting and gathering to growing of food crops was a gradual development. The first crops were grown by man in areas where they existed naturally.

Crop growing first developed in the Fertile Crescent which is in the Middle East.

Neolithic women noticed new grain plants grew when they accidentally spilled grain seeds. They tried scattering seeds on purpose – it worked!

~ Animals often find plants in places with water / good soil – Hunters saw pattern

~ People stayed at sites, animals became tamer

~ People started weeding / irrigating so plants would grow better

~ Started saving seeds of better plants to plant

~ One season, nomads liked a site so much they stuck around

~ Stayed so long they harvested a crop and then saw it grow to harvest stage again

~ Groups learned to grow a crop from seed to harvest and then move on

~ Since men did the hunting and females were responsible for the food gathering, women learned how to plant seeds, as well as process and prepare the food.

The above facts point out that the beginning of crop farming was accidental and mainly through trial and errorEarliest crops to be domesticated were barley, wheat, sorghum, millet, rice, maize, yams, cassava, potatoes, bananas and grapes. Since they grew in different environments, there were many centres of agricultural revolution. For example;

~ Middle East.

~ Indus valley in India.

~ Nile valley

~ The yellow river valley in china

~ The Danube Valley in Europe.

WHEAT

Originally grown in south-west Asia

Initial type was brittle wheat-then replaced by a non-brittle type in 7500BC called emmer

Wheat then spread Mesopotamian plains by 6000 BC to Egypt by 3000BC, then to Mediterranean region, central Asia, India and southern Europe.

BARLEY

The first cereal to be domesticated.Initially grew wildly at Mureybat on the Euphrates in Syria between 7000 – 6000 BC Another evidence of growth found at Ali kosh (Iran) and Jericho (Jordan)Then spread to Egypt at Fayum in 4500 BC. Then spread to India and china by about 2000 BC.

SORGHUM AND MILLET

Originated from Africa at Hoggat in southern Algeria as early as 6000 BC

Spread to West Africa to around Sudan area between Nile and Chad, by 1500 BC

Finger millet originated in East Africa.

Later the two spread to Asia and China.

RICE

Originated in Asia where currently is a stable food- in Thailand at about 3500 BC

Then spread to India, Europe and Japan

The African variety was grown along the upper Niger around 1500 BC

MAIZE

Origin- Central America at about 5000 BC at Tehuacan in Mexico.

In Africa, was introduced by the Portuguese in 15thc.

YAMS

The first root and tuber crop to be domesticated- 9000 BC in south East Asia.

The African variety, the white guinea yam was grown in Ivory Coast.

DOMESTICATION OF ANIMALS

The Dog was the first animal to be domesticated. The next animals were the sheep, Goats, cattle and camels. Animal domestication Began through establishment of ties between man and animals during hunting or when fetching water.

Dog

Assisted humans in hunting, driving away dangerous animals and herding livestock

Goats

The Goat was first domesticated in south west Asia in5000 BC.Evidence of this is found at Tell Abu Hureyra, Tepe Ali Kosh, and Deh Luren Khuzestan in south -west Iran. Also in Iraq, upper Tigris valley, turkey and south Jordan. Goat domestication was in Egypt in 5000 BC Sheep.Sheep was domesticated after the dog. Fossil evidence of sheep keeping has been found at Zawi Chemi Shanid in Iraq and dating to about 9000 BC. Sheep were also kept in Syria, Egypt and Saharan region then to West Africa. Sheep was also kept in Indus valley and yellow river valleys.

Cattle

Cattle was first domesticated in south-west Asia as early as 5800BC in turkey and then in Iran and Iraq. It then spread to Ethiopia and North Africa from Asia.

The short-horned cattle originated in Mesopotamia then spread to Africa and Europe.

Camel

Though camels are associated with North Africa today, the original home has been traced to North America from where t spread to South America and Asia. The Asian and s. American species became the ancestors of the Alpaca and Illama.Two types of camels exist today- the one-humped (found in Middle East, northern china and Africa), and the two-humped camel (found in central Asia.) Camels were domesticated about 3000 BC to 2500 BC

 

 

Importance of the domestication of animals

  1. a) Some of them like cattle, sheep and goats provided man with regular food i.e. Milk, meat.
  2. b) Animal Hides or skin were used as clothing and beddings
  3. c) The horns were used for communication.
  4. d) Hooves and bones of animals were used as containers and as drinking vessels.
  5. e) Some of the domesticated animals like the camel, donkey and horses were used for transport.
  6. f) Domestic animals like the oxen and the donkey were used to plough land for farming.
  7. g) The dog protected man against dangerous animals.
  8. h) Some of the domesticated animals produced manure which greatly improved

agricultural produce.

EARLY AGRICULTURE IN MESOPOTAMIA

Mesopotamia was the land between the two rivers Tigris and Euphrates and lay in the present day irag. It was one of the centres of early civilization as early as 3000 BC.

Food production in this region began as early as 8000 BC.

Reasons why early agriculture developed in Mesopotamia

  1. a) Availability of indigenous crops and animals in the region e.g. Wheat, barley, dates and goats, sheep and cattle.
  2. b) Existence of fertile land along river valleys of Tigris and Euphrates-consisting of deposited silt.
  3. c) Availability of water from rivers Tigris and Euphrates which was used for irrigation. Heavy rains experienced in the Zaggroes Mountains contributed to floods on the river valleys.
  4. d) Invention of farming tools e.g. Hoes, ploughs, sickles and seed drill which promoted agricultural activities.
  5. e) Existence of transport system in form of donkeys, canoes, river transport etc; which was instrumental in transportation of inputs and outputs.
  6. f) Political instability that enabled people to practice agriculture.

The Sumerians are credited as the first people to use irrigation in growing crops. When the river water overflowed the banks during flooding, the Sumerians had the skill of controlling it through canals into the dry lands. (Canal or bucket irrigation). They also used farm implements to improve crop growing. For example the use of ox-drawn ploughs and seed drills pulled by oxen to replace stone hoes.Most of the people during the summer civilization earned their livelihood as farmers, craftsmen, fishermen and cattle breeders.Most of the land was in form of large estates owned by the rulers or the wealthy classes. The peasants were given small plots along with seeds, farm implements and animals in exchange for labour.

The Crops grown included barley, wheat, vines, date, palms, grapes, olives, onions, figs, melons and cucumbers. Milk animals kept included goats and cow. Also ducks, pigs, geese and horses were kept.

Impact of early agriculture in Mesopotamia

  1. a) It led to settled life as people now needed to concentrate on farming.
  2. b) Food production increased.
  3. c) There was an increase in population along the river valleys due to plenty and regular food supply.
  4. d) There was emergence of city-states and urban centres. For example Ur, Uruk, Eridu, Nippur, Kish and Babylon.
  5. e) Surplus agricultural production led to development of trade between communities.
  6. f) There was increased specialization as all could not engage in farming. Some became craftsmen.
  7. g) Agriculture influenced writing and arithmetic. Management of estates required knowledge in accounts. The form of writing that was developed was known as cuneiform involving the use of stone tablets.
  8. h) The invention of the wheel by around 3000 BC. it was used in carts to transport farm produce, for making war chariots to transport soldiers and also in pottery (the potter’s wheel)
  9. i) The plough was also invented. The first ox-plough consisted of simply a tree trunk with one small branch protruding upwards with the other one upwards. The invention meant that only a few people were needed to cultivate land.
  10. j) There was the development of science and mathematics with the development of the first formulas for measuring time, distance and area. There was also development in the field of Astronomy.
  11. k) Religious practices also developed with the connection of most of the gods to

agriculture in one way or another. For example, Ninurta was a god of floods.

  1. l) Development of law. A code of laws was compiled as a means of minimizing conflict in society- the Hammurabi’s code.

EARLY AGRICULTURE IN EGYPT

As early as 7000 BC, people had already settled in the Nile valley. By around 5000 BC, the Egyptians had gradually adopted agriculture, departing from a hunter-gatherer society.

Reasons that enhanced development of early Agriculture in Egypt

  1. a) Availability of Water for irrigation and for domestic use from river Nile.
  2. b) Existence of fertile silt deposits and mud originating from the flooding of the Nile betweenJuly and October annually, which provided fertile soil for crop farming.
  3. c) Another advantage was that Egypt had a suitable warm climate for crop growing and ripening.
  4. d) The Use of shadoof Irrigation technology ensured production of food during drought seasons
  5. e) Presence of indigenous crops and animals from which domestication was made. Wheat and barley had already become indigenous to Egypt as were animals like sheep and goats.
  6. f) Foreign influence from South West Asia where farming was first practiced. The proximity of Egypt to Mesopotamia, the first centre of agricultural development ensured that she borrowed heavily from there.
  7. g) The Natural protection of the region from foreign attacks, since the Nile valley was protected by the Libyan Desert to the West, the Nubian Desert and Nile cataracts to the South and the Nile coast delta on the North.
  8. h) Political stability.
  9. i) High population created need for more food and provided farm labour.
  10. j) Availability of slave labour made crop farming a success.
  11. k) The invention and use of implements that included wooden sticks, knives and wooden hoes enabled the farmers to increase their yields.
  12. l) The existence of writing in Egypt helped the Egyptians to keep accurate records of seasons and volume of food.

The shadoof irrigation

This was the method of irrigation used in Egypt during the drought season when the river was not flooding. A shadoof is a wooden device for lifting water from a river into the canals. It consisted of a long pole swinging up and down between two supporting wooden posts One end has a weight hanging on the pole while the other end has a skin bucket. The bucket is pulled down and dipped into the water by a person. It is caused to rise by the weight, once water has been filled. The other person empties the water into the canal to be drained into the fields.The Egyptians used farm implements like sticks, knives, axes, sickles and hoesAmong the crops planted in Egypt included wheat, barley, fruits, flax, beans, vegetables, cucumbers, onions, lentils, dates, figs and grapes. They used the broadcasting method. Shifting cultivation was also practiced before human population increased.They kept animals like sheep, goat, pigs, donkey, cattle and poultry.

The state directed production. It controlled distribution of harvests as well as handicrafts.

Government owned huge granaries and godowns which were used to store food.

The king was regarded as the guardian who presided over food supply for all. The master of largesse was responsible for all the livestock in the country. In the year when agricultural production was poor, the head of the exchequer would take care of the distribution of seeds and livestock.

Effects of early agriculture in Egypt

  1. a) Due to improved farming, there was increased food production thus ensuring regular food supplies.
  2. b) There was Growth in population as food supply increased and became regular.
  3. c) Agriculture led to permanent settlement of people. As a result, their living standards improved dramatically as they reaped from farming.
  4. d) Agriculture promoted trade among the Egyptians. It led to production of surplus food that in turn was used to increase trading activities.
  5. e) Agriculture Led to rise of urban centres or towns in Egypt such as Memphis’s akhetan, Aswan and Thebes along the Nile valley.
  6. f) Agriculture enabled some society members to specialize in other activities since a few could now produce enough food for all. Some engaged in hand crafts, geometry etc.
  7. g) Agriculture Led to emergence of government and related governing laws.
  8. h) Like the case of Mesopotamia, it led to the discovery of arithmetic, geometry, writing and calendar. These were used by the priests to keep records and make accurate prediction of annual foods. The Egyptian calendar is believed to be the earliest calendar in the world.
  9. i) It promoted social stratification or classes in Egyptian society.

Effects of early agriculture

Summarize from the effects in Egypt and Mesopotamia.

THE AGRARIAN REVOLUTION IN BRITAIN

The agrarian revolution refers to rapid changes and improvements in the field of agriculture.

Between 1750 and 1850 European countries underwent changes in agriculture.

The changes were marked by

 A new system of land ownership

 Use of machines and new farming methods.

The revolution took place first in Britain.

CHARACTERISTICS OF AGRICULTURE IN BRITAIN BEFORE THE AGRARIAN REVOLUTION

  1. Feudalism was practiced.

What is Feudalism?

“Loosely organized system of government in which local lords governed their own lands but owed military service and other support to a greater lord (nobility)”

The feudal kings had plenty of land; but they could not control it all. So they gave land to lords (nobility) in exchange for protection, loyalty and $.Nobility then gave Part of their land to the serfs (peasants) who would work on it and give part of their crops to the local (land) lord, for letting them farm the land.

  1. Farmers practiced open-field system.

In this system land was divided into three portions;

  1. Portion one- growing corn and wheat
  2. Portion two- for beans, barley and oats

III. Portion three- left fallow to regain fertility.

Such a system did not allow effective farming since land was not fully utilized.

It also discouraged livestock farming since it allowed easy spread of livestock diseases.

There was uncontrolled breeding in livestock instead of selective breeding since livestock grazed together.

Fallow land and existence of Cattle and footpaths that crisscrossed the farms wasted a lot of land.

  1. Stripping as a method of farming was used. The existence of strips meant that Land portions were small and discouraged the use of machines.
  2. Use of simple tools and implements that included sticks, hoes and later ploughs. Cultivation was therefore on small scale with crop rotation being used as a method of improving fertility. It was however not effective.
  3. Use of broadcasting method. Broadcasting method of planting led to wastage of seeds as it would be eaten by birds and rodents
  4. Intercropping was practiced. The growing of two or more crops on the same piece of land.
  5. Mixed farming. Livestock was allowed to graze on fallow land
  6. Mono-cropping-planting the same type of crop year after on the same piece of land. NB; this was an inefficient system leading to low yields

CHANGES THAT MARKED THE AGRARIAN REVOLUTION IN BRITAIN

  1. Fallows were abolished and available lands used effectively. This was influenced by population that occasioned demand for more food. The farmers could no longer afford to leave land to regain fertility.
  2. Application of new methods of farming.

Introduction and use of fertilizers in farms  

Lord Viscount Townsend discovered that clover added nitrogen to the soil and turnips could survive in winter and be used to feed cattle.

Townsend introduced a new four- course crop rotation called the Norfolk system consisting of barley, clover, turnips and wheat on same plot for a four-year period.

In 1843, John Bennet Lawes discovered the use of fertilizers and opened a superphosphate factory in London.

  1. Use of farm machineries like the horse drawn drilling machine invented by Jethro Tull in 1701 which replaced the broadcasting method. Iron hoes were used instead of sticks, to prepare the ground. In 1925, the wooden plough was replaced with an iron plough. Patrick Bell’s invention of the mechanical reaper replaced the sickle in harvesting corn. Andrew Meikles invented a mechanical thresher in 1876 which could cut and bind corn at the same time.

The use of machines changed agriculture from a small scale to a large-scale business.

  1. Intercropping to retain land fertility. E.g. of maize and beans. This practice enabled farmers to realize more yields.
  2. Application of scientific principles to farming. For example, Selective breeding of livestock invented by Robert Bakewell (1725-1795). He was able to develop the short horn, Devon, the Hereford, Aberdeen Angus and Ayrshire. He also improved sheep breeds such as the Leicester, Shropshire, Suffolk and the oxford. Pig varieties- the Yorkshire, Berkshire and Tamworth breeds
  3. Fencing of farms/land enclosure system; the introduction of land enclosures put to an end to strip farming. This was a demand of the rich landlords that land should be enclosed by fencing. The enclosure act enabled rich people to acquire more land. As a result more land was put under production and more land could be ploughed by one farmer

Positive effects of the land enclosure system introduced in Britain

  1. a) It created large farms which allowed use of horse drill and crop -rotation.
  2. b) The farms were easily managed and Farmers could specialize in crop or animal

production.

  1. c) Farmers could use their title deeds to borrow money from financial firms for the

improvement of their farms.

Effects of the land enclosure movement on the peasant farmers in Britain

  1. The creation of large farms led to landlessness among the peasant farmers,
  2. Peasant farmers sold off their land to the rich farmers because they could not

afford to cultivate the land.

  1. The land enclosure movement led to displacement of peasant farmers from their

land and hence they migrated to towns/ caused rural -urban migration.

  1. The rural-urban migration of peasant farmers led to overcrowding in urban centres/ congestion in urban centres.
  2. The land enclosure movement caused emigrations of the peasants to other

countries such as USA, Canada, Australia, new Zealand and south Africa

  1. The poor farmers were exploited, as they had to sell their labour to farmers and to the factories / exploitation of the poor peasant’s labour force.
  2. The royal agricultural society. It was established in 1838. Through the journals of the society, new ideas and techniques of farming were publicized all over the country. As a result, many farmers began to adopt the modern methods of farming.

CAUSES OF AGRARIAN REVOLUTION IN BRITAIN

  1. Land consolidation; the introduction of land enclosures which put to an end to strip farming. As a result more land was under production and more land could be ploughed by one farmer.
  2. Development of new methods of livestock breeding; more scientific methods of breeding livestock were developed. They involved selective breeding in which animals with suitable characteristics were maintained in the herds.
  3. Development of new tools for farming which helped to increase agricultural productivity .e.g. use of seed drill, Rotterdam plough, threshing machine and tractors.
  4. Development of new methods of maintaining soil fertility e.g. the new crop rotation system allowed the continued use of land without exhausting its fertility. Chemical fertilizers were also produced.
  5. Development of agricultural research in universities and research institutes assisted in improvement of soils and crop yields. Newspapers and agricultural journals helped to spread the results of this research to farmers.
  6. Impact of industrial revolution which provided the agricultural sector with inputs and market.
  7. Population increase led to high demand for food.

EFFECTS OF THE AGRARIAN REVOLUTION IN BRITAIN

  1. Food security for the population of Britain due to improved farming methods.
  2. There was Growth of population in Britain due to food security lowered mortality rates and increased life expectancy.
  3. There was Growth of capital/plantation farming to replace subsistence farming. Due to the enclosure act, ownership of large farms was encouraged and subsequently mechanization/plantations were set up.
  4. Poor farmers who could not afford fencing lost their land. Capital farming therefore led to emergence of landless peasants as large tracts of land were consolidated in enclosures. The poor peasants were compelled to migrate to urban areas where they were subjected to poor living conditions.
  5. Trade expanded locally and internationally. When farming was commercialized, Britain expanded trade thus boosting her economy.
  6. Growth of a working class. The landless peasants sought wage employment on farms or in towns in the emerging new industries. Thus a class of workers began to emerge.
  7. Transport systems like roads and railways improved. They were used to transport agricultural products to the market and raw materials to industries.
  8. Industries benefited from agricultural raw materials/ develop ment of industries. A number of machines produced by industries were also used in agriculture to boost production.
  9. Emigration of British national to other parts of the world. Some of the landless peasants migrated to USA, Canada, Australia, New Zealand and South Africa.
  10. Intensification of scientific research by the royal agricultural society to carter for the expanding agricultural sector.

THE SPREAD OF AGRARIAN REVOLUTION

From Britain the revolution spread to other parts of Europe and Americas and then the rest of the world. Ideas like crop rotation, use of machines, selective breeding of livestock and use of fertilizers spread into continental Europe from Britain. The governments encouraged agricultural science and research.

The work of Louis Pasteur (1890-1960) a Frenchman discovered that disease are caused by bacteria and sterilization of food such as milk through boiling keeps it bacteria-free for long time

THE AGRARIAN REVOLUTION IN THE USA

The Americas was the origin of many crops in the world the American Indians were subsistence farmers growing crops like yams, potatoes, maize (corn), cocoa, tomatoes, cotton, tobacco, beans and cassava.Political and religious differences in Europe in the 17th c forced many Europeans to settle in America as was also the enclosure system in Britain. Craftsmen and labouerers also moved in search of better life. The immigrant settlers came with horses, sheep, cattle, pigs, fowls, seeds and plants from Europe. Some of them participated in improving the machines that were already in use in Europe. For example:

  1. 1837- John Deere a young blacksmith from Illinois invented a steel plough
  2. 1837- Cyrus McCormick established a factory in Chicago to produce reapers
  3. 1837- Daniel Massey produced a similar machine in Canada.
  4. 1792- Elly Whitney invented the cotton gin and cotton picker

American scientists also developed the refrigerator. For example, John Perkins (1766-1849) an American inventor patented the first prototype refrigerator in England in 1834. The first American patent for a refrigerator was awarded to John Gorrie (1803-1855) in 1851.1859- Ferdinand Carre, a Frenchman invented the absorption system in a refrigerator. This was a major milestone in preservation of meat and other foods in America.Several agricultural zones emerged in America due to differences in soil fertility and climate:

  1. North-Eastern parts- Ranching and dairying
  2. The south- cotton zone.
  3. Central region-maize.
  4. North-west wheat

There was large scale mechanized agriculture especially after the abolition of slave trade. Most cash crops were grown to provide raw materials to European industries. Tobacco was grown in Virginia and Maryland. Rice and indigo were grown in Georgia and South Carolina. Cattle’s rearing was done in Texas.Transport development also enhanced agricultural development. For example, water transport using the great lakes, railway and road transport.Alexander graham bell invented the telegraph to enhance communication.

USA also invested in the field of science and research which boosted agriculture with better hybrid seeds and different strains of livestock.

FACTORS THAT FACILITATED THE DEVELOPMENT OF AGRICUL-TURE IN AMERICA BEFORE 1800

  1. The enclosure system in Britain led to the Settlement of enterprising European emigrants who wished to make a living through agriculture/Determination of European immigrants to succeed as farmers as there was no other source of livelihood. European immigration into the region also led to population increase and demand for more food. The immigrants also introduced new crops and new methods of farming leading to agricultural development
  2. Scientific research made it possible to improve strains of crops to resist diseases, to develop superior animal breeds and to develop new food crops e.g. Soya beans into artificial meat, etc.
  3. Mechanization; there was extensive use of machines to improve production e.g. steel plough, use of reapers, cotton gin etc.
  4. The presence of cheap means of transport e.g. Erie Canal, roads, railway, etc speeded up the transportation of goods and raw materials.
  5. The invention of the cotton gin in 1793 led to increased cotton acreage.
  6. Environmental influence on the farmers through experience leading to agricultural zoning e.g. maize in the centre, wheat in the south and beef rearing in the west/Presence of suitable soils for different types of crops such as tobacco, cotton and wheat.
  7. Government recognition of individual land ownership (the Homestead Act 1760)

encouraged settlers to farm.

EFFECTS OF THE AGRARIAN REVOLUTION IN USA

Fuelled by peasants who emigrated after they were driven out of Europe by the land enclosure movement, USA became the world’s leading producer of agricultural products.

The effects of the revolution were as follows:

  1. a) It led to diversification of agriculture through the introduction of new farm animals and crops.
  2. b) The new inventions in farm machinery enabled American farmers to bring more land under cultivation. For example the steel plough invented by John Deere and reaping machine by Cyrus McCormick.
  3. c) Food production especially of wheat and maize, increased due to the use of new farming methods like use of fertilizers and hybrid seeds.
  4. d) The agrarian revolution led to expansion of agricultural related industries.
  5. e) Mechanization of agriculture replaced slaves and other labourers at the farms. Many people went to search for employment in urban areas.
  6. f) The expansion of food production led to increase in trade between USA and Western Europe thus boosting USA economy.
  7. g) The transport system was improved to enable transportation of farm inputs to farms and agricultural produce to market.
  8. h) The revolution contributed to the enhancement of research and scientific inventions especially on the field of agriculture.

FOOD SITUATION IN AFRICA AND THE REST OF THE THIRD WORLD

“Third world” refers to the less developed countries in Africa, Asia and South America.

Many of these third world countries have food shortages and even continue to have weak economies upto date.

Causes to food shortage in Africa

  1. Rapid population growth which has put a lot of pressure on the available food resources leading to shortages
  2. Poor land use and agricultural practices. Many farmers still depend on traditional farming methods, for example, not applying fertilizers, pesticides or mechanization, thus producing low yields.
  3. Some developing countries experience adverse weather conditions such as floods and long periods of drought. Since these countries practice rain-fed agriculture, food production has been affected
  4. Overemphasis on cash crops at the expense of food crops has contributed to low food production. In Kenya for example, large farms concentrate on growth of flowers, tea and coffee with food crop farming being largely for subsistence.
  5. Rural-urban migration , especially among the young people has deprived the rural areas of the badly needed labour force for food production
  6. Lack of adequate capital for agricultural development. Low income/poverty. The farmers lack enough funds to purchase farm inputs.
  7. Political instability in some African countries undermines food production. For example in Ethiopia, Sudan, DRC, Burundi and Rwanda. This has prevented people from concentrating on food production.
  8. Decline in growing drought resistant crops. Crops like cassava and millet have been abandoned due to attitude thus causing artificial shortage of specific food.
  9. Poor and inadequate storage facilities have led to food wastage. In Kenya by 2001, the country was losing up to nine million bags of grain per year as a result of poor storage methods.
  10. Poor transport network leads to uneven distribution of food. It also discourages farmers from producing more.
  11. Over reliance on food aid and forms of aid has created a dependence attitude in many African countries. Some communities have become complacent about looking for a permanent solution to their food problems.
  12. Poor economic planning on the part of the government with many countries putting a lot of emphasis on other development projects at the expense of agricultural and food production.
  13. Poor land tenure systems resulting in low productivity. For example where a few European farmers own large tracts of land but only exploiting a small portion of the expansive farms.
  14. The HIV/AIDS pandemic contributed to food shortages since the scourge leads to death of many of the work force in their prime years.

Effects of food shortages

  1. Loss of life. Many people have lost their lives. For example the Ethiopian famine in 1984 led to the deaths of thousands of people.
  2. Increased suffering among millions of people in Africa due to deficiency diseases like kwashiorkor and marasmus.
  3. Food shortage has created social problems in societies. For example cattle raids by the karamojong and Maasai during the periods of famine. Even other anti-social problems like stealing food in rural areas can be attributed to inadequate food supply.
  4. Sometimes famine and drought has forced people to flee their home countries thus causing refugee problems in the receiving countries.
  5. Lack of food hampers efforts towards economic development. It Affects education since famine stricken children cannot concentrate on learning. There is Use of scarce foreign exchange to import food.
  6. It has created dependence on food aid from rich countries. Even some of the genetically created foods are tested in third world countries. Such foods have unknown side-effects.
  7. It has adversely affected agricultural-based industries.e.g sugar industries.-inevitably thisleads to unemployment.
  8. It has led to Political instability as people lose confidence in the governments that cannot feed them.

Solutions to food shortage in Africa

  1. Land reclamation thus increasing land under agriculture. This may increase food production.
  2. Re-formulation of agricultural policies so that there is a shift from a concentration on cash crops to paying more attention on food crops.
  3. Provision of extension services to farmers e.g. information on storage, preservation of farm produce and other forms of advice.
  4. Revision of the land tenure system- redistribution of land / land reforms as case is in china.
  5. Development of agro-based industries which will become market to agricultural raw materials like coffee, tea, etc.
  6. Creation of political stability to enable mobilization of people to self-sufficiency in food production.
  7. Relentless campaign against killer disease such as AIDS.
  8. Infrastructural development/ in transport, communication, storage and marketing.
  9. Environmental conservation measures which may help curb drought spread and ensure sufficient rains./ protection of catchments areas
  10. Family planning so that people only have children they can be able to feed, cloth and shelter.
  11. Demand for food to feed the growing population.

STEPS KENYA HAS TAKEN TO SOLVE FOOD SHORTAGES

  1. a) Extensive research has been carried out in research institutions such as the Kenya Agricultural Research Institute (KARI) producing hybrid maize such as Katumani that grows in drier areas. ICIPE and ILRI researches in pests and disease that affect both livestock and crops in the country.
  2. b) Introduction of genetically engineered crops and animal s into the agricultural sector. These crops, developed mainly at JKUAT and KARI are resistant to diseases and pests.
  3. c) Agricultural training institutions have been established to train experts such as agricultural officers, veterinary doctors and horticultural experts. Agriculture is also taught in schools- to equip learners with new and better techniques of farming that could boost production.
  4. d) People are being educated about the need for family planning so that families have only number of children whom they can feed and provide for.
  5. e) The government has formulated a food security policy to enhance production of food in the country. For example a minimum amount of cereals in the government silos has been set up with urgent measures to top up outlined.

THE PEOPLE OF KENYA UP TO THE 19THCENTURY

INTRODUCTION

There is immense evidence to confirm that east Africa was the cradle of humankind.

Archaeological evidence (for example, the tools found at kobi for a, Olorgesaillie, kariandusi, Mtongwe, around Lake Victoria, lukenya hills, near lake Naivasha) show that Kenya was inhabited by Stone Age people. There is also evidence of use of iron in Kenya dating back as AD270 e.g. at Urewe near Ngiya in Siaya and in Kwale.

THE KHOISAN

According to oral traditions, the earliest people to occupy Kenya were of the Khoisan stock. They had similar features like the Khoi khoi and the san of South Africa, the Sandawe and Hadza of Tanzania. They all spoke a language with a clicking sound.

Cultural aspects of the Khoisan

  1. a) They Spoke a language with a clicking sound like the khoi-khoi of south Africa
  2. b) They were nomadic people
  3. c) They gathered the wild fruit in the wild and dug up tubers and roots for their foods
  4. d) They used stone tools in addition to bows and arrows.
  5. e) They fished in rivers and lakes using harpoons
  6. f) They made use of rock shelters and caves.
  7. g) They buried the dead.
  8. h) Made and used pottery.

NB- such evidence of the culture of the Khoisan has been found in Gambles and Njoro river caves near Nakuru.These pioneering inhabitants of Kenya disappeared maybe after being subdued and overcome by the powerful incoming Bantus and nilotes.However, there exist some remnants of these hunter-gatherer communities in the western highlands of rift valley. They speak the language of the group near them like kalenjin (okiek), Maasai (Dorobo), Onguye and Okuro in western Kenya.

 

THE CUSHITES

They existed in two groups:

  1. a) The southern Cushites
  2. b) The eastern Cushites.

The southern Cushites

They might have entered present day Kenya through northern Kenya and seem to have originated from the Ethiopian highlands. Since they were pastoralists, they must have been looking for better pasture for their livestock.Around 2500 and 3000 years ago, they were already occupying the grasslands of the Kenya highlands cultivating food crops like sorghum , millet and rearing long horned humpless cattle. They even extended upto Tanzania. They included the Iraqi, Boni and Burungi of Tanzania, The Dahallo or Sanye of the lower Tana (the remaining southern Cushites in Kenya). Some were later absorbed by the incoming groups.

The Eastern Cushites

They include the Borana, Somali, Oromo, Gabra, Rendille and Burji.

They originated either from Ethiopia or Somalia moving and settling into Kenya around 2000 and 1000 years ago due to the following reasons;

  1. a) Escaping from clan or family feuds.
  2. b) There was population pressure in their area of origin.
  3. c) They were in search of better grazing lands.
  4. d) They were fleeing the outbreak of disease that affected both people and animals.
  5. e) They were escaping famine and drought.
  6. f) They fled constant attacks from their neighbours such as the Somali.
  7. g) The migrated to satisfy their spirit of adventure.

THE OROMO

They came in the 16thcentury from Ethiopia. Initially they settled on the eastern shores of Lake Turkana. They later moved south pushing the Mijikenda and the Pokomo out of the Shungwaya to occupy Malindi and Kilifi. Today they occupy the southern part of Tana River and are neighbours to the Pokomo.

Effects of migration and settlement of the Oromo in Kenya

  1. a) They inter-married with the people they came into contact with e.g. Somali, Pokomo and Borana.
  2. b) Their settlement in Kenya led to expansion of trade.
  3. c) Their settlement led to increased conflict between communities over resources e.g. pasture and water.
  4. d) Displacement and redistribution of people in the area where they settled e.g. the Oromo pushed the Bantu from the Shungwaya region.
  5. e) Assimilation of some communities they came into contact with e.g. the Oromo vs. Somali.
  6. f) Cultural exchange e.g. neighbouring communities adopted Islam.
  7. g) Settlement in high agricultural potential areas e.g. river valleys encouraged some of them to practice crop farming.
  8. h) Expansion of agriculture due to demand of agricultural produce.

THE BORANA

They are also Oromo speaking people whose origin is southern Ethiopia. Their migration into Kenya was due to escaping the Menelik Wars of Conquest in 1897 and who had imposed heavy taxes on them. They represent some of the most recent migrations into Kenya end as late as 1900 when more Borana groups fled into Kenya from Somali running away from the war between the Somali Nationalists and the British.

Today the Borana occupy the area north of the Tana River.

THE SOMALI

They originated from Mogadishu where they were living by 10th century A.D. They begun moving southwards into Kenya around that time maybe due to the Oromo threat or they were looking for pasture for their livestock.The Somali represent the largest single group of eastern Cushites in Kenya.

Results of Cushitic migration into Kenya

  1. a) There was massive warfare during the migrations leading to killing of many people in the process. For example, there was constant warfare between the Somali and the Oromo.
  2. i) They displaced some of the communities which they came into contact with e.g. the Oromo pushed the Mijikenda from the Shungwaya region in AD 1500 AND 1600.
  3. b) They intermarried with those people they interacted with e.g. the some of the Pokomo intermarried with the Borana.
  4. c) Their settlement led to expansion / development of trade between them and their

neighbours e.g. they traded with the Samburu and the Maasai.

  1. d) There was cultural exchange between them and the Bantu and Nilotic neighbours. E.g. the

Taboo against eating Fish among the Bantu, the age set system and circumcision has origin from the Cushites.

  1. e) The migrations led to population pressure in the region.
  2. f) Adoption of some agricultural practices from the Bantu.
  3. g) There was redistribution of population in Kenya. The Mijikenda for example were scattered at Shungwaya.

THE BANTU SPEAKERS

Introduction

The term Bantu refers to group of people who speak the same or similar language with common word “NTU” which means a person. The Bantu-speaking groups include the Luhyia, Kisii, Kuria, Kikuyu, Akamba, Meru, Aembu, Taita, Agiryama, Digo in Kenya and Pokomo, as well as many other smaller groupsTheir original homeland was somewhere between eastern Nigeria and the Cameroon (Congo Basin).

They then moved southwards towards present day Democratic Republic of Congo (around 500 BC the Bantu were living in the Congo forest). This became a major dispersal point from where the Bantus moved in four major waves. Of these waves, the two waves that account for settle of the Bantu in Kenya are the ones moving south-eastwards through the area west of LakeVictoria (a 2nddispersal point for Bantus). From here they dispersed in two groups;

  1. some group passed through present-day Uganda , some settling there (Baganda,

Banyoro, Batoro), proceeding into kenya to form the western Bantu(Luhyia, Kisii, Kuria and abasuba)

  1. From the west Victoria dispersal point a group moved and entered east Africa at appoint south of Lake Victoria and then proceeded eastwards across northern Tanzania to a dispersal point between Taita hills and mt. Kilimanjaro. Some settled in Tanzania (Chagga, nyamwezi, sukuma, Kuria, haya, Yao, Segeju, Zaramo).the rest of the groupproceeded northwards to the coast upto Shungwaya (another dispersal point). These were the eastern Bantus.

REASONS FOR THE BANTU MIGRATION

The reasons for the migration of the Bantu are not known but they most likely included the following;

  1. a) Drought and famine: This broke out because the climate in their cradle land had become unreliable/unpredictable.
  2. b) Population increase which resulted into population pressure, e.g. they became

overpopulated in their cradle land.

  1. c) The constant attacks (external pressure) from stronger tribes in West Africa and the Nile valley; also due to the migration of the Arabs, who were believed to be more hostile, into West Africa.
  2. d) Internal conflicts from the Bantu tribes: These conflicts concerned the ownership of agriculture area, the shortage of grazing lands and watering areas.
  3. e) Epidemics and diseases/natural calamities, e.g. earthquakes, over flooding of rivers like river Niger, sickness, diseases such as Nagana caused by Tsetse flies, sleeping sickness e.t.c.
  4. f) Search for fertile land: Since they were predominantly farmers, the Bantu migrated in order to find more land which could be more fertile than the cradle land, which could no longer support them.
  5. g) Love for adventure: They moved due to their desire for adventure, i.e. they wanted to find out what was happening in other areas.
  6. h) Group influence: Some moved because they had seen their relatives and friends move.
  7. i) Need for water and pasture for their animals forced them to move.
  8. j) The Bantu migrated in order to export their iron-working culture. They had discovered the knowledge of iron working and had invented iron tools. These iron tools had transformed the agricultural sector by making the clearing of land for cultivation faster and more efficient.

The western Bantu

They include Luhyia, Kisii, Kuria and abasuba and settled in western part of kenya thus their name.

Abaluhyia

~  The Abaluhyia community is made up of eighteen sub-groups. The sub-groups which constitute the community have a common background, common customs and speak closely related dialects of the same language.

~  According to Abaluhyia tradition, communities used to hold criminal tribunals at the junctions of footpaths. The area at the junction of footpaths was known as Uluyia or a meeting point and it is claimed that the name Abaluhyia is derived from this. Another version states that in a polygamous home the courtyard outside the main father’s house is called Luhyia. All the children are referred as children of one Luhyia and hence the name Abaluhyia.

~  Most of the Luhyia sub-groups point to mt. elgon dispersal point as their origin. The settlement of the Abaluhyia into Kenya dates back to 300 AD. By 1750 AD, many groups had settled in present day Bukhayo, Marama, Tiriki, Bunyore, Wanga and Maragoli.

~  They absorbed some groups they found in the area. Also, their interaction with the Maasai led to establishment of clans like the Abashimuli among the Idakho. The Marachi, Kisa and Samia interacted with the Luo.

Abagusii

~  Abagusii traditions acknowledge a close relationship with the following people: the Abakuria, Abalogoli, Ababukusu, Abasuba, Agikuyu, Ameru, Aembu, Ambeere and the Akamba. Their tradition has it that on their way from the country which they call ‘Msiri’ they were accompanied by the Baganda and the Basoga besides the above groups.

~  The Abagusii and the Abalogoli migrated southwards following the River Nzoia valley and arrived near Lake Victoria between 1490 and 1520. Following an easterly course along the lake shore, they settled at the head of Goye Bay in Yimbo location of Nyanza with their homeland spreading across present day Ulowa, Sare and Unyejra at the foot of Ramogi hill. Luo migrants in 1550 AD found them settled in this general area and pushed them from alego to Kisumu where they lived upto 1600AD.

~  Their migration from Kisumu to Kano was motivated by drought in the area.. However, their eastward migration was checked by the Maasai and the Kipsigis

~  By the 18thcentury, they had settled in the Kisii highlands positively interacting with the neighboring Luo, Maasai and Kipsigis in terms of trade.

Why the Abagusii remained in the Kano plains for too long before settling in the Kisii highlands.

  1. a) They were obstructed by the Kipsigis who were migrating westwards.
  2. b) The Maasai were also quite wild/hostile.
  3. c) The plains favored their activity of livestock grazing.
  4. d) Lack of a strong warrior group to fight their expansionist wars against the warring neighbors.

Abakuria

~  The origin of the name ‘Kuria’ is a thorny point in the Abakuria history. The major Abakuria sub-tribes such as Abanyabasi, Abatimbaru, Abanyamongo, Abakira, Abairegi and Abagumbe have traditions to the effect that their ancestor was Mokuria (or Mukuria) that lived in “Msiri”. His descendants migrated from “Msiri” and after many years of wandering on the other side of Lake Victoria; they eventually reached and settled in the present Bukuria By 1800AD,) in south Nyanza.)

~  According to this tradition, the Abakuria have been divided from time immemorial into two families: the Abasai of the elder wife of Mokuria and the Abachuma of the younger wife.

~  The Abakuria are related to Abalogoli of Abaluhyia and Abagusii and trace same origin at mt. elgon dispersal point.

~  The Abakuria people appear to have sprung from too many directions to have a common historical origin, although a number of clans claim to have come from Msiri.

~  Among the Abakuria today are found people who were originally from Kalenjin, Maasai, Bantu and Luo speaking communities. The Abakuria adopted the practice of age set organization and circumcision from the southern Cushites

Abasuba

~  The name “Suba” means “the people who are always wandering”.

~  The Suba migrated into their current locations beginning in the mid-1700s. They came from the region just west of Lake Victoria and settled on the islands.

~  The Suba migrated from Uganda and settled on the two Lake Victoria islands of Rusinga and Mfangano, and are believed to be the last tribe to have settled in Kenya. Other subgroups migrated and settled on the shores of Lake Victoria in the early 18th century.

~  The Suba are descendants of one wave of the Bantu migration from Central Africa over the last 1500 to 1800 years. In the 16th century, it appears, small family groups related to the Ganda people on the western side of the lake migrated across Lake Victoria on boats to settle on Rusinga Island and other islands near what is now Kenya and Tanzania.

~  The Suba are descendants of one wave of the Bantu migration from Central Africa over the last 1500 to 1800 years. In the 16th century, it appears, small family groups related to the Ganda people on the western side of the lake migrated across Lake Victoria on boats to settle on Rusinga Island and other islands near what is now Kenya and Tanzania.

~  Linguistically, the Suba are highly influenced by the neighbouring Luo, to the point of a language shift having taken place among large portions of the mainland Suba.

~  The remaining speakers of the Suba language are mostly elderly residents on the island of Mfangano.

The eastern Bantu

They are divided into Highland or Mt. Kenya Bantu and Coastal Bantu.

Coastal Bantu

They include the Taita, Pokomo and Mijikenda.From the west Victoria dispersal point their first movement was upto Taita hills, where the Taita remained. The Mijikenda and Pokomo proceeded northwards to the coast upto Shungwaya (another dispersal point). The main reason for the Shungwaya dispersal was the Oromo attack In AD 1600.

Pokomo

They moved from Shungwaya following river Tana interacting with the Cushites like the Oromoand Somali.

Mijikenda

The name means Nine Clans comprising of the Kauma, Giriama, Duruma, Chonyi, Jibana, Kambe, Ribe, Rabai and Digo.From the Shungwaya dispersal point,(forced out by the Oromo/Somali southwards expansionist attacks), they settled in fortified villages mainly due to security concerns. Each of the nine groups settled in their own separate ridge referred to as Kaya fortified with thorny trees.By the 19th, the Mijikenda were established as middlemen during the long distance trade between the Akamba and the coastal Waswahili.

The highland Bantu

Examples of highland Bantus include Agikuyu, Ameru, Aembu, Ambeere and the Akamba

They are also products of the Shungwaya dispersion.

Agikuyu

~  The largest single group of the eastern group.

~  While the Kikuyu can be found throughout Kenya, the heaviest concentration being in Central Province, known as the traditional Kikuyu homeland.

The Kikuyu traditionally believe that a man, Gikuyu, was the founder of the tribe. He had a wife named Mumbi, who gave birth to nine (plus one) daughters. The daughters married and had their own families, retaining a domineering role in Kikuyu society.

~  It was in Mukurwe wa Gathanga division of Nyeri district where an identifiable beginning for the modern Kikuyu people is defined.

~  Ancestors of the Kikuyu arrived in Kenya during the Bantu migrations of 1200-1600 AD. The Agikuyu seem to have moved southwest from the coast at around 1400AD also running away from hostile Oromo. They followed Tana River with some groups falling off and settling in different places. For example the Tharaka settled in the east and the Ambeere settled in the southwest. The main group proceeded upto the confluence of rivers Tana and Thika (Mukurwe wa Gathanga. They spread and settled in Kiambu and Nyandarua from Murang’a.

~  The key event in their migration and settlement was military conflict with and defeat of the Gumbapeople by the Mathira and Tetu people, allied with the Athi and the Maasai in the early 1800’s.

~  They displaced or absorbed the original inhabitants-the Dorobo (Athi) and Gumba who were a hunter- gatherer community.

~  Settlement of the Nyeri plains took place after the British moved the Maasai from the area. The Kikuyu were in Kabete by around 1850, Ruiru about 1900.

~  They heavily interacted with the Maasai and Cushites in the area.

Describe the relationship between Athi and the Agikuyu

  1. a) The Athi were the original inhabitants of the land where the Agikuyu live presently.
  2. b) The Agikuyu claim they bought the land from the Athi.
  3. c) The Agikuyu also acquired some cultural practices from the Athi e.g. circumcision, clitoridectomy and age set system.
  4. d) The Athi acted as middlemen in the trade between the Agikuyu, Maasai and the coastal people.

Akamba

~  They point to the area around mt Kilimanjaro as their original homeland.

~  From here they moved to Taita Hills before reaching Tsavo West. They followed the Banks of Athi River in the 15thcentury one group crossing Athi into Ulu. Another group moved south to the Galana River and settled in the region around chyulu hills north of mt. Kilimanjaro

~  By around mid 16thcentury a group of the Akamba had settled in the Mbooni hills near Machakos.

~  Due to environmental influence, the Akamba near Mbooni began to practice agriculture before migrating to iveti, kilungu and masaku. Those that moved to drier Chyulu hills became hunters. The Kitui group adopted pastoralism and hunting and participated in long distance trade.

The Ameru

~  Their original homeland is claimed to Mbwa, located somewhere at the coast on manda island. The Shungwaya dispersal might have led to the pushing of the Ameru to tigania and igembe regions at around 1400AD. They crossed the Tana River with the Tharaka sections of Agikuyu and settled to the east of tana. The Chuka section settled in the west of river tana. The mwimbi, imenti, tigania and igembe also settled west of the Tana River.

~  According to tradition, the Meru and Agikuyu were initially migrating as one group and separated at around 15thc and 16thc.

Effects of the Bantu Migration

The results of the Bantu migration were both positive and negative.

 

 

Positive results

  1. Introduction of iron working the use of iron tools in the interior of East Africa where peoplewere at first using stone tools. There was an increase in food production.
  2. Introduction of new crops e.g. yams, bananas: the Bantu introduced and increased the knowledge of food and extensive crop cultivation. Earlier on, the inhabitants of East Africa were food gatherers, but with iron smelting and its results, food production seriously started.
  3. The absorbed other tribes e.g. the gathers: This led to widespread Bantu languages of “NTU”prefix in East Africa.
  4. They introduced centralized administration: They introduced a centralized system of government whereby the king acted as the overall ruler, under who were the other chiefs, down to the lay person. This was done in western Kenya by the Wanga.
  5. Introduced a system of building permanent homes: They opened new land to settlement in families, clans and villages.
  6. The knowledge of iron smelting which the Bantu introduced led to the making of hoes and pangas for tilling and clearing land, the bows, arrows and spears for defense and protection.
  7. They introduced subsistence agriculture, whereby they grew enough food for home consumption, and the rest could be kept in case of shortages, or be exchanged in barter trade.

Negative effects

  1. The Bantu migration led to depopulation: This was caused by the frequent attacks made on the Bantu by Somali and Oromo, or by the Bantu against the people East Africa for land, through wars.
  2. There was loss of culture due to cultural absorption: This was brought about due to Bantu intermarrying with the non- Bantu peoples, whom they came across.
  3. There was transformation of languages into new ones: This led to the dying down of some of the Bantu languages, while others remained.

The Nilotic speakers

Nilotes is a term originating from the word Nile. The origin of these groups is associated with the Nile River. These are the second largest group after the Bantu.

They are divided into three groups;

  1. a) River-lake nilotes- the Luo.
  2. b) Plains nilotes- the Maasai, Tunkana and Samburu.
  3. c) Highlands nilotes- kalenjin groups of the Marakwet, Tugen, Nandi, Kipsigis, Elgeyo , Pokot and Sabaot

River-lake nilotes

They are sometimes referred to as the southern Luos to differentiate them from other riverlake nilotes in Uganda and Sudan like the Dinka, Shilluk, Bor , Anwak, Alur, Acholi, Jopaluo, Padhola, Nuer and Luo of Uganda.

They are believed to have originated from Bahr-el-Ghazal region of southern Sudan. They then migrated to Pubungu Pakwach in Uganda where they settled by 1450 AD. They later moved into Kenya. Their arrival caused the displacement of many Bantu-speaking peoples, notably the Gusii, Kuria and Luhya, who were forced into the highlands east and north of the lake.

Why did they leave Bahr-el-Ghazal region?

  1. a) They might have been Escaping from clan or family feuds.
  2. b) There was population pressure in their area of origin.
  3. c) They were nomadic pastoralists in search of better grazing lands and water for their livestock
  4. d) They were fleeing the outbreak of disease that affected both people and animals.
  5. e) They were escaping famine and drought.
  6. f) They fled constant attacks from their neighbours.
  7. g) They were also looking for better fishing grounds.
  8. h) The migrated to satisfy their spirit of adventure.

Their migration into Kenya began in the 15thc. they moved in four distinct groups;

  1. a) Joka-jok- people of jok. Was the first group to enter into kenya from Uganda. They first settled at Ramogi hills in Kadimo Siaya district displacing the earlier Gusii settlers. Two of Jok’s sons fled to south Nyanza to form the Karachuonyo and Wanjare clans. Thisgroup spread to Sakwa, Alego, Asembo and other parts of Nyanza.
  2. b) Joka-Owiny. Owiny moved from Uganda to settle in Sogoma in Alego with his group in the 17thc. he was both a great fighter and leader (Ruoth). He came to be known as

Owiny Sigoma and his people Joka Ruoth. This group settled in Kisumu, Nyakach and South Nyanza.

  1. c) Joka-Omolo. They came from northern Banyoro and settled temporarily in Ibanda and Bukoli before moving to Ugenya and Gem. They displaced the Abagusii and Abalogoli out of Yimbo. They spread to Alego and then across winam gulf into south nyanza.
  2. d) The abasuba. They are Bantu in origin but are associated with the Luo. They are a mixture of Bantu refugees from Uganda who intermarried with the Luo. They settled in the Lake Victoria islands of Mfangano and Rusinga and also in gwasi area. They adopted Luo culture.

Effects of Luo Migration

  1. a) The settlement of the Luo in Kenya led to increase in population in the area.
  2. b) Their arrival intensified conflicts between them and other communities in the area over limited resources. For example they displaced the western Bantu like the Abaluhyia,

Abakuria and Abagusii

  1. c) There were intermarriages between the Luo and the Luyia and Maasai groups in the area.
  2. d) The Luo assimilated some Luhyia communities living in the area.
  3. e) Their settlement enhanced trade with different communities; they exchanged livestock products for grains with the Luyia.
  4. f) The Luo adopted agriculture as a result of interacting with the Bantus who were farmers.

Plain Nilotes

They include the Maasai and Samburu (Maa speakers), Iteso, Turkana and Njemps.

The Plain Nilotes entered Kenya at around AD 1000 from an area north of Lake Turkana.

Why they moved into Kenya:

  1. a) Drought and famine that broke out in their cradleland.
  2. b) Population increase which resulted into population pressure in their cradle land.
  3. c) The external pressure from stronger neighbours.
  4. d) Internal conflicts from among other Nilotic groups concerning the ownership of grazing lands and watering areas.
  5. e) Epidemics and diseases like sleeping sickness affecting both humans and animals.
  6. f) They moved due to their desire for adventure, i.e. they wanted to find out what was happening in other areas.
  7. g) Need for water and pasture for their animals forced them to move.

Their first point of settlement was near Mount Moroto in eastern Uganda by AD 1000. From here, several groups like the Jie, Iteso, Turkana and karamojong emerged, with the Iteso settling in Uganda in 17thc before expanding into western Kenya by 19thc. The Turkana extended northwards to their present area.

The effects of the migration and settlement of the iteso

  1. a) The settlement of the iteso in their present region led to increase in population in the area.
  2. b) It intensified conflicts between them and other commu nities in the area over limited resources.
  3. c) There were intermarriages between the iteso and the Luyia groups in the area.
  4. d) Cultural interaction giving rise to enriched cultures.
  5. e) Some people were displaced from the area with the arrival of the iteso. E.g. the Maasai and some kalenjin communities.
  6. f) The iteso assimilated some communities living in the area.
  7. g) Their settlement enhanced trade with different communities; they exchanged livestock products for grains with the Luyia.
  8. h) The iteso adopted agriculture as a result of interacting with the Bantus who were farmers

The Maasai

~  Their movement from north of lake Turkana is closely associated with the original Kalenjin speakers. By AD 1500, the Maasai begun to move separately southwards between Mt,. Kenya and Mt. Elgon. By 19thc , they had settled in Uasin Gishu and even spread into Tanzania along the Rift Valley.

~  As they moved, they assimilated the Sirikwa peoples. They also waged war against the neighbouring Kalenjin, Akamba and Abagusii.

~  In the 1850s the Maasai experienced many natural disasters like drought, famine and cattle diseases leading to decline of their power. They also experienced civil wars between the Kwavi (iloikop) and the Purko (Ilmaasai) sections. When Oloibon Mbatian died, his two sons Sendeyo and Lenana became involved in a protracted succession dispute. They were also weakened by wars with the Agikuyu. Their power came to an end with the coming of British rule.

Effects of the migration and settlement of the plain nilotes into Kenya

  1. a) The migration and settlement of the Maasai in their present region led to increase in population in the area.
  2. b) As they migrated, into Kenya, the Maasai pushed and displaced the communities they came across. For example, they subdued the Nandi in the 18thc.
  3. c) The Maasai influenced the fighting tactics of other groups in Kenya.
  4. d) The Maasai absorbed the southern Cushites such as the Dorobo.
  5. e) There were intermarriages between the Maasai and the Akamba, Agikuyu and even the kalenjin groups in the area.
  6. f) There was Cultural interaction giving rise to enriched cultures. They adopted some cultural practices from the southern Cushites for example, the age-set systems circumcision and clitoridectomy. They also adopted some Kalenjin vocabulary.
  7. g) Their settlement enhanced trade with different communities; they exchanged livestock products for grains with the Luyia.
  8. h) A section of the Maasai adopted agriculture as a result of interacting with their agricultural neighbours in the Rift Valley. The Kwavi Maasai became mixed farmers.
  9. i) They influenced Communities like the Nandi who adopted the institution of Prophet or diviner from the institution of Laibon among the Maasai.

The Highland Nilotes

They comprise the kalenjin speakers namely the Tugen, Nandi, Kipsigis, Marakwet, Keiyo, Pokot and Sabaot. They are believed to be the earliest Nilotic speakers in Kenya. This evidenced from the narratives of their neighbours like the Luo.

Their traditions point their original homeland to be a place to the north-western part of Kenya, between Sudan and Ethiopia.

Why they migrated:

  1. a) They might have been Escaping from internal enemies causing clan or family feuds.
  2. b) There was population pressure in their area of origin forcing them to look for new land for settlement.
  3. c) They were fleeing the outbreak of diseases and epidemics that affected both people and animals.
  4. d) They were escaping famine and drought.
  5. e) They fled constant attacks from their neighbours.
  6. f) They were also looking for better lands for cultivation.
  7. g) The migrated to satisfy their spirit of adventure.

Key notes for the teacher and students- @Helot 2012-2013  49

They began migrating from their cradleland in around 600AD. By 700AD, some kalenjin groups like the Sirikwa were already occupying the rift valley.

Some were later pushed out of the Mt. elgon region by the incoming Bantu and plain nilotes. Those that remained include the Bok, Bongomek and Kony. The Terik later migrated to western Kenya and greatly borrowed from the Bantu, adopting a new name, Tiriki.

The Nandi.

They were pushed out of the Mt. Elgon region between 1700 and 1800 by the incoming Maasai.

The decline of the Maasai in the 19thc made them rise to become a formidable group that conducted raids against their neighbours like the Abaluhyia and Luo.

Their power only declined due to colonization.

The Kipsigis

They are believed to have separated together with the Nandi from other kalenjin groups at around Mt. Elgon region around AD1600. They moved south east to Teo, near Lake Baringo. Due to the Maasai attacks, they moved westwards to Tambach where they stayed for a long period. They later moved southwards to Rongai near Nakuru.

They only separated from the Nandi due to drought and the Maasai Raids on the Nandi.

The Kipsigis moved further south to Kericho while the Nandi moved to Aldai during the 2nd half of 18thc.  The Kipsigis settled at Kipsigis Hills forming a strong community that assimilated thelegendary Sirikwa and some Maasai and Abagusii groups. They were for a long time allies of the Nandi.

What factors contributed to the Nandi and Kipsigis split during the mid 18th century.

  1. a) Maasai attacks on the two communities forcing each group to find its own means of Defence.
  2. b) Drought which caused scattering in search of food and pasture.
  3. c) Constant conflicts over the limited resources in the region leading to warfare and final split.

Results of the Highland nilotes migration

  1. a) It increased intercommunity conflicts in the region.
  2. b) Some of the Kalenjin groups assimilated Bantu cultures while their culture was also assimilated by other groups. The Terik for example borrowed many Bantu vocabularies and customs.
  3. c) They intermarried with other groups in the region, such as the Abagusii and the Luo.
  4. d) Their migration increased trading activities in the region.
  5. e) They displaced the people they came across e.g. the Abagusii and the Kwavi Maasai

Explain the results of the interactions between the various Kenyan communities during the pre-colonial period.

  1. a) Through the inter-tribal wars, there was loss of lives and destruction of property hence economic decline.
  2. b) Many communities were displaced as new ones arrived. E.g when the Luos arrived, Abagusii and sections of the Abaluhyia were displaced. Etc.
  3. c) The constant raids as a means of interaction led to some communities seeking for refugee in secure places. E.g the Abagusii too refugee in the present Kisii highland due to the Kipsigis, Nandi and Maasai raids in 1800AD.
  4. d) A sense of unity developed among some communities e.g. among the Luo, as a means of Defence against attacks by the Maasai, Nandi and Abaluhyia.
  5. e) Tension between various communities was reduced as they interacted through intermarriages e.g. between the Agikuyu and the Maasai.
  6. f) Some new customs found their way into various communities. E.g the Bantu and the nilotes learned of circumcision and age set system from the southern Cushites.
  7. g) New technology infused into various communities. E.g. the Bantu and the nilotes learned the art of cattle milking and bleeding, irrigation and manuring from the southern Cushites.
  8. h) Specialization emerged mainly due to inter-community trade in the region.
  9. i) There was also increased wealth in some communities. For example through the trade

between the Agikuyu and the Akamba, some Agikuyu gained wealth.

  1. j) New economic activities sprung up in some communities. E.g. the Maasai adopted crop cultivation from the Agikuyu.
  2. k) The Bantu language was enriched through the borrowing of some vocabulary from the southern Cushites.
  3. l) The Abakuria were able to develop into a distinct ethnic group as a result of constant raids from the Maasai and the Luo.

SOCIO-ECONOMIC AND POLITICAL ORGANIZATION OF KENYAN COMMUNITIES IN THE 19THCENTURY

THE BANTU

Social organization

~  Almost all the Bantu communities were organized in clans made up of people with common descent.

~  All the Bantu communities practiced circumcision. In some communities like the Akamba, Abaluhyia, only boys circumcised. Among the Abagusii and Agikuyu, both boys and girls were circumcised. The initiates were taught the values and customs of their community

~  Circumcision marked an entry into an age set whose functions included defending the community from external attacks, building huts and advising junior age-sets on how to raid.

~  All the Bantu communities believed in the existence of a supernatural power that controlled their destiny. The Abaluhyia, for example called their God Were or Nyasaye, the AgikuyuNgai etc.

~  The Bantu communities had diviners and medicineman. Among the Agikuyu community, a medicine person was called mundu mugo.

~  The Bantu celebrated life both in song and dance. There were songs for initiations, childbirth, marriage, harvest and funeral. The mood and style of their song and dances varied depending on the occasion.

Political organization of the Bantu

~  All the Bantu communities in Kenya, except the Wanga sub-group of the Luhyia, had decentralized forms of government.

~  The clan formed the basic political unit for all the Bantu communities. Each clan was made up of related families. Leadership of the clan was in the hands of a council of elders who played a pivoted role in solving disputes, decided on inter-tribal marriages, maintaining law and order and making executive decisions affecting the community like declaring war.

~  Among the Agikuyu and Ameru, the council was known as Kiama, Kambi among Mijikenda, Njama among Ataveta and Abagata ba gesaku among the Gusii.

~  The Bantu had an age-set system that had some political significance. For example among the Agikuyu, the boys joined the age-set after initiation to provide warriors who defended the community from external attacks and raid other communities for cattle.

~  Among the centralized Wanga government, the king was known as Nabongo. His office was hereditary. He was assisted by a chief minister and other officials with a council of elders.

Economic organization of the Bantu

~  The Bantu kept Livestock like sheep, cattle and goats for milk, meat and skin. Dowry was paid inform of livestock. Some communities used livestock as a form of currency in barter trade.

~  They traded among themselves and also with their neighbours such as the Luo, kalenjin and Maasai. They sold grains in exchange for baskets and fish from the Luo.

~  They practiced iron-smelting, making implements such as knives, hoes arrow heads and spearheads. This sometimes also became trading items.

~  The Bantu practiced crop growing. They grew grains like millet, sorghum and cassava among other crops mainly for food while the excess were sold to neighbours.

~  They practiced craft making pots and weaving baskets.

~  For the Bantu communities who lived along rivers and Lake Victoria, e.g. the Luhyia, they practiced fishing.

~  Hunting and gathering was also done by some communities to supplement their food. E.g. the Akamba.

~  Raiding other communities for cattle.

The Agikuyu.

By 19thcentury, the Agikuyu had a complex social, economic and political organization some of which were products of their interrraction with other communities.

Social organization

~  The family was the smallest social unit among the Agikuyu. It was headed by a father.

Several families that shared a common ancestry comprised a clan.

~  The Agikuyu had rites of passage which included initiation of both boys and girls through circumcision/clitoridectomy.

~  The initiated boys joined the age-set (riikaor mariika) after being educated on the values and customs of the society. It was only after initiation that boys and girls were considered mature enough to get married.

~  The Agikuyu believed in the existence of one God who controlled their destiny. They called their God Ngai. He was all powerful and as believed to dwell o mt. kirinyaga where they claim he created them.

~  They also had diviners whose main work was to interpret God’s message to the people.

~  The Agikuyu had medicineman. A medicine person was called mundu mugo. Their main work was to cure diseases. They learned their skills through apparent-iceship.

~  The Agikuyu had designated sacred places for prayers, worship and offerings (an example was the mugumo tree for offering sacrifices).

~  Marriage was an important institution among the Agikuyu.

The political organization of the Agikuyu

~  The Agikuyu had a decentralized system of government. The basic political system was based on the family headed by a father.

~  Several families made up a clan (Mbari). Each clan was ruled by a council of elders. (kiama).

A senior elder (Muramati) coordinated the activities of the clan.

~  Several elders(aramati)formed a higher council of elders (kiama kia athamaki)

~  The functions of the higher council of elders included settling disputes, deliberating on day to day activities, administering justice and handled disputes, inheritance disputes and acted as a final court of appeal.

~  They had warriors drawn from the age-set system, who defended the community from external aggression.

Economic organization of the Agikuyu

The Agikuyu engaged in various economic activities;

~  The Agikuyu kept Livestock like sheep, cattle and goats for milk, meat and skin. Dowry was paid inform of livestock.

~  They traded among themselves and with their neighbours such as the Akamba and Maasai.

They sold grains and iron implements in exchange for livestock products like skins and beads (Maasai) and imported goods like clothes(Akamba).

~  They practiced iron-smelting, making implements such as knives, hoes which enhanced their farming activities and trade. They borrowed this art from the Gumba.

~  They practiced crop growing. They grew grains like millet, yams, sweet potatoes,

arrowroots, sorghum and cassava among other crops mainly for food while the excess were sold to neighbours.

~  They practiced craft making pots and weaving baskets.

~  Hunting and gathering was also done by Agikuyu to supplement their food.

The Ameru

The Ameru had a system of government which ensured high standards of morality and stability. This system evolved as they migrated and interacted with other communities.

Social organization of the Ameru

The Ameru was a system characterized by the existence of various councils from the council of children to the supreme council of Njuri Ncheke. This was meant to ensure the highest moral standards in the community.The Njuri Ncheke acted as parliament and had the following functions;

~  It presided over religious ceremonies.

~  It solved disputes in the community. It also mediated in disputes involving the Meru and their neighbors

~  It ensured the custody of the community’s history, traditions and values/heritage

~  It sanctioned wars

~  Acted as ritual leaders. They provided Guidance and counseling community members.

~  It set the moral code to be adhered to by all members of the community. If one went against the moral code, he/she would be punished. A member of the Njuri Ncheke who offended another was fined a bundle of miraa. A warrior who violated the code was fined a bull, an elder who violated the code was fined a bull or a goat, a woman who broke the code was fined a big pot of cowpeas.Marriage was regarded highly among the Ameru and a married woman would be assigned to an elderly woman (midwife) whom she must give gifts like millet, peas and black beans in exchange for midwifery. Any spouse who involved in adultery or any girl who was not a virgin at the time of marriage was stoned to death by a stoning council made up of male initiates. Marriage was exogamous (no one was allowed to marry from their clan)Before a male child was considered mature, he underwent several stages including circumcision. Before circumcision of both boys and girls, two ceremonies were performed after which they became full members of the community.

~  The time of making spots where the ear-hole perforation would be done.

~  The time of actual perforation of the ears.

The Ameru believed in the existence of a supreme being called Baaba Weetu who was a loving father and took care of all. He was omnipresent.

The Ameru also believed in the existence of spirits which either brought happiness or tears depending on how one lived on earth.

They believed in life after death with good people going where rains come from when they die.Libations were offered to ancestors to quench their thirst and relieve their hunger

Building houses in the Ameru community was the work of women while men defended the community.

Economic organization of the Ameru

~  The Ameru cultivated grain crops like millet, peas, black beans, cowpeas and miraa among other crops mainly for food while the excess were sold to neighbours.

~  The Ameru kept Livestock like sheep. Goats and cattle for dowry payment and rituals and also for milk, meat and skin.

~  They traded among themselves and with their neighbours. When the coastal traders penetrated the interior, they exchanged goods with them

~  They practiced iron-smelting, making implements such as knives, spears and hoes which enhanced their farming activities and trade.

~  They practiced craft making pots and weaving baskets.

~  Hunting and gathering was also done by Ameru to supplement their food.

Political organization of the Ameru

~  The basic political system was based on the family headed by a father.

~  The basic political unit was the clan. Several families made up a clan headed by a clan elder.

~  The Ameru had a system of councils and age groups which oversaw the administration of the community. Every Meru belonged to the relevant council. E.g. the children’s council, council of elders’ council of warriors. The supreme council was known as Njuri Ncheke.

~  The functions of the supreme council of elders included settling disputes, deliberating on day to day activities, administering justice and handled disputes, inheritance disputes and acted as a final court of appeal. It also officiated over religious ceremonies

~  The age set system provided the community with warriors who defended the community from external aggression.

~  Religions leaders like prophets influenced the political administration for the Ameru.

~  Their system of government alternated between two organizations namely, Kiruga and Ntiba every fourteen years and each had its own army regiment.

The Akamba

The Akamba are of the eastern Bantus who settled in Chyulu hills, Mbooni, Kitui and Machakos.

Social organization

~  Like other Bantus, the Akamba were organized into clans whose members claimed commondescent.

~  The Akamba practiced exogamous marriages. However their tradition allowed the adoption of an outsider into a clan

~  Wrongdoers among the Akamba were banished from the community if they refused to compensate for the wrong did.

~  There existed no institutional age sets among the Akamba though boys and girls were circumcised before reaching puberty. The initiates were then taught community secrets after two years from circumcision (at 14 years)

~  At puberty, both men and women were allowed to marry and bear children with the father of a young family automatically becoming a junior elder until his children were ready to be circumcised.

~  He then moved to the next grade only after paying a bullock and several goats.

~  The top two grades formed the administrative council of the community mainly dealing with the ritual ceremonies.

~  The Akamba believed in the existence of a creator called Ngai or Mulungu whom they prayed to through ancestral spirits.

~  The Akamba had ritual experts who included medicine people that guided them in their rituals.

~  Shrines also existed where offerings and sacrifices were made by the elders called Atumia ma ithembo. (Mostly found at a place with two large fig trees.)

~  The Akamba had many social ceremonies which were accompanied with festivity dance and music. For example, during harvest, weddings, deaths and birth.

Political organization

~  The smallest political unit among the Akamba was the homestead,  (Musyi) comprising three to four generations of extended family with a stockade round the home of each married man. Outside the entrance of the homestead, there was an open space (thome), where men would sit and discuss political and other important matters.

~  Several related families formed a wider territorial grouping or clan with its own recreational ground, elder’s council (made of all the male elders), war leader and palace for worship

~  The clan was the main political unit for the Akamba.

~  There was also a larger territorial grouping above the clan called Kivalo that constituted a fighting unit. There was however no single central authority that united the Akamba the Kivalo was always disbanded after war.

~  Age grades and age sets were common to all in the community and acted as a unifying factor.

~  The elders in the community were ranked according to seniority.

~  Junior elders defended their community. Medium elders (Nthele) assisted in the

administration of the community. The full elders (Atumia ma Kivalo) participated in delivering judgements. The senior most elders (Atumia ma Ithembo) were involved in religious activities.

~  By 19th century, due to participation and gaining from trade, a number of people had gained prestige and followers to be regarded as Akamba chiefs or leaders. For example, chief Kivoi.

Economic organization

~  Due to variation in the environment, the Akamba participated in varied economic activities.

~  Those who lived around the fertile Mbooni, ulu and Iveti hills practiced farming. They planted sorghum, millet, yams, potatoes, sugarcane and beans.

~  Those who lived in the drier areas like Kitui practiced livestock farming and mainly transhumance during the drier period.

~  The Akamba were also hunters hunting for elephants, leopards, antelopes and Rhinos. They were gatherers who Collected fruits, roots etc.

~  They practiced trading activities e.g. they sold Ivory, feathers, shells hides, arrows, spearheads, to neighbours and the Arabs, Swahili traders.

~  The Akamba were skilled Iron –workers produced spears, arrow heads, hoes, knives.

~  The Akamba Practiced woodcarving making tools and shields.

~  They engaged in pottery, making pots, mats etc.

~  They were bee-keepers for honey which they sold.

~  The Akamba acted as middlemen during the long distance trade.

The Abagusii

They originated in the Congo Forest like other Bantus and settled in the fertile highlands of Kisii, Gucha and Nyamira Districts of Nyanza Province.

Political Organization

The clan formed the basic political unit for Gusii communities. Each clan was made up of related families. Leadership of the clan was in the hands of a council of elders who played a pivoted role in solving disputes, decided on inter-tribal marriages, maintaining law and order and making executive decisions affecting the community like declaring war. The council was known Abagata ba gesaku.The Abagusii also had chiefdoms made up of several clans, which United to counter-attacks from their neighbours. Each chiefdom was headed by a chief (Omugambi), assisted by a councilof clan elders.

The elders acted as ‘middlemen’ through whom people could communicate their wishes and grievances to the chief. The position of the chief was hereditary.The Omogambi presided over religious ceremonies. He led clan members in communal sacrifices and social activities such as the planting and harvesting of crops. He also performed political functions.After circumcision, the boys joined the age-set which acted as a military wing responsible for the defence of the community.The Kisii still practice most of the political features discussed above.

 

 

 

Social organization

The Abagusii lived in family unit, headed by a family member, called the family head. Several related families formed a clan, headed by clan elders who formed a council. The role of the council of elders was to settle disputes between families.A number of clans formed sub-communities headed by clan elders. Circumcision of boys and girls formed part of the initiation rites for the Abagusii. The initiates were taught the values and customs of the society after which they were considered adults.The initiated boys were organized into age groups and age-grades. An age-grade was made up of people who were circumcised together. Members of the same age-grade treated one another as real brothers and helped each other in times of need.They believed in the existence of a supreme god, ‘engoro’ who was the creator of everything. They offered sacrifices to him during special occasions like initiation ceremonies and religions festivals and when there were problems like illness and draught. They worshipped him through their ancestral spirits.Diviners and seers among the Kisii were special people and were called Omoragori.

Economic organization

~  The Abagusii practiced crop farming. They grew many food crops including maize, sorghum, yams, peas, beans, millet, cassava, bananas and sweet potatoes.

~  They also kept livestock, cattle, goats and sheep were kept for meat and milk. They also kept poultry.

~  Trading was also a main economic activity among the Abagusii. They traded with their neighbours especially the Luo and the Abaluhyia. The Luo supplied them with livestock, cattle, salt, hides, fish, drums, and poison for arrows, spears and potatoes. In return, the Abagusii supplied the Luo with grain, hoes, axes, spears, arrowheads, razors, soapstone, soapstone dust, baboon skins, pipes, bowls and carvings of animals and birds.

~  The Abagusii were also involved in iron-working, which they kept secret to avoid competition from their neighbours. They made iron implements such as hoes, spears, axes and arrow heads. They also made ornaments.

~  They mined soapstone on the hilltops. They used is dust to decorate their faces during ceremonies. Some was sold to the Luos who used to decorate faces of their heroes. It was used for making pots, pipes, bowls and carvings.

~  They also depended on hunting and gathering to supplement the other economies. They hunted wild game for meat and skins. They also collected wild fruit roots and vegetables.

~  The Abagusii raided their neighbours for livestock. To date, they still raid the Maasai and Kipsigis for livestock.

The Mijikenda

The Mijikenda comprise of nine groups that had similar social, economic and political structures. They are believed to have arrived in their current settlement from Shungwaya.

 

Social organization of the Mijikenda

The Mijikenda were organized in clans comprising of related families.

~  The Mijikenda practiced circumcision. Only boys circumcised. Circumcision marked an entry into an age set whose functions included building huts and advising junior age -sets on how to raid.

~  They believed in the existence of a supernatural power that controlled their destiny. They called their God Mulungu.

~  The Mijikenda worshipped ancestral spirits. Prophets among the Mijikenda were called wafisi.

~  Marriage among the Mijikenda was exogamous (no one was allowed to marry from their clan). They practiced polygamy

~  There was division of labour among the Mijikenda. Children looked after livestock, young men built houses, cattle sheds, hunted and cleared bushes for cultivation..

~  The Mijikenda celebrated social ceremonies in song and dance. There were songs for initiations, childbirth, marriage, harvest and funeral..

Political organization

~  The Mijikenda had a strong clan system. Administration was based on a strong clan system. 4-6 clans lived in a fortified village known as kaya.

~  The existence of a council of elders(Kambi) at clan level to settle disputes and the general administration of the clan

~  An age set (riika) system formed by young men after circumcision and which provided the base from which warriors were obtained.

~  Social and political unity was strengthened through intermarriage between different clans.

~  Judicial matters were handled by the elders’ council which was final court of appeal.

~  The council of elders declared war on warring neighbors.

Economic organization

~  The Mijikenda kept Livestock like sheep, cattle and goats for milk, meat and skin. Hunting and gathering was also done to supplement their food

~  They traded in the coastal trade with the Arabs and with the Akamba from interior.

~   The Mijikenda practiced salt mining which the used as a trading item.

~  The Mijikenda engaged in fishing along the coast as well as on rivers.

~  They practiced crop growing. They grew grains like millet, yams, sweet potatoes,

arrowroots, sorghum, coconut and cassava among other crops mainly for food while the excess were sold to neighbours.

~  They practiced craft making pots and weaving baskets using coconut leaves.

NILOTES

The second largest group in Kenya.

 

 

Social organization

~  There were slight variations in the social organizations of the various Nilotic groups in Kenya. However they shared institutions such as the clan-based organization, belief in one God, veneration of ancestral spirits, age-set system, social ceremonies and existence of religious leaders.

~  The family was the basic social unit in many communities. Several related families grouped together to form clans among the Luo, Maasai and Nandi.

~  They believed in one supernatural being. The Maasai referred to him as Engai while the Luo called Him Nyasaye.

~  The communities believed in the existence of ancestral spirits, to whom sacrifices and libations were made to ensure they remained happy.

~  There was the existence of religious leaders whose work was to lead the communitiesduring religious functions and rituals. Some of the religious leaders had assumed political power by 19th c. For example the Orkoiyot among the Nandi and Oloibon among the Maasai.

~  The Maasai and other Nilotic groups had rain makers and diviners.

~  The age-set system was another common social institution. The age sets were formed by those who were initiated at the same time. The institution created a bond among the initiates that cut across the families and clans thus uniting the whole community.

~  There were social ceremonies that accompanied the rites of passage like circumcision, marriage and death.

~  The Luo as their form of initiation extracted six lower teeth. The other groups practiced circumcision. In all the groups, the initiates were taught the community values.

The economic organization

~  The nilotes were nomadic pastoralists who kept Livestock like sheep, cattle and goats for milk, meat and blood.

~  They traded among themselves and also with their neighbours. The kalenjin traded with the Maasai and with the Luo and neighbouring Bantu communities like the Abaluhyia. They sold animal products and red ochre in exchange for grains from the Bantu.

~  They practiced iron-smelting, making implements such as arrow heads and spearheads. This skilled was borrowed from the Bantu.

~  The Maasai also practiced mining e.g. mined iron, salt and red ochre which they used for decoration and as a commodity for trade.

~  There existed variation in the economic activities within a single community like the Maasai. Some sections of the Maasai e.g. the Kwavi practiced crop growing i.e. growing grains and vegetables. The Purko were purely pastoralists

~  They practiced craft e.g. made pots, weaved baskets and leather belts.

~  Raiding other communities for cattle was also a common economic practice.

~  The Luo who lived near Lake Victoria practiced fishing. The Turkana also engaged in fishing on Lake Turkana.

Political organization

~  The Nilotic communities had a decentralized system of administration with all the communities organized on clan basis.

~  There existed councils of elders that administered and ensured maintenance of law and order, settled disputes between clans and other communities.

~  The nilotes had a warlike tradition. Each community had Warriors who defended the community and raided other communities. The Luo reffered to the warriors as Thuondi. The Maasai called them Moran.

~  The age-set system determined political leadership since all those initiated together formed one age-set for life.

~  The institution of religion influenced most of the political affairs of the Nilotic speakers. For example, the Orkoiyot among the Nandi and the Oloibon among the Maasai were primarily religious leaders who wielded political authority in the19th  century.

The Nandi

By 1900 AD, the Nandi had already established their social, economic and political institutions.

Social organization

~  The family was the basic social unit. Several related families grouped together to form clans among Nandi. The family institution was very important in the community. It played an important role in the Kokwet (council of elders) and in the clan activities.

~  The age-set system was an important social institution among the Nandi. Nandi boys and girls were initiated at puberty through circumcision. Circumcision marked entry into adulthood. The initiates were taught the deepest community values during the period.

~  Age sets were formed by those who were initiated at the same time irrespective of the clans they belonged to. In total, there were eight age-sets among the Nandi namely Sawe, Maina, Chuma, Korongoro, Kipkoimet, Kaplelach, Kimnyinge and Nyongi.

~  The Nandi boys became junior warriors after circumcision. They only promoted to senior warriors after the Saket apeito ceremony (slaughter of bullock) that was done after every fifteen years.

~  Marriage within the same clan was prohibited among the Nandi. This was meant to create unity by encouraging intermarriages between different clans.

~  They believed in one supernatural being whom they referred to him as Asis, who was believed to be the protector of the community.

~  The Nandi believed in the existence of ancestral spirits, to whom sacrifices and libations were made to ensure they remained happy.

~  The community also had important religious leaders whose work was to lead the

community during religious functions and rituals, diviners and rain makers.The institution of Orkoiyot among the Nandi was borrowed from that of Oloibon among the Maasai.

Religious functions did the Orkoiyot of the Nandi.

~   He Mediated between God and the people/acting as a priest.

~  He presided over Offering of sacrifices to God on behalf of the people.

~  He advised and blessed the warriors before they went to war.

~  Blessing people before they undertook special activities like planting and

harvesting.

~  He foretold what was going to happen in the future. e.g. success or misfortune in

the community.

Economic organization

~  The Nandi were pastoralists who kept Livestock like sheep, cattle and goats for milk, meat, manure and blood. Cattle were a symbol of status among the Nandi and also a form of dowry settlement.

~  The Nandi cultivated crops such as Millet and sorghum due the fertile soils and favourable climate in areas like Aldai.

~  They also practiced hunting and gathering to supplement their food production.

~  The Nandi raided other communities for cattle. They acquired large herds of cattle through raiding neighbouring communities such as the Maasai. Abaluhyia and Luo.

~  They traded among themselves and also with their neighbours. The Nandi traded with the Maasai and with the Luo and neighbouring Bantu communities like the Abaluhyia.  They sold animal products and red ochre in exchange for grains from the Bantu. The Nandi however were self sufficient in food.

~  They practiced craft e.g. made pots, weaved baskets and leather belts.

Political organization

The family was the basic political unit. It was headed by a father who dealt with internal matters such as discipline, allocation of crops, land and cattle. In matters affecting the neighbourhood, he was assisted by the Kokwet (council of elders) which was made up of neighbourhood heads.Above the Kokwet was the clan organization whose council of elders tackled matters to do with grazing rights.Above the clan, there was a larger socio-political unit comprising different war groups located in the same geographical zone called a pororiet. This formed the highest political unit among the Nandi. The pororiet council of elders comprised representatives from different clansIts functions included negotiating for peace and declaring war .The Nandi boys became junior warriors after circumcision. They only promoted to senior warriors after the Saket apeito ceremony (slaughter of bullock) that was done after every fifteen years.

 

 

 

The Maasai

Social organization

~  The Maasai were divided into two groups; the pastoral Maasai(Purko) and the Agricultural Maasai(Kwavi or Iloikop).

~  The Maasai were organized on clan basis with each clan associated with a particular type of cattle. In total, the Maasai had five clans spread over large areas and not necessarily staying together.

~  Maasai boys and girls were initiated at puberty through circumcision. Circumcision marked entry into adulthood. The initiates were taught the deepest community values during the period.

~  After circumcision, the boys entered an age set to which they belonged the rest of their life.

~  The age set institution created a bond among the initiates that cut across the families and clans thus uniting the whole community.

~  All the boys initiated together also formed a warrior class called Morans and lived in special homesteads called Manyattas away from the rest of the community. For about ten years.

~  They were not allowed to take milk from their mother’s house and were required to adhere to ritual and dietary restrictions.

~  They believed in one supernatural being. The Maasai referred to him as Engai. Prayers and sacrifices were offered to him at the shrines.

~  There was the existence of religious leaders whose work was to lead the communities during religious functions and rituals. They called their religious leader Oloibon.

Functions of Oloibon

~  He presided over religious ceremonies. / He was consulted on all religious matters.

~  He blessed warriors before they went to war.

~  He advised the council of elders.

~  He foretold the future events.

The Maasai and other Nilotic groups had rain makers and diviners.

There were several social ceremonies that accompanied the rites of passage like circumcision, marriage and death. The Eunoto ceremony marked the graduation of the Morans into junior elders. This ceremony is still practiced upto date.

Economic organization of the Maasai

~  The Maasai were nomadic pastoralists who kept Livestock like sheep, cattle and goats formilk, meat and blood..

~  They traded among themselves and also with their neighbours such as the Agikuyu, kalenjin and Taita. They sold animal products and red ochre in exchange for grains from the Agikuyu.

~  They practiced iron-smelting, making implements such as arrow heads and spearheads..

~  They also practiced mining e.g. mined iron, salt and red ochre which

~  They also practiced mining e.g. mined iron, salt and red ochre which they used for decoration and as a commodity for trade.

~  Some sections of the Maasai e.g. the Kwavi practiced crop growing i.e. growing grains and vegetables.

~  They practiced craft e.g. made pots, weaved baskets and leather belts.

~  Raiding other communities for cattle.

Political organization of the Maasai

The largest political unit amongst Maasai was the tribal section, which was a geographically distinct entity which operated as a nation, especially during ceremonies.

Affairs involving inter-clan cooperation were dealt within ad hoc meetings comprising age set spokesmen

Before a Maasai young man became an adult, he underwent the following four stages.

Boyhood (ilaiyak)

The youths at this stage looked after family and clan livestock until they reached circumcision stage at about 15 years.

Warrior hood (Ilmuran)

The stage was joined by young men circumcised together and comprised of ages between 18 and 25 years. They defended the community and conducted raids to boost the clan and tribal flocks. They had a military leader known as Olaiguani.

The stayed in isolation in manyattas undergoing military training in order to graduate into senior warriors. After that they were permitted to marry.

Junior elders

This was the political authority that evaluated the day to day issues of the community.

It comprised heads of households,, aim responsibility was to maintain peace and instruct warriors on how to handle issues in the community. They were permitted to own livestock.

The senior elders

They comprise the senior most age-set. Membership was determined by age and experience. The group performed religious functions and also was responsible for and dealt with difficult judicial and political decisions.The Maasai adopted the institution of Oloibon or prophet that combined socio-religious functions and later own assumed political authority. There were several social ceremonies that accompanied the rites of passage like circumcision, marriage and death. The Eunoto ceremony marked the graduation of the Morans into junior elders. This ceremony is still practiced upto date.

The Luo

Social organization

The family was the basic social unit among the Luo. The Luo community valued large families and therefore practiced polygamy.Marriage among the Luo was exogamous (no one was allowed to marry from their clan).

Several related families grouped together to form clans among the Luo.

They believed in one supernatural being whom they called Nyasaye. They prayed to Nyasaye.The communities believed in the existence of ancestral spirits, to whom sacrifices and libations were made to ensure they remained happy. Sacred shrines and trees existed. He rocks, high hills and even the lake were associated with supernatural power.There was the existence of religious leaders whose work was to lead the communities during religious functions and perform rituals. These included priests, medicine people, rain makers and diviners. For one to be a medicine person, a benevolent spirit called Juogi must possess him or her.The Luo youths as their form of initiation extracted six lower teeth. After that they were allowed to marry.The Luo had several social ceremonies that accompanied the rites of passage like marriage and death.

Economic organization

~  The Luo were originally a pastoral and fishing community. They Practiced livestock keeping for prestige and cultural purposes e.g. dowry and for meat and milk.

~  The carried out Fishing along water courses due to their proximity to the lake. Both men and women conducted fishing, which was a source of food as well as a trade commodity.

~  The Luo Traded with their neighbors. They sold pots, baskets, cattle, fish and livestock for grains, spears, arrows and canoes from the Abaluhyia, Abagusii, Kipsigis and Nandi.

~  They also Cultivated plants like millet, sorghum, etc

~  Most of them practiced hunting and gathering to get additional meat and hides and to supplement the food they produced.

~  They practiced craft. Women specialized in production of pottery products, baskets and clothes

Political organization of the Luo

The Luo were a decentralized community.

The family was the basic political unit among the Luo. The head of the family was referred to as Jaduong. Several related families made up a clan headed by a council of elders called Doho whose main responsibility was to settle inter-family disputes.

Below the Doho were lineage councils called Buch Dhoot that tackled domestic issues

Above the Doho was a grouping of clans called Oganda headed by a council of elders reffered to as Buch piny and headed by a chief elder called Ruoth. The Buch piny comprised representatives from each clan. It was responsible for settling inter -clan conflicts, declaring war and punishing criminals such as murderers.Religious leaders among the Luo also influenced politics. E.g rainmakers and diviners.One of the members of the council of elders was given a responsibility of advising the council on military matters and was therefore a war leader (osumba Mrwayi). Under them was a special group of warriors reffered to as Thuondi (bulls). Their work was to raided neighbouring communities like the Maasai, Nandi and Abagusii and other perceived enemies.

 

The Cushites

These were the smallest linguistic group in Kenya inhabiting the northern part of Kenya. They are a nomadic Sam speaking group. They comprise the Borana, Gabra, Galla (Oromo), Rendille and Burji.The communities developed complex social, economic and political institutions that were interrupted by the coming of the Muslims and Europeans.

Social organization of the Cushites

The Cushites had a patrilineal society, which means they traced their origins through the fatherThe Cushites believed in a common ancestor which makes their kinship system strong.All the Cushitic communities practiced circumcision of boys and clitoridectomy for girls as a form of initiation. This was a rite of passage into adulthood.After circumcision, the initiates were taught about their adult roles and their rights as members of the community.Circumcision marked an entry into an age set whose functions included defending the community from external attacks, building huts and advising junior age-sets on how to raid.Each age set had a leader with specific duties. They believed in the existence of a supreme god, who was the creator of everything.  He was given different names. The Oromo referred to him as wak(waq).They also believed in spirits which inhabited natural objects like rocks and trees. The Cushites had shrines from which they prayed to their God. Later on, through interaction with their neighbours, all the Cushites became Muslims by the 16thc.The Cushitic speakers were polygamous and their marriage was exogamous in nature.Inheritance was from father to son among the Cushites. The elder son inherited the father’s property and shared it with his younger brothers. Girls had no right to inheritance.The Cushitic life was full of ceremonies. They celebrated life both in song and dance. There were songs for initiations, childbirth, marriage, harvest and funeral.

Economic organization

They had a diversified economic system that catered for their livelihood and supported their lifestyle.They basically practiced Pastoralism/livestock keeping in their semi-arid region – They kept cattle, goats, camel and donkeys. Camels and cattle provided milk and blood and were assigning of prestige. Goats and sheep provided meat. Some Cushites who lived along river valleys practiced substance agriculture where they grew grain crops, vegetables, dates, peas, pepper, tubers and bananas.They also practiced iron smelting and made iron tools e.g. swords, knives, bangles and arrow heads.They hunted wild game for food, ivory, skins (hides) for clothing, bedding and gathered fruits and roots and vegetables. They engaged in craft industry e.g. production of leather items such as handbags, belts etc.Some of them who lived near rivers and along the Indian Ocean practiced fishing.They traded with their neighbours e.g. the Pokomo and the Samburu.

Political organization of the Cushites

All the Cushitic communities like other groups in Kenya, had decentralized forms of government. The clan formed the basic political unit for all the Bantu communities. Each clan was made up of related families.

The social and political system of the Cushites was interwoven that the social divisions, age set system were also important aspects of the political system.Leadership of the clan was in the hands of a council of elders who played a pivoted role in solving disputes, acting as ritual experts, presiding over religious ceremonies, maintaining law and order and making executive decisions affecting the community like declaring war.Among the Cushites a clan was independent of others except when the wider community faced a common enemy or problem.The Cushites developed an age-set system that had some political significance. After circumcision, the boys joined the age-set after initiation to provide warriors who defended the community from external attacks and raid other communities for cattle.The age set system was based on about ten groups each with its own leader. At the end of an age cycle, a ceremony was performed and the senior age sets retired from public life and settled in different territories.

The Somali

The social organization of the Somali.Like Somali were organized into clans each comprising of families whose members claimed common descent. They also had an age set system. Circumcision marked an entry into an age set whose functions included defending the community from external attacks, building huts and advising junior agesets on how to raid. Each age set had a leader with specific duties. They believed in the existence of a supreme god, whom they referred to as wak (waq). He was the creator of everything. They had religious leaders who mediated between God and the people

Later on, through interaction with their neighbours, all the Somali became Muslims by the 16thc.The Somali valued marriage as an important institution. They were polygamous and their marriage was exogamous in nature.

Political organization of the Somali

The Somali had a decentralized political system of administration. The basic political unit was the clan made up of related families. The clan was headed by a council of elders in charge of day to day affairs of the clan e.g. making major decisions and settling disputes and presiding over religious ceremonies.The Somali had an age set system and all male members of the society belonged to an age set. Each age set performed specific roles/duties. From the age set system, there evolved a military organization for community defence. Initiates joined the age set system after circumcision. With the advent of Islamic religion political organization changed. They now had community leaders called sheikhs whose role was mainly advisory.The political system was now based on the Islamic sharia.

Economic organization

  1. a) The Somali were hunters and gathers. They hunted wild game for food and gathered fruits and roots and vegetables.
  2. b) They basically practiced nomadic Pastoralism. They kept cattle, goats, camel and sheep.Their diet was mainly milk, meat and blood.
  3. c) They traded with their neighbours to get what they could not produce e.g. the Pokomo and the Mijikenda from whom they acquired grains.
  4. d) A section of the Somali practiced iron smelting and made iron tools e.g. swords, knives, bangles and arrow heads. They also engaged in craft industry e.g. production of leather items such as handbags, belts etc.
  5. e) Such craft activities were despised among the Somali and were associated with a group whom they referred to as Sab (outcasts).

The Borana

They are a branch of the Oromo or Galla people who came from Ethiopia.

Social organization

The Borana had a complex social organization.The society was divided into clans led by elders whose responsibility was to settle disputes and maintaining law and order. Each clan was made up of related families. The borana had a strong belief in the extended family.The Borana were nomadic. But they had a residential section called the camp that consisted of a few huts of related families. .In the camps, it was the most senior married and competent man who became the head of the camp (abba olla). He would have his wife’s hut built on the extreme left.The Borana had a complex age-set structure called Gada. Each Gada was headed by the most powerful individual among the group members (Abba boku). His duty would be to preside over village meetings, proclaim laws and preside over religious ceremonies.The community had two kinship groups that practiced exogamous marriage.. A man from the Gona kinship would only marry from the Sabbo kinship. Polygamy was allowed.The family among the borana was headed by a man referred to as Abba warra with the wife as the female head of the household (Hatimana)

There was division of labour in the society. The men defended the camps, wells, herds and shrines. They dug wells and organized raiding parties. The men also elected leaders of camps, age sets and Gada class. The women performed household duties, wove baskets for carrying children, prepared leather and built houses. Boys herded sheep, goats and cattle. Elders presided over the court cases.The borana worshipped a powerful God, the creator whom they called Wak (waq). He was worshipped through religious leaders

They had a patrilineal society where inheritance was from the father to the son, and specifically the first son, angafa, who would then redistribute the inherited cattle to the younger  brothers.Their culture was full of ceremonies. For example, there were ceremonies when a Gada class entered or left a Gada grade, there was war ceremony (butta) and a muda ceremony in honor of the kinship leader, kallu.

Economic organization

  1. a) The borana were basically practiced nomadic Pastoralists who kept cattle, goats and sheep. Cattle was slaughtered as part of their religious rituals and also provided raw materials for houses and other local industries.
  2. b) They traded with their neighbours to get what they could not produce e.g. they exchanged their animals with the Mijikenda from whom they acquired grains.
  3. c) The Borana were hunters and gathers. They hunted wild game for food and gathered fruits and roots and vegetables.
  4. d) Those who settled in the fertile region along the tana valley grew crops like beans and pepper.
  5. e) The Borana women engaged in craft industry e.g. production of leather items such as handbags, belts etc. men also made wooden tools, weapons and utensils.
  6. f) The Borana also practiced fishing as they settled along river tana.

Political organization of the borana

Their political system was based on the kinship system where the society was divided into clans comprising related families. There were two moieties (kinships) that were further divided into sub-moieties. The sub-moieties were further divided into clans.

Each moiety was headed by a hereditary leader known as kallu. The kallu of the Sabbo for example came from the dyallu clan of the karrayyu sub-moiety.The kallu’s camp was the spiritual and political centre of the group. His duties included leading in ritual ceremonies, providing judgment in major conflicts between clans.He was elected together with the council of the Gada leaders of each gad class when it prepared to enter a new grade.The kallu were not authorized to bear arms or defend themselves but were to move in company of other members of the society.The borana society was divided into clans led by a council of elders whose responsibility was tosettle disputes and maintaining law and order. Each clan was made up of related families who lived in a residential section called the camp that consisted of a few huts of related families. .Powers were distributed equally between the two moieties at all levels such as in the Gada class, age-set and camp councils as well as in tribal ceremonies.The complex age set system mainly provided a military base for the society. The age sets, Hariyya, were recruited from boys of the same age. Gada class (Luba) was recruited genealogically. There were eleven grades through which the Gada classes passed from birth to death, with each grade lasting eight years. While age set members were of the same age, Gada members were of varied ages.

The age sets formed the age set council that recruited the warriors.Members of the Gada classes formed the Gada council (lallaba) which the responsibility of making decisions for their classes. They also resolved conflicts between non-relatives and mobilized economic activities such as digging wells, organizing societal rituals and ceremonies and directing relatives with their neighbours such as the Oromo and Somali.The councils contributed to the development of an effective political organization.The complexity of the borana institutions strengthened unity among them. However, the coming of the colonialists in the 20th century heavily impacted on these nomadic pastoral community.

CONTACTS BETWEEN EAST AFRICA AND THE OUTSIDE WORLD UP TO THE 19TH C.

The early contacts were initially at the coast but later spread inland. The early visitors included the Arabs, Greeks, Chinese, Persians, Portuguese, British, French and the Dutch.

 

The East African coast

The existing documentaries and archaeological evidence about the historical information on the east African coast include;

~  The Graeco- Roman Documentary which only makes indirect references to the east African coast.

~  The Swahili chronicles written by the people of the coast. E.g the Kilwa chronicle gives account of achievements of coastal rulers before the arrival of the Portuguese.

~  The writings of Pliny, a Roman Geographer who wrote about the high cost of trade with India in his book, The Natural History.

~  Periplus of the Erythrean Sea; by a Greek merchant in 1st C AD describes the people and places along the coast and the Indian Ocean Trade. (Erythrean Sea Trade).

~  Geopgraphia by Claudius Ptolemy makes reference to east African coast and the trade along Somalia and Kenyan coasts.

~  Christian Topography of Cosmos Indico of the 6TH C describes the trading activities on the coast of East Africa.

~  Renowned travelers like Al-Mosudi, Al Idrisi and Ibn Battuta wrote firsthand accounts about the places they visited and the people they met at the coast in the 10th C AD.

~  The existing archaeological evidence in east Africa include the remains of pottery , iron tools, beads and coins which prove the presence of international trade.

Early visitors to the east African coast upto 1500.

Due to the great accessibility of the east African coast, there was widespread interaction between it and the people from the outside world. This was also aided by the monsoon winds that blew vessels / ships to the coast between November and April and took them away between may and October. The earliest visitors were the Egyptians, Phoenicians and Indonesians.Others who came later on included the Greeks, Persians, Romans, Chinese, Arabs, Syrians, Indians and the Portuguese.

The Greeks

Their coming to east Africa is accounted for by the quarrels between the Seleucid rulers in Greece and the Ptolemaic Greeks in Egypt over control of the land route to the east through the Mediterranean lands.The rising demand for ivory made the ptolemies venture into the red sea and finally into the east African coast. Evidence of Greek existence on the coast is the Ptolemic Gold Coin found near Dar es Salam.

Romans

In AD 45, Hippalus, a Roman sailor using monsoon wind knowledge reached the red sea and entered the Indian Ocean. The Romans were keen on breaking the Arab monopoly over trade.Evidence of trade between the Romans and the coast is in the writing of a Roman Historian Pliny (23-79AD) who points out the high coast of trade between India, Arabia and china.The fall of the Roman Empire in the 5th c AD affected international trading network in the Roman Empire.

 

Persians

They were mainly immigrants from Shirazi on the eastern shore of the Persian Gulf. Their adventure into the east African coast happened during the reign of the Sassanid Dynasty(224-636AD), which was determined to rebuild the Persian Empire that had been destroyed by the Macedonian Greeks, through wealth amassed from international trade.

By the 6th c, the Persians were trading in India and later china, controlling the red sea and parts of Egypt and Arabia.They got involved in the east African trade and even established ruling dynasties9 e.g. the (Shirazi Dynasty) at the coast. They intermarried with the locals and introduced Islamic religion.They were later overthrown by the Arabs. The succeeded in introducing Bowls of glass, swords, beakers and pots to the coast.

Chinese

They visited the coast in the middle ages. This is evidenced in the work of the Chinese authors during the Sung Dynasty (960- 1279 AD) and Ming Dynasty (1368-1644), who referred to the east African coast as Tseng- Pat or Pseng- Po.There has also been evidence of Chinese coins dating to 700 AD at the coast.The last Chinese fleet must have reached Mogadishu in 1430AD. The Chinese brought in Silk cloth, porcelain bowls and plates in exchange for Gold\, leopard skin, Rhino Horns and tortoise shells. Porcelain remains have been found at the coast.

Arabs

The earliest Arab settlers to arrive were the Daybui from Daybul In north western India. They arrived along the east African coast by AD 650 for trade. The earliest Arab settlement was Qanbalu (Pemba). They later settled in manda, Kilwa. Lamu and Mombasa.The Arabs reffered to the Africans as the Zenj (Blacks)

Factors that facilitated the coming of Arabs to the east African coast.

~  The Indian ocean provided the highway through which the traders traveled

~  The traders had the skills of harnessing the monsoon winds (trade winds) they knew what times of the year to come to the coast and what times to go back.

~  The traders had marine technology e.g. they had ship-building technology and knew how to use the compass for navigation of the ocean

~  They ensured the control of the red sea was in their hands to bar the enemy from attacking them

~  The ports of southern Arabia were good calling places on their journey between the east and the west.

~  The deep harbours at the coast were ideal for their ships to anchor, refuel and get supplies.

Reasons for the coming of the Arabs

~  They wanted to trade and control the commercial activities along the east African coast.

~  Some Arabs came as refugees, fleeing from religious and political persecutions in Arabia.

~  They came to spread their religion, Islam.

~  Some came as explorers to explore the east African coast.

~  Some came to establish settlements along the east African coast.

Trade between the East African coast and the outside world

There is sufficient evidence of the existence of regular trading contacts between east African coast and the countries in the Middle East and Far East.

Development and organization of the trade

~  The earliest foreign traders must have been the Romans who traded with the Indians in the Far East. They made stopovers at the east African coast for ivory whose demand had grown tremendously.

~  Muslim Arabs acted as intermediaries in the Indian Ocean trade between the Indians and the Romans. They also exported frankincense and myrrh among other things.

~  Traders from Persia, Arabia and Syria brought glass beakers and bowls, swords, pots, grains, sugar, cloth and beads in exchange for palm oil, tortoise shells, ivory and slaves.

~  The Greek, roman and Chinese traders brought porcelain bowls, daggers, swords, pottery, cowrie shells, glassware, beads and silk in exchange for ivory, rhinoceros horns, bee wax, tortoise shells , coconut oil and mangrove poles. Cowrie shells were obtained from Maldives islands while spices came from Spice Island.

~  East Africa also exported leopard skins, gold, ostrich feathers, copal, copper and iron. Ivory was used in Asia to make bangles, bracelets, piano keys and for decorations

~  The traders relied on the monsoon winds to blow their ships to and from the east African coast.

~  The Indian Ocean trade was conducted through the barter system but later coins were used as a medium of exchange. During barter, the foreigners bartered their goods with gold, ivory and slaves. Seyyid said later introduced copper and silver coins.

~  The middlemen in the trade included the Arabs and Swahili who organized caravans to the interior to acquire local goods which they sold to traders at the coast.

~  As there was no common language spoken, trading was conducted silently, hence the name ‘silent trade’

~  Capital for the trade was provided by the Arabs. Later the Indian banyans started giving credit facilities to the traders which increased the volume of trade.

~  The sultan of Zanzibar provided security to the Arab traders, enabling them to penetrate the interior to acquire goods.

~  The trade stimulated development of towns along the coastline. E.g Rhapta (probably located between pangani and Dar es Salam), Essina and Sarapion were the earliest towns to grow. Lamu Malindi Mombasa, pate and Brava also developed.

~  The merchants settled at various places on the coast and on the islands and interacted with the locals leading to development of the Swahili culture. Factors which promoted the Indian Ocean trade.

(a)  Availability of items of trade from the east African coast and foreigner countries. For example, ivory, slaves, cotton and porcelain.

(b)  The high demand for trade items from the coast by consumers from the outside world was also a promoting factor. This was caused by the uneven distribution of resources. Foreign items were also on demand at the coat.

(c)  The existence of enterprising merchants in both the foreign lands and the east African coast led to promotion of trade links. The Akamba, Mijikenda, nyamwezi and Swahili middlemen for example played a pivoted role in the trade.

(d)  The existence of local trade among Africans which acted as a base upon which the Indian Ocean trade was developed.

(e)  The accessibility of the east African coast by sea. This enabled the foreigner traders to reach the region across the Indian Ocean.

(f)  The existence of the monsoon winds facilitated the movement of the vessels which made it possible for the traders to travel to and from the coasty.

(g)  The existence of peace and political stability at the east African coast created a conducive atmosphere for business transactions. Where there was need, the traders were given security by the sultan of Zanzibar.

(h)  The existence of natural harbours along the coast ensured safe docking of the trade vessels for fueling and off-loading.

(i)  The advancement in the ship building technology in Europe gave great advantage to the traders. This made water transport reliable and regular.

(j)  The existence o the Indian Banyans (money lenders) who gave credit facilities enabled many more people to join the trade.

Impacts of the trade on the peoples of east Africa

(a)  The trade led to intermarriage between Muslim traders with the local Bantu communities giving rise to the Swahili people with a distinct culture.

(b)  There was emergence of Kiswahili as a new language of the coastal people. The language is a mixture of Bantu and Arabic languages.

(c)  The trade led to the spread of the Islamic culture along the coastal region. Stone buildings were constructed, new dressing styles arose (women began to wear buibui while men wore kanzus), new eating habits also evolved.

(d)  The Islamic law, sharia was also introduced.

(e)  Many Africans were converted to Islam. However the religion did not spread beyond the coastal region prior to the 19th c.

(f)  New crops were introduced along the coast. For example, rice, wheat, millet, cloves, vegetables and fruits such as bananas and oranges. Cloth, cowrie shells and spices were also introduced.

(g)  Profits derived from the trade were used to develop towns like Pemba, Mombasa, Lamu, Zanzibar and Kilwa.

(h)  The trade led to the rise of a class of rich merchants exhibiting a high standard of living. African merchants who rose to prominence included chief Kivoi among the Akamba, Ngonyo of the Giriama, Mwakikonga of the Digo, Nyungu ya mawe, Mirambo and Msiri of the Nyamwezi.

(i)  There was decline of the local industries like weaving and iron working which were affected by the influx of foreign goods like cloth fro India and iron tools from Asia and Europe.

(j)  There was destruction of wildlife, especially elephant and rhinoceros due to the increased demand for ivory.

(k)  The increased demand for slaves promoted warfare among the communities as many people were captured during slave raids. It also created fear while others lost their life during the warfare.

(l)  Slave trade also disrupted African economies as able bodied men were captured leaving behind the aged, weak, and children who made little contribution. Many even died of starvation since they could not participate in food production.

(m)  African population in the hinterland greatly reduced as many were sold into slavery.

(n)  Money (currency) was introduced as a means of exchange to replace the barter system of trade.

(o)  East African coast was exposed to the outside world through trade. This paved way for European imperialism later on.

(p)  Trade routes led to the establishment of trade caravan routes which later were upgraded to by the colonialists.

The coming of the Portuguese

Since the 10th century Arabian influence along the coast had been strong. Most of the port towns along the East African coast had been built by Arab Sultans, who brought the Muslim religion to the coastal people.The Portuguese explorer and soldier, Vasco da Gama, was the first European to make contact with the people of the East African Coast. He had been paid by the King of Portugal to find a sea route to India.

The Portuguese at the East African coast 1500 – 1700 A.D

The Portuguese were the first Europeans to have contacts with the people of the East African Coast. They invaded the east African coast in 1498 at a time when the Ottoman Empire occupied most of the Middle East thus blocking the overland route to India from Europe.They were adventurous and in search for the sea route to India. This led them to the East African Coast where they stayed for 200 years.

Reasons for the coming of the Portuguese at the East African coast

  1. a) The need to establish a commercial empire in order to get the products of East Africa e.g. ivory, gold, silks and spices that were mainly controlled by the Arabs merchants.
  2. b) They wanted to obtain control of the main trading towns, e.g. Kilwa, Mombasa etc.
  3. c) They wanted to defeat the Muslim traders and rulers who had monopolized the Indian Ocean trade.
  4. d) They wanted to prevent other European rivals from gaining access to the Indian Ocean Trade e.g. the French, Dutch, and British
  5. e) Desire to get revenue for the development of their country.
  6. f) The Portuguese wished to share in the profits of the Indian Ocean Trade by imposing taxes and forcing wealthy coastal towns to pay tribute to the king of Portugal.
  7. g) The coast had natural harbors where ships could anchor on their way to and from the East for fresh food and water. The Portuguese therefore wanted to establish a calling station for resting, refresh, treating the sick, repairing wrecked ships e.t.c
  8. h) The coast was strategically located and this made it easy to control sea pirates and other rival powers.
  9. i) They wanted to revenge on the Muslim Arabs who had conquered Portugal in 711 AD by converting them to Christianity and stop the spread of Islam i.e. the Arabs had ever run the Iberian Peninsula and forced the Christians to accept Islam.
  10. j) They hoped to get assistance of King Prester John thought to be in the interior of north –east Africa. They hoped the king would help them in their crusade against the Muslims.
  11. k) They had hope of stopping Egyptians and Turks from sending military aid to their fellow Moslems on the coast.
  12. l) They were interested in exploration and adventure; this was a period of Renaissance (means to be born again/change) in Europe. Hence hoped to search for the unknown, new knowledge and sailing across un mapped seas.
  13. m) Desire to acquire revenue for the development of their country.

Portuguese conquest of the coast 1500-1510 (Stages of conquest) Steps taken by the

Portuguese to occupy the East African coast.

~  In 1497 King John 11 sent Padro da Covillha on a land journey  to India to gather information about the Eastern trades and the sea routes.

~  In 1498 Bathromew Diaz sailed around the Cape of Good Hope, thus proving that there was a way round South Africa to the Indian Ocean.

~  Between 1497- 1499 Vasco da Gama at the command of King Emmanuel the fortunate of Portugal visited Mozambique, Mombasa and Malindi on his way to India.  He arrived in Malindi in March 1498 to a warm welcome by the locals.

~  He returned to Portugal in 1499 and gave a report of the flourishing Sofala trade, the Deep Harbour in Mombasa and the existing disunity of coastal people.

~  In response to Vasco da Gama’s expeditions, the king of Portugal sent fleets of ships to conquer the important trading towns of the East African coast.

~  In 1500 Pedro Alvares Cabral attempted to capture Sofala with its Gold trade but he failed.

~  In 1502 Vasco da Gama came back with 19 ships aiming at capturing Kilwa because it was the most important and prosperous. He captured the palace, imprisoned the Su ltan and only released him when he accepted to pay tribute to Portugal.

~  From Kilwa he invaded Mombasa, which tried to get assistance from Malindi but since they were great rivals Malindi refused to give assistance, this disunity made the work of conquest easy.

~  In 1503 Ruy Laurence Ravasco was sent with a number of ships and forced the islands of Mafia and Zanzibar and other towns to pay tribute to Portugal.

~  In 1504, Lopez destroyed gold trade at Kilwa. Attacks were too much on the harbour that trade came to a standstill. But again the Arabs failed to unite to fight the Portuguese.

~  In 1505 Francisco D’Almeida arrived at the coast on his way to Gao where he had been appointed the first Portuguese viceroy (governor) of the Eastern Empire.  With 1500 men and 20 ships, he attacked Sofala which surrendered without struggle because she was tired of Kilwa’s rule and therefore preferred the Portuguese to fellow Arabs.  His forces continued northwards and attacked Kilwa. The Sultan and his followers took off to the bush while the Portuguese looted and burnt down the town before he departed to India. He also conquered Mombasa.

~  In 1506 – 1507 Tristao Da Cunha took on the Northern towns of Socotra, Oja, Brava and Lamu. Towns that submitted without struggles were only asked to pay tribute to Portugal. Malindi was even excused from paying tribute due to her friendship with the Portuguese.

~  In 1509 Alba quiqui captured the remaining towns i.e. the work of conquest was completed with taking the islands of Pemba, Mafia, and Zanzibar.  Mombasa was burnt down.

~  By 1515 the Portuguese had succeeded in conquering most of the coastal towns, bring them under Portuguese rule. However towns like Gedi, Kilifi, Pate, Manda, Mombasa and Lamu continued with resistance. Mombasa was heavily attacked in 1528.

~  In 1585, a Turkish captain, Amir Ali Bey, arrived at the coast as an envoy of the sultan of turkey to free the coastal towns from the Portuguese. Rebellion then broke out between 1585 and 1588 between Ali Bey, the Portuguese, and the people of Mombasa and Zimba warriors. The towns of pate, Siyu and Pemba were attacked and forced to pay heavy fines while manda was completely destroyed.

~  Portugal finally brought all the coastal towns under her control establishing her

headquarters in Mombasa that had been subdued in 1589. in 1593, the Portuguese built fort Jesus

Why the Portuguese build Fort Jesus

  1. a) They used it as a watch tower
  2. b) To hide against attacks by the enemies
  3. c) As military base
  4. d) To offer food security and protection.
  5. e) To act as an armament.
  6. f) To act as a prison for the captives.

~  Portuguese control of the east African coast as greatly supported by the conquest of Hormuz, which made it easier for them to control sea traffic in the Persian Gulf, Gulf of Eden and Arabian Sea.

Why the Portuguese defeated the East African Coastal towns/Why the Portuguese were successful

  1. a) They had superior weapons e.g. cannon guns which made terrible noise and threw people in panic as compared to the poor musket guns of the coastal Arabs.
  2. b) They had well trained soldiers with superior skills of fighting compared to the coastal people who had no permanent organized army e.g. Vasco da Gama, Francisco D’Almeida were ruthless army commanders which helped them to defeat the coastal dwellers.
  3. c) They had better and faster ships (carracks) well equipped for naval warfare. The Portuguese soldiers wore Armour on their bodies and helmets on their heads, which protected them from the weapons of the coastal people.
  4. d) The coastal towns were disunited which gave chance to the Portuguese to fight isolated enemies e.g. Malindi refused to unite with Mombasa due to local conflicts. Some cooperated with the invaders giving them food and bases e.g. Malindi and Sofala.
  5. e) Some coastal towns like Kilwa were caught unaware. The Portuguese employed cruel methods of fighting like burning down towns and surprise attacks.
  6. f) The ships acted as stages against the hostile weapons of the coastal people.
  7. g) The coast had natural harbours and was not open to attacks.
  8. h) The constant attacks on the coastal towns by the Galla, Zimba and Turkish e.t.c had weakened their defence.
  9. i) The Portuguese were financially equipped and therefore supported their soldiers because they wanted to control the East African trade.
  10. j) The coastal states had very weak economies that could not sustain prolonged fights especially against the economically strong Portuguese.

Portuguese Administration at the coast

By 1510, the conquest of the East African coast was over and administration fell into the hands of the Portuguese. For easy administration, the coast was divided into two zones;

  1. The area North of Cape Delgado was ruled by the Captain at Malindi.
  2. The area South of Cape Delgado was ruled by Captain at Mozambique.

Both captains were answerable to the Portuguese viceroy at Goa on Indian coast at the General headquarters. Cape Delgado was made the midpoint of the East Africa possession. Sofala was made the regional headquarters but still under the charge of the captain who took his orders from the viceroy at Goa. Later, the Captain in the North was stationed at Mombasa after the construction of Fort Jesus in 1593 because they were rebellious.  Other forts and garrisons were established at Sofala and Kilwa.

The Portuguese captains were responsible for the collections of tributes from coastal rulers.

They imposed the customs dues on all imports and exports.  They were also responsible for the suppression of rebellions on the coast.  The Portuguese had problems with administration because they could not provide enough troops to all garrisons their strongholds.The Portuguese were more interested in gold trade in Sofala. Unfortunately, they failed to develop this trade because of the following;

~  There were wars in the mining areas between the Portuguese and Coastal people.

~  As a result the Portuguese were so cruel that any sign of disobedience was punished with maximum brutality to serve as a warning to others who might choose to rebel. This partly explains the unpopularity of the Portuguese on the coast. The Portuguese also applied the policy of divide and rule by setting one town against the other. For example Malindi against Mombasa.The relationship with the subjects was not good. They lived in isolation of each other by race and religion. The Portuguese established their own settlements, built their own churches and had their own priest. This could be the reason why their religion was rejected and hatred increased.In addition, the few Portuguese officials were corrupt, plundered and ordered destruction on the coastal town. All this earned them hatred and opposition from the people and it was not a surprise that they were nicknamed “AFRITI” meaning Devil.The Portuguese did not mix freely with Africans because they considered themselves to be a special race.During the Portuguese reign, the glory of the coastal states was no more. The high standards of living the coastal people had enjoyed were no more. The trade that had made them rich was declining.  Many buildings were in ruins and there was widespread poverty and misery.

Reasons that led to the decline of the Portuguese at the East African Coast

(Problems/challenges they faced)

  1. a) Portugal was a small country that could not provide enough administrators and officials for such a large coastline that extended from Sofala in the south to Mogadishu in the north.The territory was too big and long for effective control and administration.
  2. b) It had few soldiers and could not keep fortified garrison along the coast.
  3. c) Authority was left in hands of incompetent and corrupt officials who were after enriching themselves.
  4. d) The Africans hated the Portuguese due to differences in religion, that is to say, Muslims against Christians (Portuguese).
  5. e) The Portuguese were cruel, harsh and brutal, they always punished the coastal people whenever they attempted to rebel and made them to be hated.
  6. f) The Portuguese also used divide and rule policy for example, they allied with Malindi against Mombasa.
  7. g) There was decline of trade due high taxes on imports and other restrictions hence smuggling of goods, which affected the Portuguese economy. Due to decline in trade, the people became poor and dissatisfied and they continuously rebelled.
  8. h) The Portuguese failed to support their own allies at the coast, some even betrayed them.
  9. i) Portugal had been forced into a union with Spain between1580–1640 which weakened her control of the trading colonies as she was no longer interested in the overseas empire.
  10. j) Portugal was challenged by other European powers, which began competing with the Portuguese in the Indian Ocean Trade e.g. Dutch, English, French, Turks and others.
  11. k) The coastal people found useful allies against the Portuguese due to their bad rule e.g. Turks, Oman, and Arabs
  12. l) They were faced with constant rebellions along the coast. This greatly disrupted life at the coast e.g. Pate, Mombasa
  13. m) Tropical diseases which claimed their life like smallpox, malaria making it difficult for them to administer the coast effectively.
  14. n) The Portuguese were greatly weakened by a group of cannibals the Zimba, who attacked the East African coast.
  15. o) The unhealthy climate made the area unattractive for them to work for instance, some places where too humid and hot while others were too cold.
  16. p) The distance between Portugal and the East African coast was too far hence reinforcement delayed.
  17. q) There was a problem of communication barrier, the Portuguese refused to learn the African languages and these made their administration difficult.
  18. r) The income obtained from the gold trade was not enough to pay for administration i.e. soldiers and officials.
  19. s) The Capture of Fort Jesus their stronghold in 1698 by the Omani greatly contributed to their decline.

The collapse of Portuguese rule

~  In 1585, a Turkish captain, Amir Ali Bey, arrived at the coast as an envoy of the sultan of turkey to free the coastal towns from the Portuguese. Rebellion then broke out between 1585 and 1588 between Ali Bey, the Portuguese, and the people of Mombasa and Zimba warriors. The towns of pate, Siyu and Pemba were attacked and forced to pay heavy fines while manda was completely destroyed

~  As a result of their ruthlessness, the coastal people became hostile to the Portuguese.

~  Mombasa for example resisted the humiliation they got from the Portuguese appointedsultan

~  The sultan’s heir Yusuf was treated as a servant who resented the people of Mombasa

~  On 15thaugust 1631, during the Christian feast of Assumption in Mombasa, Sultan Yusuf stabbed the captain with a knife, killing him instantly. This sparked off a rebellion where many Portuguese were killed.

~  Yusuf posed a threat to the Portuguese rule until his death in 1637.

~  The people of pate also revolted in 1666. However, their ruler was arrested and exiled to Goa where he was executed

~  In 1622, the Persians drove the Portuguese from Hormuz. In 1650, the Portuguese were expelled from their bases in Muscat by the Omani Arabs under sultan Saif

~  Britain, France and Holland also began to compete the Portuguese in trade.

~  The final blow to Portuguese rule was attack by the Omani Arabs and the seizure of fort Jesus. The coastal Arab towns had appealed to their brothers in Oman for assistance against the Portuguese brutality.

~  In 1652, an Oman fleet sailed to pate and Zanzib ar, overpowered and killed the Portuguese.

~  In 1696, Imam Saif Ibn Sultan of Oman sailed to Mombasa with a large fleet and army. The Portuguese took refuge in Fort Jesus as battle raged on (about 2500 Portuguese men, women and children) the Portuguese were unfortunate as they could not get supplies to sustain the war with 3000 plus Arab soldiers with full packing of the coastal people.

~  In 1697, the Omani forces got access to the Fort and found most Portuguese afflicted with

disease. By December 1698, the Omanis penetrated the Fort only to find all except twelve Portuguese dead. This marked the end of Portuguese rule though they made a temporaryseizure of the fort in 1728 but were overpowered.

~  For the coastal people, it was however a mere change of guard from the Portuguese to the Arabs.

Results of Portuguese stay at the coast of East Africa

Positive:

  1. a) The Portuguese built Fort Jesus at the coast in Mombasa in1592/3 which became a fortress and later a tourist attraction for centuries.
  2. b) They enriched the Swahili language with an addition of 60 words e.g. emeza meaning table and pesa meaning money.
  3. c) They introduced new crops from South Africa of which many have become staple diet for many East Africans e.g. cassava, pawpaws, maize, oranges, sweet potatoes, guavas, pineapples and mangoes
  4. d) They made an improvement in ship building. During their stay on the coast, many architects came in from India and Europe.
  5. e) There was establishment of closer trading links between the coast and India.
  6. f) They introduced new farming methods for example they encouraged the use of cow dung as manure.
  7. g) They led to the coming of more European and Asian traders and craftsmen especially those who helped in the building of Fort Jesus.
  8. h) They broke the Muslim- Arab monopoly of the Indian Ocean Trade.

Negative:

  1. a) Trade declined due to the constant wars and rebellions and heavy taxes imposed.
  2. b) There was decline of the coastal towns because many were burnt down and left in ruins for example Kilwa and Mombasa.
  3. c) There was widespread poverty and misery among the coastal people due to decline in trade.
  4. d) There was heavy loss of lives during the attacks. There was depopulation due to the many wars in the areas
  5. e) There was destruction of property like buildings and crops, which led to famine and starvation.
  6. f) The coastal people suffered oppression and brutality under harsh rule of the Portuguese.
  7. g) Their religion, Christianity, made no impact at the coast because they lived far from their subjects and stagnation of the Islamic faith because discouraged preaching.
  8. h) Smuggling developed because the Portuguese had failed to establish proper trading links with the Interior.
  9. i) Some towns were prevented from trading with their initial partners which led to their decay e.g. Gedi
  10. j) They led to the European interest at the coast hence leading to the colonization in the 19th Century.

THE ESTABLISHMENT AND IMPACT OF OMANI RULE AT THE EAST AFRICAN COAST

The Omani Arabs (Imams of Omani) replaced the Portuguese as the rulers of the East African coast after the capture of fort Jesus in 1698.The new rulers initially administered the region through some Arab families;

~  The Mazrui (Mazaria) family which ruled Mombasa

~   The Nabahan Family which ruled Lamu.

The civil wars back home made it hard for the Omani Arabs to control the coast immediately. There were also threats of Persian invasion. Constant rebellion from coastal towns against Omani governors posed a serious challenge to Omani rule. Pate for example refused to pay tax and even murdered the imam’s messengers. Towns they were loyal to Oman were attacked.The Mazrui established themselves as independent rulers of Mombasa and ordered towns like pate, Pemba and Malindi to pay allegiance to them. Their greatest allies were the Mijikenda who promised them support in case of Omani attack.The struggle between the Mazrui and the Imams of Oman (1741-1840)

The coastal towns led by Mombasa resisted Oman’s conquest due to the following reasons.

  1. a) The Omani wanted the revenue from the taxes levied on trade.
  2. b) The towns also wished to maintain their independence as they were during the Portuguese rule.
  3. c) The towns were also encouraged by the prevailing weaknesses in Oman due to civil wars and the Persian threat.
  4. d) The harsh and ruthless rule and manner in which the Oman rulers collected taxes.
  5. e) Mombasa had fought against the Portuguese and did not wish to be under control of another foreign power.

 

The struggle

The appointment of Mohammed Ibn Azthman al Mazrui as the new governor of Mombasa coincided with the death of the Oman Imam Saif Ibn- Sultan of the Yorubi and his replacement with Ahmed Bin Said al-Busaidi.The new Mombasa governor refused to recognize the new imam and declared the independence of Mombasa from Oman. The sultan had him murdered and fort Jesus seized. A year later, the brother of the murdered governor recaptured the town and the fort. This became the century long struggle between the al-busaidi and al-Mazrui families.Taking advantage of the problems in Oman, Mombasa expanded her power and control over the coastal towns (she took over pate in 1807 and attacked Lamu in 1810). Lamu appealed to Oman for assistance.

Seyyid Said and the struggle

Further political changes happened in Oman. Seyyid said rose to power as the imam (Seyyid) of Oman. His father, the ruler of Oman had died in a sea battle in 1804 when he was only 13 years. His cousin Badr Ibn saif took over. In 1806, Said stabbed Badr to death fearing domination. With the assistance of the British he had entrenched his position as the Seyyid of Oman at the age of 15 years. The British even promised him support in claiming the east African coast.He then sent a governor to build a fortress in Mombasa and to order all towns to recognize the power of Oman. Mombasa’s new governor Abdullah Ibn Ahmed defied the order and even continued to attack Brava.

By 1817, Seyyid said had succeeded in freeing Pate from Mazrui rule. In 1822, with the help of Zanzibar, an Oman ally, he liberated Pemba and Brava from Mombasa. In 1823, he gained control of the Bajun Islands. He ordered that no town should trade with Mombasa.In 1824, the sultan of Mombasa offered Mombasa to become a British protectorate to protect him from the Oman rule. The new powerful position of Mombasa was however short-lived upto 1826 due to the terms of the Moresby anti-slavery treaty between Seyyid said and the British.The animosity between Mombasa and Oman continued. In 1837, there was a dispute in Mombasa over the succession to the vacant office of the Liwali. This became an opportune chance for Seyyid said to lure the members of the Mazrui family into fort Jesus where he killed them.

Seyyid Said; Sultan of Zanzibar 91840-1856)

After that Seyyid said consolidated his power and control over the coast as well as the interior of east Africa. He then transferred his capital from Muscat to Oman.

The transfer of the capital to Zanzibar from Muscat was due to the following reasons:

  1. a) Seyyid said desired to effectively control the coastal towns through the centrally located Zanzibar.
  2. b) Zanzibar had a pleasant climate compared to Muscat which was hot and dry. It also had

fresh water, adequate rainfall and fertile soils that favoured clove growing.

  1. c) Zanzibar was easily defensible as an island. It was easy to sea the enemy from far and launch an attack from the island.
  2. d) The good deep harbours of Zanzibar I which ships could anchor were attractive.

Zanzibar’s central position also favoured development of long distance trade.

  1. e) The town had a long history of loyalty to Oman throughout the Mazrui- busaidi

struggles. Seyyid said appointed Liwalis to rule important towns. They were give the responsibility of collecting custom dues levied at each port. The Arabs in the local towns were allowed to rule themselves. Seyyid said was keener on the commercial empire than p olitical leadership. He stated “I am nothing but just a merchant”.

Seyyid said developed an economic programme based on agriculture and international trade.

The development of plantation Agriculture

Seyyid sad encouraged settlers from Oman and Zanzibar to take advantage of the fertile sols and good climate at the coast to settle in Mombasa. Malindi, Lamu and Pemba venture into agriculture.Plantation agriculture largely depended on slave labour.The people of Mombasa extended plantation agriculture into the mainland, acquiring land from the Mijikenda in exchange for gifts. They planted rice, maize, millet, beans, sesame and sorghum. Along the island, large plantations of coconut mango trees, cashew nuts and citrus fruits were developed. Grain plantations were developed around Malindi and Takaungu whose land was largely unoccupied and the orma were no longer a threat.

By 1870, about 1400 to 1500 slaves worked on plantation farms in Malindi which had become the granary of Africa producing all kinds of grains, mangoes, coconut, mangoes and oranges.Seyyid said also established a clove plantation in Zanzibar. He also encouraged people to grow coconut trees by putting in place a policy that for eve coconut tree cut, three were to be planted. Plantation agriculture intensified slave trade.

The Slave Trade in East Africa

Slave trade: The buying and selling of human beings

Slavery: The state of being enslaved: It’s a system where by some people are owned by others and are forced to work for others without being paid for the work they have done.

It involves capturing, transporting of human beings who become the ‘property’ of the buyer. The slave trade was one of the worst crimes against humanity. The trade was started by Arabs who wanted labour for domestic use and for their plantations. However, they were later joined by Europeans..

Reasons for the rise of slave trade

~  During the second half of the 18th century, France opened up larger sugar plantations on the islands of Reunion, Mauritius and in the Indian Ocean. African slaves were thus recruited from East Africa to go and work in those plantations.

~  Africans were considered physically fit to work in harsh climatic conditions compared to the native red Indians and Europeans. This greatly increased the demand for the indigenous people (slaves).

~  The increased demand for sugar and cotton in Europe led to their increase in price and therefore more labour (slaves) was needed in the British colonies of West Indies and America.

~  Strong desire for European goods by African chiefs like Mirambo and Nyungu ya Mawe forced them to acquire slaves in exchange for  manufactured goods such as brass, metal ware, cotton cloth, beads, spirits such as whisky, guns and gun powder.

~  The existence and recognition of slavery in East Africa societies. Domestic and child slavery already existed therefore Africans were willing to exchange slaves for European goods.

~  The huge profits enjoyed by middlemen like Arab Swahili traders encouraged the traders to get deeply involved in the trade.

~  The suitable winds and currents (monsoon winds) which eased transportation for slave traders greatly contributed to the rise of slave trade.

~  The Legalization of slave trade in 1802 by Napoleon 1 of France increased the demand for slaves in all French Colonies.

~  The increased number of criminals, war captives, destitute forced African chiefs to sell them off as slaves.

~  The Oman Arabs contributed to the rise in the demand for slaves. This is because they acted as middlemen between the African Swahili people, the Portuguese and French traders. They therefore worked very hard to get slaves in order to obtain revenue from them.

~  The invention of Spanish mines in West indices increased slave demands to work in the mines.

~  The exodus of slaves from East Africa to Northeast Africa, Arabia and Persia contributed to the increase in the demand for slaves. It led to an enormous number of slaves obtained from East Africa being transported to other countries.

~  The movement of Seyyid Said’s capital to Zanzibar led to an increase in slave trade. This is because when Seyyid said settled in Zanzibar in 1840, he embarked on strong plans to open up slave trade routes to the interior of East Africa. This boosted slave trade, whereby the number of slaves being sold at the slave market in Zanzibar annually by that time, reached between 40000 and 45000 thousand slaves.

~  The outbreak of diseases like Nagana led to an increase in slave trade. This is because the beasts of burden (i.e. camels, donkeys, etc) could not be taken on many of the caravan routes. It therefore necessitated people themselves to be involved in the transportation of the trade goods and ivory. Such people included porters who were regarded as slaves, or free Africans who could sell their services in return for cloth and other trade goods.

~  Development of long distance trade that needed slaves to transport goods from the interior of East Africa.

~  Plantation farming increased in some areas, especially the clove plantations were slaves worked.

Organization of slave trade in E. Africa

The middlemen involved were;

  Arab Swahili traders

  African chiefs.

Ways of obtaining slaves

  Selling of domestic slaves in exchange for goods like beads, guns, glass etc

  Selling of criminals, debtors and social misfits in society by the local chiefs to the Arab slave traders.

  Prisoners of war could be sold off.

  Porters were sometimes kidnapped, transported and sold off to the Arab traders.

  Raiding villages, this would begin at night with gun shoots and people would scatter consequently leading to their capture.

  Through inter tribal wars many Africans become destitutes and these would be captured by the slave traders.

  Tax offenders were sold off by the African chiefs.

  They were also captured through ambushes during hunting, travelling and gardening.

  Slaves would be acquired from the main slave trade market in Zanzibar.

  Other Africans are also said to have gone voluntarily in anticipation of great wonders and benefits from the Arab Swahili traders. Slave journey: - Slaves’ journey was a difficult one. They moved long distances on foot.

  Chained, whipped and sometimes killed on the way.

  Had little food and water and experienced extreme suffering.

This is illustrated by a Quotation from Dr. David Livingstone’s Last Journal.  London 1878:“We passed a woman tied by the neck to a tree and dead …we saw others tied up in a similar manner, and one lying in the path shot or stabbed for she was in a pool of blood. The explanation we got invariably was that the Arab who owned these victims was enraged at losing the money by the slaves becoming unable to march.”

~  The main slave market where slaves were auctioned was at Zanzibar.

~  The journey across the India Ocean was horrible.

~  Crowded in ships with hardly any space to breath. Ships carried anything from 250 to 600 slaves. They were very overcrowded and packed like spoons with no room even to turn.

~  Whenever they saw anti-slave trade people, slaves would be thrown in the ocean

~  As a result many died in the process.

Effects/Impact of slave trade on people of E. Africa

Positive effects

  1. a) New foods were introduced through trade routes like maize, pawpaws, rice, groundnuts both at the coast and in the interior.
  2. b) Plantation farming increased in some areas, especially the clove plantations were slaves worked.
  3. c) The interior was opened to the outside world this later encouraged the coming of European missionaries. Many European Christian missionaries came to East Africa to preach against slave trade and to campaign for its abolition.
  4. d) The trade routes became permanent routes and inland roads which led to growth of communication networks.
  5. e) Swahili was introduced in land and is now being widely spoken in Tanzania, Kenya, Uganda and Eastern Congo.
  6. f) Islam as a religion was introduced by Arabs and it spread, especially in Yao land and in Buganda land.
  7. g) A new race called Swahili was formed through intermarriages between Arabs and some Africans.
  8. h) There was growth of Arab towns such as Tabora and Ujiji inland.
  9. i) There was emergence of dynamic leaders such as Mirambo and Nyungu ya Mawe in the latter half of the nineteenth century.
  10. j) Slave trade strengthened the large and powerful states, which could easily get access to guns at the expense of small ones.
  11. k) Slave trade led to a situation whereby power became centralized and no longer with the small, local authority (segimentary societies) mainly to enable African chiefs directly control slave trade.
  12. l) Slave trade encouraged large-scale trade whereby contact was established between the trade masters and indigenous/local population.
  13. m) Africans were dispersed to other parts of the world e.g Arabia, America and West Indies. In Africa, Sierra-Leone and Liberia were founded to accommodate former slaves from Europe and America.

Negative effects

  1. a) African population was reduced; people who would have been great leaders and empire builders were killed. It is estimated that over 15 to 30 million people were sold in to slavery while other millions died in the process being transported.
  2. b) Slave trade brought misery, suffering and lowered the quality of people in East Africa this is because they were reduced to ‘commodities’ which could be bought and sold on land.
  3. c) Villages and families were destroyed and broken up by slave raiders and never to be reunited this later resulted in to loss of identity.
  4. d) Diseases broke out among the overcrowded slaves for example the Spaniards introduced Syphilis and soon it spread to other traders.
  5. e) Slave trade led to displacement of people and many became homeless and destitute many and stayed in Europe with no identity.
  6. f) Economic activities such as farming were disrupted. This is because the young and able craftsmen, traders and farmers were carried off, causing economic stagnation as the economic workforce depleted.
  7. g) Progress slowed down, which resulted in famine, poverty and destitution and helplessness.
  8. h) There was a decline in production of traditional goods such as coffee, beans, bark cloth and iron which greatly hindered the cash economy.
  9. i) There was a decline in African industries which also faced a lot of competition from imported manufactured goods for example the Bark cloth and iron working industries.
  10. j) Guns were introduced into the interior which caused a lot of insecurity and increased incidences of wars for territorial expansion.
  11. k) Clans and tribal units, languages were broken and inter-tribal peace was disturbed for example Swahili language replaced the traditional languages in the interior.

Abolition of slave trade

Reasons why it was difficult to stop slave trade

~  Slavery existed before in Africa societies that is to say, domestic slavery and internal slave trade, which provided a favourable situation for continuation of the lucrative  slave trade.

~  The Abolition movement which had begun in Britain and her overseas territory first took effect in West Africa. The decline in West African trade encouraged the expansion of trade in East Africa especially with America and West Indies.

~  Slave trade was difficult to stop because of division of African tribes against each other .This meant that African tribes would find it difficult to unite together and resist the slave

traders, who raided their societies using organized bands of men.

~  Disregard of human life, many African rulers tended to put less value for the lives of their subjects whom they ruled for example quite often, a ruler of a tribe would easily order his warriors to attack the villages of his subjects and seize their property, kill some of them.

~  Active participation and willing cooperation of African chiefs and coastal traders who were making a lot of profits made the slave trade last for so long.

~  Many European countries depended on the products of slave labour in West Indies and America for example, British industries depended on raw sugar, raw cotton and unprocessed minerals from America which she was not willing to lose.

~  European slave merchants and Africans involved in the trade were blinded by the huge profits made from the trade.

~  There was smuggling of slaves outside the forbidden areas. Slave traders would pretend to sail northwards when sighted by British patrol ships but would change course after British navy ships had disappeared.

~  Other European countries refused to co-operate with Britain to end slave trade because they had not yet become industrialized, and therefore they still benefited from it for example Portugal and Spain.

~  The only economic alternative of slave trade was Agriculture which was not reliable compared to the booming slave trade.

~  The anti slavery campaign was too expensive for Britain alone to compensate slave owners.

~  Stopping slave trade in the interior was difficult because Arabs were in control  of large areas.

~  The East African coastline was long which delayed the anti-slavery group penetration in the interior.

~  Due to the tropical climate, most British personnel were affected by malaria which hindered the stopping of Slave trade.

~  Seyyid Said and Barghash were always unwilling to end slave trade at once due to fear of losing revenue and risk of rebellion by Arabs who found it profitable.

~  The anti-slavery group was small compared to the East African Coast.

~  European powers continued with slave trade, they shipped the slave cargos in to ships bearing American Flags.

Factors that led to the abolition of slave trade

It was the British government that began the abolition of the slave trade during the years,1822 – 1826 . This was because of the pressure by various groups based on different factors;

  1. a) Rise of humanitarians in Europe such as Christians and scholars condemned it on moral grounds. The missionaries wanted it to be stopped because they wanted good conditions for the spread of Christianity. The formation of the humanitarian movements in England aimed at stopping all kinds of cruelty including slave trade, flogging of soldiers and child labour.
  2. b) Industrialization in Britain was one of the main forces behind the abolition .E.g. Britain industrialists urged its abolition because they wanted Afr icans to be left in Africa so that Africa can be a source of raw materials for their industries, market for European manufactured goods and a place for new investment of surplus capital.
  3. c) Formation of Anti-slavery movement and the abolitionist movement in 1787. Its

chairman was Granville Sharp and others like Thomas Clarkson, William Wilberforce who gathered facts and stories about the brutality of slave trade and slavery to arouse public opinion in Britain.

  1. d) Religious revival in Europe, Anglicans preached and condemned slave trade as being opposed to laws of God and humanity. Catholic popes also protested against the trade and prohibited it. In 1774, many religious leaders served as examples when they liberated their slaves in England.
  2. e) The French revolution of 1789 and the American revolution of 1776 emphasized liberty, equality and fraternity (brotherhood) of all human beings. As a result, people began to question whether anyone had a right to deprive fellow man of his liberty when he had done wrong.
  3. f) The British desire to protect their national interests, British planters wanted slave trade stopped to avoid competition with other European planters .This is because other planters were producing cheaper sugar, British sugar accumulated hence the need to stop over production.
  4. g) The rise of men with new ideas e.g. Prof. Adam Smith(challenged the economic

arguments which were the basis of slave trade when he argued convincingly that hired labour is cheaper and more productive than slave labour, Rou sseau spread the idea of personal liberty and equality of all men.

  1. h) Slaves had become less profitable and yet had led to over population in Europe.
  2. i) Influential abolitionists like William Wilberforce ( a British member of parliament ) urged the British government to legislate against the slave trade in her colonies.
  3. j) The ship owners stopped transporting slaves from Africa and began transporting raw materials directly from Africa and America to Europe, which led to a decline in slave trade.

Steps in the abolition of slave trade

The movement to abolish slave trade started in Britain with the formation of Antislavery movement. The British government abolished the slave trade through anti slave laws (Legislation), treaties and use of force. The Anti – slavery movement was led by Granville sharp, other members were Thomas Clarkson, William Wilberforce and others.

~   The first step was taken in 1772 when slavery was declared illegal and abolished in Britain. The humanitarians secured judgment against slavery from the British court.

~   In 1807, British parliament outlawed slave trade for British subjects.

~  1817 British negotiated the “reciprocal search treaties” with Spain and Portugal.

~  Equipment treaties signed with Spain 1835 Portugal 1842 and America 1862.

~  In E. Africa in 1822 Moresby treaty was signed between Captain Moresby and Sultan Seyyid Said it forbade the shipping of slaves outside the sultan’s territories. British ships were authorized to stop and search suspected Arab slave-carrying dhows. ~  In 1845, Hamerton treaty was signed between Colonel Hamerton and Sultan  Seyyid Said. It forbade the shipping of slaves outside the Sultan‘s East African possessions, i.e., beyond Brava to the north.

~   In 1871 the British set up a parliamentary commission of inquiry to investigate and report on slave trade in E. Africa.

~  In 1872 Sir Bartle Frere persuaded Sultan Barghash to stop slave trade but not much was achieved.

On 5th March 1873, the Sultan passed a decree prohibiting the export of slaves from main land and closing of slave market at Zanzibar. Zanzibar slave market was to be closed within 24 hours.

~  1876 the Sultan decreed that no slaves were to be transported overland.

~  1897 decree left slaves to claim their freedom themselves

~  1907, slavery was abolished entirely in Zanzibar and Pemba.

~  In 1927, slavery ended in Tanganyika when Britain took over from Germany after the 2nd world war.

Effects of abolition of slave trade

  1. a) The suppression of slave trade led to loss of independence that is to say, it confirmed among the Arabs and Swahilis that the Sultan had lost independence over the East African coast, and that he was now a British puppet .
  2. b) The suppression of slave trade led to development and growth of legitimate trade which provided equally profitable business to both Europeans and African traders.

Many ship owners diverted   their ships from transporting slaves to transporting raw cotton and raw sugar from Brazil and America.

  1. c) It accelerated the coming of European missionaries to East Af rica who emphasized peace and obedience thus the later European colonization of East Africa.
  2. d) Disintegration of the sultan Empire. This is because it loosened the economic and political control which the sultan had over the East African nations .His empire in E.A. therefore began to crumble .This gave opportunity to other ambitious leaders like Tippu-Tip to create an independent state in Manyema ,where he began selling his ivory and slaves to the Belgians in Zaire.
  3. e) The abolition of slave trade was a catalyst to the partition of East Africa where by Britain took over Kenya, Zanzibar and Uganda and Germany took over Tanganyika.
  4. f) Slave trade markets were also closed for example Zanzibar in 1873 following the frère treaty signed between Sultan Barghash and Bantle Frere.
  5. g) Islam became unpopular as many converted to Christianity.
  6. h) African societies regained their respect and strength as they were no longer sold off as commodities.

Development and organization of long distance trade

Local trade refers to the exchange of goods among members of a community.

Regional trade involves exchange of goods between a community and her neigbouring communities.Long distance trade was the exchange of trade goods between communities over long distance, for example between the east African interior and the east African coast.

The organization of long distance trade

~  The communities that participated in the long distance trade were the Akamba, Swahili, Arabs, Yao, nyamwezi, Mijikenda and Baganda.

~  The trade developed because of the demand for ivory in Europe and the United States of America, slaves for plantation agriculture at the coast and in Mauritius and reunion sugar plantations

~  Ivory and slaves from the interior were exchanged for cloth. Utensils, ironware, zinc and beads at the coast.The system of trade were barter.

~  The middlemen included the Mijikenda and the Akamba who obtained slaves and ivory from the interior. The Akamba adopted the long distance trade after the outbreak of famine in 1836 and due to the central location of their country.

~  The Akamba organized caravans that left for the coast on weekly basis to sell ivory, gum copra, honey, bees wax, rhinoceros horns and skins. They had prosperous traders like chief Kivoi who is remembered for organizing the trade.

~  They set up markets and routes in the interior.

~  The source of slaves and ivory extended as far as Mt. Kenya region, Baringo and the shores of Lake Victoria.

~  The trade led to the development of Mombasa and Lamu as important market points.

~  The Waswahili and Mijikenda traders were also used in the trading caravans to the interior.

~  By 1860s, Arabs and Swahili traders started penetrating to the interior of Kenya as far as Uganda.

~  In Kenya, the main trading centres were taveta, Mbooni hills, elureko in Wanga and Miazini near Ngong and along Lake Baringo.

~  By 1870, the Akamba dominance in the trade declined as a result of competition from the Arab and Waswahili traders who began penetrating into the interior to get goods from the source.

~  Movement between the interior and the coast was carried out in caravans along well defined routes.

~  The trade routes became insecure due to the Oromo and Maasai raids.

~  The abolition of slave trade also affected the long distance trade.

~  In Tanganyika, the Yao, nyamwezi, Arabs and Waswahili were great traders. The Yaoexchanged tobacco, hoes, and animal skins at Kilwa with imported goods like cloth and beads. They were also the principal suppliers of ivory and slaves to Kilwa. The Yao were the most active long distance traders in east Africa.

~  The Arabs and Waswahili traders organized caravans into the interior and set up markets and trade routes. They were given security by Seyyid said who signed treaties with Chief Fundikira of the Nyamwezi to allow the Arab traders to pass through his territory.

~  They established interior Arab settlements at Tabora which became the centre of Arab culture.

~  The nyamwezi organized trading expeditions under their chiefs upto the coast with ivory, copper, slaves, wax hoes, salt and copra. They returned with cloths, beads and mirrors. They established trade routes such as the route from Ujiji via Tabora to Bagamoyo. They travelled to Katanga in DRC for iron, salt and copper. By 1850 nyamwezi merchants such as Msiri , and leaders like Nyungu ya Mawe and Mirambo played a key role in the trade development.

~  When the Arab and Waswahili traders arrived in Buganda, the kabaka welcomed them because he needed their goods such as beads, cloths, guns etc. He also wanted assistance in aiding his neighbours. E.g the invasion of Busoga in 1848 was assisted by the Arab traders. From the raids to Bunyoro, Toro, and ankole and Buvuma and Ukerewe islands, the Baganda acquired cattle, ivory, slaves and grains which the sold to the Arabs.

~  The Khartoumers also practiced long distance trade. They raided the northern part of Uganda for ivory and slaves.

~  Arab and Waswahili traders ventured into the Bunyoro kingdom by 1877 for ivory.

~  There were three main trade routes that linked east African coast and the interior;

  1. a) From Mombasa through the Mijikenda area onto Taita-taveta then branching into two. One leading to Kilimanjaro onto the Lake Victoria region the diversion was to evade the hostile Maasai. . The other branch proceeded northwards from taveta across Galan River into Ukambani then to mt Kenya region and further west. Taveta became an important point on these routes.
  2. b) The route from Kilwa to Yao then branching southwards to Cewa in Zimbabwe.
  3. c) From Bagamoyo to Tabora where it branched northwards to Buganda and another branch to Ujiji then to Zaire.

MAP OF EAST AFRICA SHOWING TRADE ROUTES

Effects of the Long distance trade on the people of East Africa

  1. a) The trade led to Development of towns e.g. Mombasa, Lamu, Kilwa, Pemba and Zanzibar.
  2. b) It increased the volume of local and regional trade as varieties of new goods were introduced.
  3. c) There was the Emergence of a class of wealthy Africans along the coast and the interior as Arab, African and Waswahili merchants acquired a lot of wealth. E.g. Kivoi of Ukambani, Ngonyo of Mijikenda, Tippu tip, Msiri, Nyungu ya mawe of nyamwezi, Mwakikonga of the Digo etc.
  4. d) There was Introduction of foreign goods such as beads, cloth and plates to the peoples of East Africa.
  5. e) The trade led to Introduction of new crops to the coast e.g. bananas, rice sugarcane and mangoes.
  6. f) Arab and Waswahili traders introduced Islam to the East African Coast. They also introduced Islamic culture along the coast.
  7. g) Development of plantation agriculture in Malindi and Mombasa due increased slave trade.
  8. h) It led to the development of trade routes and market centres in the region. Such routes later became important highways during the colonial rule and upto today.
  9. i) Traders gave reports about the coast, its strategic and commercial stability leading to the colonization of East Africa.
  10. j) It led to the development of a money economy that replaced barter trade
  11. k) The trade facilitated the colonization of east Africa as the interior was exposed to the outside world.

Development and organization of international trade

The east African coast also participated in international trade during the 19

Th century with traders from different countries such as USA, Britain and France.

Factors that facilitated the development of international trade

  1. a) The existing earlier trade links between east Africa and the Far East before this period.
  2. b) The existence of regional trade which became a means through which goods such as ivory were acquired from the interior to be used in the international trade.
  3. c) The role played by Seyyid said through encouraging the foreign traders to come to the coast. He even signed treaties with them. He also gave letters of introduction to the Arab caravans leading into the interior.
  4. d) The improvement of the monetary system by Seyyid said facilitated the trade. He introduced the small copper coins from India to supplement the silver currency (Maria Theresa dollars and the Spanish Crown). He also employed the services of the Indian Banyans or Baluchis (Money Lenders) who organized credit facilities for the caravans going into the interior.
  5. e) There was a high demand for goods from the coast and the international community. Trade goods on demand were also readily available. E.g Gold ivory slaves cloths, beads, and guns.
  6. f) The existence of deep natural harbours and the attractive beaches lured many foreigners to the region.
  7. g) The existence of a class of wealthy merchants facilitated the trade.
  8. h) The establishment of specific trade routes and markets such as Zanzibar, Kilwa and Mombasa facilitated the movement and exchange of goods.
  9. i) The sultan’s identification of Britain as the sole trading agents in the interior overcame any rivalries which could have led to competition and decline of regional trade which would have in turn affected the international trade.
  10. j) The development of a sound trading policy by Seyyid said to ensure international market for his grains, coconuts and ivory. He developed trade links with Europe and America by signing treaties with USA in 1833 that opened a consulate in Zanzibar in 1837. He signed a similar treaty with Britain in 1839 that opened a consulate in Zanzibar in 1941. With France in 1844 and Germany in 1871.The arrival of IBEACo with William McKinnon further strengthened international trade links and increased the volume trade.

Consequences of international trade

  1. a) Through the trade, the east African coast was exposed to the outside world.
  2. b) Some of the European traders later spread their faith thus leading o the spread of Christianity in east Africa.
  3. c) The international trade fostered good relations between the east African coast and European nations and USA.
  4. d) The contacts between the coast and European powers later contributed to the colonization o east Africa by Britain and Germany.
  5. e) New trade goods and crops were introduced to the coast.
  6. f) Participants in the trade grew richer and exhibited high standards of living.
  7. g) The slave trade led to sufferings, killings and increased warfare.

CHRISTIAN MISSIONARIES IN EAST AFRICA

Introduction

Christian missions were organized efforts to spread the Christian faith for the purpose of extending religious teaching at home or abroad. Their coming of Christian missionaries to East Africa and Africa in general was based on a number of motives which were humanitarian, economic, political and social in nature. The Portuguese were the first to introduce Christianity to the east African coast in the 15th c.This attempt however had little success. By the 19th century, a number of missionary groups worked in East Africa and these included;

  1. The Church Missionary Society
  2. The Holy Ghost Fathers
  3. The University Missionary Society to Central Africa
  4. The White Fathers
  5. The Methodist Fathers
  6. The Mill Hill Fathers
  7. The London Missionary Society

Reasons for the coming of Christian missionaries in East Africa

  1. a) The missionaries had the ambition to spread Christianity to the people of East Africa. This would be through preaching and teaching the holy gospel so that many would get converted to Christianity.
  2. b) They wanted to fight against slave trade in East Africa. Earlier travelers like John Speke and James Grant, H.M. Stanley, Dr. David Livingstone and others had reported about the evils of slave trade in East Africa.
  3. c) They wanted to check on the spread of Islam in East Africa from the coast with intentions of converting many to Christianity.
  4. d) Some missionaries came because they had been invited by certain African chiefs, For example, Mutesa I of Buganda wrote a letter through H.M Stanley inviting missionaries to Buganda.
  5. e) They came to establish legitimate trade in East Africa. They, for instance wanted to trade in items like glass, cloths, etc. as Dr. Livingstone told Cambridge University students, “I go back to Africa to make an open pass for commerce and Christianity…..” Similarly, his speech in 1857 emphasized the unity between Christianity and Commerce.
  6. f) The missionaries also loved to adventure and explore the interior of East Africa. For example Dr. John Ludwig Kraft of CMS is said to have been the first European to see Mt.

Kenya while Johann Redman was the first to see Mt. Kilimanjaro.

  1. g) They had a mission to clear the way for the colonization of East Africa. The missionaries were tasked by their home governments to preach ideas of love, respect, brotherhood, forgiveness, tolerance and non violence so that when the colonialists come, they would meet less resistance from the East Africans.
  2. h) It’s also argued that missionaries wanted to “civilize” East Africans. They argued that they came to stop some of the barbaric acts and customs e.g. Female Genital Mutilation among the Kikuyu in Kenya, human sacrifices and the practice of killing twins.
  3. i) The information they gave about important places like the source of the Nile, fertile soils, river falls and the climate all attracted the missionaries into East Africa. Early contacts by travelers like Stanley, Speke and Grant, among others encouraged missionaries to come.
  4. j) The expulsion of some of the missionaries from other parts of Africa led them into East Africa. For example Johann Ludwig Kraft and Johann Redman are said to have been expelled from Ethiopia around 1842 before they chose to relocate to East Africa.

Missionary Activities in East Africa

The pioneer missionaries in East Africa were the Church Missionary Society led by the Germans John Krapt and Johann Rebmann who arrived in East Africa around 1844 and 1846 respectively. Krapt arrived and established a mission station at Rabai.

When they realized they were not making any great impact at the coast, the two moved into the interior visiting the Akamba and Taita. The CMS set up stations in Taita and taveta.They were the first Europeans to see Mount Kilimanjaro in 1847. Krapt discovered the source of River Tana and was the first European to see Mount Kenya in 1849.

In 1949, Jacob Erhardt, a Germany explorer joined them and became the first European to draw a crude map of east Africa fro then stories he heard from traders.

In 1862, the united Methodist Church led by Thomas Wakefield arrived from Britain and settled at the coast. They established a station at Rabai. They also set up mission stations at Jomvu and Lamu. They were able to convert some people among the Mijikenda.

In 1863, the University Mission Society to Central Africa moved to Zanzibar where a mission was started from Re-union and later to Bagamoyo. Cardinal Lavigerie’s formation of the White Fathers Mission in Algeria (1863) extended to other parts of Africa. In 1875, Freetown Mission a centre for freed slaves was established. By 1889, about 1400 slaves had settled in Freetown. In 1877, the Church Missionary Society mission arrived in Buganda while the white fathers arrived in 1879. In 1891, the Presbyterian Church of Scotland arrived in Kenya and began their work at Kibwezi in Machakos. In 1898, the Church of Scotland Mission arrived at Kikuyu and set up a mission station at Thogoto. Members of the African Inland Church from the United States of America established their station at Nzaui in Machakos. They then spread to Kijabe, Nandi, Kabarnet and Nyakach in Nyanza. The catholic missionary societies, like the Holy Ghost Fathers and the Consolata Fathers arrived in Zanzibar but later moved to Mombasa in 1890 . They advanced interior and founded stations among the Akamba and among the Agikuyu towards the end of the Century. The Holy Ghost fathers established a station at St Austin’s near Nairobi in 1899 while the Consolata fathers from Italy opened a station in Nyeri in 1907The Mill Hill Fathers reached Kenya from Uganda.In 1902, the Friends Missions arrived at Kaimosi. By 1914 there were many missionary societies working in western Kenya. For example, the Seventh Day Adventists, the Quakers (Friends Mission) and the Church of God Mission. The roles of these missionaries varied enormously depending on the colonial context and their relations with the colonial authorities.

Missionaries in Tanganyika

The missionaries here enjoyed the support of the sultan of Zanzibar, Seyyid Said.

At Zanzibar, the Roman Catholic missionaries began to follow the lead of CMS in taking interest in East Africa. The CMS began a freed slave centre at Freetown in 1875 where the freed slaves were taught Christianity and formal education. The slave villages later became Christian outposts. The CMS finally reached Uganda in 1879 where they were later joined by the White Fathers from Tabora and Ujiji.In 1863, a group of missionaries from the Holy Ghost Fathers arrived from Reunion where they had been working among freed slaves and began their work in Zanzibar. They also began a freed slave settlement at Bagamoyo. By 1885, they had set up five villages that were to act as Christian outposts

Missionary work in Tanganyika was motivated by the reports given by Dr, David Livingstone on the horrors of slave trade.In 1863, the University Mission Society to Central Africa under Bishop Tozer moved to Zanzibar where a mission was started from Re-union and later to Bagamoyo.  Dr.Livingstone of UMCA also worked I Ujiji in 1871 where he met with Henry Morton Stanley, a journalist who had been sent to look for him.

In 1875, the London Missionary Society set up a mission post around Lake Tanganyika.

Missionaries in Uganda

The pioneer missionaries were the members of the CMS based in Tabora, Tanganyika.

The first protestant missionaries were sent from England in 1876 after a letter that was sent by Henry Morton Stanley confirming Kabaka Mutesa I’s invitation. They came in through Tabora and Usukuma and reached Rubaga, mutesa’s capital in 1877 where they set up a church. In 1879, the Roman Catholic Missionaries and White Fathers followed also from Tabora and Kibanga.The Protestants and Catholics were supported by Kabaka Mwanga though he did not want them to work outside the capital and beyond the royal family. This arrangement did not favour Missionary work in Uganda.Soon there ensued rivalry between the Catholics and protestants. The kabaka had also embraced Muslims and African traditionalists to the level of generating the infamous religious and political conflicts that rocked the kingdom eventually leading to its colonization.Missionary work expanded upto lake Nyasa. For example the Scottish Mission of the Livingstone Mission and the church of Scotland Mission set upstatations around lake Nyasa in 1876.

Activities of Christian missionaries in East Africa

The following were the activities carried out by the Christian missionaries in East Africa.

  1. a) Missionaries carried out evangelization. They tried to convert and baptize many people into Christianity from their paganism and Islam.
  2. b) Christian missionaries carried out linguistic research and came up with new developments in language. Dr Kraft for example translated the Bible into Swahili and wrote a Swahili dictionary and grammar hence making it easy for people to understand the Bible more.
  3. c) The Christian missionaries built many churches in East Africa many of which are still in existence. They for example set up a church at Zanzibar, Rubaga and Rabai missionary station near Mombasa. This enhanced evangelization into the local population.
  4. d) They carried out exploration work into the discovery of various East African physical features. For example, Kraft was the first European to see Mt. Kenya in 1849 while Rebmann was the first to European see Kilimanjaro in 1848.
  5. e) Christian missionaries set up stations for free rehabilitation services for example in 1868 the Holy Ghost Fathers set up a home for the free slaves at Zanzibar.
  6. f) Christian missionaries participated in skill development in East Africa. They for example participated in modernizing Agriculture and carpentry by setting up agricultural institutionsand carpentry workshops for training.
  7. g) Christian missionaries were also influential in establishing educational institutions and training efficient class of African clergy (catechists) who were close and more understandable to the local communities. This helped and enhanced the propagation of faith.
  8. h) Christian missionaries were at times involved in political processes that were beyond spiritual jurisdiction. They for example participated in the overthrow of Kabaka Mwanga of Buganda. They also acted as front runners in the colonization process.

Reasons for the success of missionary work in East Africa

  1. a) The missionaries faced no strong opposition from any religion. Islam was only greatly dominant at the coast.
  2. b) The evils of slave trade made East Africans welcome missionaries as liberators. Their campaign against slave trade won them much support from different tribes in East Africa.
  3. c) The support they got from some of the local chiefs and kings led to their success. For instance, the sultan of Zanzibar gave them immense support. Mutesa I of Buganda and Mirambo of Nyamwezi all gave them protection as well as rights to do their work in their territories.
  4. d) The earlier explores helped to map out potential areas of East Africa for smooth missionary work. For instance, H.M Stanley had identified Buganda as a hospitable community for the missionaries and they were later welcomed by the Kabaka of Buganda in 1877.
  5. e) The support missionaries got from their home governments led them to success. This was inform of finance and physical manpower for instance colonial governments   gave protection to the missionaries whenever they were challenged by local chiefs or other threats. For instance Captain Lugard supported the Prot estants in the religious wars in Buganda.
  6. f) Some missionary groups sought for alliances with African chiefs. Such treaties of friendship made their work easy since the chiefs would call on their subjects to take on the missionary teachings.
  7. g) The missionaries’ efforts to translate the bible into several local languages helped them succeed for example Kraft translated the New Testament of the Bible into Swahili and wrote a Swahili dictionary and a Grammar book.
  8. h) The missionaries also received the support of African converts in spreading the Gospel.

Converts could now teach in their mother tongue and therefore overcame the language barrier.

  1. i) The industrial revolution had provided such technology like the printing press which made printing of bibles and other academic work easy.
  2. j) Their efforts in life saving services like medical care (Quinine) won them great admiration among the people of East Africa that few were ready to oppose them. The discovery of quinine also facilitated their work as it cured tropical diseases.
  3. k) The missionaries’ practical skills enabled them to survive even when their supplies from home delayed. They for instance adopted agriculture as soon as they settled anywhere. This ensured steady supply of food.
  4. l) The building of the Kenya Uganda railway greatly encouraged missionary work in the interior. The missionaries could now travel between the coast and the interior.
  5. m) Political stability in East Africa favoured missionary work because missionaries could settle.
  6. n) The emergence of the African independent church movement boosted the spread of

Christianity. African initiatives to Africanize Christianity encouraged its growth in East Africa..

  1. o) The death of Dr. David Livingstone in 1873 and other earlier missionaries increased the determination by many groups to see missionary work succeed in Africa, and East Africa in particular. E.g. the London news paper wrote after his death, “the work for Africa must hence forth begin in earnest where Livingstone left it off.”
  2. p) Establishment of resettlement centers for freed slaves e.g. at Bagamoyo and Frere town

near Mombasa where skills like carpentry, and agriculture were taught. Such communities thus looked at missionary work as “a life- saving mission”

Problems faced by missionaries in East Africa

Christian missionaries in East Africa were faced with various problems which clipped their activities at times. These include:

  1. a) They faced the problem of language barrier. This was because East Africa had a multiplicity of languages hence rendering communication between the missionaries and the local people very difficult.
  2. b) There was a problem of the influence of Islam. Arabs being the first group of people to arrive at the coast and interior had deep rooted Islam into the people thus making it difficult for the people to easily adopt Christianity. For example, by the time Sir Edward

Frere arrived in East Africa (1873) Rebmann had only 6 converts.

  1. c) Existence of tropical diseases was yet another problem faced by the Christian missionaries. Tropical diseases like malaria, small pox, claimed many missionary lives thus making progress in their activities very difficult since they could be left very few in numbers.
  2. d) Another hardship was caused by geographical barriers. These included hilly areas, rivers, lakes and forests. These hindered their free movement to various places thus a threat to their activities.
  3. e) Divisions and quarrels between various missionary groups for example Catholics versus Protestants was a hindrance to their activities. This could create divisions and biases among the believers thus weakening their capacity to convert more converts.
  4. f) Poor transport was a hindrance to the missionary activities in East Africa. This was due to undeveloped roads at the time to help in the movement of missionaries from one place to another.
  5. g) Presence of hostile tribes in East Africa was also a problem that faced Christian missionaries. The Nandi and Maasai who believed that strangers were not supposed to pass via their land could attack and kill many missionaries thereby reducing their numbers compared to the increasing number of converts.
  6. h) The presence of wild animals was also a threat to the missionary activities in East Africa. Man enters in Tsavo National Park consumed and threatened many whites. This clipped their activities at times.
  7. i) The missionaries faced the problem of lack of supplies. They for example lacked enough money, accommodation and drugs. This was because they originated from very far (Europe) thus making it difficult for them to have full time and constant supplies. Such put their lives at risk and could sometimes lead to death.
  8. j) The Christian missionaries faced the problem of stiff contradiction and rivals between European missionaries and traditional Africans. Customs like polygamy, satanic worship, etc were deep rooted into African communities which proved a threat for the missionaries to successfully uproot them.
  9. k) The missionaries made their work difficult by involving in politics and judicial systems which were beyond spiritual jurisdiction. Local leaders could misinterpret them as political rivals and organize their masses for resistance against missionary activities.

 

 

Effects of missionaries in East Africa

(a)  They spread Christianity and baptized many converts. Catechists were also trained who helped in the spread of Christianity for example, in Kenya by 1911 many people had been converted and many cathedrals and churches were built like the Kikuyu churches (Charismatic Arathi or spirit churches.)

(b)  African religious beliefs, culture and traditions were despised and demoralized for example the birth and murder of twins, human sacrifice.

(c)  They established hospitals and clinics which offered modern medicine plus research in tropical diseases like malaria, small pox, yellow fever and sleeping sickness which had claimed many lives. For example, the Mission Hospitals at Rabai, Thogoto, Kaimosi e.t.c.   Dr Albert Cook built Mengo hospital.

(d)  They introduced the European system of management and styles of dress and architecture which have been adopted by many people in East Africa today.

(e)  They put to an end the inter-tribal or inter-village wars and established a stable and peaceful society under one faithful leader (centralization).

(f)  They studied African languages and translated the Bible into various languages. For example Kraft translated the New Testament of the Bible into Swahili, Bishop Edward Steere based inZanzibar learnt and studied Swahili and translated books from English to Swahili, published the New Testament and the entire Bible in 1891.

(g)  They established printing presses like Marianum press and published newspapers.

(h)  They opened up primary and secondary schools as well as training collages for teachers and trade schools for craftsmen e.g. Alliance High School, Kisubi Vocational School. In the technical schools, carpentry and brick laying skills were obtained.

(i)  A new class of elite emerged. Africans educated mainly in English and French emerged, these later served as doctors, lawyers, clerks, teachers, catechists, agriculturalists and priests who played a great role of spreading Christianity. For example, in 1890, Africans

were ordained as priests of the University Mission to Central Africa in Tanganyika.

(j)  They paved way for the improvement of agriculture through establishing experimental farms and plantations where new crops, better methods of farming and equipment   were introduced for example cotton was introduced by Kenneth Boroup in 1903 and Africans were taught how to use a plough and how to grow coffee.

(k)  Missionaries improved communication and transport which in turn led to the opening up of the hinterland of Africa. The building of strong boats and ships gave Europeans courage to travel far from home.

(l)  Missionaries destroyed local industries like craft industry e.g. blacksmiths, pottery work were all destroyed and replaced with European products e.g. manufactured items like cups, saucepans, etc.

(m)  They contributed to the rise of nationalism. This was made possible through education where the African elite emerged and started demanding for independence e.g. Tom Mboya, Obote, Nyerere, and Kenyatta.

(n)  They fought slave trade which was later abolished and equality and liberty for all was encouraged in East Africa.

(o)  Mission stations were developed in towns like Rabai missionary station near Mombasa.

Role of Christian missionaries in the colonization of East Africa

  1. a) Missionaries signed treaties which were later used by colonialists to take over colonies e.g. Tucker, a British Missionary interpreted the 1900 Buganda Agreement to the regents of Kabaka Daudi Chwa II. This led to loss of political, economic and social powers to the British protectorate government. Sir Harry John stone who signed on behalf of the British government confessed that;
  2. b) Missionaries supplied information to the colonialists which they utilized to plan how to effectively impose their colonial rule on how to crash the African resistance. In the religious wars in Buganda, the British fought behind the Protestants.
  3. c) In fact there was a reciprocal relationship between missionaries and the colonialists that is why missionaries laid the ground work before the partitioners offered missionaries protection for the success of their evangelization mission.
  4. d) The Church missionary society managed to raise enough funds for Imperial British East African Company for its staying in Uganda for at least 2 or more years. The church missionary society and Captain Lugard viewed that the company’s withdraw would live theBritish and the protestant party in a dangerous position versus Moslems.
  5. e) Missionaries enhanced the growth of tropical raw materials like coffee, cotton to satisfy the British industrialists urge but disguising everything in Christianity. Bishop K. Boroup for example introduced cotton in Uganda.
  6. f) They appealed to their home governments for protection in case of attack. It is in this light that Britain came to Uganda during the religious wars of 1884-1892 and later occupied Uganda.
  7. g) They created a collaborating class by luring it religiously and materially. This class helped colonialists to fight resistors despite the fact that they were all Africans.
  8. h) In their evangelization role, they brain washed Africans with biblical teachings as “love your neighbor as you love yourself”, “blessed are the humble for the kingdom of God is theirs”, etc. With these preaching’s they made potential resistance important.
  9. i) Religion was a mechanism of divide and rule. The converts and the non-converts hated each other which caused division to the advantage of the Europeans.
  10. j) Collaboration with chattered companies, European Christian missionaries and their converts worked hand in hand with the Imperial British East African Company to defeat Kabalega’s resistance.
  11. k) Missionary stations served as military bases from where the European colonial forces

launched attacks on the resisting Africans. African Lugard used old Kampala hill as a military base against Kabalega.

  1. l) Mission stations served as colonial government headquarters. The established mission infrastructure was used to help in the establishment and sustenance of European colonial rule.
  2. m) Colonialists lacked skilled manpower, so the missionaries by design or accident were very faithful servants of the colonial government i.e. they were Colonial government servants.
  3. n) They created a peaceful atmosphere for the germination of colonialism in areas of hostility. This is because they emphasized the centralized leadership where peace and obedience were expected.
  4. o) Missionaries also trained manpower through introduction of education which was used by colonialists. This was done through teaching those academic subjects and manual skills like use of a plough and how to grow coffee.
  5. p) They acted as interpreters e.g. Tucker in the 1900 Buganda agreement.
  6. q) Through conversion of the Buganda chiefs and pages before Buganda commoners it meant that each party i.e. the Church Missionary Society and France had gained converts. This was a political security of sympathy to the Christian missionaries as against the Kabaka in Buganda’s leadership. This indirectly undermined the Kabaka’s authority and respect i.e. his traditional power base was being eroded.

CITIZENSHIP

What is citizenship?

This refers to the legal right of a person to belong to a particular country. A Kenyan citizen is a person who has the legal right to belong, live and do freely all that has to do with their life in Kenya.

BECOMING A KENYAN CITIZEN

Ways in which Kenyan citizenship can be acquired.

  1. a) By birth.
  2. b) By registration.

Citizenship by birth

The following are the Ways through which citizenship by birth is acquired in Kenya.

  1. a) A person is a citizen by birth if on the day of the person’s birth, whether or not the person is born in Kenya, either the mother or father of the person is a citizen.
  2. b) A child found in Kenya who is, or appears to be, less than eight years of age, and whose nationality and parents are not known, is presumed to be a citizen by birth.
  3. c) A person who is a Kenyan citizen by birth and who has ceased to be a Kenyan citizen because the person acquired citizenship of another country, is entitled on application to regain Kenyan citizenship.

Citizenship by registration

Conditions for qualification to apply for Citizenship by registration are as follows:

  1. a) If a person has been married to a Kenyan citizen for a period of at least seven years.
  2. b) If A person who has been lawfully resident in Kenya for a continuous period of at least seven years applies to be registered.
  3. c) If a child who is not a citizen, is adopted by a citizen and applies to be registered.
  4. d) Citizenship may be granted to individuals who are citizens of other countries that allow Kenyans citizenship in their countries.

Revocation of citizenship

The revocation of citizenship by registration may happen under the following circumstances.

  1. a) If a person acquired citizenship by fraud, false representation or concealment of any material fact.
  2. b) If the person has, during any war in which Kenya was engaged, unlawfully traded or communicated with an enemy or been engaged in or associated with any business that was knowingly carried on in such a manner as to assist an enemy in that war.
  3. c) If the person has, within five years after registration, been convicted of an offence and sentenced to imprisonment for a term of three years or longer.
  4. d) If a person has, at any time after registration, been convicted of treason, or of an offence for which a penalty of at least seven years imprisonment may be imposed.

Citizenship by birth may be revoked under the following circumstance

  1. a) If the citizenship was acquired by fraud, false representation or concealment of any material fact by any person.
  2. b) If the nationality or parentage of the person becomes known, and reveals that the person was a citizen of another country.
  3. c) If the age of the person becomes known, and reveals that the person was older than eight years when found in Kenya.The concept of “Dual citizenship”.

   a citizen by birth does not lose citizenship by acquiring the citizenship of another country.

Rights and responsibilities of a Kenyan citizen

Human rights

Human rights refers to the accepted principles of fairness and justice- or the universal moral rights that belong equally to all people in their capacity as human beings.

Components of human rights

Every human right must fulfill these three fundamental conditions;

  1. a) Condition of life, which is necessary for development of human personality
  2. b) A Social character (since it presupposes existence of other members of the society)
  3. c) It must be enjoyed equally by all members of the society.

The constitution of Kenya contains the rights of the individuals and special groups such as children, the youth and people with disabilities. It gives the state the responsibility of guaranteeing these rights. The rights are contained in chapter 4 of the current constitution under the bill of rights. This chapter is not merely an integral part of the constitution of Kenya; it is the fundamental basis for the establishment of the state.Human rights and fundamental freedoms are recognized and protected in the constitution because they preserve the dignity of individuals and communities, and promote social justice

The rights and freedoms protected in the Bill of Rights

  1. Right to life

Life begins at conception and no child should be deprived of life deliberately. Abortion is not therefore permitted unless occasioned by the need for emergency treatment or life of the mother is in danger.

People who attempt to commit suicide are also punishable on the strength of their right

Limitations of the right to life

 A court of law can sentence one to death if found guilty of an offence punishable by death

Instances when the right to life may be taken away:

 When one is defending one’s life or country as is the case during war.

 When defending one’s property against violent attack.

  When a law enforcement officer’s life is endangered, for example when apprehending armed criminals.

  1. Equality and freedom from discrimination

Every person is equal before the law and has the right to equal protection and equal benefit of the law. This means that both men and women are equal before the law. Any form of discrimination is illegal and is prohibited in the constitution.

  1. Human dignity

Every person’s dignity should be respected and protected. One must not ridicule or embarrass other members of society.

  1. Freedom and security of a person

This right protects a person from being detained without a good reason and without trial. No person will be subjected to physical or psychological torture, corporal punishment or cruel and inhuman treatment. Each citizen must also protect the freedom and security of others. It is unlawful for one to subject his or her spouse to either psychological or physical abuse.

  1. Freedom from slavery, servitude and forced labour

No one should be held in servitude or slavery or perform forced labour. Every employer should treat his or her employees with dignity and not to force them to work.

  1. Right to privacy

Every person has a right NOT to have him or herself, his or her property searched, or his or her possessions seized. Not revealing a person’s family or private affairs unnecessarily or private communications interfered with.

 

 

 

Exceptions to this right:

The law allows police officers, tax inspectors and other government agents to search private homes or business premises for purpose of health inspection, tax collection or any other officially sanctioned reason.

  1. Right to assembly, demonstration, picketing and petition

Every citizen has a right to assemble and participate in peaceful demonstrations and even present petitions to public authorities

Responsibility:

Those demonstrating must not interfere with peace of others for example through harassment of motorists and property destruction.

  1. Political rights

Every citizen is free to make political choices, which includes the right to form, or participate in forming, a political party and to participate in the activities of, a political party.Every citizen has the right to free, fair and regular elections based on universal suffrage and the free` expression of the will of the electors for any elective public body or office. Every adult citizen has the right, without unreasonable restrictions, to be registered as a voter; to vote by secret ballot in any election or referendum and to be a candidate for public office, or office within a political party and, if elected, to hold officer responsibility.It is illegal to prevent other people from participating in elections, buy votes etc.

  1. Freedom of movement and residence

Citizens have a right to free movement and ownership of property in any part of the country.

Responsibility:

Citizens should not obstruct efforts of any citizen to move freely and reside and own property in any part of the country.

  1. Economic and social rights

Every person has the right to the highest attainable standard of health, which includes the right to health care services, including reproductive health care.

Every person has the right to accessible and adequate housing, and to reasonable standards of sanitation.Every person has the right to be free from hunger, and to have adequate food of acceptable quality.Every person has the right to clean and safe water in adequate quantities.Every person has the right to social securityEvery person has the right to education.A person shall not be denied emergency medical treatment.The State must provide appropriate social security to persons who are unable to support themselves and their dependants.Nb-it is on the strength of this right that the government is providing free primary education.

Responsibility

Every citizen must pay tax.

  1. Consumer rights

Consumers have the right to goods and services of reasonable quality.

Consumers have the right to the information necessary for them to gain full benefit from goods and services.Consumers have the right to the protection of their health, safety, and economic interests.Consumers have the right to compensation for loss or injury arising from defects in goods or services.

Responsibility

It is one’s responsibility to question the quality of goods and services being offered, to enable one get value for money.

The traders and other service providers have a responsibility to provide quality goods and services to fellow citizens.

They should give truthful information when advertising their products.

  1. Right to fair labour practices

Every worker has a right to fair labour practices like fair remuneration, reasonable working conditions, the right to join or practice in trade union activities and the right to go on strike .Every employer has a right to join an employers’ association and participate in its programmes and activities

Responsibility

One must respect the right to fair labour practices of one’s employees. Employees on the other hand must conduct themselves responsibly, even during strikes, to avoid causing physical injury to innocent people, or destroying property.

  1. Right to clean and healthy environment

Every person has the right to a clean and healthy environment. It is our duty to ensure that the environment is protected for the benefit of present and future generations.

The following are the obligations set by the government in order to achieve a clean and healthy environment:

  1. a) Ensure sustainable exploitation, utilization, management and conservation of the environment
  2. b) Work to achieve and maintain a tree cover of at least ten percent of the land area of Kenya.
  3. c) Encourage public participation in management, protection and conservation of the environment.
  4. d) Establish systems of environmental impact assessment, environmental audit and monitoring of the environment.
  5. e) Eliminate processes and activities that are likely to endanger the environment.
  6. f) Utilize the environment and natural resources for the benefit of the people of Kenya.
  7. g) Protect and enhance intellectual property and indigenous knowledge of biodiversity and the genetic resources of the communities.

Responsibility

Every person has a responsibility to protect and conserve the environment and ensure ecologically sustainable development, and use of natural resources.

 

 

  1. Freedom of conscience, religion, belief and opinion

Every person, whether individually or as a group, has freedom to manifest any religion or belief through worship, practice, teaching or observance, including observance of day of worship.One cannot be denied employment or educational opportunity because of belonging to a particular religion or because of one’s belief or religion.A person cannot be forced to engage in any act that goes against his or her  belief or religion.

Responsibility

Every citizen must be careful not to infringe upon this freedom

  1. Freedom of expression

This guarantees all Kenyans the freedom to seek, receive or impart ideas or information. It also guarantees freedom of artistic creativity, academic freedom, and freedom to conduct scientific research

Responsibility

In the exercise of this freedom, everyone is called upon to respect the rights and reputation of others. He/she should not spread propaganda with the intention t provoke others to war or to violence.

It is unlawful to engage in hate speech.

  1. Freedom of media

The freedom and independence of the media is guaranteed. The state should not interfere with the media.

Responsibility

The media industry should report impartially and avoid inciting members of the public.

The media should provide fair opportunity for the presentation of divergent views and dissenting opinions

  1. Access to information

Every person has a right to access information held by the state, or by others, which may be required for the protection of any right or fundamental freedom. The state is expected to make public any important information affecting the nation.Every person has a right to the correction or deletion of untrue or misleading information that affects the person.

Responsibility

A person should not misrepresent the information accessed, or misuse it for selfish gain. It is also illegal to sell public information for monetary gain.

  1. Freedom of association

Every person has the right to form, join and participate in the activities of an association of any kind, provided that the association is not engaged in illegal activities, such as stealing or killing.

 

 

  1. Protection of the right to property

Every person is entitled to own property either individually or as a group, in any part of the country. However the property has to be legally acquired.

This right provides all Kenyans a fair opportunity to invest in property and thus, prosper.

Responsibility

All citizens must respect this right. It is unlawful for one to deprive a person of his or her property without good reason.The state, in acquiring privately owned property must ensure adequate compensation granted promptly and in full

The state has an obligation to respect the intellectual property rights of the people of Kenya.

  1. Right to language and cultur

Every person has the right to use a language, and embrace the culture of the person’s choice.Every person has the right to form or join cultural groups. Every person is also protected from being forced to join any such group.Each linguistic group is free to use their language, practice their culture, and form associations and other organs of the civil society.It is unacceptable to force another person to perform, observe or undergo any cultural practice or rite.

Responsibility

This right should not be used to undermine national unity.

Other citizens should be allowed the freedom to enjoy diverse culture, including members of one’s own family.

  1. Right to family

An adult has the right to marry a person of the opposite sex, based on the free consent of the parties. Parties to such a union enjoy equal rights. Both parties have a responsibility to respect the rights of their spouses during marriage and even in the event of its dissolution.It is wrong to deny one’s spouse access to marital property after separation or divorce.The constitution also recognizes marriages conducted under traditional, religious, personal or family law. Marrying of underage persons and forced marriages are outlawed in the constitution.

  1. Fair administrative action

Every person should be subjected to an efficient, lawful, reasonable and procedurally fair administrative action. This promotes efficient administration in public offices

Responsibility

The officers of the state have a responsibility to accord every person fair administrative action.The right requires that a person be given written reasons for any administrative action that will adversely affect a right or freedom of the person.

  1. Access to justice

Everybody should access justice and a reasonable fee will be charged to enhance this, if required. If this is not free, many people will not access justice which will continue to be a preserve of the rich people.

Responsibility

Everybody has a responsibility to facilitate fair play and access to justice for all. Any action aimed at blocking justice is unlawful and invites punishment. For example, shielding criminals or attempting to bribe law enforcement officers to prevent them from arresting a criminal. Aiding a criminal to evade arrest, concealing criminal acts; and lying to help culprits evade punishment.

  1. Right of arrested persons

An arrested person has;

  1. a) The right to be informed promptly in a language that the person understands of the reason for arrest, the right to remain silent and he consequences of not remaining silent.
  2. b) The right to remain silent. – The right of a person to choose to talk or to remain silent.
  3. c) The right to communicate with an advocate and other persons whose assistance is necessary (freedom of speech with all those who will assist him or her in the case.)
  4. d) The right of not being compelled to make any confession or admission that could be used in evidence against the person.
  5. e) The right t be held separately from persons serving a sentence ( should not be held in prisons alongside those already convicted)
  6. f) To be brought to court as soon as reasonably possible, as but not later than twenty four hours after being arrested.
  7. g) To be charged or be informed of the reason for the extension of detention or release, at the first court appearance.
  8. h) To be released on bond or bail, on reasonable conditions, pending a charge or trial, unless there are compelling reasons as to why one cannot be released.
  9. Fair hearing

Every person has the right to have any dispute that can be resolved through a court hearing be resolved in such a manner that will accord him or her fair and public hearing. An accused person has the following rights;

  1. a) To be presumed innocent until proven otherwise.
  2. b) To be informed of the charges.
  3. c) To have adequate time and facilities to prepare a defence.
  4. d) To a public trial before a court.
  5. e) To have the trial begin and be concluded with few delays.
  6. f) To be present when being tried.
  7. g) To be represented by an advocate and be informed of this right immediately. Depending on the circumstances, the accused may be assigned an advocate by the state and at the state’s expense.
  8. h) To remain silent and not testify during the proceedings.
  9. i) To be informed in advance, of the evidence the prosecution intends to present, and to have reasonable access to that evidence.
  10. j) To challenge the evidence.
  11. k) To refuse to give self-incriminating evidence.
  12. l) To have the assistance of an interpreter if the accused person cannot understand the language used in the trial.
  13. m) If convicted, to appeal, or apply for review by a higher court.

Responsibility

  1. The accused person has the responsibility of obeying instructions of the court.
  2. They must behave well in court and outside the court
  3. They should respect the rights of the accusers as well as their advocates.
  4. Accused persons should behave as the law spells out while awaiting the verdict of the court. Whatever the verdict, they should abide by the law.
  5. Rights of persons detained, held in custody or imprisoned.

A person, who is detained, held in custody or imprisoned under the law, retains all rights and fundamental freedoms in the bill of rights. Except those that are impractical and inapplicable under the circumstances.A person who is detained or held in custody is entitled for an order Habeas Corpus- This is a law that states that a person who has been arrested should not be kept in prison longer than a particular period of time unless a judge in a court has decided that it is right. It is the right of the person who is detained, held in custody or imprisoned to be treated in a humane manner.

Responsibility

All citizens have a responsibility to ensure that the rights of those detained, held in custody or imprisoned are respected. For example the judicial staff , prison staff and the police should respect the constitutional rights of all persons without discrimination.

Fundamental rights that might not be limited:

  1. Freedom from torture and cruel, inhuman or degrading treatment or punishment.
  2. Freedom from slavery or servitude.
  3. The right to a fair trial.
  4. The right to an order of habeas corpus

Rights enjoyed by Children in Kenya

  1. a) Every child has the right to a name and nationality from birth
  2. b) Every child has the right to free and compulsory basic education.
  3. c) Every child has the right to basic nutrition, shelter and health care.
  4. d) Every child has the right to be protected from abuse, neglect, harmful cultural practices, all forms of violence, inhuman treatment and punishment, and hazardous or exploitative labour.
  5. e) Every child has the right to parental care and protection, which includes equal

responsibility of the mother and father to provide for the child, whether they are married to each other or not.

  1. f) Every child has the right not to be detained, except as a measure of last resort, and when detained, to be held for the shortest appropriate period of time.
  2. g) Every child has the right to separate from adults and in conditions that take account of the child’s sex and age.
  3. h) Every child has the right to a child’s best interests are of paramount importance in every matter concerning the child.

Rights enjoyed by Persons with disabilities in Kenya

(a)  A person with any disability is entitled to be treated with dignity and respect and to be addressed and referred to in a manner that is not demeaning. A person with any disability is entitled

(b)  A person with any disability is entitled to access educational institutions and facilities for persons with disabilities that are integrated into society to the extent compatible with the interests of the person.

(c)  A person with any disability is entitled to reasonable access to all places, public transport and information.

(d)   A person with any disability is entitled to use Sign language, Braille or other appropriate means of communication.

(e)  A person with any disability is entitled to access materials and devices to overcome constraints arising from the person’s disability.

Rights of the Youth in Kenya

(a)  Right to access relevant education and training.

(b)  Right to have opportunities to associate, be represented and participate in political, social, economic and other spheres of life.

(c)  Right to access employment.

(d)  Youths are protected from harmful cultural practices and exploitation.

Rights of Minorities and marginalized groups in Kenya

  1. a) Minorities and marginalized groups have the right to participate and are represented in governance and other spheres of life.
  2. b) Minorities and marginalized groups have the right to be provided special opportunities in educational and economic fields.
  3. c) Minorities and marginalized groups have the right to be provided special opportunities for access to employment.
  4. d) Minorities and marginalized groups have the right to develop their cultural values, languages and practices.
  5. e) Minorities and marginalized groups have the right to reasonable access to water, health services and infrastructure.

Rights of older members of society in Kenya

  1. a) Right to fully participate in the affairs of society.
  2. b) Right to pursue their personal development.
  3. c) Right to live in dignity and respect and be free from abuse.
  4. d) Right to receive reasonable care and assistance from their family and the State.

Circumstances, which may force the Kenya government to limit the freedoms and rights of an individual.

  1. a) Conviction of murder by a court of law limits the right to life
  2. b) When planning for a criminal activity one loses the freedom of movement/liberty
  3. c) When government develops a place one loses the freedom to own property
  4. d) Freedom of worship is denied if one uses it to undermine the government /create disunity
  5. e) Freedom of assembly can be limited if internal security is threatened
  6. f) Personal liberty can be denied if one has an infectious disease e.g. rift valley fever

Other responsibilities of a citizen

  1. a) Every person has a responsibility to contribute to positive development in the country by working hard and honestly, irrespective of the type of work or profession one is in.
  2. b) Every citizen is expected to participate in the democratic process. One has the moral responsibility to vote and even present him/herself to be voted for provided he/she fulfils all the requirements of the position.
  3. c) A responsible citizen should actively contribute views on matters affecting the community. This includes taking Part in national debates.
  4. d) A responsible citizen must be mindful of other peoples’ welfare. For example guiding visitors, assisting the disabled, the aged, children, as well as the less fortunate members of the society in ways in which they need the assistance.
  5. e) A good citizen should report law breakers, and even those suspected of having intentions to break the law to the relevant authorities.
  6. f) A responsible citizen should ensure proper utilization of public and private facilities including toilets, water points, post offices, public telephone Booths etc.
  7. g) A responsible citizen must maintain high moral and ethical standards. One must refrain from telling lies.

Values of good citizenship

Values and principles of governance in Kenya

  1. a) Patriotism, national unity, sharing and devolution of power, the rule of law, democracy and participation of the people.
  2. b) Human dignity, equity, social justice, inclusiveness, equality, human rights, nondiscrimination and protection of the marginalized.
  3. c) Good governance, integrity, transparency and accountability.
  4. d) Sustainable development.

Values of good citizenship

  1. a) A good citizen has a duty to be patriotic to the country. He/she should be ready to place the interests of the country above one’s own selfish interests. One sh ould volunteer for a national cause, for example engaging in freedom from hunger walk, helping victims of disasters, volunteering to help the country in times of war and using talents such a sports and music achieve personal goals and to promote the country.
  2. b) A good citizen must take part in activities that foster national unity including economic activities such as agriculture and trade which boost the economy.
  3. c) A good citizen participates in democratic process either by volunteering themselves to be elected, or by taking part in electing of leaders at national or county levels.
  4. d) A good citizen maintains and protects human dignity. He/she has an obligation to dissuade people from engaging in acts that deprive others of their human dignity such as mob justice.
  5. e) A good citizen observes equity by respecting the interests of every citizen, regardless of race, ethnicity or age) A good citizen respects social justice. A person who protests against the grabbing of public land and destruction of the environment such as Wangari Maathai demonstrates good citizenship.
  6. g) A good citizen respects inclusiveness in society. He/she does not ignore any member of society in making of decisions on matters affecting all citizens
  7. h) A good citizen respects equality of all citizens
  8. i) A good citizen respects human rights. He/she not only respects his /her right but also the rights of others in society
  9. j) A good citizen is expected to ensure that there is no discrimination against any member or section of the population to ensure the protection of the marginalized in the society.
  10. k) Good citizenship entails support for good governance. He/she has a duty to pay taxes to the government so that it can generate the revenue required to finance activities for the benefit of all.
  11. l) A good citizen has an obligation to maintain a high level of integrity in society. H/she should desist from corrupt practices and even report such acts to relevant authorities.
  12. m) A good citizen has a duty to maintain transparency and accountability. Public servants should be accountable for their actions and maintain high level of transparency.
  13. n) A good citizen supports government by taking part in projects that ensure sustainable development in the country- through participation in environment friendly projects.

Importance of being a good citizen

  1. a) Being a good citizen promotes peace and stability hence development.
  2. b) A good citizen promotes law and order hence enjoyment of rights and freedoms.
  3. c) Good citizenship promotes cordial relationship and social peace.
  4. d) It reduces government expenditure on security organs necessary for maintaining law and order.
  5. e) It promotes the good name of a country hence encourages tourism which is important for our development.
  6. f) It curbs against social vises like corruption, nepotism or tribalism since a good citizen can not indulge in such activities.
  7. g) It promotes good relationship with neighbors.

 

NATIONAL INTEGRATION

What is National Integration?

Integration means unification into a whole. – The act of combining or bring together various parts in a way that makes them one.National integration refers to the process by which various components of a nation are brought together into a whole leading to national unity.

Importance of National Integration

Why is National Integration a priority in Kenya?

(a)  National integration Helps in social and economic development through enhanced national unity.

(b)  It develops a sense of national direction, facilitating unified goals and co-operation.

(c)  It enhances political stability and security by eliminating suspicion.

(d)  Promotes peaceful c-existence of different tribes and races hence leading to peace and harmony.

(e)  Promotes collective responsibility due to easier, more efficient and accurate communication.

(f)  It enables a country to develop a sense of direction as national goals are communicated to the people in the spirit of national integration.

(g)  It leads to achievement of easier, more accurate communication as the nation increases efforts of national integration.

Factors that promote national unity in Kenya

  1. a) The constitution. This is a set of rules agreed upon by a group of people who have chosen to live together. It provides for equality of all Kenyans before the law. It Guarantees equal opportunities to all Kenyans. It Provides protection to individuals against any form of discrimination/bill of rights. It provides for a unitary government
  2. b) The curriculum aims at ensuring that pupils and students focus on issues that unite them. The integrated education system encourages the children to accept one another as Kenyans. Teaching of history in schools encourages unity. Religious studies taught in schools promote respect for the Supreme Being and fellow human beings. Music and drama festivals in schools promote unity among students.
  3. c) One government. Our one government, with the three arms is recognized by each Kenyans a body that runs the affairs of the nation.
  4. d) The presidency. Kenya has one president despite the diversity in parties and tribes. The presidency unites Kenyans.
  5. e) National language. The use of Kiswahili as the official language enables Kenyans to interact freely. Kiswahili became a national language in 1975. It helps overcome communication barriers and gives Kenyans a sense of belonging and identity
  6. f) Economic growth. The government attempts to provide social amenities to Kenyans without bias. It has tried to achieve equitable distribution of economic resources. Urbanization promotes socialization and co-existence among Kenyans.

There also the use of a common currency giving Kenyans a sense of nationhood. The policy of offering equal employment opportunities to all Kenyans has enabled Kenyans to work in various parts of the country where they interact freely.

  1. g) National activities. National holidays remind Kenyans of their history. Agricultural shows enables different economic sectors display and advertize their goods. Games and sports promote unity as they bring together people of different communities for a common cause.
  2. h) Mass media. The mass media in Kenya is instrumental in ensuring that information is disseminated to all at the same time. It enables Kenyans from all pats to contribute to national debates.
  3. i) Symbols of National unity. National anthem promotes a sense of belonging among Kenyans and gives them an identity. Existence of the national flag symbolizes national unity.
  4. j) The government encourages social, economic interaction among Kenyans e.g. through marriages, worship etc.

Factors that undermine national unity in Kenya

  1. a) Tribalism – this is the practice of favouring people who are from one’s own ethnic group in employment, admission to schools and allocation of resources. Others end up being discriminated against thus leading to hatred and enmity.
  2. b) Nepotism –this is the practice of people favouring their relatives. This vice is similar to tribalism
  3. c) The unequal distribution of resources causes animosity between those who are favoured and those who are not.
  4. d) Political wrangles / Ethnic conflicts / clashes discourage co-operation among the citizens.
  5. e) Corruption – asking for and offering of bribes to obtain and give services violates people’s rights to equal treatment. Corruption creates suspicion and hatred among people since those who cannot afford to bribe feel cheated and frustrated.
  6. f) Discrimination on the basis of gender denies people the right to participate equally in national development.
  7. g) This is discrimination on the basis of colour/ race. This creates hatred and suspicious among people. This was a common cause of disunity during the colonial days.
  8. h) Religious conflicts. In Kenya, conflicts between the Muslims and Catholics in 2000 led to destruction of a catholic church in Nairobi. Intolerance of other people’s religions creates disunity.
  9. i) Party membership. Multipartism in Kenya has to some extend become a cause of disunity.

The country regularly becomes polarized on party lines especially when we near general elections. Sometimes members of parties such as TNA, ODM, UDF, URP etc don’t see eye to eye during campaigns. There has also been discrimination on the basis of party membership.

  1. j) When people lack basic needs such as food, education, health, shelter and clothing, anti-social behaviour arise. For example, stealing and violence. Criminal activities create fear and suspicion and therefore discourage national unity.
  2. k) Lack of knowledge creates intolerance of other people’s views and lack of appreciation of the development taking place around. This may create unnecessary division.

Steps have been taken by the Kenyan government to promote national integration since independence.

  1. a) The government has developed national symbols like the flag, anthem, and the court of arms. These symbols have helped to identify us as one nation.
  2. b) Immediately after independence the then only major opposition party, KADU was disbanded to have a single party system. However this did not work for long as

Multipartism was inevitably reintroduced.

  1. c) The government also set up a national curriculum in our educational institutions. This creates a sense of oneness despite the diversity.
  2. d) Declaring Kiswahili a national language. In 1975, Kiswahili was made a national language of communication as a step towards curbing rampant tribalism. This has greatly assisted as Kenyans of different diversity can communicate.
  3. e) Promotion and fostering Harambee spirit. This has led to Collective participation in development programmes by people from different groups which have promoted national unity.
  4. f) During the reign of president Moi the Nyayo philosophy of peace love and unity was introduced. It stressed the concept of being mindful of other people’s welfare. It is closely related to the principal of mutual social responsibility as embodied in African socialism.
  5. g) A new constitution in Kenya was promulgated in august 2010. This constitution promises a lot of hope in terms of unity as it may be an important tool of fighting all vices that have discouraged unity. It also stresses equal rights for all.
  6. h) The government has tried to bridge the gap between the rich and the poor through the creation of an equalization fund under the new constitution. Through this fund, development easily trickles down to reach the disadvantaged.
  7. i) Abolition of racial schools hence enrolling students of different backgrounds in the same schools. /Ethnic balance in public institutions.
  8. j) The teaching of history in schools has helped to create a sense of oneness as Kenyans realize that they share a common history.
  9. k) Promotion of games, sports, drama and cultural activities. National games at school and college level have been a source of interaction. This is a way of developing a common culture in the country
  10. l) The government has made use of media to propagate unity.
  11. m) Abolition of ethnic organizations and groupings.
  12. n) Promotion of national public service i.e. civil servants can serve anywhere in the country..

Conflict resolution

Conflict refers to a situation in which people or groups are involved in serious disagreements, or disputes.Conflict resolution refers to the process of settling a dispute when it occurs

Levels of conflicts found in Kenya

  1. a) Individual versus individual. This is where two people disagree for political, economic or social reasons.
  2. b) Group versus group. This type of conflict involves one group against another also due to political, social and economic reasons.
  3. c) Individual versus state. Such a conflict of an individual against the state may be political especially one feels his/her rights are being violated by the state.
  4. d) State versus state. This is a case where a state is in disagreement with another state maybe over boundary like was the case between Kenya and Uganda during the reign if Idi Amin dada
  5. e) Group versus state. This may be caused by for example a trade union demanding the improvement of the terms and conditions of service of its members. For example the standoff between KNUT and KUPPET on one hand and the government over harmonization of the salaries of teachers with those of civil servants in 2012 leading to a countrywide strike in September 2012.

The factors that cause conflict

(h)  Difference in views arising from background beliefs, social and political standing and values.

(i)  Economic differences. E.g. when consumers feel exploited by businessmen, when employees feel exploited by employers. Etc.

(j)  Political differences based on ideological orientation i.e. capitalism versus socialism.

(k)  Social differences, for example tribal clashes, religious conflicts, racial discrimination, age/sex differences.

(l)  Limited land/economic resources-unfair distribution of land, mineral resources, water resources, etc.

Peaceful methods of conflict resolution

  1. a) Diplomacy/negotiation. This is a dialogue between two warring parties in order to reach an agreement over a dispute. The following steps are followed in negotiation;
  2. Fact finding- negotiation starts with finding out all the facts about the conflict that is to be solved. At this stage, the laws or guidelines to be followed are also looked at.
  3. Discussion. During this stage, a friendly environment is cultivated to enable discussion of workable solutions. This is usually a give and take situation.
  4. Reaching an agreement. The points of agreement reached should be fair to both parties with both feeling they have benefited. Each party should be willing to comprise for negotiation to succeed.
  5. b) Arbitration –this is like an informal court where a neutral person (arbitrator) is chosen to resolve the dispute by listening to both sides and help them reach an acceptable decision.

Arbitration procedure:

  1. Both sides involved in conflict presents their case as they know it to the arbitrator.
  2. After listening to the complainant’s story, the arbitrator makes questions to clarify some aspects of the story. The other group may also seek clarification.
  3. The second group then responds to the story by the first group by a representative. The arbitrator again asks questions for clarification.
  4. On grounds of applicable rules, the arbitrator should consider the facts and then make a decision.
  5. c) Mediation – a person who is not involved in the conflict tries to help the warring parties reach an amicable agreement. The parties involved must be willing to listen and come up with good ideas that can help them solve the disagreement.

Steps followed in mediation:

~  Step 1. The mediator explains the rules as a means of helping the two parties reach an agreement and not imposing a decision on them.

~  Step 2. Giving the two parties involved in the conflict chance to explain in their own words what the problem is. The Complainant explains first and then the defendant.

~  Step 3. The mediator, after listening, summarizes the stories from each party and also identifies the facts.

~  Step 4. The Mediator suggests the solutions and invites the two parties to give their opinions of the solutions proposed.

~  Step 5. Depending on the two parties’ reaction, the solution is looked at afresh and then an acceptable solution identified.

~  Step 6. The acceptable agreement reached is then written down and each party has to be committed to it.

  1. d) This is where one party takes the other to court and the court makes judgments that are bidding on both sides.
  2. e) Legislation – where the parliament passes laws to control conflict.
  3. f) Workshops – this is where conflicting parties talk in the presence of facilitators and tries to work out a resolution to the problem.
  4. g) Arms inspection – the government in order to build confidence and prevent misunderstanding between warring parties carries it out.

Negative methods of conflict resolution

  1. Subjugation (use of war)
  2. Avoiding responsibility and refusing to accept defeat
  3. Appeasement/compromise.

Under what circumstances violent method may be used in resolving conflict?

  1. When law and order is broken and the alternative is the use of force
  2. In case of serious social unrest
  3. Striking students or workers, street mobs and bandits

 

HISTORY FORM TWO NOTES

 

TRADE

Definition of trade

Trade refers to the exchange of goods and services between people or countries.

Man must have started trading soon after the evolution of the homo sapien sapiens.

Trade was occasioned by the existence of varying environmental and climatic conditions. Trade arises from the basic human needs such as satisfying food requirements

Methods of trade

There are two main methods of trade;

  1. Barter trade
  2. Currency trade.
  3. a) Barter trade

This is the exchange of gods for gods. It is one of the earliest forms of trade that was even taking place during the reign of King Solomon of the Bible.Barter trade emerged from the natural needs of the people. For example, among the Kenyan pre-colonial communities such as the Maasai who kept livestock but did not have grains which the neighbouring kikuyu possessed. Barter trade sometimes even took place within the same community where some people had some special talents that others did not possess. E.g ironsmiths.A form of barter trade known as ‘silent trade’ was practiced in some areas where the two involved communities could not speak the same language. For example, it existed between Morocco and Carthage in 400 BC.Barter trade can still be witnessed in the modern society. For example, Kenya exchanges tea and coffee with petroleum, chemicals and machinery from other countries.

Barter trade however has the following disadvantages;

  1. a) It may involve bulky goods in the transaction.
  2. b) There may lack double coincidence. It is difficult always to get the goods one wants.
  3. c) Lack of standards of deferred payment; if a good was borrowed, it would be difficult to decide whether the same value was returned later or not.
  4. d) Some goods cannot be sub-divided into smaller units. If one wanted cloth equal to a half a sheep, then he could not divide the sheep into two parts.
  5. e) Lack of store of value for some goods which cannot be stored for a long time since they are perishable. E.g. milk, vegetables.
  6. f) Lack of measures of value; a specific quantity of goods cannot be measured vis-à-vis other goods.

Advantages of barter system

  1. a) Poor countries without adequate foreign currencies benefit from it by being able to exchange goods they have for what they do not have.
  2. b) It benefits where money is non-existent.
  3. c) It avoids wastage as demand and supply tend to equate.
  4. d) It promotes interaction hence good relationship, peace and stability especially among traditional African societies.
  5. b) Currency trade

This is a type of trade that involves the use of money.

Money is an item that is mutually recognized as a medium of exchange or a measure of value. In the pre-colonial times items like Gold dust, cloth, copper rods, and iron and cowrie shells were used as a form of currency.

Advantages of the use of money in trade

  1. a) Money is a medium of exchange- it is needed to obtain goods or services.
  2. b) Money as a measure of value enables units of goods to be bought. A specific quantity of goods can be measured Visa- Vis other goods.
  3. c) Money is a standard of deferred (future) payments which allows borrowing and lending to take place.
  4. d) It is a store of value- one is able to defer satisfaction of a want to future times or make provision for one’s want at a future date.
  5. e) It is a means through which immovable property can be transferred. For example when one sells a house in one city to go and dwell in another.
  6. f) Money as a unit of account is used as a calculating medium and assigning prices of goods and services.
  7. g) Money is easily divisible into smaller units. For example, if a product is valued at a lower price, the buyer only pays the agreed cost.
  8. h) The qualities of money and its functions overcome the difficulties of barter.

Money however becomes valuable only when those using it have confidence that it will continue to retain its value during the period it is in possession.Technology today has made the use of currency easier. There is the use of Visa Card and Mobile money services like Mpesa and Airtel Money to carry out transactions.Difference between barter trade and trade in which currency is used as a medium of exchange.

  1. a) In barter trade goods are exchanged for goods/in currency trade, there is use of money as a measure of value.
  2. b) In barter trade depends on the existence of a double coincidence of needs but in currency method one meets his needs by the use of money.
  3. c) Items used for barter trade are bulky (some) and inconvenient to handle -and others perishable. Money is not bulky.

Local trade

This refers to the exchange of goods between people within the same geographical area such as a village or town.

Origin of local trade

This form of trade took place between groups of people who produced different goods mainly because of varying ecological conditions. It was motivated by the following factors;

  1. a) Existence of surplus production e.g. where some community’s harvest was excess; they could sell the excess commodity to carter for shortages elsewhere and to avoid wastage.
  2. b) Differences in climate and environmental conditions which affected the type of natural resources available in various places/ not all needs of a particular community can be satisfied by the resources available hence trade. The kikuyu of Nyeri had to go to Mathira for their foodstuff requirements during drought periods.
  3. c) Specialization and improved technology which always creates a need to exchange skills and goods with those who do not have. E.g trade between Mathira kikuyu cultivators and the Mukurwe-ini kikuyu ironmongers and weavers. Some even exchanged skills for money.
  4. d) Population increase making man to begin to supplement his needs by trading with his neighbors.Sometimes, this trade extended even beyond the local community to the neighbouring community. The Abagusii, for example, acquired hides, milk, snake poison, and pottery items from their Luo Neighbours.

Some seasonal markets emerged which enabled traders to meet and exchange goods on particular days of the week.

Factors that facilitated development of local trade

  1. a) Availability of capital for investments in trade – to generate more wealth.
  2. b) Specialization and improved technology, e.g. specialization in production, in technology and in marketing. Sometimes people even exchanged their skills for money.
  3. c) Demand and supply; the growing demand for goods and services was met by increase in supply.
  4. d) Enterprise; many people began to take greater risk and invested more in trade.
  5. e) Peace and stability. This enabled people to interact more and hence the growth and expansion of trade.

Impact of local trade

  1. a) There was development of market places which specialized in certain items like pottery, iron tools and baskets. Others specialized in livestock
  2. b) Local trade helped to strengthen bonds between people in the same locality. It even enhanced intermarriages and other social functions.
  3. c) Local trade satisfied the requirements of the communities in terms of tools, foodstuff s, medicinal herbs etc.
  4. d) Local trade enhanced acquisition of new products that a particular community did not produce.
  5. e) There was an improvement of transport routes. Some markets were strategically located along transport routes.
  6. f) In centralized governments like Buganda, Bunyoro-Kitara, Mali, Ghana and Wanga, the local markets that developed due to the trade became important sources of revenue for the kingdoms. In Bunyoro-Kitara for example, the Omukama had officers whose duty was to collect taxes from the market places.
  7. g) Many people were brought together through trade. In Bunyoro–Kitara, communities like the Alur, Acholi, Langi, Basoga, Baganda, Kumani, Iteso and Banyankole interacted through trade.

NB; the greatest danger to the local traders was that they risked being attacked by hostile communities and wild animals.

Regional trade

This refers to a type of trade between two distinct geographical regions

Characteristics of regional trade

~ It Takes place within a bigger geographical area.

~ It Involves intermediaries or middlemen between producers and the buyers.

~ The trade often covers long distances to and from the market.

~ It involves people who specialize mainly in trade as their means of livelihood.

~ Larger Varieties of goods are involved.

In regional trade there existed established markets but goods did not have to be sold on a particular market days like the case of local trade.

It also involved large volumes of trade as compared to local trade

Examples of regional trade included:

  1. a) The Trans-Saharan trade
  2. b) The long-distance trade.

The trans-Saharan trade

‘Trans’ means across. This was therefore the exchange of goods across the Sahara between the peoples of North Africa (Berbers and Tuaregs) and the people of western Sudan (the darkskinned people who occupy the region south of the Sahara)

The West African kingdoms of Mali, Ghana and Songhai were involved in this trade.Development of the trans-Saharan trade. (8th-16thc AD)

Factors that led to the development of the trans-Saharan trade

  1. a) Demand for West African good such as gold, slaves and kola nuts by the North Africans and for North African goods like horses, cotton cloth and weapons by the west Sudan people.
  2. b) Existence of rich merchants in the region, such as the Berbers and Tuaregs, who provided capital for investment in the trade/ availability of capital.
  3. c) Existence of Local trade in the western Sudan belt and among the barbers and Tuaregs provided a base for the regional trade.
  4. d) Existence of the Tuaregs, who provided security to traders, guided them through the deserts and maintained some water points like the oases where the Berber merchants watered their camels and rested before continuing with their journey to and from western Sudan.
  5. e) Availability of well established trade routes across the desert which made it easy for the traders to travel.
  6. f) Existence of Kings in western Sudan like Mansa Musa of Mali and Askia Muhamed of Songhai who provided protection to traders, ensured peace and political stability.
  7. g) Availability of pack animals like the camel and the horse which enabled easy movement through the desert. The camel could carry heavy loads and travel long distances without water.
  8. h) Existence of oases which became a source of water during the travels, for the camels and the traders.
  9. i) Invasion of North Africa by the Arabs and their eventual settlement led to increase in the volume of trade.
  10. j) There were also vast trade goods like gold, palm oil and ivory. This stimulated the development of trans-Saharan trade.

The trade goods in the trans-Saharan trade

From western Sudan;

  1. a) Gold- this was by far the most important commodity that originated from the wangara region, Bornu, Upper Senegal and upper Niger.
  2. b) Slaves- they were forcefully captured and later used as soldiers and labourers in the Arab world.
  3. c) Kola nuts and feathers. Monopoly of the Hausa traders from Kano region.
  4. d) Hides and skins- from Hausa land for making leather clothing and shoes.
  5. e) Ivory- originated from western belt mainly from cote d’ivore.
  6. f) Gum- from Mauritania and Senegal
  7. g) Dyed cloth and pepper

From the north

  1. a) Salt- from Taghaza, Taodeni, Bilma and Ghadames.
  2. b) Horses- from Tripoli were on demand among the political leaders and their soldiers.
  3. c) Glassware, beads, mirrors, perfumes, spices, dried fruits, needles, firearms, daggers and cowrie shells.

Organization of the trans-Saharan trade

Beginning of Trans-Saharan Trade was due to the fact that North Africa was rich in the salt that West Africa lacked while West Africa was rich in gold. The Trans-Saharan trade led to an exchange of salt for gold.The trade was between people of the western Sudan and Arabs from North Africa.Because of the long distance involved, the traders had to organize themselves very well. Traders travelled in large caravans of camels and traders to enhance their security.The rich traders from North Africa initiated the trade. They provided trade goods, camels and horses to middlemen who coordinated the trade.

The middlemen would contact desert guides known as takshifs who also acted as desert guards.They protected the traders and guarded the oases in the Sahara .The Tuaregs also provided the traders with security and acted as interpreters.The caravans usually departed from the north after the rainy season when sandstorms would subside for smooth travel. The traders made stops at the oases to refresh themselves and let their camels drink water.

They carried gifts for leaders of the communities along the route to appease them and as reciprocation for security while traveling through their kingdoms. Rulers of western Sudan offered service to the traders while they were in the territory.The trade was conducted in barter/ exchanging one good for another/ silent trade. Some of the caravan traders used agents who sold goods on their behalf in the interim period between their departure back to the north until the time they came back to western Sudan. The rulers of western Sudan controlled trade/regulated amount of gold to be sold . The traders paid taxes to the kings of western Sudan.The main items of trade were gold and salt i.e. from the west came gold, ivory, slaves, ostrich feathers, leather, kola nuts and pepper. From the north came salt, horses, weapons, iron implements, clothes, silk and beads. Arabs and Berbers financed the trade.The traders followed fairly defined route. The most important routes were as follows;

  1. a) A route Starting at Sijilmasa (an oasis) in Morocco through Taghaza (a desert town with a lot of salt) and ended at Andaghost in western Sudan.
  2. b) A route starting in Tunis and passing through Ghadames, Ghat, Agades and Gao. Then it passed through Hausaland, Gonja and eventually ended at Yorubaland in modern Nigeria.
  3. c) A route beginning at Sijilmasa and passing through Timbuktu before proceeding to Gao.
  4. d) A route beginning at Tripoli passing through Fezzan and eventually ending at Bornu in the Sudan Belt.

Challenges faced by the trans-Saharan traders

  1. a) There was Communication barrier due to lack of a common language for transactions. This was a challenge during the pioneer years.
  2. b) Traveling long distances for many months, usually up to three months, across the desert was tedious and stressful.
  3. c) Traveling under extreme weather conditions; too hot during the day and too cold at night.
  4. d) Scarcity of water and food during the journeys. The traders suffered serious sickness due to such extreme weather variations.
  5. e) There were constant Attacks by hostile communities who sometimes robbed them of their merchandize.
  6. f) Traders were sometimes attacked by insects like scorpions and wild animals.
  7. g) The traders sometimes suffered from Loss of direction due to the vastness of the desert.
  8. h) Exposure to frequent sandstorms which killed many traders.
  9. i) Sometimes wars between kingdoms disrupted trade.

Impact of the trans-Saharan trade

Positive impact;

  1. a) The trade stimulated the emergence of urban centres along the trade routes. Towns like Taghaza and Timbuktu developed due to the production of trade commodities like salt and gold respectively.
  2. b) Profits from the trade stimulated the growth of strong empires as the kings levied taxes on the caravan traders. Examples of such empires include Mali, Ghana and Songhai.
  3. c) Introduction of horses in the western Sudan belt led to strengthening of the state armies as horses were used by the armies to boost security in the region.
  4. d) A class of wealthy traders emerged in western Sudan. These were mainly the local merchants who interacted with the merchants from North Africa.
  5. e) The trade stimulated the emergence and growth of smithing technology and industry.
  6. f) The trade led to the introduction of iron tools in wider areas of western Sudan. This boosted agricultural production in western Sudan and ensured food security in the area.
  7. g) There was population increase in western Sudan due to increased food production as a result of better farming tools.
  8. h) It also enhanced contacts between North Africa and the Suda n belt. This facilitated the spread of European goods and ideas between the peoples of the two regions.
  9. i) The trade facilitated the spread of Islamic religion in the Sudan belt. For example, the Hausa traders were converted to Islam.
  10. j) There was introduction of the Islamic system of education in the Sudan belt. The

University of Timbuktu for example, teaching mainly Islamic syllabus, was one of the institutions that emerged as a result of the trade.

  1. k) Sharia law was introduced in the states that accepted Islam in western Sudan.
  2. l) The trade led to the introduction of the Arabic architectural designs in West Africa.
  3. m) The Islamic and Arabic culture-language, mode of dressing and eating mannerisms also spread to western Sudan.
  4. n) The mode of transport in the region was remarkably revolutionized by theintroduction of camels and horses making transport efficient.

Negative impacts:

  1. a) The trade increased warfare in the region as communities gained access to firearms and horses. Thousands of people lost their lives.
  2. b) Many people in the western Sudan belt were captured and taken into slavery to meet the demands of the trans-Saharan traders.
  3. c) The demand for ivory also led to the destruction of wildlife in western Sudan.

Decline of the trans-Saharan trade.

The trade reached its climax at around AD 8th c. by 15th c, the trade had declined due to the following reasons;

  1. a) Exhaustion of the salt and gold minefields as well as other like ivory. This discouraged traders from coming to West Africa.
  2. b) Increased political instability in the region due to so many wars of conquest created insecurity to the traders.
  3. c) The desert conditions e.g. harsh weather, dangerous insects, snakes and robbers discouraged many traders from the activity.
  4. d) Invasion of the region by the almorarids and the Tuaregs increased insecurity even more along the trade routes. Hence traders discontinued their involvement.
  5. e) Moroccan invasion of western Sudan in the 16th century undermined the trade.
  6. f) The growth of the trans-Atlantic trade attracted some of the trans-Saharan traders thus reducing the volume of commodities that were sold.
  7. g) Colonization of west and North Africa by Europeans who took over the resources hence African activities were undermined.
  8. h) Invasion of North Africa by the ottoman Turks created insecurity along the caravan routes leading to decline of the trade.
  9. i) Anti-slave trade pressure from the British and eventual abolition of slave trade reduced trade profits.
  10. j) The establishment of commercial ports on the western African coast and the use of navigable rivers by the 16th century AD rendered caravan trade unpopular as it was slow, cumbersome and risky.

International trade

This is a type of trade that involves the exchange of goods between different countries in one continent or beyond the continent.

Examples of international trade include

  1. a) The Indian Ocean trade
  2. b) The trans-Atlantic trade.

The trans-Atlantic trade

The trans-Atlantic trade involved Europe, Africa and the Americas thus earning it the name Triangular trade. It was also called the trans-Atlantic slave trade because it involved crossing the Atlantic and the main commodity was slaves.The trade was fueled by the technological innovations especially in Spain and Portugal which facilitated sea transport.The trade happened at a time when the Europeans were keen on expanding overseas (15th and 16th c AD) for the following reasons;

  1. They were searching for the sea route to India and Far East to get the spices and other commodities. The Turks had blocked the land route.
  2. The Europeans wanted to acquire gold and other precious items that believed to be in

existence in Africa.

  1. The Europeans wanted to revenge against the Muslims who had colonized the Iberian Peninsula between 8th c and 1491 AD.
  2. They were motivated by the desire to spread their civilization to the backward areas of the world.
  3. European countries such as Portugal and Spain also wanted to increase their

geographical knowledge.

Origin of the trans-Atlantic trade

The exact date when the first slave was captured and sold was 1441 AD. Young Portuguese sailor named Ahtam Goncalvez captured a man and a woman on the Western Sahara coast whom he presented to Prince Henry the Navigator, the Portuguese king, thus setting off a chain of reaction in the trade. The Portuguese built a fort on the Arguin Island on the coast of Mauritania in 1445 which was used as a base for buying slaves and Gold. The suppliers of the slaves at the fort were the Moors.The Portuguese ventured into the gold coast in search of gold in 1471. They built a fort at Elmina in 1482.The Portuguese then established trading contacts with the king of Congo who even accepted Christianity and Portuguese culture. (He baptized his son Afonso Bemba Nzinga)

By 1500AD, the Portuguese established sugar plantations in the island of Sao Tome near modern Gambia. They relied on slave labour from Gambia.

Development and organization of trans-Atlantic slaves.

The demand for labor in the western hemisphere stimulated a profitable three-legged trading pattern. European manufactured goods, namely cloth and metal wares, especially firearms, went to Africa where they were exchanged for slaves. The slaves were then shipped to the Caribbean and Americas from 1532 AD, where they were sold for cash or sometimes bartered for sugar or molasses. Then the ships returned to Europe loaded with American products.European ports of Bristol, Liverpool and Glasgow in Britain, Bordeaux and Nantes in France, and Amsterdam in Holland were crucial in this trade.

The forts that developed in West Africa due to this trade were Elmina, Lagos, Whydah, Accra, Badagri, Sekondi, Winneba, Goree and Dakar. In the 16th c, the Portuguese emerged as the main suppliers of slaves to Spanish colonies, having been granted special licenses, asientos, by the Spanish monarchy.African slaves were more preferred by Europeans because;

  1. They were available in large numbers.
  2. They were found to be cheaper to use than European labouerers and American Indians.
  3. They were thought to be immune to both European and tropical diseases.
  4. They appeared stronger and therefore suitable for manual labour.

The Dutch were among the first European nations to compete the Portuguese in slave trade.

For example in 1630, they wrestled the Elmina Fort from the Portuguese and captured Luanda in 1641. They were supplying slaves to new sugar plantations in the British Colony of Barbados and the French Caribbean colonies of Martinique of Guadalupe.

The British and the French used merchant companies to conduct the slave trade having been motivated by the fortunes the Dutch were making. e.g, the Royal African Company was granted charter in 1672 and began taking colonies to the British colony in Jamaica.

The original capture of slaves was almost always violent. As European demand grew, African chieftains organized raiding parties to seize individuals from neighboring societies. Others launched wars specifically for the purpose of capturing slaves

Factors that facilitated the acquisition of slaves

  1. Existence of the institution of slavery in West Africa where the war captives, adulters, witches, the weak, debtors and murderers were enslaved
  2. Availability of firearms to precipitate warfare and capture of the conquered as slaves.
  3. Existence of well defined trade routes easily used by the slave merchants to access the

interior slave markets.

  1. The great demand for slaves in the New World (Latin America) and North America.

Ways of obtaining slaves

  1. a) Selling of domestic slaves in exchange for goods like beads, guns, glass etc
  2. b) Selling of criminals, debtors and social misfits in society by the local chiefs to the Arab slave traders.
  3. c) Prisoners of war could be sold off.
  4. d) Porters were sometimes kidnapped, transported and sold off to the Arab traders.
  5. e) Raiding villages, this would begin at night with gun shots and people would scatter consequently leading to their capture.
  6. f) Through inter tribal wars many Africans become destitutes and these would be captured by the slave traders.
  7. g) Tax offenders were sold off by the African chiefs.
  8. h) They were also captured through ambushes during hunting, travelling and gardening.
  9. i) Slaves would be acquired from the main slave trade market in Zanzibar.
  10. j) Other Africans are also said to have gone voluntarily in anticipation of great wonders and benefits from the new world.Following capture, slaves were force- marched to the coast to holding pens where they were oiled and fed ready for inspection, before being loaded on ships. Prices of slaves depended on sex, age and size.The slaves were bartered for guns, alcohol, gun-powder, cloth and different metals.

Two trading systems were used:

  1. a) Factory system where political authorities allowed Europeans to establish permanent

coastal baracoons or fortresses where slaves were kept in bulk as they awaited

shipment. This method was only used by chartered companies as t was expensive. It was also only viable in Dahomey where slaves were in large numbers.

  1. b) Private trading. Sailing with vessels down the coast, and then stopping at different points to purchase slaves until there was enough cargo.The slaves were branded before loading them into the ships ready for the trans-Atlantic journey which was called the “Middle Passage”. The ships were filthy, hot, and crowded. By 1654, some 8,000-10,000 Africans each year were undergoing the Middle Passage. The moment of sailing is described as the most traumatic. Many Africans revolted during the middle passage in a bid to escape. For some jumping overboard was more preferable than their ‘blood being turned into red wine, bones into gunpowder, skins, into black leather shoes and flesh -the Whiteman’s meat’ as they believed.

Factors which led to the development of the trans-Atlantic slave trade

  1. a) Increased demand for slave labour by European countries led them to West Africa where they were available in large numbers.

Dangers of Middle Passage

Suicide

Disease

The mortality rate averaged between 13 and 33 percent of the slaves and the crew. “If the Atlantic were to dry up it would reveal a scattered pathway of human bones marking the various routes of the Middle Passage.”.

  1. b) Greater preference for African slaves by the slave traders since they were thought to be more strong and resistant to tropical disease and could cope with stress easily.
  2. c) West Africa had well defined interior routes which enabled establishment of earlier strong trade links by the Europeans. There were also vast trade goods like gold, palm oil and ivory.

This stimulated the development of trans-Atlantic trade.

  1. d) African chiefs had developed a taste for European goods like cloths, firearms and glass enabling exchange for slaves, gold ivory and palm oil. There was also existence of the institution of slavery in West African communities.
  2. e) The introduction of firearms facilitated the capture of slaves and hence their increased supply.
  3. f) The exploitation of minerals and establishment of plantations in the Americas pushed demand for slaves to higher levels hence trade with the region expanded.
  4. g) The increased demand for raw materials to feed the growing industries in Europe led to increased demand for slaves in cotton farms in the Americas.
  5. h) The rivalry between the Portuguese and the Spaniards and with the Britons over the control of slave trade pushed the trade to a higher new level.
  6. i) The fact the trade was very lucrative led to its further expansion.
  7. j) Improved technology which meant ability to construct greater capacity ships. Th is enhanced transportation of more slaves from West Africa and thus development of the trade .

 

Impact of trans-Atlantic trade on the people of West Africa

  1. a) It caused immense suffering to many people.
  2. b) It led to forced emigration of about 10 million people to the Americas between 1500 and 1888.
  3. c) Many slaves died between capture and arrival to their destinations.
  4. d) Depopulation occurred in areas where slaves were taken from. This led to underdevelopment since the young and productive people were taken away.
  5. e) African traditional industries were destroyed by the sale of cheap manufactured goods from Europe.
  6. f) There was increased conflict between communities especially where the gun was used. This led to destruction of property during the inter-community wars.
  7. g) Many African communities were weakened and were left unprepared for the scramble and partition of Africa which soon followed.
  8. h) It led to rise and growth of states e.g. Asante, Dahomey.
  9. i) It led to founding of Liberia and Sierra Leone as settlements for slaves who were
  10. j) It led to changes to social roles; women became the heads of their families due to the enslavement of men.
  11. k) Some African cultures spread to the Americas e.g Jazz Music and samba dancing styles of Brazil and even witchcraft.
  12. l) The trade led to the rise of the mullato population. E.g in Senegal, where they are mainly found in Goree and Dakar, as a result of the intermingling between the European traders and the African women.
  13. m) It contributed to the decline of the trans-Saharan trade and the colonization of West Africa.

Economic impacts of slave trade

  1. a) It led to introduction of new (manufactured) goods in West Africa which undermined many indigenous technologies like smithing and medicine.
  2. b) Africa was depleted of her vital manpower that was greatly needed in agriculture and defence. This led to economic retardation.
  3. c) Destruction of African property during the slave raids.
  4. d) Led to the eventual decline of the Trans Atlantic trade at its abolition.
  5. e) Stimulated development of ports in West Africa and in Europe.
  6. f) African leaders accumulated a lot of wealth e.g Dahomey, jaja, Asantehene.
  7. g) It led to development of European economies. A number of large cities grew along the coastal ports. For example Glasgow, Bordeaux Liverpool and Nantes.
  8. h) Growth of industrialization in Europe as the slave labour ensured constant flow of raw materials into the industries.
  9. i) Some of the slave dealers accumulated enormous wealth. For example, the merchants like Barclays Brothers and sailing companies like Lloyds.
  10. j) The trade led to the expansion of plantation farming in USA (cotton and sugar plantations) which relied on slave labour.

Decline of the trans-Atlantic slave trade

In 1807, the British government made a decision to abolish slave trade.

Factors that led to the abolition of slave trade;

  1. a) Rise of humanitarians in Europe such as Christians and scholars condemned it on moral grounds. The missionaries wanted it to be stopped because they wanted good conditions for the spread of Christianity. The formation of the humanitarian movements in Engl and aimed at stopping all kinds of cruelty including slave trade, flogging of soldiers and child labour.
  2. b) Industrialization in Britain was one of the main forces behind the abolition .E.g. Britain industrialists urged its abolition because they wanted Afri cans to be left in Africa so that Africa can be a source of raw materials for their industries, market for European manufactured goods and a place for new investment of surplus capital.
  3. c) Formation of Anti-slavery movement and the abolitionist movement in 1787. Its chairman was Granville Sharp and others like Thomas Clarkson, William Wilberforce who gathered facts and stories about the brutality of slave trade and slavery to arouse public opinion in Britain.
  4. d) The attainment of independence by USA in 1776 left Britain in a dilemma since she had no colonies where she would take the slaves to work.
  5. e) The French revolution of 1789 and the American revolution of 1776 emphasized liberty, equality and fraternity (brotherhood) of all human beings. As a result, people began to question whether anyone had a right to deprive fellow man of his liberty when he had done wrong.
  6. f) The British desire to protect their national interests, British planters wanted slave trade stopped to avoid competition with other European planters .This is because other planters were producing cheaper sugar, British sugar accumulated hence the need to stop over production.
  7. g) The closure of the American slave market after the defeat of the South American states in the American civil war of 1865 left the slave dealers with no market for their slaves.
  8. h) The rise of leading London economists with new ideas e.g. Prof. Adam Smith(challenged the economic arguments which were the basis of slave trade when he argued convincingly that hired labour is cheaper and more productive than slave labour, Rousseau spread the idea of personal liberty and equality of all men.
  9. i) Influential abolitionists like William Wilberforce (a British member of parliament) urged the British government to legislate against the slave trade in her colonies. They in turn influenced public opinion against slave trade.
  10. j) The ship owners stopped transporting slaves from Africa and began transporting raw materials directly from Africa and America to Europe, which led to a decline in slave trade.

TRANSPORT

Definition of Transport

Transport is the movement of people and from one place to another.Transportation is usually classified by the medium in which the movement occurs. For example, land, air and water transport.Transport can be categorized into traditional and modern means.

  1. a) Traditional means of transport.

The means of transport at this category were land and water evolved.

Land transport

People move on land either by walking or by using other human powered transport. People also use domestic animals as a means of transportation

Human transport

Human powered transportation included carrying goods on their backs, heads and shoulders. Africans were used as porters during the slave trade. Human porterage still goes on in the modern society.

Limitation of human porterage

 Human porterage was cumbersome, slow and tiresome.

 Humans Carry limited amount of goods at particular time.

 It is not convenient over long distances.

Animal transport

Early human beings used the domesticated animals to carry loads on their backs or pull carts. Such animals are referred to as pack animals.In 500 AD a paddled collar was devised that rested on the animals’ shoulders. In 200 AD saddles were introduced in Egypt. Horse shoes were introduced in 700 AD

Donkey\Ass

The first animals to be used as pack animals; they were used in Egypt as early as 3400bc to carry weight upto 80kg. They were commonly used in the trade between Nubia and South Sudan. In Ukambani today, donkeys are used to fetch water.

Oxen

Referred to as draught animals used for ploughing and pulling carts and also transportation of goods and people.

Horses

They were first rode but were later trained to pull wagons, chariots and passenger coaches. In the Roman Empire, they carried soldiers during war. (Soldiers on horseback are referred to as cavalry.

Disadvantages of horses

  1. a) It is highly susceptible to diseases.
  2. b) It cannot survive in tsetse fly infected areas.
  3. c) The weight limit of the load it can carry is 120kg
  4. d) They are not suitable in arid and semi-arid areas because they need a lot of water.

NB; – horses are mainly reared by the rich as a symbol of high social status.

Mules.A crossbreed of a horse and a donkey, they are sterile and carry loads upto 110kg.they are mostly used in mountainous areas in central and southern Europe and in Mexico.

Camels

It is referred to as the ship of the desert.

What makes a camel ideal in desert transport?

  1. a) It has a unique ability to survive for long without food and water.
  2. b) They have an incredible water storage capacity, they do not sweat lose much moisture.
  3. c) They have broad padded, two toed feet ideal for walking on desert sand.
  4. d) The nostrils have flaps which keep away sand during sandstorms.
  5. e) Its fur is thick enough to protect it from the sweltering desert heat by day and ext reme cold conditions at night.
  6. f) The hump contains a lot of fat which the camel uses when it goes without eating

Camels were commonly used during the trans-Saharan trade. They are in use in Kenya today among the Galla and Somali carrying weight upto 200kg.

Llamas and alpaca.

Members of the camel family found in central and south America. They carry load upto 40 kg.

Elephants

They are used in Asia to carry people and heavy loads upto 250kg. In India, they were used to transport people and goods during war in 2500BC.

In Africa they were used in warfare in 270BC.

Water Buffalo.

A member of the cattle family and the only type of buffalo that has been domesticated. The cape buffalo of Africa and the Pygmy buffalo of Philippines have not been domesticated. It isused to pull ploughs and do other heavy work in India and south East Asia.

Reindeer

A long-horned deer family breed used in the cold parts of Canada, Sweden and Norway for riding and transportation. It also provides milk, meat, hides and horns.

Dogs

Dog types like Bouriers were used to pull small carts and sledges, especially in the Arctic thus making transportation of gods and people easy. Dogs are also used in guiding blind people in sports and as pets at home.

 

 

Advantages of animal transport

  1. a) Pack animals can be used in largely inaccessible areas. The Llama, for example is used in the mountainous areas with narrow and meandering paths and steep cliffs. The camel is well adapted for deserts.
  2. b) Animals are cheap to maintain. They attract very little maintenance costs, since only feeding costs are incurred.
  3. c) Pack animals are safe as accidents are rare probably because they do not speed..
  4. d) Animals help to maintain the ecological balance since they do not interfere with the environment.
  5. e) Pack animals are capable of sensing danger. For example, horses and dogs can sniff out an enemy from a distance. This enhances security as dangerous confrontations with an enemy can easily be avoided.

Disadvantages of animal transport

  1. a) Animal transport is slow and tedious. The animals need to feed and drink along the way.
  2. b) Pack animals may be attacked by wild animals, disease- causing insects such as tsetse-flies and disease.
  3. Their movement is limited to the day only and cannot travel at night.
  4. They can only carry small loads as compared to vehicles.
  5. Some pack animals such as donkey are stubborn when tired and heavily loaded. The camel is only suited for the desert.
  6. Pack animals use is limited to short distances as they fatigue when they travel for long.

The wheel

The wheel was invented in sumeria at about 3000bc. By 2500BC, they had invented the spoked wheel used on horse drawn chariots. The chariot was used in Mesopotamia at around 2000BC and later spread to Egypt, Persia, Rome, china, Africa and Europe.

The cart or wagon pulled by humans or animals was the first wheeled vehicle. The wheeled wagons and carts created the need for roads

Today many types of wheels are in use. For example, the steering wheel for cars, turbines for jet engines and gyroscopes used in the automobile pilot technology.

Ways in which invention of the wheel impacted on road transport

  1. a) More roads were constructed to use wheel vehicles for transport
  2. b) Road transport became faster and efficient
  3. c) Bigger loads could be carried hence was cost effective – profitable
  4. d) It made the use of motor engine driven vehicles possible
  5. e) It enabled man to move over long distance to disseminated ideas and interact.

Water transport

Water transport has progressed from early rafts and canoes to the modern large passenger and freight ships.

 

Rafts

A raft is a simple floating structure, usually made by tying together floating material like animal skin, papyrus stalks or logs. The earliest people to make rafts were the Australians. They made rafts called catamaran by tying logs together. Long poles were then used to drive the raft.Rafts however sank easily and required a lot of manpower upstream. A canoe was a narrow boat that was propelled by one or more paddles. The oldest canoe was made by stripping the bark from trees (bark canoes). Later a new canoe was made from a hollow on a log (dug-out canoe).In Kenya, canoes are used for transporting people and goods and for fishing in inland lakes and rivers.

Oar-driven boats

Boats are small vessels for travelling on water and are powered by oars, sails or motor. The Egyptians pioneered in the building of boats that used oars (a short wooden pole with a flat end) instead of paddles in 3000BC. The Phoenicians, Greeks and the Romans developed oardriven trading vessels and warships.

Sailing ships.

Humankind learned that the wind could move a boat more easily than human beings if the ship had a piece of cloth fixed on poles (sail). The Egyptians used the sailing ships by 3000BC on the Mediterranean and Red seas. The Greeks made sailing ships known as galleys which were used for trade and war. They used war galley known as triremes to defeat the Persians and Phoenicians.Sailing ships were depending on monsoon winds discovered by Hippalus. The Arabs and Persians relied on the monsoon winds to reach the east African coast.The Portuguese invented a three-masted ship called a caravel as the one used by Christopher Columbus and other explorers to sail to America and the Far East. The Carrack used by Vasco da Gama was five-masted to sail to east Africa. Ferdinand Magellan became the first person to sail around the world using a Sailing ship

Fast sailing ships called clippers were made in 1840s in America. It was a long and narrow ship with sharp bows and almost straight sides.However, sailing ships could not sail on windy days and seasons. Some communities however still use sailing ships upto today for sports, fishing and leisure.By the 12th c AD, the magnetic compass was being used in navigation aid

Factors that led to the development of various forms of transport

  1. a) Technological development during the scientific age which enabled man to invent machines which could be used to manufacture various parts of cars , rails, airplanes, ships and motor boats.
  2. b) Expansion of geographical knowledge encouraged the development of transport so as to enable man to search new places faster and more safely.
  3. c) Introduction of specialization as a means of production which necessitated exchange o goods and services which could only be made possible through development of transport and communication.
  4. d) Population increase hence demands for more food and goods hence the need for essential transport system.
  5. e) In order to satisfy the desires of man there was need to develop a system of transport that would enable man to get the goods and services he needed so much.

Modern means of transport

Road transport

The invention of the wheel stimulated the construction of roads. The Roman soldiers built hard and straight roads all over Europe and North Africa by around 300 BC. The roads were built by digging a trench, 1.5metres deep which then would be packed with heavy stones or rocks. Rough and fine concrete was added to the foundation, then layers of gravel, chalk and cement. The road surface was slightly convex with deep trenches on the sides. Roman roads declined with the fall of the Roman Empire.Attempts to built better roads in Europe in the 18th c were made by George Wade (1673- 1748) built 400km of roads and John Metcalfe (17171-1810) built 290km of roads.However modern road construction is attributed to John McAdam (1756-1836). McAdam laid three layers of small broken stones packed tightly together. He then placed a layer of gravel which was bound together by the weight of a vehicle. These roads were called the flexible road or macadamized road. These roads were straight and had a smooth surface. They were widelyused all over the world. They have curved surfaces and had a Good drainage system. They are cheap and durable.The roads were later improved by adding tar to produce a water proof surface called tarmac. By 1820, Britain had built 200,000km of road.

Advantages of macadamized roads

  1. a) They were durable with three layers of small broken stores
  2. b) They were cheap to construct using stones as the basic material for construction
  3. c) They had a smooth motoring surface since the gravel layer was bound together by the weight of vehicles
  4. d) They were straight hence reduced occurrence of accidents
  5. e) They were easily drained due to their smooth surface and being raised.

The bicycle

In 1790, a Frenchman, de Divrac made the first bicycle which was pushed with the feet thus called a walkalong. A german named Baron Karl Drais invented a walkalong called draisine which had a steering bar connected to the front wheel.In 1860, Ernes Michaux, a French locksmith, invented a bicycle with two wheels and pedals attached to the front wheel.In 1866, Piere Allement a Frenchman, was given the first patent on a bicycle, boneshaker. It had iron wheels fixed to wooden spokes. In 1873, a bicycle named a high-wheeler was introduced in England. The firs bicycle in England was made by Kirk Patrick Macmillan of Scotland.James Starley is referred to as the father of the cycle industry. In 1870, he invented the tension spoked wheel in which the rim and the hub were connected by wire spokes.John Dunlop invented the tyre filled with compressed air in 1888 which replaced the iron tyres and solid rubber tyres.In 1893, a bicycle with a diamond shaped frame with a roller-chain-drive and a compressed air wheel was invented.The bicycle is today used all over the world not only for transport, but also for sporting and leisure activities. The advantage of a bicycle is that it easily used on narrow paths and on a fairly level surface. It is also cheap and convenient.

Motor vehicles

These are self-propelled power-driven land transportation devices used to transport people or goods, especially on land. The device converts fuel into energy to provide the power for the vehicle to move.The first attempt to power drive devices was the suggestion by a Swiss clergyman J.H Genevoisin 1760 that wind springs be used to move wheels on roads.However the making of an engine that could drive a vehicle is attributed to a French engineer, Nicholas Joseph Cugnot (1725- 1804). He built a three wheeled steam-driven vehicle in 1769, though he abandoned his experiment prematurely.

In 1883, a German, Gottlieb Daimler (1834-1900) produced a high speed petrol engine which he fitted on a wooden cycle in 1885. Karl Benz (1844-1929) fitted the same engine on a w tricycle in the same year.In 1886, Daimler made the first petrol driven car with four wheels. Benz built the first four wheeled Benz car in 1893. In the same year, an American, Charles Duryea (1862-1938) built the first gasoline powered automobile. The tyres made by Dunlop were fitted on these cars to make them more comfortable.The first car in the motor industry, Panhard-Hevassor, was made by a French company which had bought the rights to use Daimler’s engine.In 1903 in USA Henry Ford founded the Ford Motor Company in Detroit leading to mass production of cars in the world. For example the model TFord was developed in 1909.Students read more on the motor vehicle inventions.

Impact of road transport

  1. a) Roads have promoted trade within and between countries since goods are transported by road to various markets. This case is true in east Africa.
  2. b) Road transport has stimulated industrial development as raw materials to factories and manufactured goods to the market are easily transported.
  3. c) Development of towns and urban centres along roads has been as a result of improved road transport.
  4. d) Many countries earn a lot of foreign exchange from the sale of motor vehicles. For example Japan, Germany and USA.
  5. e) Employment opportunities are created as many people work in the motor vehicle industry while others are employed to construct and maintain roads.

Advantages of road transport

  1. a) Since it is the commonest mode of transport, it reduces the cost of movement of goods and people as well as promoting social interaction.
  2. b) It is cheaper compared to other forms of transport. Roads are easier to construct and maintain when compared to railway transport.
  3. c) It is faster when compared to water and railway transport unless in the case of electric trains.
  4. d) Roads are flexible and link with other forms of transport such as water, railway and air.

Disadvantages of road transport

  1. a) The high number of accidents on roads leads to loss of lives.
  2. b) Road transport is responsible for pollution which causes environmental degradation.

Key notes for the teacher and students- @Cheloti 2012-2013  20

  1. c) Due to an increased number of vehicles on roads, traffic congestion is a major concern in most urban cities and towns.
  2. d) Roads may sometimes inconvenience the users when they become impassable.
  3. e) The quantity of goods carried is limited as roads cannot carry bulky goods compared to the railway.
  4. f) The use of roads is limited to specific areas. It cannot go beyond land e.g across the sea or lake.
  5. g) Construction of all-weather roads is expensive. Developing countries find themselves constrained by limited resources that are needed to construct all-weather roads.

Rail transport

Railway lines are paths of parallel metal rails that allow a wheeled vehicle to move easily by reducing friction. Initially, they were used in 1800s to guide horse drawn wagons. Later the steam engine replaced horses as the means of transport.The development of modern railway was a gradual process that started in Britain and Germany with the use of wooden rails.A British engineer, Richard Trevithick (1771-1833) designed a steam engine that was small enough to be put on a truck. This he fitted on a railway locomotive which he had bought in 1804 to pull a cargo and passenger train in south Wales.

Fenton, Murray and Wood of Leeds built the John Blenkinsopp locomotive in 1812.

William Hedley built the puffing Billy in 1813.George Stephenson (1781-1845) a coal miner in Newcastle, England invented a locomotive engine called the Blucher which pulled eight laden wagons in 1814. He also built the world’s first public railway between Stockton and Darlington near Durham in 1825. In 1829, Stephenson and his son, Robert, built the most improved engine, the rocket, which had a speed of 48 km per hour. In 1830, he built the Northumbrian and the planet.In 1825, in the United States, Colonel John Stevens built a tiny experimental locomotive. In 1929, a major railway was built by the Delaware and Hudson Canal Company to serve a coal mine.Germany and Belgium had railroads by 1835, Russia by 1837, Spain by 1848 and Sweden by 1856.In 1892, a Germany Rudolf Diesel designed a heavy oil-driven-engine which replaced the steam engine. It was cheaper and efficient.The first diesel railcar was used in 1913 in Sweden. Later diesel engines were replaced with electric engines which was an invention of the Siemens Brothers and John Hopkinson in Britain in 1883. The electric train from Paris to Lyon covers a distance of 212 km in one hour.Railway transport has remained a major mode of passenger travel. In Europe and Japan, major cities are connected by high speed passenger trains such as the French TGV (Train a’ Grange Vitesse) and the Japanese Shinkansen trains travelling at a speed of 300km/h.

Results of railway transport.

  1. a) It has promoted the movement of people thus leading to increased social and cultural interaction. People can migrate easily in Europe thanks to the faster electric trains.
  2. b) It has promoted trade as goods, light, heavy or bulky, are transported efficiently to the markets. It also supplements the use of other forms of transport.

Key notes for the teacher and students- @Cheloti 2012-2013  21

  1. c) It has stimulated industrial development since in dustrial products and raw materials can now be transported faster and in large quantities.
  2. d) Railway transport has stimulated the growth of urban centers. In Kenya for example, urban centres like Nairobi, Kisumu, Mombasa and voi either developed along the railway line or at the terminus.
  3. e) It has facilitated the spread of religious faiths and political This was the case in Kenya during the period of missionary work and colonization. In a way railway transport therefore facilitated European occupation of overseas colonies.
  4. f) There has been a significant improvement in agriculture since agricultural goods are transported more easily and faster using the railway.
  5. g) It has been a source of employment for many people I maintenance, engine driving etc.
  6. h) It has facilitated the exploitation of natural resources like mining, fisheries and forestry. The raw materials from these resources are transported faster using the railway.
  7. i) Railway transport has stimulated economic growth since it is a source of revenue for many governments.

Disadvantages of railway transport

  1. a) It is expensive to construct. The wagons are also expensive to buy and maintain.
  2. b) Railway transport lacks in flexibility. It can only pass through certain landscapes.
  3. c) Smoke emitted from the trains lead to environmental pollution.
  4. d) Railway accidents might be rare but when they happen, they are fatal. This was the case in Kenya in 1998 when 200 people lost their lives.
  5. e) Railway transport is not self sufficient. T has to be supplemented with road transport.

Water transport

Canal vessels

A canal is an artificial river that is used to transport people and goods. It may be built to link a ricer and a lake, sea or a sea with a sea. Apart from transportation, their water may be used in irrigation like in the case of River Nile.Canals have been used for centuries for transportation. The earliest canal was built by the Europeans nearly 4000 years ago to link the river Nile and the Red sea.The longest canal, the Grand Canal in china is bout 1900km long and it links the Yangtze and Yellow Rivers.Canal building in Europe was pioneered by the Romans who built them for transportation, irrigation and drainage. The Dutch, British and the French also constructed elaborate canals.Canal building in the US began in 1817 and ended in 1825 with the construction of the Erie Canal which is 845 km long connecting Hudson River with Lake Erie. It is now known as the New York State Barge. Up to 1840, 4,800 km of canals had been constructed in USA.Another type of canals is the ship canals, for example the Suez Canal, Panama Canal and Kiel Canal, which are deeper. The Suez Canal in Egypt is 195 km long and links the Mediterranean Sea with the red sea. It was constructed between 1859 and 1869 by a French company under. Ferdinand Lesseps. The Kiel Canal links the North Sea and the Baltic Sea. The Panama Canal was built by the USA Government between 1904 and 1914 linking the pacific and Atlantic oceans. It is the most important canal as it shortened the long and dangerous trip around the southern tip of south Africa.  The St. Lawrence Seaway is the longest and most important inland waterway system in North America. It is 3,800 km long and was completed in 1855 in USA and 1895 in Canada.

Steamships

Steamships were made after the invention of the steam driven engine. The first attempt to make a steamship was made by Dr. Denis Papin of France when he fitted a steam engine to a boat and sailed along river Fulda in Hanover. In 1736, Jonathan Holls of Gloucestershire patented a steam tugboat but it was nev er tried.In 1774, Comte J B d’Auxiron of France experimented with a steamboat but also failed like Papin as it broke down.In 1775, C Perier became the first person to move a small boat powered by steam engine o river Seine in Paris.The first successful steamboat was built and tried out in1783 by a Frenchman called Marquis de Jouffrey on River Saone near Lyons in France.

In America, John Fitch built a steamboat in 1787. It was used on river Delaware between Philadelphia and Trenton. In 1809, William Symington and Miller Pat succeeded in constructing a wooden steamship that was used on the Forh-Clyde Canal in southern Scotland.In 1807, in America, Robert Fulton had invented a double  –paddle-wheeled steamboat known as Clermont which began operating on the Hudson River.

In1807, the phoenix became the first steamship that made regular voyage from Philadelphia to New York.In 1819, the savannah became the first ship equipped with a steam engine to cross the Atlantic Ocean.In 1853, the peninsular and oriental Line built the iron-screw steamer, Himalaya, the biggest vessel as at that time.John Elder invented a compound engine with two cylinders which reduced fuel consumption in steamships.

In 1838, Sirius sailed from London to New York, the Great  Western, without using sails crossed the Atlantic in 15 days from Bristol.In 1839, the Archimedes and the Robert F Stockton were built using Smith’s and Ericcson’s patent.The most important ship to cross the Atlantic was the Great Britain built by the Islamabad Kingdom of Brunei in 1843.

The first USA trans-Atlantic steamers were the Herman and Washington.The first merchant ship to be all-welded without any rivets in its hull was the MS Fullagar in 1920.

 

Importance of the discovery and use of the steamship

  1. a) Man could no longer depend on nature –wind for power. This made travel by sea easier and more comfortable.
  2. b) It led to expansion of international trade since transportation became cheap.
  3. c) Bigger volumes and varieties of goods could be carried including those that required special handling like petrol.
  4. d) It formed the basis for colonization as colonizers could move to other continents easily.
  5. e) It increased international migrations and spread of races, cultures, diseases, intermarriages, languages and religion
  6. f) It led to greater expansion of geographical knowledge. It gave access to countries bordered by sea.
  7. g) It led to expansion of world economies, industries, trade and commerce.
  8. h) Spread of plants and animals internationally.

Motor- Driven ships

With the invention of the internal combustion engine, oil replaced coal. The Caspian Steamer Wanal was built in 1903 was the first sizeable ship with an internal combustion engine.In the 20th c, the use of atomic energy (nuclear power) was developed. The first ship to use atomic power was the Nautilus in 1956. In 1961, an American merchant ship, MV Savannah, propelled by nuclear power was launched.There are two types of ships based on the service offered;

  1. a) The Liners operate regular scheduled services on defined trade routes charging advertised rates.
  2. b) The Tramp ships carry any suitable cargo between any two points based on a negotiated contract. They have no regular route or timetable.

Modern passenger Liners

The cruise ship, the most important passenger liner, is a specially designed vessel providing luxurious surroundings and entertainment to passengers. It is about 270 m and carries 2000 passengers. New passenger Liners were developed after World War II for example the American United States of 1952 and the British Queen Elizabeth 2 of 1969.

The liners were overtaken by the development of the aeroplane and airline transport and only a few remain today.

Freight Vessels

These are Special Ocean going ships designed for carrying large amounts of cargo.

Containerships transport large metal containers that have been pre-loaded with cargo. Some container ships carry over 6,800 containers.

Military Vessels

In 1859, the French launched Gloire, the first iron-plated ship. During the American civil war (1861-1865), two iron-plated ships were used.

In world war II, battleships, Aircraft carriers (can carry 85 aircrafts) , cruisers, destroyers, destroyer escorts(frigates), minesweepers, torpedo boats, landing craft and other support vessels were developed.

Hydrofoils and hovercraft

These are specialized water vessels (a hydrofoil has small wing-like surfaces called foils attached to the bottom of its hull that lifts the hull out of water when the hydrofoil accelerates. A hovercraft is lifted entirely off the water surface by a cushion of air and are propelled by giant air propellers or by water jets)

Ferries

These are vessels used to transport people, animals and vehicles over water in places where bridges would be inconvenient or impossible to build.

Motorboats and personal craft

These are small boats that are used for recreational purposes with either out boat motors or in boat motors.

Pipeline transport

This is a form of transport used to move liquids, gases or solid liquid mixtures over long distances. The most common liquid that is transported by pipeline in many countries is water. Others are oil and gas. Pipelines are also used to transport solids suspended in liquids such as coal slurry which consists of powdered coal suspended in water.

Air Transport

This is the fastest form of transport over long distances and continents. Different types of Aircraft exist.

Aeroplane

An airplane is an aircraft heavier than air that uses wings to obtain lift in order to fly thus transporting people, mail and cargo from place to place. They are also use in warfare.

The development of an aeroplane started in 1783 when a successful manned flight was made in France by two brothers, Jacques and Joseph Montgolfier using a hot air balloon.

Sir George Cayley, an English scholar and inventor, built model Gliders that could sail in the air in the 19th c. Later, Pilcher added wheels to the gliders in order for them to be towed into the air. By 1850, power driven planes were built. An English engineer, John String built and designed power-driven planes. In December 1903, An American astronomer, Samuel Langleys almost won the honour of perfecting the power driven airplanes, by making a full size airplane called the aerodrome. The plane unfortunately crashed in Potomac River before being launched. On 17th December 1903, two weeks after Langley’s failure, the Wright brothers, Orville and Wilbur Wright, produced the first manned power driven aeroplane at Kitty Hawk, North Carolina USA. Their machine was a wooden glider fitted with a petrol engine and two propellers. In 1906, a Brazilian-born aviation pioneer made the first officially observed European flight in a powered bi-plane.In 1909, Louis Bleriot of France became the first person to fly a plane across the English Channel in 35.5 minutes.

In 1915, the Germans used the first mono-plane during the First World War.

In 1919, John N. Alcock and Arthur W Brown flew non-stop across the Atlantic from New Foundland to Ireland.Later improvements in the plane were replacement of wood and cloth with aluminum and stainless steel, invention of a retractable gear that improved streamlining in planesBy 1920, plane speed had gone up to 303 km /h. in 1940; it was 755 km/h.The best known aviator in 1920s was Charles Linburgh who accompanied a non-stop flight from New York to Paris in 1927 in his single monoplane called the spirit of Saint Louis in 33 hours.In 1920, the first scheduled passenger service was made between Amsterdam and England by KLM Dutch Airlines.In 1930, the first pressurized plane was launched. The most popular passenger plane at that time was the DC-3 built by Douglas Aircraft Company. It had a capacity of 30 people and moved at a speed of 320 km.

The jet engine

The jet engine was invented by German engineers in 1939.the first jet powered airplane was the german Heinkel HE -178. The first practical jet fighter was the Lockheed P-8 developed in 1944.During the post war period, the jet engines were put to commercial use.. For example, the Boeing 707 flight which was launched in 1958 in USA. The Boeing 747 Jumbo Jet which entered the market in 1970 can carry 375 passengers, 20 tonnes of freight and move at a speed of 900 km/h.The Supersonic Loans Port (SST) is designed to fly at speeds of over 1180 km/h. the Russian TU-144 and the French – British Concorde are both SSTs and entered passenger market in 1972.

Helicopters

It is a type of airplane which obtains its lift from a set of rotor blades rather than fixed wings. The first successful helicopter was made in 1907 when a French helicopter left the ground for a few seconds.Germany made the first practical helicopter in 1936 while the United States Army unveiled its wartime helicopter in 1942.

Uses of helicopters

Lighter- than-air-vehicles

These include balloons relying on hot air and lighter than air gases like helium and hydrogen for lift.Airships that combine lighter than air gas bags with propellers navigation were initially   used for passenger traffic but their usage declined due to several fatal accidents. For example the disaster that befell the German airship, Hindenburg, in New Jersey in 1937.

The rocket engine

Rocket engines use fuel. They carry chemicals which enable them to burn their fuel without air supply. The first rocket engine to be used was by a German manufacturer, Fritz von Opel  in 1930. An American, R H Goddard also developed a modern rocket in Massachusetts in the USA. Factors which encouraged the development of air transport.

  1. a) The effect of the First World War- it increased demand of war planes-jet fighters and fighter planes flying over 600kph were manufactured.
  2. b) The arms race and the cold war which also made many countries to acquire many planes.-fear, jealousy and competition based on ideological differences.
  3. c) Desire for comfort among passengers and the need to transport perishables quickly.
  4. d) Expansion of international trade and desire for more wealth.
  5. e) Colonization and international migrations.
  6. f) The expansion of the tourist industry.
  7. g) Vast improvement in science and technology and growth of industries.

Results of air transport

1)  Air transport is a major global employer. The air transport industry directly generates 5.5 million jobs globally and contributes USD 408 billion to global GDP. It directly contributed USD 1,830 billion to world GDP in 2007 and generated 79 million direct jobs globally – 2.8% of total employment.

2)  Air transport is an important facilitator of international trade, thereby promoting economic growth and development. Forecasts suggest that the global economy will become even more dependent on trade over the next decade. World trade is expected to nearly double, rising at more than twice the rate of global GDP growth, with China, India and emerging markets leading the way.

3)  Air transport stimulates Tourism which makes a major contribution to the global economy.The air transport industry plays a major role in supporting tourism. Over 40% of international tourists now travel by air, up from 35% in 1990. At the same time, the WTTC estimates that foreign visitors account for just fewer than 25% of overall tourism spending around the world. This includes spending by business travelers, as well as those on leisure trips or visiting friends and relatives.

4)  Air transport is a significant tax payer. Unlike other transport modes, the air transport industry directly pays for its own infrastructure costs. The user charges collected by airport operators pay both for the day-to-day services they provide to airlines and their customers, and also for the massive investment in runways, terminals and other infrastructure required for a modern, efficient air transport service. In addition, companies in the air transport industry make significant tax payments to national treasuries.

5)  Air transport expands the range of consumer choices and opportunities to visit other countries and  to experience new cultures.

6)  Air transport delivers humanitarian aid. Air services play an essential role in humanitarian assistance to countries facing natural disasters, famine and war – through cargo deliveries, refugee transfers or the evacuation of people trapped by natural disasters. They are particularly important in situations where access is a problem – for example, ‘air drops’ are among the first response of aid agencies to stem a humanitarian crisis.

7)  Air transport also plays a vital role in the rapid delivery of Medical supplies and organs for transplantation worldwide.

8)  Air transport provides access to remote areas. Air transport provides access to remote areas where other transport modes are limited. Many essential services, such as food deliveries, hospitals, education and post, would not be available for people in such locations without air services. And residents would be isolated from family, friends and business contacts.

9)  Air transport has improved security as soldiers can be flown to troubled areas. Aeroplanes are also used in espionage

10)  Air transport has led to improvement f space exploration. Satellites are used to study objects in space such as stars and planets.

11)  Air transport has promoted international cooperation and understanding. People from different countries can exchange ideas..

12)  It has provides the fastest means of transport for passengers and goods thus increasing cultural and social exchange.

13)  Aeroplanes are used to break hail in order to cause rain.

14)  Plans and other aircraft have added to variety to sporting and entertainment. E.g the staging of fighter plane shows in public holiday celebration.

15)  Aircraft has revolutionized warfare especially during the Second World War when countries began using panes in warfare.

16)  International terrorism has been facilitated in the recent past by aeroplanes. Incidents of planes being hijacked are becoming common in the world today.

17)  Air transport contributes to environmental pollution due to waste discharged by the burning fuel. Jets cause noise pollution.

18)  Air transport has enhanced agriculture as planes are used to spray and dust insecticides on crops in the case of large scale farming. They are also used in quick delivery of perishable farm produce from horticultural farms.

19)  Planes assist in fire fighting, inspecting fence lines and power cables and border patrol.

20)  Aeroplanes are used in making aerial survey in cartography thus improving map making.

21)  Air transport enhances wildlife management and conservation. Counting of animals by wildlife officers is one used planes.

22)  In meteorology, air transport has enhanced weather survey.

23)  Air transport sometimes leads to deaths of many people when fatal accidents occur. For example, the mid-air blow-up of the trans World Airline plane over the Atlantic ocean in July 1996, the 5th may 2007 crashing of a Nairobi –bound KQ 507 moments after leaving Duala international Airport in Cameroon killing 114 passengers.

Space exploration

This is the attempt by scientists to reach the heavenly bodies namely the stars and moon to learn more about them and their importance to man as a whole.

Space age refers to the period in which the exploration of space became possible. It began with the launch of the first artificial satellite in October 1957 by the soviet union – Sputnik.The first human to go to space was a Russian Major Yuri Gagarin using Vostok I in April 1961. Inthe same year an American, John Glenn also went to space.Neil Armstrong, an American Became the first man to land on the moon in July 1969 in his space craft, Apollo II. He was accompanied by Edwin E Aldrin Jr and Michael Collins. Many other have toured the moon since then.Later on a space shuttle was built. The first space shuttle, Columbia, launched in 1981, carried two American astronauts, John W. Young and Robert L Crpens. In 1983, the space shuttle, challenger released a satellite into space. One of the crew members, Sally K Ride became the first woman astronaut to go to space.In 1984, Kathryn D Sullivan became the first American woman to walk in space .By 1988, there were 300 operating satellites in space while 1200 were not functioning.

Challenges facing space exploration

  1. a) Deadly hazards like cosmetics and solar radiation and micro meteorites dangerous to spacecraft.
  2. b) Hostile natural environment which is unsuitable for human life making it very expensive.
  3. c) Extreme temperatures and light intensities. Extreme darkness and brightness.

Such difficulties have been overcome through development of new tools and techniques for space navigation.

Importance of space exploration to man

  1. a) Spacecrafts continue to provide information about conditions in space in particular about the weather.
  2. b) Reports derived from weather satellite can act as warning systems about impending storm.
  3. c) It helps us to gain more knowledge about our planet earth. e.g. a scientific satellite known as Vanguard 1 sent back pictures, which showed that the earth was slightly pear-shaped.
  4. d) Communication satellites like the Telstra and Relay have made it possible to send television programmes and telephone calls over much longer distances.
  5. e) In 1965, the US achieved another momentous feat in space communication. The mariner4 in a deep space probe sent back pictures of mars that were taken as it passed the planet.
  6. f) Some space exploration offers possibilities without limit. Planets themselves may have metals and other resources that men on earth need.
  7. g) Information about outer space may make it possible to make rain and make long-range weather forecast more accurately than before.
  8. h) Some scientists are optimistic that space research might make it possible for human beings to settle on some planets; so far, we are not very definite about this.
  9. i) Humankind can benefit from medicine prepared under ideal conditions on the planet namely dust free and germ free medicine.
  10. j) Space exploration enhances technological development.
  11. k) It facilitates own understanding of the universe.
  12. l) It leads to improved manufacture of aircrafts, telescope and related machines.
  13. m) Contributed to development of advanced air force weapons.

Advances in transportation

Africa’s first high speed train system, the Gautrain, was officially lanced in Johannesburg on 8th June 2010 to connect the cities of Johannesburg and Pretoria with a 160 km/h rail service.

Effects of modern forms of transport

  1. a) It has made local and international trade more efficient. Trade in perishable goods such as flowers and vegetables have been expanded thanks to air transport.
  2. b) Population migration and settlement all over the world has been encouraged using the means of transport.
  3. c) It has facilitated the quick transfer of technology and ideas as people interact
  4. d) It has made industries more efficient. Raw materials, industrial workers, and manufacturedgoods are transported to their destinations cheaply and quickly.
  5. e) It has promoted tourist industry which is a major foreign exchange earner in many countries. Accessibility to tourist attraction sites has greatly improved.
  6. f) It has generated employment opportunities to many as road constructers, drivers, pilots and mechanics.
  7. g) It contributes additional revenue to the government. Countries charge toll fee, license fee and fuel levy.
  8. h) Air transport enhances space exploration.
  9. i) Has contributed to the growth of the service sector like banking and insurance.
  10. j) Transport has promoted humanitarian assistance particularly in disaster situations, e.g distribution of relief food, medical services and evacuations during catastrophes and wars.
  11. k) It has led to growth of schools and hospitals and social amenities. In Kenya most schools and hospitals are located along transport routes.
  12. l) It has led to agricultural development. Farmers have been able to increase food production since they can transport farm produce and inputs more efficiently and effectively.
  13. m) It has stimulated the growth of urban centres. Towns such as London, Nairobi and Harare started off due to their location along transport roués. The towns have also grown due to their transport function.
  14. n) Transport has enhanced political control in countries. National security has been enhanced due to accessibility of many areas of a nation.
  15. o) Transport facilitated colonization of Africa and Asian countries. Railway systems helped them to conquer and suppress local resistances to facilitate easy administration.

Negative effects of transport.

  1. a) Transport systems are responsible for many accidents in world leading to loss of lives. The Mtongwe ferry accident in Kenya claimed 257 lives in 1994; a plane crash in Ngong in 2012 killed the minister for internal security professor George Saitoti and six others.
  2. b) Transport is responsible for environmental pollution. Different forms of transport emit poisonous gases to the atmosphere. Oil –tankers cause oil spills in the sea s leading to marine pollution.
  3. c) Unless they complement each other, different forms of transport are unreliable. For example, water and railway transport have to be complemented by road transport.
  4. d) The growth of international terrorism has been attributed to transport network.

Communication

Definition

This is a Two-way process of reaching mutual understanding, in which participants not only exchange information but also create and share ideas and messages.Communication includes writing, talking and Non-verbal communication (facial expressions, body posture, or gestures.

Traditional forms of communication.

The methods of communication that were used in the traditional society included;

Gestures

These are signals or body movements intended to pass a message. The person to whom the gesture is directed must know the meaning of the gesture. It is sometimes referred to as sign language.(a combination of gestures that simulate actions or a sound)

Body language

Sometimes gestures are used to enhance and emphasize speech. They are used where silence is required yet communication is vital like in operating theatres, and in traffic control.

Verbal communication-language

This is the commonest form of communication among human beings involving the use of sound (spoken language) in combination with some gestures or alone, to express messages.There are over 6000 distinct languages world today.

Signals

The use plants on the roadsides, the shaving of hair, physical marks on one’s body or property are means through which communication is passed to others.

Fire and smoke signals

Fire and smoke signals were used to send quick and urgent messages. Fire and smoke signals were coded such that strangers could not interpret the message correctly. They were commonly used in warning people of an impending danger.The Jews used fire signals (torch light) to proclaim their feast days on mount Olives.Fire and smoke signals were always sent at night.

Advantages of using fire and smoke signals

  1. a) Fire and smoke signals Conveyed messages faster than a messenger.
  2. b) Confidentiality of messages was upheld since the messages were coded and could not be interpreted by strangers.
  3. c) It was a cheap method of passing a message.

Disadvantages of fire and smoke signals 

  1. a) Messages could not be sent over long distances.
  2. b) Ranges of messages passed were limited.
  3. c) It was restricted by weather conditions/smoke is useless in cloudy and misty days. It is difficult to set fire in wet conditions. Smoke could be blown by wind.
  4. d) It was of little use if no one was on the look out to see and interpret.

Drumbeats

In drumbeating as a means of communication, each beat was coded for relaying different messages. For example there were different beats for ceremonies, announcing funerals, meetings, declaration of war, arrival of strangers and impending attack.Once the initial beat was heard, the other drummers could pick up the beat in different areas thus spreading the message very quickly.

Advantages of drumbeating

  1. a) Drumbeats could relay a wide range of messages-different beats could convey different messages. E.g. death, danger, festivities.
  2. b) In most cases drum beating could be used at any time both day and night whereas smoke signals could only be used during the day.
  3. c) Drum beats relayed specific messages whereas smoke relayed general messages.
  4. d) Drum beats could be used all seasons whereas smoke signals could not be used during certain seasons e.g. when it is raining.“
  5. e) Drumbeats could convey messages over wide areas.
  6. f) Messages by drumbeat were conveyed faster compared to smoke signals.

The major disadvantage of drumbeats was that at times it was difficult to differentiate the beats and therefore, the message could not be clearly interpreted thus leading to confusion.

Horn blowing

They were used to make public announcements, summon warriors or invite people to an important meeting. This was done by specialists with different tones that passed different messages thus passing a wide range of massages.

Screams and cries

Screaming was effective mostly on hill or mountain tops because of echoing. There were different ways of screaming in different situations.. Ululations signified feasting or good news like child birth.

 

Running messengers

Sometimes there was use of trust worthy runners for very personal and urgent messages.

However the accuracy of the message delivered depended on the memory of the messenger. An Athenian soldier, Phidippides, is remembered in history as a great messenger for covering great distance from Marathon to Athens. Unfortunately, he dropped dead shortly after arrival. The Marathon race is named in his honour.

Messengers are still used to deliver messages today although there has been tremendous improvement after invention of writing.

Disadvantages of using messengers

  1. a) Messages could not reach recipients on time since the messengers walked on foot to their destinations.
  2. b) Messengers sometimes forgot the message they were to deliver thus leading to inaccurate messages being passed.
  3. c) Information could be distorted in the process. Sometimes wrong messages were delivered.
  4. d) Messengers could be attacked on the way by wild animals.
  5. e) The distance to be covered by messengers was limited since they walked on foot. However this problem was overcome with improvements in forms of transport.

Written messages

The oldest record of writing date back to about 5000years. Different communities use different symbols and alphabets to write messages. The messages were recorded on scrolls, stone tablets parchment (dried animal skin) or paper.The earliest forms of wring were pictographic and ideographic. Examples of these were the cuneiform of Sumerians and Hieroglyphics of the Egyptians.

Cuneiform Writing

“Wedge-Shaped” Writing

Scrolls

Scrolls are rolls of paper which were rolled around rods of wood or ivory for writing on. They were commonly used among the Egyptians, Romans, Asians, Jews, Greek, Hebrews, Chinese and Japanese. Papyrus Reeds along the Nile were used for making writing material. Pens and brushes were also made from the reeds and the hard part of a feather.The Hebrews used scrolls for their sacred writings.

Stone Tablets.

The Sumerians wrote on clay tablets. Writing was done on wet clay which, after drying, hardened like a stone and left a permanent impression.. for example, Hammurabi the law giver wrote his laws on stone pillars for all to read and obey. The Ten Commandments were also written on stone tablets.On the left is a stela, which has all 282 of Hammurabi’s laws engraved on it. This stela is located in the Louvre Museum in Paris, France.

These tablets have been discovered by archaeologists and looked at by historians.

Advantages of written messages

  1. a) They provided reliable information that was not easily forgotten.
  2. b) Information was stored in that form for future reference.
  3. c) Information could be interpreted into different languages so that it could be accessible to many.
  4. d) The message in most cases was accurate.

Limitations

  1. a) They were only limited to literate people.
  2. b) At times the information could be biased depending on the writers’ orientation.
  3. c) Written messages were open to misinterpretation.

Modern means of communication

Numerous modes of communication have been evolved over time since the time primitive speech was the main means of communication. The modern means of communication include telephone, radio, television, video, cinema, telegraph, telex, electronic mail. Pager etc.The methods are categorized into telecommunications and print media.

Telecommunications

This is a term that describes the technology of receiving and sending messages by telephone, radio, television, telegraph, telex, facsimile or e-mail. The message can be verbal, written or pictorial.There are a wide range of devices in telecommunication through which messages can be sent in a variety of ways. For example, Telephone.

This a communication device which is used to relay sound waves by converting them into electrical signals and then reconverting them into sound waves. Telephones carry sound over a distance using electric current. The history of the invention of telephones starts with the success of a Scottish-born American inventor, teaching speech to deaf children in Boston Massachusetts, Alexander Graham Bell, who built an experimental telegraph which broke down after one day. Bell constructed a transmitter and a receiver for which he received a patent on March 7, 1876. Assisted by Thomas Watson, he discovered that voice can be sent using wires.Later, Almon Brown Strowger of Kansas City, Missouri, invented the first automatic telephone exchange using electromagnetic switchboard (Strowger Switches) in 1897. By 1900, long distance service was possible through the use of repeaters (electromagnetic devices placed along the route of the call) which amplified and repeated conversations into the long distance instrument.

Radio transmission later replaced underground and submarine cables for long distance transmission.In 1877, Graham Bell opened the Bell Telephone Company. In 1900, it was sold t o the American Telephone and Telegraph Company (AT&T) In Kenya, telephone communication was introduced in 1908 and has grown tremendously

Cell phones

A cellular telephony is a type of wireless communication which uses many base stations to divide a service area into multiple cells.The concept of cellular phones began in 1947 when researchers looked at the crude mobile car phones and realized that by using small cells with frequency reuse, they could increase the traffic capacity of mobile phones

Dr Martin Cooper, a former general manager of the systems division at Motorola is considered the inventor of the first modern portable handset. Which he used for the first time in April 1973.The development of mobile telephony technology was slow in the earlier periods due to the hindrance by the strict federal regulations in USA and Europe. In 1921, the USA mobile Radio began to operate.In June 1946, the first American Commercial mobile radio telephone service was introduced in Saint Louis, Missouri.By 1950s, the first telephone equipped cars took to the roads in Stockholm.In 1964, the Bell system introduced the mobile telephone service. By 1982, commercial cellular phones were being used in the USA and Tokyo in Japan. By 1987, USA had over 1million cellular telephone subscribers.Currently, there are many mobile manufacturing companies are now in operation. For example, Nokia, Motorola Inc., Sony, Alcatel, Samsung, Sagem, Siemens, AG, and Sony Ericsson.There are also a number of mobile phone service providers. In Kenya, the main ones are Safaricom, Airtel, Orange and Yu

Standard Features of cellphones

  1. a) They are used for making and receiving calls.
  2. b) All have a personal phone book.
  3. c) They all have the ability to send and receive SMS.
  4. d) They have the ability to store messages and display and record the telephone number of a caller.

The following features are not standard and vary from phone to phone.

  1. a) Calculator, clock and calendar.
  2. b) Access to the internet
  3. c) Digital camera capability
  4. d) A variety of ringtones

Limitations of cell phones

  1. a) They may be prone to poor reception especially where they are reliant on internal antennas.
  2. b) Their use is dependent on the availability of electricity. The phone must be recharged after a number of days. In areas where accessibility to electricity is a problem, mobile phones may not be so much in use.
  3. c) The continuous use of mobile phones has raised fears of possible side effects of radioactive rays on human beings.
  4. d) Handsets are easily stolen due to their small size.

Television

The a public broadcasting medium that uses a point to multipoint technology to broadcast to any use within the range of the transmitter. In 1855, the idea of a television was perceived but only came into use in 1922 when a Scot, Loggie Baird, showed how moving images could be transmitted by electromagnetic waves.In 1931, the cathode ray tube (CRT) was invented in USA. The CRT transforms beams of electrons into visible images on the screen. This led to development of modern television.The first television broadcasting service was launched in 1936 by BBC.I 1942, Baird invented the colour transmission.In Kenya, broadcast television began after a television station was opened in 1970. This was the Voice of Kenya. Kenya was connected to worldwide television via Longonont Satellite Station in1972. In 1990, KTN, the second channel was introduced in Kenya

Cable Television

Cable television, a commercial service that links televisions to a source of many different types of video programming using Coaxial cables, was introduced in Kenya in 1994. The television users with personal satellite dishes can access satellite programming directly without a cable installation.Recently, the digital television (DTV) was invented. This is the transmission of audio and video of digital signals, in contrast to analog signals

Television is an important means of communication since it is an audio-visual device.

Its importance can be summarized as follows;

  1. a) It conveys news and information from all over the world more vividly than other means of communication such as radio.
  2. b) It is a source of entertainment as it shows music and drama programmes.
  3. c) It is a device that may be used in educational broadcasting. Some educational programmes are broadcast on television. For example, programmes that sensitize people on HIV and AIDS pandemic.
  4. d) It is used in commercial advertisement by manufacturers and companies thus enabling them to sell their products.
  5. e) It is the best means of transmitting ideas since it commands attention.
  6. f) It is a source of employment in the television stations.
  7. g) Television has enabled humankind to bridge the gap of real-time communication between different time zones in the world.

Disadvantages.

  1. a) TV can only be viewed where there is electricity. It is expensive to install solar panels in areas where there is no electricity. The car batteries that may be used require constant charging.
  2. b) Pornographic programmes have eroded cultural values, especially among the youth. Such programmes originate in the west and the youth want to imitate what they see.
  3. c) Watching violent programmes has created the culture of violence among the youth. For example, watching of wrestling and violent movies.
  4. d) Some advertisements encourage deviant behavior. For example, advertisements of alcohol and cigarettes.
  5. e) Watching television can sometimes become addictive in some homes thus limiting the time to participate in other activities.

 

Radio.

The invention of the radio was a significant development in the electronics industry. In 1864, an English mathematical physicist, clerk Maxwell (1831-1879) suggested that there was the existence of waves.In 1888, a German, Heinrich Rudolph Hertz, (1857-94) demonstrated the existence of electromagnetic waves (vibrations) that travel through space, which were named after him. These waves could be used in wireless communications. In 1901, an Italian, Guglielmo Marconi (1874-1937) invented the radio and sent a radio transmission across the Atlantic from poldhu in Cornwall to Saint John, Newfoundland, Canada.The radio gained prominence during the World War I as it was used to communicate.The Marconi Company made the first radio broadcast in Britain in 1920.The British Broadcasting Company (BBC) was set up in London in 1922.Kenya’s Radio Broadcasts before independence depended on the BBC. The VOK began to air programmes after independence. In 1990, VOK changed its name o KBC. In 1995, the FM meter Band was launched thus leading to an increase in radio stations

Importance of radio

  1. a) Radio is easy to access since people can afford to buy the device.
  2. b) News and information from the radio is quickly received throughout the country
  3. c) It can also be accessed by the illiterate people who can listen and understand the radio news if broadcast in the language they can understand.
  4. d) Radio is used to enhance communication in transport systems like motor vehicles, railway, ships and airplanes.
  5. e) Radios are sometimes used to broadcast educational programmes and important government communications on issues like health, agriculture and family planning.
  6. f) The radio is a source of entertainment. E.g through Music and drama programmes.
  7. g) Radio can be used by manufacturers and companies to advertise their products thus stimulating business.
  8. h) Radio communication has enhanced space exploration. Radio signals are used to communicate with space vehicles.

Telegraph

This is a device or process by which messages are passed over a distance, especially using radio signals or coded electrical signals.Telegraph messages are sent by a code in which numbers, letters and punctuation marks are represented by a combination of dashes and dots.The earliest code to be used was the Morse code which evolved into the international Morsecode.A message sent by a telegraph was called a telegram.

Radio invention made it possible for wireless telegraphy.Samuel Morse (1791-1892) is credited for the invention of the electric telegraph. In 1837, Morse made the first crude telegraph and by 1844, he successfully sent a telegraph over line.By 1845, the first public telegraph was operating between Washington and Baltimore.In 1851, the first telegraph cable was laid under the English Channel between London and Paris.In 1866, the Trans-Atlantic cable was established.In 1872, most cities in the world were linked by telegraph.

Disadvantage.

~  Communication through the telegraph could be rendered unreliable where

accidents and poor weather could cut telegraph cables.

Internet.

This is a computer-based global communication network system that links thousands of computers using telephone lines. Currently Mobile phones are also used in internet communication.Internet forms one of the inexpensive and fastest communication means in the world today which has gained popularity..Internet was introduced in the 1970s. Currently there are over 4000 million users of internet in the world today with its popularity being manifested in the social media networks like facebook, Twitter.

Results of internet.

  1. a) Education has been developed since research can be done on the internet.
  2. b) E-commerce can be done on the internet hence enhancing the sale of goods and services.
  3. c) The running of government operations can be done on the internet since the government may use it for internal communication, distribution of information and automated tax processing.
  4. d) Internet has led to expansion of Business as people use it to interact with other business people.
  5. e) Individuals use the internet to communicate through e-mail or other social network platforms such as facebook, Twitter, Skype, etc.Electronic Mail. (E-mail)This kind of communication is also reliant on internet. The communication is done using either computer or mobile phones with the help of a modem.

E-mails first came into widespread use in 1990s and has today become a major contributor to business development. It has taken the lead ahead of telephone, fax, radio and television in communication.

Facsimile transreceiver (fax)

This is a method of transmitting text over telephone network. A written, printed or pictorial document is scanned then sent and reproduced photographically at the destination. The message /picture is transmitted within 30 seconds. The Fax machine was developed by a german named Arthur Korn in 1902 and was commercialized in 1926.

Telex

This is system of direct dial teleprinter which uses a keyboard to transmit typed text over telephone lines to similar terminals

Satellites

A Satellite is a spacecraft or an artificial device orbiting the earth, moon or another planet, transmitting back to earth scientific information. It is launched at a velocity of at least 28,960 km per hour (escape velocity) to enable it overcome gravitational pull of the earth and thus remain in space.In 1680, a British Scientist, Isaac Newton, introduced the idea of artificial satellites.The first message to be transmitted by satellite was the Christmas greeting by President Dwight D Eisenhower of the USA in 1958.In 1969, the first television pictures were relayed around the earth by satellites from Apollo II astronauts. In October 1957, USSR sent sputnik I, the first satellite into the orbit. In the same year, the first living passenger, a little dog called Laika, was carried into space by a satellite.In 1961, a Russian Yuri Gagarin went into space on board of a satellite.In 1969, an American, Neil Armstrong, in his spacecraft Apollo I, landed on the moon.In 1981, the US released the first space shuttle which is manned, airplane like craft which orbits the earth.In 1983, Challenger, the space shuttle, released a satellite into space.

In 1986, an accident occurred on the space shuttle, Challenger, killing seven  Astronauts

Pagers/beepers

These are portable communication message devices. In using it, the person sending the message uses a phone and calls a pager number.

The impact of telecommunications today.

  1. a) Telecommunication has revolutionized communication through enabling faster and easier communication between individuals. This has increased interaction and therefore international understanding.
  2. b) Telecommunication has enhanced information management e.g the use of computers for information storage and processing and the internet in communication.
  3. c) Telecommunication devices are also sources of entertainment. Radios and television broadcast music and movies to entertain people.
  4. d) Telecommunication systems like television bring reality to the viewers by transmitting live pictures.
  5. e) Telecommunication devices enhance cultural exchange and understanding through showing programmes from other countries. This helps people to appreciate other people’s culture and even enrich their own.
  6. f) Telecommunication systems have promoted water and air transport. Ships at sea and airplanes use these devices to send signals to guide captains and pilots.
  7. g) Telecommunication systems have made world trade and businesses more effective and efficient. People can quickly place orders for goods and get news of world markets and commodity prices.
  8. h) Telecommunications has enabled organizations, government institutions and individuals to access information and programmes at their convenience. This has led to effective management and good governance.
  9. i) Countries have also improved their security systems by using radio and radio calls and mobile tracking systems to combat crimes.
  10. j) Modern war fare has been revolutionized. Modern weapons depend on telecommunication services that provide accurate and reliable information. For example, satellites are used to guide missiles.
  11. k) Remote areas are no longer inaccessible thanks to telecommunications. People can communicate using cell phones even from the most remote areas of a country.
  12. l) Telecommunication systems have promoted space exploration. Man has been able to send spacecraft to the moon, mars and Venus using communication satellites.
  13. m) Telecommunication is a source of employment in many countries. Many people offer services, operate systems and maintain them.
  14. n) Governments earn revenue from telecommunication systems. This revenue promotes economic development. For example taxes collected from licensing of service operators, manufacturers of telecommunication systems etc.

Negative attributes to telecommunication.

  1. a) Telecommunication has promoted international social crimes such as fraud, drug trafficking and terrorism.
  2. b) Some forms of telecommunication promote immorality among children and the youth in the world through watching of pornographic materials.
  3. c) Some telecommunication devices cannot be accessed by many people due to the expense of acquisition and installation.
  4. d) Telecommunication devices have an addictive effect for many users. This affects speed of development in developing countries AS people sit for long hours watching television instead of engaging in productive activities.
  5. e) Mobile phone users risk suffering from effects of the constant exposure to radioactive rays which may cause certain types of cancer.

Print media

This refers to all that is printed or written down and published. For example, journals, books, newspapers, magazines etc.

Newspapers

It is an unbound publication produced at regular intervals and devoted primarily to current events and advertisements. Before printing was invented, the oldest newspaper, The Siloam Inscription,(a stone on which news were recorded) was in circulation among the people of Mesopotamia at around 700 BC.The Chinese court journal, Tsing Pao, published in Peking in AD 500 was another early form of newspaper.The Roman Bulletin, Acta Diurna, used by Emperor Julius Ceaser from 60BC to post government daily announcements was also an early form of newspaper.Printing was invented by a german, Johannes Gutenberg, in the 15th century. The first publication, Strasbourg Relations, was published in 1609The London Daily Post also known as the Public Advertiser was published by Henry Woodfall and his son Sampson Woodfall in 18th c.

The London Times was first published as the Daily Universal Register by John Walter in 1785. It changed its name to Times in 1788.In 1900, C Arthur founded the Daily Express.

The first newspaper in Kenya was the African Standard founded by Alibhai Mullas Jeevanjee, in Mombasa in 1902. It later changed its name to the east African standard in 1905. And moved its operations from Mombasa to Nairobi in 1910.in 1928, Jomo Kenyatta published a local newspaper in Kikuyu, Muigwithania aimed at spreading the views of the Kikuyu central Association and promote kikuyu culture.The Daily Nation was established by the Aga Khan in 1960In 1983, the Kenya Times was founded by Hilary Ngweno and later bought by KANU and owned jointly with a Briton Robert Maxwel

Types of Newspapers.

Daily Newspapers

These print atleast one edition every weekday. Some print morning and evening edition when necessary. Examples of daily newspapers include the Daily Nation, The standard, the Toronto Star and The Los Angeles Times.

Weekly Newspapers

These are published once a week. They contain news of interest to people in a smaller area, maybe a city or a neighborhood. For example the east African in Kenya and the weekly Telegraph in Britain.

Special interest Newspapers

They concentrate on news of special interest to a particular group for example an ethnic community, a corporation or a trade organization. They can be daily, weekly or monthly.

Periodicals

These are publications released at regular intervals and containing news, feature articles, poems, fictional stories etc. they also contain photographs and drawings. Periodicals aimed at general audience are called magazines.Periodicals differ from newspapers in that whereas newspapers deal with sometimes daily news and are unbound, periodicals like magazines and journals focus on more specialized material and deal with news in form of summaries or commentaries. They are printer on finer paper with smaller bound pages and issued at a longer interval than a day when compared to newspapers.

Magazines

These are periodical publications with specialized information on particular issues. They are published fortnightly, weekly or monthly.The oldest magazine is Eileen’s Oxford Gazette published in 1665, later became the London Gazette.The first periodical to use the word magazine in its Title was the Gentleman Magazine published in 1731 in Britain.

The oldest magazine in Kenya is the Kenya Official Gazette (1900-1963), renamed the Kenya Gazette after independence. Other were the Leader of the British East African Company, Wathiomo Mukinyu by Consolata Catholic Missionaries in Nyeri, Tangaza by Harry Thuku, the East African Chronicles and the Colonial times by the Asian Journals

These are periodicals with a narrower target audience such as scholarly publication. They specialize in particular themes or professions. For example the Review of Political Economy, Canadian Journal of African Affairs, the East African Journal of Social Sciences and the East African Medical Journal.

DEVELOPMENT OF INDUSTRIES

Industry is defined as the skill of making other products from raw materials. It involves extraction and processing into finished products of raw materials

 

Early Sources of Energy.

Energy is the ability to do work. The following are the early sources of energy that can be identified.

Wood.

Wood developed as a source of energy after the discovery of fire. It was used as follows;

  1. a) Making fire which provides heat to warm people during cold seasons lighting, to cook roots and roast meat, for hunting(bushfires), tool-making to harden tips, means of communication, food preservation
  2. b) Charcoal made from wood fuel provided heat that was used for steaming water to provide steam power for steam engines during the industrial revolution.

This is a form of energy still in use today since it is cheaper and easily available.

Wind.

Wind was used to drive sailing ships during the trade between East African Coast and the Far East.Windmills were used in China to grind grain and process foods

They were also used to pump water from polders in Netherlands.Windmills are also used to generate electricity. Windmills are mainly used in areas with fewer trees like in Isiolo, Garissa, Wajir and Mandera.However the use of wind as a source of energy is disadvantaged by its being irregular and inconsistent in direction and strength.

Water.

Water has been harnessed to produce HEP. Water was used to turn wooden propellers (water wheels) which in turn turned grindstones to grind grains into flour.In England, it was used in the Textile and paper industry to turn spinning machines.In Italy water-powered machines were used to make copper pots, weapons of war, to spin silk and to sharpen various tools. Water also is not reliable as a source of energy since the levels may be too low during dry weather for HEP production.

Uses of metals in Africa

The age of metals in Africa is divided into the Bronze and Iron Age.

Man moved from the Stone Age to the age of metals because metals had the following advantages;

  1. a) Metallic tools were more durable. They could not break easily.
  2. b) Cutting edges of metals could be sharpened.
  3. c) Malleable Metals could be heated and reworked into deferent usable designs when need arose
  4. d) Metals are not prone to waste. Broken pieces can be smelted and reworked into useful items. For example a broken spear into an arrow.

The following are examples of metals that were used in Africa.

Gold

This was the first metal to be used by humankind. It was used in Meroe, Egypt, Wangara in Ghana and in Central Africa.

Gold is malleable and therefore it could be easily moulded into the desired shape without smelting it. Its softness however implied that tools made from gold could bend easily. It was also heavy and could not be found everywhere.

Uses of Gold

  1. a) It was used to make ornaments and decorations. In Egypt, it was used to make jewellery like rings, bangles and bracelets.
  2. b) It was used to make utensils, such as plates, vases and drinking vessels.
  3. c) It was used to make swords and flint knife handles among the rich in Egypt.
  4. d) It was used to make coins in Egypt.
  5. e) It was used as a trade item in East, central and West Africa
  6. f) It was used to make weapons such as sword and knife blades.
  7. g) Gold was also a measure of wealth in Egypt.

Copper

Though quite soft, copper as harder than Gold and could make better tools. The Egyptians were the earliest people to use copper by 3000 BC.The metal could further be hardened by mixing it with other metals to form alloys during smelting.

Uses of copper

  1. a) Making utensils and containers such as pots and pans.
  2. b) The Egyptians used copper to make axes, tools, Chisels, Pins and fish hooks.
  3. c) It was used to make ornamental bangles, rings, helmets, needles, wire chains and statues.
  4. d) It was used as a medium of exchange in the form of copper bars.
  5. e) It was used to make daggers (weapons).
  6. f) It was used as a trade commodity. Those with copper exchanged it with other goods that

they did not have.

  1. g) It was used to make alloys like Bronze and Brass.

Bronze.

Bronze is a mixture of copper and tin which makes it harder than copper. It was used during the Bronze Age.

In Africa Bronze was used among the Yoruba, Dahomey and Asante in Nigeria and in Benin. And also in Egypt. Benin was the centre of Bronze.

Uses of Bronze.

  1. a) Making stronger weapons such as shields, spears, arrowheads, swords and daggers.
  2. b) Making sculptures and decorations. For example, in Benin it was used to make objects for religious ceremonies, masks and decorating the king’s palace. It decorated temples, palaces and pyramids in Egypt.
  3. c) Making knives, containers, pans and vases.
  4. d) It was a store of wealth.
  5. e) It was used to make tools, shields and chariots.

Disadvantages of Bronze.

  1. a) The tools lost their sharpness and became blunt quickly since the metal was relatively soft.

They required constant sharpening.

  1. b) Bronze was not cheap. The mixture of copper and yin had to be acquired through trade thus making bronze expensive.
  2. c) It was difficult to get an appropriate proportion of each of the two metals.

Iron.

Two theories that explain the origin and spread of iron working in Africa are;

1)  It was first introduced in North Africa from the Middle East by the Phoenicians and the Assyrians, and then spread to west, East Central and South Africa.

2)  The art of iron working probably developed independently in Africa as evidenced by the Archaeological evidence in Buhaya (the oldest Iron Age site that existed between 5th  and 6th  C AD ) , North –West of Tanzania. The Buhaya iron is associated with the pottery style known as Urewe-ware. The Hittites were the first people to smelt and use iron in around 1500BC. The skill then spread to the Assyrians. The idea then spread to Africa between 400 and 500 BC and became widespread in the Nile Valley.By 5th c it had spread upto Meroe (the Birmingham of Africa) then to Ethiopia. From Carthage and Tunisia, it spread to West Africa, at Taruga in Nigeria’s Jos plateau at around 580BC, then to Lake Chad by 500 AD

Ways in which the iron culture spread in Africa.

1)  Through wars of conquest e.g. Egypt versus Assyrians where the Assyrians forced the Egyptians to learn to use iron from Meroe to make strong weapons.

2)  Trade e.g. the Mesopotamians traded with Africans. The North African then traded with the West Africans, thus spreading the iron smelting technology across the Sahara.

3)  Intermarriages e.g. Arabs and Africans intermarried and hence a new iron culture and technology developed.

4)  Through learning and acquiring the technology from neighbors.

5)  Increased demand for iron tools for agriculture, weapons and iron products increased trade in iron.

6)  Migrations. E.g in east Africa where the Bantus and nilotes arrived from West African region with the iron culture which they introduced to east Africa.

7)  Travelers and messengers who gave out and received the gifts of iron

Uses of Iron

  1. a) It was used as medium of exchange. Iron bars were used as currency.
  2. b) To make agricultural tools such as hoes and pangas this increased food production.
  3. c) Weapons such as spears and arrows were made of iron, which strengthened some communities while others who lacked the same were easily defeated.
  4. d) Iron was used as a trade item where those who did not have it acquired it through barter trade.
  5. e) It was used for storing wealth. Smithers used iron bars as a measure of value.

Effects of iron working

  1. a) It promoted empire building. Many kingdoms and empires relied on strong iron, weapons to fight expansionist wars e.g. Egypt, Benin and Mwene Mutapa empires.
  2. b) It led to migrations especially of the Bantus who war able to protect themselves during the journeys using iron weapons.
  3. c) It promoted agriculture since large tracts of land could now be used to produce more food using stronger tools.
  4. d) Adequate food resulted in population increase and later migration to areas with sparse population.
  5. e) It resulted in specialization and division of labour as some people became iron smelters while others engaged in other activities like trade.
  6. f) It stimulated construction and building works using stronger metals like iron. Better houses, temples and bridges were built.
  7. g) Metal technology also had an impact on religion in that metals began to be used when performing religious rites and in royal palaces e.g. the golden stool among the Asante.
  8. h) Trading and industrial towns developed within and around the major mining centres like

Meroe Axum, in Ghana, in Zimbabwe and in Benin.

  1. i) Trade was promoted in that sometimes iron was used as currency and others became important items of long distance and regional trade.

INDUSTRIAL REVOLUTION IN EUROPE.

The Industrial Revolution was a period from 1750 to 1850 where changes in agriculture, manufacturing, mining, transportation, and technology had a profound effect on the social, economic and cultural conditions of the times. It began in the United Kingdom, and then subsequently spread throughout Western Europe, Northern America, Japan, and eventually the rest of the world.The industrial revolution in Europe occurred in two phases;The old phase was from 175-1850 and began in Britain and spread to other European countries like France (1825), Germany (1840), Belgium (1870) and Russia (1890). In USA, it began after the American civil war of 1861 to 1865. In Japan it began in 1900. In Kenya, it is hoped to be done by 2030.

Characteristics of industrial revolution in Europe

  1. a) The use of machines to replace human and animal labour.
  2. b) The use of steam power as a new source of energy to replace water, wind and animal power.
  3. c) Increased exploitation and use of coal, iron and steel.
  4. d) The rise of the factory system in owns instead of the cottage industries in homes.
  5. e) The development of better forms of transport including the use of railways, roads and water.
  6. f) Improved living standards and an increase in the human population who required more manufactured goods.
  7. g) The production of goods on large scale. Machines worked faster than human labour.
  8. h) The development of science and the application of scientific knowledge in production.
  9. i) There was development of trade as manufactured goods were sold locally and abroad.
  10. j) The rise of modern capitalism that provided enough wealth which was then invested back into industry.
  11. k) The growth of trade Union Movements to carter for the rights of industrial workers.

Uses of Various Sources of Energy

Coal

This is a compact black or dark brown, carbonaceous rock which is a fuel and source of coke, coal gas and coal tar.Abraham Darby invented the process by which coal was turned into coke in 1709 thus discovered that coal produced immense heat. Coke was used to smelt iron.

Uses of coal

  1. a) To heat water to high temperatures so as to produce steam.
  2. b) To provide lighting.
  3. c) To drive steam engines in factories. Some generators depended on coal heat to produce steam.
  4. d) To drive locomotives. This promoted transport.
  5. e) It was a raw material in the manufacturing of dye and pharmaceutical products.

Disadvantages of Coal

  1. a) It is bulky and transporting it is difficult.
  2. b) It produced too much smoke when used in locomotives. Also gases released during the burning of coal e.g sulphur dioxide polluted the air and caused acid rain.
  3. c) Coal was expensive to mine and to transport to the required destination.
  4. d) Coal mining was risky to miners who often lost their lives when mines collapsed and buried them.

Petroleum.(often referred to as oil)

Before 1850, oil was known to American farmers as a substance that affected food production in farms. It was an American Don, Bissel who carried out an analysis of oil samples at a university lab and established that oil was both a fuel and lubricant.

The use of oil became widespread with the invention of the internal combustion engine by Gotlieb Daimler.

Uses of oil.

  1. a) To power vehicles, aeroplanes and ships
  2. b) To generate electricity used in lighting and cooking.
  3. c) To run engines in industries
  4. d) Tar (Bitumen), a by-product of petroleum is used to tarmac roads.
  5. e) Greasing of metals in industries was also done by petroleum by-products such as grease.
  6. f) Certain petroleum chemicals are used in making of drugs, fertilizers, synthetic fibre and plastics.

Disadvantages of oil

  1. a) For countries importing oil, it is expensive to transport.
  2. b) Prospecting for oil is quite expensive.
  3. c) Oil may also affect the environment, since extracting large quantities of petroleum may cause land to sink.

Steam.

Steam is boiling water turned into gas. It was used for first time around 100 AD in a steampowered engine developed by a Greek scientist called Hero.In the 16th century, Thomas Savery, a Briton, built a steam engine which could pump water out of a coal mine.In 1712, Thomas Newcomen improved Savery’s design, though he design was still ineffective.In 1764, James Watt improved on Newcomen’s engine to make it more effective and by 1800, 320 of Watt’s engines were in use in Britain.In 1801, Richard Trevithick installed one of Watt’s engines in a road vehicle. Three years later, he produced a steam-driven locomotive that ran on rails.In 1830, George Stephenson improved on Trevithick’s work and invented the first steam locomotive, the rocket.

In all these engines, coal was used to produce steam.

Uses of steam

  1. a) It was used to drive heavy machinery in factories and to turn turbines that generated power for industrial use, e.g driving, spinning and weaving machines.
  2. b) It was used for pumping water out of coal mines.
  3. c) It was used in steam –powered locomotives and ships.
  4. d) The massive temple doors in Egypt were only opened using steam.

Electricity

Electricity was discovered by an English Scientist called Michael Faraday (1791-1861) in 1831 when he invented the electric Dynamo.His principal of electromagnetic induction was the beginning of both the dynamo and the electric Motor. The energy used energy from coal, oil, steam or water to produce electricity. The use of electricity became widespread from 1900.

Uses of electricity

  1. a)
  2. b) Heating and cooking.
  3. c) Powering machines in factories.
  4. d) Electric signals are used in communication gadgets.
  5. e) Powering transport vehicles such as electric trains and electric cars.

Disadvantages of electricity

  1. a) It can be dangerous if not properly installed or used.
  2. b) The generation and distribution of electricity is very expensive thus making its use limited to fewer people in developing countries.

Other sources of energy

Atomic energy

In 1896, A French physicist, Antoine Henri Beckquerel (1852 -1903), discovered that uranium produces radiation or energy in waves. (Radioactivity). This was the birth of the development of Atomic energy.In 1938, Hahn and Stressman discovered the process of Atomic fusion which leads to production of Atomic energy.In 1942, a group of scientists led by Enrico-Fermi at the university of Chicago, USA, built the first Nuclear research Station which resulted in the invention of the nuclear reactor and later the discovery of an Atomic Bomb like one which was used Hiroshima and Nagasaki in 1945.In Belgium and France, 60% of the electricity is produced from atomic power. However, atomic energy when used in war can be very fatal.Radioactivity also endangers both animal and plant life.Polluted air, where radioactivity has taken place causes fever, diarrhea and death. For example the radioaction accident in 1985 at Three Mile Island in the USA and at Chernobyl near Kiev in Ukraine in 1986 had fatal consequences.

Solar Energy.

It is obtained directly from the sun and is used to dry firewood, clothes and to cook food.

In 1714, Antoine Lavoisier made a solar furnace which could melt metals.An engine using solar power was used to run a printing press in Paris in 1880.The use of solar water heaters was widespread in USA by 1900.In 1954, the first solar cell which turned sunlight into electricity was made. The energy was  then used to heat water and generate electricity.

Uses of Solar energy.

  1. a) Drying agricultural products.
  2. b) Distilling of salty water to get salt crystals.
  3. c) Heating water in homes and industry
  4. d) Heating and lighting buildings
  5. e) Cooking using solar cookers
  6. f) Irrigating using solar water pumps,
  7. g) Powering satellites in space.

Advantages of solar energy

  1. a) It is clean and is available in places where sunlight is readily available.
  2. b) It is natural and therefore free, non-pollutant and inexhaustible source of energy.

Iron and steel

Iron was not really a source of energy but the industrial revolution was dependant on the availability of iron

Uses of iron

  1. a) Production of machines for textile industry. Water pipes and ploughs were made of iron.
  2. b) Production of steam engines.
  3. c) Building of trains, railway lines ships, wheels, bridges and coach frames.In an attempt to overcome the disadvantages of iron (it was too heavy and could rust easily), in 1856, an Englishman, Henry Bessemer produced steel out of Iron and Carbon. (Steel is an alloy of iron and Carbon and is lighter, flexible, stronger and harder than iron).Stainless steel, commonly used in cutlery is an alloy of Steel and Chromium.

Uses of steel

  1. a) The construction of rail lines, bridges, cars and ships.
  2. b) The manufacturing of machinery especially in the agricultural and industrial sector.
  3. c) Reinforcement of concrete in buildings and roofing houses.
  4. d) Making of containers and utensils.

INDUSTRIALIZATION IN BRITAIN

This change, which occurred between 1750 and 1830, happened because conditions were perfect in Britain for the Industrial Revolution. The transformation was facilitated by the following factors;

  1. a) Availability of coal and iron ore which served as a basis for heavy industries. Coal was a source of energy for use in the industries. Iron was used in the manufacture of machinery.
  2. b) The agrarian revolution ensured that important raw materials were available for the industries and also made food more available for the many factory centres
  3. c) Existence of a large population which provided steady internal market for the manufactured goods/domestic local markets. There was also Availability of external markets in her colonies for the industrial produce.
  4. d) Existence of cottage industries which acted as a base for industrial take-off in Britain. It was easier to turn to mass production of goods on the basis of the small scale production in cottage industries.
  5. e) Due to the enclosure act, many peasants became available to offer unskilled labour especially following their displacement from the rural areas.
  6. f) Political stability and strong leadership that existed at the time created a condusive

environment for investments when compared to other European countries.

  1. g) Well developed transport and communication network e.g railway, canals, bridges, harbours and roads which promoted industrialization.
  2. h) Existence of good banking and insurance systems which gave financial help and security to the industries.
  3. i) Britain had a strong navy that guarded her trade routes thus protecting her merchants from foreign competition.
  4. j) Policy of free trade encouraged industrialization/ existence of the merchant and middle class who formed pressure groups that forced the government to adopt measures favoring their industries.britain had no internal customs barrier to hurt her industrial growth.
  5. k) Availability of wealth/capital that stimulated industrial revolution. Britain had accumulated a lot of wealth from her trade with other countries and her colonies in America and Africa.e.g. The steam engine was made in Britain by a wealth Briton.
  6. l) Availability of industrial raw materials in her vast colonies.

INDUSTRIALIZATION IN CONTINENTAL EUROPE.

The Industrial Revolution on Continental Europe came a little later than in Great Britain.

Reasons why other European countries delayed in the industrialization process.

  1. a) The political upheavals in France, Germany and Italy were responsible for the delay in the take- off of industrialization.
  2. b) The existence of a feudal economy in which the peasant farmers could not afford to buy industrial goods nor raise capital to invest in industry.
  3. c) The system of farming implied that inadequate raw materials came from the farms thus making it difficult for industrial development.
  4. d) Their system of transport was not developed.
  5. e) Unlike Britain, these countries did not have an enterprising class of people and scientists ready to take up the task of industrial investment and invention.

Factors that led to industrial development in continental Europe

  1. a) Political stability and strong leadership that followed the unification of Italy and Germany and end of Napoleonic rule in France created a contusive environment for investments when compared to other European countries. Feudalism was also abolished.
  2. b) The agrarian revolution that had taken place in continental Europe ensured that the countries had raw materials for their industries. Other strategic raw materials like coal and iron were readily available.
  3. c) There was adequate capital from the rich traders who willingly invested in industry. Britain also gave loans to the European countries to industrialize.
  4. d) Existence of good banking and insurance systems which gave financial help and security to the industries.
  5. e) Existence of a large population which provided both skilled and unskilled labour required by the industries.
  6. f) The European governments supported the industrial ventures that were aimed at enhancing economic development. French and Germany governments gave tax concessions and subsidies to encourage industrialization.
  7. g) Existence of a steady internal and external market for the manufactured goods/there was a high European population that consumed most goods locally.
  8. h) Well developed transport and communication network e.g. better roads, railway and water transport which meant that industrial workers, raw materials and finished goods could be transported easily.
  9. i) Countries in continental Europe had vast sources of energy such as coal, steam power and electricity which enhanced industrial development.
  10. j) The development of new skills in science and technology facilitated industrial growth. Some European countries like France and Germany sent their people to Britain to acquire skills and ideas in science and also invited English technicians to their countries.

Effects of the industrial revolution in Europe

  1. a) Creation of employment opportunities. Ordinary working people found increased opportunities for employment in the new mills and factories.
  2. b) Emergence of Factories and urbanization. Industrialization led to the creation of the factory system was largely responsible for the rise of the modern city, as large numbers of workers migrated into the cities in search of employment in the factories.
  3. c) Improved Standards of living. Living conditions and health care improved during the 19th The famines that troubled rural areas did not happen in industrial areas.
  4. d) Population increase. As living conditions and health care improved during the 19th century, Europe’s population doubled every 50 years. Infant mortality reduced.
  5. e) Local and international trade developed. Manufactured goods were sold locally while others were exported to America. The industries also created market for raw materials from Africa and Asia.
  6. f) European economies became diversified as a result of industrial growth. This led to specialization e.g. traders, bankers, mechanics and agriculturalists.
  7. g) Development and use of machinery in agriculture led to increased production
  8. h) Improvement in Transportation and technology. The expansion of business and factories expanded Canals, highways and railways were expanded.
  9. i) Large scale production of a wide range of goods. new methods of farming , such as the use of fertilizers and new crop breeds were developed
  10. j) The industrial revolution promoted development of science and technology. There was increased utilization of knowledge in production of goods as well as scientific inventions such as invention of electricity.
  11. k) The emergence of trade union movement. The Industrial Revolution concentrated labour into mills, factories and mines, thus facilitating the organization of combinations or trade unions to help advance the interests of working people.
  12. l) Eventually effective political organization for working people was achieved through the trades unions who began to support socialist political parties that later merged to become the British Labour Party.
  13. m) It led to Political corruption – the amount of money generated by the Industrial Revolution created a class of super rich who could buy any politician or process.
  14. n) Environmental damage – there were few if any rules regarding how resources could be removed and used. The air was horribly polluted from factories, as was the soil and rivers.
  15. o) There was increased exploitation of natural resources in Europe during the revolution. Iron, coal and steel production increased.
  16. p) Industrial revolution was accompanied with economic Exploitation of people. While jobs were created, sometimes the jobs were dangerous and people died. Harsh working conditions, Child labour, dirty living conditions, and long working hours were prevalent.
  17. q) Rise of unemployment. The rapid industrialization cost many craft workers their jobs. Many weavers found themselves suddenly unemployed since they could no longer compete with machines to produce cloth.
  18. r) The industrial revolution was responsible for the scramble and partition of Africa. The colonies produced raw materials for industries in Europe and also acted as markets for goods processed in Europe. For this reason, many European nations sought to have as many colonies as possible.

The scientific Revolution

Science is the systematic study of the nature and behaviour of the material and physical universe based on observation. The scientific revolution refers to the history of science in the early modern period, where sudden development in mathematics, physics, astronomy, biology, medicine and chemistry transformed views of society and nature.

Causes of scientific revolution

  1. a) Discovery of the New World. Exploration/conquest leading to discovery of new plant/animal life. Traditional link between navigation and astronomy + great advances made by Portuguese navigators fueled an interest in learning more about the stars
  2. b) Invention of the Printing Press, allowed for rapid dissemination of scientific knowledge. Numerous books and newsletters were in circulation keeping people informed of science
  3. c) Rivalry among Nation-States. Constant warfare among nation-states pushed for scientific development by placing an importance on technology, or applied science. Powerful leaders of nation-states funded scientific development.
  4. d) Renaissance / birth of knowledge. During this period, Human interest in the classical world increased. Renaissance time made people to develop interest in research/ learning.
  5. e) The need to solve their daily life problems like shortages, disease etc. necessity is the mother of all inventions.
  6. f) Financial support for governments and individuals. Governments and individuals financed scientific research.
  7. g) Religion failed to answer all questions. This sometimes betrayed man’s belief in

supernatural power thus emphasizing research.

Scientific inventions.

Scientific inventions have roots in the ancient civilization in Egypt, Mesopotamia, Greece, China and India. Early inventions were witnessed in the field of medicine, astronomy, agriculture, medicine and mathematics as follows;

  1. a) The Egyptians discovered geometry which they used on farms. They discovered dead body preservation method (mummification). Build pyramids for their pharaohs using knowledge in mathematics.
  2. b) Greeks like Pythagoras contributed to mathematics, especially the right angled triangle as early as 200BC, Euclid did some work in geometry. Archimedes discovered how the lever works. Ptolemy is remembered for geographical work especially production of the Atlas.
  3. c) The Chinese made cloth from silk and developed acupuncture skills. They invented paper making in 70 AD. They made gunpowder and the calendar.
  4. d) The Indians invented the decimal system in mathematics.
  5. e) The Muslim Arabs developed the art of architecture as evidenced by the construction of unique mosques.

Period   Inventor and invention

1473-1543  Nicolas Copernicus a polish astronomer. He discovered that Celestial bodies possess uniform, circular motion around a central point.

1564 – 1642   Galileo Galilei. In 1609 the Italian mathematician invented the telescope and observed the universe.  He accepted Copernican astronomy and the implicit necessity of a ‘new’ physics to replace Aristotelian mechanics.

1571 – 1630   Johannes Kepler.  Used Brahe’s data to confirm that the sun was the center of the universe and the earth and other planets revolved around it.1642 – 1727   Sir Isaac Newton). He explained theories of motion and inertia with the force of gravity. Newton also described the composition of light.

1743-1794 Antoine Lavoisier, a Frenchman. He showed that air was made of hydrogen and oxygen elements.

He stated that chemical substances comprised different elements.

1766-1844 John Dalton, an English Teacher was the founder of modern chemistry and is famous for the atomic theory “all matter is made up of tiny particles called atoms.”

1706-1790 Benjamin Franklin (USA) he stated that lightning was a form of electricity. He came up with the theory of electricity and  invented the lightning rod.

1791 – 1867   Michael Faraday creates the electric motor, and develops an understanding of electromagnetic induction, which provides evidence that electricity and magnetism are related. In 1831, he invented the electric dynamo, a machine which produced electricity from a magnet.

1799 – 1878   Joseph Henry’s research on electromagnetic induction is performed at the same time as Faraday’s. He constructs the first motor; his work with electromagnets leads directly to the development of the telegraph.

Impact of scientific inventions

Impact of scientific inventions on agriculture

  1. a) Food production has been increased thanks to the use of farm machinery, fertilizers, pest

1831-1979  James Clerk Maxwell pointed out that acceleration of electric charges emitted electromagnetic radiation. The ideas underlying Maxwell’s theories of electromagnetism describe the propagation of light waves in a vacuum.

1787-1854  . In 1827, George Simon Ohm determined that the current that flows through a wire is proportional to its cross sectional area and inversely proportional to its length or Ohm’s law.

1876  Nicolaus Otto, A German traveling salesman named constructed the first practical internal combustion engine; it used a four stroke cycle of a piston to draw a fuel-air mixture into a cylinder, compress it, mechanically capture energy after ignition, and expel the exhaust before

beginning the cycle anew.

1847-1869  Alexander Graham Bell, In 1876, at the age of 29, invented his telephone.

1701  Tull, Jethro invented a horse-drawn seed drill.

1764  Water frame invented by Richard Arkwright – the first powered textile machine.

1888-1946  John Logie Baird is remembered as the inventor of mechanical television (an earlier version of television). Baird also patented inventions related to radar and fiber optics.

1755

Robert Bakewell produces Leicester sheep through selective breeding methods. In 1769, Bakewell breeds Longhorn cattle through selective breeding

1786  Andrew Meikle, a Scottish engineer, develops threshing machine

1831  Cyrus McCormick invents the first commercially successful horse-drawn reaper for harvesting wheat

1837  John Deere develops and manufactures the first commercially successful cast -steel plough

1831 – 1860s  John Fowler pioneers the use of engines for ploughing and drainage channels

1879  Anna Baldwin patents a milking machine—a vacuum device connected to a hand pump—to replace hand milking. Invention receives a patent but not commercially successful.

1842  The first grain elevator is built by Joseph Dart in the U.S.

1850  Edward Quincy invents the corn picker

1764  Spinning jenny invented by James Hargreaves – the first machine to improve upon the spinning wheel.

1733 Flying shuttle invented by John Kay – an improvement to looms that enabled weavers to weave faster.

1779 Crompton invented the spinning mule that allowed for greater control over the weaving process.

1785  Cartwright patented the power loom. It was improved upon by William Horrocks, known for his invention of the variable speed batton in 1813.

1847 -1931  Thomas Alva Edison is Most famous for his invention of the electric incandescent light bulb.

1853 – 1937  Elihu Thomson.  His experiments eventually led to the adoption of alternating current technology.

1913  Robert Adler. He is Most famous for his invention of the wireless TV remote control.

1856 -1943  Nikola Tesla is  Recognized as one of the outstanding pioneers in the electric power field

1765-1825 Eli Whitney invented the cotton gin in 1794. The cotton gin is a machine that separates seeds, hulls and other unwanted materials from cotton after it has been picked.

1895   Wilhelm Röntgen discovers x rays.

1898   Marie and Pierre Curie separate radioactive elements.

1898   Joseph Thompson measures the electron, and puts forth his “plum-pudding” model of the atom — that the atom is a slightly positive sphere with small, raisin -like negative electrons inside.

and control methods and scientific breeding. Hybrid seeds have been developed together with new animal breeds.

  1. b) Scientific inventions have stimulated scientific research in the field of agriculture. This is done in schools, agricultural institutes and colleges.
  2. c) Farming of perishable foods has been made possible due to invention of preservation methods for foods like canning and refrigeration.
  3. d) Increased food production has led to increase in population. There is increased food security. There is also increased trade.
  4. e) Biotechnology has contributed to diversification of agriculture leading to greater crop and animal production.
  5. f) Farming has been revolutionized from small-scale subsistence farming to large –scale economic activity due to mechanization on farms

Negative impacts of scientific inventions on agriculture.

  1. a) The consumption of chemically –treated and stored food has raised concern for food related disease such as cancer and heart diseases
  2. b) Use of pesticides and fertilizers sometimes poses the challenges of cost. Some pesticides are toxic and therefore harmful to humans and animals.
  3. c) Consistence use of fertilizers impoverishes the soil fertility. The more the fertilizer is used the more the soil becomes infertile.
  4. d) Traditional crops are being threatened by biotechnology and development of hybrids.

Impact of scientific inventions on industry.

  1. a) Large quantities of goods can be produced due to scientific inventions. This has led to enjoyment of economies of scale.
  2. b) Efficient sources of energy necessary for industrial production have been developed. New forms of energy such as nuclear, solar and electricity have been invented.
  3. c) Improvements in transport and communication have stimulated industrial development.

Movement of labour, raw materials and manufactured goods is efficient.

  1. d) There has been increased exploitation of resources like factories, fisheries, minerals etc as factories yearn for raw materials due to increased production.
  2. e) The large scale manufacture of goods has led to growth of trade. This in turn has created wealth for industrialized nations.
  3. f) Space exploration has been enhanced through science. Satellites are used in photographing of the earth’s surface and in weather research.
  4. g) Science has revolutionized military technology. Dangerous weapons have been

manufactured.

  1. h) There is faster dissemination and spread of ideas or knowledge and skills due to

development of printing press, and internet development.

  1. i) Industries have created job opportunities. Exploitation of mineral deposits has created employment.

Negative impact of scientific inventions on industry

  1. a) Scientific inventions in industry have led to industrial wastes and pollutants that contribute to environmental pollution. Smoke pollutes the air, machines cause noise pollution etc.
  2. b) Human life has suffered unnecessarily due to development of war weapons and accidents on roads and aeroplanes.
  3. c) Many people have been rendered unemployed due to development of machines.

Impact of scientific inventions on medicine

  1. a) Discovery of various medicines to treat both animals and human diseases has boosted both curative and preventive measures in promoting health.
  2. b) Improved nutrition has reduced the number of disease that kills man. Population has there increased as a result of reduced death rate.
  3. c) Proper diagnosis of disease is now possible with the use of x-rays and other modern scientific methods. With accurate diagnosis, proper treatment can be given.
  4. d) The manufacture of various drugs has been facilitated by scientific discoveries. Many companies produce drugs that prevent and cure diseases.

Factors undermining scientific revolution in third world countries

  1. a) Lack of enough funds for scientific research.
  2. b) High level of ignorance and illiteracy.
  3. c) The educational systems do not allow for development of inquisitive mind and development of interest in science. The system is not science oriented.
  4. d) The brain –drain; the few specialized scientists have migrated to areas with greener pastures like Europe and America.
  5. e) There is too much dependence on developed countries for nearly everything manufactured or scientifically produced.
  6. f) Lack of adequate support from the government. This is clear in the type of budgetary allocations to scientific research.

Measures that can be undertaken to promote scientific research in third world countries.

  1. a) Putting emphasis on the teaching of sciences in schools.
  2. b) Making available financial resources for scientific research.
  3. c) Emphasizing on competitions and congresses in schools and colleges.
  4. d) The government of Kenya has set up research institutions and centres of science and technology.
  5. e) Scientists have been trained locally and abroad on new knowledge in science and technology.
  6. f) International cooperation conferences in science, which bring scientists together, are organized and attended by Kenyan scientists.

Emergence of selected world industrial powers

United States of America.

This is the third largest nation in the world after Canada and China

Industrialization of the USA began in the mid 19th c and she had emerged as a major industrial power by mid 20th c. USA remains the only superpower in the world after collapse of USSR in 1990.

Factors influencing the industrialization of USA.

  1. a) Abundance of natural resources like iron ore, oil from the oilfields of Texas, copper and coal. There were also agricultural raw materials like cotton, corn, wheat and Tobacco plus forest resources which boosted industrial development.
  2. b) Good transport and communication. The USA government developed transport systems in the country. For example railway (opened in 1869), roads, and water transport. Electronic communication was also developed.
  3. c) Availability of both skilled and unskilled labour some of which came from the immigrant population. The American system of education gave room for acquisition of necessary skills.
  4. d) There were scientific and technological advances to support the industrial process especially by the Europeans who moved to USA. The education system also promoted research which further boosted industrialization.
  5. e) Foreign investments in the 19th c from countries like Britain led to industrial development.
  6. f) The high American population was a source of domestic market for her industrial products.

Her high quality products were also on high demand outside America.

  1. g) Enterprising citizens. The Americans were ready to venture into business. Some had good managerial skills. For example John Rockfeller ventured in the petroleum sector, Andrew Carnegie and James Hill in the steel and iron industry. Henry Ford in the mass production of cars.
  2. h) Long periods of political stability since her independence assured investors of security and thus paving way for industrialization.
  3. i) Availability of sources of energy like coal, petroleum, gas and HEP and later Atomic energy.
  4. j) The capitalism policy encouraged both local and external investors since it allowed private ownership of property.
  5. k) Government support. President Franklin Delano Roosevelt (1933-1945) and Woodrow Wilson (1913-1921) provided capital to develop transport systems.
  6. l) The 1st and 2nd World wars. During the war period, European nations were unable to produce goods since they were busy fighting. This enabled USA to expand her market as she initially kept away from the war.

Germany

The unification of Germany took place in 1871 after which she began to emerge as an industrial power.

Emergence of Germany as an industrial power was aided as by the following factors.

  1. a) Establishment of the customs union, Zollverein. This linked the german states and removed trade barriers hence leading to free trade and economic growth in Germany. Transportation of goods and communication was eased by the customs union.
  2. b) Germany was rich in coal which was an important source of energy for the industries. HEP and Atomic energy was also produced o boost industrialization.
  3. c) Abundance of natural resources like water and minerals like iron ore from Alsace and Lorraine, coal, oil and copper which were vital industrial raw materials.
  4. d) The large Germany population was a source of both skilled and unskilled labour. The system of education also ensured availability of skilled labourers.
  5. e) There was also a large domestic market from the large population. Her products were also on high demand from the rest of Europe. For example, her vehicles (Volkswagen, BMW and Mercedes Benz)
  6. f) Existence of good transport and communication networks of roads, railway and waterways. This ensured easy transportation of raw materials to factories and finished goods from industries to the market.
  7. g) Existence of long periods of political instability in Germany after unification in 1871 under the leadership of Otto Von Bismarck which ensured investor security.
  8. h) The availability of finance for industrial growth from the rich german citizens and from loans granted by USA in 1924. The Marshal Plan after 1945 was another source of finance.
  9. i) The existence of a hard working and enterprising people in Germany. For example, Krupp Meyer Thyssen who promoted the development of industries in steel. Egells and Harkoft Borsig made great contributions in the field of machinery.

German’s industrialization was however interrupted during the two world war periods. At the end of world war Germany was able to recover and progress in industrial development.

Factors which enabled Germany to recover after world war two.

  1. a) West Germany still had a high population which was an important resource in terms of labour. There were also a high number of immigrants from European countries like Turkey and Italy.
  2. b) The USA marshal Plan ensured that the required finance was available to assist her industries.
  3. c) Germany industries were not totally destroyed by the two wars.
  4. d) Industrial \unrests was not very common in Germany, and therefore, industrialization was not interrupted.
  5. e) Good leadership accelerated the industrialization process. Between 1949 and 1955, Germany chancellor Konrad Adenaur proved to be an able leader who encouraged industrial growth.

Japan.

Japan is a nation that has achieved a great deal in industrialization. In the 18c, Japan was faced with civil wars. Later she made contacts with the west, through which her leaders realized that industrialization could strengthen Japan as a nation. Great strides towards industrialization were made during the reign of Emperor Meiji from 1896.

Factors that enabled Japan to emerge as an industrial power

  1. She had enterprising citizens who were hard working and determined. They are always ready to undertake risks in business. The national motto ‘just in time’ confirms their efficiency.
  2. The Long period of political stability especially after World War II has promoted industrialization.
  3. The role played by America in financing the industrialization process in Japan as a means of preventing her from falling under the influence of communists after world war II. This enabled Japan to build many industries in the post war period.
  4. Japan is a country whose industrial growth has never been slowed down by industrial disputes. The Japanese work for life. When one is employed in Japan, they put the interest of the employer first. This therefore reduces industrial disputes.
  5. The Japanese goods are always of high quality and affordable. For example the vehicles, thus ensuring a steady market both local and international.
  6. The Japanese education system is technically oriented ensuring production of skilled.

Unskilled manpower has been made availability thanks to the abolition of the policy of feudalism that enabled labourers to move from the farms to the industries.

  1. Japan has a well developed transport and communication network of railway, roads, water transport, large airports and electric trains. This has enabled improved transportation of raw materials to factories and manufactured goods to markets
  2. Existence of an industrial base. Before World War II, Japan had already attained a certain level of industrial development. Many industries were not completely destroyed during the war period. The industries were repaired after the war.
  3. Japan has a highly developed renewable hydro-electric power given the existence of large and fast flowing rivers.
  4. The government invited expatriates and deployed them to local industries. In 1870, a group of 100 Japanese were sent out to western European factories to learn.
  5. Geographical factors. The country’s terrain did not favour agriculture thus making industrialization the best option to improve her economy.
  6. The open investment policy encouraged the west to invest in her industrialization. The government encouraged foreign industrialists to plough back their capital and resources into the Japanese economy.

Industrialization in the third world countries.

The term ‘Third world’ refers to developing nations of Africa, Asia and South America.

Most of them are former colonies of European powers and there resources were used to develop the mother countries during the colonial period.

Reasons why many developing countries have lagged behind in industrialization.

  1. a) Long periods of colonization relegated them to the role of suppliers of raw materials and as markets for industrial goods from developed nations at the expense of their own industries.
  2. b) Poor transport and communication systems has undermined industrialization since raw materials and manufactured goods cannot be transported to their various destinations.
  3. c) Inadequate capital. Most of the third world countries have poor agricultural-based economies which cannot support meaningful industrialization.
  4. d) Poor technology. The use of appropriate technology in third world countries is lagging behind and this hampers exploitation of natural resources and manufacturing of goods.
  5. e) Many developing countries face stiff completion from the industrialized nations that produce high quality products and have an advanced marketing system for their goods.
  6. f) High levels of illiteracy among majority of the population in developing countries leads to lack of technical and scientific skills necessary for industrial take –off.
  7. g) The protectionist policies adopted by developing countries have discouraged private enterprises and foreign investment. Policies like nationalization and imposition of import duties discourage investors in many countries.
  8. h) High levels of poverty in third world countries mean low domestic market. Governments also spent most of their resources to provide for the basic needs of their citizens at the expense of industrialization.
  9. i) Many third world countries have been faced with political instability problem. This has hampered industrialization. There are numerous civil wars or cross-border conflicts in many countries.
  10. j) Third world countries often poor disaster management strategies. The devastating effects of natural disasters affect industrialization.
  11. k) Lack of skilled personnel. Many well trained people migrate to the developed nations in search of well paying jobs. Since independence however, some have made tremendous effort to industrialize. For example, South Africa, Brazil and India.

Brazil

The fourth largest nation in the world after Canada, China and USA, she was colonized by Portugal and attained her independence in 1882. In the last 25 years, she has been able to expand and diversify production of manufactured goods.

Her industrialization has been in four main sectors namely;

  1. Petroleum and petrochemical industries. She has petrochemical complexes based in the states of Balica, Rio Grande, Dosul and Sao Paulo.
  2. Motor vehicle industry. The country has earned a lot of forex through the massive manufacture and sale of motor vehicles since 1997.
  3. Aircraft and aerospace industry. The Brazilian Space Agency (AEB) and the National Institute of Space Research (NPE) have been involved in the Brazilian space programme which comprises the construction of satellites and launching of space craft.
  4. Electricity generation industry. The main source of Brazilian electric energy is water. In 1996, 92 % of all her electricity power generation was HEP.

Factors that have facilitated industrialization in Brazil

  1. a) Availability of Cheap and both skilled and unskilled labour from the country’s large population especially after the abolition of slave trade.
  2. b) Plentiful natural resources. For example mineral supplies like gold, coal, iron ore, uranium, and manganese etc, agricultural raw materials like coffee, sugarcane, cocoa and maize and forest resources are a great boost to industrialization
  3. c) Availability of hydro-electricity as early as 1905 to boost industrialization. Coal is also available.
  4. d) Foreign capital. There was heavy influx of foreign capital from countries such as the USA,Canada, Britain, Portugal and France which led to establishment of industries in the country.
  5. e) Improved transport and communication. Railway lines were constructed in most parts of Brazil thus opening the interior areas for the exploitation of natural resources and

transportation of manufactured goods.

  1. f) Good economic policies adopted by President Getulio Vargas (1930-1945) have contributed to industrialization in Brazil. He encouraged the development of transport and communication. He encouraged the harnessing of HEP. He Provided loans and subsidies to certain industries. Adopted protectionist policies of imposing heavy duties on imports. He encouraged exploitation of oil.
  2. g) Development of banking in major Brazilian cities such as Manaus, Salvador, Brasilia and Sao Paulo facilitated provision of loans to individuals who wanted to venture in business.
  3. h) Large Internal and external markets. Increased Trade between Brazil and other countries has led to growth of external market to supplement the available market locally.
  4. i) The World War II which made it hard for her to import goods from Europe thus compelling her to manufacture her own goods.

Obstacles to industrialization in Brazil.

  1. a) High levels of poverty (more than 40% of the population is poor) meaning low purchasing power. Governments also spent most of their resources to subsidize the basic needs of their citizens at the expense of industrialization.
  2. b) Inability to fully exploit her natural resources especially those found in low population

zones like the south where labour for exploitation is lacking.

  1. c) Huge foreign debt. A lot of money is being used to service these debts at the expense of industrialization.
  2. d) Poor technology. The use of appropriate technology for exploitation of natural resources and manufacturing of goods is still lagging behind in Brazil.
  3. e) Stiff completion from the industrialized nations like USA and Western Europe that produce high quality products and have an advanced marketing system for their goods.
  4. f) The resources of Brazil are monopolized by the multinational companies that are based there. The government therefore has no freedom to exploit them for use in industries.

SOUTH AFRICA

She attained majority rule in 1994 after a long struggle against the apartheid regime. The country has achieved great strides in industrialization with many industries including iron and steel industries, engineering, locomotive, chemical, textile, cement, light industries and tourism

Factors influencing industrialization in South Africa

  1. a) The country is endowed with mineral resources such as gold, diamonds, Iron etc.
  2. b) Availability of Cheap and both skilled and unskilled labour from the country’s large population.
  3. c) Availability of natural resources. For example mineral supplies like gold, lead, iron ore, uranium, manganese, Zinc, Bauxite, Tin, Chromium, Tungsten, Phosphate etc. some of these resources are in plenty and are exported to earn forex.
  4. d) Development of hydro-electricity has boosted industrialization. Coal is also available from the Witwatersrand.
  5. e) Development of transport and communication. Railway lines, water and road network have been improved thus opening the resources for the exploitation and for transportation of manufactured goods. Air transport is also well developed thus enhancing business operations.
  6. f) Availability of capital from her trade in other materials.
  7. g) Government support. The government has adopted sound economic policies that promote industrialization. For example imposing heavy tariffs on the imported commodities as a means of protecting local industries, encouraging foreign entrepreneurs to invest in the country and encouraging local investors.
  8. h) South Africa is endowed with a variety of tourist attractions like wildlife which boost the tourism industry.
  9. i) Large Internal and external markets. Increased Trade between South Africa and other

countries especially after end of the apartheid rule has led to growth of external market to supplement the available market locally.

Challenges facing industrialization in South Africa.

  1. a) Long periods of apartheid rule was accompanied with sometimes violent resistance and struggle for majority rule which created an atmosphere not conducive for investment
  2. b) The country suffered long periods of economic sanctions imposed by the United Nations between 1948 and 1994 which affected her manufactured goods that could not access external markets.
  3. c) There were rampant industrial strikes in the country, during the apartheid regime which affected industrialization.
  4. d) The HIV and AIDS scourge has ravaged the country’s labour force thus seriously undermining the industrial efforts.
  5. e) There is stiff completion from the industrialized nations in Western Europe that produce high quality products and have an advanced marketing system for their goods.
  6. f) High levels of insecurity which, at times, discourages would-be foreign investors.
  7. g) High levels of poverty in South Africa mean low purchasing power. Manufactured goods perform poorly locally.

India.

Since India’s independence from Britain in 1947, the country has continued to experience extensive industrialization

Factors that facilitated India’s industrialization.

  1. a) Existence of good industrial base from the textile and leather industries. The British governor Lord Dalhousie also laid a good foundation for industrialization by promoting road construction and cotton growing.
  2. b) Also cottage industries like smithing and textiles existed in India long before colonialism. This formed the basis for modern industries
  3. c) Availability of Cheap and both skilled and unskilled labour from the country’s large population which is almost at a billion mark
  4. d) Existence of raw materials. For example mineral supplies like iron ore, manganese and coal allowed development of heavy industries. Cotton was also available as a textile industry raw material
  5. e) Development of energy sources like coal and hydro-electricity has boosted industrialization. Other sources of energy include oil, natural gas and nuclear energy..
  6. f) Development of transport and communication. The great trunk road from Calcutta to Punjab and sea transport development has led to resource exploitation and transportation of manufactured goods. Communication services have also been greatly improved.
  7. g) Good technical and scientific education available in India has produced experts who are in great demand in industry and agriculture.
  8. h) Availability of capital from her trading contacts with European countries like Portugal, Britain, France and Holland.
  9. i) Good national development plans. In the first five-year development plan of 1951, the government adopted sound economic policies that prioritized agriculture especially modern farming. The second phase emphasized industrialization, especially decentralization if industries to high population areas where labour and market existed.
  10. j) The government has imposed protective tariffs on the imported commodities as a means of protecting local industries.
  11. k) Political stability. India has enjoyed a long period of political stability since her independence thus giving investors’ confidence.
  12. l) Development of banking in India has enabled farmers and industrialists to access credit facilities.

Challenges facing industrialization in India

  1. a) Competition from goods manufactured in the developed countries; the developed nations produce goods of high quality than those manufactured by the Indian industries.
  2. b) High population in India requires that the government spare enough capital to feed the people. The government spends a lot of revenue in developing agriculture to feed her people.
  3. c) High poverty levels i.e. majority of the Indian population is poor and do not have adequate purchasing power for her manufactured goods/ the local market is therefore limited.
  4. d) Lack of efficient communication and transportation infrastructure hence poor movement of goods and labour.
  5. e) Natural calamities e.g. drought and floods that destroy raw materials for industries.
  6. f) Political conflicts e.g. with neighboring Pakistan, and the civil unrest hinders industrial development.

URBANIZATION

This is the process by which people are attracted to live in towns or large settlements.

An urban centre is any area with a human population of 20,000 people or more.

Early Urbanization.

Some of the early urban centres in Africa included Cairo, Meroe/Merowe and Kilwa.

Factors that influenced development of urban centres in Africa.

  1. a) Existence of transport routes-Meroe/Merowe located at an intersection of transport routes.
  2. b) Availability of water for irrigation which increased food production and influenced growth of towns e.g. Cairo.
  3. c) Industrial development –areas of industries grew up as towns since they attracted laborers e.g. Cairo.
  4. d) Commercial activities like trade-location along trade routes.
  5. e) Strategic location which ensured security and thus ample growth e.g. Kilwa.
  6. f) Growth of religion –some grew rapidly because they were religious centres.
  7. g) Mining –led to development of towns’ e.g. Meroe, Johannesburg.

Cairo.

This is the capital city of Egypt. The city was founded in 969 AD when the conquerors from Tunisia, ‘The Fatimid Dynasty’ invaded and conquered Egypt

Factors for the growth of Cairo

  1. a) The Nile River provided water for domestic use and was also a means of transport. This enabled Cairo to grow.
  2. b) Availability of water for irrigation which increased food production and influenced growth of Cairo.
  3. c) Industrial development –various industries developed in Cairo. Food processing industries and construction works. The industries attracted migrants from rural areas.
  4. d) Fertile Nile Valley. the Valley had adequate rainfall and the river always carried silt which it deposited downstream to provide
  5. e) The Suez Canal which was opened in 1869 opened a new trade route which encouraged the arrival of thousands of Europeans. Commercial, administrative and public buildings were constructed during this time.
  6. f) Commercial activities like trade-location along trade routes. The Strategic location along the Nile attracted caravans which would pass through Cairo from North, west and Central Africa
  7. g) The opening of the Aswan High Dam in 1902 enhanced food production through irrigation thus influencing Cairo’s growth.
  8. h) The effects of the two world wars which disrupted Egypt’s trade with other countries thus compelling her to find ways of substituting imports. This boosted industrialization
  9. i) Cairo is a cultural centre being home to treasures preserved from the early Egyptian civilization and Islamic culture in their museums. ‘The city of a thousand Minarets’.
  10. j) Cairo also grew as a centre of education and medicine. Several institutions of higher learning such as the University of Cairo, American University and Azar University contributed to this.

Functions of Cairo

  1. a) It was a national capital and a political centre of the Arab world.
  2. b) It serves as the transport and commercial centre of North Africa and the Middle East.
  3. c) It is a recreational centre housing many recreational facilities like stadiums and entertainment halls
  4. d) Cairo has been a historical centre being the house to the Egyptian civilization for over 5000 years
  5. e) Cairo serves as an industrial centre. Many of these developed during the industrialization process. For example, textile, vehicle and communication equipment assembly plants.

Cairo faces the following problems today;

  1. a) High population. Cairo is the largest city in Africa and the Middle East. One fifth of Egypt’s population stays in Cairo. In 1988, her population was 11 million.
  2. b) Scarcity of food. The high population in the city has caused food shortage.
  3. c) The number of unemployed people in Cairo is increasing every year mainly due to the high rate of migration to the city and the natural population increase.
  4. d) Housing problems. Between the Nile and the main airport, between 250,000 to 900,000 poor people have put up shanties. This area is commonly reffered to as the ‘city of Death’.
  5. e) Traffic jams.
  6. f) Pollution from the industries, vehicle exhaust, desert storms and garbage burning.
  7. g) High crime rate. This is mostly due to the high unemployment level

Solutions to the problems facing Cairo.

  1. a) The food shortage problem is being tackled through reclaiming land for agriculture. The Aswan high Dam provides water for irrigation.
  2. b) The housing problem is being addressed by constructing industries in the suburbs to reduce the population in the city.
  3. c) Traffic jams have been eased through the launching of the Cairo Metro in 1987, which was Africa’s first subway system, which serves the Ramses station to the north and Helwan area to the south. It conveys 60,000 passengers per hour.

Meroe/Merowe.

This was the second capital of the kingdom of Kush and emerged as a city in 650 BC. It rose to become an important industrial centre and specifically iron working producing weapons, hunting and farming tools.

Factors for growth of Meroe.

  1. a) Existence of transport routes-Meroe/Merowe was located at an intersection of transport routes (from east via the red sea and from north via Egypt). This promoted trade with other parts of the world.
  2. b) Abundance of wood fuel, from the heavily forested Blue Nile / white Nile intersection area, which was a key to the prosperity of the iron-working industry.
  3. c) Mining –Merowe was located in a region endowed with a lot of iron.

Social effects of the growth of Merowe

  1. a) The Merotic language developed to replace the Egyptian language previously used by the Nubian founders of Merowe.
  2. b) New architectural developments took place in the region. These were characterized by tombs where rulers were buried after death, ruins of temples, palaces and homes.
  3. c) Other industries developed besides the iron working industry. For example, weaving of cotton, cloth and pottery

Functions of Meroe during the colonial period

  1. a) Meroe was a centre of iron working hence an early industrial centre.
  2. b) A mining centre since Meroe had iron ore, which it mined.
  3. c) A religious function since it had many temples where people worshipped their gods. The priests who headed the Meroe church had their headquarters in Meroe.
  4. d) It was a centre of trade.
  5. e) It was an administrative and political centre.
  6. f) Transport centre-major trade routes converged and radiated from Meroe.

Factors that led to decline of Merowe

  1. a) The rise of Axum kingdom of Ethiopia which denied her access to the red sea.
  2. b) The increasing desertification of the region, perhaps due to the rapid deforestation.

The city began declining in 350 BC.

Kilwa

The town is among the city states that developed along the east African coast. Her greatness was due to the Persian influence. One of its Shirazi rulers from Banadir Coast in Persia, Ali Ibn Hassan, transformed the town into a large city.The sultan erected a stone citadel to protect the island from external enemies. He also forced other conquered city-states to pay tribute to Kilwa.Later on Sultan al-Hassan Ibn Sulaiman I built the Great mosque of Kilwa in 1270 AD and a luxurious palace referred to by historians as Husuni Kubwa.

Factors influencing the growth of Kilwa

  1. a) Exemplary leadership provided by the Shirazi Leaders who kept enemies off and forced the neighbouring city-states to pay tribute to Kilwa.
  2. b) The strategic location of Kilwa enabled her to attract merchants as it was a convenient stopping place.
  3. c) Monopoly of the sofala Gold Trade. The control of the Sofala Gold trade had fallen in the hands of Kilwa by 1300 AD
  4. d) The gleaming buildings of Kilwa such as the great Mosque and palace made her the Jewel of the Zenj Coast, minting her own coins to add to her prosperity.. the mosque became a tourist attraction later own

Functions of Kilwa.

  1. a) It was a major trading centre flourishing mainly due to the gold trade.
  2. b) It was a major defence centre since it was heavily fortified against external aggression by a stone citadel.
  3. c) It was a religious centre. Mosques for Islamic worship were located at Kilwa e.g the great mosque.
  4. d) It was an administrative centre which housed palaces for the rulers and other rich people.However 14th C AD, Kilwa’s prosperity began to decline due to the following reasons.

Factors that led to the decline of Kilwa.

  1. a) Disruption of the Gold trade/ civil wars among communities.
  2. b) Dynastic rivalries/ family feuds.
  3. c) Series of rebellions among some of the towns.
  4. d) Conquest by the Portuguese who even burnt the towns.

Factors that led to the collapse of early urban centres in pre-colonial Africa

  1. a) Collapse of state system and kingdoms for example Kush collapse and the coastal city states.
  2. b) Collapse of trade and their economic systems e.g. the trans-Saharan trade and long distance trade.
  3. c) Collapse of Arab influence I east Africa and east Africa.
  4. d) Impact of Portuguese conquest leading to destruction of towns like manda and decline of others.
  5. e) Introduction of new types of trade e.g. legitimate trade which replaced slave trade.
  6. f) European colonization brought in a new social political and economic order.
  7. g) Exhaustion of mineral resources e.g. gold as in case of sofala and Kilwa as well as Meroe. Some minerals lost value.
  8. h) Changes in transport routes as new roads by-passed some towns thus diverting trade to other centres e.g. Timbuktu
  9. i) As a result of stiff competition, some towns dwindled as others expanded.

Early urban centres in Europe

Athens

This is one of the early states in ancient Greece that flourished after the Persian wars of between 490-480 BC.Athens developed from a farming settlement situated in a defensive site. It had many beautiful buildings such as the Parthenon (a large temple built between 460 and 430 BC in honour of Athena, the goddess of Athens). The acropolis was the highest part of the town.Athens had narrow streets and some of its houses were made of unbaked bricks or mud and thatched roofs.There were frequent outbreaks of diseases due to poor sanitation.The concept of democracy first developed in Athens. At the centre of the city was a market, Agora, which was used as an assembly hall for debates.Athenians were divided into four classes.

  1. a) First class –the richest that were the most heavily taxed.
  2. b) Second class- provided the cavalry for the army.
  3. c) Third class- provided the soldiers for the infantry.
  4. d) The fourth class- the poorest and who paid no taxes.

Athens began to decline due to the Peloponnesian wars (431-404 BC). It was finally crushed in 338 BC by Phillip of Macedonia.Currently Athens is the capital of Greece with a population of 4 million.

Factors that led to growth of Athens.

  1. a) Trade and commerce. Their soils of the surrounding areas were infertile and, therefore could not support agriculture. The Athenians therefore resorted to trade to obtain foods in exchange for wine, wool and olive oil.
  2. b) Athens was located in an easily defensible place. The town was surrounded by water, valleys and highlands making it difficult for an external enemy to attack.
  3. c) Religious activities. The area was a worship centre. People coming to the Parthenon temple contributed to the growth of the town.
  4. d) Accessibility and communication network. The port of Athens was located about six kilometres from the city thus making Athens a transport centre.
  5. e) Availability of water.

Functions of Athens.

  1. a) It was a cultural centre. The Greeks loved to watch play. In Athens, there was the great theatre of Epidaurus.
  2. b) An educational centre. In Athens, every person was taught how to read and write. Athens became a centre of scholarly work producing great thinkers like Socrates, Plato, Pythagoras, Archimedes and Aristotle.
  3. c) Athens was a sports centre. There were Gymnasiums where boys were taught games which were developed into what came to be known as Olympics.
  4. d) Religious centre. The Parthenon temple was a great manifestation of this function. People coming to the Parthenon temple contributed to the growth of the town.

London.

The capital city of England, it is situated on the estuary of the river Thames. Its name is derived from the name Llyn Dun which means ‘Celtic Lake Fort’.  The town developed during the Roman rule in Britain in A.D 43.By 314 AD London had become an early centre of Christianity.In 1381, the city was adversely affected by a serious peasant, revolt that led to massive destruction of property.By 18th c, London had emerged as an elegant city though however also with numerous urban related problems. In 1890, it hosted the world’s first electric train.

Factors influencing growth of London

  1. a) Trade-money obtained from trading was used to build the city.
  2. b) Industrialization-industry such as textile, ship building, metal works, etc led to the growth of London.
  3. c) Improved transport –London is well served by a network of railway and roads. This facilitated the movement of goods and people.
  4. d) Shipping activities-there are many harbours in London enabling expanded loading and unloading activities
  5. e) Population growth.
  6. f) London was the seat of government for a very long time.

Functions of London

  1. a) It was a transport and communication centre. The city was inter-connected with roads which served various parts of Britain. The city houses the main international airports on UK. E.g. Heathrow- the busiest airport in the world.
  2. b) It is a political and administrative capital with offices for the Prime Minister and cabinet. The Monarchical offices are also located here.
  3. c) It is a commercial centre. Many financial institutions such as banks and other commercial and trading activities attract a lot of traders.
  4. d) An industrial centre. London was an early centre of the textile industry. There are light service industries in the city.
  5. e) It is an educational centre, housing institutions like the oxford university, the University of London, founded in 1836, etc.
  6. f) London is a historical centre. The city has theatres for the performance of cultural activities and museums which display artefacts of Historical importance.

Problems of London

Like many large cities worldwide, London has its share of problems:

  1. a) Overcrowding,
  2. b) Unemployment has continued to increase with the growing population. In 1988, for example, nearly 1 in 8 people were unemployed throughout London and the situation in the inner city was worst
  3. c) Poor housing and homelessness. This has led to development of slums.
  4. d) Transportation is another problem. However, an excellent public system has helped to alleviate this.
  5. e) Air pollution continues to be a major challenge.
  6. f) Rural-urban migration by the job seekers causing overcrowding in the city.
  7. g) This was a greater problem in London in the initial stages.

Modern cities in Africa.

Nairobi.

Nairobi developed as a depot and camp for the railway workers during the construction of the kenya-Uganda railway

Factors influencing the growth of Nairobi

  1. a) Excellent location in an area almost midway between Mombasa and Lake Victoria.
  2. b) There was adequate supply of water.
  3. c) The land was suitable for construction of workshops as it was flat.
  4. d) The climate was suitable for Europeans. Cool temperatures at an altitude of 1700m.
  5. e) It was surrounded by a fertile countryside producing adequate foods.
  6. f) Transfer of the seat of the colonial government in 1907.

Functions of Nairobi.

  1. g) It was a transport and communication centre. The city is inter-connected with roads which served various parts of the country. The city houses the main international airport- JKIA.
  2. h) It is an administrative capital with offices for the head of state, cabinet, parliament and department of defence.
  3. i) It is a regional headquarter of various international bodies like UN, ILO etc.
  4. j) It is a commercial and financial centre. Many financial institutions such as banks and other commercial and trading activities attract a lot of traders.
  5. k) An industrial centre. Nairobi’s industrial area hosts many key industries in Kenya and east Africa.
  6. l) It is an educational centre, housing institutions like the University of Nairobi, kenya polytechnic and other key institutions
  7. m) It is a tourist centre. The town boasts of various tourist attractions such as the Nairobi National Park, National Museums etc.

Problems facing Nairobi

  1. a) Rural-urban migration by the job seekers causing overcrowding in the city.
  2. b) Unemployment has continued to increase with the growing population.
  3. c) Poor housing. The population growth in Nairobi to 3 million has not corresponded to the development of housing.
  4. d) Inadequate social services including health services and educational facilities.
  5. e) Congestion on roads caused by an increase in the number of vehicles on the roads while the road network is not expanding.
  6. f) Poor town planning has led to poor drainage, especially during heavy rains when a lot of flooding occurs
  7. g) Pollution continues to be a major challenge in Nairobi. The factories located in the city are a cause of air and noise pollution.
  8. h) Water shortage caused by the high rate of expansion in the town and the depletion odf water reservoirs.
  9. i) The rate of HIV/AIDS infection is very high.

Solutions to these problems

  1. a) New housing projects are being developed. For example the Mathare slums upgrading project.
  2. b) The education and other social services are being provided through a cost-sharing scheme between the government and the town dwellers.
  3. c) The government is addressing the transport/congestion problem through the upgrading of the Thika superhighway to an eight lane highway; the Nairobi Syokimau Railway service was commissioned by president Kibaki I November 2012 to de-congest jogoo road. Etc.
  4. d) The government is encouraging the expansion of the informal sector as an alternative source of employment.
  5. e) The government is rehabilitating street families by taking them to school s to acquire relevant skills to make them useful to the nation.
  6. f) New water projects have been put in place. For example, the third Nairobi water Project from River Chania.
  7. g) The government is sensitizing, through NGOs and GOs, civilians about responsible sex as a measure to curb the spread of HIV/AIDS.

Johannesburg.

The city started as a mining camp in 1886 after the discovery of gold in the Witwate-rsrand. This attracted thousands of people coming to prospect for minerals and seek for employment. By the end of 19thc, the population of Johannesburg had risen to 166,000 people.

Factors which contributed to the growth of Johannesburg

  1. a) Existence of minerals/discovery of gold in the Witwatersrand which resulted in a rush of people to the area.
  2. b) Availability of energy i.e. coal which was an important source of energy to the mines, industries and homes.
  3. c) Excellent location in the veldt/plain making construction work easy.
  4. d) Its proximity to Vaal River which supplied plenty of water to industries and domestic use.
  5. e) Area around Johannesburg is fertile and therefore agriculturally productive ensuring steady supply of food.
  6. f) The organization of the city council which has ensured that financial control and revenue collection is effectively and the city able to manage its growth problems.
  7. g) Government policy of supporting industrial development. This has favored its growth.

Functions of Johannesburg.

  1. a) It was a transport and communication centre. The city has a highly develope d network of transport lines since it served the mining industry. In June 2010, it became the first city in Africa to house an electric train service.
  2. b) An industrial centre. Its manufacturing functions include mining, metalwork, engineering, diamond cutting, jewellery manufacturing and food processing.
  3. c) It is a commercial and financial centre. Many financial institutions such as banks and other commercial and trading activities attract a lot of traders. It is also a major shopping centre in South Africa.
  4. d) It is an educational centre, housing institutions like the University of Witwatersrand, teacher training colleges and other key institutions.

Problems facing Johannesburg

  1. a) The problem of racial segregation. The black Africans who work around Johannesburg were often treated almost as slaves though they were the majority in the country.
  2. b) Poor housing. Most of the workers who work in and around Johannesburg live in shanties, mainly because of underpayment
  3. c) Unemployment has continued to increase with the growing population. Though the city is an industrial town, her industries have failed to provide sufficient employment for all people in the town.
  4. d) Rural-urban migration by the job seekers causing overcrowding in the city.
  5. e) A large gap between the affluent class, especially the Europeans and the poor people who majorly are African
  6. f) Congestion on roads caused by an increase in the number of vehicles on the roads while the road network is not expanding.
  7. g) The city has the highest crime rate in the world.
  8. h) Inadequate social services including health services and educational facilities.
  9. i) Water shortage caused by the high rate of expansion in the town and the depletion ofwater reservoirs.
  10. j) The rate of HIV/AIDS infection is very high.

Solutions to the problems

  1. a) The apartheid regime was ended in 1994 thus ending the problem of racial segregation.
  2. b) The new government of South Africa is trying to come up with better housing estates.
  3. c) Crime has been contained by creating more job opportunities.
  4. d) The government is sensitizing, through NGOs and GOs, civilians about responsible sex as a measure to curb the spread of HIV/AIDS

Impact of agrarian development on urbanization in Africa

  1. a) The practice of agriculture forced people to adopt a sedentary lifestyle. Such settlement formed the basis of the earliest urban centres.
  2. b) Early agriculture led to specialization. The areas where the potters, iron smelters weavers and fishermen did their work grew up into urban centres
  3. c) From the agrarian revolution, there was adequate food for town dwellers.

On urbanization in Europe

  1. a) The revolution in Europe led to a landless society who moved to urban centres seeking employment. This promoted urban growth.
  2. b) Increased agricultural production ensured steady supply of raw materials to the new industries hence further growth of the industries.
  3. c) Agricultural expansion meant the big farmers had to borrow loans hence the expansion of banking facilities in towns leading to further growth.
  4. d) Agricultural produce entering and leaving countries had to be handled in ports hence towns near coasts grew.

Impacts of industrial revolution on urbanization in the world.

  1. a) The establishment of many factories drew many people to towns in search of employment, the mining industry attracted many people to work in the mines. The mining camps soon grew up into towns.
  2. b) Industrial revolution stimulated innovations in transport and communication ensuring faster movement of people to further expansion of trading towns.
  3. c) The growth of industry has led to expansion of port towns to handle increased

manufactured goods for export and raw material for factories e.g. growth of London, Budapest, Marseilles, Lagos and Cairo.

  1. d) The use of machines replaced human labour and caused layoffs. Those who lost their jabs sometimes became a security risk hence an increase in crime.
  2. e) The many inefficient factories that came up after the revolution have caused massive air and water pollution.
  3. f) Rural urban migration has exerted pressure on the limited resources and services the towns can offer.

Consequences of urbanization on European communities during the 19th c.

  1. a) Rural –urban migration by Africans looking for better opportunities led to increased crime levels and insecurity for the Europeans.
  2. b) Air pollution which also affected them.
  3. c) Creation of employment for the Europeans in the developing industries.
  4. d) Creation of markets for agricultural produce due to increased urban population.
  5. e) Europeans were deprived of cheap African labour as most of them moved to urban areas.

ORGANIZATION OF AFRICAN SOCIETIES

Despite the high amount of decentralization of African communities in the 19th c , there existed a few who were centralized. For example, Buganda, Ethiopia, Buganda, Asante, Mandinka, Ndebele and shona among others.

The Baganda

These were a Bantu speaking people of the Buganda kingdom in Uganda. The Buganda Chiefdom had emerged as early as 140 AD as a subject state of Bunyoro- Kitara Kingdom

Origin of Buganda kingdom

The kingdom was crystallized around the counties of busiro, kyadondo and mawakota.

Traditions also state that the first king and creator of Buganda kingdom was Kintu who came from the east around Mount Elgon region. It is believed he entered Buganda with 13 clans. Other theories attribute Buganda’s origin to the Luo. That Kimera Kato, a brother of Isingoma Rukidi Mpunga the founder of the luo-babito dynasty in Bunyoro was the founder of Buganda.It is also probable that Buganda might have been one of the many kingdoms founded by the bachwezi- the demi-gods.Other clans of Buganda are believed to have come from the ssese islands.

Factors that led to the growth of a strong Buganda Kingdom

  1. a) Good strong and able leaders like Kkyabagu, junju and Suna etc. who propelled it to prosperity by uniting the people and restructuring the existing administration system.
  2. b) Buganda Was small and a compact kingdom and therefore easy to manage. Other kingdoms like Bunyoro-Kitara were too large with a class system.
  3. c) Its strategic location in a defensible position in the lake region was of great advantage over her rivals Toro and Bunyoro. She lay next to Lake Victoria giving her defence, communication and transport advantage. On the east were small states of Toro and Ankole who posed no threat.
  4. d) Good climate and fertile soils in the region. This enabled successful growing of Bananas, their staple crop.
  5. e) The contacts with the Waswahili enabled her to gain riches and weapons/guns.
  6. f) The kingdom had a strong loyal army to defend it from her warring neighbors. The Kabaka even possessed a royal navy that kept guard over Lake Victoria.
  7. g) Existence of a centralized government making the kingdom cohesive.
  8. h) The ganda traditions allowing the kabaka to marry from every clan as means of ensuring unity.
  9. i) System of labour organization. The tradition demanded that farming be done by women while the men were involved in other activities such as politics, carpentry, war, bark cloth making and smithing
  10. j) The wars of conquest which finally led to her expansion.

How Buganda kingdom was governed.

Buganda kingdom had a highly centralized monarchy under the kabaka who enjoyed absolute powers. His position was hereditary. The Kabaka’s Court was the nerve centre of the Baganda community. All symbols of Royal authority were kept in the court. E.g. the throne (Namulondo), royal Drums, spears and stools.  The kabaka was the political leader of the Baganda kingdom. He was the Head of the traditional religion –lubale/ he was the chief priest. He was the judicial head and the final court of appeal/he was the supreme judge. The was the commander-in- -chief of the armed forces.He appointed senior government officials and dismissed them when need arose. He controlled trade.

The capital of the kingdom was at Mengo, where the palace, Lubiri, was situated.

The kabaka appointed senior government officials and dismissed them when need arose. Forexample, he appointed the katikiro, omulamuzi and omuwanika i.e. prime minister, chief justice and treasurer respectively who assisted him in administration. He also appointed mugema (the senior most chief among the Bataka), Musenero (the chief Butler) and Mfumbiro (the chief baker).The katikiro was in charge of organizing tax collecting and public works. He planned wars in the Kabaka’s name. He had to protect the kabaka during war. He was responsible of informing the kabaka of the decisions he made on court issues. Below him were omulamuzi (chief justice) and omuwanika (treasurer) who were directly responsible to the kabaka.The Bataka were minor chiefs in charge of clans, guarded land, collected taxes, carried out conscription to the army and presented the page boys to the kabaka.Peasants served under chief and were to fight in wars. Slaves (badus) served the king chiefs in their homesteads. Pages and bagalagala (sons of chiefs and other nobles) served the kabaka too.To ensure unity the kabaka married from principal clans.There was a Lukiko which advised the kabaka and was the final court. It comprised 69 members who were nominated by the kabaka (positions were not hereditary). It made laws and debated issues concerning the kingdom. It also directed tax collection and planned expenditure, it acted as the final court of appeal, and it represented the needs of the people to the kabaka. It helped the kabaka in general administration. It checked the activities of government.

Political organization

The kingdom was divided into counties (Ssaza) and sub-counties. Each county was under Ssaza chiefs whose position was hereditary initially before the kabaka began to appoint them as a means of making them accountable. Each Ssaza was divided into a gombolola headed by a gombolola chief, who maintained law and order and collected taxes. The gombololas were further divided into smaller sub-divisions called miluka each under a miluka chief. The miluka was divided into kisoko. The smallest administrative unit among the Baganda was the village council. The Abatongole appointed by the kabaka, governed the vassal states

Social organization of the Baganda

The kingdom was divided in social classes with the royal family occupying the top of the hierarchy, then ruling class, the chiefs who ruled over the peasants or commoners known as bakopi.At the bottom of the social class were the slaves (Badu) who were acquired mainly through raids on neighbouring communities such as Busoga, Toro and Bunyoro.

The Baganda believed in the existence of many gods some of whom included;

  1. a) Katonda, God the creator whose home was in heaven. The prayers to him were done every morning and were conducted by the head of the homestead.
  2. b) Kibuuka, God of war and thunder.
  3. c) Mukasa, goddess of fertility who was worshipped in order to bless the nation with more children, livestock and a bumper harvest.
  4. d) Kiwanuka, god of lightning.
  5. e) Nawagenyi, goddess of Drought.

The community also believed in the existence of ancestral spirits whose main responsibilitywas to maintain discipline in the clans since the spirits were believed to restrict their influence to close relatives. Balubaale were the spirits of people who had supernatural powers and were consulted through prophets or mediums.

The Baganda had religious leaders, led by the kabaka, then the mediums, prophets, and medicine people.There also existed sorcerers called Balopo who were feared since they could cause harm to people.The Baganda religion however was greatly undermined by the influx of the Waswahili and ArabMuslims into the community in the 19th c.

The Baganda society was polygamous. For example, the kabaka was required to marry from all clans to maintain links in the society.There was division of labour according to sex. Women tilled the land while men engaged in warfare, built houses, and made clothes from bark-cloth.As a form of rite of passage, the Baganda went through formal education that trained them in their rites.

Economic organization.

  1. a) Buganda’s economy was based on agriculture and the production of the staple food bananas (matoke).
  2. b) The baganda also kept large herds of livestock. The bahima herded Kabaka’s herds. From the livestock, they obtained milk and meat to supplement their diet.
  3. c) The baganda conducted raids on their neighbours like the Buddu, Busoga and Kyaggwe through which they acquired slaves, livestock and ivory.
  4. d) There was division of labour, women worked in fields while men were involved in construction of roads, bark cloth making, smithing and war.
  5. e) The kingdom was deeply involved in local, regional and international trade. They exchanged bark cloth and beans for cattle from their neighbours. She exchanged slaves and hides for guns, glassware and cotton cloth from coastal traders.
  6. f) The baganda practiced iron working, producing hoes for cultivation and weapons for defence. Some of these items formed their trade items. Rich iron deposits were also acquired by waging wars against their neighbours.
  7. g) Handcraft was an important activity and included basketry and pottery.
  8. h) The textile industry consisted of bark cloth manufacture.
  9. i) Salt mining was an important activity.
  10. j) Fishing on Lake Victoria
  11. k) The baganda also engaged in some hunting activities to acquire ivory.

SHONA

The Shona were a Bantu-speaking people who comprised the Rozwi, Kore kore, Zezuru and Manyika sub-groups. The first stone buildings in Zimbabwe are believed to have been the work of the Shona. Their capital was at Mapungubwe, south of the confluence of the Limpopo and Shashi rivers.About 1450 AD, the Rozwi Groups gained dominance and established a centralized political system. They established the Mwene Mutapa Empire which ruled until the time of the Ngoni invasion in the 1830s.

Political organization of the Mwene Mutapa Empire

The emperor was the head of the state and government. Succession of authority was hereditary. Important emperors included Chikura, Nyatsimba, Mutota and Matope.

Religion played a role in government and united people. The emperor was a semi-divinereligious leader, a military leader and the chief priest. He was the only one who could communicate with the spirits of the ancestors. It was believed that when Mwene Mutapa died, he became a Mudzimu and automatically qualified to be worshipped as a national ancestral spirit.The ancestral spirits (Vadzimu) communicated people’s problems to god.Religion also influenced laws.The priests were used as spies and link between the emperor and the people.

Another unifying factor in the kingdom was the royal fire. It was from the continuous fire that each vassal chief carried a flame to his chiefdom that he kept burning as a symbol of national unity.The empire was divided into provinces namely Guruhaswa, Mbire, Utere, Banua, and Manyika each headed by a lesser chief. The most important chiefs in the empire sent their sons, with tribute in form of cattle, gold, slaves and ivory, each year to pay homage to the Mwene Mutapa as goodwill ambassadors.There was a standing army of warriors which was used for defence and expansion of the kingdom. Revenue from trade was used to run the army and sustain the empire.The position of importance held by Mwene Mutapa led to the creation of a complex Style of administration around him.

The government officials included the court steward, treasurer, commander-in-chief of the army and Mbokurumme (king’s sister-in-law). Others were the queen mother, the emperor’s sister and nine principal wives, the doorkeeper and the chief cook and head drummer. At the lower level were the lesser chiefs who paid tribute to the king by providing cattle, labour and agricultural produce.

Economic organization of the Shona.

The Shona country enjoyed ample rainfall with fertile soils thus enabling them to engage in the following economic activities;

  1. a) The Shona were mixed farmers who cultivated crops and reared animals. Among the agricultural produce were corn, millet, ground nuts, beans, watermelons, tomatoes, fruits and cabbages.
  2. b) The Shona practiced trade, specifically long distance trade between them and the Arabs and Waswahili at sofala. They gave Gold and ivory for cotton cloths, glassware, copper items, guns, daggers and knives.
  3. c) They were skillful hunters. They hunted elephants for their ivory which was in great demand. They also gathered wild honey and wild fruits to supplement their diet.
  4. d) The shona were skilled craftsmen who made articles like spears, hoes and knives. Others were goldsmiths who used gold to decorate. They also practiced cloth making from wild cotton and bark fibres.

Social organization of the Shona

Among the shona, Mwene Mutapa was regarded as a divine king and was therefore venerated. When he was well, the nation was also well.The shona religion was based on the Mwari cult. They believed in the all powerful God, Mwari/Murungu. His worship was done through several priests who were mainly produced by the Rozwi clan. The priests presided over religious functions in sacred places of worship, shrines where sacrifices were offered.The shona believed in ancestral spirits. They had two kinds of spirits, Vadzimu or family spirits and Mhondoro or clan spirits. The spirits communicated though an intermediary, Svikiro, a departed family or clan spirit.The shona had a national spirit Chamiruka who settled clan disputes and also protected the people against injustice in the government.The shona had a kinship system which was patrilineal (inheritance through the father). The shona were divided into clans whose names were coined from animals like leopard, monkey, elephant etc. it was a taboo to consume meat from such animals.They were a polygamous community which was viewed as a means to enable the family to have enough members to provide labour.The shona lived in stone buildings. Their skill in masonry is associated with the ruins of Mapungubwe found in Zimbabwe.

The Asante

The Asante are one of the Akan-speaking peoples who occupy the southern part of Ghana, west Africa. By the middle 18th c, the Asante/Ashanti had established the most dominant state in modern Ghana.

Origin of the Asante Kingdom

The empire Developed in the 1670’s. It was formed as a result of competition for gold fields in the Akan forestland. In the 1500’s: Akan peoples came into contact with Portuguese traders. Wealthy owners of the Akan gold mines begin to trade gold for Benin slaves with the Portuguese. In the 1670’s, Osei Tutu was a military leader and head of the Oyoko clan of the Akan peoplesTook control over a trade center near Kumasi and established this as his capital city. This happened after his maternal uncle Obiri Yeboa, the leader of the Oyoko clan was killed during war.A company of Akwamu troops are believed to have been instrumental in facilitating Osei Tutu’s rise to power. He conquered the neighboring chiefdoms and took control of their trade. He took the title of ASANTEHENE. He Collected taxes from the chiefdoms on profits from the gold mines. He built a standing army by demanding that chiefdoms provide soldiers. He sought the support of religious leaders throughout the region. For example, a priest of the shrine of the war god (Otutu0 called Anokye in Akwapim played a role in ensuring that Osei Tutu became the Asantehene.). He established the “GOLDEN STOOL” as a symbol of his rightful rule.

The Golden Stool

Akan peoples become Asante (Ashanti)

By 1700, Osei Tutu controlled most of the gold fields of the Akan forestland.Osei Tutu was succeeded by Opoku Ware (1717-1750). During his rule, he will extend the Asante kingdom to include most of what is today present-day Ghana. The new city-states now included Kumasi, Juaben, Bekmai, Mampon, Kokofu and Nsula.Opuku Ware will participate in the slave trade with the Europeans, selling war captives and growing very wealthy. Asante were one of the last great kingdoms to fall to the Europeans in the late 19th century.

Factors that led to the rise and growth of the Asante Empire

  1. a) The Asante had a strong economy based on agriculture. Both food and cash crops like Kola nuts were cultivated. This helped to increase the population.
  2. b) The Asante had capable political leaders they included Obiri Yeboa (1670-1678), Osei Tutu (1680-1717) who unified the people through the Golden stool that he created and Opuku Ware (1720- 1750).
  3. c) The several city-states that emerged around Kumasi supported each other. Most of them were related by the fact that they originated from the same Oyoko clan.
  4. d) The growth of the Trans- Atlantic slave trade brought a lot of wealth to the Asante people.

The wealth was instrumental in the prosperity of the Kingdom.

  1. e) The centralized political system under the Asantehene provided stability.
  2. f) The Odwira festival that was held annually helped to make the state more cohesive.
  3. g) The Asante were brave and proud people, and the need to free themselves from the oppressive rule of Denkyira, their former masters, motivated them to create a strong state.

Political organization

The Asante had a centralized political system. The Nucleus of the Asante Empire was five citystates of Kumasi, Dwaben, Bekwai, Kokofu and Nsula.The empire comprised of three parts, namely Kumasi (Metropolitan Asante), Amatoo states and Provincial Asante. Each part had its own system of administration though the three cooperated in some areas. Kumasi was directly ruled by the Asantehene and was recognized as Kumasihene.

Metropolitan Asante

These were the five states that lay 35 miles around Kumasi and which recognized the Asantehene as the supreme authority. The government of the metropolitan Asante consisted the confederacy council made of the Kings (Omanhene) of the various states and presided over by the Asantehene. The Asante Union provides a good example of a federal system of government. All the states within the metropolitan Asante paid tax to the Asantehene which was used to pay for the administration and form an army.Each of the five states had its own state council that made important decisions. Each also had its own Black stool that symbolized their power over the state .The omanhenes were expected to give the right of declaring war on another Omanhene, attended the annual Odwira festival (to pay allegiance to Asantehene, settle disputes and honor the dead), grant own subjects the right to appeal to the high court set up for the union of the capital and recognize the right of Asantehene to impose national levies.Neither the Asantehene nor the Omanhene enjoyed dictatorial powers.The kingdom had an army that was divided into several wings. Though overall leadership of the army was provided by the Asantehene, each Omanhene command his own forces. The Asantehene was deputized by Mamphohene who automatically take over army leadership whenever the Asantehene was unavailable.Among the Asante, there was compulsory military service for all able-bodied men in the empire (a system borrowed from the Akwamu).The Asantehene established a national festival called the Odwira festival during which all The Omanhene assembled in Kumasi to show their loyalty to the Asantehene, to honor the deadand to solve disputes amongst themselves. It also enhanced unity amongst the Asante states.

The golden stool, an idea invented by a priest called Okomfo Anokye (he claimed it came from the sky in 1695) during the reign of Osei Tutu, made the office of the Asantehene acceptable. It was a source of unity as it bound together the Asante states since they all recognized its sacredness.

Provincial Asante

It comprised all the states conquered by the Asante in the 18th century (subject states). Such people were represented in the army and paid taxes to the Asantehene. Osei Tutu appointed two consuls who resided in each subject state to supervise their affairs. An efficient bureaucracy was established in each o the provincial Asante states with the Asantehene appointing senior officials directly himself

Social organization

The Kingdom was composed of many communities who spoke the Akan language. The clans that made up the Akan speakers included the Akyem, Kwahu, the Fante, the Wassa, the Assin and the Akwapem. All these communities shared the same social institutions like the forty-day calendar, same marriage and naming rites. The basic social unit was the clan.They had a matrilineal system of inheritance. The birthright of each family passed through the mother from one generation to the other.  The practiced polygamy marriage due to wealth and comfort in society and prohibited inter clan (paternal and maternal clans) marriages. The Odwira festival helped unite the society besides the golden stool.

The Asante was socially stratified into social classes e.g. the rulers, rich, peasant farmers and slaves.  The Asantehene and his family comprised the royal family together with the Omanhene. The saves among the Asante were majorly war captives. Some of the female slaves could be elevated to concubines and later become entitled to some rights.They believed in magic and superstition and also worshipped gods and goddesses i.e. they were polytheists. Their supreme creator was Nyame (Nyambe).They believed in their ancestors as mediators between the people and God (gods). The Odwira festival was held annually to honour ancestors and solves my disputes. They offered sacrifices to their gods/ancestors including human sacrifices.The Asante hence was considered semi-divine being and highly regarded. Creative arts like dancing music, sculpture were highly respected in society.

Economic organization of the Asante 

Being located in an area rich in terms of land fertility forest resources, mineral resources and rainfall, the Asante Empire thrived economically in the following ways.

  1. a) Being located at the point of convergence of the trans-Atlantic trade routes, the Asante people participated in the trade providing gold, slaves and ivory in exchange for cotton, cloth, guns and gunpowder. They also provided middlemen and porters during the trade.
  2. b) The Asante practiced agriculture, growing crops like yams, vegetables and fruits. They also kept livestock like cattle.
  3. c) The community practiced gathering of Kola nuts and hunting for game meat from the forestto supplement their diet.
  4. d) They practiced iron working and made crafts such as baskets and pots

The Asante community however became a victim of the same economic wars it waged against her neighbours especially the Fante and Denkyira. In 1873, the British came to the aid of the Fante thus greatly weakening the Asante power.

Reasons for the collapse of the Asante Empire.

  1. a) The type of political organization in the kingdom did not encourage cohesion. Some states in the provincial Asante had no attachment to the golden stool/were semi -independent/ condition of a state within a state.
  2. b) Leadership struggle between the Asante and dwaben; a neighboring rival of Asante’s state.
  3. c) Civil wars /Constant rebellions from the conquered states /wars with other tribes e.g. war with the afante.
  4. d) British interference in the Asante affairs through the 19th they had a burning desire to destroy the Asante empire and colonize the region.. they even supported dwaben in her war against Asantehene
  5. e) Periodic interference with trade and trade routes as a result of wars weakened the financial position of the empire i.e. Abolition of slave trade as a major source of income.
  6. f) The Anglo-Asante wars which the British won led to final destruction of the empire.

CONSTITUTIONS AND CONSTITUTION MAKING

The term ‘constitution’ refers to a set of agreed principles and rules which state the structure and powers of a government.The constitution of Kenya is a supreme law that binds all people and all state organs at national and county level. It outlines the structure of government, defines the powers and prerogatives of the head of state, states the compositions, functions and powers of parliament, states the compositions of the executives and outlines the duties and rights of the citizens. Constitutions vary in various countries depending on different experiences and their form is determined by the following.

  1. a) The historical background of a country
  2. b) Geographical factors. For example the numerous islands of Japan must be catered for in their constitution
  3. c) Religious beliefs of the people. Some countries have the Islamic Sharia law in their constitution e.g Libya and Somali
  4. d) Race composition of a country. For example, in South Africa the apartheid racial policy had been included in their constitution.

Functions of a constitution

  1. a) The constitution provides the legal ground from which the laws of the country are made.
  2. b) It spells out the powers of government and its relationship to the gove rned.
  3. c) It spells out the rights and duties of all citizens. It also provides the options a citizen has, legally, if those rights and freedoms are violated.

Types of constitutions

  1. Written constitution.

This is a constitution in which the basic principles concerning the organization of government, powers of its various agencies and rights of the subjects are consciously written down in one document.The first country to adopt a written constitution was USA after she attained political independence from Britain on 4th July 1776. France adopted it in 1791following the French revolution of 1789. The primary objective of these adoptions was to include the rights of the citizens to avoid abuse by those in power.

Other countries with written constitutions include many European, African, Latin American and Asian countries. Kenya also has a written constitution.

Characteristics of a written constitution

  1. a) It acts as a standard of reference to which the acts of the government of the day may always be compared.
  2. b) It is a rigid document that cannot be altered easily.
  3. c) It is only amended through a clearly spelt out procedure which is followed to the letter.
  4. d) There must be a special body entrusted by the legislature with the work of drafting the constitution.
  5. e) Once drafted the constitution must get the approval of the legislature.

Advantages of a written constitution

  1. a) Since the procedures of amending a constitution are clearly spelled out, it is not easy for politicians or other interest groups in the society to alter it.
  2. b) In case of a crisis, the constitution provides very clear guidelines on the procedures to be followed, thus restoring stability in the country.
  3. c) Since a written constitution is rigid, it therefore recognizes that there are fundamentals in a state, e.g rights of citizens, powers and duties of the president, which should never be easily changed. Change can only be done after adequate consideration.
  4. d) It is fundamental to a newly formed nation so as to take off in an orderly and organized manner.
  5. e) A written constitution is important to ensure that the identity of the various groups are preserved and maintained in a country with diverse racial groupings, religion and ethnic composition.
  6. f) Since it is arrived at after thorough and careful consideration by all, it therefore unites the people in the nation as it would have acquired recognition and acceptance from the majority of the citizens.

Disadvantages of a written constitution.

  1. a) Due to its rigidity, it can fail to respond to changing circumstances and can therefore easily become obsolete.
  2. b) A written constitution tends to make the judiciary too powerful as it I the only body that interprets the document. Where the executive and the legislature control the judiciary, the constitution can easily be manipulated.
  3. c) Some written constitutions are too detailed and rarely understood by the ordinary citizens.
  4. d) The procedure for amending the constitution is slow and costly. This causes delays which could lead to civil disorder in a society.
  5. Unwritten constitution

This is a constitution where the fundamental principles of the organization and powers of the government are not contained in one document but rather in several scattered documents to add to the customs of a country. For example, the British constitution.

Sources of British constitution

  1. a) This refers to an Act of Parliament. Examples of statutes that comprise the British constitution are;

~  Act of Union with Scotland of 1707 that determined the territorial boundaries within which the United Kingdom’s constitution operates.

~  Parliament Act of 1911 that governs the relationship between the House of

Commons and the House of Representatives

~  The Reform Acts of 1832 and 1834 which determine succession to the throne.

  1. b) This refers to ancient or traditional practices or the common law. For example, the first born inheriting the throne.
  2. c) Laws of precedents. Past accepted principles may be applied to a new set of facts in a judgment and this may eventually become part of the law of the land.
  3. d) Customs of parliament. House procedures including standing orders and other regulations are part of the British constitution.

Key notes for the teacher and students- @Cheloti 2012-2013  82

  1. e) Historical documents. The following two Important documents form part of the British constitution;

~  The Magna Carta (1215AD) that contained the promises by the England King that he would not levy taxes outside the three legal feudal taxes without the consent of the legal counsel.

~  The Petition of Right (1628) in which King Charles I agreed not to levy taxes unless through the Act of Parliament.

  1. f) The Conventions and Practices that have become respected over the years are also part of the British constitution.

Advantages of unwritten constitution

  1. a) It is flexible and adaptable to changing circumstances in the society. This is especially valuable during periods of rapid socio-economic and political changes.
  2. b) It is indigenous and therefore suited for a state.
  3. c) It can be changed by ordinary legislative process.
  4. d) It provides continuity with the nation’s traditions and is therefore accepted and respected by the people.

Disadvantages of an unwritten constitution

  1. a) It gives the courts too much work in handling matters as they search for constitutional principles not only in judicial decisions but in different statutes and customs.
  2. b) Because of the nature of the unwritten constitution, it is not easy to protect the rights of people effectively as the fundamentals of the state are not recorded in a few or a single document.
  3. c) An unwritten constitution tends to be vague and indefinite as compared to the written constitution.
  4. d) An unwritten constitution presupposes that the people are politically conscious and alert and will ensure that their rights and liberties are respected.

Features/qualities of a good constitution.

  1. a) Definiteness; it must depict clear intelligence and one which facilitates thinking. It must define its content clearly.
  2. b) It should be comprehensive/ it must be short but inclusive of all the issues involved in government operation.
  3. c) Should be durable and elastic/ it should neither be too rigid to amend or change nor so flexible as to encourage interference of its basic principle.
  4. d) Should be able to protect fundamental rights and freedom of citizen/a bill of rights must be provided for in the constitution, showing the extent to which the government can interfere with individual rights.
  5. e) Amendment procedure must be stated clearly.
  6. f) The constitution must be representative of the diverse social and political spectrum of the people.
  7. g) It must exhibit supremacy of the people/ it must make the will of the people as the basis of government.
  8. h) It must stipulate the choice of government through free and fair elections
  9. i) Statement of national wealth. /It must have a clear statement on how resources are to be managed and how wealth created is to be distributed.Constitution making process in Kenya in pre-colonial, colonial and post colonial eras.

Pre- colonial era

The rules and regulation that formed the constitutional basis of pre-colonial communities in Kenya were mainly formulated by the councils of elders and then handed down from generation to generation.The constitution was unwritten constitution guiding only the political, economic and socio cultural activities

Colonial Era (1885- 1960)

Kenya was under the British colonial rule after the Berlin Conference upto 1963. The constitutional developments in the country were greatly influenced by the settlement of immigrant communities like the white settlers, the Asians and Christian missionaries. These communities competed with the Africans for control of economic resources and political power.The turning point in Kenya’s pre-colonial constitutional developments was the outbreak of Mau Mau war and subsequent declaration of a State Of Emergency on 20th October 1952 by Sir Evelyn Barring. When the colonial secretary Oliver Lyttelton visited Kenya in 1954, he proposed the following constitutional reforms.

~ Establishment of a multi-racial council of ministers representing the three races setting ground for two Indian and one African minister (B. A Ohanga became the first African Minister)

~  It Proposed direct representation of Africans in the LEGCO

~  Lifting the ban on African political parties/district associations.

In 1958, a new constitution was proposed by Lennox Boyd. The constitution led to increased number of elected Africans in the legislative council (from 8 to 14). It led to introduction of multi-racial representation in the legislative council. It led to the increase of the number of African ministers to two.

The African elected members demanded for a constitutional conference culminating into the independence constitution.

The independence constitution (1960-1962)

The first Lancaster House Conference (1960)

Attended by all members of Legco and two nominated members, the conference received the following demands;

  1. a) Africans demanded for true democracy, where one man would have one vote.
  2. b) The Arabs wanted to retain the ten-mile coastal strip, while Somalis wanted reunification with Somalia.
  3. c) Michael Blundell, representing a section of Europeans demanded for a multi-racial government while Captain Briggs representing the white extremists demanded for creation of provinces along racial lines.

All these proposal were moderated by the British government

The period after the first Lancaster House conference witnessed a lot of differences among Africans and among other races. Among the Africans, the differences culminated into the formation of KANU in March 1960 at Kiambu with James Gichuru as president and KADU in Ngong Town with Ronald Ngala as the president.The main difference between KADU and KANU was that while KANU was advocating gor a unitary government, KADU wanted a federal system.The second Lancaster House conference (1962).When KANU refused to form government despite winning the elections, demanding for the release of Jomo Kenyatta, KADU formed a rather minority government that was heavily dominated by the colonial officials. Such a government was rejected by most people thus creating instability that led to the British Authorities calling for the second Lancaster House Conference.

The following important issues were discussed;

  1. a) The future of the coastal strip that belonged to the sultan prior to colonialism.
  2. b) The future of North Eastern Province(North Frontier District)
  3. c) Security of the minority.

The participants in the formulation of the independence constitution were representatives of various political parties: – Paul Ngei (APP), KADU and KANU. Others were representatives of the Asian and European communities.The 1962 conference settled for a federal structure with a strong central government.A coalition government was formed briefly but when the 1962 constitution was promulgated, it was followed by a general election in May 1963.The third and final conference in 1963 resulted in the drafting and adoption of Kenya’s first independent Constitution by the British Parliament

The 1963 constitution established a parliamentary system with executive powers vested in a cabinet headed by a Prime Minister, The Queen of England remained Head of State.

Independence (1963)

Kanu won the May elections and Kenya Attained internal self-government with Jomo Kenyatta as the first Prime Minister on 1st June 1963. Kenya attained full independence on 12th December 1963 when the Queen ceased to be the head of state.Kenya has been using the Independence Constitution upto August 2010 though with so many amendments.

Main provisions of the independence constitution of Kenya

  1. a) The independence constitution provided for a regional/majimbo government with each of the seven regions having a regional assembly and president. The boundaries of the regions were given protection in the constitution.
  2. b) It also provided for a bicameral parliament consisting of the senate and the house of representatives/upper house and lower house. The lower house comprised 117 elected members and 12 special members. The senate comprised 41 members representing the 41 administrative districts and one representing Nairobi city.Though the senate was subordinate to the House of Representatives, it had powers to authorize declaration of a state of emergence, 65% of the senators were required to approve the amendment of constitution. Also all Bills required approval of both houses.
  3. c) The constitution stipulated that the Prime Minister (appointed by the governor) was to be head of Government and Queen the Head of State, represented by the Governor General.

The powers of the governor were defence of the country, foreign affairs, internal security and approval of legislation.

  1. d) The constitution recommended a multiparty system of government and the party with the majority of seats forming the government.
  2. e) It contained the Bill of Rights, which protected the individual’s rights. The Bill of rights was modeled on the European convention on Human Rights and Fundamental freedoms.
  3. f) The constitution provided for an elaborate scheme to protect the minority rights. The minorities in this case were the Europeans, Asians and some indigenous communities.
  4. g) Independent Electoral commission was set up consisting of the speakers of the two houses and a nominee of the Prime Minister. Also it comprised nominees representing the regions. This was to ensure impartiality and honesty in elections.
  5. h) The constitution provided for an independent and impartial judiciary to ensure justice and prevent corruption. Judges were accorded security of tenure which was extended to the Attorney General, the government’s principal legal advisor.
  6. i) It provided for public service commission. The aim was insulate the civil service recruitment and promotions from abuse and corruption.
  7. j) An independent land board.

Post –colonial Era (1963-2010).

From independence to Mult-party democracy period (1963-1991)

Like many former British colonies, Kenya started off with a west Minister system of government.The first Constitutional amendment in independent Kenya was in 1964. Kenya became a republic and the executive became presidential. The senate and regions were also abolished.A Constitutional review in June 1982 officially transformed Kenya into a one-party state.A parliamentary act in December 1991 repealed the one-party system provisions of the constitution and effectively established a multiparty system.

The period after 1992 was influenced by Global issues like the decline of the cold war, collapse of the Soviet Union in 1989 and the intensified struggle for democracy all over the world.In 1997, the Inter Party Parliamentary Group (IPPG) was formed with membership from the Opposition and KANU mps. The aim was to come up with minimal constitutional reforms to level the ground before the 1997 general elections

The following reforms were approved;

  1. a) The KBC shall observe fairness in providing balanced all-inclusive political views in the news coverage.
  2. b) Membership of the Electoral Commission to be reviewed to accommodate the interest of the opposition.
  3. c) Registration of Parties would be done without unnecessary delay.
  4. d) The powers of the chiefs that would likely interfere with political activity at local level be contained.
  5. e) The police Act be amended to provide for politically impartial police force
  6. f) To repeal a number of laws restricting civil and political rights, ad abolition of the offence of sedition

In 1997, a constitutional review commission, called the Constitution of Kenya Review Commission (CKRC), was established to provide civic education, seek public input and prepare a draft constitution. In October 2000, parliament passed a Bill entrenching the CKRC into the independence constitution. It was now headed by Professor Yash Pal Ghai and comprised 15 commissioners. In June 2001, the CKRC was expanded to include other groups like the People’s commission following the amendment of the 1997 Constitution of Kenya Review  Act.The CKRC act specified a 2 year time frame for completion of the review process.However, its activities were marred by controversy in 2002 and the ultimate dissolving of parliament in October 2002 by president Moi. He even attempted to dissolve the commission, thanks to its being entrenched in the independence constitution.When the NARC government took over power in 2003, the review exercise was reviewed. The National Constitutional Conference was convened at Bomas of Kenya and came up with what came to known as the Bomas Draft constitution. However the political elite did not support the Bomas Draft.In 2005, Parliament amended the constitution of Kenya Review Act to allow the Attorney General to come up with the Proposed New Constitution, popularly known as the Wako Draft. The draft constitution was ultimately rejected by Kenyans at the constitutional referendum in 2005 because of disagreements amongst various stakeholders.In December 2007, Kenyans participated in the general elections that were followed by Post Election Violence caused by the controversy that surrounded the results of the elections.

Steps towards realization of a new constitution in Kenya from 2008 .

  1. a) On 28 February 2008 The National Accord and Reconciliation Act (NARA) was signed by President Kibaki and Prime Minister Raila Odinga .Agenda No 4 of this arrangement was a new process to finalize the long awaited constitution of Kenya

The main provisions of the National Accord were:

~  Establishment of a grand coalition government with two parties; PNU and ODM

sharing power.

~  Raila Odinga was to become Kenya’s second Prime minister after the position was created in the accord arrangement

~  Two deputy Prime Minister Positions would be filled by the PNU and ODM parties respectively.

~  Provision for An expanded cabinet with the two parties being accorded slots as

per their proportion in the house.

  1. b) In 2008 the Constitution of Kenya Review Act 2008 was passed and a Committee of Experts

(CoE) was established as the main technical constitutional review organ to drive the

process.

  1. c) The CoE was chaired by Nzamba Kitonga, the deputy chair was Ms Atsango Chesoni, other

members were Ms Njoki Ndung’u, Mr Otiende Amolo,Mr Abdirashid Hussein, Mr Bobby Mkangi, Professor Christina Murray (South Africa), Dr Chaloka Beyani (Zambia) and Dr Frederick Ssempebwav (Uganda).

  1. d) 23 February 2009 Members of the CoE were appointed by the President were later on sworn in,
  2. e) On 17 November 2009 CoE released the draft to the public and invited views and comments on the draft constitution,
  3. f) By 23rdFebruary 2010. CoE had submitted the final draft of constitution to the Parliamentary Select Committee.
  4. g) On 4thaugust 2010 Kenya held a Constitutional Referendum where the new constitution was overwhelmingly endorsed.
  5. h) On 28th august 2010, the new constitution was promulgated and became operational making Kenya the first independent African state to depart from the independence constitutions.

Stages in the constitution making process in Kenya since independence

1)  Debate over contentious issues. Issues like the entrenchment of section 2A in the independence constitution in 1981 raised concerns among various stake holders and groups. The issue of whether to include the position of Prime Minister or not has also been debated for many years.

2)  Collection of public views. The Saitoti commission (the Constitution review commission established by Moi in 1990) had the objective of collecting views of Kenyans concerning how KANU was to operate in the best way possible. In June 2001, the CKRC, chaired by Yash Pal Ghai was mandated to collect views as part of the constitution review process.

3)  Civic education. In 2001, the Ghai Commission was mandated and funded to provide civic education.

4)  Convening of constitutional conferences. For example, The 2002 National Constitution Conference at Bomas of Kenya and other similar conferences.

5)  Drafting of the constitution. This involved both local and international experts who drafted the constitution between 2000 and 2010. This was mainly the work of the Ghai led CKRC and the Committee of experts led by Nzamba Gitonga.

6)  The referendum. During the 2005 referendum, the Wako Draft constitution was rejected. In August 2010, another referendum was held and the 2010 proposed New Constitution was approved.

7)  Promulgation of the constitution. On 27th of August 2010, President Mwai Kibaki presided over the promulgation of the new constitution of Kenya.

Constitutional Changes in Kenya since independence upto 2010

1)  The 1963 independence constitution marked the end of colonial rule and transformed the colony into a dominion. It established a parliamentary system with executive powers vested in a cabinet headed by a Prime Minister, who is appointed by the Queen of England from the majority party in Parliament. The Queen of England remained Head of State as represented by the Governor General who was also the Commander-in-Chief

2)  By the 1stamendment Act 28 of 1964, published in November 1964, Kenya became a republic and the executive became presidential. The amendment outlined the criteria to be met by a presidential candidate. It made provision of a Vice President who would be appointed by the president from among the members of parliament. Jaramogi Oginga Odinga became the first occupant of that office.

3)  By The 2nd amendment Act 38 of 1964 published on 17th December 1964, the senate and regions were also abolished.

4)  3rd amendment Act 14 of 1965, published on 8th June 1965, altered parliamentary Majorityrequired for approval of a state of emergency to only a simple majority from the previous

65%. The term ‘region’ was replaced with ‘province.’ The amendment altered the title of Supreme Court.

5)  By the 4th amendment Act 16 of 1966, published on 12th April 1966, commonwealth citizens became eligible for Kenyan citizenship. Also any legislator jailed for six months or more or missed to attend eight consecutive parliamentary seatings without the speaker’s permission had to forfeit his/her parliamentary seat.

6)  On 28th April 1966, an amendment was passed, published on 30th  April, to compel MPs who defected from sponsoring party, to resign from parliament and seek re-election. This amendment targeted Kenya People’s Union (KPU) of Jaramogi Odinga that had been formed that year. The amendment was published, tabled, debated, passed and received presidential assent within 48 hours. (it was nicknamed ‘the KPU amendment’).

7)  In May 1966, the Public Security Act was passed, published on 7thJune 1966, empowering the president to detain a citizen without trial on grounds of being a threat to state security.

The president also acquired power to control freedom of the press.

8)  In 1966, a constitutional amendment abolished the Bicameral Legislature and replaced it with a Unicameral Legislature, chosen directly by the electorate.

The Act was published on 4th January 1967. The voting majority to change the Constitution was lowered to two-thirds of the MPs.

9)  In 1968, by the 9th amendment, published on 12th April 1968, the president was empowered to alter provincial and district boundaries. The act abolished the provincial councils and all representatives to the provincial and district boundaries. This marked the end of regionalism.

10)  In 1968, by the 10th amendment, Act 45 published on 12th July 1968, the procedure for presidential elections and succession in the event of his death was laid down. Also, that all candidates for a general election should be nominated by a political party. The act also gave the president power to nominate 13 MPs to replace the 12 specially elected members of the House of Representatives.

11)  In 1974, the age qualification for presidential candidates was also lowered to 35 from 40 years. The minimum voting age was altered from 21 to 18 years.

12)  In 1975, an amendment of the constitution empowered the president to pardon any election offender at his own discretion. This was done to favour Paul Ngei who been found guilty of an election offence. It was named ‘the Ngei Amendment’. The bill went through all the stages in one afternoon and received presidential assent the following day.

13)  In 1975, Kiswahili was declared the national language of the national assembly.

14)  In 1977, the Kenya court of appeal was established after the breakup of the East African Community.

15)  The 18th amendment Act passed in 1979 was the first one under president Moi. It provided that public officers had to resign six months in advance in order to qualify as candidates for parliamentary elections.

16)  In 1979, both Kiswahili and English were declared languages of the national assemb ly.

17)  By The 19th amendment Act of 1981 published in 1982, Kenya became a de jure one party

state. KANU became the only lawful party in Kenya. The infamous section 2A was

introduced in the constitution. (Kenya had been a  de facto one party state between 1969and 1982). The post of Chief Secretary was created to head the public service. The first occupant being Jeremiah Kiereini.

18)  By the 1985 20th amendment Act, the High Court began acting as a Court of Appeal.

19)  The 21st amendment Act passed in 1985 repealed Section 89 of the constitution which provided for the acquisition of Citizenship for anyone born in Kenya after December 11th 1963.

20)  In 1987, the security of tenure of the Attorney General, Chief Secretary, The Comptroller and Auditor–General was removed. The president could now dismiss them at will. Office of chief secretary was abolished.

21)  In 1988, the security of tenure of Puisine Judges and Chairman of Public Service Commission was removed. The removal of security of tenure of the above officers sparked a lot of condemnation from LSK and main stream churches.

22)  In 1988, an amendment was passé that provided the police with powers to hold a suspect in custody for upto fourteen days before taking him/ her to court if the crime constituted a capital offence. This is what led to detaining of persons suspected of opposing the government in the dingy basement of Nyayo House where some were tortured to death.

23)  1990- Security of tenure of the offices of AG and Controller and Auditor –General was reinstated.

24)  A parliamentary act in December 1991 repealed the one-party system provisions (section

2A) of the constitution and effectively established a multiparty system. Multiparty elections were held the following year in December.

25)  In 1991, an amendment that was passed limited the tenure of the president to a maximum of two-five year terms.

26)  After 1997 elections, Parliament, on the initiative of the government, passed the Constitution of Kenya Review Act that set the pace for comprehensive constitutional reforms.

27)  A constitutional review commission, called the Constitution of Kenya Review Commission (CKRC), was established to provide civic education, seek public input and prepare a draft constitution.

28)  In October 2000, parliament passed a Bill entrenching the Constitution of Ken ya Review Commission (CKRC) headed by Professor Yash Pal Ghai into the independence constitution.

29)  In 2005, Parliament amended the constitution of Kenya Review Act to allow the Attorney General to come up with the Proposed New Constitution, popularly known as the Wako Draft

30)  The draft constitution was ultimately rejected by Kenyans at the constitutional referendum in 2005 because of disagreements amongst various stakeholders .

31)  The rejection of the draft constitution by Kenyans in the referendum of 2005 meant that the 1963 constitution (as amended) remained the basic law of Kenya. .

32)  28 February 2008The National Accord and Reconciliation Act (NARA) was signed by President Kibaki and Prime Minister Raila Odinga to end violence that erupted after the December 2007 presidential elections.

Agenda No 4 of this arrangement calls for a new process to finalize the long awaited constitution of Kenya

33)  In 2008 the Constitution of Kenya Review Act 2008 was passed and a Committee of Experts (CoE) was established as the main technical constitutional review organ to drive the process. The CoE was chaired by Nzamba Kitonga; the deputy chair was Ms Atsango Chesoni, other members were Ms Njoki Ndung’u, Mr Otiende Amolo,Mr Abdirashid Hussein Mr Bobby Mkangi Professor Christina Murray (South Africa) Dr Chaloka Beyani (Zambia) and Dr Frederick Ssempebwav (Uganda.)

34)  On 28thaugust 2010, the new constitution was promulgated and became operational making Kenya the first independent African state to depart from the independence constitution.

Key changes in the New Constitution.

  1. a) Reduction of president’s executive powers.
  2. b) Devolution of power to regions (creation of county and national governments.)
  3. c) Creation of the senate and national assembly to constitute parliament.
  4. d) On Citizenship, Birth and registration are the only recognize ways of attaining Kenyan citizenship. Dual citizenship is now recognized by the constitution.
  5. e) Recognition of the Kadhi’s courts as subordinate courts in the judicial court system.
  6. f) Expansion of the citizens’ Bill of Rights to guarantee equal representation for either gender in all governance structures.

FEATURES OF THE NEW CONSTITUTION.

Why there was need to have a new constitution in Kenya.

  The need to meet the changing needs of the Kenyan society, e.g. due to population growth.

  The rise of gender sensitivity in Kenya/The need to address the rights of women which had not been adequately addressed in the outgoing constitution.

  The constant misuse of executive authority by the Moi and Kenyatta regime/ the need to give less or more power to the executive.

  The need to depart from the colonial policies that found their way into the outgoing constitution.

  The need to safeguard against social vices like corruption and land grabbing.

  The need to enhance unity and realize a liberal society due to political maturity.

Problems that Kenya faced in realization of a new constitutional dispensation.

  1. a) Party differences have been transferred to the constitution making process e.g. the NARC fallout, the ODM wrangles between Raila and Ruto. Etc.
  2. b) Sectarian interests based on tribe, religion, age, sex which is hard to satisfy. E.g in relation to creation of counties, Kadhis court and land laws.
  3. c) Attempts to project personality, individual or group interests rather than national interest into the process.
  4. d) Direct misinformation of the public and propaganda by politicians and other groups with selfish interests.
  5. e) Illiteracy and ignorance of the electorate and therefore easily misled.
  6. f) Tension and sometimes violence marred the whole review process.
  7. g) Limited financial resources and personnel
  8. h) Lack of unity of purpose and co-operation among existing political parties hence difficulty in hammering out compromise..
  9. i) Inadequate civic education/wrong civic education.
  10. j) Lack of consultation with all the interested stake holders.
  11. k) An attempt to tie the constitutional review process with election time-table, political programmes and interests.

Why Kenya’s new constitution is regarded as supreme.

  1. a) The Constitution is the supreme law of the Republic and binds all persons and all State organs at both levels of government.
  2. b) No person may claim or exercise State authority except as authorized under the Constitution.
  3. c) The validity or legality of the Constitution is not subject to challenge by or before any court or other State organ.
  4. d) Any law, including customary law that is inconsistent with the Constitution is void to the extent of the inconsistency, and any act or omission in contravention of the Constitution is invalid.
  5. e) The general rules of international law shall form part of the law of Kenya.
  6. f) Any treaty or convention ratified by Kenya shall form part of the law of Kenya under this Constitution.

Functions of the Kenyan constitution

  1. a) It is the fundamental law of Kenya.
  2. b) It has helped in establishing the philosophy, character and structure of the Kenyan government.
  3. c) It has laid down principles which determine government power and duties.
  4. d) It r regulates, distributes and limits the functions of different institutions of the state.
  5. e) It spells out the basis of relationship between the Ke nyans and the government and what rights should be in that relationship.

Role played by the Kenyan constitution in governing the country

  1. a) It protects the interests of the weak in the society from those who would want to dominate them.
  2. b) It checks the powers of the dictatorial rulers.
  3. c) It defines how to rise to power hence preventing unnecessary power struggles.
  4. d) It provides for the separation of powers between the three arms of government.
  5. e) It defines the powers of those in authority hence preventing misuse of
  6. f) It defines relations with other countries
  7. g) It specifies on how a government is to be formed.

DEMOCRACY AND HUMAN RIGHTS

What is democracy?

The is derived from the Greek word Democratia (Demos meaning people and Kratas meaning ‘rule or power’). It is a form of government where political decisions are directly in the hands of the citizens.

Key aspects of a real democracy.

  1. a) Political aspect. The consent of the governed (expressed directly or indirectly through their elected representatives) must be sought when making political decisions. Public opinion must be given priority in governance.
  2. b) Social aspect. Human dignity must be valued at all times. Every individual should be free to organize his own lifestyle, hold and express opinions, enjoy company of others and join associations.
  3. c) Economic aspect. All citizens must be provided with equal opportunities. Exploitation of humans by fellow humans should be eliminated. Means of production should be nationalized to reduce inequalities between the rich and the poor.

Types of democracy

1)  Pure or direct democracy. This is where the people are directly involved and participate in decision-making. Such a democracy has an advantage in that the laws made are easily accepted by all the people since they feel they own the laws.

This is common form of democracy in smaller organizations and was also used in ancient Greece.

2)  Indirect democracy. This is a type of democracy where citizens exercise their right in decision making not directly as individuals, but through their agreed representatives, elected by the citizens. Parliament acts as the basic institution in this type of democracy.

The elected may make Appointments of persons to fill other positions like the Cabinet or carry out Nomination (hand-picking of additional representatives to join the elected ones.

3)  Constitutional Democracy. This is where democracy is exercised but within the limits of the constitution. The minority rights are guaranteed (freedom of expression, association and worship).It is also referred to as Liberal democracy and is a form of representative democracy.

Merits of democracy

  1. a) It is founded on the concept of the people and therefore leaders cannot ignore the people from whom they get authority to rule. It is most popular form of government.
  2. b) It recognizes equality among all the people without discrimination. It advocates equality before the law and anyone can rise to power regardless of one’s background or environment.
  3. c) It promotes patriotism or national pride as it urges people to participate in their governance. This reduces chances of a revolution
  4. d) It promotes liberty and peace as it advocates for peaceful coexistence. People develop a sense of cooperation. It can also promote international cooperation when extended beyond the borders.
  5. e) Since it is based on moral and educative values, democracy helps individuals to develop their personality. It develops initiative of the people and their sense of responsibility.
  6. f) Democracy balances the liberty of the individual with the power of the state. Demerits of democracy
  7. a) Democracy promotes dictatorship by the majority. The majority government by fulfilling the election pledges to please the supporting electorate ends up neglecting the political, social and economic interests of the minority who did not vote for it.
  8. b) Democracy encourages class struggle and corruption as only those that possess money can engage in intensive campaigns and get elected due to their influence. Then once elected, they pass laws that protect their interests.
  9. c) A democratic government is usually slow and wasteful since consultations have to be made when making a decision. Time and public resources are used in the process of seeking the views of the majority.
  10. d) The ethical value of democracy is questionable. It is not easy to find an honest, sincere man of good moral character being elected.
  11. e) Democracy may perpetuate incompetence since it is numbers which matter when choosing a leader not the leadership qualities. Where a majority of the electorate is ignorant, they may make poor decision during elections thus promoting incompetence.
  12. f) Although democracy is regarded as the rule of the majority, in essence, it is the elected minority who rule. Democracy is therefore as a form of dictatorship by the informed or elected minority.

 

Principles of democracy.

Principle-basic truth or general law.

  1. a) Freedom of speech, debate and enquiry. The basic healthy political culture among a group of people is based on open debate among citizens where they can express their views without fear.
  2. b) People’s participation as a whole in government. Through free, fair and regular elections, the government should remain a servant of the people and not master. Democracy is based on consent which can be withdrawn if the government fails to satisfy peoples’ expectations.
  3. c) Open and accountable media. The media must be open in their agenda and be held accountable to the public. Media monopolies should not be allowed to develop.
  4. d) Economic democracy. This implies the decentralization of economic power so that individuals and communities can be economically empowered to create and control their own wealth.
  5. e) Equality before the law. Judgment should be made in accordance with a written law, rather than in an arbitrary manner. Each citizen also has an equal ability to seek and receive justice.

Human rights

Human rights refers to the accepted principles of fairness and justice- or the universal moral rights that belong equally to all people in their capacity as human beings  regardless of sex, race, and tribe, and language, place of origin, age or political beliefs.

Why human rights are important.

  1. a) Rights are necessary for human beings to achieve a dignified life, fulfill their potential and to satisfy both their physical and spiritual needs.
  2. b) Rights are inherent to human beings. One has rights purely because they are human. They are not granted by the state.
  3. c) Rights empower citizens and residents by giving them control in decision making organs of the state.
  4. d) Rights justify special treatment of minorities and other special or disadvantaged groups or communities.
  5. e) Rights provide guidance to organs of state regarding the exercise of state power.
  6. f) Rights such as the right to vote, freedom of expression and of the press ensure the public access the necessary information necessary for the protection of democracy and ensure accountability of public authorities.
  7. g) Respect for human rights limits internal and external conflicts and strengthens national unity.

Classification of Human rights

  1. a) Social economic and cultural rights. On the basis of these rights, the state is expected to pursue policies that enable individual, families or groups to earn a living and provide basic needs including education and medical care for themselves.
  2. b) Solidarity rights. These are rights that focus on the whole community. They require that the state to pursue policies which do not destroy natural resource or waste financial resources but instead create conditions for peaceful co-existence. These rights include the right to clean, healthy and sustainable environment, peace, and development.
  3. c) Civil and political rights. The rights include the right o vote, right to think and to have access to information. These rights ensure a secure space for the individual to pursue their values and interests.

Groups that monitor human rights in Kenya

  1. a) Lawyers and Judges and other professionals including teachers.
  2. b) Religious groups
  3. c) Journalists (The media-print and electronic).
  4. d) The police force
  5. e) Association and special commissions, e.g business associations, women groups, the Kenya National Human Rights and Equality Commission (KNHREC), among others.
  6. f) pressure groups

Characteristics of human rights.

  1. a) They are universal. Human rights apply equally to everyone by virtue of being a human being.
  2. b) They are indivisible. One right cannot be applied if the other does not exist. They are inherent.
  3. c) Incase circumstance demand they can be suspended. For example during war, or during disease outbreak like Ebola or other contagious diseases, one may be denied the right to freedom of movement.
  4. d) Human rights have limitations. As people enjoy their rights, they should respect the rights of others.

United Nations Charter on human rights.

This is a document that contains the basic human rights to which every person by virtue of being a human being is entitled to. It also reaffirms the equality of the rights of all men and women. The Universal Declaration if Human Rights was adopted by the United Nations General Assembly on 10th December 1948.. Member states that signed the document are supposed to publicize the declaration in their countries

The basic human rights contained in the Charter include;

  1. All human beings are born free and equal.
  2. Everyone is entitled to all rights and freedoms set forth in the declaration without discrimination on basis of sex, race, colour, sex, language, religion, political or other opinion, racial origin birth or any other status.
  3. Everyone has a right to life, liberty and security.
  4. No one should be held in servitude or slavery or perform forced labour.
  5. Everyone has a right to recognition as a person before the law.
  6. Every person is equal before the law and has the right to equal protection and equal benefit of the law.
  7. Every person’s dignity should be respected and protected.
  8. Everyone has a right to nationality. One is free to change nationality.
  9. No person will be subjected to physical or psychological torture, corporal punishment or cruel and inhuman treatment.
  10. Everyone has a right to free movement and residence within the borders of each state.
  11. Everyone has a right to ownership of property alone as well as in association with others. State cannot take away ones property without proper compensation.
  12. Every citizen has a right to peaceful assembly and association.
  13. Every citizen is free to make political choices, which includes the right to form, or participate in forming, a political party and to participate in the governing process of the country.
  14. Every person has the right to the highest attainable standard of health, which includes the right to health care services, including reproductive health care.
  15. Every person has the right to accessible and adequate housing, and to reasonable standards of sanitation.
  16. Every person has the right to be free from hunger, and to have adequate food of acceptable quality.
  17. Every person has the right to clean and safe water in adequate quantities.
  18. Every person has the right to social security
  19. Every person has the right to education. Elementary education shall be compulsory while technical and professional education should be made generally available.
  20. Every person has the right to a clean and healthy environment. It is our duty to ensure that the environment is protected for the benefit of present and future generations.
  21. Every person, whether individually or as a group, has freedom to manifest any religion or belief through worship.
  22. An adult has the right to marry a person of the opposite sex, based on the free consent of the parties. Parties to such a union enjoy equal rights.
  23. Every person should be subjected to an efficient, lawful, reasonable and procedurally fair administrative action.
  24. Everyone has freedom of opinion and expression.
  25. Everyone has a right to seek and enjoy, in other countries, asylum from persecution. The right is however enjoyed only for political reasons.
  26. Everyone has a right to a fair and public hearing by an independent and impartial tribunal in the determination of one’s rights and obligations.
  27. Everyone has a right to protection of the law against interference or attacks against one’s property, home or correspondence.
  28. Everyone has a right to work, to free choice of employment, to just and favourable conditions of work and protection against unemployment.
  29. Everyone has a right to leisure, which includes reasonable working hours and periodic holidays with pay.ght to freely participate in the cultural life of the community, to enjoy the arts e.g drama, music, dance etc.
  30. However every person has various duties to the community in which they live.
  31. Freedom from torture and cruel, inhuman or degrading treatment or punishment.

Importance of the UN Charter on human rights.

  1. a) Protection of human rights, which is the core thing in the UN Charter, is important for the Establishment and maintenance of peace and security. Where there is violation of human rights, it becomes difficult to prevent conflict and maintain peace.
  2. b) Respect for human rights is an important requirement for efficiency and effectiveness in governance. The principle of non-discrimination, principle of international human rights law, enables one to strive for more equitable societies even within the level of resources available.
  3. c) Respect for human rights promotes development. National development strategies can only

lead to tangible improvement in the lives of people if they have as their key objectives realization of economic, social and political rights.

  1. d) The UN Declaration provides a guideline for collective action towards eradication of poverty.
  2. e) The UN human rights mechanisms have given utmost attention to countering of terrorism as a way of protecting human rights.
  3. f) A SOCIETY that observes respect for human rights reduces the chance of conflict outbreak.
  4. g) The UN Charter on human rights is the foundation on which peace-making (peace-building and peace-keeping) is built. Any strategy to achieve peace anywhere is accompanied by strategies to uphold human rights like was the case in Yugoslavia.
  5. h) In recognition of human rights, the UN has played a key role in giving humanitarian assistance to the people of different countries suffering from effects of natural disasters and other emergencies.
  6. i) The UN Charter on Human rights promotes the rights of women and their empowerment by affirming the equal rights for women and fighting discrimination based on gender
  7. j) The UN Charter champions the rights of vulnerable groups like the minority migrant workers, abused children, indigenous people and persons with disabilities.

The Kenyan Bill of Rights

This is a statement of human or civil rights in the constitution of Kenya. The Bill of Rights is covered in chapter four of the constitution of Kenya (2010).

 

Importance of the Kenyan Bill Of Rights

  1. a) States that every individual has the right to life
  2. b) It guarantees liberty to all citizens by forbidding enslavement, detention without trial etc.
  3. c) It protects the individual from all forms of torture and inhuman treatment
  4. d) It guarantees the protection of private property and allows Kenyans to own property anywhere in the country.
  5. e) It protects individuals’ freedom of conscience and religion.
  6. f) It guarantees the protection of the freedom of speech and expression
  7. g) It gives Kenyans the right to move freely throughout the country and to reside in any part of the country.
  8. h) It guarantees individuals against any form of discrimination on the basis of colour, creed, and gender.
  9. i) It protects individual against arbitrary search, arrest and entry into one’s property without his/her consent

Rights and fundamental freedoms contained in the Kenyan Bill of Rights.

  1. Right to life.

Life begins at conception and no child should be deprived of life deliberately. Abortion is not therefore permitted unless occasioned by the need for emergency treatment or life of the mother is in danger.

People who attempt to commit suicide are also punishable on the strength of their right

  1. Equality and freedom from discrimination

Every person is equal before the law and has the right to equal protection and equal benefit of the law. This means that both men and women are equal before the law. Any form of discrimination is illegal and is prohibited in the constitution.

  1. Human dignity

Every person’s dignity should be respected and protected. One must not ridicule or embarrass other members of society.

  1. Freedom and security of a person.

This right protects a person from being detained without a good reason and without trial. No person will be subjected to physical or psychological torture, corporal punishment or cruel and inhuman treatment.

  1. Freedom from slavery, servitude and forced labour.

No one should be held in servitude or slavery or perform forced labour. Every employer should treat his or her employees with dignity and not to force them to work.

  1. Right to privacy.

Every person has a right NOT to have him or herself, his or her property searched, or his or her possessions seized. Not revealing a person’s family or private affairs unnecessarily or private communications interfered with.

  1. Right to assembly, demonstration, picketing and petition.

Every citizen has a right to assemble and participate in peaceful demonstrations and even present petitions to public authorities.

  1. Political rights

Every citizen is free to make political choices, which includes the right to form, or participate in forming, a political party and to participate in the activities of, a political party.Every citizen has the right to free, fair and regular elections based on universal suffrage and the free` expression of the will of the electors for any elective public body or office Every adult citizen has the right, without unreasonable restrictions, to be registered as a voter; to vote by secret ballot in any election or referendum and to be a candidate for public office, or office within a political party and, if elected, to hold office.

  1. Freedom of movement and residence

Citizens have a right to free movement and ownership of property in any part of the country.

Anyone is also free to leave the country or enter and remain in the country

  1. Economic and social rights

Every person has the right to the highest attainable standard of health, which includes the right to health care services, including reproductive health care.Every person has the right to accessible and adequate housing, and to reasonable standards of sanitation.Every person has the right to be free from hunger, and to have adequate food of acceptable quality.Every person has the right to clean and safe water in adequate quantities.Every person has the right to social security. Every person has the right to education.A person shall not be denied emergency medical treatment.The State must provide appropriate social security to persons who are unable to support themselves and their dependants.

  1. Consumer rights

Consumers have the right to goods and services of reasonable quality.Consumers have the right to the information necessary for them to gain full benefit from goods and services.Consumers have the right to the protection of their health, safety, and economic interests.Consumers have the right to compensation for loss or injury arising from defects in goods or services.

  1. Right to fair labour practices

Every worker has a right to fair labour practices like fair remuneration, reasonable working conditions, the right to join or practice in trade union activities and the right to go on strike .Every employer has a right to join an employers’ association and participate in its programmes and activities

Responsibility.

One must respect the right to fair labour practices of one’s employees. Employees on the other hand must conduct themselves responsibly, even during strikes, to avoid causing physical injury to innocent people, or destroying property.

 

 

  1. Right to clean and healthy environment.

Every person has the right to a clean and healthy environment. It is our duty to ensure that the environment is protected for the benefit of present and future generations.

  1. Freedom of conscience, religion, belief and opinion.

Every person, whether individually or as a group, has freedom to manifest any religion or belief through worship, practice, teaching or observance, including observance of day of worship.One cannot be denied employment or educational opportunity because of belonging to a particular religion or because of one’s belief or religion.A person cannot be forced to engage in any act that goes against his or her belief or religion.

  1. Freedom of expression.

This guarantees all Kenyans the freedom to seek, receive or impart ideas or information. It also guarantees freedom of artistic creativity, academic freedom, and freedom to conduct scientific research.

  1. Freedom of media.

The freedom and independence of the media is guaranteed. The state should not interfere with

the media.

  1. Access to information

Every person has a right to access information held by the state, or by others, which may be required for the protection of any right or fundamental freedom. The state is expected to make public any important information affecting the nation.Every person has a right to the correction or deletion of untrue or misleading information that affects the person.

  1. Freedom of association

Every person has the right to form, join and participate in the activities of an association of any kind, provided that the association is not engaged in illegal activities, such as stealing or killing.

  1. Protection of the right to property

Every person is entitled to own property either individually or as a group, in any part of the country. However the property has to be legally acquired.This right provides all Kenyans a fair opportunity to invest in property and thus, prosper.

  1. Right to language and culture

Every person has the right to use a language, and embrace the culture of the person’s choice.Every person has the right to form or join cultural groups. Every person is also protected from being forced to join any such group.Each linguistic group is free to use their language, practice their culture, and form associations and other organs of the civil society.It is unacceptable to force another person to perform, observe or undergo any cultural practice or rite.

  1. Right to family

An adult has the right to marry a person of the opposite sex, based on the free consent of the parties. Parties to such a union enjoy equal rights. Both parties have a responsibility to respect the rights of their spouses during marriage and even in the event of its dissolution.It is wrong to deny one’s spouse access to marital property after separation or divorce.  The constitution also recognizes marriages conducted under traditional, religious, personal or family law. Marrying of underage persons and forced marriages are outlawed in the constitution.

  1. Fair administrative action

Every person should be subjected to an efficient, lawful, reasonable and procedurally fair administrative action. This promotes efficient administration in public offices.

  1. Access to justice.

Everybody should access justice and a reasonable fee will be charged to enhance this, if required. If this is not free, many people will not access justice which will continue  to be a preserve of the rich people.

  1. Right of arrested persons.

An arrested person has;

  1. a) The right to be informed promptly in a language that the person understands of the reason for arrest, the right to remain silent and he consequences of not remaining si lent.
  2. b) The right to remain silent. – The right of a person to choose to talk or to remain silent.
  3. c) The right to communicate with an advocate and other persons whose assistance is necessary (freedom of speech with all those who will assist him or her in the case.)
  4. d) The right of not being compelled to make any confession or admission that could be used in evidence against the person.
  5. e) The right t be held separately from persons serving a sentence ( should not be held in

prisons alongside those already convicted)

  1. f) To be brought to court as soon as reasonably possible, as but not later than twenty four hours after being arrested.
  2. g) To be charged or be informed of the reason for the extension of detention or release, at the first court appearance.
  3. h) To be released on bond or bail, on reasonable conditions, pending a charge or trial, unless there are compelling reasons as to why one cannot be released.
  4. Fair hearing.

Every person has the right to have any dispute that can be resolved through a court hearing be resolved in such a manner that will accord him or her fair and public hearing. An accused person has the following rights;

  1. a) To be presumed innocent until proven otherwise.
  2. b) To be informed of the charges.
  3. c) To have adequate time and facilities to prepare a defence.
  4. d) To a public trial before a court.
  5. e) To have the trial begin and be concluded with few delays.
  6. f) To be present when being tried.
  7. g) To be represented by an advocate and be informed of this right immediately. Depending on the circumstances, the accused may be assigned an advocate by the state and at the state’s expense.
  8. h) To remain silent and not testify during the proceedings.
  9. i) To be informed in advance, of the evidence the prosecution intends to present, and to have reasonable access to that evidence.
  10. j) To challenge the evidence.
  11. k) To refuse to give self-incriminating evidence.
  12. l) To have the assistance of an interpreter if the accused person cannot understand the language used in the trial.
  13. m) If convicted, to appeal, or apply for review by a higher court.
  14. Rights of persons detained, held in custody or imprisoned.

A person, who is detained, held in custody or imprisoned under the law, retains all rights and fundamental freedoms in the bill of rights. Except those that are impractical and inapplicable under the circumstances.A person who is detained or held in custody is entitled for an order Habeas Corpus- This is a law that states that a person who has been arrested should not be kept in prison longer than a particular period of time unless a judge in a court has decided that it is right. It is the right of the person who is detained, held in custody or imprisoned to be treated in a humane manner.

Application of the Kenyan bill of rights to specific groups of people in Kenya

Rights enjoyed by Children in Kenya

A child refers to a young person from birth to full physical development. The term also refers to a person who has not attained the age of eighteen. The rights of children are contained in the United Nations Convention on the Rights of the Child, and International Agreement on the Rights of the Child put in place in 1990.

The rights include;

  1. a) Survival rights

~ Every child has the right to a name and nationality from birth.

~  Every child has the right to basic nutrition, shelter and health care.

  1. b) Development rights

~  Every child has the right to free and compulsory basic education.

~  Every child has the right to parental care and protection, which includes equal

responsibility of the mother and father to provide for the child, whether they are

married to each other or not.

  1. c) Right of protection

~  Every child has the right to be protected from abuse, neglect, harmful cultural

practices, all forms of violence, inhuman treatment and punishment, and hazardous

or exploitative labour.

~  Every child has the right not to be detained, except as a measure of last resort, and when detained, to be held for the shortest appropriate period of time.

~  Every child has the right to separate from adults and in conditions that take account of the child’s sex and age.

~  Every child has the right to a child’s best interests are of paramount importance in every matter concerning the child.

~  Children should be protected from exploitation such as child labour.

Rights enjoyed by Persons with disabilities in Kenya.

(a)  A person with any disability is entitled to be treated with dignity and respect and to beaddressed and referred to in a manner that is not demeaning. A person with any disability is entitled

(b)  A person with any disability is entitled to access educational institutions and facilities forpersons with disabilities that are integrated into society to the extent compatible with the interests of the person.

(c)  A person with any disability is entitled to reasonable access to all places, public transport and information.

(d)   A person with any disability is entitled to use Sign language, Braille or other appropriate means of communication.

(e)  A person with any disability is entitled to access materials and devices to overcome constraints arising from the person’s disability.

Rights of the Youth in Kenya.

(a)  Right to access relevant education and training.

(b)  Right to have opportunities to associate, be represented and participate in political, social, economic and other spheres of life.

(c)  Right to access employment.

(d)  Youths are protected from harmful cultural practices and exploitation.

Rights of Minorities and marginalized groups in Kenya

The constitution specifies a marginalized community as;

~  A community that because of its relatively small population has been unable to fully participate in the integrated social and economic life of Kenya as a whole.

~  A traditional community that, out of need or desire to preserve its unique culture and identity from assimilation, has remained outside the integrated social and economic life of Kenya.

~  An indigenous community that has retained maintained a traditional lifestyle and livelihood based on a hunter or gatherer economy.

~  Pastoral persons and communities, whether nomadic or settled and because of their relative geographical location, have experienced only marginal participation in the integrated social and economic life of kenya as a whole.

Rights of Minorities and marginalized groups

  1. a) Minorities and marginalized groups have the right to participate and are represented in governance and other spheres of life.
  2. b) Minorities and marginalized groups have the right to be provided special opportunities in educational and economic fields.
  3. c) Minorities and marginalized groups have the right to be provided special opportunities for access to employment.
  4. d) Minorities and marginalized groups have the right to develop their cultural values, languages and practices.
  5. e) Minorities and marginalized groups have the right to reasonable access to water, health services and infrastructure.

Rights of older members of society in Kenya

  1. a) Right to fully participate in the affairs of society.
  2. b) Right to pursue their personal development.
  3. c) Right to live in dignity and respect and be free from abuse.
  4. d) Right to receive reasonable care and assistance from their family and the State.

The Kenya National Human Rights and Equality Commission

This commission was entrenched in the Constitution of Kenya (2010) to replace the KNHRC. The commission constitutes atleast three but not more than nine members appointed by the president with the approval of the national assembly.

Objectives;

  1. a) To protect the sovereignty of the people.
  2. b) To ensure secure observance by all state organs of democratic values and principles
  3. c) To promote constitutionalism

Functions of the Kenya National Human Rights and Equality Commission.

  1. a) It has a duty to promote respect for human rights an d develop a culture of human rights in the republic.
  2. b) A duty to promote protection and observance of human rights in public and private institutions.
  3. c) It monitors, investigates and reports on the observance of human rights in all spheres of life in the republic, including observance by the national security organs.
  4. d) It receives and investigates complaints about alleged abuses of human rights and takes steps to secure appropriate redress where human rights have been violated.
  5. e) It acts as the principal organ of the state in ensuring compliance with obligations under treaties and conventions relating o human rights.
  6. f) It investigates any conduct in state affairs, or any act or omission in pu blic administration in any sphere of government, which is alleged or suspected to be prejudicial or improper, or to result in any impropriety, or prejudice.
  7. g) It investigates complaints about abuse of power, unfair treatment, manifest injustice or unlawful, oppressive, unfair or unresponsive official conduct.

 

 

 

HISTORY FORM THREE NOTES

 

  1. 1. EUROPEAN INVASION AND THE PROCESS OF COLONIZATION OF AFRICA

Introduction

In the last Quarter of the 19th century, Britain, Germany, France, Italy, Belgium and Portugal were in Africa, competing for colonies to boost their social, economic and political standing.They convened the Berlin conference of 1884-1885 (convened by Otto Von Bismarck, the Germany Chancellor) where they shared Africa in Europe without regard to the inhabitants. This is what is termed the invasion of Africa.By 1914, apart from Liberia and Ethiopia, the rest of Africa had been colonized

The scramble and partition of Africa

Scramble

It refers to the rushing for something.In the African situation, it meant the rush for and struggle by European powers to acquire various parts of Africa during the 19th century.

Partition

It refers to the sharing of something. In the African situation, it referred to the actual division of Africa by European powers during the Berlin conference of 1884 -1885Methods used by Europeans to acquire colonies in Africa.

1)  Signing of treaties;

  1. a) Treaty signing with African leaders.

~ The British signed the Maasai Agreements (1904 and 1911), Buganda Agreement of 1900 and the Lewanika-Lochner treaty with Lozi. The royal Niger Company had by 1884, signed 37 treaties through George Goldie, with African leaders in Niger delta, Yorubaland and Gambia.

~ Carl peters signed treaties on behalf of Germany with the chiefs of Uzigua, Ukami, Usagara and ungulu.

These treaties facilitated the acquisition of those areas for colonization.

  1. b) Treaties signed amongst European powers. These were known as Partition Agreements. For example;

~  The Anglo-Germany Agreements of 1886 and 1890 and Heligoland between the British and the Germans over the sharing of East Africa.

~  The Anglo Italian treaty signed in 1891 between the Italians and the British over possession of Eritrea and the Somali coast.

~  The treaty between the British and Portugal and France in 1890 on the sharing of

Madagascar (France) Mozambique and Angola (Portugal).

2)  Military conquest/ Use of force. Europeans employed outright war against those societies that resisted their invasion. E.g

  1. a) The French war against the Mandinka of Samori Toure (1870-1899) and their conquest of western Sudan from Senegal to Chad specifically in the Tukolor Empire, Segu and Masina by 1898. Tunisia, morocco and Algeria were acquired forcefully.
  2. b) The British used military force in the Nandi resistance from 1895-1905, the Chimurenga wars involving the Shona/Ndebele against the British, forced acquisition of Egypt and Sudan
  3. c) The Germans fought the Maji Maji wars from 1905- 1907.
  4. d) The Italians were defeated during their Ethiopian campaign, by Menelik II in the battle of Adowa in 1896.
  5. e) The Portuguese forcefully established their rule over Angola, Guinea Bissau and

Mozambique.

3)  Use of missionaries as frontrunners. The Europeans used missionaries, carrying a bible in one hand and a gun in the other, who tried to convince the Africans to support the European goals.

~  Missionaries manipulated local quarrels and took sides in a view to promote European occupation. For example, in the case of Buganda where we had religious conflicts between Protestants, Muslims, Catholics and Traditionalists.

~ Sometimes the missionaries went to war against each other and against Africans. E.g the Franza-Ingeleza war of 1892 that pitted the Protestants (British) against the Catholics (French). Fredrick Lugard’s intervention on the side of Protestants set stage for the acquisition of Uganda by the British.

~   In Bulozi, Father Francois Coillard convinced Lewanika of the benefits of British protection.

~  In Nyasaland (Malawi) which was depicted as Livingstone’s  country, missionaries (read role of Scottish missionaries) shaped public opinion in favour of imperial control.

4)  Treachery and Divide and rule policy

~  The Europeans instigated inter-tribal wars causing some Africans to support them against warring communities. E.g. use of the Wanga against the Luo and the Luhya in Kenya, the Ndebele/shona against the Lozi in Rhodesia.

~  The Italians lied to Menelik II by signing a treaty of friendship but which was published in Italian version indicating that Ethiopia had agreed becoming an Italian protectorate.

~  The Maasai agreement was written in a language that the Lenana never understood.

5)  Use of company rule. The British and the Germans used chartered companies to acquire and rule their colonies. For example, the role played by the British South African Company of Cecil Rhodes, Imperial British East African Company of Sir William Mackinnon and the German East Africa Company of Carl Peters.

6)  Luring/enticements. The Europeans gave gifts like cloth, weapons tools, drinks etc to African chiefs like Lewanika of the Lozi and Mwanga of Buganda thus luring them into collaboration.

7)  Diplomatic skills. This involved building relations with African leaders, which were later, used to acquire the areas. The British employed this method in Maasailand and Yorubaland.

8)  A blend of diplomacy and force. The British for example initially signed treaties with the Ndebele (Moffat and Rudd treaties), but they fought them during the Ndebele war of 1897.

FACTORS THAT LED TO THE SCRAMBLE FOR COLONIES IN AFRICA

Economic factors

  1. The industrial revolution in Europe.
  2. a) The revolution led to search for markets for European manufactured goods in Africa resulting in scramble for and partition.
  3. b) The need for raw materials. The machines invented processed goods faster than use of hand. The Europeans came to Africa in search of raw materials like cotton, palm oil, copper and iron ore.
  4. c) Cheap labour was also readily available in Africa after the abolition of slave trade.
  5. d) There was desire by the entrepreneurs to invest excess capital gained from accumulation of profits from industrial investment. Africa provided an avenue for investment.
  6. e) Industrial revolution led to improved transport system, which was necessary for effective colonization.
  7. f) The military hardware manufactured during the revolution enabled Europeans to conquer African territories.
  8. g) The discovery of medicine enabled the Europeans to survive the African conditions and protect themselves from diseases such as malaria, yellow fever etc.
  9. h) Those who were rendered unemployed in Europe due to invention of machines had to move to Africa to assist in harnessing raw materials.
  10. i) Industrial revolution led to intense rivalry in trade, which was projected, into Africa.
  11. Speculation about the availability of deep pockets of minerals in Africa. Gold and Bronze had

been items of trade in Africa for centuries. The discovery of Diamond at Kimberly in the

1860s and Gold in the 1870s precipitated their appetite for Africa more.

Political reasons.

  1. Unification of Germany after under Otto Von Bismarck after the Franco-Prussianwar of 1870-71. The rise of Germany upset the balance of power in Europe and there was need to rebalance out through acquisition of colonies in Africa. France for example had to redeem her lost glory (especially after the loss of mineral rich Alsace and Lorraine provinces) by acquiring eight colonies in Africa.
  2. The rise of Public opinion in Europe. There was growth of public support towards the acquisition of colonies. With the rise of democracy in European states in the 19th c, it was fatal for any government to ignore public opinion.
  3. a) For example in 1882, due to public demand, the French assembly was compelled to ratify De Brazza’s treaty with Chief Makoko thus creating a French colony in Congo.
  4. b) German took over South-West Africa (Namibia), Togo and Cameroon due to what Bismarck termed as public demand.
  5. c) In Britain, the public demanded that Britain must maintain her position as the leading colonizing power by taking her share in Africa.
  6. Militarism. Army officers in Europe favoured colonial expansionist wars to give them greater opportunities for glory or promotion.
  7. a) For example, in Sudan, it was the military offers, in search of glory, and not the French government who directed the extent of French colonization.
  8. b) British soldiers like Wolseley Kitchener supported the expansion of the British Empire in Africa.
  9. The rise of Nationalism. In Europe, there was the rise of a general feeling of civilians that their nations should acquire overseas colonies for national prestige. The Germans began feeling they belonged to a superior race that must be shown by acquiring colonies in Africa.

Strategic reasons

  1. Construction of the Suez Canal. (The Egyptian question).

~ The construction of the Suez Canal, opened in 1869, promoted a link between Europe and Asia/ shortened the routes to Far East. It also promoted international trade. It also made Egypt gain some strategic importance to Europeans.

~ The inability of Khedive Ishmael (1863-1879) to pay for the cost of the construction of the canal (due to his extravagancy) led to British full occupation of Egypt in 1882, being a major shareholder in the Anglo-Suez Company that owned the canal.

~  The dismayed French planned diversions of the Nile waters, and make Egypt a desert, after occupying territories to the south of Egypt.

~  It was against the backdrop that Britain claimed Uganda (source of the Nile) in 1894,  Kenya (the gateway to Uganda) in 1895 and Sudan (where the Nile passes) in 1898.

  1. French activities in West Africa and the Congo

The activities of France in Congo and West Africa, after loss of Egypt, through their Italian agent Savorgnan de Brazza in connection to acquisition of colonies alarmed other powers. This encouraged powers like Germany to join in the scramble and acquire Togo, Cameroon, Namibia and Tanganyika.

  1. The personal activities of King Leopold II of Belgium.

~  He endeavored to create a personal empire. In 1876, Leopold convened the Brussels

Geographical Conference where he formed a business company, the International

African Association comprising explorers and traders with a mission to civilize Africa, abolish slave trade and establish free trade.

~  As a result of the activities of his agent, Henry Morton Stanley who created  the Congo Free State, Leopold had established a personal empire in 1884 .

~  It was the activities of king Leopold leading to intense rivalry amongst European nations over Congo that led to the convening of the Berlin Conference in 1884.

Social reasons

  1. The work of Christian missionaries

~  They created an atmosphere of friendship with Africans by giving those gifts like cloths and beer, introducing economic activities like farming, carpentry, clerical work, among Africans, that were important virtues in the process of colonization.

~  Where they were in danger, they pressurized their home governments to protect them.

~  The missionaries had direct contact with the people of the interior of Africa and they were front-runners who paved way for the colonialists through their works.

~  They preached peace, love and hard work and hence calmed down the emotions of Africans towards the Europeans.

~  Some of them wrote exaggerated reports about Africa to convince Europeans to take interest in Africa.

  1. The growth of European population. The growth of European population –steadily to about 420 million in the 19th century led to the quest for new outlets to resettle the population.E.g– Britain settled some of her people in Australia, New Zealand, USA, Canada and South Africa. German, Portugal and Dutch also had to find places in Africa to settle some of their people.
  2. Anti-slave trade campaigns- Humanitarian factor.

The humanitarians in Europe like William Wilberforce and Granville Sharp, and the missionaries who led the crusade against slave trade advocated for colonization of Africa in order to stop it and introduce Legitimate Trade.When slave trade was abolished, many European nations used it as an excuse to remain in some parts of Africa, control the region, enforce the anti-slavery treaties, and promote legitimate trade.

The pull factors

  1. a) Existence of Vast natural resources in Africa. There were pockets of minerals in various parts of Africa and ivory awaiting exploitation. This attracted the Europeans.
  2. b) Well developed trade/trade routes in the interior. Imperialists used these routes as transport routes to penetrate the interior.
  3. c) Existence of Navigable Rivers. For example, rivers like Congo and Niger made transportation easy
  4. d) Existence of weak Decentralized local communities. Most African communities were decentralized with no military structures therefore offering little resistance to European invasion.
  5. e) Frequent wars / inter community wars. These wars weakened African communities and were left ill prepared for any resistance. Some readily collaborated with the Europeans.

 

 

THE PROCESS OF PARTITION

The fore –runners to the process of partitioning Africa were the early explorers, missionaries and traders. Their activities were succeeded by the making of treaties and agreements in various parts of Africa between trading companies and the locals. . For example, the Buganda Agreement, the Heligoland Treaty and the Berlin act of 1884-1885.In places where the Europeans employed diplomacy, they won the support of many Africans who collaborated with the intruders. The Europeans sometimes blended diplomacy with wars of conquest or use of force especially against the resisting communities.The partitioning boundaries were drawn along physical features like rivers, mountains, etc.The Berlin conference On 15th  November 1884, Britain, Germany, France, Belgium, the USA, Portugal and Italy convened in Berlin to lay down the rules for the partition and eliminate conflicts amongst European nations. Africans, whose continent was being shared, were not represented in the conference

The Berlin Conference of 1884-85, partitioned Africa into different spheres of influence without recourse to war.

Terms of the Berlin act of 1884-1885.

  1. a) That all signatories must declare their sphere of influence an area under each nation’s occupation
  2. b) That once an area is declared a sphere of influence, effective occupation must be

established in the area through establishment of firm colonial infrastructures to be followed by colonial administration.

  1. c) That any state, laying claim to any part of Africa must inform other interested parties in order to avoid future rivalry.
  2. d) That any power acquiring territory in Africa must undertake to stamp out slave trade in favour of legitimate trade and safeguard African interests.
  3. e) That if a European power claims a certain part of the African coast, the land in the interior next to the coast became hers.
  4. f) That the Congo River and the Niger River basins were to be left free for any interested power to navigate.
  5. g) The European powers vowed to protect and safeguard European interests in Africa irrespective of their nationality.

Impacts of the Partition

Political effects

  1. a) Introduction of European administration minimized intertribal wars and civil strife.
  2. b) It led to development of strong African leadership and beginning of state formation.
  3. c) Colonial government structures inherited by most independent African states have continued to be models of governments in African countries.
  4. d) Rise of African nationalism to fight colonialism led to the development of African political awareness.
  5. e) The Europeans gained fame, prestige and national glory by having colonial possessions.
  6. f) Negatively, it led to collapse of African traditional political systems and leadership.
  7. g) Use of divide and rule promoted ethnic disunity that continues to trouble Africa many years after independence.
  8. h) Boundary creation split apart many African communities. For example, the Somali are found both in Kenya and in Somalia, the Maasai in Kenya and Tanzania and the Ewe in Ghana and Togo.
  9. i) In some cases some communities whose cultures were incompatible found themselves bunched together.

Social impacts

  1. a) Through the protection offered to missionaries, it stimulated the spread of Christianity to various parts of Africa.
  2. b) It led to development of urban centres. Some towns grew as centres of administration e.g. Nairobi and Machakos. Others grew as railway terminus e.g. Kisumu.
  3. c) African welfare was boosted. Some African benefited from western education and health facilities introduced by the Europeans.
  4. d) European languages were introduced in Africa.
  5. e) Negatively, it created landlessness as European settlers appropriated African land.
  6. f) The Africans adopted some negative aspects of western culture.
  7. g) Many Africans lost their lives through resistance.

Economic effects

  1. a) There was construction of roads, railway and other forms of infrastructure, which helped to open up the interior.
  2. b) Imperialization helped to widen market for African produce especially with the

establishment of local industries.

  1. c) Africans were exposed to European manufactured goods/ increase in essential

commodities.

  1. d) Partition speeded up the economic growth of European nations.
  2. e) Negatively, forced labour and exploitation of African resources left many parts of Africa impoverished and underdeveloped.
  3. f) Africans were exposed to heavy taxation and denial to participate in economic activities like farming, trade etc.

AFRICAN REACTION TO EUROPEAN COLONIZATION.

RESISTANCE

Some communities were keen on defending their age-old and ancient political, social and economic institutions and viewed the arrival of the Whiteman with suspicion. Their leaders did not want to lose their power, wealth and sources of prestige. Others were militarily prepared for the Europeans. E.g the Mandinka, Nandi, Ndebele and Ethiopia.

Some resisters were centralized states enjoying immense unity making it easy to mobilize people for a war.

The Maji Maji Rebellion (1905- 1907).

The Maji Maji Uprising in Tanganyika was the most significant African challenge to German colonial rule in its African colonies. The Uprising lasted two years c over 10,000 square miles. Tanzania had been acquired largely by Dr. Karl Peters, who signed treaties with the Chiefs of Usagara, Ungula, Uzigua and Ukami, in 1885. The Rebellion involved the Zaramo, Matumbi, Bena, Ngindo, Pogoro, Bunga, Ngoni, Luguru, Wamwera and Ndendeule

Causes of the maji maji rebellion.

  1. When Germany established its control over Tanganyika by 1898, it imposed a violent regime in order to control the population. Kings who resisted German occupation were killed. Africans resented the cruel, brutal, harsh and ruthless rule of the Germans.
  2. Africans resented the Creation of new system of administration using Akidas and Jumbeswho terrorized the people and misused their positions.
  3. The African population was also subjected to high taxation by the Germany East Africa Company to raise revenue for administration. The Matumbi on their part felt that the Germans should instead have paid the Africans for using their land.
  4. The Africans resented a system of forced labour, whereby they were required to grow cotton and build roads for their European occupiers. The Africans were treated inhumanely while at work by the Akidas.
  5. The Germans had no respect for African culture in that they misbehaved with Ngindo women. Crimes like rape, fornication and adultery, committed by the Germans were punishable by death among the Ngindo.
  6. Christian missionaries discredited traditional belief and practices e.g. condemning sacred places as places of witchcraft. This greatly offended the Africans.
  7. Germans had alienated land from Africans as a way of making the railway pay for the cost of its construction. The arrival of German settlers in U sambara area in 1898, Meru in 1905 and Kilimanjaro area in 1907 led to massive loss of African land.
  8. Africans were forced to grow cotton in the communal cotton growing scheme, where they got very little payments. In 1902, Peters also ordered villages to grow cotton as a cash crop (for export) with each village, charged with producing a quota of cotton. This policy annoyed Africans who could no longer effectively work on their on farms to produce food.
  9. The Ngoni were seeking revenge for the Boma Massacre of 1897 during which their soldiers were killed in large numbers.
  10. The role of Kinjeketile Ngwale in instilling confidence in the Africans to unite and rise up against the Germans
  11. The 1905, a drought that threatened the region making Africans incur heavy losses on a crop that was not even edible, combined with opposition to the government’s agricultural and labor policies, became the immediate cause of the rebellion against the Germans in July, 1905.

Course of the maji maji war.

The oppressive regime bred discontent among the Africans, and resentment reached a fever pitch in 1905 when drought hit the region. A Ngarambe prophet, Kinjikitile Ngwale emerged, who claimed to know the secret to a sacred liquid which could repel German bullets called “Maji Maji,” which means “sacred water.” Ngwale claimed to be possessed by a snake spirit called Hongo.Thus, armed with arrows, spears, and doused with Maji Maji water, the first warriors of the rebellion began what would become known as the Maji Maji Rebellion. The rebellion was led by Kinjeketile Ngwale, Abdalla Mpanda and Ngamea. On July 31, 1905, Matumbi tribesmen marched on to Samanga and destroyed the cotton crop as well as a trading post. Kinjikitile was arrested and hanged for treason. However, Kinjekitile’s ideas were spread widely through a whispering campaign called  Njwiywia or Jujila by the Matumbi. Matumbi warriors uprooted cotton from an Akida’s farm at Nandete to provoke the chiefs to fight. On August 14, 1905, Ngindo tribesmen attacked a small party of missionaries on a safari; all five, including Bishop Spiss (the Roman Catholic Bishop of Dar es Salaam) were speared to death. The Ngindo drove their hated Akidas from their area. They boycotted cotton picking.By August 1905, Germans were restricted to four military stations i.e. Wahenga, Kilosa, Iringa and Songea. The apex of the rebellion came at Mahenge in August 1905 where several thousand Maji Maji warriors attacked but failed to overrun a German stronghold. On October 21, 1905 the Germans retaliated with an attack on the camp of the unsuspecting Ngoni people who had joined the rebellion killing hundreds of men, women, and children. This attack marked the beginning of a brutal counteroffensive that left an estimated 75,000 Maji Maji warriors dead by 1907.  Forces from Iringa under Captain Migmann assisted in the recapture of Kabata by Major Johannes.Reinforcement arrived from Germany and in 1907 warriors were defeated by Governor Graf Von Gotzen. The Germans employed the scorched earth policy which destroyed all property on sight. The Africans lost faith in the magic water. Some surrendered while others fled to

Mozambique.

Consequences of the maji maji uprising

  1. a) There was massive loss of lives. In its wake, the Maji-Maji rebellion left 15 Europeans and 389 African soldiers and between 75,000 and 100,000 insurgents dead.
  2. b) There was massive destruction of property, as villages and crops were burnt when Germans applied the scorched earth policy.
  3. c) Southern Tanganyika experienced severe famine as farms and granaries were destroyed.

This disrupted economic activities such as agriculture and trade.

  1. d) Thousands of families were displaced during the war. This was because of the fear that gripped the land, forcing people to flee in different direction.
  2. e) The war undermined the German economy in Tanganyika, as numerous economic activities came to a standstill.
  3. f) There was loss of leadership in African communities which created disorganization and demoralized the African people. Most captured leaders were hanged or imprisoned. A total of 47 Ngoni chiefs were hanged.
  4. g) Africans resigned to colonial authority. The revolt broke the spirit of the people to resist and the colony remained calm, realizing they did not have better weapons to fight with.
  5. h) The uprising undermined the Africans’ confidence in their traditional religion. The magic water failed to protect them against the German bullets.
  6. i) The uprising laid the foundation to Tanganyika’s Nationalism. The uprising would become an inspiration for later 20th Century freedom fighters who called for similar interethnic unity as they struggled against European colonial rule.
  7. j) Although the Maji Maji Uprising was ultimately unsuccessful, it forced Kaiser Wilhelm’s government in Berlin to institute reforms in their Tanganyika administration as they realized the potential cost of their brutality.

Reforms introduced by the German administration after the maji maji uprising.

  1. a) Corporal punishment was abolished by the German administration. Those settlers who mistreated their workers were punished.
  2. b) Forced labour for settler farms was abolished.
  3. c) Communal cotton growing was stopped and Africans were to plant their own cotton and get profit from it.
  4. d) Better educational and medical services for the Africans were introduced.
  5. e) Africans were involved in administration of the region as Akidas and Jumbes.
  6. f) Newspapers that incited settlers against Africans were censured.
  7. g) Kiswahili became an official language.
  8. h) A colonial department of the German government was set up in 1907 to investigate and monitor the affairs of the German East Africa.
  9. i) The new governor rejected extra taxation of Africans.
  10. j) Colonial administration in Tanganyika was now tailored to suit the Africans.

Role of religion in the Maji Maji rebellion.

  1. a) It gave people courage, loyalty and confidence to fight the Germans.
  2. b) It gave spiritual strength to fight a superior force.
  3. c) Through religion, suspicions among communities were wiped out.
  4. d) Religion stood above tribal loyalty/all followed it regardless of tribe.
  5. e) Religious cults like bolero/kolelo promised people the destruction of the white man.
  6. f) It provided the ideology, which guided the war efforts.
  7. g) It sustained the morale of the warriors.
  8. h) It provided a common plan of action based on mass action
  9. i) It provided leadership during the war e.g. the prophetic leaders.
  10. j) It was used, to address the so many African grievances emanating from the harsh German rule.

The Mandinka Resistance.

Samori Toure (c. 1830-1900)

One of the great kings and fighters of African freedom was the great Samori Toure. Born about 1830 in Sanankaro, SE of Kankan in present-day Guinea, Samori Toure chose the path of confrontation, using warfare and diplomacy, to deal with the French colonial incursion. His father was a Dyula trader, leading Toure to follow his family’s occupation. In the 1850s, he enrolled in the military forces at Madina (present-day Mali) to liberate his mother, captured during a slave raid by king Sori Birama of Bisandugu. Displaying extraordinary military skill and prowess, he and his mother were subsequently released in 1858. Coupled with his experience as a Dyula trader, he built his army. Samori employed the triple thrust of persuasion, threat and war, in the same way as Sundiata did in Mali, to organized Malinké chiefdoms and expand the Mandinka state.  Between 1852 and 1882, Samori Toure had created the Mandinka Empire with the capital at Bisandugu, in present day Gambia.Samori’s army was powerful, disciplined, professional, and trained in modern day warfare. They were equipped with European guns. The army was divided into two flanks, the infantry or sofa, with 30,000 to 35,000 men, and the cavalry or sere of 3,000 men. There was a third wing of 500 men forming specially trained bodyguards. In 1881, Samori extended the empire to the east as far as Sikasso (in Mali) to the west, up to the Futa Djallon Empire. Meanwhile, the French were extending eastwards from Futa Djalon while the Mandinka were extending westwards towards Kenyeran trading centre, Next to the rich Bure Gold fields.In 1882, at the height of the Mandinka empire, the Frenc h accused Samori Touré of refusing to withdraw from an important market center, Kenyeran (his army had blockaded the market). They thus started war on him.

His bid to obtain assistance from the British to deal with the French failed as the later were not willing to enter into conflict with the French. From 1882 to 1885, Samori fought the French and had to sign infamous Bisandugu treaty on 28th march 1886 and then 1887.

Significance of the Bisandugu treaties (1886-1887)

  1. a) To Toure, these were acts of delay the real confrontation that with the French that would come at an opportune time.
  2. b) He hoped that by this treaty, he would reach out at the British for a friendship treaty to enable him secure trade routes from the north under Tieba of Sikasso.
  3. c) The French on their part hoped to use the treaty to enable them to arrange the conquest of the Tukolor Empire.
  4. d) The treaties put the Mandinka under brief French protection.

In 1888, he took up arms again when the French reneged on the treaty by attempting to foster rebellion within his empire.

In 1890, he reorganized the army and concluded a treaty with the British in Sierra Leone, where he obtained modern weapons. He now stressed defense and employed guerilla tactics.

The Franco- Mandinka war (1891-1898)

Causes of the Franco-Mandinka war (1891-1898)

  1. a) Samori wanted to safeguard the independence and religion of his empire. Being a staunch Muslim, he could not tolerate non-Muslims on his land.
  2. b) He was not ready willing to lose the rich Bure Mines to the French whether through diplomacy or warfare.
  3. c) His empire was at that time enjoying military and economic superiority. The French incursion was merely a threat to his territorial expansion that was to be fought at all costs.
  4. d) His participation in trade had enabled him to acquire modern arms thus enabling him to build an equipped and well trained army which did not fear the encounter French. He even had facilities for arms repair.
  5. e) His scheme to play off the British against the French, between 1882 and 1889, had failed. This upset him and therefore left him only with the fighting option.
  6. f) The activities of the French of selling arms to his enemies such as Tieba of Sikasso were viewed by Samori as an act to weaken the Mandinka dominance.

Course of the franco-mandinka war.

Samori waged a seven –year war against France whose army was led by Major Archinard. In 1891, with his improved weaponry and reorganized army, he defeated the French. In 1892, French forces overran the major centers of the Mandinka Empire, leaving death and destruction in their wake.  In 1894, the French assembled all their troops in western Sudan (Senegal, Mali, Niger, etc…) to fight Samori.Between 1893 and 1898, Samori’s army retreated eastward, toward the Bandama and Como, resorted to the scorched earth tactic, destroying every piece of land he evacuated. He moved his capital east from Bisandugu to Dabakala, thus creating a second empire in 1893. This enabled him to delay the French. He formed a second empire, and moved his capital to Kong, in upper Cote d’Ivoire.

Disadvantages of Samori’s second empire

  1. a) He was cut off from Freetown where he used to buy firearms.
  2. b) He was at war with the communities, which he had attacked in his expansionist wars.
  3. c) His southern frontier was open to French attacks from the Ivory Coast.
  4. d) At his new empire, Samore was cut off from his gold mines at Bure thus; he had no wealth to keep his army running.
  5. e) The occupation of the Asante Empire by the British in 1896 meant that enemies from all corners surrounded Samori Toure.

In 1898, Samori, forced to fight a total war against innumerable odds like famine and desertion that weakened his forces, was captured on September 29, 1898, in his camp in Gué (lé) mou at the town of Sikasso in present-day Côte d’Ivoire and exiled to Ndjolé, Gabon, where he died of pneumonia on June 2, 1900.

Factors that aided Samori Toure in offering a protracted resistance to the Europeans

  1. a) He had established military workshops with a trained cadre of artisans whom he used to repair and manufacture his own weapons. This guaranteed regular supply of weapons during the resistance.
  2. b) He himself was a courageous fighter, a greater organizer and a military tactician and he personally commanded his army on the battlefield.
  3. c) His adoption of the Scorched Earth Policy as he mobilized the entire population to retreat left the French to starve and delay their advance.
  4. d) The success witnessed in trade enabled him to acquire guns and horses from the north, which were important in the resistance.
  5. e) Through trade and subsequent tribute collection, he obtained adequate wealth, which he used to maintain a large army.
  6. f) He had a large strong and well-organized army of 35,000 men, which was a formidable force for the French.
  7. g) He used diplomacy in dealing with the French to buy time to reorganize and strengthen his army, and to negotiate with the British in Sierra Leone to guarantee regular supply of guns.
  8. h) French soldiers were ignorant of the strange land they were fighting in and were faced with further problem of tropical disease.
  9. i) Some of his soldiers had served in the French colonial army and were thus familiar with the

French tactics.

  1. j) He used Mandinka nationalism and Islam to unify the army. Many of Samori’s soldiers

believed that they were fighting a Jihad (holy war) and therefore fought with determination.

Why samori was finally defeated.

  1. a) Since his army and community were constantly on the move, they could not engage in any gainful economic activity to replenish their supplies.
  2. b) The abandoning of the rich Bure Gold reserves as Samori retreated meant he had lost an important source of revenue that was initially used to sustain the army.
  3. c) When he moved to his second empire, He was cut off from Freetown where he used to buy firearms.
  4. d) Samori failed to get any support from other African societies due to lack of unity. Ahmed Seku of Tukolor and Tieba of Sikasso chose to rather assist the French than support Samori.
  5. e) His second empire was open to attack from all sides by either the British or the French, making it difficult to defend.
  6. f) The French had superior weapons and better means to re-equip their stores. They were also determined to defeat samori to set up an overseas colonial empire.
  7. g) The use of the scorched earth policy was resented by the civilians since it left them with nothing after destruction. It thus starred up local resistance.
  8. h) Even within his own empire, there was no total unity. The non-Mandinka communities and non-Muslims in the empire who had felt mistreated during his reign supported the French.
  9. i) The refusal by the British to assist Samori dented his hopes of getting a European ally against the French.
  10. j) Samori’s retreat to Liberia was blocked and his capital besieged. He had to surrender to the French.

The Ndebele Resistance

Background

The Ndebele were descendants of Nguni conquerors from South Africa (fleeing from the mfecane wars) who occupied what is now Matabeleland. Mzilikazi (Ndebele King) opened the door for the London Missionary Society led by Robert Moffat, who settled in Matabeleland in 1859. They assisted him in repairing his guns, inoculating cattle, writing and interpreting letters and providing medical care to the sick.  Hehowever had little interest in Foreigners and even had those whose who accepted missionary influence killed. Mzilikazi died in 1868 and his son Lobengula took over.Lobengula was the Ndebele king at the outbreak of the Anglo-Ndebele war of 1893. He went to great lengths to appease the increasingly aggressive British imperialists from the South, Portuguese invasion from Angola and Mozambique and Germans from the south west. He used his diplomatic skills to buy time before engaging in war with the British. He even tried to pit one European nation against the other (the Boers and the British). He in 1870 had granted a mining concession to Thomas Baines of Durban Gold Mining Co. in order to diffuse white intervention. In 1888, Lobengula signed the Moffat treat y which stated that he was not to sign any other treaty with other European groups without British permission. Rhodes sent his partner and agent Charles Rudd to compel Lobengula to acquiesce to the Rudd (mining) Concession- a verbal agreement between Lobengula and BSA Co granting the company a mining monopoly in Matabeleland. In return, he was to get a gunboat on River Zambezi or 500 sterling ponds, a monthly salary of 100 sterling pounds, 1000 rifles and 100,000 cartridges. Lobengula’s conditions for concession were not incorporated in the final text. When the terms of the treaty were interpreted to him, he learned that he had been tricked into surrendering his kingdom to Europeans.In 1889, he repudiated the treaty and sent a fruitless delegation of Indunas (Motshede and Babiyance) to London to meet Queen Victoria.  Despite the Ndebele king’s repeal of the concession, Rhodes, supported by the British crown, enacted a charter of the newly created British South Africa Company investing it with an array of rights: the right to ma.ke treaties, to pass laws and to subject the natives to its police force, as well as to make grants of minerals and land to white settlers. Lobengula was thus pushed into reluctant resistance by white greedy rapacity.

Causes of the 1893 Ndebele war.

  1. The Ndebele detested the treachery used by the British in compelling Lobengula to sign the Rudd Concession
  2. British occupation of Matabeleland had ended Ndebele powers over the shona whom they always raided for cattle and women.
  3. The British acts of provocation (inciting the Shona to raid the Ndebele for cattle). When the Ndebele chose to attack the shona, the British would then fight them under the pretext of protecting their interests in Mashonaland.
  4. The attempt by the Ndebele indunas to punish some shona who disobeyed King Lobengula became the immediate cause.

Course of the war.

The war broke out in October 1893. The British army was led by Dr.Starr Jameson and comprised the shona police and other mercenaries from South Africa. At that time, the Ndebele had been weakened by smallpox and inferior weapons leading to little confrontation between them and the British. Lobengula chose to evacuate his people towards Northern Rhodesia. Atthe two battles of Shangani River and Mbembezi. The Ndebele were defeated by superior European gun-fire. Lobengula finally fled to Bulawayo where he died in 1894. The conquerors took advantage of the natives’ inner divisions, with people of the low castes remaining passive and even some traitors helping the invaders. The aftermath of the British conquest in Zimbabwe was that cattle were seized from the natives and their land taken. Even the for the small plots that were left to them, Africans  were often forcibly prevented from ploughing and sowing, since they were subjected to tax-collection and coerced labour in whiteowned farms.  The Ndebele were pushed to the reserves of Gwaai and Shangani.

Second Matabele War (the Chimurenga war 1896-1897)

The war of liberation which was dubbed ‘Chimurenga’, or the Second Matabele War was a fulfillment of prophesy of a great Shona spirit, Mbuya Nehanda, sister of the great Shona prophet Chaminuka. Mlimo, the Ndebele spiritual leader is in fact credited with fomenting the Second Ndebele War. He convinced the Ndebele that the White settlers were responsible for the drought, locust plagues and the cattle disease rinderpest ravaging the country at the time.

Causes of the Chimurenga war

  1. a) The war broke out because the Shona and the Ndebele feared disruption of their age-old and valued trade and trade routes.
  2. b) They fought for economic and trade independence. The company had stopped shona Gold and ivory trade with the Portuguese and forced them to trade only with the company only and at low exchange rates.
  3. c) They were fighting against land alienation. The BSA Company had alienated the Ndebele land and pushed them to the Gwaai and Shangani reserves that had no water and were infested with tsetseflies.
  4. d) The war eroded the Ndebele traditional authority. When Lobengula’s sons were sent to South Africa by Rhodes for education, they were denied chance of succeeding their father.
  5. e) They detested the removal of the rights of chiefs to allocate land. The British ruined the regimental system and refused to recognize the power of the indunas and Ndebele laws.
  6. f) The British began to assume the rights to punish the subjects on behalf of the chiefs.

Sometimes even the chiefs were also punished. E.g, Chief Moghabi’s village was burnt.

  1. g) They revolted against taxation which was an interference with their economic independence. The hut tax, introduced in 1894 was collected with much brutality.
  2. h) The Ndebele were not pleased with the recruitment of the shona in the police force. They felt humiliated as the shona took the chance to revenge for the many years of oppression.
  3. i) They resented the general brutality of the whites when dealing with the Africans, like threatening the black people with punishment just before pay, to cause them to run away.
  4. j) They wanted the removal of the policy of forced labour on European mines and farmswhere workers operated under deplorable conditions, often whipped with syambok (whip) and worked for long hours without chance to engage in activities of their choice.
  5. k) The company disregarded the Ndebele customs especially the class system. They treated everybody equally, including the Holi – who were traditionally slaves to the Ndebele

aristocrats. The traditional leaders were sometimes flogged before their subjects.

  1. l) The confiscation, by the company, of 250,000 head of cattle in 1893 from the Ndebele. Leaving them with only 50,000 affected by cattle disease. The rights to raid the shona for cattle was also denied.
  2. m) The people were resented more by the Natural calamities that continued to afflict them and which religious mediums like Mlimo blamed on the presence of the whites.
  3. n) The influence of the Mwari cult leaders who urged people to resist with an assurance of victory against the British and immunity against the European bullets.

Course of the war.

Mlimo’s call to battle happened at a time when the BSA Co’s Administrator General Matabeleland, Leander Starr Jameson, had sent most of his troops to fight the Transvaal Republic in the ill-fated Jameson Raid in Dec. 1995 leaving the country’s defenses in disarray.

War in Matabeleland.On 29th March 1896, the Ndebele High Priest Umlugulu, with senior indunas, organized a ceremony to install Umfezela as Lobengula’s successor. On that day, The Ndebele rebels killed the whites on their farms as they found them by surprise. They also killed African policemen in the British force. The European settlers took refuge in fortified camps in Bulawayo, Gwelo, Belingwe and Mangwe.The British immediately sent troops to suppress the Ndebele and the Shona, but it cost the lives of many settlers, Ndebele, and Shona alike. The Matabele military defiance ended only when Burnham found and assassinated Mlimo, thanks to a Zulu informant. The Ndebele finally agreed to peace talks with Rhodes during which Rhodes agreed to disband the shona police and give the Ndebele headmen some powers as indunas.

The War in Mashonaland

On 17 June 1896, the Hwata dynasty at Mazowe attacked the Alice Mine. They succeeded in driving away the British settlers from their lands on 20 June 1896. In the same month, Mashaykuma, working with the local spiritual leader Kagubi, the Zezuru Shona people in killing a British farmer Norton and his wife at Porta Farm in Norton.

With the war in Matabeleland ending in October 1897, Gen. Carrington was able to concentrate his forces on Mashonaland. Nehanda Nyakasikana and Kagubi Gumbo-reshumba were captured and executed in 1898, but Mkwati, a priest of the Mwari shrine, was never captured and died in Mutoko. Traditional leaders played a major role in the rebellion, notably Chief Mashayamombe, who led resistance in Mhondoro, Gwabayana, Makoni, Mapondera, Mangwende and Seke.

Role of religion in the organization of the S hona –Ndebele resistance

  1. a) Religion united the Shona and Ndebele who had hitherto been bitter rivals. / The two communities entered a common plan of action.
  2. b) It boosted and sustained the morale of the masses and gave them spiritual strength to fight a might force.
  3. c) Religion was used as a base of mass action. It provided the resistance with a common ideology. Much of the ideology used was derived from Umlugulu, the chief priest of the Ndebele Nyamanda, Lobengula’s eldest son and Mlimo, the medium of Mwari Cult
  4. d) Religious leaders provided leadership to the war against white aggressors who were considered immoral and brutal.
  5. e) The Mwari Cult provided an important organization link between the Ndebele and shona since it was widespread.
  6. f) The most important representatives of the Mwari Cult were Mkwati and Singinyamatse who were the backbone of the spiritual unity of the Ndebele.

Why the Ndebele and shona were defeated

  1. a) Disunity among Africans and between Shona and Ndebele. They fought on different fronts. Even some African communities supported the British against the shona and Ndebele.
  2. b) The Ndebele social class lacked unity of purpose. The former aristocrats fought on their own

while the former slave classes chose to even cooperate with the British.

  1. c) British soldiers were well trained as compared to African soldiers. They also got

reinforcement from Botswana and South Africa.

  1. d) The arrest and execution of African leaders like Nehanda, Kagubi and Singinyamatse demoralized the people.
  2. e) The British had superior weapons as compared to African inferior weapons.
  3. f) The magic failed to protect them against the enemy bullets. Many people were killed by the British including the leaders of the Mwari cult.
  4. g) The determination of Cecil Rhodes, who negotiated for peace with Ndebele thus ending the war. This made the suppression of the Shona by the British easy.

Results of the war.

  1. a) The Africans lost their independence as the British established their authority over them.
  2. b) There was an enormous loss of life and property.
  3. c) The African land was alienated and they confined to reserves
  4. d) Africans in reserves were be subjected to forced labour.
  5. e) The war led to rapid spread of Christianity as the local people lost faith in their religion.
  6. f) The Ndebele indunas gained recognition as headmen.
  7. g) The Africans were exposed to severe famine, as the war hindered farming.
  8. h) The colonial office in London lost confidence in company rule due to its poor administration.

COLLABORATION

What is collaboration?

This was a style in which Africans responded to European intrusion through diplomacy, adaptation or allying with the Europeans for military support and for material gains

Reasons for collaboration by some African communities.

  1. a) Some African kings needed to safe guard themselves against internal and external enemies. e.g. Lewanika of Lozi who was facing threat from the Ndebele and the Ngoni.
  2. b) Others wanted to promote trade with the imperialists so that they can gain material wealth. For example, the Wanga and the Shona.
  3. c) Influence of the missionaries who convinced some African leaders to collaborate in order to get western education and civilization. E.g, François Coillard encouraged Lewanika to collaborate with the British.
  4. d) In some communities, there was need for protection against other European powers e.g. the Lozi against the Portuguese.
  5. e) Others were merely in need for assistance to gain regional supremacy. E.g the Maasai who were on downward trend as the Nandi were raising.
  6. f) To some it was a means of showing courtesy visitors assuming that they would leave soon and being ignorant of European intentions. For example, Kabaka Mwanga of Buganda.
  7. g) Other African leaders influenced some communities. For example, Chief Khama influenced Lewanika of the Lozi to resist.
  8. h) Having witnessed the European military might against the resisting neighbours some communities saw it futile to resist stronger force

The Lozi Collaboration

Factors, which influenced Lewanika of the Lozi to collaborate with the British

  1. a) Lewanika was encouraged to collaborate with the British by King Khama of Botswana who had already benefited from British protection against the Dutch in South Africa.
  2. b) The European missionaries who had visited him earlier influenced Lewanika. For example, François Coillard who convinced Lewanika to ally with the British to gain western education.
  3. c) Lewanika needed support against Portuguese and Germans who were approaching his territory.
  4. d) Lewanika wanted the British to protect his kingdom from attacks by other African communities such as the Ndebele and Shona-protection against African enemies.
  5. e) Lewanika also wanted the British to protect him against internal enemies e.g. in 1884,

Lewanika faced an internal rebellion-to safeguard his position.

  1. f) Lewanika desired western education especially for his sons and civilization in his country.
  2. g) Desire for promotion of trade between Britain and his people. He was keen on acquiring European goods such as firearms for territorial defence.
  3. h) He was fearful and considered it futile to resist a strong military force like Britain.

How Lewanika collaborated with the British.

Signing of treaties e.g. he first signed a treaty with Harry Ware in 1889 before signing the Lochner Treaty of 1890 and the Corydon Treaty of 1898. These treaties put Bulozi under British protectorate.Lewanika became friendly to British agents like Frank Lochner and the missionary, François Coillard, whom he allowed to establish a permanent mission station within his territory. He sent his sons to the Coillard mission school as a show of acceptance of westernization.

Lochner Treaty of 1890.

It was British missionary Francois Coillard who negotiated for the meeting between Frank Lochner, acting on behalf of Rhodes, and Lewanika in 1890. The treaty put Lewanika’s Kingdom under the protection of the British South African Company.

Terms of the treaty.

  1. a) Lewanika gave the BSA Company mining rights in Bulozi except in certain farming and iron mining areas.
  2. b) The company promised to protect the kingdom from outside attacks.
  3. c) The British company promised to pay the king 2000 sterling pounds a year and 4% royalties of all minerals mined in the area.
  4. d) A promise was made to develop trade, build schools and develop telegraphy in the kingdom.
  5. e) Lewanika would still be a king but just a constitutional monarch, not an absolute

ruler as before.

  1. f) That a British resident would be posted in Lealui, the capital of the Kingdom, to

monitor company activities and advise Lewanika on foreign affairs.

The treaty consequently implied that Lewanika had given up his kingdom to the British company.In 1897, Robert T. Coryndon a former police officer was sent as a British resident in Bulozi. Upon his arrival, he made arrangements for the signing of the Lawley treaty of 1898 which further reduced the size of the area governed by Lewanika.

In October 1900, he signed another treaty, the Coryndon  Treaty with Lewanika.

The Coryndon Treaty (1900)

It had the following terms;

  1. a) The British government would be responsible for administration of Bulozi. The company administrator would answer to the High Commissioner at the cape.
  2. b) The company would appoint officials and pay for the administration of the area.
  3. c) The company would provide schools, industries, postal services, transport and telegraphic facilities.
  4. d) Lewanika would receive only 850 sterling pounds a year as his stipend.
  5. e) The company was allowed to acquire land on the Batoka plateau.
  6. f) The company maintained its rights to prospect for mineral in Bulozi.
  7. g) Lewanika was to stop slavery and witchcraft in his area.
  8. h) Lewanika was made paramount chief of Barotse. His powers were reduced more when more white settlers arrived in 1905 ready to participate in government.

NB; the Coryndon treaty made Lewanika a mere employee of the company, receiving only a stipend. He lost control of the former vassal states that no longer would pay tribute to him since they were now under the British.In the final run, Lewanika lost his independence just like any other collaborator or resistor.

Results of Lewanika collaboration

  1. a) Schools and health centres were put up in his kingdom.
  2. b) He got British protection from Ndebele attacks.
  3. c) It marked the beginning of the erosion of the independence and traditional authority of his empire. Lewanika lost his authority as the administration was taken over by the British South Africa Company
  4. d) The British recognized Lewanika as a paramount chief of Barotse and gave him necessary protection.
  5. e) Lewanika received payment of £ 2000 yearly
  6. f) The British South Africa Company took over the control of the minerals
  7. g) The Lozi land was alienated and given to British settlers
  8. h) The Lozi were later forced to pay taxes in order to maintain the administration.
  9. i) The Lozi were forced to work as labourers on settler’s farms
  10. j) The Lozi were employed in the civil service
  11. k) The British South Africa Company developed infrastructure in Barotseland
  12. l) The British used Barotseland as a base to conquer the neighbouring communities.

The Buganda collaboration.

By the mid 19th century, Buganda had become the most powerful state in the interior of East Africa. However despite this might, the Kabakas (Mutesa I and Mwanga) chose the path of collaboration instead of resisting the European intrusion.

Why kabaka Mutesa I (1856-1884) collaborated with the Europeans.

  1. a) His kingdom was under threat form Khedive Ishmael of Egypt. He therefore wanted British assistance against the Egyptian threat.
  2. b) There was threat from his traditional enemy, Omukama Kabalega of Bunyoro Kingdom.
  3. c) Mutesa wanted to establish a centralized religious authority over Buganda to counter there power wielded by the traditional priest of the Lubaale Cult and the Muslim power and influence.
  4. d) He wanted modernization and to gain Prestige from association with the Europeans. For example, western education, medicine and other material benefits.
  5. e) He had the desire to trade with Europeans to get their goods especially firearms.

Kabaka Mwanga (1884-1898)

Mwanga’s main problem when he took over power was religious indecision which eventually generated political instability. In January 1885, he executed three C.M.S converts. In October 1885, he had Bishop Hannington killed. In May 1886, 30 young converts were burnt to death at Namugongo for refusing to denounce their Christian faith.

In 1888, under the urge of the traditionalists, he unsuccessfully attempted to expel all foreigners whom he blamed for causing chaos in his kingdom. He instead was disposed by a combined force of Muslims, Catholics and Protestants and replaced by his brother Kiwewa, sharing authority with foreigners.In 1890, Mwanga recaptured the throne assisted by the Christians and Kabalega of Bunyoro kingdom. He signed a protectorate treaty with Carl peters for the Germans and rejected a treaty offer by Fredrick Jackson of IBEACO. IN 1891, Mwanga signed a treaty of collaboration with  Fredrick Lugard, the First British administrator sent to Uganda. This was after the Heligoland Treaty of 1890 had put Uganda a British sphere of influence.

Why Mwanga collaborated

  1. a) He wanted to acquire protection from internal and external enemies e.g religious groups and Banyoro.
  2. b) He wanted to secure his position and safeguard the Baganda from interference.
  3. c) He wanted the British to help him Gain regional supremacy over the surrounding kingdoms of Bunyoro, Ankole and Toro.However, throughout all the religious conflicts that continued in Uganda between the Protestants and the Catholics, Kabaka Mwanga always supported the Catholics to the Chagrin of the British administrators. He was disposed by Lugard in 1894 after the capture of his palace at Mengo.Under Kabaka Mwanga II, Buganda became a protectorate in 1894. This did not last and the Kabaka declared war on Britain in on July 6, 1897. He was defeated at the battle of Buddu on July 20 of the same year. He fled to German East Africa where he was arrested and interned at Bukoba. The Kabaka later escaped and led a rebel army to retake the kingdom before being defeated once again in 1898 and being exiled to the Seychelles.While in exile, Mwanga II was received into the Anglican Church, was baptized with the name of Danieri (Daniel). He spent the rest of his life in exile. He died in 1903, aged 35 years. In 1910 his remains were repatriated and buried at Kasubi.The war against Kabaka Mwanga II had been expensive, and the new commissioner of Uganda in 1900, Sir Harry H. Johnston, had orders to establish an efficient administration and to levy taxes as quickly as possible. This he did through the Buganda Agreement of 1900

The Buganda agreement

The Buganda agreement was signed in 1900 between Sir Harry Johnstone, British Official, and Apollo Kagwa, representing the Baganda

Reasons for signing of the Buganda agreement

  1. a) The treaty was to define the position of Buganda in the country.
  2. b) To introduce law and order in the country.
  3. c) To reduce the cost of British administration since Buganda was to meet the cost of administration.
  4. d) To define the relationship between Buganda and the British government.

Terms of the Buganda agreement

  1. a) The Buganda laws were to remain in effect as much as they did not interfere with protectorate laws that were to be applicable to Buganda Kingdom as well. Bugandakingdom was to be ruled by the Kabaka with the assistance of Katikiro. The Lukiko was to be the legitimate body making laws of Buganda and it was to compose 89 members.
  2. b) Buganda people were to pay poll and hut tax. However, No tax was to be levied on Buganda unless approved by the Lukiko (parliament). Revenue from Buganda was to be merged with all the revenue from other provinces.
  3. c) The kabaka, ministers and Chiefs to be paid since they were now employees of the British government.
  4. d) Buganda boundaries were defined to include parts of Bunyoro (the ten sazas she had acquired from Bunyoro). The kingdom was therefore expanded to twenty counties. To ease administration, each county was placed under a Saza Chief.
  5. e) Land tenure system was changed to include land on freehold basis (Mailo land) and crown land. The crown land was for protectorate government while the Mailo land was particularly for the kabaka, his ministers and his chiefs.
  6. f) Though Buganda became a province within the protectorate, Ganda system of government was recognized and modified. It was to have three ministers (katikiro, treasurer and chief justice.). The Lukiko had fixed number- 20-saza chiefs, 60 notables and 6 Kabaka’sappointees.

Results of the Buganda agreement.

  1. a) British overlord ship was confirmed over Buganda.
  2. b) Buganda was reduced to a status of a mere province.
  3. c) The position of the king was reduced – he lost his power to give or withhold land as well as the power to appoint or transfer chiefs.
  4. d) The 1900 Agreement led to the birth of early nationalistic movements. For example, the Bataka Opposition Movement in the 1920s by the landless class people rising up against the land-owning group.
  5. e) Modern economy and western education were introduced with Buganda taking the lead.
  6. f) Buganda formed the basis for the British administration as baganda were appointed as British administrators.
  7. g) It strengthened the special position of Buganda in relation to other communities in Uganda.
  8. h) Sazas were increased from 10 to 20 and saza chiefs got land and right to impose land rent.
  9. i) It led expansion of Christianity and decline of Islamic influence.
  10. j) Bunyoro kingdom became aggrieved as results of loss of part their territory that was transferred to Buganda by the British. This caused friction later.

Results of African collaboration

  1. a) Just like resistors, the collaborating communities also lost their independence and were eventually colonized. Bulozi and Buganda finally became British Protectorates.
  2. b) The collaborating community leaders gained some recognition, though with reduced powers. Lewanika foe example became the paramount Chief of Barotseland while Kabaka gained the title, ‘His Highness’.
  3. c) The collaborators were able to secure some amount of protection from their traditional enemies. The Lozi were protected from the Ndebele while the Baganda were protected from the Banyoro.
  4. d) The collaborators were used by the Europeans to exert their authority over other African societies. The baganda on their part were used to administer Busoga.
  5. e) The collaborating Africans gained from missionary work. Lewanika’s sons for example gained western education. Hospitals and schools were also built in the kingdoms.
  6. f) There was increased trade between the collaborating communities and the Europeans. The communities gained European goods such as glassware, clothes, guns and ammunition.
  7. g) The collaborators just like resistors were later subjected to economic exploitation such as land alienation, mining, taxation and forced labour.

ESTABLISHMENT OF COLONIAL RULE IN KENYA

CAUSES OF THE SCRAMBLE FOR EAST AFRICA

Factors that contributed to the scramble and partition of East Africa

  1. The rise of Nationalism in Europe. The Unification of Germany, after the Franco- Prussian war (1870-71) upset the balance of power in Europe and there was need to rebalance out through acquisition of colonies in Africa including east Africa. The Germans also felt that the only way their nation could gain recognition among other European powers was through securing colonial possession.
  2. Strategic location of East Africa in relation to Egypt. Europeans were concerned with the source of the river Nile in East Africa and control of the Suez Canal. Therefore, the ownership of East Africa was crucial to the Egyptian affairs. East Africa, had, from the days of the Portuguese conquest in the 15th century, proved to be a strategic location for fresh supplies. That is why the Germans and the British competed for possessions in the region.
  3. The need to speed up economic development of the European countries. The industrializednations were rushing for colonies to tap raw materials to keep their factories running. There was also a popular believe that East Africa contained pockets of precious metals awaiting exploitation. They were also driven by the search for market for European produced goods.

The Europeans were also looking for places to invest their capital.

  1. The rise of Public opinion in Europe. There was growth of public support towards the acquisition of colonies. E.g., the Daily Press in London spoke well about acquiring colonies.
  2. Social factors.

~  East Africa was to be occupied as a means of stamping out slave trade and replacing

it with legitimate trade.

~  The Europeans were keen on spreading their culture to east Africa.

~  They wanted to protect their missionaries who were already operating in east Africa

The process of Partition

The Berlin conference failed to fully resolve the rivalry between the Germans and the British in East Africa. The activities of Karl Peters and Harry Johnstone for the Germans and the British respectively in the Mount Kilimanjaro region depicted intense rivalry which almost led to war.The two signed treaties with local chiefs as a way of legalizing their arbitrary declaration of their spheres of influence. Karl peters even declared german protectorate over Ungulu, Uzigua, Usagara and Ukami.These activities together with those of Sir William Mackinnon of the Imperial British East Africa Company became the immediate cause of the partition of east Africa.The partition of East Africa was sealed through the following two treaties.

The Anglo-German Agreement of 1886

The agreement facilitated peaceful settlement of the german and British claims on east Africa as follows;

  1. a) The Sultan was given the 16 KM (10mile) coastal strip from Vanga to Lamu. He also acquired islands of Zanzibar, Pemba, mafia, Lamu, pate and Towns like Lamu, Kisimayu, Mogadishu, Merca, and Brava.
  2. b) Germany acquired the coastline of Witu the region between river Umba in the North and river Ruvuma in the south.
  3. c) The British got the territory north of river Umba up to river Juba in the north.

However, the treaty failed to determine the western boundary, thus leaving Uganda up for grab to any power that got there first. Uganda therefore became a theatre of intense rivalry between Karl Peters who even secured a treaty with Kabaka Mwanga in 1890 and Fredrick Lugard who tried in vain to sign a treaty with Kabaka Mwanga.

This tension is what led to the Heligoland Treaty of 1890.

Terms of the Heligoland Treaty of 1890

  1. a) Germany officially recognized Uganda as a British sphere of influence/protectorate.
  2. b) Germany abandoned her claim over the territory of Witu for British in exchange for Heligoland island in the North sea
  3. c) Germany accepted British protectorate over Zanzibar and Pemba.
  4. d) Germany acquired a strip of land on Lake Tanganyika from Britain and the Coastal region of Tanganyika from the Sultan of Zanzibar.
  5. e) The Sultan of Zanzibar retained a 16km (10 miles) Coastal strip.

This treaty thus ended the scramble for and partition of East Africa.

BRITISH OCCUPATION OF KENYA

Methods used by the British to occupy Kenya.

  1. a) Signing of treaties. The following treaties were signed either by the British or on behalf of the British to facilitate their occupation of Kenya;

~  A treaty by Sir William Mackinnon and the Sultan of Zanzibar Barghash in 1887

which effectively put Zanzibar under the British for 50 years.

~  The Maasai Agreements of 1904 and 1911 between Oloibon Lenana and the British

~  The Anglo-Germany Treaties of 1886 and 1890.

  1. b) The British collaborated with communities like the Wanga and Maasai who were later used as bases to extend British Authority over other areas.
  2. c) Establishing operational bases. The British built Forts like Fort Smith (Kabete) and Fort Hall (Murang’a) to enhance their political control.
  3. d) Use of company Rule. In the initial stages, due to the fear of the enormous costs of effective occupation and administration, the British mandated the IBEA. Company to administer the Kenyan protectorate.The Imperial British East Africa Company of Sir William Mackinnon was given the royal charter in 1888 and thus had the following new powers;
  4. a) Levying and collecting taxes and institute custom duties in the area.
  5. b) Establishing political authority and Maintain of law and order in the British East Africa.
  6. c) Promoting legitimate trade and Eradicate slave trade
  7. d) Developing and civilizing the indigenous peoples with the assistance of the imperial consul based in Zanzibar.

Achievements of the IBEAC.

  1. a) The company succeeded in quelling local aggression in the British spheres of influence from

communities such as the Nandi, Maasai and Akamba.

  1. b) The company established a series of Forts at Kibwezi, Machakos, Smith and Dagoretti, which laid the basis for colonial administration in Kenya.
  2. c) The company improved transport and communication in the protectorate by pioneering road construction in Kenya. For example the Sclater’s Road between Kibwezi and Busia in 1894 which assisted in transportation of railway building materials.
  3. d) The company succeeded in eradicating slavery to some extend and securing freedom for many slaves.
  4. e) The company also developed a rubber industry along the coast and the interior.

Reasons why Britain used the IBEA Company to administer her possession

  1. a) Absence of a clear policy on the administration of colonial possessions. This gave room to the use of the company to administer the colony.
  2. b) The company could provide cheap administrative capital that Britain had failed to raise for colonial governance. The colonies were not yet economically viable
  3. c) There was a problem of inadequate personnel to be used in the administration of the colonies.
  4. d) B.E.A.Co’s long experience in the region. The company had invested heavily in east Africa, hence making its participation in the administration of the colony inevitable.

Why company rule had failed by 1895.

  1. a) The region lacked strategic natural resources for export thus making the IBEACO, a trading company, to operate at a loss and narrow its revenue base. Minerals like Gold, copper and Diamond were not existent.
  2. b) The company lacked sufficient capital to carry out the day- to- day administrative operations. The company had spent the little funds available in the construction of fortified trading stations, with little reward.
  3. c) Transportation of goods in the region proved expensive and slow as the region did not have any navigable rivers
  4. d) The company faced the problem of poor coordination of its activities caused by lack of proper channels of communication between the head office in Europe and the offices in the colony.
  5. e) Some of the company officials were corrupt and therefore misappropriated funds.
  6. f) The company faced numerous resistances especially in the Nandi country thus disrupting their operation. At one time, Fort Smith was set on fire by African resisters.
  7. g) Some of the company officials lacked experience in administrative matters since most of them came merely as traders.
  8. h) The company officials also were affected by the harsh tropical climate and diseases like malaria and sleeping sickness that killed many.

The company thus surrendered the Charter in 1895 to the British government for a

compensation of 250,000 dollars

Factors facilitated the establishment of the British control over Kenya during the 19th century?

  1. a) The Christian missionary factor. They created an atmosphere of friendship with Africans, which was important for colonization. They also occasionally called home for protection against hostile communities.
  2. b) Presence of trading company (IBEACO. The companies through their agents signed treaties with African rulers and among themselves as a means of initiating effective occupation of Kenya.
  3. c) Superior military power/good army. The European armies were more efficient than he African ones. This was witnessed in the ability to quell the numerous wars of resistance like the Nandi resistance.
  4. d) Disunity among African communities. By the time the British came to East Africa, the Wanga were up against the neighboring communities in western Kenya, the Nandi and the Maasaiwere at war and the Mijikenda against the coastal Arabs over land. This was of advantage to the British.
  5. e) Signing of treaties. There was Collaboration of some communities with the British. The Maasai signed the Maasai Agreement of 1900. The Wanga also signed various treaties with the British.
  6. f) The British policy of indirect rule was readily acceptable, thus reducing the chances of resistance.
  7. g) Financial support from the home government.

KENYA PEOPLES’ RESPONSES BRITISH INVASION OF KENYA

Africans in Kenya offered varied responses to the British intrusion into their country. Some resisted while other collaborated.The communities that resisted actively included the Nandi, Agiryama, Bukusu, Somali and sections of the Agikuyu

 

 

 

The Nandi Resistance (1895-1906)

Reasons why the Nandi resisted British occupation of their land

  1. a) The Nandi had gained a lot of pride, having subdued their neighbours E.g the Luo, Maasai, Abagusii and Abaluhyia. At that time, they were enjoying a sense of superiority that gave them confidence to take the British Intruders head-on.
  2. b) The Nandi military superiority made them feel equal if not superior to the whites. Their warriors were well- trained and equipped and had gained a lot of experience through the numerous cattle raids the conducted against their neighbours.
  3. c) The Nandi detested the physical appearance of the white people which they considered as evil and must be expelled from their community.
  4. d) The Nandi were opposed to Land alienation by the British. They disliked the grabbing of their land for railway construction/white settlement.
  5. e) Kimnyole’s prophecy that foreigners would dominate the Nandi motivated them to fight against the Europeans.
  6. f) The Nandi had a long history of resisting and fighting intruders. They had successfully warded off the Arab and Swahili traders in the 1850s.
  7. g) The Nandi resisted as a means of safeguarding their independence which they had enjoyed for a long time.
  8. h) The Nandi also enjoyed unity under the leadership of Koitalel Arap Samoei between 1895 and 1905. This had helped them to register numerous victories against neighbouring communities. They therefore felt strong enough to resist the British.

Course of the Nandi rebellion

The Nandi wars of resistance began in 1895. The Nandi mainly employed guerilla warfare ambushing the caravan traders and mail carriers who passed in their territory.

When two Nandi warriors strayed into the Guasa Mesa administrative camp headed by Andrew Dick in 1895, he murdered them as a response to the attacks by the Nandi on foreigners passing in their territory.The Nandi retaliated through the murder of a British trader, Peter West and thirty of his workers. This sparked off British punitive expeditions against the Nandi with the first in 1897 which however failed to stop the Nandi raids.

When the railway reached the Nandi territory, they refused to cooperate with the railway builders and even kept stealing building materials to make weapons and ornaments. They even ambushed and murdered railway builders.In 1900, the British sent three punitive expeditions under Colonel Evatt, the commander of the Uganda Rifles reinforced by the Maasai, Baganda, Swahili and Indian mercenaries.The Nandi were supported by the Kipsigis enabling them to resist for so long causing high death toll on the British and the Nandi as well.The year 1901 witnessed a temporary truce worked out by the British administrator, Walter Mayes (1901-1905), after realizing the heavy causalities both sides were experiencing.

The war was re-ignited when the Nandi realized that the British had started settling and farming on their land. They destroyed the railway in protest. The British reacted by destroying crops and villages and stealing cattle for the next three years.

The Nandi war of resistance only ended when the British officer in Nandi, Captain

Meinertzhagen, hatched a plan to have Koitalel, the chief coordinator of the résistance, killed. He and his advisers were killed in October 1905, during a “peace” meeting convened by Meinertzhagen.

The Nandi finally sought for peace in December 1905 ending the ten year long resistance.

Why the Nandi offered the longest and strongest ever resistance to the British intrusion in Kenya.

  1. a) The British intrusion into their territory happened when the Nandi were at the best of their power and superiority.
  2. b) Existence of a superior military organization based on the age set system. The Nandi army was strong and could match any foreign force. The regimental age-set system supplied the Nandi with young men who were experienced in battle, disciplined, organized and were effective.
  3. c) The Nandi also possessed knowledge of weapon manufacture and repair through their local ironsmiths and using stolen railway material.
  4. d) The Nandi enjoyed regular supply of food and war equipment which sustained the fighters for a long period. This was mainly aided by the Nandi mixed economy enabling them to turn livestock for food when the British destroyed crops.
  5. e) The Nandi had good knowledge of the terrain in which they were fighting the intruders thus having an advantage over the British who were not familiar with the terrain. The difficulties faced by the British as posed by the terrain disadvantaged them durin g the resistance
  6. f) The Nandi knowledge of Guerilla tactics. This enabled them to organize many surprise attacks while vandalizing key British installations like the telegraph lines.
  7. g) The existence of strong leadership. The Nandi leadership was religiously inspired and therefore very strong. The Orkoiyot was their symbol of unity and strength and was believed to possess some supernatural powers that gave courage to the fighters.
  8. h) Their enemies, the British troops, were slowed down in their advance by problems like respiratory disease due to the wet and cold climate. The Nandi were accustomed to these conditions
  9. i) The Nandi received assistance from the Kipsigis fighters – the Elgeyo, Lembus and Nyangori which enabled them to hold off the British for Six weeks in 1900.

Why the Nandi were defeated in the hands of the British

  1. a) The British obtained support, against the Nandi, from the collaborating communities like the Somali and the Maasai.
  2. b) The British military strength remained superior to that of the Nandi especially in terms of the weapons. Their guns were superior to the Nandi spears.
  3. c) There was an outbreak of smallpox in the Nandi country 1890. This weakened them by killing many and rendering others unable to fight on.
  4. d) They Nandi failed to get support from the neighboring Kenyan communities like the Luo and the Abaluhyia who were not friendly to them.
  5. e) The treachery employed by Captain Meinertzhagen, the British commander who lured Nandi Orkoiyot Koitalel Arap Samoei to a meeting where he was killed.
  6. f) The death of Koitalel Arap Samoei demoralized the Nandi into even signing for peace.
  7. g) The British used Scorched Earth Policy, which seemed more punitive to the Nandi since their houses were burnt and livestock confiscated.

Results of the Nandi resistance.

  1. a) The Nandi country was colonized by the British after 1906. The Nandi lost their

independence.

  1. b) There was massive loss of life. Koitalel Arap Samoei, his entire council of elders and over 1000 warriors were killed. The British also experienced casualties on the part of their forces.
  2. c) There was destruction of property through burning and looting. E.g the British confiscated at least 5000 herds of cattle and burnt more than 5000 huts and grain stores.
  3. d) There was massive land alienation. The Nandi were pushed into reserves where they experienced impoverishment due to drought and cattle diseases. The Nandi lot their territory and traditional salt licks at Kapchekendi and Kamelilo that were now inhabited by the whites.
  4. e) The Nandi military organization disintegrated thus making them lose their dignity and authority in the region.
  5. f) The Nandi were separated from their close cousins and allies the Kipsigis through the creation of the Nandi Reserves where they were confined. Their economic lifestyle of grazing animals freely was also disrupted.
  6. g) Many Nandi warriors were recruited into the colonial police.

Agiriama resistance.

A Bantu speaking group inhabiting the coastal region, their reaction to the British invasion was motivated by the reaction of the Mazrui Arabs and the Swahili who rose up against the British in 1895.The Agiriama reaction began as an offer of support to the Mazrui Arabs, with whom they had long trading links, during their conflict with the British over succession to the TakaunguSheikhdom. The Agiriama was also hitting back against the Busaidi Arabs who were encroaching on their territory. The British had supported the Al Busaidi collaborators throughout succession conflict.The British reacted by bombarding Rashid’s Headquarters at Mweli forcing the Agiriama and the Mazrui to resort to guerilla warfare. While the Mazrui Arabs later surrendered, the Agiriama now resorted to full scale résistance against the British encroachment in 1914.

 

 

Causes of the Agiriama resistance

  1. a) They did not want to pay taxes, especially hut tax that was hurting to traditionally polygamous group, to the British. The British also were forcing them to pay it in terms of labour instead of allowing them to sell their grains and livestock to pay.
  2. b) They had lost their independence/the British replaced the Agiriama traditional rulers with their own appointees
  3. c) They were opposed to forced labour on British plantations for little or no pay especially on land that had been snatched from them.
  4. d) The British did not respect their culture. The British policemen at Kitengani insulted the Agiriama culture by raping their women.
  5. e) The Agiriama were reacting against forced conscription into the King’s African Rifles. They were forced to produce 1000 able-bodied men within a month, join the British army
  6. f) They lost their land to the British due to the massive land alienation for settler farming. They were forced to offer paid labour on their own former land to the chagrin of the elders.
  7. g) The British, who were seeking to take over the Agiriama role as middlemen, disrupted their trade in ivory and food stuffs
  8. h) They disliked the British-appointed headmen whose duties included collection of taxes and recruitment of labour.

Course of the resistance

The Agiriama resistance was inspired by a Giriama prophetess, Mekatilili WA Menza. She was joined by an Elder, Wanje wa Madorika in mobilizing people to a mass resistance against the British rule.The immediate course of their reaction was the forced military recruitment into the KAR. To provoke the British to war, they barred their young men from moving outside their villages to work.Mekatilili and Wanje called on the people to return to their ancestral shrine at Kaya Fungo and offer sacrifices and denounced all appointed puppet rulers in favour of the traditional council of elders.

The two administered traditional oaths to unite and inspire the people to war. I.e. the Mukushekushe oath for women and the Fisi oat for men.When a state of emergency was declared by the British over the Agiriama, they resorted to Hitand-run warfare. They attacked the homes of loyalists, Europeans and collaborators forcing the missionaries to seeker refuge at Rabai. The British countered the hit-and-run warfare with burning villages and crops and driving away livestockThe resistance only subsided when Mekatilili and Wanje were arrested and deported to Kisii.The Arabs, under Fadhili bin Omari, mediated between the Agiriama and the British, marking the end of the war under the following terms;

  1. a) The Agiriama to offer a specific number of labourers for European settlers and

public works.

  1. b) They would also offer a certain number of able-bodied men to serve in the King’s African Rifles.
  2. c) The British would occupy all the land to the north of River Sabaki.

Role of Mekatilili in the Agiriama resistance.

  1. a) She encouraged the Agiriama to face the British by administering the Mukushekushe and Fisi oaths to unite the people to war.
  2. b) She presented the grievances of the Agiriama, some of which the British later addressed.
  3. c) She rallied the people together against a common enemy thus laying the basis for

nationalistic struggles for independence.

Results of the Agiriama resistance to the British

  1. a) Many people lost their lives some as fighters while others were caught in the crossfire.
  2. b) The Agiriama lost their independence to the British
  3. c) There was Rampant destruction of property i.e. food stores at home, food crops in the fields and cattle. Some property was lost through confiscation.
  4. d) The community’s economic activities were disrupted, especially the lucrative trade at Takaungu, where they had been acting as middlemen.
  5. e) The Agiriama were prohibited from brewing traditional liquor.
  6. f) The British withdrew their order demanding Agiriama to move out of their homes.
  7. g) For the first time women took up the leadership of the rebellion e.g. Mekatilili

Bukusu resistance

Reasons why the Bukusu resisted the British rule

  1. a) They wanted to safeguard their independence and culture i.e. circumcision.
  2. b) They were being compelled to recognize Nabongo Mumia as the overall leader of Abaluhyia.
  3. c) The Bukusu did not like the idea of paying taxes to the British through force.
  4. d) They resented the British demand in 1894, that the Bukusu warriors surrender guns they possessed.
  5. e) The British invasion had happened when the Bukusu were enjoying immense military power.

Course of the resistance

The Bukusu resistance began with the ambush of a trade caravan heading to Ravine through bukusuland. The Bukusu stole all the rifles. When they were commanded to surrender all the guns in 1894 and declined, the British sent a punitive expedition which however was defeated. The British administrator at Elureko, Charles Hobley sought for reinforcement from Major William Grant of the Ugandan protectorate.

In 1895, at the battles of Lumboka and Chetambe, the Bukusu were summarily defeated.

Methods used by the Bukusu to resist the British.

  1. a) Use of Warfare. They directly fought the British troops led by Major William Grant, at Lumboka and Chetambe hills.
  2. b) The Bukusu ambushed a caravan of traders, sent by the commanding officer at Kavirondo to the Ravine Station.
  3. c) Revolting against rule by Wanga agents. The Bukusu Murdered a Wanga agent, Hamisi, who had been sent, to administer the area. `

Effects of the Bukusu resistance

  1. a) The Bukusu lost most of their land through massive land alienation
  2. b) They lost their independence as bukusuland was declared part of the British East Africa

Protectorate

  1. c) There was massive loss of life within the Bukusu and the British forces.
  2. d) There was loss f property and disruption of Bukusu economy. The Bukusu lost their cattle

and sheep.

  1. e) Bukusu women and children were taken prisoners by the British.

The Somali resistance.

The Somali resistance was a reaction to the British declaration that Jubaland was a British protectorate. They were led by their leader Ahmad bin Murgan.

causes of Somali resistance.

  1. a) The Somali were opposed to the division of Somaliland into the British and Italian spheres of influence, which separated the clans.
  2. b) They were opposed to punitive expedition sent against them by the British.
  3. c) The Somali people being Muslims were opposed to being controlled by the British who were Christians.
  4. d) The British attempted to stop the Somali raiding activities against their neighbors.
  5. e) The Somali were against British control of their pastureland and watering points.
  6. f) The British wanted the Somali to drop their nomadic way of life.

Course of the resistance.

The British initially reacted minimally to the Somali aggression on their Kisimayu

neighbourhood in 1898 due to the following reasons;

  1. a) They viewed such an undertaking as to expensive in terms of the arms and military personnel that would have been involved.
  2. b) The Somali were a nomadic group therefore it was very hard and time consuming to suppress them.
  3. c) There was no economic justification for waging such a war on a highly unproductive territory. However, when the Somali murdered the British sub-commissioner for Jubaland, Mr Jenner, in 1900, the British dispatched a punitive expedition of Indian regiments against them.The Somali rose up again in 1905 against the British after they had procured Firearms. The Somali skirmishes continued into 1914 with the change of boundaries and finally ended in 1925 when Jubaland was put under the Italian Somaliland.

Results of the Somali resistance

  1. a) There was massive loss of life, as many Somalis were killed. Sub-commissioner Jenner was also killed.
  2. b) The British divide the Darod and Hawiye clans through the boundary changes of 1914.
  3. c) The Somali cattle were confiscated.
  4. d) Somali lost their independence through the declaration of the protectorate status.
  5. e) The process of colonization by Europeans was delayed considerably.
  6. f) There was favorable boundary change that saw Ogaden being placed under Italian Somaliland.

Collaboration

In Kenya, the Maasai, Wanga and a section of the Agikuyu, Akamba, and Luo collabo rated.

The Maasai collaboration

In the 19th century, the Maasai community changed from a once feared community to one marred by succession disputes and natural calamities. The Disputes between Lenana and Sendeyo over succession of Mbatian after he died weakened the Maasai community to the level of merely collaborating with the British intruders. Sendeyo moved with his followers to northern Tanzania leaving behind Lenana’s group who chose the path of collaboration.

Reasons for the Maasai collaboration with the British

  1. a) Losses of the Maasai military supremacy. At the time the British came to Kenya, the Nandi had overtaken the Maasai in terms of military superiority. They therefore sought for foreignsupport against their aggressors.
  2. b) Internal feuds. There were a series of succession disputes in the period between 1850 and 1890 caused by differences in economic activities. In one of the disputes, when Lenana seemed to be losing to Sendeyo, he appealed to the British for support.
  3. c) Natural calamities/disasters. The Maasai country witnessed severe hunger, livestock and human diseases in the 1850s. These weakened them more making them unable to resist.
  4. d) Threat and wars from the Agikuyu. When the Maasai went to reclaim their women and children at the end of the hunger period, they were met with outright threat of attacks from the Agikuyu. They therefore sought British support.
  5. e) Prophecy of Mbatian. He prophesized the coming of a white man who was more powerful and that the Maasai should not bother to resist him.
  6. f) Lenana personally chose the path of collaboration because he wanted to consolidate his position and that of his kingdom. He was looking for the much needed military support to overcome his sibling, Sendeyo of the Loita Maasai.

 

 

The process of Maasai collaboration.

The attempt by Lenana to secure assistance against Sendeyo was the beginning of his collaboration with the British.The Kedong massacre incident (Maasai warriors attacked a caravan of Swahili and Agikuyu traders travelling from Ravine) and the resultant death of 100 Maasai at the hands of three white men (Andrew Dick and two French companions) made the Maasai the immediately seek for collaboration with the British.They cooperated with the British in establishment of colonial administration. The provided mercenaries in the British punitive expedition against the Nandi, Kipsigis and Kikuyu. Maasai were rewarded with cattle acquired from uncooperative peoples e.g. The Nandi and Agikuyu

They exchanged gifts and used British manufactured goods. Lenana was made a paramount chief. Between 1904 and 1923, a fair proportion of the Maasai agreed to be moved from one grazing land to another to pave way for British settlement.They signed the first Maasai agreement in 1904 by which they moved into two reserves, one to the south of Ngong and the railway and the other up on the Laikipia plateau. A corridor of five kilometres was set aside in Kinangop for the Eunoto ceremony that accompanied circumcision. The second Maasai agreement of 1911 implied the Maasai abandon the Laikipia plateau to rejoin others in the enlarged southern reserve.

Results of the Maasai collaboration

  1. a) Lenana was made a paramount chief of the Maasai in 1901.
  2. b) The collaboration led to the separation of the Maasai related clans. The Purko Maasai were divided into the Loita and Ngong Maasai.
  3. c) There was massive land alienation with the Maasai being moved to the Ngong and Laikipia reserves and later the southern reserve.
  4. d) Maasai freedom in conducting rituals was curtailed with their confinement to a five –square-mile reserve for initiation rites.
  5. e) The Maasai lost their independence. Just like any other part of kenya, Maasailand became part of the British protectorate.
  6. f) There was total disruption of their territorial integrity. Even their cattle economy was disrupted as the number of livestock was reduced. There was an attempt to cause them to abandon their nomadic habit.
  7. g) The Maasai gained material reward in form of cattle and grains looted from resisting communities like the Nandi and Luo of Ugenya.
  8. h) Their age old custom of livestock cross- breeding with their Samburu neighbours was disrupted with the curtailing of their migratory behaviour. Their stock was therefore weakened.
  9. i) Some Maasai were hired as mercenaries against the resisting communities such as the Nandi and Agikuyu.

 

 

 

Wanga Collaboration

Nabongo Mumia, the Wanga leader from 1880, was an ambitious and shrewd leader who had the desire to expand his Kingdom through collaboration with  British intruders and soliciting their military assistance.

Reasons for Wanga Collaboration

  1. a) Nabongo Mumia hoped that by collaborating, he would be made a paramount Chief of the entire western region.
  2. b) There was family rivalry over leadership. This compelled Mumia to seek help against his brother Sakwa. He wanted to safeguard his position at home.

Key notes for the teacher and students- @Cheloti 2013  Page 33

  1. c) He wanted British protection against the Nandi, who were by then enjoying military superiority, the Bukusu and the Luo of Ugenya
  2. d) He wanted to revive a disintegrating kingdom.
  3. e) He wanted to take advantage of the British western civilization particularly education and religion. He also wanted material gains from the British.
  4. f) He aimed at achieving territorial expansion. Mumia aimed at ruling up to Kabras, Kimilili, Marama, Butsotso, Ugenya and Samia.
  5. g) He realized that his community was very small and it was futile to resist the militarily superior Europeans.
  6. h) Having realized that the British declaration of western Kenya as their sphere of influence was inevitable, he chose to become their ally at the earliest opportunity ever.

Process of Wanga Collaboration.

Mumia’s contact with the outside world began when he befriended the Swahili and Arabcaravan traders and later the IBEA Company merchants when they visited wangaland.They built a fort and a trading station at Elureko, his capital, which was to remain the headquarters of the British administration in western Kenya until 1920.

Ways in which Nabongo of Wanga collaborate with the British.

  1. a) He offered his seat-elureko to become an operational base of the British expeditions.
  2. b) He offered his men to fight alongside the British in their expeditions against other communities.
  3. c) He provided Wanga agents to aid the British in administering the conquered areas.
  4. d) The Wanga provided food, water and shelter to the British invading forces.
  5. e) They gave the British free passage through their territory and offered them hiding places during the battles.
  6. f) Mumia signed treaties of friendship with the British.

Results of the Wanga collaboration with the British.

  1. a) Wanga kingdom was strengthened using military support from the British. Wanga kingdom was expanded. Nabongo gained more territories e.g. Samia, Bunyala and Busoko
  2. b) Their king Mumia was declared a paramount Chief thus raising his prestige. He ruled as a British paramount chief ruling as far as Bunyala, Gem , Ugenya and Alego, upto 1926, when he officially retired
  3. c) Mumia warriors became agents of the British colonialism. The warriors were used to subdue the Luo, Bukusu and Nandi.
  4. d) The Wanga Princes became agents of British rule over western Kenya. For example, Mumia’s half-brother Murunga was appointed chief of the Isukha and Idakho.
  5. e) Mumias headquarters at Elureko became the seat of British administration in western Kenya upto 1920 when it was moved to Kakamega.
  6. f) Mumia and his people gained material benefits from the British through trade, western education and religion.
  7. g) Nabongo Mumia became an important ally of the British administration in western ken\ya, providing them with vital information over the appointment of chiefs and Headmen in western Kenya.
  8. h) Due to the Wanga Collaboration, there was intensified enmity and hostility between the Wanga people and other Abaluhyia subsections who viewed the Wanga as traitors.
  9. i) However, The Wanga, just like any other collaborator or resister lost their independence when Kenya was declared a British Colony in 1920.

Mixed reactions

The communities that exhibited mixed reaction were the Akamba, Agikuyu and Luo.

The Akamba Reaction

The arrival of the British traders threatened to destabilize the prominence enjoyed by the Akamba as middlemen during the long distance trade. The British even tried to stop the Akamba from organizing raids on their Oromo, Agikuyu and Maasai neighbours.

Why did the Akamba decide to resist British administration?

  1. a) The British failed to respect Akamba traditions and customs. For example, the cutting down of the ithembo (shrine) tree for a flag post at Mutituni in 1891.
  2. b) When the Akamba attacked the Agikuyu, The British intervened against them. This was not taken kindly.
  3. c) The Akamba were protesting the misconduct of Company officials based at Machakos who stole from the local people and raped Akamba women.
  4. d) The establishment of colonial administration disrupted the long distance trade, which was the Akamba lifeline.
  5. e) The establishment of British rule meant loss of independence for the Akamba.
  6. f) The establishment of military posts in Ukambani without their consent. The British built a fort at Masaku in 1890.
  7. g) The British kept on disrupting their peace by sending military expeditions that resulted in death and massive destruction of property.
  8. h) The Akamba were also resisting forced labour.

 

Course of the Akamba resistance.

In 1890, Nzibu Mweu led he Akamba in boycotting to sell goods to the company agents.

Prophetess Syonguu also ordered the Iveti Warriors to attack the Masaku fort in the same year as a reaction to the cutting down of the ithembo tree for a flagpole.The British agents were defeated during this surprise attack.When the British tried to stop the Akamba raids on their neighbours in 1894, a Warrior, Mwatu wa Ngoma ordered the Akamba warriors, who had been inspired by medicinemen, to attack the British.

The British responded with devastating consequences on the side of the Akamba forcing them into collaboration with the British District Commissioner, John Ainsworth. Mwatu wa Ngoma became a collaborator.Later, another gallant fighter, Mwanamuka, led the Kangundo people to attack the colonial police at Mukuyuni and Mwala, killing six. With the assistance of Maasai mercenaries, the British sent a punitive expedition against the Akamba and even confiscated their livestock.When Mwanamuka tried to blockade the Lukenya area to cut off communication between Fort Smith and Masaku, he was met with devastating consequences that forced him to also petition for peace.

Why a section of the Akamba collaborated with the British.

  1. a) They had lost heavily during the Akamba-British war of 1894 causing them to fear the British.
  2. b) The ruthlessness with which the British attacked the Akamba scared many warriors into collaborating. For example, the Machakos station superintendent, Leith dispatched troops to deal with Syonguu’s forces in 1891, causing merciless killings and looting of property.
  3. c) Some especially the trades collaborated expecting material gains.
  4. d) Collaborators wanted to gain prestige.
  5. e) They wanted to get guns to be used in robbing for wealth.
  6. f) The Akamba had been weakened by the 1899 famine and were therefore unable to effectively tackle the British.

Reasons for the Akamba defeat

  1. a) Some of the Akamba were not patriotic to the resistance course. Some self-serving opportunists allied with the colonial agents with the aim of enriching themselves thereby resulting in the Akamba defeat.
  2. b) Internally, the Akamba lacked territorial cohesion. It was therefore very difficult to coordinate a strong resistance to British rule among a highly segmented society lacking in a centralized system of government.
  3. c) Sections of The Akamba community experienced severe famine in 1899. They were weakened to the level of being unable to stage a gainful resistance to the British.
  4. d) The role of missionaries who pacified some sections to the level of collaborating with the intruders. The missionaries actively undermined their religious practices and traditional beliefs.
  5. e) When the Akamba caravan trade and raiding activities were disrupted, they had lost a significant source of livelihood and thus became weakened more.

Consequences of the Akamba reaction

  1. a) The Akamba lost their independence as their territory was declared a British protectorate.
  2. b) There was massive alienation of Kamba land to pave way for white settlement.
  3. c) Many people, especially the Akamba warriors lost their lives during the confrontations with the British soldiers.
  4. d) The British interfered with the Akamba culture by cutting down the Ithembo tree and raping their women.
  5. e) The Akamba were subjected to heavy taxation in order to raise revenue for the colonial administration.
  6. f) Many of the Akamba men were forcefully conscripted into the King’s African Rifles to fight in World War I.

The Agikuyu reaction

The Agikuyu was also a highly segmented nature lacking in territorial unity. This explains why they had mixed reaction against the British.

Explain the causes of Agikuyu resistance.

  1. a) The British failed to respect Agikuyu traditions and customs. The missionaries campaignedagainst female circumcision and Kikuyu forms of worship.
  2. b) Misconduct of company officials. They stole from the local people, killing some of them, and raped Agikuyu women.
  3. c) The Agikuyu were revolting against the forced supply of grains and water, by their women, to the British soldiers.
  4. d) There was massive land alienation, which had left many landless or pushed to unproductive land.
  5. e) Harassment of the Agikuyu, by British punitive expeditions. To enforce their policies, the British usually applied excessive force.
  6. f) The British had begun meddling in the Agikuyu internal affairs making them suspicious of their intentions.
  7. g) Fear of Loss of independence by some leaders like Waiyaki wa Hinga.
  8. h) The Agikuyu were reacting against the punishment meted on them by the British for raiding Fort Smith in 1892.

Reasons why some Agikuyu collaborated.

  1. a) Agikuyu leaders like Kinyanjui wa Gathirimu and Karuri wa Gakure wanted to derive personal wealth and prestige through collaboration.
  2. b) Kinyanjui wa Gathirimu and Karuri wa Gakure hoped that by collaborating, they would be made paramount Chiefs among the Agikuyu.
  3. c) The collaborators wanted British protection against their enemies amongst the Agikuyu and other neighbouring communities.
  4. d) They wanted to take advantage of the British western civilization particularly education and religion.
  5. e) They also wanted material gains from the British through trading with them.
  6. f) The Agikuyu of Nyeri realized that it was futile to resist the militarily superior Europeans.They therefore chose to collaborate.

Organization of the Agikuyu reaction

When captain Lugard established a fort at Dagoretti in 1890, he began relating with Waiyaki WA Hinga who was in charge of the area. Wayaki’s people supplied Lugard’s men with food.However, when Wilson took over from Lugard who had left for Uganda, his soldiers began looting food and livestock from the Agikuyu. The Agikuyu reacted by setting the Dagoretti fort on fire. Waiyaki was arrested by the forces sent by Sub-commissioner Ainsworth, and died enroute to Mombasa. It is alleged that he was buried alive at Kibwezi after provoking his captors.Kinyanjui WA Gathirimu, a collaborator, succeeded Waiyaki at Dagoretti. In 1899, Fort Dagoretti was closed down due to a series of raids. Francis Hall opened another Fort at Murang’a (renamed Fort Hall after his death in 1901) after the locals were subdued and forced to accept the British Colonial rule.

British trader John Boyes forged an alliance with Karuri WA Gakure, the Agikuyu leader at Fort Hall, which enabled him to subdue the resisting Agikuyu groups. He also made contacts with Wang’ombe of Gaki (Nyeri) who together with Gakure supplied the British with mercenaries in exchange for confiscated loots from resisting groups.Meinertzhagen, who succeeded Francis Hall in 1902, subdued the Muruku and Tetu section (led by Chief Gakere) of the Agikuyu. Chief Gakere was murdered and his associates deported to the coast after they wiped out the entire Asian caravan on the slopes of the Aberdares.The Agikuyu of Iriani (Nyeri) were defeated in 1904 and their Aembu and Ameru allies sought for peace in 1906, having seen the effects of resisting.By 1910, British rule had been established in the entire Mount Kenya region. With the Agikuyu settling peacefully in the reserves upto 1920s when they began to agitate again.

Results of the Agikuyu mixed reaction.

  1. a) The reactions fuelled mistrust, hatred and animosity in most of Kikuyuland. Such feelings of mistrust continue among the Agikuyu of Murang’a, Kiambu and Nyeri up-to-date.
  2. b) There was massive alienation of Agikuyu land by the British with the help of the collaborators like Wang’ombe WA Ihura and Gathirimu who gave land to the British for construction.
  3. c) Some Agikuyu leaders amassed a lot of wealth and rose to prominence. For example, Karuri wa Gakure and Wang’ombe of Nyeri,
  4. d) The collaborators like Kinyanjui wa Gathirimu and his people received western education and were converted to Christianity.
  5. e) There was massive loss of lives for the resisters. For example Waiyaki wa Hinga and many Agikuyu fighters were killed.
  6. f) The Agikuyu, both collaborators and Resisters lost their independence when their territory was declared a British protectorate.
  7. g) The Agikuyu wars of resistance forced the British to shift their administrative base from Fort Dagoretti to Fort Hall.
  8. h) There was massive destruction of property. The Agikuyu razed down Fort Dagoretti. The Agikuyu villages were burnt by the British.

The Luo reaction.

The resisters were the Luo of Sakwa, seme, Uyoma, Ugenya and Kisumu. The collaborators were the Luo of Gem and Asembo, led by Chief (Ruoth) Odera Akang’o.

Reasons for the resistance against the British by the Luo of Ugenya.

  1. a) To protect their land and national heritage.
  2. b) To protect their freedom and independence
  3. c) Protect their livestock, grains and fish from being taken by the British soldiers who were undisciplined
  4. d) The Luo had become a formidable nation in the area and did not entertain any intruder.
  5. e) They were also provoked by the punitive expedition sent against them by Mumia and the British.

Why the Gem and Asembo Luos collaborated.

  1. a) Their chief, Odera Akang’o had been influenced by the Wanga Neighbours who had gained materially from their collaboration.
  2. b) Odera also needed British assistance to subdue the Luo of Seme, Uyoma, Sakwa and Ugenya, and the Nandi, who were a threat to his people.
  3. c) He realized the futility of resisting the British through the experience of his neighbours.

Course of the Luo resistance.

The Luo of Ugenya set off the resistance by attacking the Wanga in an attempt to expand. They vandalized British key installations like the telegraph wires and administrative stations.In 1896, the British sent an expedition against them and 200 people were killed.

When the British attacked the Seme Luo for cattle and Grains, they were provoked into revolting. They attacked the Asembo Luo who had collaborated with the British. The British invaded them in 1898 with devastating effects in terms of property and life loss.

The Luo of Kisumu rose up in 1898 attacking a British Canoe party on Winam Gulf for taking their fish without paying. They were however overcome.The Gem and Asembo Luos led by Ruoth Odera Akang’o supported the British throughout all these confrontations.

Results of the Luo reaction

  1. a) Both collaborators and resisters lost their independence to the British.
  2. b) The Luo lost their property through burning and looting.
  3. c) There was massive loss of lives, especially among the Ugenya Luo.
  4. d) It Bred hatred between the collaborators and resisters
  5. e) The collaborating communities were able to gain western education and religion as the British established schools and missions in their areas.
  6. f) The African leadership was replaced with the British administration, thereby undermining traditional political systems.
  7. g) The Luo were alienated from their land to pave way for the British occupation and settlement.

Colonial system of administration in Kenya

In their administration of Kenya, the British employed both central government and local government as the basic administrative framework.

Central Government

The protectorate was divided into provinces headed by Provincial commissioners, who acted as representatives of the Governor. The governor was answerable to the colonial s ecretary in Britain.

Hierarchy of colonial administration in Kenya

  1. Colonial secretary. Based in London, he was the political head of the British colonial administration and overall coordinator of the colonial policies as passed by the British parliament.
  2. Governor. Reporting to the colonial secretary, he was the representative of the British government in the Kenyan colony. He headed the executive council which effected colonial policies and programmee he gave assent to laws from the LEGCO before they were implemented.
  3. Provincial Commissioners. They represented the governor at provincial level and

implemented the policies and laws that were enacted by the legislative council that was established in 1907. They supervised the work of DCs, Dos and the entire provincial administration on behalf of the governor.

  1. District commissioners. They implemented policies and maintained law and order and security in their districts. They headed the District Advisory Committees. They coordinated the work of Dos and Chiefs.
  2. District Officers. They implemented orders from the DCs and coordinated the work of the chiefs. They maintained law and order in their divisions.
  3. Chiefs. They acted as a link between the people and the Governor at local levels. They maintained law and order at the locations and coordinated the work of headmen.
  4. Headmen. They were a link between the government and the people at the grassroots level. They mobilized people for development within their villages.
  5. The principal function of Chiefs and Headmen under the Headman’s Ordinance and Chiefs Authority Act was tax Collection and labour recruitment for public works and European settlers. Their duties were confined in the African reserves.

The advisory and Executive Councils guide the governor and effected the colonial policies.

Local Government.

The British introduced the Local Government in colonial Kenya because;

  1. a) They wanted to involve the local communities in administration of the region. This would reduce the costs of administration.
  2. b) They wanted to mobilize local people in resources exploitation in order to stir up

development

  1. c) Local Government was a means of providing a legal forum for the local people to make decisions about their day to day affairs
  2. d) The Local Government would provide an important link between the Central government and the locals.
  3. e) The Local Government would provide a means through which the government would understand Africans better.
  4. f) It also originated from the desire by European settlers to safeguard a number of privileges for themselves by getting directly involved in local administrative units

Local Native Councils

They were established in 1922 after the passing of the Native Authority Ordinance.

In 1924, the District Advisory Councils (DACs) were renamed Local Native Councils (LNCs)

Objectives of the LNCs

  1. a) To encourage and develop a sense of responsibility and duty among the Africans.
  2. b) To provide a mechanism through which educated Africans could articulate their grievances at District level.
  3. c) To ensure proper restriction of the Africans in their reserves.
  4. d) To provide a means through which the government would understand the Africans better so that to contain them.

Achievements of the Local Native councils

  1. a) The councils succeeded in restriction African political Agitations and other activities to their reserves.
  2. b) The LNCs provided basic social needs like water, cattle Dips, Public Health, Education and Markets.
  3. c) They succeeded in maintaining basic infrastructure in their areas of jurisdiction.
  4. d) They succeeded in collecting taxes to finance their operations.

NB; in 1948, the LNCs were renamed African Native Councils. Pascal Nabwane became the first African chairmen of the ADCs in 1958. The ADCs operated as local authorities for Africans until 1963.

Impact of Local government

  1. a) It exploited local resources and initiated development.
  2. b) It created a link between the central government and the local people.
  3. c) It helped maintain law and order using the small police force set up in 1896.
  4. d) It promoted infrastructural development and general welfare of Africans. It used the levied taxes to improve social services such as schools and hospitals.
  5. e) It helped in the arbitration of African disputes through the District African Courts. E.g, Land disputes were settled by the LNCs.

Factors that undermined the local Government

  1. a) Shortage of trained personnel to work in the LNCs and ADCs.
  2. b) Poor transport and communication leading to poor coordination of their activities.
  3. c) Lack of adequate revenue to finance their operations as the colony lacked strategic mineral resources.
  4. d) There was a lot of rivalry between the settlers and the locals, later becoming the freedom struggles. This hampered the operations of the councils.
  5. e) Racial discrimination was so pronounced that basic services were absent in African areas. Many Africans survived through self-help schemes.

COLONIAL ADMINISTRATION

The methods mainly used by the British to administer their colonies were

  1. Direct rule.
  2. Indirect rile.

Difference between direct rule and indirect rule.

Indirect rule was a system under which the British recognized the existing African political system and used it to rule over the colonies.Direct rule was a system where the Europeans/the British entrenched themselves in the direct administration of their colonies. Indigenous political and administrative institutions and leaders are replaced with European systems.

Indirect rule

This was a policy advanced by Fredrick Lugard, the British High Commissioner in the protectorate of Northern Nigeria from 1900 to 1906.To Lugard, as summed up in his book, The Dual Mandate in the Tropical Africa (1922),”the resident acts as a sympathetic adviser to the native chief, on matters of general policy. But the native ruler issues his instructions to the subordinate chiefs and district heads, not as orders of the resident but as his own”.Such a system was applied in Kenya and in West Africa.

Why Britain used indirect rule in Kenya and Nigeria

  1. a) Britain lacked enough manpower to handle all the administrative responsibilities in the colonies. For example, in the Nigerian protectorate, there were only 42 British officials by 1900.
  2. b) Lack of adequate funds for colonial administration from the parent government made her use the existing traditional political system as a means of cutting down the administrative costs.
  3. c) The use of indirect rule was a means of diffusing the expected stiff resistance from the Africans. The traditional rulers were to be made to feel that they had lost no power.
  4. d) The policy of administration had succeeded in India and Uganda, thus motivating them to apply it in Kenya and Nigeria.

British rule in Kenya

In Kenya, the British lacked both funds and experienced personnel to facilitate their administration. Kenya also did not have a reference model of an administrative system –like that in Buganda Kingdom. It was only among the Wanga section of the Abaluhyia and the Maasai where traditional chiefs that were recognized by the British existed.

Where the institution of chieftainship did not exist as the case of the Agikuyu, the British appointed chiefs (men with ability to communicate in Kiswahili and organize porters) like Kinyanjui WA Gathirimu in Kiambu, Karuri wa Gakure in Murang’a and Wang’ombe wa Ihura in Nyeri. The passing of the Village Headman Act in 1902 gave the chiefs the responsibilities of maintaining public order, hearing of petty cases and clearing of roads and footpaths.The 1912 0rdinance increased the powers of the chiefs and their assistants (headmen); they were now allowed to employ other persons to assist them, such as messengers and retainers. They were to assist the District officers in Tax collection and control brewing of illegal liquor and cultivation of poisonous plants like Cannabis sativa. They were to control carrying of weapons and mobilize African labour for public works.

The selected colonial chiefs however faced two problems;

  1. a) Most of them lacked legitimacy and were therefore rejected not only by the African elders who regarded them as nonentities, but also by the young generation who saw them as tools of colonial oppression and exploitation.
  2. b) Many of the colonial chiefs were young and inexperienced.
  3. c) Many of the chiefs also became unpopular since they used their positions to amass riches in terms of large tracts of land, livestock and wives. E.g Chief Musau wa Mwanza and Nthiwa wa Tama acquired 8000 herds of cattle and 15 wives respectively in kambaland.The structure of administration was as discussed earlier with governor being answerable to the colonial secretary in London. Below him were provincial commissioners, district commissioners, district Officers and Chiefs.All the administrative positions above that of the chief were occupied by European personnel.

The British in Nigeria.

Nigeria comprised the Lagos colony and protectorate, the Southern Nigeria Protectorate and the Northern Nigeria Protectorate. These regions were later amalgamated into the Nigerian protectorate in 1914.In Northern Nigeria, Fredrick Lugard employed indirect rule.

Reasons for the use of indirect rule by the British in northern Nigeria.

  1. a) The system was cost-effective. There was need to reduce the administrative cost by using

the local chiefs in administration while employing very few British officials.

  1. b) Northern Nigeria had communities with a well-organized centralized system of government complete with Islamic sharia whose use provided a base to govern the protectorate. i.e. The Sokoto Caliphate
  2. c) The vastness of the region coupled with the inadequate British administrative work force and Poor transport and communication network made it difficult for the British officials to effectively administer some parts of the region.
  3. d) The system would help dilute African resistances since governance was by local rulers. TheBritish were keen on guarding against the local resistance to their administration.
  4. e) The method ensured smooth transition from African to British dominion. It was a way of deliberately preparing Africans for self-government.
  5. f) Indirect rule had been tried successfully in Uganda and India.

Indirect administration as applied in northern Nigeria

In Northern Nigeria, the existing emirates with centralized system of administration formed thebasis of local governance. The Emirs were retained and were to rule under supervision of the British resident officials.The British administration was based on the local customs and laws. Chiefs chosen by the British were to be acceptable by the local people. Local chiefs collected taxes and a portion of it was given to the Central Government.Local Native Courts operated as per the laws of the land. The Emirs were allowed to try cases in their own Muslim courts.The Emirs were mandated to maintain law and order. They possessed firearms.In 1914, Northern and Southern Nigeria were Brought under one syatem of administration.

However Lugard found it hard to apply indirect rule in Southern Nigeria.

Why indirect rule was not successful applied in southern Nigeria

  1. a) Southern Nigeria lacked a centralized indigenous system of administration, which would have been vital in the application of indirect rule.
  2. b) The south had many ethnic groups, many languages and many disparities in customs, whichdenied it the homogeneity necessary for the application of indirect rule.
  3. c) The southern people were infuriated by the British introduction of new concepts like forced labour and direct taxes.
  4. d) The British did not give themselves time to understand the operation of the social, political and economic systems of the people of southern Nigeria.
  5. e) The educated elites in the south felt left out of the administration of their own country in favour of the illiterate appointees of the British.
  6. f) There existed communication barrier between the British supervisors, the warrant chiefs and the people, which sometimes led to misinterpretation and misunderstanding.
  7. g) The warrant chiefs sometimes misused their powers in tax collection and molesting women sexually.
  8. h) The brutish had used excessive force in dealing with any form of resistance and this made them unpopular

Problems associated with indirect rule as a system of government.

  1. a) Indirect rule could only e applied where centralized government was present. Its application in stateless societies often faced difficulties.
  2. b) Where chiefs were imposed, especially in the stateless societies, their authority lacked legitimacy and only resulted in suspicion and lack of confidence. This would lead to constant riots when they tried to exert their authority.
  3. c) Local people even in the highly centralized states looked at indirect rule as curtailing the authority of their local rulers and hence resented it. E.g the Yoruba state in Nigeria.
  4. d) Some inexperienced British officials tended to interfere too much with the vital African customs and practices e.g. among the Asante thus bringing further problems.
  5. e) Different administrations had different views on the degree of indirect rule to be applied hence confusion was created. It was difficult to draw a boundary between the advisory and supervisory roles of colonial powers.
  6. f) Language was a problem and there was need for interpreters. Communication was poor and made adaptation difficult.
  7. g) Education of chiefs was necessary but even this took a long time and needed patience and skillful knowledge which the British did not have.

Effects of indirect rule.

  1. a) The system led to transformation of the role of traditional African chiefs. they now began to recruit fellow Africans to provide labour to the colonial government and even fight in world war I. the chiefs thus became unpopular.
  2. b) The indigenous system of administration was modernized by the British especially in northern Nigeria.
  3. c) Many African chiefs used their positions to accumulate a lot of wealth at the expense of their people. Chiefs like Wang’ombe and Gakure in central Kenya acquired large tracts of land.
  4. d) Indirect rule created suspicion and mistrust between the educated elites and the traditional chiefs who were given power ib southern Nigeria. The elite reacted by forming political movements thus leading to growth of nationalism in Nigeria.
  5. e) Indirect rule helped preserve African cultures, unlike assimilation which sought to replace them.

DIRECT RULE

This system was mainly used in regions with large white settler population such as Algeria, south Nigeria and Zimbabwe.

Direct rule in Zimbabwe

Zimbabwe was colonized by the British South African Company under John Cecil Rhodes. Rhodes used his resources to sponsor a group of South African Europeans who set out to establish in Southern Rhodesia, a satellite of South African System.

They began off by engaging the Ndebele in a series of wars from 1893 before finally occupying the fertile land in Mashonaland and Matabeleland.

Characteristics of direct rule in Zimbabwe

  1. a) Zimbabwe had a large number of European settlers with their population rising to 50,000 by 1931. The whites therefore maintained an advantaged position throughout their administration of Zimbabwe.
  2. b) Many of the British settlers developed the attitude and consequently the belief that the territory was pre-ordained to be a white settler colony.
  3. c) The territory was administered by a commercial company (B.S.A.C) for a long period (1890-1923)
  4. d) An administrator below who was a long chain of European civil servants performing simple administrative duties headed BSAC.
  5. e) Direct method of administration was applied to the Africans who had initially resisted the intrusion. New chiefs were appointed to dethrone the traditional leaders.
  6. f) The Legislative Council that was begun in 1898 gave the European settlers political Rights to the extent that by 1923, they had attained some self-governance.
  7. g) The system was characterized by massive alienation of African Land compelling Africans to provide labour to the new European settlers.
  8. h) There was racial segregation which was effected through the Legislative Council. African communities suffered greatly in the hands of the settler regime.

Reasons for use of direct rule by the British in Zimbabwe

  1. a) The British desired to fully control the economy of Zimbabwe and maximize on profit generation through direct involvement in administration.
  2. b) The Shona and Ndebele resistance against British intrusion made the them not to trust the Matabele chiefs nor use them as British agents
  3. c) There was lack of reliable political system to be used in indirect administration of the region. The local political institutions based on the Induna system had been destroyed when the British conquered and occupied Zimbabwe.
  4. d) Existence of enough B.S.A Co personnel on the spot who were familiar with the area as well as the British system of government.
  5. e) Favourable climatic conditions and the expected rich mineral deposits attracted many settlers who later provided the necessary personnel.
  6. f) There was a strong desire by the Europeans to be able to direct their own affairs and destiny without interference from within or without/The spirit nationalism

The BSAC administrative structure in Southern Rhodesia (1905-1923)

The government was headed by a resident Commissioner who was appointed by the Company stationed at Salisbury. Below him were various commissioners in charge of the Districts (all Europeans). Below them were African Chiefs whose duty included collecting tax, recruiting labour and maintaining law and order.In 1898, a LEGCO was established –heavily dominated by the European settlers. An Executive Council, consisting of the Resident Commissioner and 4 nominees of BSA.Co was also established. In 1902, a Native Affairs Department, headed by a European Native Commissioner was created thus entrenching the dominance of Europeans in Zimbabwe. The duty of the commissioner was to allocate land to Africans, collect taxes and recruit labour.For lack of enough valuable minerals in Zimbabwe as expected, the Europeans compensated by acquiring large tracts of land from African communities with some having grants of upto 3000 acre pieces of land.( Europeans occupied 21 million acres while Africans despite their majority were confined to 24 million acre reserves.)

The Company relinquished control in 1923 to for Zimbabwe to become a crown colony.

Crown colony Rule (1923-1953)

Why the settlers favoured crown colony over merger with South Africa.

  1. a) The merger would have led to domination by Afrikaners in their political matters.
  2. b) Their economic interests would have been neglected in favour of those of Afrikaners.

As a crown colony, a Governor was appointed in 1923 to represent the Queen of England. British government was empowered by the constitution to veto any legislation that would discriminate against Africans. This however never happened practically.

For example, the government formulated the Two-Pyramids Policy or parallel development policy characterized by discrimination against Africans. At the base of the pyramid was the majority Africans relegated to offering cheap labour for the white settlers. At the apex were the minority whites who took the highest positions in the economic and political system.To legitimize the two pyramids policy were two Acts that were passed in 1930 and 1934.

  1. a) Land Apportionment Act of 1930

The Act introduced rigid territorial segregation with land being divided into white’s and Africans’ portions. No African was allowed to acquire land outside their segregated portion.The minority whites acquired over half of the best arable land. Africans were given the semi arid areas infested by mosquitoes.

Land was categorized into four;

1)  Native Reserve Area- for Africans population. The Land was characterized with congestion since it was inadequate.

2)  Native Purchase Area- for Africans to buy. Such areas had harsh climatic conditions.

3)  European Area- For Whites only.

4)  Unassigned Area- For government expansion of buildings and other uses.

Effects of the Land Apportionment Act on Africans

  1. a) Many Africans became migrant labourers, moving to mines, towns and European farms to provide cheap labour since their land was unproductive.
  2. b) Large tracts of African land were alienated and they were confined to only 29 million acres while only 50,000 whites occupied 49 million acres of land.
  3. c) This exposed Africans to problems like overgrazing that further deteriorated their land.
  4. d) There was widespread poverty among Africans. For those on the reserves, they

faced starvation, those in towns faced slum life.

  1. e) Africans suffered racial segregation in provision of social services in urban areas.
  2. f) There was disruption of social roles as African men moved to towns and settler

farms. Women took over men’s jobs in the reserves.

  1. g) Land apportionment became the seedbed for the rise of African nationalism in

Zimbabwe.

  1. h) Africans were exposed to over taxation to compel them to provide labour to the

Europeans.

  1. b) The Industrial Conciliation Act of 1934.

The prime objective of the Act was to protect white workers from African competition. The government through the act prohibited Africans from setting up a trade union. Africans from beyond southern Rhodesia were imported to provide labour to the whites at low wages.The act resulted in relegation of Africans to the lowest level while skilled jobs were set aside for the Europeans. The two acts resulted in the humiliating conditions for the Africans which resulted in the rise of African Nationalism that continued more after the Second World War.As an answer to African agitation, the government invited more white settlers giving them more large tracts of land. The settlers also began to agitate for the formation of a federation of the three central African territories (southern Rhodesia, Northern Rhodesia and Nyasaland).In 1953, the British government gave approval for the formation of the federation of central African countries.

The Central African Federation.

The federation was organized as follows;

1)  Each territory had its own government responsible for local administration.

2)  Each territorial government was responsible for all aspects of native affairs within its boundaries.

3)  The British government was directly involved in the administration of the two northern protectorates.

4)  An African Board was established to ensure that no racist legislation against the Africans was passed in the federation parliament.

5)  The Federal Parliament was given powers to deal with all matters involving more than one territory and foreign affairs.The first Prime Minister of the Federation, Garfield Todd, being sympathetic to African protests over formation of the federation, legalized the formation of trade Unions and funded African education and Agriculture. Unfortunately when Todd was replaced in 1958, all his programmees were abandoned.

In 1963, the federation was dissolved and shortly afterwards Malawi and Zambia became independent as southern Rhodesia remained a self -governing colony.

The reign of Ian Smith

Ian Smith’s Rhodesian Front Party, controlled by the white extremists with no regards for Africans, won the 1962 elections.On 15th October 1965, Smith led the settlers to announce a Unilateral Declaration of Independence (UDI), from Britain implying that political leadership was now fully in the hands of the white rebel settlers.

This declaration provoked instant protest not only within Africa but also from the international community. UN declared sanctions against South Rhodesia though countries like South Africa and Portugal unfortunately continued to trade with her making the sanctions ineffective.In 1970, UDI declared itself a republic under a new constitution that entrenched whites’ position in Zimbabwe by spelling the following;

  1. a) Voting qualifications for Africans were revised and were now based on income. This automatically disenfranchised the majority of Africans.
  2. b) The land tenure system was revised to enable the Europeans to purchase land from the government.Meanwhile the war of independence had began in 1966, provoked by the 1965 UDI declaration, with a patriotic front formed by Zimbabwe African National Union(ZANU) of Mugabe Robert and Zimbabwe African People’s Union(ZAPU) of Joshua Nkomo waging a guerilla warfare.Zimbabwe became independent in 1980, with Robert Mugabe as the fits Prime Minister.

Effects of British rule in Zimbabwe.

  1. a) It led to African land alienation by white settlers/ Africans were displaced from their ancestral lands.
  2. b) The establishment of white settlement subjected Africans to abject poverty and suffering.Africans were subjected to intense economic exploitation through taxation and forced labour.
  3. c) African traditional economy was undermined as many of the Africans were forced to work for the Europeans.
  4. d) African interests were ignored in the day-to-day running of the colony.
  5. e) African traditional rulers lost their autonomy and became mere puppets of British administration.
  6. f) African cultures were undermined, for example through the separation of families as people sought alternative livelihood.
  7. g) The white settlers were to enhance the production of cash crops as transport, trade and industry were developed.
  8. h) Africans were denied freedom of movement and confined I reserves.
  9. i) Positively, it led to development of transport network the region.
  10. j) It led to introduction of new crops in the region
  11. k) It led to rise of nationalism as many Africans could no longer bear the burden of suffering in the hands of the whites.

ASSIMILATION

Definition.

This was a system of administration in which French colonies were given a culture and civilization similar to that of France. This system was influenced by the French revolution of 1789, which emphasized the equality of all men.In Africa, it was perfected by Lewis Faidherbe in Senegal when he was governor from 1854 to 1865.To many historians Assimilation was a deliberate French policy to help them destroy African Chieftaincies and Kingdoms that were thriving at the time of their arrival. Under the system, Africans had to;

~  Learn the French language.

~  Practice the French legal system.

~  Apply the French civil and political system.

~  Convert to Christianity and learn French mannerism including eating and dressing habits.Later on assimilation evolved into association which had been first applied in Africa in central Africa by Savorgnan de Brazza.Association involved letting the subjects develop independently due to the belief that nonwesterners were racially inferior and would therefore never be accepted as equal to Europeans even when assimilated.

French administration in West Africa

The French system of administration was highly centralized.The eight French colonies were grouped into the confederation of French West Africa. They were governed from one capital, Dakar, Senegal.The federation was headed by a Governor-General answerable to the French Minister for colonies in Paris. Each colony was headed by a lieutenant- Governor answerable to the Governor-General in Dakar.Each colony was divided into cercles (provinces), each headed by a commandant de cercle. Each cercle was further divided into small districts each headed by a chef de sub-division below whom were African chiefs (chefs de cantons in charge of locations). At the base were chefs de village in charge of the sub-locations.All the French overseas colonies were seen as overseas provinces and each elected a deputy to the French Chamber of Deputies in Paris (lower House). However the French administrators appointed lacked high standards of education and some were military officers simply rewarded with senior administrative positions. This led to inefficiency.

French administration in Senegal

In Senegal, the policy of assimilation was only applied in the four communes of St.Louis, Goree, Rufisque and Dakar. In the rest of the country, African chiefs who ruled were put I three grades namely;

  1. a) Chefs de province: – equivalent of the paramount chiefs, they were usually successors of the pre-colonial chiefs.
  2. b) Chefs de Canton: – these were ordinary people appointed by the French officials due to their ability, to be charge of locations. They kept register of taxpayers the location, helped the government in conscription of Africans into the army and assisted in mobilizing forced labour for road construction and other public works.
  3. c) Chefs de village:- these were usually traditional heads of the community(village) who were given the responsibility of collecting taxes, maintenance of law and order, organizing relief during floods and locust invasion and maintaining roads I their areas.

The privileges which were enjoyed by assimilated Africans in the four communes of Senegal included;

 

Economic privileges

~  They were exempted from forced labour.

~  They were allowed to work in France.

~  They were exempted from paying taxes.

~  They were allowed trading rights like the French people.

Political privileges

~  They were allowed to send representatives to the French Chamber of Deputies.

~  They were enfranchised like the French people in France (right to vote)

~  They enjoyed the rights of the French Judicial System like the French.

~  They were allowed to operate Local Authority’ structures which were similar to those in France.

~  They were allowed to retain Muslim law.

~  They were exempted from arbitrary arrest/through the Indigenization policy.

Characteristics of assimilation.

  1. a) Administrative assimilation. There was an administrative relationship between the French colonies and their mother country. Colonies were regarded as overseas provinces.
  2. b) Political assimilation. The colonies were represented in the French chamber of deputies thus maintaining a close political identity.
  3. c) Economic assimilation. The French currency was used in the colonies to enhance the economic relationship.
  4. d) Personal assimilation. Africans in the Quatre communes were given French citizenship and other privileges enjoyed by French citizens.

Reasons why assimilation was successful in the four communes

  1. a) There was a high percentage of Mullato population within the communes, who readily accepted the French culture making it easy for the French to apply assimilation.
  2. b) Africans were familiar with Europeans and their culture due to long interaction with them through trade.
  3. c) Many people had converted to Christianity and this made it possible for the French to apply their policy.

Factors that undermined the application of the French policy of assimilation in West Africa

  1. a) There was opposition by local people who did not want the French to interfere with their culture.
  2. b) The Traditional African rulers resisted the policy since they did not want to lose their authority and influence over the assimilated people.
  3. c) The French traders in West Africa also opposed the system they viewed assimilated Africans as a potential threat to their commercial monopoly in the region.
  4. d) The policy of assimilation ran the risk of undermining the very foundation of French colonialism, as it was not possible to exploit Africans who had attained the assimile status.
  5. e) Missionary school system of education undermined the French policy of assimilation since there was segregation in provision of mission education.
  6. f) Nationalism conflicted with the policy of assimilation.
  7. g) Assimilation was becoming too expensive to the French government especially because West African colonies were not self-supporting yet.
  8. h) The vastness of the French colonies made it difficult to supervise the implementation of the policy.
  9. i) Muslims resisted fiercely the French attempt to convert them to Christianity.
  10. j) Racial discrimination against the indigenous people also contributed to the failure of the system. This is because many Frenchmen never accepted assimilated Africans as their equals.
  11. k) The French citizens in the motherland opposed the policy as they feared being outnumbered in the chamber of deputies.

Ways in which Nationalism undermined the policy of Assimilation in French West Africa.

  1. a) It emphasized loyalty or devotion to one’s country and national independence or

separatism, which were against the policy of assimilation.

  1. b) Nationalists agitated for boycott of anything of French origin.
  2. c) The nationalists created awareness on the value of African culture and systems; this encouraged Africans to condemn assimilation.
  3. d) The nationalists created awareness on the importance of African unity which exposed the hypocrisy of assimilation

Consequences of assimilation in Senegal.

  1. a) The policy of assimilation undermined African cultures, as many Africans embraced the French culture. For instance, the French language became the official language in the colony.
  2. b) The authority of traditional African leaders was eroded and even many were replaced by the assimilated Africans.
  3. c) The colony was incorporated into the French republic and regarded as an overseas province of France.
  4. d) Africans from Senegal were allowed to participate in the political matters of France. Some Senegalese like Blaise Diagne were elected as deputies in the French parliament.
  5. e) The spread of Islam was greatly frustrated, especially in the four communes where Africanswere converted to Christianity.
  6. f) A great rift emerged between the assimilated Africans , who were regarded as French citizens and the rest of African communities , who were subjected to taxation and forced labour

 

 

 

The policy of association.

Under this system, the French colonial government was to respect the cultures of her colonial peoples and allow them to develop independently rather than force them to adopt French civilization and culture.Unlike the assimilated Africans, subjects retained their cultural practices e.g polygamy and Islam. The subject came under a system of law known as  indigenat where the subject could suffer arbitrary arrest or be forced to serve a longer period in the army than assimilated citizens

Why the French government replaced the policy of assimilation with that of association in 1945

  1. a) The French had realized that assimilation would lead to equality between them and the colonized people.
  2. b) Assimilation was too expensive especially because West African colonies were not selfsupporting yet.
  3. c) The method clashed with the commercial interests. The French businesspersons and their friends in the colonial administration saw Africans as source of cheap labour. They therefore disapproved the idea of uplifting them.
  4. d) The French had realized that not all the colonial people could be assimilated. Only the elite ones among them could. Association aimed at transforming the Native elites into Frenchmen while allowing the other masses to learn enough French for communication purposes.
  5. e) They had realized that there was need to allow the colonies to enjoy the freedom of developing according to existing traditional political and social structure. / respect for the culture of her colonies.

The similarities between the French and the British colonial administrations

  1. a) Both methods emphasized the superiority of the colonial master and his overlord ship in Africa. The Europeans were in charge and took all senior positions.
  2. b) The administrative systems applied in both were meant to assist the colonial masters in controlling their territories in Africa.
  3. c) Both systems led to massive economic exploitation of resources in Africa. E.g. minerals, labour, and market land etc.
  4. d) In both Africans reacted to the systems in a hostile manner.
  5. e) Both methods led to loss of independence and freedom for the African.
  6. f) In both, every power trained a local army to maintain law and order.
  7. g) In both, Africans were oppressed through taxation and forced labour.
  8. h) In both, the position of chief was created where there was none. I.e. in Kenya, Southern Nigeria, and Somali.

Main differences

  1. a) The British were keen to appoint traditional rulers as chiefs. The French on the other hand were not keen to appoint traditional rulers but simply handpicked individuals who met their qualifications (those who embraced French culture and civilization).
  2. b) The British gave the traditional rulers a lot of power, unlike the French – who undermined African chieftaincies.
  3. c) The British colonies were administered separately by a governor accountable to Britain, unlike the French colonies which were governed as federations equated to provinces of France.
  4. d) Most of the French administrators were military officers. The British used a mixture of amateurs and professionals.
  5. e) Whereas the British applied mainly the policy of indirect rule, the French applied the policy of assimilation and later, association.
  6. f) The French colonies elected their representatives to the Chamber of Deputies in France, while British colonies had legislative councils where policies were debated in the colonies.
  7. g) Laws applied in the French colonies were legislated in France while in British colonies laws were enacted by the respective legislative assemblies.
  8. h) In French colonies, assimilated Africans became French citizens with full rights, while the elite in the British colonies remained colonial subjects.
  9. i) Indirect rule preserved African cultures while assimilation undermined them.

SOCIAL AND ECONOMIC DEVELOPMENTS DURING THE COLONIAL PERIOD IN KENYA.

The Uganda Railway

The railway was built between 1896 and 1901 with George Whitehouse as the Engineer. Work was mainly done by 32,000 Indian coolies and 5,000 clerks and craftsmen. The locals could not provide skilled labour. It costed the British taxpayers about 6 million sterling pounds.

Reasons for the construction of the Uganda railway line.

  1. a) To promote trade with the outside world by encouraging the exploitation of available resources and enable the colony sustain itself
  2. b) To link Uganda with the Coast so that the British can achieve their strategic interests.
  3. c) To enable missionaries to go the interior to spread Christianity.
  4. d) To help stop slave trade since slaves would no longer be needed to ferry goods to and from the coast.
  5. e) To provide quick, safe and convenient means of transport for government administrators/troops
  6. f) Open up Kenya for economic development/to stop slave trade/promote legitimate trade
  7. g) To maintain law and order so that economic development could be achieved.
  8. h) To make Africans more productive and able to generate revenue in form of tax to the colonial government.
  9. i) To activate interior trade to enable transportation of imported goods to the interior of the colony.

The construction

The railway construction works commenced in Mombasa in 1896. By 1901, the railway had reached Kisumu (then Port Florence) passing through Nairobi in 1899.

Numerous feeder lines were later laid down as follows;

The Nairobi –Thika Branch(1914), Konza – Magadi (1915), Voi- Moshi(1918), Rongai- Solai (1925), Eldoret-Kitale(1926), Eldoret- Jinja (1927), Gilgil-Nyahururu(1929), Thika- Nanyuki(1930)and Kisumu – Butere(1930)

In 1948, the Kenya Uganda Railway had been linked with the Tanganyika network to become the East African Railways.

Problems experienced during the construction of the Uganda railway.

  1. a) There was insufficient labour since African labour force was not forthcoming. In the case of the Akamba and the Maasai, they were forcefully recruited.
  2. b) The climate of the interior was not suitable for the European labour force. The Europeans constantly fell ill, thus interfering with construction progress.
  3. c) The Arab rebellion under Mbaruk Rashid between 1895 –96 at the coast delayed the railway construction.
  4. d) There was an additional expense of constructing special jetties since Mombasa port was not large enough.
  5. e) The Man-eaters of Tsavo created danger and havoc to the construction works.
  6. f) The rift valley terrain was difficult. It was rugged with many hills and escarpments thus causing difficulties in construction.
  7. g) Hostility of some Kenyan communities to intruders e.g. the Nandi who vandalized the railway and telegraph lines.
  8. h) Insufficient building material since most of them came from Europe and their delivery often delayed,

The effects of railway construction.

  1. a) It led to development of European settler farming in order to make the railway pay for its construction.
  2. b) There was rampant land alienation. The colonial government alienated African land for railway construction forcing communities like the Maasai and Nandi to move into reserves.
  3. c) There was rise of wage labour for the railway and later for the settler farmers.
  4. d) It led to growth of urban centres along the railway line e.g. Nairobi.
  5. e) Railway construction promoted economic growth of the East African region. This is because farm produce and other commercial products could easily reach market.
  6. f) It led to rise of large Asian settlement since many Indians were employed as railway workers. This Asians boosted trade in east Africa.
  7. g) It led to development of other forms of infrastructure like the roads and telecommunication lines. This stimulated trade development.
  8. h) It led to transfer of the administrative capital from Mombasa in 1905 to Nairobi.
  9. i) When the railway reached Kisumu in 1902, it led to major changes to the ad ministrative boundaries within East African region. Initially, the western region up to Naivasha was part of Uganda.
  10. j) The railway became a major revenue source for the colonial authorities.
  11. k) It facilitated the establishment of colonial rule in Kenya since it was possible for rapid movement of troops.
  12. l) It facilitated the cultural and social interaction among the different races.
  13. m) The railway made rural-urban migration and the resultant enterprises such as hawking and charcoal –selling possible.
  14. n) Other forms of transport and communication developed and expanded along the ralwayline. For example: roads and telecommunications.
  15. o) Christian missionaries were able to move into the interior, where they established missionschools.

SETTLER FARMING AND COLONIAL LAND POLICIES

As a means of raising revenue to meet the cost of administering the Kenya colony and maintain the Uganda railway, the colonial government encouraged the influx of white settlers to the ‘white Highlands’.

The administration did this by;

  1. a) Providing efficient railway transport connecting the coast and the interior
  2. b) Alienating of the white highlands for European settlement.
  3. c) Advertising the availability of free land in foreign newspapers
  4. d) Giving loan incentives
  5. e) Providing security

The settlers however faced the initial challenges of crop and animal diseases, labour shortage, lack of inputs and African aggression.

Why the colonial government encouraged white settlement in Kenya.

The reasons why the colonial administration led by Sir Charles Eliot (1900- 1904) and later Sir Edward Northey encouraged settler farming in the white highlands were;

  1. a) They hoped that settler farming would meet the cost of administration and railway maintenance.
  2. b) The British industries were also in need of cheaper raw Materials in an increasingly competitive European Market. These raw materials would be cheaply produced by the settlers.
  3. c) The settlers would also help control the prevailing Asian immigration and influence in Kenya.
  4. d) The colonial government wanted to make Kenya a white man’s country by encouraging white settlers to form the backbone of the economy.
  5. e) Kenya Highlands had cool wet climate and fertile volcanic soils suitable for Europeansettlement and agriculture.
  6. f) There was need to get rid of social misfits in Europe and the landless who would be offered avenues in the Kenya colony.
  7. g) Existence of already willing entrepreneurs lake Lord Delamere and Captain Grogan who were ready to come to Kenya and engage in profitable agriculture.

Factors which promoted settler farming

  1. a) The land policies availed cheap African labour to settler farmers. The alienation of African land and Creation of African reserves forced Africans to work in the settler farms.
  2. b) Africans in Kenya were not allowed to grow some cash crops in order to enable Europeans continue getting cheap African labour for their farms.
  3. c) The government built and maintained various forms of transport. For example the railway, Bridges and roads which facilitated faster movement of produce and inputs.
  4. d) The government Reduced freight charges in the importation and exportation of agricultural inputs and products.
  5. e) The government encouraged formation of cooperatives to help in the processing and marketing of produce.
  6. f) The establishment of financial institutions such as Agricultural Finance Corporation and Banks provided the settlers with credit facilities.
  7. g) The government availed extension services for crops and animal farming through the establishment of the Department of Agriculture and research stations to improve the quality of crops and animals.
  8. h) Trade tariffs were also removed and settlers were granted concessions.

Problems experienced by settlers.

  1. a) Inadequate labour as Africans refused to work. Bush clearance and preparation of land for cultivation was therefore a problem.
  2. b) Constant raids by the local inhabitants such as the Nandi, Maasai and Agikuyu threatened their peace and security. Some communities even raided their dairy farms for cattle.
  3. c) Some of the settlers lacked faring experience. Some of the settlers had not engaged in farming before and therefore lacked basic agricultural knowledge.
  4. d) Inadequate capital often hindered procurement of farm inputs. Machinery, labour. Some settlers became bankrupt and could not meet the day to day operational costs on the farms.
  5. e) Lack of proper knowledge on farming seasons hence crop failure. The climate and soils in the colony were alien to the settlers.
  6. f) There was the problem of poor transport and communication as it had become difficult for the government to network all areas occupied by settlers with roads and communication lines.
  7. g) Inadequate and unreliable market for their produce. They mainly relied on foreign market which could not serve in the case of perishable commodities.
  8. h) Pests and diseases were prevalent in the white highlands. The settlers were assailed by various human, animal and crop disease.

Settler Crop cultivation

The main crops cultivated were coffee, wheat, tea and sisal.

1)  Coffee.

Coffee was first introduced by the Roman Catholic Fathers of St. Austin’s Mission near Nairobi in 1889. It required plenty of farm inputs in terms of chemicals and labour. Therefore was a preserve of wealthy European settlers.Coffee Planters Corporation was founded in 1908 by Lord Delamere’s Efforts, and led to the spread in the growing of coffee. By 1913, coffee had become the leading cash crop in Kenya grown mainly in Murang’a, Thika and Kiambu.Africans were unfortunately not allowed to grow coffee until 1937

Reasons why Africans in Kenya were not allowed to grow coffee before 1937

  1. a) Europeans wanted to continue getting cheap African labour for their farms. This could not be available if Africans were allowed to earn some money through growing of coffee.
  2. b) European settlers did not want to compete with Africans in coffee growing. They feared that it would limit market for their produce.
  3. c) The settlers claimed that Africans did not have knowledge of growing coffee. They claimed that African participation in cash crop growing would lead to low quality products.
  4. d) They feared that diseases would spread from African farms to settler plantations.
  5. e) European settlers claimed that African farmers would produce low quality coffee due to inadequate resources.

2)  Wheat.

It was introduced in Kenya in 1903 by Lord Delamere who experimented on his Njoro farm. It was however until 1912, when a more resistant variety was developed, that wheat growing took root in Kenya.In 1908, Lord Delamere set up Unga Ltd which boosted wheat farming in Kenya.  It was grown in the Nakuru and Uasin Gishu areas. Like coffee, wheat farming was the preserve of wealthy European settlers from Australia,

Canada, Britain and South Africa. Africans began to grow wheat only after independence.

3)  Sisal.

It was introduced in Kenya from Tanganyika in 1893 by Richard Hindorf, a german Doctor. Initially, it was cultivated around Thika in 1904. By 1920, it had become the second  –largest income-earning crop after coffee.The main sisal growing areas included Baringo, Koibatek, Ol Donyo Sabuk, Ruiru, Thika, Voi, Taita and Taveta.Africans began growing coffee in 1964 though its growth declined due to the completion it faced from synthetic fibre.

4)  Tea.

Tea was introduced in Kenya in 1903 around Limuru by Messrs Caine Brothers. It was until 1925 when tea began being grown successful with large tea estates being established by tea companies like Brooke Bond and Africa Highland from India.The main tea growing areas were Nandi, Kericho, Sotik, Nakuru, Murang’a and Kiambu.

Stock rearing.

Lord Delamere carried out many experiments in sheep and cattle rearing at his Equator Ranch in Njoro though the Maasai raids in his farm and cattle diseases frustrated his efforts.After cross-breeding exotic types with local stock, he came up with more resistant variety. The government also set up an experimental livestock farm in Naivasha.

In 1925, the Kenya Cooperative Creameries was established due to Delamere’s efforts. Later, the Uplands Bacon Factory was established near Limuru to promote pig rearing.

In 1930, the Kenya Farmers Association (KFA) was established Colonial land policies in Kenya.To empower the settlers to take up more arable land in Kenya, the Legislative council passed the following Land Acts or Ordinances;

1)  The Indian Acquisition Act (1896). it empowered the authorities to take over land for the railway, government construction and public utilities.

2)  The Land Regulations Act (1897). It allowed the government to offer a certificate of occupation and a lease of 99 years. This Act encouraged settlers to take up land left vacant by the Agikuyu due to drought and famine.

3)  The East African Land Order in Council (1901). It defined crown land as all public land which was not private. The government could take up any land at will, sell it or lease it for use by settlers.

4)  The Crown Land Ordinance (1902). It allowed the government to sell or lease crown land to Europeans at 2 rupees per 100 acres or rent at 15 rupees per 100 acres annually.

5)  The Maasai Agreement (1904). It led to creation of the Ngong and Laikipia reserves while the settlers took up Maasai land for livestock farming. For example Lord Delamere in Nakuru.

6)  The Elgin Pledge of 1906. The government through the British Secretary of State, Lord Elgin confirmed that the Highlands were reserved for settlers. This barred the Asian attempts to buy land in the highlands.

7)  The second Maasai Agreement of 1911. The Maasai were pushed out of the fertile Laikipia reserve to pave way for more European settlement and large scale farming.

8)  The Crown Land Ordinance (1915). This provided for land –registration scheme for settlers. It defined crown land as land occupied by and reserved for Africans who could be evicted any time. Farm sizes wee increased from 5,000 to 7,500 acres.

9)  The Kenya Annexation Order in Council (1920). It announced that Africans were tenants of the crown even in the reserves.

10)  The Land Commission (1924). It fixed boundaries of the reserves, which were later legalized in 1926.

11)  The Native Trust Ordinance (1930). It stated that African reserves belonged t the Africans permanently.

12)  The Carter Commission (1932). It fixed the boundaries of the white highlands, leading to population pressure in the African reserves. All Africans were removed from the highlands into the reserves.

13)  The Kenya Highlands Order in Council (1939). It fixed boundaries of the white highlands and reserved them permanently and exclusively for Europeans.

Effects of the colonial land policies

  1. a) The displaced Africans were confined to native reserves thus leading to congestion/overuse of land. By 1914, settlers like Lord Delamere and Captain Crogan owned 100,000 and 220,000 acres of land, respectively, at the expense of African congestion in the reserves.
  2. b) Africans who lost their land became poor. Many Africans became squatters and lived in misery and hopelessness.
  3. c) The situation in the reserves and the landlessness forced to supply labour in settler farms for wages in order to pay taxes.
  4. d) The displaced Africans moved to towns looking for employment. Their movement to towns led to growth of urban centres.
  5. e) The traditional socio-economic set-up of the Africans was disrupted. Communities could no longer migrate in search of better lands and pasture. Family roles changed as women increasingly took over headship of families while men sought for paid employment.
  6. f) The large European farms suffered acute shortage of labour as many Africans were unwilling to work on them.
  7. g) It led to the introduction of the Kipande System enforced by the Native Registration Ordinances of 1915 and 1920, to prevent the African labourers from deserting their duties on European farms.
  8. h) Taxes were imposed on Africans and were to be paid only in monetary form. This was meant to compel Africans seek for wage employment.
  9. i) The reserving of the highlands for the whites only denied Indians access to agricultural land, compelling them to resort to businesses and residences in urban areas.
  10. j) Loss of land led to bitterness and made Africans later to form political organizations to demand for their land/spread of nation

THE DEVONSHIRE WHITE PAPER.

The Mandate of the League of Nations compelled Britain, just like any other colonial authority to institute reforms that would involve addressing African grievances. Governor Edward Northey who had given many concessions to the settlers was recalled to Britain in 1922.

Other reforms that were instituted were;

  1. a) Abandonment of Racial segregation policy in Kenya except in the highlands.
  2. b) Allowing Asians to elect four members to the Legco, which was initially settlerdominated. This however was not done until 1933.In March 1923, settlers in a form of protest to these reforms sent a delegation to London to try to settle scores with the Secretary for Colonies, the Duke of Devonshire. The fundamental set of principles that were issued in this meeting are what came to be known as the Devonshire White Paper.

Factors that led to the issuing of the Devonshire white paper.

  1. a) The influence of “The Dual Mandate”. This was a book of the League of Nations that had regulations concerning colonial mandates. Britain was committed to the principle of trusteeship whereby she was interested on its African population than European settlement
  2. b) The rise of race conflicts i.e. Africans versus European dominion and European versus Asian conflicts. The Indians were opposed to the privileged position of European settlers.
  3. c) The banning of racial segregation .The decision by the colonial government to ban racial segregation apart from the white highlands only, disappointed the settlers who wanted the ban lifted hence they sent a delegation to London to see the colonial secretary.
  4. d) The African general resentment. Their resentment was on land alienation, forced labour, taxation system, kipande system, low wages and no political representation.

Terms of the Devonshire White Paper

  1. a) White highlands were reserved for European settlement only
  2. b) Indians would be allowed to elect five members to LEGCO not on a common roll, but on a communal roll.
  3. c) Racial segregation was abolished in all residential areas.
  4. d) Restriction on Indian immigration was lifted
  5. e) A nominated missionary was to represent African interests in the LEGCO.
  6. f) The European Settlers’ demand for self government in Kenya was rejected.
  7. g) African interests were declared paramount before those of immigrant races if there was a conflict.
  8. h) The settlers were to maintain their representation in the LEGCO.
  9. i) The Colonial Secretary was given mandate to exercise strict control over the affairs of the colony.

Implications of the Devonshire white paper.

The issuance of the paper left the Settlers, Asians and Africans more dissatisfied than ever before as follows;

On the part of the settlers;

  1. a) The Indian call for equality, to them, was unrealistic since they could not stomach the mixing of Oriental and Western cultures in Kenya.
  2. b) Since European culture was superior, they felt that racial segregation was justified in all spheres.
  3. c) To the settlers, instead of giving in the Indians’ grievances, they would rather give in to African demands since they had moral rights to protect African interests.
  4. d) To them, the white highlands were primarily theirs and they had a legal claim over them.

On the Asian part;

  1. a) They wanted equality of all races instead of settler dominance in Kenya especially pertaining to settlement in the white highlands.
  2. b) They opposed policies on residential segregation and restriction on their immigration.

The government was inviting more settlers to check Indian immigration into Kenya by this time.

  1. c) They wanted direct and adequate representation in the Legco based on a common roll free election (not communal roll).
  2. d) They objected separate taxation for Europeans and Indians and segregated education.

The Devonshire White paper was therefore viewed as the product of the struggle between the Asians and the Europeans. The paper made the Asians join their African comrades in the struggle for freedom, especially in the trade Union Movement.Settler dominance In Kenyan affairs continued upto 1963 despite recommendations done in the white paper.

Results of the Devonshire white paper

  1. a) The Devonshire white paper saved Kenya from becoming another Rhodesia or South Africa.The European demand for self-government was rejected.
  2. b) In theory, settler’s dominance was weakened but in practice, the white paper upheld the dominance of the settlers more than that of the Africans e.g. segregation in residential areas in towns continued, they dominated the economy because they retained the white highlands.
  3. c) The paper did not satisfy the Asians since they did not gain access to the white highlands.
  4. d) Although many Asians came to Kenya, the Asians did not achieve equality with Europeans through a Common Roll. The Indian congress refused to cooperate with the government; they declined to hold elections for the Legislative Council seats offered to them. No Asian seats, five in all were occupied until 1933.
  5. e) Africans were to be represented by a nominated missionary, John Arthur, instead of representation by an African. For the first time, Africans were represented in the Legco.
  6. f) The Devonshire White Paper Benefited the Africans by declaring/recognizing Kenya as an African country where African interests should be paramount
  7. g) It failed to resolve African land and labour grievances.
  8. h) It sensitized the Africans on their plight leading to formation of politi cal parties.

URBANIZATION

Towns that were already in existence before the advent of colonialism include Mombasa, Lamu and Malindi. Many other towns in the interior grew during the colonial period.

Factors which led to the establishment of urban centres in Kenya during the colonial period

  1. a) Development of transport network. Construction of roads and the Uganda railway led to growth of some towns as transport terminus or along the transport lines e.g. Nairobi, Voi, Nakuru and Kisumu.
  2. b) Growth of trade in the interior of Kenya. Most towns began as trading centres for Indian commercial entrepreneurs. E.g Machakos, Nakuru, Kisumu, Nairobi and Voi.
  3. c) Development of administrative posts. The colonial government established administrative posts in various parts of the country. These posts later grew into urban centres. E.g Fort Hall, Embu, Kapsabet, Meru and Garissa.
  4. d) Rural-urban migration. The movement to urban areas by African labourers from various parts of the country led to further growth of urban centres.
  5. e) Development of agriculture. Settler farming led to growth of towns like Eldoret which began as agricultural collection centres
  6. f) Development of Agro-based industries like flour mills, meat-processing plants and sawmills which attracted labourers from all parts of the country to be transformed into urban centres.
  7. g) Development of mining activities. This stimulated development of industries in the mining areas leading to urban growth. E.g. Kakamega, Athi River and Magadi.

Why Africans moved to urban areas in colonial Kenya.

  1. a) The Urban centres had recreational facilities and social amenities which attracted the Africans, fed up with hardship conditions in the reserves.
  2. b) The Africans expected Job opportunities with better wages in the towns where there were industries as compared to the rural areas.
  3. c) Some Africans were escaping from forced labour and taxation.
  4. d) The African entrepreneurs wanted to take advantage of the wider markets in the towns to escape poverty in the crowded reserves.

Ways through which the colonial government controlled Africans migration to urban centers.

  1. a) Taking headcount of those who were supposed to live in urban centres
  2. b) Enacting strict rules about migration into urban centre
  3. c) Creation of African reserves
  4. d) Ensuring that only those who had specific activities to undertake in the urban centres lived there
  5. e) Introduction of kipande system.

Positive effects of urbanization during the colonial period.

  1. a) It promoted interaction between people of diverse ethnic and racial backgrounds, who exchanged ideas and experiences. The centres became seedbeds of political activities that eventually culminated into the struggle for independence.
  2. b) Urbanization promoted national integration and instilled a sense of nationhood among Kenyans as it watered down the differences and prejudices between communities.
  3. c) The welfare associations formed by Africans in urban areas, like the Bara Association in Mombasa for all hinterland people, united them for a common cause by lessening ethnic hostilities.
  4. d) Through sporting and cultural activities that took place in towns, relationships between different ethnic groups and races were cemented.
  5. e) Many Africans benefitted from the numerous employment opportunities as shoe shiners and repairers, charcoal sellers, hawking in industries and in European homes.
  6. f) Due to the Abundance of labour and raw materials, industries in urban areas expanded further.

Negative effects of urbanization during the colonial period in Kenya

  1. a) There were inadequate housing facilities to meet the demands of the people. This led to overcrowding especially in slums/shanties led to the outbreak of diseases. Lack of planning of housing led to poor drainage and sanitation facilities.
  2. b) Africans in urban areas were subjected to racial discrimination. The social services provided to the Africans were inadequate and of poor quality. Even houses in towns were occupied according to the various racial groups, with Europeans enjoying the best facilities.
  3. c) Increased population in urban centres led to serious water shortages.
  4. d) Establishment of industries in urban centres led to pollution of the environment, whichaffected the health of the inhabitants.
  5. e) There was rampant unemployment as urban centres could not cope with the large influx of labourers and increased competition for the available jobs
  6. f) Many unemployed people in urban areas got involved in social vices / crimes such as drug abuse, alcoholism and promiscuity, due to desperation and poverty.
  7. g) Africans working in urban centres received low wages with employers taking advantage of the high supply of labour, which affected their standards of living.
  8. h) The mass rural-urban migration brought about intensification of migration regulations to control the numbers of African migrants. The Kipande system became stricter.
  9. i) Economic activities in the rural areas were disrupted by the absence of men who had moved to urban areas. Women took up men’s roles.

EDUCATION AND HEALTH

Education.

Formal education in colonial Kenya was provided by four groups;

~  The Christian Missionaries.

~  The Colonial government through local councils.

~  The Africans themselves.

~  Community organizations(Asians)

Major milestones in the development of education in Kenya during the colonial period.

Initially, the provision of education was the preserve of the missionaries. For example, the Church Missionary Society (CMS) pioneered by setting up a school at Rabai in 1844 and another in Mombasa in 1873.

Features of Missionary education

  1. a) It was elementary. The subjects taught included religion, writing, reading, reading, hygiene and arithmetic.
  2. b) It was industrial and technical in approach, aiming at training Africans to be carpenters, masons, agricultural assistants and shoe repairers.
  3. c) It was denominational and aimed at inculcating doctrines of a particular church in the learners.

Objectives of Missionary education.

  1. a) To impart in the Africans Agricultural Skills in order to promote settler farming.
  2. b) To give the Africans basic technical skills to improve their industrial knowledge.
  3. c) To train some Africans as Catechists to enhance the spread of Christianity.
  4. d) To offer Africans basic literacy and numeracy to read the bible and do simple arithmetic.Education development in Kenya in the period between 1904 and 1963 was facilitated by the following factors;

1)  The WWI ex-soldiers experiences which convinced them of the advantage of higher education.

2)  Increase in African nationalism that demanded for better education for Africans.

3)  The need to produce better and more skilled manpower for the future independent Kenya.

4)  Primary education had produced qualified children who needed higher education.

In 1911, the colonial government agreed to share the burden of providing education to Africans with the missionaries. In 1913, the first Government African School was started at Machakos. It became a centre for Technical and Teacher training.

In 1918, the education commission made the following far-reaching recommendations to the government in line with the Fraser Commission report of 1908 which had recommended a racially –segregated system of education;

  1. a) Provision of technical education to Africans.
  2. b) Maintenance of racially segregated Schools.
  3. c) More cooperation between the colonial government and the missionaries.
  4. d) Appeals for grants-in-aid for mission schools.

In 1924, a commission came to Kenya (the Phelps –Stokes Commission) to look into the education situation. It recommended that Africans should receive Practical AgriculturalOriented Education suitable for rural areas. Other recommendations included;

  1. a) That there should be a uniform system of education in all government and missionary schools.
  2. b) That sufficient training for teachers and related personnel should be enhanced by establishing colleges.
  3. c) That schools should be built in the rural areas. This was done through the education ordinance of 1924.

Due to its recommendations, the Native Industrial Training Centre was built at Kabete in 1924 and Jeanes School, Kabete (1925) for offering technical and industrial education. Other schools were started later at Kapsabet, Kajiado, Tambach, Kitui, Kwale, Kabianga and Kapenguria.The 1924 Education Ordinance created an advisory committee on African education. The representation to the committee was missionaries, colonial officials and settlers. The same year, more schools were built with the assistance of the newly formed Local Native Councils. In 1931, another Education Ordinance helped in the establishment of Kakamega GAS In 1932, Kisii GAS in 1934, and Kabianga. Finance for African education was to come from the colonial government.From 1925, the missionaries began providing advanced level education to Africans. Initially secondary education was the preserve of the Europeans. In 1926, the Alliance of protestant missionaries set up Alliance High School. Catholics established Kabaa in 1927 and Mang’u School in Thika in 1930 for Africans. In 1938 and 1939, Maseno and St. Mary’s Yala were started as secondary schools.

Achievements of missionaries in provision of education.

  1. a) They designed a curriculum with emphasis on agriculture, tailoring, masonry and carpentry.
  2. b) They established the first secondary schools for Africans such as Alliance (1926), Kabaa (1927), Maseno (1938 and Yala (1939).
  3. c) They trained African teachers to man the ‘Bush Schools’ (schools found in remote areas consisting of mud huts with grass-thatched roofs) and teach in independent schools.
  4. d) They offered the necessary financial and material support to make these schools

operational.

Secondary schools for whites included Prince of Wales (Nairobi School), and Duke of York

(Lenana School) for European boys, Kenya Girls High School (Kenya High) and Limuru Girls for European Girls.Schools for Indians include the Asian Railway School (1904) and other schools developed by the government in Mombasa and Nairobi. Also community-based schools like Allidina Visram and the Arya Samaj Foundation.Hospital School became the first multi-racial school in 1953.In 1934, a District Education Board was created to plan education in districts, establish primaryschools and manage the schools.In 1949, the Beecher Committee was instituted to look into African education

From 1961, Asian and African pupils begun to join European schools.Provision of elementary education by Africans was pioneered by John Owalo of the Nomiya Luo Mission in 1910.

 

University Education.

Africans in Kenya got opportunity for university education at Makerere which was established in 1922 initially as a technical college and became an affiliate of the University of London on 1949. In 1954, the Royal Technical College, Nairobi began to offer higher education and became an affiliate of the university of London in 1959 to offer the first degree courses in 1961 when it became known as the royal college.

Community based education

This was done mainly by Asian families of Ismaili and Arya Samaj for the Indian traders in urban areas. Allidina Visram, A wealthy man, also established centres of higher education.

African Role in educational provision

Africans began their own schools for the following reasons;

  1. a) They wanted to protect certain cultural practices like feral circumcision and polygamy.
  2. b) They wanted to access higher education, since the government and missionaries were only offering them technical and industrial education, so that to be able to compete for the white-collar jobs with other races.
  3. c) They would also use the schools as a forum to air their grievances and to create political awareness in their community.

The Nomiya Luo Mission built several schools in Nyanza between 1908 and 1910. Other schools were built in Gem-Luanda region between 1913 and 1918 and in central Kenya in 1923 in Kiambu. In 1934, the Kikuyu Independent Schools Association (KISA) and the Kikuyu Karinga Education Association founded more schools. In 1938, Githunguri Teacher Training College had been established under Mbiyu Koinange.

Health.

Developments in provision of health services in colonial Kenya

Initially, just like in the case of education, the Christian missionaries were concerned with provision of health services in colonial Kenya.  The colonial government was majorly concerned with eradication of plague, malaria and sleeping disease which the Pioneer European settlers suffered from. Preventive medicine was later introduced to help stop various infections of killer diseases.The Church of Scotland Mission and the Church Missionary Society soon opened medical facilities in Kikuyu (1902), Kaimosi (1903), Kaloleni (1904) and Maseno (1905). Dr, Arthur, a missionary and pioneer doctor, put up the Thogoto Mission Hospital in 1907 and the facility exists prominently upto today as the Kikuyu Eye Unit Hospital and Kikuyu Rehabilitation Centre.

Objectives of the Health centres.

  1. a) To eradicate diseases such as smallpox, malaria and sleeping sickness.
  2. b) To train medical personnel to handle western medicine.
  3. c) To improve health and hygiene for Africans and Asians in towns where they lived in

overcrowded areas lacking in sanitary facilities.

Africans began being trained in the provision of emergence health services during the first war. (The East African Medical Corps was formed). Between 1919 –1922, missionaries began to train Africans as Medical Dressers and Dispensers.

After the opening of the Alliance medical college in 1920 and the establishment of a Medical training centre under the Nurses and Midwives Ordinance many African school leavers trained as laboratory and pharmacy assistants.A Public Health Ordinance was passed in 1921 giving the Medical Department powers to institute measures for the control of malaria and prevent communicable diseases. As a follow up to the 1921 Ordinance, new health units were established in the four different African reserves.

The Rural Dispensary System was established to supplement the missionary efforts in provision of health care. Health centres were built in rural areas as part of the colonial government efforts to improve health facilities.After 1945, the Development and Research Authority (DARA) gave 47,000 sterling pounds for health care and improvement of health services. In 1949, the Bureau of Medical Research was set up as an agency of the East African High Commission.In 1950 King George IV hospital (today the Kenyatta National Hospital) was started as a hospital for Africans and in 1951, it started training female nurses.By 1962, there were over 100 rural health centres in the country.

Role of Africans in Health Provision

Africans were more pre-occupied with superstitions and over-reliance on traditional medicine which negated their participation in provision healthcare..The traditional medicinemen were dismissed by missionaries despite their wealthy knowledge on herbal Medicine. Today, many people rely on traditional herbalists to compliment healthcare provision.

POLITICAL DEVELOPMENTS AND STRUGGLE FOR INDEPENDENCE IN KENYA (1919-1963)

Early Political Organizations In Kenya Upto 1939

African participation in the First World War contributed to rapid political developments in Kenya in the following ways;

  1. a) When many African from different communities and countries met, they realized that they shared numerous interests and problems which necessitated political unity.
  2. b) The Africans’ disapproval of the Whiteman’s immortality during the war, as he could also get wounded, die and suffer like them. This motivated them to strive for equal rights when they came back.
  3. c) The introduction of many unfair measures after the war made their lives difficult. For example, governor Northey introduced the Soldier settlement scheme in 1919 to settle British ex-soldiers while African ex-soldiers got a raw deal.

Other factors for the rise of early political organizations included;

  1. a) The introduction of the Kipande system in 1920 which was used to force Africans to provide labour for the European settlers.
  2. b) The replacement of the Indian Rupee with the shilling in 1921 meant that those in possession of the rupee had valueless money at a short notice.
  3. c) The reduction of African wages and the increase in hut tax and poll tax in 1920 from 10 to 16 shillings.
  4. d) The change of status of Kenya from a protectorate to a colony in 1920 which d awned on the Africans that the Whiteman was here to stay unless this move was fought.

Kikuyu Association

This was the first political organization in Kenya. It was founded in 1920 by Loyalist Kikuyu chiefs, concerned about the continued grabbing of African land for European settlement.They also complained about the planned reduction of African wages after the replacement of the rupee with the shilling, the kipande system which they equated to slavery.The patron was Paramount Chief Kinyanjui wa Gathirimu and Chief Koinange wa Mbiyu was the president. The secretary was I.M.Ishmael. Other members were Josiah Njonjo, Philip Karanja, Mathew Njoroge and Waweru wa Mahui. The Association, being made of loyalist chiefs, was never aggressive in its demands. The members therefore failed to get any meaningful concessions from the government.Later, Harry Thuku and Abdalla Tairara joined the association together with other Christian converts who were labourers, colonial house servants and clerks in Nairobi and central Kenya.When Thuku tried to introduce radicalism in the Association, he was forced to decamp on 7th June 1921 and founded the Young Kikuyu Association.

The East African Association.

It began off as Young Kikuyu Association (YKA) in 1921 having been inspired by the Young Buganda Association in Uganda. Its founders included Harry Thuku, Abdalla Tairara,  Mwalimu Hamisi and Muhamed Sheikh.Harry Thuku, the leading founder of this association was a mission educated elite who was working as a telephone operator in Nairobi. He became dissatisfied with the nonaggressiveness of the Kikuyu Association which was dominated by loyalist chiefs, in pressing the colonial government for Africans’ demands.YKA being very aggressive demanded;

~  The return of African land.

~  Better working conditions for Africans.

~  Reduction of taxes.

~  Withdrawal of Kipande system which had been introduced in 1920.

~  Increase in wages.

YKA incorporated other ethnic community members thus necessitating it to change the name to the East African Association in July 1921. The officials included Harry Thuku (Chairman) George Samuel Okoth, Abdalla Tairara, Kibwana Kambo, Jesse Kang’ethe, Z. K. Sentongo from Uganda, Maitei ole Mootian, Molanket ole Sempele from Tanzania, James Mwanthi and Muhamed Sheikh. EAA became a very popular association in the 1920s attracting huge crowd in its meetings.

 

Grievances of the East African Association

~ They were demanding for the removal of the status of Kenya as a colonial territory.

~ They were demanding for a common roll for all in the legislative council elections.

~  They wanted the return of the alienated land, back to African owners.

~  They were opposed to forced labour.

~  They wanted more educational facilities and opportunities for Africans.

~  They were demanding that all labour in urban areas be paid fair wages.

~  They wanted the compulsory selling of cattle be stopped.

~  Removal of Kipande System.

~  Protested European domination of government.

~  Wanted hut tax that was exclusively paid by Africans abolished.

Due to the radical approach that was adopted by Harry Thuku, the colonial Governor had him arrested on 15th March 1922 and detained at the Kingsway Police Station (now Nairobi Central Police Station). On 16th March 1922, a Kikuyu Woman, Muthoni Nyanjiru, challenged the African men to violence demanding the release of Thuku. More than 21 people including Muthoni Nyanjiru, were killed when the police opened fire on the over 1000 people who were surging forward.Harry Thuku was deported to Kisimayu. His colleagues Waiganjo and Mugekenji were banished to Lamu as EAA was banned.

Consequences of Harry Thuku’s arrest

  1. a) The political parties that succeeded the EAA continued using even more radical approach when they realized that the colonial government was determined to continue using ‘Iron Rule’ in Kenya.
  2. b) Governor Edward Northey was recalled to London by the then Colonial Secretary, Sir Winston Churchill due to the way he mishandled the Thuku affair.
  3. c) The colonial government did not allow formation of any other countrywide political Associations among Africans until 1945.
  4. d) Thuku became the undisputed flag-bearer of Kenyan Nationalism prior to formation of later political parties.

The kikuyu central association.

When EAA was banned, its former officials Joseph Kang’ethe and Jesse Kariuki founded the Kikuyu central Association. It was formed in 1924 at Kahuhia, Fort Hall with Kang’ethe becoming the president and Henry Gichuru, secretary. Job Muchuchu (Treasurer), James Beauttah (secretary-general) and Jesse Kariuki (vice-president). All these were extremist politicians whose activities were closely monitored by the government.

Grievances of the Kikuyu Central Association.

~  They were demanding for the removal of the 1915 Crown Land Ordinance that made

Africans mere tenants and not real owners of their land.

~  They were demanding for African representation in the Legislative Council.

~  They were opposed to forced labour.

~  They wanted free primary education as opposed to the colonial education system.

~  Establishment of a secondary school, training facility for hospital workers and a school for girls.

~  Removal of kipande system.

~  They demanded that all colonial laws be translated into Gikuyu Language so that all members of the community could understand them.

~  They demanded for the appointment of a well-educated Paramount Chief elected by the majority of the Agikuyu.

~  Wanted hut tax abolished and other taxes reduced

~  They advocated for the growing of coffee and other cash crops by Africans.

~  To work towards the restoration of alienated African land.

~  To pressurize the colonial government to abolish racial segregation.

~  Respect of African culture & customs e.g. Circumcision/polygamy

~  Agitating release of political prisoners e.g. Harry Thuku.

By 1925, KCA had attracted membership from all large urban centres in Kenya and the Kikuyu squatters in the Rift Valley. They presented their demands to Governor Grigg when he visited Fort Hall in 1925.In 1927, KCA relocated its headquarters from Murang’a to Nairobi in order to link up with other Kenyan elites. In 1928, Jomo Kenyatta became its Secretary- General, taking over from James Beauttah who had been transferred from Nairobi in an act of sabotage by the government. Kenyatta started the Association newspaper, Muigwithania which was instrumental in reviving the cultural values of the Agikuyu.When the Hilton Young Commission was formed in 1927 to look into the question of the federation of Kenya, Uganda and Tanganyika, KCA through Jomo Kenyatta presented the following demands to it;

~  Introduction of free primary education for Africans.

~  Provision of secondary and higher education for Africans.

~  Abolition of kipande system

~  Appointment of Africans to LEGCO

~  Release of Harry Thuku

~  Giving of Title Deeds to Africans as a guarantee against any further land alienation.

~  Rejection of the proposed East Africa Federation

KCA championed female circumcision arguing that it was a beautiful cultural practice which eradicated prostitution in the community. When the Church of Scotland Mission, African inland Mission and CMS expelled all sympathizers with the practice from their missions, KCA responded by leading the pack in the beginning of independent schools and churches.KCA sent Jomo Kenyatta, accompanied by Parmenas Mukiri, to present Agikuyu grievances in 1929 to the colonial office in London. It also helped kikuyu elders in preparing evidence to the Kenya Land Commission in 1931.Rivalry for power within the KCA between 1931 and 1938 nearly rocked the association.The Association was banned in 1940 alongside others.

Kavirondo Tax Payers and Welfare Association

It started as Young Kavirondo Association (YKA) in December 1921 at a Baraza held in Ludha, central Nyanza, by mission educated Luo and Luhyia men. The meeting was meant to discuss issues affecting African communities.The official of the Association were Jonathan Okwiri (chairman), Simon Nyende (Treasurer), Benjamin Owuor (secretary), Rueben Omulo, Ezekiel Apindi, George Samuel Okoth, Mathayo Otieno, Joel Omino and Jolmeo Okaka. The demands of the YKA included;

~  They were demanding for addressing of the problem of change of the status of Kenya from a protectorate to colonial territory.

~  Demanded for a government school to be built in central Nyanza.

~  Demanded for a self- government for nyanza province with a separate legislative council and an elected African president.

~  They were opposed to forced labour and labour camps.

~  An end to land alienation.

~  Creation of the position of paramount chief for central and southern Nyanza, just like Mumias was for northern Nyanza.

~  Removal of Kipande System.

~  Demanded to be given title deeds for their land.

~  Wanted hut tax removed.

~  The advocated for better wages.

The members presented their demands to the Nyanza PC in May 1922 and met governor Northey in Kisumu in July 1922 at Nyahera in Kisumu. The governor agreed to authorize the closing down of labour camps and reduce taxation. However, the revocation of the Crown Colony Status was out of question.In 1923, however, government, alarmed by the mobilization level of YKA in Nyanza, compromised its leadership and Jonathan Okwiri handed over chairmanship to Archdeacon Owen fearing the banning of the association the way EAA had been.Under Owen YKA changed its name to KTWA with its emphasis shifting from political grievances to social grievances focusing on killing rats, digging latrines and keeping compounds clean. It also adopted the use of written memoranda in expressing their grievances. All Nyanza chiefs became Vice-presidents of the association under its new constitution.In 1931, the association split up into Luo and Luyia Factions due to disagreements. The Abaluhyia faction formed the North Kavirondo Central Association that had close links with the KCA. It was formed with the objective of stopping any further land alienation for European use without compensation, especially after the 1930s Kakamega Gold rush.By 1944, many of the top leaders of the KTWA had been co-opted into the colonial administration with Okwiri becoming a chief. Benjamin Owuor, Nyende and Okwiri were made members of the LNC in central Nyanza. KWTA was therefore weakened and became extinct in 1944.

 

 

Ukamba Members Association

UMA was formed in 1938 by Samuel Muindi Mbingu (Chairman), Elijah Kavula (Vice-chairman), Isaac Mwalozi (secretary) and Simon Kioko (treasurer) as an association of the Akamba of the eastern part of Kenya.The leaders who founded this association were closely associated with East African Association of Harry Thuku. For example, James Mwanthi, Ali Kilonzi and Muhamed Sheikh.

Reasons for the formation of Ukamba Members Association

  1. a) The Akamba wanted to fight against land alienation for European ranchers causing shortage of land for grazing.
  2. b) To oppose the colonial policy of de-stocking who argued that overstocking was responsible for soil erosion in Kitui and Machakos regions. In 1936, the Liebigs Group established a meat processing plant to effect the de-stocking policy.
  3. c) To oppose heavy taxation.
  4. d) To represent the Akamba people’s interests.
  5. e) To fight for the Akamba rights and freedoms

They wrote memorandum to the colonial government with the assistance of Asian lawyers. It mobilized people to fight for their rights through meetings and signing of petitions. They got support from KCA and the Asian representative to the Legco, Isher Das.The association used Muigwithania journal of KCA to advance their cause.

On 28th July 1938, UMA members including women and children demonstrated and marched to Nairobi with their cattle to seek audience with the governor over destocking and grazing policies. They staged a sit in Nairobi for 6 weeks led by Muindi Mbingu until the governor conceded to their demands at a meeting in Machakos. However, their leader, Muindi Mbingu was arrested in September 1938 and deported to Lamu until 1946.

The Association was banned at the beginning of World War II.

Problems that faced UMA in its operations

  1. a) The colonial government had a negative attitude towards the activities of the association. This discouraged open participation.
  2. b) Arrest of their leader Muindi Mbingu and his deportation to Lamu demoralized the movement.
  3. c) The Association alongside others was banned, with the World War II looming.

Coast Africa Association

The Association was formed in 1943 with Noah Mwana Sele as president, Muhamed bin Mwichande as vice president, E.W. Timothy as secretary General and H.G.Banks as honorary treasurer. Other officials were Muhamed bin Omar, Enoch Benjamin and H. Harrison.

 

Demands of Coast Africa Association.

  1. a) The demanded for improved education and the general welfare of Africans in the coastal region
  2. b) The elevation of Shimo la Tewa to a high school.
  3. c) The establishment of evening classes in the region so as to give African adults a chance to pursue basic western education.
  4. d) to protest inadequate healthcare services for the Africans.
  5. e) They were demanding for appointment of Africans as administrators.
  6. f) They demanded that tax collected from African drinks be used to develop African rural areas.
  7. g) They demanded for the revocation of allocation of Mijikenda land to Asians and Arabs.
  8. h) They demanded for African representation of Coast region in the LEGCO in 1947.

Unlike other Associations CAA did not present their grievances in political meetings bur instead used written memoranda and also their newspaper, the Coast African Express whose editor wads Elkana Young. This explains why the association existed while others had been banned.

In 1955 however, the association began to disintegrate due to the following reasons;

  1. a) The departure of their leaders Francis Khamisi and Ronald Ngala who joined the Mombasa African democratic union and the LEGCO.
  2. b) Leadership wrangles based on ethnic consideration.
  3. c) Shortage of funds to run the activities of the association.

It succeeded in achieving elevation of Shimo la Tewa school into a high school and a Legco position for the Mijikenda.

Taita hills Association

It was formed on 22nd June 1939, being modeled on the KCA and UMA styles.

Its objectives were;

~  To achieve equal political status with whites and Asians.

~  To help the Taita community to advance.

~  To protest the destocking policy. Most of the fertile land of the community had been occupied by European settlers who were growing coffee on it.

~  Oppose the plan to relocate the Wada Wida people from Taita hills to Samburu to create room for settlers.

~  They were opposed to the kipande system and forced labour. The Europeans forced the Wataita to work on coffee plantations and ferry the coffee over long distances for low wages.The pioneer founder of the Association was Daniel Mapinga, a young catechist, who began mobilizing the Wataita against oppressive measures used by the colonial government. Unfortunately he died in 1837.In 1939, Woresho Kolandi Mengo, Jimmy Mwambichi and Paul Chumbo took over his course and established THA with the help of KCA leadership.

Achievements

  1. a) The association succeeded in stopping the government’s plan to relocate the Wada Wida people from Taita hills to Samburu to create room for settlers.
  2. b) The colonial government stopped the de-stocking plan among the Wataita.
  3. c) The government revised the Taita reserve boundaries and reduced the land initially carved for European settlers.

Problems experienced

  1. a) It failed to attract prominent personalities I Tata.
  2. b) It lacked support of all the African groups in the region. For example the Wataveta and Wagisiga were reluctant to join THA.
  3. c) The association was banned alongside others in May 1940.
  4. d) Their leader Mwambichi was deported after being arrested.

Problems faced by early political organizations.

  1. a) Their members were subjected to harassment by the colonial government, especially arresting and dispersing demonstrators.
  2. b) The organizations were demoralized through the deportation of the leaders like Thuku (EAA). Muindi Mbingu (UMA) and Mwambichi (THA).
  3. c) The associations experienced political wrangles between members as witnessed in KCA between 1931 1nd 1839 and CAA upon departure of its tow key leaders.
  4. d) Many of the leaders of the organizations had little experience in running political parties and therefore mismanaged their offices.
  5. e) The organizations were faced with financial inadequacy. Many Africans were

experiencing financial problems due to land alienation, taxation and poor working

conditions and therefore could not adequately contribute to the associations.

  1. f) There was a lot of disunity since most organizations were ethnic-based

Features of the political associations formed in Kenya before 1939

  1. a) They lacked a national outlook since they were ethnic (tribal based/oriented/urban based).

Most of them were confined to one or two ethnic communities except EAA.

  1. b) Most of them received material and moral support from the Asians
  2. c) Mission-Educated African young men led them. For example, Harry Thuku, Okwiri and Mwambichi.
  3. d) They were formed in response to socio-economic and land problems of various ethnic groups.
  4. e) They all agitated for an end to European exploitation and oppression rather than demand for political independence.
  5. f) Most of them did not attract large membership due to their ethnic tendency.
  6. g) They were non-militant and tended to be moderate and their demanded.
  7. h) They were characterized by squabbles over leadership.

Achievements of early political parties.

  1. a) They provided political education to the African communities through their political rallies.
  2. b) They communicated the communities’ feelings to the colonial government through publications, memoranda or speeches.
  3. c) They defended the African cultures against further erosion by the European missionaries. For example KCA defended female circumcision among agikuyu.
  4. d) They re-awakened the masses by making them conscious of the political situation in the country.
  5. d) Some succeeded in to stop further land alienation by restraining the Europeans from displacing the Africans to the reserves. For example THA succeeded in stopping the government’s plan to relocate the Wada Wida people from Taita hills to Samburu to create room for settlers.
  6. e) The played the role of trade Unionism by fighting for the welfare of the workers in the absence of formal trade unions.
  7. f) They publicized Africans’ grievances to the international community. For Example, the role played by Jomo Kenyatta on behalf of KCA.
  8. g) They pioneered in the growth of nationalism by forging inter-community relations in the struggle for independence.

EMERGENCE OF INDEPENDENT CHURCHES AND SCHOOLS MOVEMENT IN KENYA

This was an expression of African protest against European interference with traditional African economic and political organization.

Reasons why independent churches and schools emerged in Kenya

  1. a) The desire by majority of Africans to retain their cultural values while at the same time converting to Christianity. Many were unhappy with the western influence of Christian missionaries who taught against traditional customs.
  2. b) Africans were unhappy with the 3Rs style of education in mission schools which only prepared them for low positions in government or employment on European farms and homes. They desired to be equal to Europeans and Asians.
  3. c) Independent schools emerged as a reaction against colonial domination and exploitation in terms of taxation, kipande, forced labour and racial discrimination.
  4. d) Africans desired leadership in their own churches instead of being led by European missionaries whom they viewed as agents of colonialism.
  5. e) The role played by Africans like John Owalo and Elijah Masinde who claimed to have received divine calls to begin independent churches.
  6. f) Some Africans felt dissatisfied with the interpretation of the scriptures. The Holy Spirit Church, for example, broke away on this account.
  7. g) Some churches were formed to allow Africans to express their Christianity freely through dancing, singing and drum beating which many mission churches did not accommodate.
  8. h) Characteristics of independent churches and schools.

Characteristics of independent churches and schools.

  1. a) All of them accommodated African cultural values.
  2. b) Both churches and schools valued Christianity and western education but were against the westernizing influence by missionaries.
  3. c) Africans held positions of leadership in the churches and schools.
  4. d) Most Churches and schools worked closely with the African political association.

The independent churches movement in Nyanza.

John Owalo is credited for leading in the establishment of independent churches in nyanza. He stared as a Roman Catholic, then joined the Church of Scotland mission (CSM) at Kikuyu before moving to the CMS first in Nairobi, then defected to Maseno.

The reason why Owalo suffered from denominational defection is because he was seeking for a mission church that accommodated African cultural values and where Africans could be given a say I terms of leadership and worship. In 1907, Owalo claimed to have received a direct call from God with instructions to begin his own church. Though CMS at Maseno dismissed him as a ‘lunatic’, the colonial authority (Nyanza

PC John Ainsworth) granted Owalo permission to start his own mission. In 1910, he founded the Nomiya Luo Church, which became the first independent church in Kenya. Owalo proclaimed himself as a prophet equating similar to Jesus.

Other independent churches in Nyanza included;

1)  Dini ya Roho (Holy Spirit Church) founded among the Luhyia in 1927 as a breakaway from the Friends African Mission. The members claimed to speak in tongues and believed in baptism by the ‘holy spirit’,

2)  Joroho church founded by Alfayo Odongo Mango in 1932 among the Luo. It was similar to Dini ya Roho.

3)  The Christian Universal Evangelical Union founded in 1938 In Siaya by Ismael Noo, a school teacher linked to the Anglican Church at Maseno. He began off as one of the leaders of the revival movement at Maseno, which emphasized salvation by the blood of Jesus and public confession of sin. His movement insisted that men and women should have sexual intercourse since they were saved. His church attracted many women and soon he was accused of infidelity with peoples’ wives.He officially broke away from the Anglican Church at a convention at Nyabondo in Nyakach to establish the Christian Evangelical Union. The church is currently known as the Christian Evangelical Church, having changed its name in 1965.

The independent churches and schools movement in central Kenya

Due to its proximity to Nairobi, the seat of colonial administration, central Kenya experienced the presence of white settlers more than any other region in Kenya. The schools established by the so many missionary groups in the region only aimed at imparting basic literacy and numeracy skills to African converts. As the evangelized, the \missionary groups condemned many traditional African practices and values like polygamy, consumption of traditional brews and female circumcision. It is behind this backdrop that independent churches and schools emerged in central Kenya.

Kikuyu Independent schools

Kikuyu elders out of the desire for western education for their children, without necessarily being Europeanized, set up independent schools. In 1913, a Kikuyu elder, Mukunga wa Njehu, donated land at Gaithieko, Kiambu where the first independent school In central kenya was built.In 1925, another school had been built and registered at Githunguri.The independent Schools Movement emerged in the 1920s as a result of the expulsion from mission schools of the children of the supporters of female circumcision. The two bodies that emerged as a consequence were Kikuyu Independent Schools Association (KISA) and the Kikuyu Karinga Educational Association (KKEA)

The Kikuyu Independent Schools Association

The Body was closely associated with the Independent Pentecostal Church and was predominantly in Murang’a, Nyeri and Embu.

Following a showdown over female circumcision, the kikuyu elders got permission from the DC to build a prayer House around Gituamba on land donated by two elders, Kagere Gatundu and Gathai Gachohi of Thiru sub-location. Between 1929 and 1932, a school was set up at the church. This success inspired the emergence of similar churches and schools in Mariira, Kahiti and Gakarara in Kandara, Murang’a.In 1934, KISA was established to coordinate the efficient running of these schools with its leaders including Daudi Maina Kiragu, Musa Muriithi, Hezekiah Gachui, Peter Gathecha and Johana Njoroge.The Association had the responsibility of establishing more schools and maintaining them as well as mobilizing funds for teacher training programmes. Their activities got the support of the colonial authorities which even permitted establishment of more schools that must be registered at the DO’s office.By 1935, KISA had established 34 independent schools with an enrolment of 2,518 pupils.

Similar schools emerged in the Rift Valley among the kikuyu squatters.

Challenges encountered by KISA.

  1. a) There were inadequate funds to support the large number of pupils and schools.
  2. b) Many teachers were untrained.
  3. c) Many of the KISA leaders lacked proper management skills.
  4. d) Mission schools fought the efforts of KISA leaders.
  5. e) There were disagreements among KISA leaders where some demanded for money for the land they had donated for the schools.The independent churches also suffered from lack of ordained ministers. This problem was solved when KCA invited the Most Reverend William Alexander, the Archbishop of the African Orthodox Church in South Africa in 1935, who established a seminary at Gituamba and ordained Daudi Maina Kiragu, Philip Kiande and Harrison Gachukia Kimanga as Ministers.In 1937 after Archbishop Alexander had left, Daudi Maina Kiragu and Harrison Gachukia Kimanga broke away and formed the African Independent Pentecostal Church which they claimed was independent from external influence.In 1938, KISA named their church the Independent Pentecostal Church.

By 1952, at the time of its banning, KISA had 168 schools with an enrolment of 60,000 pupils in central Kenya and rift valley.

Kikuyu Karinga Educational Association

The association emerged out of a split at the Gituamba between the Murang’a group and the -Kiambu members who were radical and were more closely associated with KCA.

The term ‘Karinga’ means ‘pure’ implying unpolluted kikuyu customs and values. KKEA was opposed to all forms of cooperation with either the missionaries or the colonial authority.By 1940, it had established 12 schools in Kiambu and 11 in the rift valley. By 1952, it had established schools at Moshi and Arusha in Tanganyika. It established its own church in 1952(the African Orthodox Church of Kenya), relying on church ministers trained at Gituamba seminary. It was led by Arthur Gathuna and Philip KiandeThe Association was banned in 1952 after declaration of a State of Emergency.In 1939, the Kenya Teachers Training College was established at Githunguri, Kiambu, to train teachers for the independent schools. Mbiyu Koinange was the first principal. It was closed in 1952 alongside other independent schools.

Problems faced by independent churches and schools

  1. a) Poor leadership as many churches and schools were led by people without any management experience. Many of them lacked trained personnel who could run them efficiently.
  2. b) They faced a lot of hostility from the colonial government and missionaries who constantly harassed them.
  3. c) Ideological differences among their leaders on which name to adopt. There were also many leadership squabbles as all founders wanted to be recognized.
  4. d) The schools were forced to follow the official syllabus and become members of the District Education Board.
  5. e) The independent churches and schools competed with mission churches and schools for followers with the later declaring war on certain African practices

POLITICAL ORGANIZATIONS AND MOVEMENTS AFTER 1945.

Factors that hastened political development in Kenya after 1945.

  1. a) The Acquisition of western education by many Africans by 1945 which enabled them to articulate their grievances more forcefully and to understand political developments outside Kenya.
  2. b) The return of the ex-servicemen after the second world war which exposed the myth of the white supremacy making Africans ready to fight them. Moreover, the colonial government failed to reward African ex-soldiers to embitter them more.
  3. c) The change of government from Conservative to Labour Party in Britain in 1946 stimulated a new attitude in Britain towards decolonization. Africans in Kenya took advantage of this attitude.
  4. d) The granting of independence to India and Pakistan in 1947 aroused great confidence among Africans in Kenya to also clamour for their own independence.
  5. e) The rise of Pan-Africanism in Africa after the 1945 Manchester conference contributed to the new demands for political independence in Kenya.
  6. f) The formation of the UNO and the pressure it exerted on the European powers to

decolonize helped the Kenyans in their course.

  1. g) The emergence of United States and the Soviet Union as super powers in the world contributed to the decolonization process. USA was keen to see Britain and France grant independence to their subjects in the world in order to secure new markets.
  2. h) The signing of the Atlantic Charter in 1941 by Winston Churchill and Franklin Roosevelt which demanded that when the WWII ended, all subject peoples should enjoy the right to self-determination.
  3. i) The costs incurred by the European nations during WW2 made their taxpayers become reluctant to raise any more funds for colonial expenditures.

Characteristics of political parties formed after 1945.

  1. a) They had a national outlook as members were drawn from different ethnic groups
  2. b) Their main objectives was to fight for independence
  3. c) Educated elites led them
  4. d) They had a large membership.
  5. e) They demanded for fair taxation for Africans.
  6. f) They all demanded for improved conditions for African workers.
  7. g) They all demanded for the return of alienated land.

Kenya African Study Union 

When Eliud Mathu was nominated to the Legco on 10th October 1944, a number of well educated Africans led by Francis Khamisi agreed to form Kenya African Union (KAU) with the following objectives;.

  1. a) To assist Mathu in his new task as the first African nominated to the LEGCO.
  2. b) To create a Multi-ethnic political grouping representing the interests and constitutional rights of all Africans effectively.
  3. c) To advocate for more constitutional reforms for Africans.
  4. d) To demand for better living and working conditions.

The interim officials were Harry Thuku (chairman), Francis Khamisi (Secretary) and Albert Owino (treasurer). Other officials were James Gichuru, John Kebaso, Simeon Mulandi, Harry ole Nangurai, S.0. Josiah, F.M. Ng’anga, Jimmy Jeremiah, J.D. Otiende and S.D. Jakay.Two weeks after its formation, the governor ordered its officials to change its name to the Kenya African Study Union as it was meant to help Mathu in studying African problems.In January 1945, James Gichuru became the president of KASU after Harry Thuku resigned, being unable to cope with radicalism in the union.

Under Gichuru, KASU published a newspaper – Sauti ya Mwafrika that concentrated on African grievances and the proposed East African Federation which they opposed.

The organization rejected proposals to give more powers to European members in the Executive council. They refused to accept a European dominated government of the East African Federation. Later in 1946 on KASU changed its name to KAU feeling that the former name was inappropriate.

Kenya African Union

Formed in February 1946, the main demands of KAU were;

~ They protested against inadequate African representation in the LEGCO.

~ They protested against the lack of Participation of Africans in the governance of

Kenya. They even demanded for Self-government for Africans.

~  They were against the continued existence of the Kipande System and forced labour.

~  They demanded improvement of the African working conditions with better wages equal to what was paid to other races.

~  They demanded an end to Land alienation and racial discrimination.

~  They demanded an end to Imposition of taxes.

~  They demanded compensation of ex-servicemen.

~  They were protesting against Lack of education opportunities for Africans.

The return to Kenya by Kenyatta in 1946 marked the beginning of mass nationalism. On 1st June 1947, Kenyatta became president of KAU after Gichuru stepped down for him. W.W.W. Awori was elected vice-president and Ambrose Ofafa and Muchohi Gikonyo were elected treasurer and secretary respectively.Kenyatta travelled widely in Kenya where he urged people to join KAU. After 1947 KAU began to face the problem of a standoff between Radicals like Fred Kubai and Paul Ngei who wanted to use force to acquire independence, and moderates like Kenyatta himself. Radicals who included Bildad Kaggia took over the Nairobi branch of KAU.When the national delegates’ conference was held in 1951, Jomo Kenyatta retained presidency, J.D. Otiende became secretary General, PAUL Ngei –assistant SG and Ole Nangurai –Treasurer. Between 1948 and 1950, KAU faced serious financial problems even failing to pay rent for its offices at the IBEA building.

Other problems that faced KAU

  1. a) Kenyatta also appeared too busy to run the affairs of the party as he doubled up as the Principal of Githunguri TTC.
  2. b) The party also faced a lot of hostility from the colonial government and the white settlers.
  3. c) There were rampant ethnic divisions within the membership of KAU being complicated by the fact that the party appeared to be dominated by one ethnic group, the kikuyu.
  4. d) Majority of the African population, who were illiterate, lacked political awareness under could not understand the political efforts required of them.

When the Mau Mau movement began, the Nairobi office of Kubai, J.M.Mungai and Kaggia worked closely with it.

KAU continued to expand its membership in Kenya with Ramogi Achieng’ Oneko opening a branch in Kisumu in 1951, Johana Adala and Boaz Muha opened a branch in Maragoli and Muinga Chokwe opened one in Mombasa.In 1952, KAU rallies were banned outside Nairobi after a political meeting in Nyeri, attended by the leader of Mau Mau, Dedan Kimathi, which attracted over 25,000 people thus startling the government.

When a state of emergency was declared in 1952, KAU leaders were arrested for being behind Mau Mau. Walter Odede became the acting president, Joseph Murumbi acting secretary and W.W.W.Awori-acting treasurer.The acting official presented a 24-point memoranda to Oliver Lyttelton , secretary of state for colonies when he came to kenya during the emergency period, demanding the release of the Kapenguria six (Jomo Kenyatta, Paul Ngei, Kung’u Karumba, Bildad Kaggia, Achieng’ Oneko and Fred Kubai)

Walter Odede, the acting president was late arrested on 9th march 1953 while Murumbi escaped to Bombay, India as KAU was banned on 8th June 1953.

Achievements if KAU

  1. a) Party members especially from the Nairobi branch gave moral and material support to the Mau Mau freedom fighters.
  2. b) The party provided guidance and political support to Eliud Mathu, the first African representative to the Legco.
  3. c) The party laid the foundation for the growth of the Kenya African National Union that ushered in independence in Kenya.
  4. d) Some of the members of the party were active members of Mau Mau. For example, Fred Kubai and Bildad Kaggia.

THE MAU-MAU REBELLION 1951 – 60

Mau-Mau is an abbreviation which stands for “Mzungu Arudi Ulaya, Mwafrika Apate Uhuru” (meaning let the white man go back to Europe and the Africans regain Independence).Sometimes the movement was referred to as the ‘Land and Freedom Army’ and the Anake-aForty.Sometime in the late 1940s the General Council of the banned Kikuyu Central Association (KCA) began to make preparations for a campaign of civil disobedience involving all of the Kikuyu in order to protest the land issue. The members of this initiative were bound together through oath. The rituals obliged the oath taker to fight and defend themselves from Europeans.In These oath rituals, There were rumors about cannibalism, ritual zoophilia with goats, sexual orgies, ritual places decorated with intestines and goat eyes, and that oaths included promises to kill, dismember and burn settlers. The oaths were a cultural symbol of the solidarity that bound Kikuyu men, women and children in loyalty together in their opposition to the colonial government. It also instilled courage and unity among people,Nonetheless, the British were scared by the oath, made taking the Mau Mau oath a capital offence. The British also screened Mau Mau suspects and forced them to take a ‘cleansing oath’, a strange instance of colonialism ‘gone native’.

CAUSES OF THE MAU-MAU REBELLION

  1. a) The unemployment of the ex-soldiers who had been promised jobs after the World War II, but instead were made porters on European-estates. Similarly, people were retrenched, traders pushed out to business by Asian retail trade monopoly and European settlers.
  2. b) Africans, especially the Kikuyu, wanted their land returned. By 1948, 1.25 million Kikuyu were restricted to 2000 square miles (5,200 km²), while 30,000 settlers occupied 12,000 square miles (31,000 km²) fertile land. In the reserves Africans suffered from congestion, starvation and diseases like typhoid, cholera.
  3. c) It was a reaction against the Kipande system. This was a method of identity cards imposed on Africans to restrict them from unnecessary movements.
  4. d) The introduction of racial discrimination in Kenya. The Europeans equated the black colour with low intelligence, uncivilized, barbaric and a backward race. All the best hotels, restaurants, schools, recreational centres and most fertile soils in Kenya were reserved for the whites only.
  5. e) Africans were fed up of heavy and harsh taxation by the Europeans. Failure to pay tax was punishable by taking away the land or even imprisonment. So the Africans were forced to go and work under harsh condition and for long hours, yet poorly paid.
  6. f) The dominance of the economy by the Asian and white settlers. The Africans were not allowed to take part in meaningful business, were not given positive consideration in awarding jobs.
  7. g) They also wanted to be exposed to the social services e.g. education. The white settlers frustrated the African efforts to set up schools even the few educated Africans were not employed in the civil service.
  8. h) Africans feared a gradual destruction of their culture by the whites e.g. the missionaries were totally against the circumcision of women among the Kikuyu and the traditional view of twins.
  9. i) Africans wanted a fair share in the administration of their country (Parliament). For a long time many Kenyans were excluded from decision making and political participation the whites and Asians in the Legislative Council did not represent their interests.
  10. j) The return of Jomo Kenyatta in the 1950s’ after his studies in Europe, he came back with a wider vision to convince the Kenyans about their rights and they therefore united and rebelled.
  11. k) The role of educated Kenyans who aware of their rights as citizens and in turn educated the rest about their place in society. This prompted them to rebel against the whites.
  12. l) The colonial policy discouraged Africans from growing cash crops like coffee, tea, cotton, pyrethrum for fear of competition with the Africans who would grow rich and challenge the colonial administration.
  13. m) Forced labour. Africans were obliged by colonial law to offer labour on the plantation this was to be done forcefully without offering any payments. This kind of new slavery inspired the occurrence of the Mau Mau rebellion.
  14. n) Influence of the Second World War. Many Kenyans who participated in this war discovered the weakness of the white man and the loopholes in their systems of administration. These included General China, Dedan Kimathi among others  who also acquired good military skills.
  15. o) The move was a quest for constitutional reforms in Kenya. African political parties had been banned with impunity and their leaders like Harry Thuku, Muindi Mbingu and Mwambichi detained
  16. p) They were protesting colonial brutality especially the mistreatment of Africans on the white farms. Many Africans were killed at the slightest excuse like in the case of the upland Bacon

Factory Massacre in September 1947.

The course of the uprising.

On May 1, 1949, six trade unions formed the East African Trades Union Congress (EATUC). The union leaders joined with the “Forty Group,” which was a roughly cohesive group mostly composed of African ex-servicemen conscripted in 1940 when attempts for a union members strike failed on May 16th 1950. In June 1951, the urban KAU radicals (Mutonyi, Isaac Gathanga, Bildad Kaggia, Paul Ngei and Fred Kubai) created a secret Central Committee (Muhimu) to coordinate the oath campaign throughout Nairobi and outside Nairobi. It also formed armed squads to enforce its policies, protect members from the police, and kill informers and

collaborators. Different leaders led the Land and Freedom Armies. Three of the dominant Active Wing leaders were Stanley Mathenge; Waruhiu Itote (known as General China), leader of Mount Kenya wing; and Dedan Kimathi, leader of Aberdare forest wing. Others were General Ndung’u Gicheru, General Mwariama and General Matenjagwo (one who never shaves). Other armies were in Nairobi, Kiambu, Fort Hall and Rift Valley. They were mostly equipped with spears, simis (short swords), kibokos (rhino hide whips) and pangas (machete). Some made their own gunswhile others employed armed robberies on police stations and isolated settler homes.  African and Asian merchants funded the movement by paying protection fees.On 1st of October 1952, Mau Mau assassinated a Nairobi councillor, Tom Mbotela, who was a government loyalist. On 3 October, Mau Mau claimed their first European victim when they stabbed a woman to death near her home in Thika. A week later, on 9 October, Senior Chief Waruhiu, a strong supporter of the British presence in Kenya, had been shot to death in broad daylight in his car. His assassination gave Governor Baring the final impetus to declare a State of Emergency on 20 October 1952. Early the next morning, the British carried out a mass-arrest of 180 alleged Mau Mau leaders and subjected six of them to a trial (the Kapenguria Six); the real militants, such as Dedan Kimathi and Stanley Mathenge, fled to the forests.

While much of the senior leadership of the Nairobi Central Committee was arrested, Local rebel committees took uncoordinated decisions to strike attack settlers and there was an abrupt rise in the destruction of European property and attacks on African loyalists. On January 24, 1953, Mau Mau, possibly former servants, killed settlers Mr. and Mrs. Ruck, as well as their six-year-old son, on their farm with pangas. White settlers reacted by dismissing all of their Kikuyu servants because of the fear that they could be Mau Mau sympathizers. Naivasha Police Station was raided in March 1953.Over 1800 loyalist Kikuyu were killed. Operating from the safety of the forests, the Mau Mau mainly attacked isolated farms at night, but occasionally also households in suburbs of Nairobi.In May 1953, the Kikuyu Home Guard became an official part of the security forces. It became the significant part of the anti-Mau Mau effort. On March25–March 26, 1953, nearly 1000 rebels attacked the loyalist village of Lari, where about 170 non-combatants were hacked or burnt to death. Most of them were the wives and children of Kikuyu Home Guards serving elsewhere. In the weeks that followed, some suspected rebels were summarily executed by police and loyalist Home Guards.In June 1953 General Sir George Erskine arrived and took up the p ost of Director of Operations. A military draft brought in 20,000 troops who were used aggressively. The Kikuyu reserves were designated “Special Areas,” where anyone failing to halt when challenged could be shot. The colonial government created so-called pseudo-gangs composed of de-oathed and turned ex-Mau Mau and allied Africans, sometimes headed by white officers. They infiltrated Mau Mau ranks and made search and destroy missions. By September 1953, the British knew the leading personalities in Mau Mau, the capture of General China in January the following year provided a massive intelligence boost on the forest fighters.

On April 24, 1954, the Army launched “Operation Anvil” in Nairobi, the forest fighters’ source of supplies, money and recruits, and the city was put under military control. By the end of 1954 there were 77,000 Kikuyu in concentration camps mainly deported from Nairobi.  In June 1954, a policy of compulsory villagization was started in the reserves to allow more effective control and surveillance of civilians and to better protect pro-government collaborators. When the program reached completion in October 1955, 1,077,500 Kikuyu had been concentrated into 854 “villages.”The last Mau Mau leader, Dedan Kimathi, was captured by Kikuyu Tribal Police on 21 October 1956 in Nyeri with 13 remaining guerrillas, and was subsequently hanged in early 1957. His capture marked the effective end of the Uprising, though some Mau Mau remained in the forests until 1963 and the Emergency remained in effect until January 1960.

Mau war by other communities

~  In April 1953, a Kamba Central Committee was formed by Kamba rebels who were all railway men and effectively controlled the railway workforce. They organized acts of sabotage against the railway lines during the emergency.

~  Rebel Maasai bands became active in Narok district before being crushed by soldiers and police who were tasked with preventing a further spread of the rebellion.

~  In Maragoli, Chief Mukudi of Bunyore was associated with the movement.

~  Other communities involved were the Kipsigis section of kalenjin, Luo etc.

 

Factors, which facilitated the MAU MAU uprising.

  1. a) Oathing, which united the people and gave them the courage, determination and

momentum for the rebellion course.

  1. b) The use of guerilla tactics ensured less loss of life and prolonged war. It made it difficult for the British to suppress the rebellion.
  2. c) The support to the fighters from the civilians who supplied food, water, spying etc.
  3. d) Strong leadership for the movement by people like Dedan Kimathi, Waruhiu Itote (General China), Stanley Mathenge and General Matenjagwo.
  4. e) The deep resentment of the people against the Europeans gave them the reason to continue fighting.
  5. f) The natural forests of Mount Kenya and Aberdere ranges provided good hideouts for the fighters.
  6. g) The fighters had enough weapons. They accessed weapons like the homemade guns, swords and Machette to add to what they were able to seize from the settlers.

Problems that faced Mau Mau Rebellion

  1. a) The fighters lacked transport and communication facilities.
  2. b) They were faced with adverse weather conditions, operating in the Aberdere and MountKenya Forests that were extremely cold.
  3. c) In the Wild environment, they were frequently attacked by wild animals.
  4. d) They lacked proper fighting equipment when compared to the weaponry of the Europeans.
  5. e) They faced brutality from the British forces when they were retaliating.
  6. f) There were constant divisions and disagreements among the fighters.
  7. g) The movement suffered from the infiltration of spies in form of pseudo-gangs who exposed their military strategies.
  8. h) The movement suffered from lack of proper coordination due to the use of forest hideouts and mountain terrain by the guerrillas which prevented them from developing a wellcoordinated strategy.
  9. i) The arrest of the movement’s key leaders General China and Dedan Kimathi dealt in a devastating blow.
  10. j) The movement suffered from a disjointed recruitment process with some fighters being coerced into membership which put their loyalty to doubt.

Results of the Mau Mau uprising

  1. a) Many people died as a result of the war. The official number of Kenyans killed was estimated at 11,503 by British sources. More than 1,800 Kenyan civilians and 32 British civilians were killed by Mau Mau militants.
  2. b) The war attracted the attention of British citizens and international community to the crimes committed by the colonial administration. British forces committed widespread human rights abuses, including rape, torture and castration.
  3. c) Many Africans were arrested and detained while thousands were seriously injured during the interrogations. For example, 11 of the 88 detainees at Hola Camp lost their lives as the rest were seriously injured in brutality incident.
  4. d) The war speeded up the march to independence especially when the realty of the inability of the colonial administration to govern kenya dawned on the British government
  5. e) The uprising led to destruction of property. Villages, houses and crops were burned down.
  6. f) The war led to the relocation of the Agikuyu, Ameru and Aembu communities from Nairobi region as their jobs were taken by people from western and rift valley who did not participate in the rebellion.
  7. g) The uprising led to the reduction of the influence of the settlers in Kenya as it was realized that it was the enormous settler influence that was responsible for the insurgence.
  8. h) The war forced the colonial authority to apply tough measures to restrict the activities of African political parties such as KAU that was banned in 1952.
  9. i) The war led to the beginning of a program of villagization and land reform consolidated the land holdings of the Kikuyu, thereby creating emergency kikuyu villages in various parts of the country.
  10. j) It led to the declaration of a state of emergence in Kenya on 20th October 1952.
  11. k) The war bred bitterness among members of Agikuyu Aembu and Ameru where some were government loyalists while others were Mau Mau supporters.
  12. l) The war resulted into the land reform measures that came to be known as the SwynnertonPlan of 1954 that sparked off the resettlement of Africans in the countryside.

Swynnerton Plan

Refusing to give more land to the Kikuyu in the reserves, which could have been seen as a concession to Mau Mau, Baring turned instead in 1953 to Roger Swynnerton, Kenya’s assistant director of agriculture. The primary goal of the Swynnerton Plan was the creation of family holdings large enough to keep families self-sufficient in food and to enable them to practice alternate husbandry, which would generate a cash income.

Recommendations of the Swynnerton Plan of 1954

  1. a) The survey and enclosure of African land in high potential areas.
  2. b) The processing of title deeds and giving out title deeds to the owners. Only progressive African farmers would get title deeds and benefit from the land reforms.
  3. c) A few Africans were allowed to practice new agricultural methods and obtain credit as well as title deeds.
  4. d) A few African s were allowed to practice individual land ownership.
  5. e) A few progressive African farmers were allowed to grow cash crops.

Kenya African National Union

During the emergency period, (From October 1952 to December 1959) African participation in the political process increased rapidly. The Kenya African National Union (KANU) was formed after the First Lancaster House Conference of January 1960 resolved that nationwide political parties be formed in Kenya as a step towards decolonization.On 27th march 1960, at a meeting at Kirigiti, Kiambu convened by ex-KAU strongmen, James Gichuru and Oginga Odinga, KAU merged with Kenya Independent Movement and the People’s Congress Party to form KANU. The colonial government declined to register KANU with Kenyatta as president since he was still in detention.In May 1960 James Gichuru took the presidency with Odinga as his deputy. Tom Mboya became the secretary General and Arthur Ochwada his assistant. Ronald Ngala and Daniel Moi were elected treasurer and assistant treasurer respectively in absentia as they were attending a commonwealth parliamentary Association meeting in London.In the party’s constitution, drafted by Mwai Kibaki and Tom Mboya, the following were the objectives;

  1. a) To attain political independence for Africans inn Kenya.
  2. b) To achieve national unity through a unitary national constitution under one central government.
  3. c) To create a society based on African socialism.
  4. d) To eradicate poverty, ignorance and disease.
  5. e) To get back African land.
  6. f) To have all political detainees released.
  7. g) To unite with liberation movements in other countries in a Africa in order to end

imperialism and colonialism in the continent.

  1. h) To encourage good neighbourliness in the East African Region.

When Kenyata was released, he took over leadership of the party. During the independence elections in may 1963, KANU won 73 seats against KADU’s 31 and African Peoples’ Party’s 8 . Jomo Kenyatta became the Prime Minister on 1st June 1963.

Achievements of KANU in the struggle for independence.

  1. a) KANU mobilized Africans in Kenya and united them in the struggle for independence.
  2. b) Through its numerous nationwide meetings, it provided political education to the Africans in Kenya.
  3. c) It participated in the independence constitution making process by being part of the Lancaster House conference of 1962.

Challenges faced by KANU in the struggle for independence.

  1. a) There was disunity among its members with some suspicious of the big communities who had taken up key leadership positions
  2. b) The party faced the problem of lacking adequate funds to carry out its countrywide campaigns for Independence.
  3. c) The KANU leaders suffered from ideological differences with some opposing the unitary system of government as advocated by the party’s constitution.
  4. d) Some members were dissatisfied with the way party affairs were being run especially the elections which they felt were not fair.

Kenya African Democratic Union (KADU)

KADU was formed in 1960 as an alliance of minority ethnic political groups to protect the rights /interests of the minority groups against possible domination of KANU /majority groups.Its senior leaders included Ronald Ngala (president), Masinde Muliro (Vice president), Daniel Arap Moi (chairman), Martin Shikuku (secretary General) and Justus ole Tipis (treasurer).KADU leaders advocated for a federal system while KANU group were advocating for a unitary system of government.When KANU refused to form government while Kenyatta was still in detention, KADU formed the first coalition government with the Europeans and Asians who belonged to Michael Blundell’s New Kenya Party after garnering 11 seats in the May 1961 elections.In 1962, KADU and KANU formed a coalition government while awaiting the 1963 elections.Following the defeat by KANU in the May 1963 elections, it became the major opposition party until 1964 when it was disbanded after persuasions from Jomo Kenyatta.

Roles played by the Kenya African Democratic Union in the struggle for independence.

  1. a) It united the smaller communities in Kenya. E.g the Kalenjin, Luhyia, Maasai and coastal communities.
  2. b) It educated/ mobilized Africans against the colonial domination.
  3. c) It pressed for the release of Jomo Kenyatta while hopping that he would eventually join on their side.
  4. d) It participated in drawing up the independence constitution in the second Lancaster House conference.
  5. e) As an opposition party though for a short time, it helped to provide checks on the KANU government.

Challenges faced by KADU

  1. a) There were suspicions of dominance of the party by some communities.
  2. b) The party faced the problem of lacking adequate funds to carry out its countrywide campaigns for Independence.
  3. c) Wrangles between senior officials of the party often undermined the party’s operations.
  4. d) Illiteracy among the majority of the members left the top leaders with too much responsibility over party affairs.
  5. e) The party was prone to manipulations by the colonial authority in its operations.
  6. f) The party members were faced with a lot of pressure from KANU to decamp. African People’s Party

The party also emerged after the 1962 Lancaster House conference, founded by Paul Ngei, one of the radical members of KAU’s Nairobi branch.

Paul Ngei had similar fears just like the founders of KADU that the Akamba interests would not be catered for in the proposed government arrangement that favoured KANU as well as KADU.The party was formed in February 1962. After Kenya became a republic in 1964, APP decamped from the opposition to join KANU.

The trade-union movement.

The early trade Unions in Kenya were formed along racial lines though all form them aimed at addressing labour problems that faced workers. The first trade union in Kenya was the Indian Trade Union formed in 1914 in mombasa. Upto 1914, there existed no African trade union in Kenya because of the following reasons;

  1. a) Artisans and farm labourers were not allowed to join or form associations since it was feared they would organize sudden and unofficial strikes.
  2. b) Majority of the Kenyans were illiterate and lacked the knowledge to run workers’ unions.
  3. c) The migrant labour system militated against the establishment of such unions.
  4. d) The colonial government fought attempts by Africans to form workers’ organizations.

For this reason, in the 1920s, African political organizations doubled up as also defenders of workers welfare.In 1922, Asian workers in the railway department formed the Railway Artisans Union but its officials were sacked by the government causing it to wind up in 1923.in 1930s, a Trade Union Committee was formed in Mombasa by Masons and labourers with R.M. S hah as its president.In 1934, the Indian Trade Union became the Kenya Indian Labour Trade Union (KLTU ) whose membership was from other towns in Kenya.By 1935, the union began admitting members from other races necessitating it to change its name to Labour Trade Union of Kenya (LTUK). When it expanded its membership to the rest of East Africa in 1939, it became known as the Labour Trade Union of East Africa (LTUEA) on 14thJanuary 1947, over 15,000 striking African workers of Mombasa formed the African Workers Union (AWU). Muhamed Kibwana was elected president, Mwangi Macharia-secretary, Mbaruk Kenze-treasurer and Chege Kibachia –executive officer.

The Union’s demands included;

  1. a) A salary increase due to the high cost of living.
  2. b) Implementation of the policy of equal pay for equal work regardless of race.
  3. c) Respect for African workers wherever they were employed.
  4. d) Payment of sufficient allowances to cater for African wives and children.
  5. e) Elimination of the deliberate strategies applied by employers to keep Africans in their places of work all the time.The Union changed its name to African Workers’ Federation on 24th January 1947 at the advice of Eliud Mathu who also convinced them to end the strike. Meanwhile a trade dispute tribunal led by Mr. Justice Thacker was set up to look into the workers’ grievances.The AWF became very popular to all workers in Kenya due to the success of the strike. However its leaders were either repatriated from Mombasa to their reserve areas or as was the case of Kibachia, arrested and detained in Baringo district.Achievements of AWF.
  6. a) It mobilized workers from different communities to come together and fight for better wages.
  7. b) It provided education to the workers about their rights.
  8. c) It introduced the concept of collective bargaining among workers in Kenya.
  9. d) It fought for better living and working conditions for workers.
  10. e) It advocated for better allowances for African workers’ wives and children, a factor which resulted in better wages and salaries for workers.
  11. f) Its activities made the colonial government change its attitude towards labour unions and start to give attention to workers’ grievances.
  12. g) It succeeded in exposing the Kenyan workers’ grievances to the international community as its strike was internationally publicized.

Kenya Federation of Labour

Following the enactment of the Trade Unions Ordinance in 1952, various small African trade unions (Kenya Local Government Workers’’ Union, Domestic and Hotel Workers’ Union and East AFRICAN Federation of Building and Construction) united to form the Kenya Federation of Registered Trade Unions (KFRTU). Its officials included Mwichigi Karanja (president), Aggrey Mwinya(secretary general), S. Ondiege, Elikana Okusimba, Silas Okeya, David Jomo, S. Osore, James Wainaina and Dishon Sambili.

Among the demands of KFRTU were the following;

~  Increase in African wages.

~  Improvement of the living conditions and poor housing for its workers

~  Protest against the arrest and detention of union officials.

~  Protest against forceful evacuation of the Aembu, Ameru and Agikuyu from Nairobi In 1953.

~  Protest against increase in the price of tea and bread in 1955

~  Protest against the continuity of the state of emergency.

In 1953, Tom Mboya’s Kenya Local Government workers’ Union (KLGWU) joined KFRTU. The following were elected officials in the 1953 elections. David Njomo-prrsident, Stephen Obwaka- vice president, Tom Mboya- general secretary, G.W.Owuor-assistant SG, Daniel Ng’ethetreasurer and John Opiyo- ass treasurer.

In 1955, it changed its name to the Kenya Federation of  Labour (KFL) representing 35,000 members.

Due to Tom Mboya’s efforts KFL was affiliated to the International Confederation of Free Trade Unions (ICFTU).

Achievements of KFL.

  1. a) It kept the spirit of African nationalism alive during the emergency period when political associations had been banned.
  2. b) It secured international support through its affiliation to ICFTU for the cause of African nationalism.
  3. c) It educated Africans on their rights as workers.
  4. d) It helped to improve the living conditions of African workers securing for them a major salary increment in 1956
  5. e) It prepared some African nationalists for leadership roles in the struggle for independence. For example, martin Shikuku and Tom Mboya.

Role of trade union movement in the struggle for independence in Kenya

  1. a) Trade Unions mobilized workers to strike against colonial government.
  2. b) They Motivated workers to sustain the struggle for their political rights/self governance
  3. c) They provided national political parties with funds required for their operation.
  4. d) Trade union leaders became prominent leaders of political associations that fought for independence.
  5. e) They introduced the concept of collective bargaining for workers in Kenya.
  6. f) The unions promoted regional cooperation in east Africa.
  7. g) They improved working conditions of the Africans through their welfare duties.
  8. h) They intensified the spirit of nationalism after ban on political parties.
  9. i) They provided a training ground for nationalist leaders e.g. Thomas Mboya
  10. j) Educated Africans on their rights

Problems faced by trade unions during the colonial period

  1. a) There was fear of victimization and harassment from the colonial authorities especially in the pioneer years.
  2. b) The migrant nature of African workforce paused a challenge to their membership.
  3. c) Ignorance of the African people about trade unionism and its role.
  4. d) Poor leadership which affected the running of pioneer trade unions.
  5. e) Shortage of funds since they relied on meager contributions from the poorly paid workers.
  6. f) Mismanagement of funds by the officials due to inexperience or corruption.
  7. g) Ethnicity, which had a hand in the choice of leaders for the unions.
  8. h) Constant wrangles among the leaders of the unions.

ROLE OF WOMEN IN THE STRUGGLE FOR INDEPENDENCE

Key women contributors in the struggle for independence..

  1. Mekatilili WA Menza of Giriama who mobilized and administered oaths to the kaya elders to cause the Agiriama resistance
  2. Moraa, a Kitutu, prophetess of Gusii who was instrumental in the Gusii resistance.
  3. Mary Muthoni Nyanjiru, famously remembered for inciting men to riot when Harry Thuku had been arrested in Nairobi in March 1922
  4. Syotune wa Kithuke, a Kamba prophetess who used the kilumi dance in 1911 to mobilize the Akamba to protest against British colonialism.

role played by women in the struggle for independence.

  1. a) The women acted as spies to the Mau Mau fighters in Nairobi and other urban centres. They supplied arms to fighters.
  2. b) They contributed to the establishment of independent churches and schools. For example, Legio Maria was co-founded by a Woman, Aoko, in western Kenya.
  3. c) They provided food to the fighters in the bushes.
  4. d) In central Kenya, they composed songs and dances, which ridiculed colonial chiefs and other agents of the colonial system. E.g Muthirigu.
  5. e) They, looked after families, as the men were busy fighting in bushes.
  6. f) In the 1930s, some section of the agikuyu women formed the Mumbi Central Association, feeling that KCA was not recognizing their contribution.
  7. g) The hid the fighters in houses.
  8. h) They participated in the oathing ceremonies, some acting as chief oathing administrators.
  9. i) Some participated actively in the freedom wars and were even killed e.g. Marshal Muthoni, Elizabeth Gachika etc.
  10. j) They participated in demonstrations and meetings to fight colonialists.
  11. k) They joined the MAU MAU fighters in the forest, with the main role of organizing and coordinating the rural network. They Supplied information to their husbands in the bush.
  12. l) They smuggled arms from the whites to the fighters.
  13. m) They led and inspired the resistance through their prophecy and encouragement e.g. Moraa and Mekatilili.
  14. n) In 1960, a woman, Priscilla Abwao, took part in the Lancaster House Conference. London, to prepare the independence constitution.

Role of women in the Mau Mau movement.

  1. a) Some women were fully-fledged warriors fighting alongside men. ‘Field Marshall’ Muthoni went to fight alongside famous warriors of the forest like Dedan Kimathi Waciuri.
  2. b) The women in the camps made sure that the family continued intact through all of the while their men were out fighting. They would weed and grow food for family use.
  3. c) While men were in the forests, Mau Mau women continued to educate their children to be the future leaders of their government. Women would collect money and smuggle the brightest children out of Kenya to study overseas through Sudan, Ethiopia and Egypt.
  4. d) Many women sought support for Mau Mau internationally. E.g, Mama Sarah Sarai, an ally of Kenyatta’s, when out of the country would get people to write in support of Mau Mau.
  5. e) Some women offered their property for use by mau mau. In Nairobi, Mama Josephine Muthoni offered her cars to be used for Mau Mau activities. Mama Elizabeth Waruiru’s house in Pangani which became a Mau Mau meeting place.
  6. f) Women were first class spies and informers. They supplied information to the forest forces.
  7. g) Women supplied guns, would do anything to get them. Sometimes they killed for them.
  8. h) Women had primary responsibility for the organization and maintenance of the supply lines. Operating from villages, thousands of women acted as go -betweens and carriers of food and firearms, and generally provided a system of intelligence.
  9. i) Women composed songs like the Kanyegenuri, to commemorate their deeds, like the bravery of Mary Nyanjiru. Years later the song became the Mau Mau anthem of resistance
  10. j) They also recruited for Mau Mau fighters.
  11. k) They officiated at and participated in oathing ceremonies. Some like Waithera allowed themselves to be subjected to unnatural sexual acts for the sake of the movement.
  12. l) In forest camps, women would serve male leaders as Kabatuni (a small platoon to be commanded by the man), doing minor military duties like cleaning guns as well as seeing to the other needs like meeting his sexual needs.
  13. m) Some women were co-opted in the political Arena in the mau mau duo-sex councils. For example Muthoni Ngatha – even rose to the senior position of Field Marshal. In June 1953 Wagiri Njoroge was crowned as the Queen of Mau Mau and ruled for 7 months.
  14. n) Women also contributed the services of their children who served as errand boys and girls and informers.
  15. o) Women were allowed to flirt with “enemies” to gather vital information, weapons and other resources. For example, in Gakenia’s village in Nanyuki, four girls lured four loyalist African soldiers to Kaarage Forest where the soldiers were killed and their rifles taken.
  16. p) Some women like Wanjiru were appointed judges in Nakuru’s Mau Mau Courts which passed sentences on anti-Mau Mau crimes. These illustrated by the emergence of a small number of women who acted as executioners.

Problems caused by presence of women in forests during mau mau wars

  1. a) Some women could not withstand the harsh forest conditions of torrential rains and bitter cold and constantly fell sick
  2. b) Many women could not defend themselves against enemies and were therefore a burden to men.
  3. c) Women would be extra mouths to feed, but would do very little useful things in return.
  4. d) Occasionally, women could cause tension and conflict among male guerillas as the men competed for sexual favours from the small number of women.

CONSTITUTIONAL CHANGES LEADING TO INDEPENDENCE.

African representation to the Legco.

In 1944, Eliud Mathu, a former teacher at Alliance School, the first African was appointed to the LegCo. KAU’s demand for more representation in 1946 caused the appointment of Benaiah Ohanga as the second African to the LegCo.

By 1948, there were four Africans in the LegCo compared to 11 Europeans, 5 Asians and 2 Arabs.

Various commission reports made significant pointers to the fact that the British government had realized the need to involve Africans in the administration and need to reduce settler influence. For example;

1)  The Report of the East African Royal Commission of 1955 proposed;

~  An end of racial segregation.

~  Increased involvement of Africans in the colonial administration

~  Opening of the Kenya Highlands to all races.

2)  The Swynnerton Plan of 1954 proposed the consolidation and registration of African land with a view to having better land management.

3)  The report on African wages and the Lidbury Commission on Civil Service recommended better pay for African workers.

The Lyttelton Constitution

In 1954, the British secretary for colonies visited Kenya in the wake of the Mau Mau Uprising and made the following constitutional proposals;

  1. a) A multi- racial Council of Ministers to replace the executive council, which would include one African (B.A. Ohanga, minister for community development and African affairs), two Asians and three Europeans. For the first time, Africans were represented with members with executive powers.
  2. b) Lifting the ban on African political Associations. This was done in 1955 though only Africans were allowed to form local (district –based) political organizations. Tom Mboya formed the Nairobi People’s convention Party while D. Mwanyumba formed the Taita African Democratic Union. John Kebaso formed the Abagusii Association, Argwings Kodhek formed the Kenya National Congress and John Keen the Maasai Front.
  3. c) Africans were able to take part in elections of 1957. /it proposed multi-racial elections.

However, other than race-pegged rules for participation in the 1956/57 elections, voting qualification for Africans were based on income, property and education

  1. d) Proposed direct representation of Africans in the LEGCO. In march 1957, the African elections to the Legco were held and Tom Mboya(Nairobi), Masinde Muliro( Northern Nyanza), Oginga Odinga(Central Nyanza), Lawrence Ogunda(south Nyanza), Ronald Ngala( Coast ), Daniel Arap Moi( Rift Valley), James Miumi(Ukambani) and Bernard Mate (central)were elected.

The elected Africans formed the African Elected Members Organization (AEMO) with Odinga as chairman and Mboya as secretary.

 

 

Demands of AEMO after formation

  1. a) They contested the fewer African positions in the LegCo by condemning the Lyttelton constitution. While elected members were 29, nominated members were 30, majority of who were Europeans.
  2. b) They protested the rigid voter qualification requirements imposed on Africans and demanded that every African of 21 years and above be allowed to vote, regardless of education or income.
  3. c) They demanded that registration of voters be done on a common roll.
  4. d) They called for the end of a State of Emergency.

Role played by AEMO in the struggle for independence up to 1963.

  1. a) They formed pressure groups to demand for greater political rights for Africans. e.g., formation of AEMO.
  2. b) They formed the core team, which pressurized for independence.
  3. c) They made known the grievances of Africans in International Fora.
  4. d) They networked with other African nationalists elsewhere e.g. in Ghana and Nigeria to hasten achievement of independence in Kenya.
  5. e) They fought for the release of detained nationalists e.g. Kenyatta.
  6. f) They formed he national political parties e.g. KANU and KADU, which led the country to independence.
  7. g) They educated and created awareness among the masses about the nationalists struggle.
  8. h) They took part in the formulation of the independence constitution.

The Lennox-Boyd Constitution.

In 1958, Sir Allan Lennox- Boyd, who had succeeded Oliver Lyttelton as secretary State for Colonies visited Kenya and made the following constitutional proposals;

  1. a) An increase by six LegCo Seats for Africans to bring their total representation to 14 seats.
  2. b) A special membership in the LegCo, with four members from each race, who were to elected by other members of the LegCo.
  3. c) An increase of the number of African ministers to two.

AEMO members rejected the Lennox-Boyd proposals saying they still favoured white monopoly in the colony especially the specially elected membership to LegCo. AEMO also called for the unconditional release of Jomo Kenyatta. They even boycotted the Legco from 1958 to 1959 when a new constitutional conference was promised.

Acted of Betrayal became evident among Africans when Musa Amalemba and Wanyutu Waweru accepted the special seats appointment and even Amalemba went ahead to appointed the second African Minister for Housing in 1958.Other developments in 1959 included;

~  The White moderates led by Michael Blundell (who resigned as minister of agriculture) formed the New Party of Kenya (NPK). He was backed by 46 non -African members of the LegCo for his ideas of multi-racialism.

~  The white extremists led by Captain Briggs formed the United Party (UP) demanding for the abolishing of the LegCo and replacing it with regional assemblies. This was aimed at preserving the white highlands as one regional assembly for European benefits.

~  Increased divisions on AEMO between radicals and moderates .Ngala, Moi, Mate, Towett and Nyagah resigned from AEMO to form the Kenya National Party (KNP) advocating multi-racialism. This party was interestingly joined by all Arab and Asian members.

~  The radicals led by Mboya, Odinga and Gikonyo Kiano formed the Kenya Independent Movement (KIM) that was exclusively for African membership. They demanded convening of a full constitutional conference to discuss Kenya’s future and release of Jomo Kenyatta.

The Lancaster House Conferences

The Conferences were called to iron out the differences that arose out of the fact that both radical Europeans and AEMO members opposed multi-racialism.

The First Lancaster House Conference (1960)

The conference was convened by Ian MacLeod, the secretary of state for colonies. it was attended by all members of the LegCo.. The African team was led by Ronald Ngala and Tom Mboya was the secretary.

The conference came up with the following compromise decisions;

  1. a) The 12 elective seats In the LegCo would remain intact.
  2. b) There were to 33 open seats in the LegCo, which were to be vied for on a common roll.
  3. c) Another 20 seats would be reserved – 10 of these for Europeans, 8 for Asians and 2 for Arabs.
  4. d) The composition of the Council of Ministers was to be altered to incorporate 4 Africans, 3 Europeans and 1 Asian.
  5. e) The conference authorized the formation of countrywide political parties for Africans.

KANU and KANU were formed.The Lancaster conference however failed to entirely please both Africans and the settlers. Some settlers, finding the new turn events so tough began to sell their property and leave Kenya. Africans though feeling that they had not been given a responsive government, accepted ministerial positions as follows;

  1. a) Ronald Ngala- Minister for Labour, Social Security and Adult Education.
  2. b) Julius Gikonyo Kiano- Minister for Commerce and Industry.
  3. c) Musa Amalemba- Minister for Housing, Common Services, Probation and Approved Schools.
  4. d) James Nzaui Miumi- Minister for Health and Welfare.

Out of fear of political domination by the big tribes the following new alliances were formed;

  1. a) The Kalenjin Political Alliance of Taita Towett.
  2. b) The Coast African Political Union of Ronald Ngala.
  3. c) The Kenya African People’s Party of Masinde Muliro.

In the 1961 elections KANU won but refused to form government demanding release of Kenyatta.  KADU was invited by the governor, Patrick Renson to form a coalition government with Europeans and Asians.

When Kenyatta came on 21st August 1961, Kariuki Njiiri offered his Murang’a seat to Kenyatta to enable him join LegCo.

The second Lancaster conference (1962)

The main aim of this conference, called by the then secretary for colonies, Reginald Maulding was to draft the independence constitution acceptable to the two main parties KADU and KANU. It also aimed at reconciling the differences between the two parties.

KANU delegation was led by Jomo Kenyatta while Ngala led the KADU group.

KANU conceded many KADU grounds to enable success of the negotiations.

Main provisions of the independence constitution of Kenya

  1. a) The independence constitution provided for a regional/majimbo government with each region having a regional assembly and p resident.
  2. b) It also provided for a bicameral parliament consisting of the senate and the house of representatives/upper house and lower house.
  3. c) The constitution stipulated that the Prime Minister was to be head of Government and Queen the Head of State, represented by the Governor General.
  4. d) The constitution recommended a multiparty system of government and the party with the majority of seats forming the government.
  5. e) It contained the Bill of Rights, which protected the individual’s rights.

In the elections of 1963, KANU won with 73 seats against KADU’s 31, APP’s 8. Jomo Kenyatta became the first Prime Minister on 1st June 1963.On 12 December, Kenya attained full independence. On 12th December 1964, Kenya became a republic with Kenyatta becoming an executive president.

EMERGENCE AND GROWTH OF NATIONALISM IN AFRICA

Factors for the rise of nationalism in Africa

  1. a) The exposure of Africans to severe economic exploitation during the colonial period. For example land alienation in the Kenya Highlands, in southern Rhodesian, Algeria and South Africa which was accompanied with forced labour where the labourers faced mistreatment.
  2. b) Africans were fed up of heavy and harsh taxation by the Europeans. They were exposed to heavy taxation, ranging from hut tax to breast tax in Belgian Congo.
  3. c) Africans were fed up with the gradual destruction of their culture by the whites.

Missionaries totally dismissed the age-old African traditions as being barbaric. This explains why independent schools and churches sprung up in central Kenya.

  1. d) The introduction of racial discrimination to go hand in hand with colonialism. All the best social amenities in South Africa, Zimbabwe and Kenya were reserved for the whites. The Europeans equated the black colour with low intelligence, uncivilized and a backward race.
  2. e) Africans resented colonialism because it interfered with their political institutions. The colonial rulers disregarded traditional rulers, appointing their own puppets in their place.
  3. f) The Acquisition of western education by many Africans by 1945 enabled them to articulate their grievances more forcefully and to understand political developments outside Africa.
  4. g) The return of the ex-servicemen after the second world war which exposed the myth of the white supremacy making Africans ready to fight them. Moreover, the colonial government failed to reward African ex-soldiers to embitter them more.
  5. h) The change of government from Conservative to Labour Party in Britain in 1946 stimulated a new attitude in Britain towards decolonization. This motivated African nationalists.
  6. i) The rise of nationalism in Asia, culminating into the granting of independence to India and Pakistan in 1947 aroused great confidence among Africans who worked closely with Asian nationalists like Jawaharlal Nehru, the India Prime Minister.
  7. j) The rise of Pan-Africanism in Africa after the 1945 Manchester conference contributed to the new demands for political independence in Africa Many African élites attended the conference which served as a source of awakening.
  8. k) The formation of the UNO and the pressure it exerted on the European powers to decolonize helped the Africans in their course.
  9. l) The emergence of United States and the Soviet Union as super powers in the world contributed to the decolonization process. USA was keen to see Britain and France grant independence to their subjects in the world in order to secure new markets.
  10. m) The signing of the Atlantic Charter in 1941 by Winston Churchill and Franklin Roosevelt which demanded that when the WWII ended, all subject peoples should enjoy the right to self-determination.

NATIONALISM IN GHANA

The British annexed Gold Coast in 1874 after quelling a stiff resistance by the Asante. In response to the British imperialism, the Fonte Confederation was initiated in 1868, marking the birth of African Nationalism in Ghana. In 1897, the Aborigines Rights Protection Society was formed to guard against the alienation of African land.In the 1930s, African elites like J.B. Danquah launched the Gold Coast Youth Conference in order to awaken the youth to the economic and social needs of the country.Their efforts bore fruits because in 1946, governor Burns embarked on constitutional reforms leading to increased African representation in the LegCo. (Of the 18 slots given to Africans in the LegCo, 13 were to drawn from among the chiefs while 5 were to be popularly elected).

The elites formed the United Gold Coast Convention (UGCC) and invited Kwame Nkrumah, a graduate of the University of Pennsylvania in Philadelphia, to come and lead it since most of them were professionals lacking time for political commitment. Nkrumah appeared to have more political experience having participated in the 1945 Manchester conference.

Factors for the growth of nationalism in Ghana

  1. a) The early Introduction of cocoa growing led to adoption of money economy in Ghana ahead of other countries. This enabled faster social and economic transformation of the people.
  2. b) The colonial government’s attempt to tamper with cocoa growing by ordering cutting of coca trees hurt people to the level of developing nationalistic feelings against the British.
  3. c) Ghana was one of the first countries in Africa to receive western education from the missionaries. There was a large class of elites with western university education accompanied with leadership skills to spearhead nationalism their country.
  4. d) The existence of ex-servicemen in Ghana also played an important role in the campaign for independence.
  5. e) The granting of trading licences by the government selectively to European traders while deliberately denying then Africans.
  6. f) Ghana had comparatively better developed transport and communication system. Also being a small country, movement of information, ideas and people was easy, quick and efficient. This facilitated nationalist activities.
  7. g) The charismatic and strong leadership provided by Kwame Nkrumah brought cohesiveness among people of Ghana. He formed the CPP party, which became the symbol of struggle for the oppressed people of Ghana.
  8. h) The participation of Kwame Nkrumah in the Pan-African Manchester conference in 1945, which championed the right of countries to self-determination, made the country take the lead in Africa in championing this right.
  9. i) The people of Ghana were more exposed to international affairs than other countries in Africa due to its location in a region, which had the earliest contacts with European traders and colonizers.

The peak of nationalism in Ghana.On 28th February 1948, the ex-soldiers led the Accra riots, protesting to Governor Gerald Creasy the failed fulfillment of the government pledges while in service during the World WarII. Two rioters were killed. The shooting incident sparked of chaos in the town leading to another 29 Africans being killed. Nkrumah was arrested together with his colleagues popularly

known as the ‘Big Six’. (Nkrumah, Danquah, William Ofori, Addo, Adjei and Obetsebi Lamptey).

This arrest popularized Nkrumah among the Africans. The 1948 Alken Watson commission blamed the social-economic oppression for the riots. The governor ordered for constitutional reforms led by J.H Coussey.On 12th June 1949, Nkrumah broke ranks with the conservative UGCC senior members and formed the Convention People’s Party (CPP). His party gained support mainly from among the primary school leavers, store-keepers, artisans, peasants and cocoa farmers. Nkrumah advocated positive action through legitimate political action, newspaper and political campaigns and constitutional application of boycotts, strikes and non-cooperation based on the policy of absolute non-violence on the basis of Mahatma Gandhi teachings. He started a newspaper, The Accra Evening News to expound CPP views. He was arrested, but secured landslide victory in the February 1951 elections while in jail. He was released to become the leader of government business in the new cabinet. CPP also won in the 1954 elections in which a new party, the National Liberation Movement (NLM) had emerged to compete CPP. NLM membership mainly from the Ashanti, were uncomfortable with Nkrumah because;

~  He came from a small ethnic group little known in southern Ghana.

~  His radicalism did not please the conservative Ashanti leaders.

Again elections were called in July 1956 and CPP trounced NLM. This time, the British accepted the results and on 6th March 1957, the country attained political independence under Kwame Nkrumah

Achievements of CPP under Kwame Nkrumah

  1. a) CPP under Nkrumah united Africans of all ranks in Ghana in the struggle for national liberation.
  2. b) The party introduced the concept of positive action to pressurize the government to liberate Africans.
  3. c) CPP formed the first African government in Africa in 1951 after winning the elections. Under Nkrumah’s leadership, Ghana began attaining economic development.
  4. d) CPP, under Nkrumah, advocated for unity of all Africans in the country us other parties like NLM advocated for regionalism, a factor that enhanced progress towards political libration.How Kwame Nkrumah contributed to the liberation struggle in Africa.
  5. a) He funded nationalists in other countries e.g. Guinea and Algeria.
  6. b) He supported other African leaders who faced political threats from their former colonial masters.
  7. c) When some countries were faced with threats from their former colonial masters after independence like in the case of Patrice Lumumba in DRC, Nkrumah provided them with his support.
  8. d) He championed trade unionism in Africa.
  9. e) He attended pan-African congress in 1945 which was key to defining the liberation struggles in Africa.
  10. f) He initiated the formation of the Ghana- Guinea Union in 1958 as a practical step towards building African unity.
  11. g) He convened two pan-African conferences in April 1958 and the all African Peoples conference in December 1958 that led to the formation of O.A.U in 1963.

NATIONALISM IN MOZAMBIQUE

Mozambique was among the last countries in Africa to attain independence from the Portuguese. Even before the Berlin conference, Mozambique and Angola were considered Portuguese colonies owing to the later’s interests in the region dating back to the pioneer years.

Reasons for slow process in decolonization process of Mozambique.

  1. a) Mozambique was colonized by a colonial power that was very poor and backward and which needed to keep its hold on her to enable her economy grow. She was an important source of revenue for the Lisbon government.
  2. b) Mozambique housed many settlers who had invested heavily in farming, mining, building, construction and in other sectors. They were therefore reluctant to leave.
  3. c) Mozambique was an important market for Portuguese products. Portugal was not willing to let go easily.
  4. d) The support, which the colonial government got from South Africa, enabled them to get uranium, which they used, for making bombs used to suppress African independence riots. They also got electricity and assistance to built caborra bassa dam on Zambezi.
  5. e) Mozambique was big geographically with very poor infrastructure i.e. roads and

communication facilities. This hampered fast movement of people and ideas.

  1. f) Unlike other colonized countries, Mozambique suffered the worst kind of exploitation and repression/ rigorous censorship and surveillance by security forces, which discouraged emergence of nationalism.
  2. g) The Portuguese practiced racism out of fear that if they educated Africans and gave them equal status, the Africans would outnumber them and throw them out.

Factors for the growth of nationalism in Mozambique.

  1. a) The arbitrary replacement of the traditional rulers by the Portuguese administrators whenever they felt they were not performing.
  2. b) The massive alienation of African land by the Portuguese who pushed Africans to regions of unfavourable conditions.
  3. c) The exposure of Africans to severe economic exploitation like forced labour where the labourers faced mistreatment.
  4. d) The rampant racial discrimination through which Africans continued to lose agricultural land to the Europeans. Being from a poor country, the Europeans competed with Africans for simple jobs like taxi driving and often gaining advantage on racial lines.
  5. e) The Portuguese imposed many restrictions on Africans, limiting their freedom of expression and intellectual advancement. For example, General Salazar, who rose to power in the 1920s, ensured strict censorship of the press.
  6. f) The security police treated Africans with great cruelty. Any political unrest was crushed ruthlessly.

The peak of nationalism in Mozambique.

In early 1960, the Makonde people of Cabo Delgado province formed the MozambicanMakonde Union (MANU).In June 1960 MANU organized a peaceful protest but in which over 600 Africans perished in police firepower. The government outlawed all African organizations with membership of over thirty people. African political activities went underground. Mwalimu Julius Nyerere inviting some of the liberation groups to relocate to Tanzania in 1962. The political groups united to form the Liberation Front of Mozambique (FRELIMO) with Eduardo Mondlane Chirambo, formerly a lecturer at Syracuse University in USA, as its first president.From 1962 to 1964, FRELIMO undertook guerilla training in Bagamoyo and at the Mozambique institute in Dar es Salam in preparation for war. From September 1964, they began a full-scale war against the Portuguese along river Ruvuma and extending their attacks on the Cabo Delgado province. By 1967, the Portuguese forces numbered 65,000 soldiers.Mondlane Eduardo was assassinated in 1969. Samora Machel was elected to become the FRELIMO army commander in 1970.The coup d’etat in Lisbon in 1974 was a blessing to FRELIMO movement since soldiers who did not favour colonial wars by Marcello Caetano carried it out. The new military junta finally signed an agreement with FRELIMO the enabled the setting up of a transitional gover nment in September 1974. He handed over power to the Africans in 1975 with Samora Machel becoming the first president.

Machel died in 1986 in a plane crash blamed on the South African Apartheid regime, unhappy with his support for African nationalists in South Africa.Samora Machel’s widow, Graca Machel, married South African President Nelson Mandela in 1994.

Reasons why the struggle for independence in Mozambique was violent

  1. a) The depth of suffering by ordinary people in Mozambique was unbearable.
  2. b) The harshness of the Portuguese administration could only be matched with similar violence.
  3. c) The unwillingness of Portugal to ease her colonial hold and begin the process of

decolonization. (they were deeply entrenched in Mozambique)

  1. d) Extreme exploitation of Mozambique resources e.g. land, labour, minerals.
  2. e) Widespread land alienation left many landless.
  3. f) To uproot the Portuguese from Mozambique, they had to use full-scale military operation by the liberators because the masters did not see any sense of granting Mozambique independence peacefully.

Factors that facilitated the defeat of the Portuguese colonial armies by FRELIMO in Mozambique.

  1. a) A few Africans were privileged to acquire university education in Portugal and came to form the bulk of FRELIMO leadership.
  2. b) The overwhelming support Mozambique fighters received from other African states e.g. Tanzania, Zimbabwe and DRC. From these countries, they gained moral and military support.
  3. c) FRELIMO was a formidable, well-organized force, which witnessed rapid expansion from a mere 250 in 1964 to 35000 in 1967.
  4. d) The forested environment favoured guerilla warfare. Moreover, the soldiers knew the topography of the country.
  5. e) The local population gave their logistic support to the fighters, having become tired of the extreme suppression by the Portuguese administration.
  6. f) The movement fighters had their own supply of food.
  7. g) African countries through OAU were united against the Portuguese in Mozambique.
  8. h) The communist countries notably USSR and china gave FRELIMO military aid.
  9. i) FRELIMO adopted the right strategy; liberating the country bit by bit and systematically. This approach won the local people’s support for the movement.
  10. j) The FRELIMO Army consisted of all tribes, all sexes and all ages. The women played a very important role in the success of the war. I.e. spies, some fought, hiding the fighters and cooking for them.

Problems that faced FRELIMO in the war against Portuguese

  1. a) Africans experienced severe shortage of basic needs while in the forests. The government forces ensured that food and other supplies did not reach the fighters.
  2. b) The attitude of the church in Mozambique made many African faithful reluctant to support the liberation war. The church termed FRELIMO a terrorist organization.
  3. c) FRELIMO suffered internal divisions due to ideological differences and selfish ambitions among some of the nationalists. African elites like Reverend Uria Simango and Lazaro Kavandame saw FRELIMO as an instrument of acquiring assets for their own selfish benefits.
  4. d) Competition from rival guerilla movements like Revolutionary Committee of Mozambique (COREMO) which broke away from FRELIMO in 1965 due to the later’s lean towards socialism.
  5. e) The assassination of FRELIMO leader Eduardo Mondlane in Da es Salaam on 3rd February 1969 was a great blow to the nationalists.
  6. f) The brutality employed by the Portuguese in dealing with FRELIMO sympathizers. For example at Wiriyamu, in December 1972, 400 civilians, protesting against the Portuguese administration, were massacred.
  7. g) The apartheid regime in South Africa and the Unilateral Declaration of Independence regime in south Rhodesia combined forces to fight the nationalists in Mozambique since they were a threat to their countries.

SOUTH AFRICA.

The complex nature of nationalism in South Africa was due to the following reasons;

  1. a) The country was not colonized by one specific European power.
  2. b) The existence of valuable mineral deposits made the Europeans more aggressive in their efforts to control the wealth in South Africa. There existed different types of nationalism in South Africa namely;

~  The British nationalism

~  Afrikaner nationalism

~  African nationalism.

Afrikaner nationalism

Afrikaners were the Dutch speaking – speaking settlers. The Afrikaner nationalism emerged in the 19th century reaching its peak in 1948 when their Nationalist Party under Daniel F. Malanwon the lections introducing the Apartheid policy.

Reasons for the birth of Afrikaner Nationalism in South Africa.

  1. a) The desire to regain the culture against Anglicization, which they considered, was alien. (Anglicization of power, language and cultures)
  2. b) The Boers hated the British rule, which they considered as alien.
  3. c) The British were dominant in many spheres of life yet they could neither speak nor understand Afrikaners’ language.
  4. d) The Boers wanted to rule South Africa and restore Boer culture, language, education and literature.
  5. e) They favoured republican states and complete independence for South Africa and noncooperation with British to fulfill their divine mission of bringing civilization to the heathen.
  6. f) The Jameson raid flared up Boer sentiments. Jameson, a Briton led a force of 500 soldiers to invade Transvaal, a Boer territory.
  7. g) Formation of union of South Africa under British terms.

African Nationalism

Its roots are traced in the 17th century with the first Boer occupation of South Africa. Africans resisted strongly against the interference with their political freedom and economic resources. This was in form of the Xhosa and Ndebele wars of the 17th c and the Zulu wars of 1870s led by Cetewayo.In 1906, a Zulu chief named Bambata staged another African uprising this time against the British who had annexed the Zululand in 1887.From 1910, when the union of South Africa was created and the Afrikaners gained political control of South Africa, Africans lost all the political privileges they previously enjoyed like ability to vote and contest parliamentary seats.Africans founded independent churches and formed organizations like the Orange River Organization.

Factors for the growth of African nationalism in South Africa

  1. a) The role of the Christian religion whose ideals encouraged Africans to fight for equality, as all people were equal before God. The Boers however treated Africans with contempt.
  2. b) The exposure of Africans to severe economic exploitation like land alienation and causing them to be subjected to forced labour on Afrikaner farms. Even the native Land Act of 1913 denied Africans the right to purchase land outside the areas set aside for Africans.
  3. c) The influence of Pan-Africanism in South Africa as early as the 19th century when people like Rev. Dube founded the Ohlange Institute to educate fellow Africans in South Africa.
  4. d) The introduction of racial discrimination enshrined in the apartheid law of 1948 convinced Africans that only freedom could save them. All the best hotels, restaurants, schools, recreational centres and most fertile soils were reserved for the whites only.
  5. e) The Acquisition of western education by many Africans like Rev. Dube, Walter Sisulu and Nelson Mandela enabled them to articulate their grievances more forcefully. They became pioneers of early African political parties.
  6. f) The return of the ex-servicemen after the second world war which exposed the myth of the white supremacy making Africans ready to fight them. The war also exposed them to democratic ideals elsewhere.
  7. g) The great exploitation of African labour through Labour regulations and laws. For example, the Mines and Works Act of 1911 effectively excluded Africans from all skilled occupations confining them to manual occupations in Mines and farms.
  8. h) The development of large urban centres created an enabling environment for Africans to forge close inter-ethnic relations that enabled them to counter the Afrikaner racist policies.

Formation of the African National Congress, 1912

Opposition to the Natives Land Act  led to the formation of the South African Native NationalCongress (renamed the African National Congress [ANC] in 1923) by South Africa’s educated African elite in a meeting at Bloemfontein on January 8, 1912.

~  The founding president was John L. Dube, a minister and schoolteacher.

~   Pixley Ka Isaka Seme, a lawyer, was appointed treasurer.

~  Solomon T. Plaatye, a court translator, became secretary general.

~  Other members were Thomas Mapikela, Walter Robusana, Solomon Plaatye and Sam Makgatho.The congress was moderate in composition, tone, and practice. However, In 1940s, a militant form of nationalism emerged under the ANC Youth League formed in 1943 led by Nelson Mandela, Walter Sisulu and Oliver Tambo, emphasizing the inalienable right of the Africans to the African continent. As a result of the League’s activities, violent confrontations between ANC and the government broke out in 1952 in Witwatersrand, Kimberley and Eastern Cape.The Congress of the People and the Freedom CharterIn 1952, Albert Sisulu became the president of the organization and presided over the ‘congress of the people’ which adopted the ‘Freedom Charter’ on June 25 and June 26 1955.The congress drew 3,000 delegates from;

~  The black (the ANC).

~  White (the Congress of Democrats).

~  Indian and coloured (the the SA Coloured People’s Congress) political organizations

~  The multiracial South African Congress of Trade Unions (SACTU).

The Freedom Charter emphasized that South Africa should be a non-racial society with no particular group assumed to have special rights or privileges. After adoption of the charter, in 1956 the police arrested 156 leaders, including Luthuli, Mandela, Tambo, Sisulu, and others, and put them on trial for treason in a court case that dragged on for five years. The Pan-Africanist Congress and Sharpeville. The Africanists, led by Robert Sobukwe, criticized the ANC for allowing itself to be dominated by ‘liberal-left-multi-racialists”. They formed their own organization, the Pan-Africanist Congress (PAC) in 1959. In March 1960, the PAC began a national campaign against the pass laws. One such demonstration outside the police station at Sharpeville, the police fired on the demonstrators, killing at least 76 of them and wounding 186. Approximately 18,000 demonstrators were arrested, including the leaders of the ANC and the PAC, and both organizations outlawed.

The ANC and the PAC Turn to Violence

Prohibited from operating, both the ANC and the PAC established underground organizations in 1961. The militant wing of the ANC, Umkhonto we Sizwe (Spear of the Nation), targeted strategic places such as police stations and power plants. Poqo (Blacks Only), the militant wing of the PAC, engaged in a campaign of terror, targeting in particular African chiefs and headmen believed to be collaborators with the government and killing them. 17 Umkhonto leaders, including Walter Sisulu were arrested at Rivonia farm house. Along with Nelson Mandela, they were tried for treason. Albert Luthuli was confined by government to his rural home in Zululand until his death in 1967. Tambo escaped from South Africa and became president of the ANC in exile. Robert Sobukwe of Poqo was jailed on Robben Island until 1969 and then placed under house arrest in Kimberley until his death in 1978. The Johannesburg railway station bomber, John Harris, was hanged.

The Black conscious movement – Soweto, 1976

In the absence of other forms of political expression, young people sought alternative means to express their political aspirations. African university students, disappointed with the multiracial National Union of South African Students (NUSAS), decided to establish the South African Students’ Organization (SASO) in 1969 with Steve Biko, an African medical student at the University of Natal, as president.In 1972, a Black allied workers’ union and the Black Peoples’ Convention (BPC) was set up to act as a political umbrella organization for the adherents of black consciousness. In 1972, SASO organized strikes on university campuses resulting in the arrest of more than 600 students. On June 16, 1976, hundreds of high-school students in Soweto marched in protest against use of Afrikaans as a Language of instruction. Over 360 African school children were killed.On 12th September 1977, Steve Biko, who had been held in indefinite detention, died from massive head injuries sustained during police interrogation. In October 1977, SASO, the BPC and all black consciousness organizations were banned.

The peak of African nationalism in South Africa

In 1983, P.W. Botha’s government proposed establishment of separate houses of parliament for each racial group.  In place of the single House of Parliament were;

~  A 50-member (all-white) House of Assembly.

~  A 25-member (coloured) House of Representatives.

~  A 13 member (Indian) House of Delegates.

Implications and results

~  Whites thus retained a majority in any joint session.

~  Liberal government opponents denounced Botha’s plans arguing it would permanentlyexclude Africans from any political role in South Africa.

~  Most blacks strongly condemned the new constitution as it reinforced the apartheid notion.

~  Indians and coloureds also condemned the constitution feeling it  weakened their

participation in the political process

~  Radical Afrikaners, led by Eugene Terry Blanche, vowed to use all means, including violence, to make sure that apartheid was not weakened.The United Democratic Front (UDF), which was formed in late 1983 and the National Front (NF) aimed to use nonviolent means to persuade the government to withdraw its constitutional proposals and do away with apartheid. The UDF membership included, Bishop Desmond Tutu and the Reverend Allan Boesak, who emerged as its prime spokesmen.Black trade unions meanwhile resorted to economic and political protests. For example, TheNational Union of Mineworkers (NUM), formed in 1983 by Cyril Ramaphosa, successfully brought work in mines to a stop in a dispute over wage increases. By end of 1985, 879, fatalities and 8000 arrests were linked to political unrest. ANC and UDF were banned.Meanwhile, Supporters of the Zulu-dominated Inkatha Freedom Party (IFP) and the banned ANC clashed in an upsurge of “black-on-black” violence that would cause as many as 10,000 deaths by 1994.President Botha resigned under pressure on August 14, 1989, the Electoral College named de Klerk to succeed him in a five-year term as president.  In October 1989, De Klerk released Walter Sisulu and others except Mandela. He announced on February 2, 1990, the impending release of Mandela and unbanning of the ANC, the PAC, and the SACP, and the removal of restrictions on the UDF and other legal political organizations. Mandela was released on February 11, 1990, at age 71 after 27 years in prison. ANC officials elected Mandela deputy president in March 1990, under ailing president, Oliver Tambo.Between June 5, 1991 and June 17, 1991, the government repealed the pillars of apartheid, the Land Act of 1913, the Group Areas Act of 1950 and Population Registration Act of 1950, (the most infamous, which had authorized the registration by race of newborn babies and immigrants). Most international sanctions were lifted soon after the Population Registration Act, Group Areas Act, and Land Acts were repealed.

In mid-1992 due to escalating violence, by IFP supporters on ANC sympathizers in Boipatong delayed the process of negotiation for elections. On March 5, 1993, Chris Hani, the popular general secretary of the South African Communist Party (SACP), was murdered threatening the process again.On April 12, 1994, a team headed by former British foreign secretary Lord Carrington and former United States secretary of state Henry Kissinger attempted in vain to break the logjam that was keeping the IFP out of the elections. However, on April 19, Buthelezi –under intense pressure from trusted local and international figures—including a Kenyan diplomat professor Washington Okumu, relented and agreed to allow the IFP to be placed on the ballot.When the elections finally took place on schedule, beginning on April 26, 1994, ANC won 62.6 percent of the vote; the NP, 20.4 percent; and the IFP, 10.5 percent.  Mandela was unanimously elected president by the National Assembly on May 9, 1994, in Cape Town. He was inaugurated on May 10 at ceremonies in Pretoria.

Key South African Nationalists

Nelson Mandela

Nelson Mandela was born on 18 July 1918 in Umtata, to a Thembu royal family of Transkei. His forename Rolihlahla, means “troublemaker”.  Later he was given a clans’ name, Mandiba. His father, Gadla Henry Mphakanyiswa, was a local chief and councillor to the monarch. In 1926, Gadla was sacked for corruption. Nelson’s mother was Gadla’s third wife, Nosekeni Fanny, a member of the amaMpemvu clan of Xhosa.

At a local Methodist school when he was about seven, he was baptised and given the English forename of “Nelson”. His father died of an undiagnosed ailment when he was nine. Aged 16, he underwent the circumcision.

Mandela joined Clarkebury Boarding Institute in Engcobo, the best secondary school for black Africans in Thembuland. In 1937, he moved to Healdtown, the Wesleyan college in Fort Beaufort where he took an interest in boxing and running.  Mandela joined Fort Hare University, where he met Oliver Tambo, a long time friend. He was studying Bachelor of Arts but was expelled in his first year for being involved in a Students’ Representative Council boycott against university policies. Mandela relocated to Johannesburg, fearing early forced marriage, where met with his friend and mentor, Walter Sisulu.

After 1948 Mandela began actively participating in politics. He led in the ANC’s 1952 Defiance Campaign as secretary General of the youth league. Mandela and 150 other participants in the freedom charter adoption were arrested on 5 December 1956 and charged with treason. In 1961 Mandela became leader of the ANC’s armed wing, Umkhonto we Sizwe (Spear of the Nation). He coordinated sabotage campaigns against military and government targets.On 5 August 1962 Mandela was arrested and was imprisoned in the Johannesburg Fort. On 11 July 1963 police arrested other prominent ANC leaders at Rivonia, north of Johannesburg. Together with Mandela, they were charged with capital crimes of sabotage at the Rivonia Trial. All were sentenced to life imprisonment on 12 June 1964 on Robben Island. Mandela remained there for the next 18 of his 27 years in prison. In March 1982 Mandela was transferred to Pollsmoor Prison, along with other senior ANC leaders. In 1988 Mandela was moved to Victor Verster Prison where he remained until his release on 11 February 1990. Mandela returned to the leadership of the ANC led the party in the multi-party negotiations that led to the country’s first multi-racial elections in 1994. Mandela and President F. W. de Klerk were jointly awarded the Nobel Peace Prize in 1993. Mandela, as leader of the ANC, was inaugurated on 10 May 1994 as the country’s first black President after the 27th May 1994 Elections.As President from May 1994 until June 1999, Mandela presided over the transition from minority rule and apartheid. He helped to resolve the long-running dispute between Libya on one hand, and the US and Britain, over bringing to trial the two Libyans indicted of the Lockerbie bombing on 21 December 1988. Mandela decided not to stand for a second term and retired in 1999, to be succeeded by Thabo Mbeki. In July 2001 Mandela was diagnosed and treated for prostate cancer. In June 2004, at age 85, Mandela announced that he would be retiring from public life.On 8th December 2012; Mandela was hospitalized at a Military Hospital near Pretoria suffering from a recurring lung infection. On 15 December, Mandela had surgery to have gallstones removed. He was released from the hospital on 26 December 2012.Until July 2008 Mandela and ANC party members were barred from entering the United States—except to visit the United Nations headquarters in Manhattan—without a special waiver from the US Secretary of State, because of their South African apartheid-era designation as terrorists.

Robert Mangaliso Sobukwe

Sobukwe was born in Graaff-Reinet in the Cape Province on the 5 December 1924. He attended a Methodist college at Healdtown and later Fort Hare University where he joined the African National Congress Youth League (ANCYL) in 1948. In 1949 Sobukwe was elected as president of the Fort Hare Students’ Representative Council.

In 1950 Sobukwe was appointed as a teacher at a high school in  Standerton. In 1954 Sobukwe became a lecturer of African Studies at the University of the Witwatersrand. He identified with the Africanists within the African National Congress. He edited The Africanist Newspaper in 1957, criticizing the ANC for allowing itself to be dominated by ‘liberal-left-multi-racialists”. He later left ANC to form the Pan Africanist Congress (PAC). He became its first President in 1959.On 21 March 1960, Sobukwe led a march of PAC supporters to the local police station at Orlando, Soweto in order to openly defy the Pass laws. In a similar protest in Sharpeville, police opened fire on a crowd, killing 69 in the Sharpeville Massacre. Sobukwe was arrested, convictedof incitement, sentenced to three years in prison and later interned on Robben Island. Sobukwe was released in 1969 and allowed to live in Kimberley with his family under house arrest. He died on 27 Feb.  1978 Due to lung cancer and was buried in Graaf-Reinet on 11 March 1978.

Albert Luthuli

Albert Luthuli was born near Bulawayo, Rhodesia, around 1898 to a Seventh-day Adventist missionary John Bunyan Luthuli and Mtonya Gumede. When His father died, his mother returned to her ancestral home, Groutville in Stanger, Natal, South Africa to stay with his uncle, Martin Luthuli. On completing a teaching course at Edendale, Luthuli became principal and only teacher at a primary school in rural Blaauwbosch, Natal. Here he also became a lay preacher. In 1920 he declined a scholarship to University of Fort Hare to provide financial support for his mother. In1928 he became secretary of the African Teacher’s Association and in 1933 its president. He was also active in missionary work. He became chief in1936, until removed from this office by the government in 1952 due to what colonial authority called conflict of interest.In 1944 Luthuli joined the African National Congress (ANC). In 1945 he was elected to the Committee of the KwaZulu Province Provincial Division of ANC. A month later Luthuli was elected president-general of ANC. In 1955, he attended an ANC conference only to be arrested and charged with treason a few months later, along with 155 others. In December 1957, Luthuli was released and the charges against him dropped.  Luthuli’s leadership of the ANC covered the period of violent disputes between the  party’s “Africanist” and “Charterist” wings. In 1962 he was elected Rector of the University of Glasgow by the students, serving until 1965. In 1962 he published an autobiography titled: LET MY PEOPLE GOIn July 1967, at the age of 69, he was fatally injured in an accident near his home in  Stanger.

Methods used by nationalists in South Africa in their struggle for liberation from white minority rule

  1. a) They used force to fight for their independence.
  2. b) Africans used mass media to articulate their grievances, spread propaganda and mobilize the masses.
  3. c) Riots e.g. the Soweto riots of 1976 against the proposal to make Afrikaner (Boer language) the medium of instruction in all schools.
  4. d) There were demonstrations against Press Laws in 1960 at Sharpeville leading to massacres.
  5. e) Guerilla fighters trained in Algeria, Ghana etc carried out acts of sabotage like bombing strategic installations and power plants.
  6. f) The role of the clergy .e.g. Desmond Tutu who bitterly campaigned worldwide against apartheid.
  7. g) Use of diplomacy and negotiations to convince the whites about the futility of apartheid policy.
  8. h) Use of slogans such as Freedom Charter (1955) which proclaimed south Africa belonged to all races and called for political, social and economic equality
  9. i) They sent petitions, delegations to international forum.
  10. j) They formed political parties e.g. ANC, PAC, UDF and trade union activism to pressurize the government to change.
  11. k) They used job boycotts and strikes.
  12. l) They organized defiance campaigns and demonstrations in the streets to provoke the police to arrest them.
  13. m) They formed underground movements after the Umkhonto we Sizwe.
  14. n) Pressure from youth groups e.g. Steve Biko formed the Black Consciousness Movement as a weapon to counter oppression through organized strikes.
  15. o) Africans serving jail terms organized hunger strikes.

Problems encountered by African nationalists in South Africa

  1. a) The colonial government employed the method of Banning of political organizations as a means of frustrating the struggle for independence. .g ANC, PAC, and CP which restricted their activities
  2. b) The Nationalists were harassed, arrested and detained or jailed by the authorities e.g. Mandela, Oliver Tambo Sisulu, Sobukwe e.t.c
  3. c) Many were forced into exile or flee the country in search of political asylum and restriction.
  4. d) A lot of violence was unleashed on them/ Killing of many nationalists and Africans such as Steve Biko and the 1960 Sharpeville massacre of school children spreading fear.
  5. e) Deliberate policy of divide and rule was employed to weaken African unity e.g.

establishment of black homelands or Bantustans which eventually brewed the conflict between ANC and IFP of Buthelezi.

  1. f) The racist regime used emergency powers to harass and frustrate Nationalist leaders.
  2. g) The nationalists faced the problem of lack of money and other resources which slackened the struggle.
  3. h) Nationalists were denied access to state owned radio and other media outlets. Those media were instead used as a means of propaganda against the nationalists.
  4. i) Banning of trade unions also frustrated the activities of nationalists. Where they were allowed to exist, they were monitored by the police.
  5. j) The nationalists faced the challenge of movement restrictions through the pass laws that were introduced.
  6. k) African Journalists were harasses and their newspapers proscribed by the government.

LIVES AND CONTRIBUTIONS OF KENYAN LEADERS

Jomo Kenyatta.

Early life

Jomo Kenyatta was born Kamau wa Ngengi to Ngengi wa Muigai and Wambui in Gatundu, Kiambu on 20th October 1891. His father died while Kamau was very young was adopted by his uncle Ngengi, who inherited his mother. When his mother died during childbirth, young Kamau moved from Ng’enda to Muthiga to live with his medicine man grandfather Kũngũ wa Magana.He joined the Church of Scotland Mission (CSM) at Thogoto, as a resident pupil. In 1912, having completed his mission school education, he became an apprentice carpenter. In 1914, he converted to Christianity, assuming the name Johnstone Kamau. He left the mission later that year to seek employment as an apprentice carpenter on a sisal farm in Thika.To avoid forced recruitment as WWI soldier, he lived with Maasai relatives in Narok, where he worked as a clerk for an Asian contractor. He took to wearing a traditional beaded belt known as a ‘Kenyatta’, a Swahili word which means ‘light of Kenya’.In 1922 Kamau adopted the name Jomo Kenyatta, and began working for the Nairobi Municipal Council Public Works Department as a store clerk and water-meter reader.

Marriage and family.

In 1919 he married Grace Wahu. On 20 November 1920 Kamau’s first son Peter Muigai was born. Grace Wahu lived in the Dagoretti home until her death in April 2007 at the age of around 100.In 1942, he married Edna Clarke and Peter Magana was born in 1943. In 1951 Kenyatta married Ngina Muhoho, daughter of Chief Muhoho and was independent Kenya’s First Lady, when Kenyatta was elected President.

Kenyatta and politics

Kenyatta joined the EAA in 1922 which disbanded in 1925.Kenyatta worked as editor of the KCA’s journal between 1924 and 1929, and by 1928 he had become the KCA’s general secretary. In May 1928 Kenyatta launched a monthly Kikuyu-language newspaper called Mwĩgwithaniawhich was intended to draw all sections of the Kikuyu together. He also made a presentation on Kikuyu land problems before the Hilton Young Commission in Nairobi in the same year.In February 1929 Kenyatta was dispatched to London to represent the KCA in discussions with the Colonial Office. He wrote several letters and in the letter published in The Times in March 1930 set out five points:

~  The security of land tenure and the return of the land taken by European settlers.

~  Improved educational opportunities for Black Africans.

~  The repeal of Hut and poll taxes.

~  Representation for Black Africans in the Legislative Council.

~  Freedom to pursue traditional customs (such as female genital mutilation)

He returned to Kenya on 24 September 1930. He returned to London in 1931. In 1932 to 1933, he briefly studied economics in Moscow. at University College London from 1935 studied social anthropology. Kenyatta published his own book, Facing Mount Kenya in 1938.

Kenyatta and pan-Africanism.

In 1945, with other prominent African nationalist figures, such as Kwame Nkrumah of Ghana, Kenyatta helped organize the fifth Pan-African Congress held in Britain.

Kenyatta and the struggle for independence.On arrival into Kenya in 1947, he became principal of Kenya Teachers College Githunguri.In 1947, he was elected president of the Kenya African Union (KAU) after James Gichuru stepped down.From 1948 to 1951 he toured and lectured around the country. He also published My People of Kikuyu and The Life of Chief Wang’ombe, a history shading into legend.The Mau Mau Rebellion began in 1951 and KAU was banned, and a state of emergency was declared on 20 October 1952. Kenyatta was arrested in October 1952 and indicted with five others (Bildad Kaggia, Fred Kubai, Paul Ngei, Achieng Oneko and Kung’u Karumba).At Kapenguria trials lasting 5 years, Rawson Macharia who was the main prosecution witness later confessed that he had been bribed to give false information about Kenyatta. The defense was led by British barrister D.N. Pritt. The court led by Judge R.S. Thacker, sentenced Kenyatta and his team on 8 April 1953 to seven years imprisonment with hard labour and indefinite restriction thereafter.Kenyatta remained in prison at Lokitaung in north western Kenya until April 1959, after which he was detained in Lodwar.On 14 May 1960, he was elected KANU President in absentia.  In 1960, Ambu Patel, a follower of Mahatma Gandhi formed the ‘Release Jomo Kenyatta Committee’. On 23rd march 1961, Kenyan leaders visited him in Lodwar. On 11 April 1961, he was moved to Maralal with daughter Margaret. On 14 August 1961, he was released.

Leadership

Kenyatta was admitted into the LegCo after his release in 1961, after Kariuki Njiiri gave up his Kigumo seat for him. In 1961 and 1962, he led the KANU delegation to first and second Lancaster Conference in London to negotiate Kenya’s independence constitution.

Elections were then held in May 1963 and KANU beat KADU by winning 83 seats out of 124. On 1 June 1963, Kenyatta became prime minister of the autonomous Kenyan government. On 1 June 1964, Kenyatta became an executive President following amendment of the Constitution to make Kenya a republic.

Commentary

Historians have questioned Kenyatta’s alleged leadership of the radical Mau Mau movement. Kenyatta was in truth a political moderate. It is even alleged that the colonial administration deliberately arrested him to protect him from the radical KAU members who accused him of betraying their course. (There were three attempts to assassinate him before he was arrested). His marriage of Colonial Chief’s daughters, his post independ-ence Kikuyu allies mainly being former colonial collaborators, and his short shrift treatment of former Mau Mau fight ers after he came to power, all strongly suggest he had scant regard for the Mau Mau

Kenyatta and nation building

On 10 November 1964, KADU officially dissolved and its representatives joined KANU, forming a single party. Kenyatta was re-elected un-opposed in 1966, and the next year had the Constitution amended to expand his powers. In the 1969 elections, Kenyatta banned the only other party, KPU led by Jaramogi Oginga Odinga, detained its leaders, and called elections in which only KANU was allowed to participate.  Kenyatta made use of detention, ethnic loyalties, and careful appointment of government jobs to maintain his commanding position in Kenya’s political system.Kenyatta was again re-elected unopposed as President in 1974He remained president until his death four years later in 1978.

 

 

Sickness and Death

President Kenyatta had suffered a heart attack in 1966. In April 1977, then well into his 80s, he suffered a massive heart attack.On 14 August 1978, he hosted his entire family, including his son Peter Magana who flew in from Britain with his family, to a reunion in Mombasa. On 22 August 1978, he died in Mombasa due to ‘old age’. He was buried on 31 August 1978 at a mausoleum on Parliament grounds.Kenyatta’s tenure as president featured the following problems.

  1. a) There was a great split within KANU due to his land policy. Kenyatta compromised with the whites over their property. The Land-buying companies formed to buy European farms favoured one community.
  2. b) From the onset of independence, KADU advocated for Majimboism and therefore opposing national unity.
  3. c) The 1966 term featured border conflicts with Somalia, and more political opposition. He made the Kikuyu-led KANU practically the only political party of Kenya. He placed several of his Kikuyu tribesmen in most of the powerful state and security offices and posts.
  4. d) Increasing loss of confidence in his government suspected of complicity in murders of Pio Gama Pinto, Tom Mboya and J.M. Kariuki. MP and Lawyer C.M.G. Argwings-Kodhek and former Kadu Leader and Minister Ronald Ngala.
  5. e) Poverty, ignorance and disease were serious problems in Kenya in the early years of independence.
  6. f) There was shortage of manpower since the inherited educational policy left Africans illequipped for skilled employment.
  7. g) Kenya did not have adequate funds to provide for is development needs.
  8. h) There was a serious problem of poor transport and communication.
  9. i) The existence of Banditry (Shifta Menace) in north-eastern kenya also shifted attention from economic development.

Achievements.

  1. a) Mzee Jomo Kenyatta is credited with leading Kenya to independence and setting up the country as a relatively prosperous capitalist state.
  2. b) He oversaw a peaceful land reform process, oversaw the setting up of the institutions of independent Kenya, and also oversaw Kenya’s admission into the United Nations.
  3. c) During his reign, the country was reasonably well governed, peaceful and stable, the economy developed and grew rapidly and attracted high levels of foreign investment, and a black Kenyan professional and business middle class was established.

Failures

  1. a) Kenyatta failed to mould Kenya, being its founding father, into a homogeneous multi-ethnic state. The country remains a de facto confederation of competing tribes.
  2. b) His resettlement of many Kikuyu tribesmen in the country’s Rift Valley province is widely considered to have been done unfairly.
  3. c) His authoritarian style, with elements of patronage, favouritism, tribalism and/or nepotism drew criticism and dissent, and set a bad example followed by his successors.
  4. d) He had the Constitution radically amended to expand his powers, consolidating executive power.
  5. e) He was also been criticized for ruling through a post colonial clique of his relatives, mainly African Kikuyu colonial collaborators from Kiambu, while giving scant reward to the real fighters for Kenya’s independence.
  6. f) Kenyatta has further been criticized for encouraging the culture of wealth accumulation by public officials their office influence, thereby deeply entrenching corruption in Kenya.
  7. g) His policies are also criticized for leading to a large income and development inequality gap in the country favouring mainly Nairobi and the Country’s Central Highlands, over others.

Tom Mboya

Thomas Odhiambo Mboya was born on August 15, 1930 in Kilimambogo, near Thika town.In 1942, he joined St. Mary’s School Yala. In 1946, he went  to the Holy Ghost College (later Mang’u High School), where he passed well enough to proceed to do his Cambridge School Certificate. In 1948, Mboya joined the Royal Sanitary Institute’s Medical Training School at Nairobi, qualifying as an inspector in 1950 and employed by the Nairobi City Council.In 1955, he attended Ruskin College, Oxford, where he studied industrial management. In 1956, he returned to Kenya and joined politics at the height of Mau Mau uprising.

Political life

A year after joining African Staff Association, he was elected its president. He molded it into a trade union named the Kenya Local Government Workers’ Union. Upon returning from Britain, he contested and won a seat against incumbent C.M.G. Argwings-Kodhek. In 1957, he formedhis own party, the People’s Congress Party. In 1958, during the All-African Peoples’ Conference in Ghana, convened by Kwame Nkrumah, Mboya was elected as the Conference Chairman at the age of 28.In 1960, Mboya together with others formed KANU. As Secretary General of KANU, Mboya headed the Kenyan Lancaster House delegation.After Kenya’s independence on 1 June 1963, Mboya was elected as an MP for Nairobi Central Constituency (today: Kamukunji Constituency) and became Minister of Justice and Constitutional Affairs.As Minister for Economic Planning and Development, he wrote “Sessional Paper 10” (adopted by Parliament in 1964), which provided a model of government based on African values.He was gunned down on July 5, 1969 on Moi Avenue, aged 38 years.Mboya left a wife and five children. He is buried in a mausoleum located in Rusinga Island which was built in 1970.

 

 

 

Ronald Ngala

Early career

Ngala was born in 1922 at Gotani in Giriama country. In 1929 the family moved to Vishakani near Kaloleni, which was to be Ngala’s home for the rest of his life. Ngala attended Alliance High School and Makerere University College where he gained a teaching diploma. He worked as a teacher and later became headmaster of Mbale Secondary School in Taita-Taveta. In 1952 he was transferred to Buxton School in Mombasa where he served as the principal.

Political career

Ngala was elected to the Legislative Council in 1957 to represent the Coast Rural constituency.He formed the African Elected Members Organization (AEMO) together with other elected African MPs.at a meeting held on May 14, 1960 in Kiambu he was elected as the KANU’s treasurer, a position he declined to take. At a meeting held in Ngong on June 25, 1960, the Kenya African Democratic Union (KADU) was formed with Ngala as its leader, in opposition to KANU.At the 1961 legislative council elections Ngala formed the first African government. Ngala became Leader of Government Business and later Prime Minister.On 12 November 1964 the leaders of KADU, including Ronald Ngala, Masinde Muliro and Daniel arap Moi decided to dissolve KADU and join KANU. Ngala in the post independence periodRonald Ngala was made Minister of Cooperatives and Social Services in the Kenyatta government. He went on to become one of KANU’s vice-presidents at the 1966 Limuru Conference. Ngala remained active in the government until he died in a road accident in 1972. The circumstances of Ngala’s death in 1972 were suspicious.

Daniel Arap Moi

Early life and entry into politics

Daniel Arap Moi was born on 2nd September, 1924 in Kurieng’wo in Sacho Location of Baringo County, raised by his mother Kimoi Chebii following the early death of his father.  His elder brother Tuitoek played a guardian role, influencing him to go to school at an early age. In 1934, Moi joined African Inland Mission School, Kabartonjo. On October 20th 1936 he was baptised Daniel. In 1938, he transferred to African Inland Mission, Kapsabet and later to Government African School, Kapsabet where he was a school captain and a captain of the football team. He attended Tambach Teachers Training College. He worked as a teacher from 1946 until 1955. He was posted as a Head teacher at Kabarnet where he studied privately and passed London Matriculation Examinations. He was promoted in 1949 to the rank of P2 and transferred to Tambach Government African School as a Teacher Trainer. President Moi married Helena (Lena) Bommet in 1950 and they were blessed with 8 children; 3 daughters and five sons, (Jennifer, Doris and adopted daughter June; Jonathan, Raymond, John Mark, Philip and Gideon).  But they separated in 1974, before his presidency.. Lena died in 2004.

 

Moi’s long political career.

In October 1955 the Electoral College selected Moi from a list of eight nominated candidates to fill a vacancy left by Joseph ole Tameno who resigned from the unofficial benches of the legislative council. In 1957, when elections were held, for LEGCO, Moi won with a landslide against Justus Ole Tipis and later joined AEMO. In 1959, he led AEMO members to visit Jomo Kenyatta in detention in Lodwar. In 1960 he founded the Kenya African Democratic Union (KADU) with Ronald Ngala to challenge the Kenya African National Union (KANU) led by Jomo Kenyatta.Moi was among the Kenyan delegation under the auspices of KADU who went to the London Constitutional talks of June 1960. Moi was elected to the Kenyan parliament in 1963 from Baringo North. Since 1966 until his retirement in 2002 he served as the Baringo Central MP and only served as a vice -president from 1967 until 1978 when he became the president.In 1976, the Kiambu Mafia, tried to infamously change the constitution to prevent the vicepresident automatically assuming power in the event of the president’s death. However, Kenyatta withstood the political pressure and safeguarded Moi’s position.

Presidency

When Jomo Kenyatta died on 22 August 1978, Moi became president. Political realities dictated that he would continue to beholden to the Kenyatta system which he had inherited. On 1 August 1982, fate played into Moi’s hands when forces loyal to his government defeated an attempted coup d’état by Air Force officers led by Hezekiah Ochuka. Moi took the opportunity to dismiss political opponents and consolidate his power reducing the influence of Kenyatta’s men in the cabinet. He appointed supporters to key roles and changed the constitution to establish a de jure single-party state.

Moi, his regime now faced an economy stagnating under rising oil prices and falling prices for agricultural commodities, singlehandedly convinced the KANU delegates at a conference at Kasarani in December, 1991 over the restoration of a multi-party systemin 1992 and 1997, marred by political violence and  absence of an effective and organized opposition, Moi had no difficulty in winning, skillfully exploited Kenya’s mix of ethnic tensions. Mwai Kibaki was elected President on 29 December 2002 and Moi handed over power to him.

Moi After retirement.

After leaving office in December 2002, Moi lived in retirement but still retained some popularity with the masses. He spoke out against a proposal for a new constitution in 2005.  On 25 July 2007, Kibaki appointed Moi as special peace envoy to Sudan.

On 28 August 2007, Moi announced his support for Kibaki’s re-election. Moi owns the Kiptagich Tea Factory, established in 1979, which in 2009 the factory was under threat of being closed down by the government during the Mau Forest evictions.

Challenges and achievements

The major test to His leadership was in August 1982 when a detachment of Airforce soldiers attempted to overthrow his government but they were crushed.

Achievements

~  Moi served as Chairman of the Organization of African Unity (OAU) for two consecutive terms – 1981 and 1982.

~  He has also been involved in mediation between various conflicting sides in Uganda, Congo, Somalia, Chad, Sudan, Mozambique, Eritrea/Ethiopia, Rwanda, and Burundi etc.

~  He served as Chairman of Preferential Trade Area (1989-1990), COMESA (1999-2000), E.A. Co-operation (1996- 2002) and Inter-Governmental Authority on Development IGAD (1993 -1998).

~  He has travelled widely, being called upon as a president to provide peace keeping forces in troubled parts of the world like Chad, Uganda, Namibia, Mozambique, Iran/Iraq, Kuwait, Yugoslavia, Liberia, Morocco, Angola, Serbia/ Croatia, D.R. Congo, Sierra Leone and East Timor.

~  Moi has supported the formation of regional economic bodies to increase trade and as a means for the developing countries to have a united voice in the global economy.

~  On 30th December 2002, Moi handed over power to Mwai Kibaki in a peaceful transition

that followed the Narc victory over Kanu in the December 2002 General Elections.

~  Currently, Moi is setting up a foundation through which he hopes to participate in solving conflicts in the horn of African and the Great Lakes Region as well as help rehabilitate  street children and those orphaned by HIV/aids.

Jaramogi Ajuma Oginga Odinga (Oct.1911 – Jan 20, 1994).

Early years and career

Oginga Odinga was born at Nyamira Kang’o, in Sakwa location in Bondo, in October, 1911. Christened Obadiah Adonijah, he later renounced his Christian names and became known as Ajuma Oginga Odinga.Young Odinga began his formal education in 1926, at Maranda. He sat for his common entrance examination in 1929. He Attended Maseno School where he sat his STD 8 exams in 1934. He enrolled at Alliance High School in 1935 upto, finishing his formal education with a diploma in education from Makerere University College in 1939.  From 1940 to 1942 Odinga taught mathematics at the Church Missionary Society school, Maseno.  From 1943 to 1946 he was headmaster of the Maseno Veterinary School. Odinga and Economic and social independence

In 1944, he quit teaching and formed the Bondo Thrift Association in 1945.In 1947, he founded the Luo Thrift and Trading Corporation for commercial and political

purposes, serving as its managing director until 1962. LUTATCO build their first shop, MasenoStore, posho mills at Ngiya, Bondo and Dudi. The company owned Ramogi Press in Nairobi in 1947, publishing a Dholuo newspaper, Ramogi, edited by Achieng Oneko, Odinga’s student in Maseno School. They also published Nyanza Times, Radioposta, Sauti ya Mwafrika and Mumenyereri. Between 1956 and 1957, they built Ramogi House and Africa House Kisumu.

He helped to form the Luo Union, which brought together all the Luo people. His efforts earned him admiration and recognition among the Luo, who revered him as Ker – a title previously held by the fabled classical Luo king, Ramogi Ajwang, who reigned 400 years before him. Odinga became known as Jaramogi (man of the people of Ramogi).

Odinga travelled across the major towns in East Africa raising funds that resulted in the building of the Ofafa Memorial Hall in Kisumu in 1957 which became the headquarters of the Luo Union.

Odinga’s political contributions (1948-1963)

In 1947, he won the central Nyanza African District Council elections. In 1948 he joined Kenya African Union (KAU) having been influenced by  a Luo Union and KAU leader, Ambrose Ofafa. In 1957 and became the political spokesman of the Luo. The same year, he was elected member of the Legislative Council for the Central Nyanza constituency.  He became the chairperson of AEMO formed by the eight African elected Members of the LEGCO. He with Mboya and Kiano formed the Kenya Independence Movement after AEMO began to disintegrate. After the 1960 Lancaster House Conference, attended by a unified African delegation, Odinga emerging as one of the radical group leader, dissatisfied Africans with the conference decisions.Odinga and other members of the legislative council formed the Kenya African National Union (KANU). Odinga’s KANU used its strong showing in the 1961 general elections to help gain Kenyatta’s release.

Odinga after independence

Kenya gained independence in Dec 1963, and Odinga was appointed minister for home affairs.When Kenya became a Republic in 1964, he was its first Vice-President. As VicePresident he did not agree with Jomo Kenyatta’s government, and he resigned his post and quit KANU in 1966 to form the Kenya People’s Union (KPU). He openly challenged the government’s use of private and foreign investment capital and its close ties with the West.Within KANU, a coalition formed against Odinga and in 1966 a KANU reorganization conference abolished his post of party vice-president. In October 1969, Odinga together with Achieng Oneko and other KPU members were jailed by the government. The KPU was banned, and he stayed in prison for 15 months. Odinga remained an opposition leader throughout the1970s. After Kenyatta’s death in 1978, the new president, Daniel Arap Moi, tried to bring Odinga back into KANU. Moi, appointed Odinga as chairman of the Cotton Lint and Seed Marketing Boardwhere he did not last long, because he was still outspoken against Kenyatta’s policies.  When Odinga was reinstated into the party in 1980, he attacked Moi and Kenyatta as corrupt and protested U.S. military presence in Kenya.Odinga attempted to register a political party in 1982, but his plans were foiled when Kenyawas made a de jure single-party state in 1982, KANU party again banished Odinga.Throughout the 1980s, Odinga remained vocal in calling for democracy. In 1984, he tried to launch and register the Ramogi Development Trust (RADET) but the government denied it registration.

 

Odinga and the Struggle for multi-parytism in the 1990s

In 1991, Odinga founded the National Democratic Party, but the government refused to recognize it and briefly jailed Odinga. Later that year Odinga and five other opposition leaders formed the Forum for the Restoration of Democracy (FORD). But FORD split in 1992, and Jaramogi formed FORD-K finishing fourth behind Moi, Matiba and Kibaki.

In 1993, Odinga’s reputation suffered when he admitted taking a campaign contribution from a bank accused of bribing government officials. In the months before his death in January 1994, Odinga tried to reconcile his branch of FORD with KANU, but without success.

Wangari Maathai

Early life of Wangari Maathai.

Maathai was born on April 1, 1940 in the Ihithe village, Nyeri County, in the

central region to Muta Njugi, a farm labourer on a white owned farm in the rift valley.  In 1950, she joined Ihithe Primary School for primary education in 1951, Maathai moved to St. Cecilia’s Intermediate Primary School at the Mathari Catholic Mission in Nyeri where she studied for four  years.During this time, she converted to Catholicism, taking the Christian name Mary Josephine. In 1956 she joined Loreto High School Limuru.

She was chosen to study at American universities in September 1960 under the Kennedy Airlift or Airlift Africa. In 1964, she joined the University of Pittsburgh to study for a master’s degree in biology.In January 1966, upon her return to Kenya, Maathai dropped her Christian name, preferring to be known by her birth name, Wangari Muta. In April 1966, she met Mwangi Mathai, whom she later married in 1969 and had three children with him.In 1971, she became the first Eastern African woman to receive a Ph.D., (in Anatomy) from the University of Nairobi. She was a member of the Nairobi branch of the Kenya Red Cross Society, becoming its director in 1973. In 1979, her husband, Mwangi Mathai divorced her, saying she was too strong-minded for a woman and wife and accusing her of adultery with another Member of Parliament.

Wangari Maathai as political activist.

In 1979, Maathai ran for the position of ch airman of the National Council of Women of Kenya (NCWK). She lost, but was chosen to be the vice-chairman of the organization.  In 1980, Maathai was elected chairman of the NCWK unopposed. However NCWK was left virtually bankrupt, as Future funding by government was channeled to Maendeleo Ya Wanawake a progovernment splinter group.In 1982, she resigned from the University of Nairobi to campaign for a Parliamentary seat in her home region of Nyeri. However, she was disqualified from vying.On February 28, 1992, Maathai and others took part in a hunger strike in Uhuru Park, to pressure the government to release political prisoners. The protest continued until early 1993, when the prisoners were finally released. After the first multi-party election of Kenya, in 1992, Maathai traveled with friends and the press to areas of violence in order to encourage them to cease fighting. After her friend and supporter Dr. Mukanga was kidnapped, Maathai chose to go into hiding.During the elections of 1997, Maathai ran for parliament and for president as a candidate of the Liberal Party. She lost the election.On July 7, 2001, shortly after planting trees at Freedom Corner in Uhuru Park in Nairobi to commemorate Saba Saba Day, Maathai was again arrested. Later that evening, she was again released without being charged.Maathai again campaigned for parliament in the 2002 elections, this time as a candidate of the National Rainbow Coalition; she won with an overwhelming 98% of the vote. In January 2003, she was appointed Assistant Minister in the Ministry for Environment and Natural Resources and served in that capacity until November 2005. In December 2007, choosing to run as the candidate of a smaller party  Maathai was, defeated in the parliamentary election. The life of Wangari Maathai as an environmental conservationist.Following the establishment of the Environment Liaison Centre in 1974, Maathai became the chair of the board.  In 1974, with her husband as the MP for Lang’ata constituency, Maathai founded the Envirocare Ltd., a business that involved the planting of trees to conserve the environment. This led to the planting of her first tree nursery, in a government tree nursery in Karura Forest. On June 5, 1977, marking World Environment Day, Maathai led the NCWK in a procession from Kenyatta International Conference Centre to Kamukunji Park where they planted seven trees in honor of historical community leaders.

This was the first “Green Belt” planted by what became the Green Belt Movement.

In 1982, she was approached by Wilhelm Elsrud, executive director of the Norwegian Forestry Society. Who partnered with the Green Belt Movement and offered her the position of coordinator. In 1987, Maathai stepped down as chairman of the NCWK and focused her attention on the newly separate nongovernmental organization.In October 1989, Maathai learned of a plan to construct the 60 -story Kenya Times Media Trust Complex in Uhuru Park. Her protests, some leading to her being harassed, led to the foreigninvestors to cancel the project in January 1990. In June 1992, both Maathai and President Arap Moi traveled to Rio de Janeiro for the UN Conference on Environment and Development (Earth Summit) where she became a chief spokesperson despite government protest. In 1998, Maathai protested against the privatization of large areas of pu blic land in the Karura Forest. In August 16, 1999, when the president announced that he was banning all allocation of public land.On October 8, 2004, Maathai became the first African woman, and the first environmentalist, to win the Nobel Peace Prize for her contribution to sustainable development, democracy and peace.On March 28, 2005, she was elected the first president of the African Union’s Economic, Social and Cultural Council and was appointed a goodwill ambassador for an initiative aimed at protecting the Congo Basin Forest Ecosystem.

Achievements of Wangari Maathai

  1. a) As a member of the Kenya Association of University Women, she was on the forefront in campaigning for equal benefits for the women while at the university and also as a member National Council of Women of Kenya (NCWK).
  2. b) She succeeded in stopping the government from encroaching on a public utility at Uhuru park to construct the 60-story Kenya Times Media Trust Complex.
  3. c) She succeeded in pressurizing the government to release political prisoners through painful hunger protests at Uhuru Park. The prisoners were released in early 1993.
  4. d) Maathai was the first African woman, and the first environmentalist, to win the Nobel Peace Prize for her contribution to sustainable development, democracy and peace.
  5. e) Maathai has been very instrumental in environmental protection through the Green Belt Movement.

THE FORMATION, STRUCTURE AND FUNCTIONS OF THE GOVERNMENT OF KENYA.

THE ELECTORAL PROCESS.

Role of the Independent Electoral and Boundaries Commission in Kenya.

  1. a) The Commission is responsible for conducting or supervising referenda and elections to any elective body or office.
  2. b) It is responsible for continuous registration of citizens as voters and regular revision of the voters’ roll.
  3. c) It Prescribes and reviews electoral boundaries in constituencies and wards at intervals of not less than eight years, and not more than twelve years. The constitution provides for 290 constituencies established under the following considerations;

~  Community of interest, historical, economic and cultural ties

~  Geographical features and urban centres

~  Means of communication

  1. d) It is responsible for regulation of the process by which parties nominate candidates for elections.
  2. e) The commission is responsible for settlement of electoral disputes, including disputes relating to or arising from nominations. However it does not handle election petitions and disputes subsequent to the declaration of election results.
  3. f) The registration of candidates for election.
  4. g) Educate/informs the public on the requirements for voters and contestants
  5. h) Facilitation of the observation, monitoring and evaluation of elections.
  6. i) It is responsible for regulation of the amount of money that may be spent by or on behalf of a candidate or party in respect of any election.
  7. j) Identifies, appoints and trains election officials.
  8. k) Verifies and announces election results
  9. l) Prepares ballot papers and other election materials.
  10. m) Identifies and recommends polling stations.

Types of elections.

There are three types of elections in Kenya;

  1. a) General elections. These are elections held after every five years. Initially they were meant to be held on the second Tuesday in August on the fifth year. But this has since been altered due to the delay in new constitution implementation process
  2. b) By elections. These are elections of new leaders to fill vacant seats left following deaths of occupants, resignation or annulment of their election through successful petition in court.
  3. c) Re –run elections– this are elections held exactly one month after the general elections involving only two presidential candidates in case of no clear winner in the general election.

Why Kenyans elect their representatives to parliament every five years.

  1. a) It is a constitutional requirement that Kenyans elect MPs after every five years.
  2. b) The elections give Kenyans a chance to practice their democratic right of choosing their representatives.
  3. c) It enables Kenyans control their elected representatives i.e. the fear of losing election ensures that elected representative serve the electorate well.
  4. d) It enables Kenyans choose between representatives and between parties that express the policies that they agree with.
  5. e) Through periodic elections, Kenyans are able to participate in activities of their government

The following methods have been used in elections in Kenya.

  1. a) Mololongo (queuing)
  2. b) Acclamation
  3. c) Secret ballot.

THE 2007 ELECTIONS IN KENYA

The electoral process that was adopted by the ECK under the stewardship of Samuel Kivuitu in the 2007 election was very unfair and yielded false results. This caused the outbreak of violence, bloodshed, destruction and loss of property.The Kreigler commission that was formed to look into the causes of the 2008 violence reported the following weaknesses.

  1. a) Irregularities in the voter register which excluded 30% of the potential voters the register contained names of deceased persons. Women who had attained the voting age were found to be under represented.
  2. b) Imbalanced distribution of registered voters among constituencies. Some constituencies like Embakasi had over 200, 000 registered voters while others like Mandera East had less than 20,000 registered voters.
  3. c) Rampant cheating where in some cases the votes cast were more than 100% of the registered voters.
  4. d) Existence of exclusive strongholds with some electoral areas being out of bounds for some political parties.
  5. e) There was a defective system of voter tallying and relaying of information. Some of those declared winners finally lost their seats through election petitions.
  6. f) Incompetence of the ECK officials with even the chairmen stating clearly that it was impossible to establish who won the elections.
  7. g) The results relayed sometimes faced integrity queries. Some officials relayed cooked results.
  8. h) The composition of the ECK raised suspicion especially among the opposition.

The principles that govern the electoral process in Kenya.

  1. a) All citizens have the freedom to exercise their political rights
  2. b) Not more than two-thirds of the members of elective public bodies shall be of the same gender.
  3. c) Persons with disabilities must receive fair representation.
  4. d) There must be universal suffrage based on the aspiration for fair representation and equality of vote.
  5. e) The elections should be free and fair and will be by secret ballot, free from violence, intimidation, improper influence or corruption.
  6. f) The elections will be conducted by an independent body, transparent; and administered in an impartial, neutral, efficient, accurate and accountable manner.

Legislation on Elections.

The following legislations govern the electoral process in Kenya.

  1. a) The constitution of Kenya-that is a sovereign state and republic with the people owning all sovereign power directly or through democratically elected leaders.
  2. b) The national assembly and presidential elections Act- it outlines the steps to be followed in the registration of voters, nomination of candidates, polling and counting of votes and other related processes.
  3. c) The local government act– it gives the procedure and rules for conducting elections for county, municipal and town councils.
  4. d) The electoral offences Act. – it lays out the election offences like bribing of voters, threatening voters, voting more than once or causing violence on polling day or during campaigns.

Voter registration.

Qualifications of a voter in an electoral process in Kenya.

  1. a) One must be an adult citizen at least 18 years old.
  2. b) He/she must be a Kenyan citizen in possession of an identity card or passport.
  3. c) He/she must be a registered voter.
  4. d) He/she must been registered at only one registration centre
  5. e) One must not be an insane person.
  6. f) He/she must have been convicted of an election offence during the Preceding five years.

 

Voter and civic education.

Voter education refers to the provision of information, materials and programmes to voters with the intention of informing them about the specifics of voting process for a particular election. For example, information on who is eligible to vote, where and how to register.Civic education is aimed at conveying knowledge to the citizens about the country’s politica l system and context. For example, information about the system of government, the nature and powers of the elective offices, to be filled in an election.

Nomination of candidates. There are two categories of Nominations

  1. a) Party nominations
  2. b) IEBC nominations

Party nominations

This refers to the selection of political party candidates to contest in an election. It is done through queuing, acclamation or secret ballot. It may involve nomination for county, parliamentary or presidential elections.

IEBC nominations

Once the political parties have nominated their candidates, they are presented to the IEBC for formal nomination to contest the presidential, parliamentary or county/civic elections.

Independent candidates

A person is eligible to stand as an independent candidate under the following conditions;

  1. a) The person should not be a member of a registered political party and should not have been a member for atleast three months immediately before the date of elections
  2. b) He/she must be a registered voter.
  3. c) He/ she must satisfy the educational, moral and ethical requirements as per the

constitution or act of parliament.

  1. d) In case of national assembly elections, he/she must attract the support of atleast 1000 registered voters in the constituency.
  2. e) In case of the senate, one must attract the support of atleast 2000 registered voters in the county.

Conditions that must be met by one wishing to be elected Member of Parliament.

  1. a) A person is eligible for election as a Member of Parliament if the person is registered as a voter.
  2. b) If the person satisfies any educational, moral and ethical requirements prescribed by the Constitution or by an Act of Parliament.
  3. c) if he is nominated by a political party, or is an independent candidate who is supported in the case of election to the National Assembly, by at least one thousand Registered voters in the constituency; or in the case of election to the Senate, by at least two thousand registered voters in the county.

Disqualifications for one from being elected a Member the National Assembly.

  1. a) If the person is a State officer or other public officer, other than a Member of Parliament.
  2. b) If a person has, at any time within the five years immediately preceding the date of election, held office as a member of the Independent Electoral and Boundaries Commission.
  3. c) If a person has not been a citizen of Kenya for at least the ten years immediately preceding the date of election.
  4. d) If a person is a member of a county assembly.
  5. e) If one is of unsound mind.
  6. f) If one is declared bankrupt.
  7. g) Is subject to a sentence of imprisonment of at least six months, as at the date of registration as a candidate, or at the date of election.
  8. h) If one is found, in accordance with any law, to have misused or abused a State office or public office.

An elected MP may lose his/her seat in parliament under the following circumstances.

  1. a) When he/she ceases to be a Kenyan citizen.
  2. b) He /she receive a jail sentence exceeding 6 months or death penalty from a court of law.
  3. c) When he/she resign, through writing to the speaker, from the national assembly.
  4. d) When he/she is declared bankrupt by a court of law.
  5. e) When he/she is found to be of unsound mind.
  6. f) When he/she resigns from the sponsoring political party or as an MP.
  7. g) When he/she fails to attend 8 consecutive sessions during the life of a particular parliament without permission from the speaker.
  8. h) When he/she defects from one party to another.
  9. i) When he/she having been elected to parliament as an independent candidate, decides to join a political party.

Campaigns.

The campaign periods starts immediately after IEBC nomination of candidates and ends 12 hours before the polling day. The main purpose of campaigns is to give the voters chance to assess aspiring candidates and their party policies and strategies and then decide the right candidate.

Polling

Voting is done in the polling station. It takes place from 6.00am to 6.00 pm on the Election Day.Counting of votes begins after the closure of the exercise. The presiding officer then announces the number of votes garnered by each candidate.

The returning officer, the election officer in the constituency then tallies the total votes from all the polling stations and announces per candidate in the constituency. He/she declares the elected mp for the constituency and councilors of each ward. He announces the number of votes per candidate for the presidential elections.

The IEBC then declares the validly elected candidates for the presidential, National Assembly and Senate.

Factors likely to interfere with free and fair elections in Kenya.

  1. a) Ethnic loyalties/polarization/Party loyalties. People may be compelled to vote along tribal lines, in total disregard of the leadership records or accomplishment of those they elect.
  2. b) Illiteracy of some voters. This curtails their ability to mark the ballot papers correctly.
  3. c) Inadequate civic education. The lack of adequate sensitization of the voters can lead to ineffective election process.
  4. d) Harassment of voters by rival groups/ Insecurity/fear instilled in candidates. All forms of chaos makes accessibility to voting stations by voters difficult.
  5. e) Corruption of candidates and their supporters. This is through bribing of voters to vote for certain candidates.
  6. f) Incompetent election officials. Some election officials are partisan and therefore unable to preside over elections competently.
  7. g) On many occasions aspiring candidates or their agents have complained of rigging.
  8. h) Transport difficulties. The electoral process in Kenya has been faced with the problem of Inaccessibility of some polling stations
  9. i) Communication problems. During the voting day, some remote areas experience

communication problems between the headquarters’ and the polling stations.

  1. j) Extreme weather conditions. Delivery of polling materials has sometimes been affected by bad weather.
  2. k) Gender insensitivity. For a long time, women have not been given a fair share in the electoral process in Kenya.
  3. l) Use and misuse of mass media. Some politicians own some media houses, sometimes they have subjected them to misuse. There has been also the problem of imbalance when it comes to media coverage of elections.

Electoral guidelines and regulations that may help minimizeirregularities.

  1. a) Whatever voting method is used, the system must be simple, accurate, verifiable, secure, accountable and transparent.
  2. b) The votes cast must be counted, tabulated and the results announced promptly by the presiding officer at each polling station.
  3. c) The results from the polling stations must be openly and accurately collated and promptly announced by the returning officer.
  4. d) Appropriate structures and mechanisms to eliminate electoral malpractices must be in place, including the safekeeping of electoral materials.

 

 

 

Electoral disputes

The following must be observed as pertains to election disputes:

  1. a) Electoral petitions, other than in a presidential election, must be filed within 28 days after the declaration of the election results by the IEBC.
  2. b) Service of a petition may be direct or by advertisement in a newspaper with national circulation.

ELECTION OFFICIALS

The following are the officers appointed by the IEBC to assist in administering elections.

  1. District election coordinators. – Officials responsible for all electoral matters at district level. They act as a link between people at the grassroots level and the IEBC headquarters.
  2. Registration officers. –they register voters in each constituency and issue them with voter’s card.
  3. Returning officers. – are in charge of elections in a constituency which has several polling stations. They perform the following functions:
  4. a) They set up polling booths in each polling station.
  5. b) They receive nomination papers from prospective candidates
  6. c) They distribute ballot papers and boxes to polling stations.
  7. d) They supervise the voting and counting of votes in the constituency.
  8. e) They appoint the presiding officers in each polling station.
  9. f) Announcing the results of the elections.
  10. Presiding officers. –in charge of polling stations. And perform the following duties;
  11. a) They conduct the polls in an orderly, free and fair manner at the polling station.
  12. b) They ensure that every eligible voter votes only once.
  13. c) They help illiterate voters mark ballot papers.
  14. d) They seal the ballot boxes and transfer them to a central point in the polling station where the votes will be counted.
  15. e) They maintain law and order at polling stations and report any irregularities to the returning officer.
  16. f) They ensure that there is impartiality in conducting.
  17. Polling clerks. On the polling day, they assist and guide voters, particularly those who are illiterate.
  18. Security personnel. –police officers maintain law and order during the polling and counting of votes.
  19. Counting clerks. –they sort out ballots and then count the ballots per candidate.
  20. Party agents. – they represent candidates or political parties in a polling station or counting hall to ensure that the polling and counting procedures are transparent , orderly , free and fair.
  21. Observers. –these are neutral persons who make observations and write reports on the polling and counting exercise to indicate if the elections were free and fair or not.

FORMATION OF GOVERNMENT

NATIONAL GOVERNMENT

Kenyans directly or indirectly exercise their sovereign or absolute power through their democratically elected representatives. This power is delegated to the state organs or arms of government namely;

  1. a) The parliament and the legislative assemblies in the county assemblies.
  2. b) The national executive and the executive structures in the county government.
  3. c) The judiciary and independent tribunals.

The process of National government formation.

After every election, the party with the majority of seats in the house forms the government by appointing cabinet secretaries from among professionals (not among elected MPs) with the approval of the National Assembly. The president then appoints the judiciary with the a dvice of the JSC. The president-elect is sworn in by the chief Justice and the members of the three arms of government also take oath.The three arms of government operate independently and work on checks and balances

The executive is responsible for running the country by developing and implementing policies that lead to national development.Even after dissolution of parliament after its expiry, the cabinet exists until a new one is appointed. This is to ensure that there is no power vacuum and that government operations continue.

Role of government in Kenya

  1. a) Government ensures that social and economic development is undertaken – by putting in place policies to improve schools, hospitals, agriculture, trade, housing and industry.
  2. b) It upholds human rights and freedoms and ensures that all citizens live in peace and harmony through the administration of justice and maintaining law and order.
  3. c) Government organizes an effective defence force to protect the country from internal and external aggression.
  4. d) It also has a duty to establish sound foreign policies to promote international cooperation with other countries by setting up foreign embassies and high commissions.
  5. e) It has a duty to foster national unity by recognizing diversity and ensuring equitable sharing of national and local resources.
  6. f) Government protects and promotes the interests and rights of the minorities and

marginalized communities.

COUNTY GOVERNMENT

The county government is composed of County assemblies, county executive committees and county public service and exist in each of the 47 counties throughout Kenya.

A county government consists of;

  1. a) Members (one member per ward) elected by the registered voters of the wards in a general election in Kenya.
  2. b) The Speaker, who is an ex officio member.
  3. c) Members appointed by the county governor, with the approval of the county assembly, from among persons who are not members of the assembly.

The structure of the executive arm of the county government.

The executive authority of the county is vested in the county executive committee. The committee consists of;

  1. a) The county Governor and the Deputy County Governor who are the chief executive and deputy chief executive of the county respectively.
  2. b) Members who are not members of the assembly and appointed by the County Governor, with the approval of the assembly. They should be not more than ten other. If the assembly has less than thirty members, the members should be One-third of the number of members of the county assembly.

NB;

~  Members of a county executive committee are accountable to the county governor for the performance of their functions and exercise of their powers.

~  The appointed members of the county executive committee cease to hold office once the office of the county governor falls vacant.

The election of a county governor.

The county governor is directly elected by the voters registered in the county at a general election for a term of 5 years. To be eligible for election as county governor, a person must be eligible for election as a member of the county assembly. If re-elected, can serve for another final term of 5 years.

Each candidate for election as county governor nominates a person as his/her running mate to be the deputy governor.

Removal of a County Governor from office.

A governor may be removed from office under the following grounds;

  1. a) Gross violation of the Constitution or any other law.
  2. b) When the county governor commits a crime under national or international law.
  3. c) When the governor abuses office or is accused of gross misconduct.
  4. d) When he/she suffers from Physical or mental incapacity that hinders performance of the functions of office.

The office of the county governor falls vacant when the holder of office;

  1. a)
  2. b) Resigns, in writing, addressed to the speaker of the county assembly.
  3. c) Is convicted of an offence punishable by imprisonment for atleast twelve months.
  4. d) Ceases to be eligible to be elected as a county governor.
  5. e) Is removed from office under the constitution.

The deputy county governor assumes office as a county governor for the remainder of the term of the county governor when a vacancy arises. Where the deputy governor is unable to act or his office is also vacant, the speaker acts as governor and elections must be held within sixty days after the speaker assumes office.

 

 

THE COUNTY ASSEMBLY

The composition of a County Assembly in Kenya is as follows;

A county assembly consists of

  Members (one member per ward) elected by the registered voters of the wards in a general election.

  Members of special seats (no more than two-thirds of the membership of the assembly is of the same gender.)

  Members of marginalized groups, including persons with disabilities and the youth.

  The Speaker, who is an ex officio member.

Nb-The members for special seats and marginalized communities are nominated by political parties in proportion to the seats received in the election in a particular county.

The functions of a county assembly

  1. a) County assemblies make laws for the effective performance of the county government.
  2. b) It acts as a watch dog over the county executive committee.
  3. c) It receives and approves plans and policies for managing and exploiting the county’s resources, and, developing and managing the infrastructure and institutions.

Conditions that must be met by a person seeking for election to a County Assembly

  1. a) The person must be a registered as a voter in his/her county.
  2. b) The person must have been a Kenyan citizen for atleast ten years before the elections.
  3. c) The person must be able to read and write in English and Kiswahili.
  4. d) He or she must be of sound mind.
  5. e) The person must be of unquestionable morals and ethics
  6. f) If a public officer, he/she must relinquish his/her public work.
  7. g) The person must be nominated by a political party
  8. h) If he/she is an independent candidate, must be supported by at least five hundred

registered voters in the Ward concerned.

  1. i) The person must not have been declared bankrupt.
  2. j) The person must not have served a sentence of imprisonment of more than six months.
  3. k) The person must not have misused or abused a State or public office.

Vacancy in the office of member of county assembly may happen if the member;

  1. a)
  2. b) Is absent from eight sittings of the assembly without permission, in writing, of the speaker of the assembly and is unable to offer satisfactory explanation for the absence.
  3. c) Resigns, in writing, addressed to the speaker of the county assembly.
  4. d) After being elected to the assembly as a member of a political party, he/she resigns from the party, or is deemed to have resigned from the party, or after being an independent candidate, the member joins a political party.
  5. e) Gets to the end of the term of the assembly
  6. f) Becomes disqualified for election after the court rules in favour of an election petition made against him/her.

Speaker of County Assembly

The speaker is elected by the county assembly from among persons who are not members of the county assembly. The speaker presides over the county assembly. Another member of the assembly may be elected to play the role of a speaker in case of the absence of the speaker.

STRUCTURE AND FUNCTIONS OF THE NATIONAL GOVERNMENT.

The three arms of government are:

  1. a) Judiciary
  2. b) Executive
  3. c) Legislature

LEGISLATURE.

The two components of the Kenyan Parliament/legislature are;

  1. The National Assembly.
  2. The Senate.

The Composition and membership of the National Assembly.

The National Assembly consists of;

  1. a) Two hundred and ninety members, each elected by the registered voters of single member constituencies.
  2. b) Forty-seven women, each elected by the registered voters of the counties, each county constituting a single member constituency.
  3. c) Twelve members nominated by parliamentary political parties according to their

proportion of members of the National Assembly to represent special interests including the youth, persons with disabilities and workers.

  1. d) The Speaker, who is an ex officio member.

Membership of the Senate

The Senate consists of;

  1. a) forty-seven members each elected by the registered voters of the counties, each county constituting a single member constituency
  2. b) Sixteen women members nominated by political parties according to their proportion ofmembers of the Senate elected.
  3. c) Two members, being one man and one woman, representing the youth.
  4. d) Two members, being one man and one woman, representing persons with disabilities.
  5. e) The Speaker, who shall be an ex officio member.

The official languages of parliament are English, Kiswahili and Kenyan sign language.

Parliament quorum is 50 members for the national assembly and 15 members for the senate.

 

Office of parliament

The following are the officers of parliament;

~  Speakers and deputy speakers.

Two Speakers, ex-officio member, one for each of the two houses.

Each is elected by members of the respective house from among persons who are qualified to be elected as members of parliament but are not MPs. A deputy speaker is elected from among members of each of the houses by the mps.

Their offices become vacant when;

~  A new house of parliament first meets after an election.

~  When he/she resigns, dies.

~  When a house resolution of two-thirds removes him/her from office.

The speakers Preside at any sitting of the house. In a joint meeting of the two houses, the speaker of the national assembly assisted by that of the senate presides over.

The speaker has no vote in parliament and in case of a tie, The question is lost.

The six speakers in Kenya since independence include;

  1. 2008-upto date- Kenneth Marende.
  2. 1993-2007- Francis Ole Kaparo
  3. 1991- 1992-Professor Jonathan Ngeno
  4. 1988- 1990-Moses Arap Keino
  5. 1970 – 1987-Fredrick Mbiti Mati.
  6. 1964-1969-Humphrey Slade became the first speaker of the single house.
  7. 1963- Muinga Chokwe (speaker of the upper house)
  8. 1963- Humphrey slade (speaker of the lower house).

Role of the speaker.

  1. a) He/she presides over the proceedings of the house and ensures that they are conducted in accordance with the rules of procedure. He enforces standing orders in the house.
  2. b) The speaker disciplines members of the house who violate standing orders by ordering such them to leave the house or be barred from attending three house consecutive sittings.
  3. c) Maintains order during debates and enforces rules which govern conduct of the house. The speaker interprets the rules of the house.
  4. d) He/she gives the MPs chance to contribute towards house debates to ensure that the minority are given a fair hearing before the will of the majority prevails.
  5. e) He/she represents and protects the authority of the house.
  6. f) He/she organizes and determines the business to be conducted in the house by receiving Bills, motions and questions for discussion in the house, and then prepares an order paper.
  7. g) He/she adjourns sittings if the house lacks a quorum.
  8. h) He/she keeps and maintains the attendance register and grants permission to MPs to be absent from sessions. MPs going out of the country must inform the speaker of their absence from Kenya.
  9. i) He/she heads the National Assembly department and takes charge of its general

administration and welfare. He/she is responsible for preserving dignity and order and for the comfort and convenience of the members and staff within parliament buildings.

  1. j) He/she chairs the speaker’s committee, the committee of powers and Privileges and the Order Committee.
  2. k) The speaker issues orders and makes rules for the regulation of visitors to parliament and represent parliament in its relations with foreign countries.
  3. l) The speaker chairs the branches of the commonwealth Parliamentary Association, InterParliamentary Union and the Union of African Parliaments. He/she represents Parliament at the commonwealth speaker’s conference.
  4. m) He/she declares parliamentary seats vacant and issues writs for general elections and byelections.
  5. n) He/she receives and accepts letters of resignation from members of parliament.
  6. o) He/she swears in members of parliament before participating in the House deliberations.
  7. p) He, summons parliament to a new when parliamentarians are on recess.

~  Party leaders

As part of parliament officers, there is the leader of the majority party and leader of minority party.

The majority party leader is the person who is the leader in the national assembly of the largest party or coalition of parties.

The minority party leader is the person who is the leader in the national assembly of the second largest party or coalition of parties.

Role of party leaders.

  1. a) They promote and uphold national unity through party activities.
  2. b) They enforce adherence to principles of good governance, democracy and upholding human rights and fundamental freedoms and gender equality and equity.
  3. c) The leaders work to advance the goals of the party and ensure their programme is carried out to the satisfaction of the party.
  4. d) The leader of the majority party has to ensure and maintain support for legislation.
  5. e) The leader of the minority party has to protect the rights of the minority.
  6. f) The leader of the majority party has to ensure accountability and transparency in the party.

And the government.

Functions of parliament in Kenya.

  1. a) The elected members of parliament Represents the will of the people, and exercises their sovereignty.
  2. b) Parliament considers and passes amendments to the Constitution
  3. c) It has powers to alter county boundaries as provided for in the Constitution.
  4. d) Parliament has the duty to protect the Constitution and promote the democratic

governance of the Republic.

  1. e) Parliament is the sole body that has the power to make provision having the force of law in Kenya

Functions of the National Assembly in Kenya.

  1. a) The national assembly represents the will of the people and expresses their sovereignty since it represents people from the 290 constituencies and special interest groups.
  2. b) The National Assembly deliberates on and resolves issues of concern to the people in the Constituencies and special interest groups.
  3. c) The National Assembly enacts legislation that affect the nation-not the county government.

For example the money bill may be introduced only in the national assembly.

  1. d) The National Assembly determines the allocation of national revenue between the levels of government/it controls revenue and expenditure in the republic.
  2. e) It appropriates funds for expenditure by the national government and other national State organs/ it exercises oversight over national revenue and its expenditure.
  3. f) The National Assembly reviews the conduct in office of the President, the Deputy President and other State officers/It may initiate the process of removing them from office.
  4. g) The National Assembly approves declarations of war and extensions of states of emergency.

Functions of the Senate in Kenya.

  1. a) The Senate represents the counties, and serves to protect the interests of the counties and their governments.
  2. b) The Senate participates in the law-making function of Parliament by considering, debating and approving Bills concerning counties.
  3. c) The Senate determines the allocation of national revenue among counties/It exercisesoversight over national revenue allocated to the county governments.
  4. d) The Senate participates in the oversight of State officers by considering and determining any resolution to remove the President or Deputy President from office.

The process of law making in Kenya.

What is law making?

This is the process of enacting new laws or amending the existing ones.

The two conditions for the start of a law making process are

  1. a) The presence of a speaker or his deputy.
  2. b) A quorum of fifty members of the national assembly.
  3. c) A quorum of 15 members of the senate.

What is a bill?

A bill is a proposed piece of legislation (law).

Bills originate in the National Assembly.

A Bill not concerning county government is considered only in the National Assembly, and passed in accordance with the Standing Orders of the Assembly.

A Bill concerning county government may originate in the National Assembly or the Senate, and is passed in accordance with the Standing Orders of the Houses.

Bills are classified into two;

  1. a) Public Bill– these deal with matters of public policy that affect all citizens of Kenya. They

are also categorized into two;

  1. Government Bill-introduced by cabinet secretaries.
  2. Private member’s Bill.-introduced by back-benchers in the national assembly
  3. a) Private Bill.-this is a bill that affects a particular person, associations or people living in a small part of the country.

Money Bill

This a bill that has provisions dealing with taxes, payment of charges by public, appropriation , receipt ,custody or issue of public money, raising or guaranteeing of any loan, its repayment or other matters relating to such monies.

The process

~  The government departments and public offices to be affected by a bill consult first before it is drafted. A bill is then drafted by the government draftsman (the parliamentary counsel)in the attorney general’s chambers.

~  When the cabinet is satisfied with the draft, it is published in the Kenya gazette at least fourteen days before it is introduced to parliament. The main purpose of this is to give the public chance to view and criticize the Bill. The draft proposal is also presented to parliament to give members chance to research on it on preparation for a debate in thefuture.

~  A Bill is first introduced by any member or committee of the relevant House of Parliament, but a money Bill may be introduced only in the National Assembly.

~  Before either House considers a Bill, the Speakers of the National Assembly and Senate jointly resolve any question as to whether it is a Bill concerning counties and, if it is, whether it is a special or an ordinary Bill.

~  When any Bill concerning county government has been passed by one House of Parliament, the Speaker of that House refers it to the Speaker of the other House.

~  If both Houses pass the Bill in the same form, the Speaker of the House in which the Bill originated shall, within seven days, refer the Bill to the President for assent.

~  The National Assembly may amend or veto a special Bill that has been passed by the Senate only by a resolution supported by at least two-thirds of the members of the Assembly.

~  Within fourteen days after receipt of a Bill, the President assents to the Bill; or refer the Bill back to Parliament for reconsideration by Parliament, noting any reservations that the President has concerning the Bill.

When a bill is referred back to parliament, the following procedure is followed;

  1. a) Parliament may amend the bill in light of the president’s reservations or pass the bill a second time without amendments.
  2. b) If parliament amends the Bill after consideration of the president’s reservations, the speaker must resubmit the bill to the president for assent.
  3. c) Parliament could pass the bill without amendments or with amendments that do not fully accommodate the president’s reservations if supported by;

~  Two-thirds of the members of the national assembly, and

~  Two-thirds of the delegations in the senate, if the bill requires approval of the

senate.

~  The bill then has to be submitted by the appropriate speaker to the president for assent within seven days.

~  If the president fails to assent the bill within seven days, the bill will be considered acted upon and therefore considered null and void.

The process of the bill coming into force as a law.

After presidential assent, a Bill becomes a law or an act of parliament. It is then published in the official gazette, the Kenya gazette, within seven days after assent.Sections of it may also be published in the local dailies so as to publicize the law t o all residents in the country.The Act of parliament then comes into force as a law on the fourteenth day after its publication in the Kenya Gazette unless the Act specifies a different date or time when it will come into force. The law then binds everybody in the country.

Special Bills concerning county governments.

Such Bills, when passed by senate, can only be amended or vetoed by National Assembly by a resolution of 2/3 of the members. When the veto or amend fails to pass, the speaker of the National Assembly must within seven days refer the Bill in the form adopted by the senate to the president for assent.

Ordinary Bills concerning counties.

If one house passes an ordinary bill concerning counties and the second house rejects it , the Bill must be referred to the mediation committee.A mediation committee refers to a committee comprising equal number of members from both houses appointed by the speaker with the task of formulating a version of the Bill that both Houses could pass.

Both houses will then vote to pass or reject the formulated version. The Bill is considered rejected if the committee fails to reach an agreed version within 30 days.If the second House passes it in an amended form, the bill must be taken back to the orig inating house for consideration. If the originating house passes it as amended; it is referred to the president for assent within seven days. If it rejects it, it is referred to the mediation committee.

Parliamentary supremacy

Meaning of parliamentary supremacy

This refers to the sovereign power exercised by parliament which makes law for the country.Parliament is supreme because, through elections, it has the people’s mandate to legislate and govern on their behalf and is the only means through which people control government.

How parliamentary supremacy is upheld in Kenya.

  1. a) It is the only Body that makes and repeals laws. Technically, a constitutional court can overrule an act of parliament, but parliament can change the law to prevent that from happening.
  2. b) Parliament can remove the president from office by impeachment. A member of the national assembly, with the support of at least a third of all the members, may move an impeachment motion.
  3. c) Parliament through an amendment of the constitution, can limit the powers of the executive. It can also pass a vote of no confidence in the government, compelling the president and his/her cabinet secretaries to resign.
  4. d) Cabinet secretaries are accountable to the parliament for their activities in the ministries under their control. They have to answer questions in parliament about their ministries.
  5. e) Bills prepared by the cabinet have to be legislated by parliament, which is a law making body.
  6. f) Parliament has to approve government expenditure. The Cabinet secretary in charge of Finance annually presents the budget to parliament for approval by MPs. – the public accounts committee scrutinizes government expenditure. The Auditor and controllerGeneral check the expenditure of all ministries and reports to parliament.

NB; – The upholding of parliamentary supremacy however depends largely on the integrity and maturity of members of the national assembly.

Ways in which parliamentary supremacy in Kenya is limited.

  1. a) Parliament cannot make laws that contradict traditional customs and practices of the people, unless people want change.
  2. b) Parliament cannot pass a law that contradicts the constitution. /the supremacy of the constitution is upheld.
  3. c) Increased power of the cabinet can reduce parliament’s authority. If the cabinet is too powerful, it may influence parliamentary decisions.
  4. d) The president can limit the supremacy by making independent decisions. For example, the president has emergency powers which sidestep parliamentary supremacy. State of Emergency does not follow parliamentary directions.
  5. e) Parliament supremacy can be limited by the application of international laws. Parliament may be forced to ratify a law out of necessity; failure to ratify an international law may invite punitive actions on the country.
  6. f) Delegated legislation may also limit its powers, i.e. the operation of the county government by-laws may limit parliamentary supremacy although national legislation prevails over county legislation.
  7. g) Referendum may be used to decide important issues as opposed to parliamentary

decisions.

Merits of parliamentary supremacy/parliamentary system.

  1. a) It increases harmony, since the legislature and the executive work together. This is realized when MPs, who represent the electorate, bring their views to the executive (cabinet secretaries) in the legislature.
  2. b) This system allows ordinary citizens to participate in the governing process by electing their representatives to articulate their views on issues of national interest.
  3. c) It ensures a responsible and responsive government since the cabinet is controlled by parliament in its actions. Cabinet cannot ignore public opinion, since people choose the MPs. Such could risk a vote of no confidence.
  4. d) It instills a sense of responsibility in the executive since cabinet secretaries have to sit and answer questions in the house.
  5. e) The system legitimizes actions taken by the government, particularly when such actions originate from recommendations passed by the MPs- the people’s representatives.
  6. f) A parliamentary system gives citizens a chance to participate in national political leadership through presenting themselves for election as members of parliament or county assemblies.
  7. g) It provides for regular elections, giving the electorate the chance to reject non performing MPs and elect others who can perform.
  8. h) Parliament is a training ground for effective leaders; the system enables Kenyans of ability and experience to prove their worth in parliamentary debates.

Demerits of parliamentary supremacy.

  1. a) It only works well where there are two parties; with one ruling while the other in opposition. In a case where there are more than two parties. A coalition government may be formed and this form of government is sometimes weak and unstable. Also where the legislature is dominated by one party, the cabinet tends to be dictatorial.
  2. b) Such government may not be effective in times of emergencies. The head of government has to consult with the cabinet and the legislature before acting.
  3. c) It weakens the executive. It compels the cabinet secretaries to spend most of their time in parliament instead of dealing with matters of their ministries.

“Terminative Role of Parliament” in Kenya.

This means that parliament has the power to impeach a president or pass a vote of no confidence in the government by a two-thirds vote majority of the national assembly, forcing the government to resign.

 

 

Functions of the Parliamentary Service Commission

  1. a) The Commission is responsible for providing services and facilities to ensure the efficient and effective functioning of Parliament
  2. b) It is responsible for constituting offices in the house.
  3. c) It prepares annual estimates of expenditure of the parliamentary service and submitting them to the National Assembly for approval, and exercising budgetary control over the service.
  4. d) It is responsible for undertaking, singly or jointly with other releva nt organizations, programmes to promote the ideals of parliamentary democracy.
  5. e) It performs other functions necessary for the well-being of the members and staff of Parliament; or prescribed by national legislation.

THE EXECUTIVE

Meaning of the executive.

This is the arm of government which deals with the implementation of laws made by parliament. It is charged with the administration of affairs of a country as well as affairs which affect the country from outside.

The National executive comprises;

  1. a) The president.
  2. b) The deputy president.
  3. c) The cabinet.
  4. d) The attorney general.
  5. e) The director of public prosecutions
  6. f) The public service.

The president.

He is the Chief Executive Officer of the republic of Kenya. He is the head of state and government in Kenya. He is the commander-in-chief of the Kenya Defence Forces. He is a symbol of national unity.He holds office for a five year term from the date of being sworn in to office and the term expires when the next candidate elected as president is sworn in. the constitution gives a twofive year term as the maximum period for the president’s position.

Qualifications for election as President in Kenya.

  1. a) A person qualifies for nomination as a presidential candidate if the person is a citizen by birth
  2. b) The person must be qualified to stand for election as a Member of Parliament.
  3. c) He or she must be nominated by a political party, or is an independent candidate and is nominated by not fewer than 2000 voters from each of a majority of counties.

NB;- A presidential candidate, whether affiliated to a political party or independent, must garner 50% plus one of all the votes cast in the election.A candidate must also attract 25% of the votes cast in more than half of the counties in kenya in order to qualify to be a president.

Disqualifications one from vying for election as a president in Kenya

  1. a) If the person owes allegiance to a foreign state.
  2. b) If he is a public officer, or is acting in any State or other public office.

Assumption of office of the president.

The president-elect assumes office by taking two oaths namely;

~  The oath of affirmation of allegiance

~  The oath of affirmation for execution of the functions of office.

If the president-elect dies before assumption of office, the deputy president-elect is sworn in as acting president. A new fresh election to the office of president must be held within sixty days after death of the president-elect.The president must be sworn in public before the Chief Justice.

Importance of a presidential election.

  1. a) The citizens get a chance to exercise their democratic right. It is the essence of democracy in a government. The people have a choice to elect a president directly, freely, and fairly.
  2. b) It is a means through which the people of Kenya give the president the mandate to rule the country and act on their behalf.
  3. c) It helps to check dictatorship. The president becomes responsible and accountable to the electorate. He cannot go against public opinion.
  4. d) The president enjoys legitimacy of power because it is derived from the people

Powers and functions of the president of Kenya as derived from the constitution of Kenya.

  1. a) As the Head of State, he performs the following functions;

~  He represents the government and the people of Kenya both locally and internationally.

~  He receives foreign diplomatic and consular reprentatives.

  1. b) He is the head of Government.

~  He nominates a deputy president to deputize him.

~  He nominates and, with the approval of the national assembly, appoints or dismisses cabinet secretaries, the attorney general, the Director of Public Prosecutions, the secretary to the cabinet, Principal secretaries, High Commissioners, Ambassadors, and diplomatic and consular representatives, the chief justice and the deputy and all the judges in line with the recommendations of the Judicial Service Commission

  1. c) He is the Commander-in-Chief of the Kenya Defence Forces

~  He has powers to declare a state of emergency, declare war with the approval of

parliament.

~  He is the chairperson of the National Security Council of Kenya.

  1. d) The President has the duty to safeguard the Constitution, ensure the protection of human rights and fundamental freedoms and the rule of law, safeguard the sovereignty of the republic, promote and enhance unity of the nation and promote respect for diversity.
  2. e) The President has legislative powers to address the opening of each newly elected Parliament. He also addresses a special sitting of parliament once every year and any other time.
  3. f) The President chairs Cabinet meetings and assigns responsibility for the implementation and administration of any Act of Parliament to a Cabinet Secretary.
  4. g) He presides over national holidays during which he expounds on government policy.
  5. h) He confers honours in the name of people and republic on men and women of Kenya for outstanding achievements. E.g. OGH, OBS, DSM, HSC and EBS.
  6. i) He may, on petition of any person, exercise mercy powers in accordance with the advice of the advisory committee. E.g.;

~  Grant a free or conditional pardon to a person convicted of an offence.

~  Postpone execution of any punishment for an offender , for a specified period, or

indefinitely

~  Substitute a less severe form of punishment.

~  Remit all or part of a punishment.

  1. j) The President ensures that the international obligations of the Republic are fulfilled through the actions of the relevant Cabinet Secretaries.

NB-the constitution provides the president with immunity from criminal proceedings during the tenure of office in respect of anything done or not done in exercise of the powers granted by the constitution. But this immunity does not extend to a crime for which the president may be prosecuted under any treaty to which Kenya is part to, and which prohibits such immunity.

The process of Removal of President by impeachment.

A member of the National Assembly moves a motion for the impeachment of the President on the following grounds;

  1. a) A gross violation of a provision of the Constitution.
  2. b) President commits a crime under national or international law.
  3. c) For gross misconduct.

If a motion is supported by at least two-thirds of all the members of the National Assembly, the Speaker informs the Speaker of the Senate of that resolution within two days.The President continues to perform the functions of the office pending the outcome of the proceedings.Within seven days, the Speaker of the Senate convenes a meeting of the Senate to hear charges against the President.A special committee appointed by the senate investigates the matter; and report to the Senate within ten days.If the special committee reports that the particulars of any allegation against the President have not been substantiated, further proceedings shall not be taken. If any of allegations against the President have been substantiated, the Senate, after according the President an opportunity to be heard, votes on the impeachment charges.If at least two-thirds of all the members of the Senate vote to uphold any impeachment charge, the President shall cease to hold office.

Reasons that may lead to a presidential by-election in Kenya.

  1. a) The president’s election may be nullified by court due to election offences.
  2. b) The serving president may die while in power.
  3. c) The president may resign.
  4. d) If the president becomes physically /mentally incapacitated.
  5. e) Parliament may pass a vote of no confidence in the president /government.
  6. f) If the serving president deserts/defects from the party that sponsored him to parliament.
  7. g) If the serving president ceases to be a Kenyan citizen.

THE DEPUTY PRESIDENT

The deputy president is nominated by the presidential candidate during a general election.

The process of Electing and swearing in of a Deputy President in Kenya.

  1. a) A candidate, (qualified for nomination for election as President) is nominated by each candidate in a presidential election.
  2. b) The Independent Electoral and Boundaries Commission then declare the candidate nominated by the person who is elected as the President as the Deputy President.
  3. c) The swearing in of the Deputy President-elect is before the Chief Justice or, in the absence of the Chief Justice, the Deputy Chief Justice and in public.
  4. d) The Deputy President-elect assumes office by taking and subscribing;
  5. a) The oath or affirmation of allegiance.
  6. b) The oath or affirmation for the execution of the functions of office.

Under the following circumstances, one can cease to hold the office of the Deputy President

  1. a) At the end of term of office when the person next elected President at an election is sworn in.
  2. b) When the Deputy President assumes the office of President.
  3. c) On resignation, death or removal from office of the Deputy President

Functions of the Deputy President in Kenya.

  1. a) The Deputy President is the principal assistant of the President and shall deputize for the President in the execution of the President’s functions.
  2. b) The Deputy President performs the functions conferred by the Constitution and any other functions of the President as the President may assign.
  3. c) When the President is absent or is temporarily incapacitated, and during any other period that the President decides, the Deputy President shall act as the President.

NB-The Deputy President is not permitted to hold any other State or public office.

The cabinet.

The composition of The Cabinet in Kenya.

The Cabinet consists of

  1. a) the President;
  2. b) the Deputy President;
  3. c) the Attorney-General; and
  4. d) Not fewer than fourteen and not more than twenty-two Cabinet Secretaries.

The President nominates and, with the approval of the National Assembly, appoints Cabinet Secretaries.

A Cabinet Secretary should not be a Member of Parliament.

Secretary to the cabinet.This office is an office in the public service.The office holder is nominated and appointed by the president, with the approval of the national assembly. He/she has the following responsibilities;

  1. a) Taking charge of the cabinet office.
  2. b) Arranging the business of the cabinet subject to its directions.
  3. c) Keeping minutes of the cabinet.
  4. d) Conveying decisions of the cabinet to the appropriate persons or authorities.
  5. e) Serving other functions as directed by the cabinet.

Principal Secretaries.

Each state department is under the administration of a principal secretary. He/she is nominated and appointed by the president from among persons recommended by the public service commission and approved by the national assembly.

This office is an office in the public service.

General Functions of the cabinet.

  1. a) The cabinet Advises and assists the president in governing the country.
  2. b) The cabinet Discusses matters of national and international concern with the president.
  3. c) The cabinet Formulates government policies and programmes. During parliamentary debates, the secretaries defend the same policies, interpret them to the people and ensure their implementation.
  4. d) The cabinet initiates new bills and table government bills in the National assembly.
  5. e) Cabinet secretaries on their individual capacity give direction to operations within their ministries.
  6. f) The secretary for finance formulates and prepares the national budget which he/she then presents to the National Assembly.

The principle of collective responsibility of the cabinet.

  1. a) The cabinet does not work in the light of day. Cabinet must abide by oath of secrecy.
  2. b) It requires that the cabinet must act together as a team. The cabinet must speak together with one voice on all matters of government policy.
  3. c) All cabinet members are collectively responsible to parliament and to the people through parliament. One act of a cabinet secretary is taken to be an act of all the members of the cabinet.
  4. d) A minister would resign if in his conscience he cannot abide by the principle of collective responsibility.

 

The functions of the Attorney-General in Kenya.

  1. a) The Attorney-General is the principal legal adviser to the Government.
  2. b) He represents the national government in court or in any other legal proceedings to which the national government is a party, other than criminal proceedings.
  3. c) He performs any other functions conferred on the office by an Act of Parliament or by the President.
  4. d) The Attorney-General has authority, to appear as a friend of the court in any civilproceedings to which the Government is not a party.
  5. e) The Attorney-General has duty to promote, protect and uphold the rule of law and defend the public interest.

The Director of public prosecutions.

The DPP is nominated and with the approval of the National Assembly is appointed by the president to hold office for a term of eight years and can’t be re-appointed. He/she does not require the consent of any person or authority for the commencement of criminal proceedings. His/her powers may be exercised in person or by subordinate officers acting under general or special instructions.A person qualified to be appointed a DPP should have the qualifications to be appointed a judge of the High Court.

The functions of the Director of Public Prosecutions.

  1. a) The Director of Public Prosecutions has power to direct the Inspector-General of the National Police Service to investigate any information or allegation of criminal conduct.
  2. b) The Director of Public Prosecutions exercises State powers of prosecution and may institute and undertake criminal proceedings against any person before any court (other than a court martial) in respect of any offence alleged to have been committed.
  3. c) He has powers to take over and continue any criminal proceedings commenced in any court (other than a court martial) that have been instituted or undertaken by another person orauthority, with the permission of the person or authority.
  4. d) He has powers to discontinue at any stage, before judgment is delivered, any criminal proceedings instituted by the Director of Public Prosecutions or taken over by the Director of Public Prosecutions.

THE PUBLIC SERVICE

The public service includes all state organs in both levels of government and all state corporations.

Values and principles of public service

  1. a) High standards of professional ethics.
  2. b) Efficient, effective and economic use of resources.
  3. c) Responsive, prompt, effective, impartial and equitable provision of services.
  4. d) Involvement of the people in the process of policy making.
  5. e) Accountability of administrative acts.
  6. f) Transparency and provision to the public, of timely, accurate information.
  7. g) Fair competition and merit as the basis of appointments and promotions
  8. h) Representation of Kenya’s diverse communities.
  9. i) Providing adequate and equal opportunities for appointment, training and advancement at all levels of the public service, for women and men, members of all ethnic groups and persons with disability.

The Public Service Commission.

This is the body charged with the responsibility of recruiting, promoting and managing the affairs of the public servants in Kenya in order to make it a motivated and an efficient workforce.The commission consists of a chairperson, a vice chair person and seven other members appointed by the president with the approval of the National Assembly.

The commission has a secretary who is the CEO and is appointed by the commission for a term of five years and is eligible for re-appointment.

The following persons do not qualify for appointment to the commission;

A person who in the proceeding five years, held office, or stood for elections as;

  1. A member of parliament or the county assembly.
  2. A member of the governing body of a political party.

iii.  If the person holds any state office.

  1. A holder of an office in a political organization that sponsors or supports a

candidate for election as Member of Parliament or county assembly.

Functions and powers of the Public Service Commission.

  1. a) The Commission is responsible for establishment and abolishment of offices in the public service.
  2. b) It appoints persons to hold or act in Offices in the public service and confirm appointments.
  3. c) It exercises disciplinary control over and removes persons holding or acting in public offices.
  4. d) It promotes the values and principles throughout the public service.
  5. e) It investigates monitors and evaluates the organization, administration and personnelpractices of the public service.
  6. f) It has the duty to ensure that the public service is efficient and effective.
  7. g) It develops human resources in the public service.
  8. h) It reviews and makes recommendations to the national government in respect of conditions of service, code of conduct and qualifications of officers in the public service.
  9. i) It evaluates and reports to the President and Parliament on the extent to which the values and principles that govern public service are complied with in the public service.
  10. j) It hears and determines appeals in respect of county governments’ public service.

Offices in the public service that are exempted from the regulation and control of the public service commission;

  1. a) State offices.
  2. b) An office of high commissioner, ambassador or other diplomatic or consular

representative of the republic.

  1. c) An office or position subject to:

~  The Parliamentary Service Commission.

~  The Judicial Service Commission.

~  The Teachers Service Commission

~  The National Police Service Commission.

  1. d) An office in the service of a county government, with the exception of powers to create and establish offices.

The commission can not appoint a person to hold office or act in any office on the personal staff of the president or retired president, except with the consent of the president or retired president.

Ways in which a public officer is protected by law while in service.

  1. a) A public officer shall not be victimized or discriminated against for having performed the functions of office in accordance with the Constitution.
  2. b) He/she shall not be dismissed, removed from office, demoted in rank or otherwise subjected to disciplinary action without due process of law.

Organs of national security.

National security is the protection against internal and external threats to Kenya’s territorial integrity and sovereignty, its people, their rights, freedoms, property, peace, stability and prosperity.

Principles that promote and guarantee national security in Kenya.

  1. a) National security is subject to the authority of the constitution and parliament.
  2. b) Operations of national security must be consistent with the law and must respect the rule of law, democracy, human rights and fundamental freedoms.
  3. c) In performing their functions and exercising their powers, national security organs must respect cultural diversity of the communities within Kenya.
  4. d) Recruitment by the national security organs must reflect the diversity of the Kenyan people in equitable proportions.

National security organs in Kenya.

The national security organs are;

  1. a) The Kenya Defence Forces.
  2. b) The National Intelligence Service.
  3. c) The National Police Service.

National Security Council

This is a body whose main responsibility is to exercise supervisory control over national security organs

Composition of the National Security Council

The Council consists of

  1. The President.
  2. The Deputy President.
  3. The Cabinet Secretary responsible for Defence.
  4. The Cabinet Secretary responsible for foreign affairs.
  5. The Cabinet Secretary responsible for internal security.
  6. The Attorney-General.
  7. The Chief of Kenya Defence Forces.
  8. The Director-General of the National Intelligence Service.
  9. The Inspector-General of the National Police Service.

Functions of the National Security Council in Kenya.

  1. a) It exercises supervisory control over national security organs.
  2. b) It has duty to integrate the domestic, foreign and military policies relating to national security in order to enable the national security organs to co-operate and functioneffectively.
  3. c) It makes assessment and appraisal, the objectives, commitments and risks to the

Republic in respect of actual and potential national security capabilities.

  1. d) The Council reports annually to Parliament on the state of the security of Kenya
  2. e) With the approval of Parliament, The Council is responsible for deploying national forces outside Kenya for regional or international peace support operations; or other support operations.
  3. f) It approves the deployment of foreign forces in Kenya.

The Kenya Defence Forces.

The Kenya defence Forces comprises;

  1. a) The Kenya Army, established in 1963 and which protects the country against external land-based aggression.
  2. b) The Kenya Air force, established in 1963, disbanded in 1982 and renamed 82 Air force. It helps in the control of locust invasion.
  3. c) The Kenya Navy, based in Mombasa and created in 1964, patrols Kenya’s territorial waters and is always on the alert for sea-borne invasions, and for illegal landings and departure, and unauthorized fishing by foreign vessels in Kenyan waters.

Functions of the Kenya Defence forces.

  1. a) The Defence Forces are responsible for the Defence and protection of the sovereignty and territorial integrity of the Republic.
  2. b) They assist and cooperate with other authorities in situations of emergency or disaster.
  3. c) They may be deployed to restore peace in any part of Kenya affected by unrest or instability only with the approval of the National Assembly.
  4. d) The forces also assist in the preservation of internal security. For example the handling of the attempted coup by the Kenya Army in 1982.
  5. e) They participate in nation building activities such as road and bridge construction.
  6. f) The military also assists the public during emergencies and calamities such as floods, famine, fire outbreaks, landslides and other disasters. For example during the E l Nino rains-construction of mobile bridge on Mombasa-Nairobi highway.
  7. g) The Navy specializes in detecting and fighting off criminals who use water masses like the Indian Ocean to commit crimes within the Kenyan territory. E.g. Somali Pirates.
  8. h) The Kenya Army takes part in peacekeeping Missions, such as the United Nations peace keeping operations in different parts of the world and also the African Union and Commonwealth.

The Kenya Defence Council.

Its composition is as follows;

  1. a) The cabinet secretary responsible for defence is the chairperson.
  2. b) The Chief of the Kenya Defence Forces.
  3. c) The Three Commanders of the defence forces.
  4. d) The Principal Secretary in the ministry responsible for defence.

Functions.

It is responsible for the overall policy, control and supervision of the Kenya Defence Forces.

Challenges facing the Kenya Defence Forces.

  1. a) There has being cases of indiscipline, such as the abortive coup attempt in 1982.
  2. b) There have been rampant cases of corruption facing some members of the Kenya Defence Forces, especially on matters of recruitment of new members into the defence forces, purchase of military and police equipment and deployment of officers on specialized duties.
  3. c) Tribalism, regionalism and nepotism have also been experienced in the Kenya Defence Forces, thereby demoralizing hardworking officers who are left out unfairly during promotions.
  4. d) Sometimes the Kenya Defence Forces faces the problem of lack of adequate funds to equip the forces with good equipment to facilitate their work.
  5. e) The majority of the military personnel are not provided with opportunities to acquire further education.
  6. f) Piracy and militia attacks and raids at the Kenyan Borders also present a major security challenge to the Defence Forces.
  7. g) Invasion of Kenya’s territorial waters by foreign fishermen and foreign fishing vessels from the big nations challenges the ability of the Kenya Navy to curb illegal fishing.
  8. h) The location of Moi Airbase at Eastleigh presents a big challenge to the air force. The Airbase was built by Britain in 1964 when the population in the area was scarce. Today the area has human congestion
  9. i) The defence forces also face challenges related to allegations on violations of human rights.

After the 2008 elections violence, the Kenya Army was deployed to restore peace in Mt. Elgon, where they were accused of violating human rights by killing people, destroying property, and sexually assaulting women.

 

The National Intelligence Service.

Initially called the Special Branch, This is an independent civilian government agency dedicated to protecting the national security interests of Kenya and safeguarding its citizens from threats such as terrorism and corruption.

Function of the National Intelligence Service

  1. a) It is responsible for security intelligence and counter intelligence to enhance national security.
  2. b) It liaises with the National police CID to investigate some of the threats that have criminal implications e.g. terrorism. And lay the appropriate charges.
  3. c) Information gathered by the NIS assists the government in decision –making and planning.
  4. d) The NIS in its operations protects human rights issues and the individual freedoms.

Challenges facing the National Intelligence Service.

  1. a) Lack of trust from Kenyan citizens. The citizens are reluctant to provide information to NIS as they view it not to be any different from the former Special Branch which was known to be a tool of oppression and torture.
  2. b) The body lacks financial credibility and political independence. The extent to which NIS is Neutral in its handling of sensitive affairs is questionable.
  3. c) Lack of a clear distinction between accountability and necessary secrecy has sometimes brewed tension. It is difficult to audit the activities of the Body just like any other government organization, due to the nature of its tasks.
  4. d) The growing volumes and complexity of communications presents a significant security challenge for national intelligence and government agencies that seek to intercept, process monitor and analyze it.
  5. e) External and internal threats for example Al-shabaab militia from Somalia, Merille Warriors from Ethiopia and Al-Qaeda attacks. Internally, the refugees hosted in Kenya and the illegal migrants from Somali and Sudan are also a threat. The problem of drug trafficking is also a threat.
  6. f) Continuous capacity building training is a necessity, given the complexity of the task. However this remains a challenge.
  7. g) Limited financial and human resources since inadequate funds are allocated to the service. This limits its operations. Sometimes even the staff employed is incompetent.
  8. h) Political interference- with the aim of using the service to gain political mileage.
  9. i) Ignorance of the Kenyan people on the kind of tasks the service undertakes and the advice it gives to the government. For example, anytime the country has been faced with tension or violence as was the case in 2008, the public seem not to understand the role of NIS.
  10. j) The organ does not have implementation powers and is limited in terms of the ability to follow up an implementation of the advice given to the government.

 

The National Police Service.

The East African Protectorate Police was first created in the 1890s. In 1920, it was renamed the Kenya Police. In 1953, control of the entire police force was placed under the Commissioner of Police. The National Police service was established in 2010 with a mandate to function throughout Kenya. It is headed by the Inspector-General who appointed by the president with the approval of the parliament.He / She exercises independent command over the national police service

The National polices Service Consists of;

  1. a) The Kenya Police Service, headed by a deputy inspector general also appointed by the president in accordance with the police service commission recommendations.
  2. b) The Administration Police Service, headed by a deputy inspector general also appointed by the president in accordance with the police service commission recommendations.

Functions of the National Police Service

  1. a) The National Police Service is responsible for the operations of the Kenya police service and the Administration police service in Kenya.
  2. b) It has the duty of ensuring the highest standards of professionalism and discipline among its members.
  3. c) It has the duty to prevent corruption and promote and practice transparency and

accountability.

  1. d) It has the duty to ensure that organs operating under it comply with constitutional standards of human rights and fundamental freedoms.
  2. e) It ensures that the staff is trained to the highest possible standards of competence and integrity and to respect human rights and fundamental freedoms and dignity.
  3. f) It fosters and promotes relationships with the broader society.

Functions of the police service (Kenya police service and administration police service).

  1. a) The police maintain law and order to ensure that those who break the law are arrested.
  2. b) The police protect the law in order to safeguard both life and property.
  3. c) It investigates crime and prosecutes offenders in the court.
  4. d) The police confines suspected criminals in remand as they await the hearing and judgment of their cases in the court.
  5. e) The police regulate traffic and arrests traffic offenders. They also check for defective or unroadworthy vehicles on the road in order to safeguard life.
  6. f) Provides assistance and relief services to victims of natural calamities such as floods, fire outbreaks and other emergencies.
  7. g) Takes part in national projects such as road construction, bridges, hospitals and other national facilities.
  8. h) The police take a leading role during public holidays. They control the crowd and entertain people.
  9. i) They liaise closely with international police (Interpol), in order to investigate and arrest international criminals such as terrorists and notor ious Somali pirates.

Challenges facing the National Police Service

  1. a) The police lack adequate transport and communication equipment necessary to discharge their duties. Lack of facilities such as radios, motor vehicles etc.
  2. b) Frequent road accident and congestion on roads add pressure to police work.
  3. c) Many members of the public in Kenya have Negative attitude towards the police making it difficult for them to discharge duties.
  4. d) Poor conditions of work and remuneration demotivates the police force.
  5. e) The police force has been accused of Corruption, sometimes demanding for money from the public. This undermines the maintenance of law and order.
  6. f) Easy access to dangerous and sophisticated weapon by criminals makes police work more difficult.
  7. g) Terrorism is a serious challenge to the police in Kenya. Some of the terrorists have targeted members of the police force.
  8. h) Political interference in the work of the police compromises the integrity of the police force.
  9. i) Modernization and advancements in ICT also some with major challenges for the police.

Incidents of cyber crimes have escalated in the world, including kenya.

  1. j) Lack of regular – in service training for police officers to cope with emerging challenges. This challenge is even compounded by the problem of recruiting of people with low academic qualifications into the force and who can’t deal with sophisticated cases.

The National Police Service Commission.

The structure of the National Police Service Commission.

The Commission consists of the following persons, each appointed by the President;

  1. a) A person who is qualified to be appointed as a High Court Judge, and who is appointed by the president.
  2. b) Two retired senior police officers, each of whom is appointed by the president.
  3. c) Three persons of integrity who have served the public with distinction, each of whom is appointed by the president.
  4. d) The Inspector-General of the National Police Service.
  5. e) Both Deputy Inspectors-General of the National Police Service.

Functions of the National Police Service Commission

  1. a) The Commission recruits and appoints persons to hold or act in offices in the service.
  2. b) The commission confirms appointments, and determines promotions and transfers within the National Police Service
  3. c) It observes due process, exercises disciplinary control over and removes persons holding or acting in offices within the Service.

Possible solutions to challenges facing the national security organs.

  1. a) The security organs have acquired modern telecommunication equipment and vehicles to improve transport and communication in the security force.
  2. b) Introduction of the post of public Relations Officer/ Spokesman in the organs to coordinate and disseminate information.
  3. c) Raising of qualification requirements for anybody aspiring to join the security organs. This has paved way for employment of university graduates in the forces.
  4. d) Introduction of professional training programmes for officers with the aim of improving the effectiveness of the organs of national security.
  5. e) The terms and conditions of service for the members of the security organs have been improved
  6. f) Community policing has-been introduced to help the security forces to get information from the public through hotlines and suggestion boxes.
  7. g) There is increased patrolling by the Kenya navy as far north as Somali border to address maritime defence more seriously.
  8. h) The aviation experts have recommended the relocation of Moi Airbase from its current location which id congested.

Correctional services.

The Correctional service Department in Kenya has its origins in the adoption of the India Prisons Act in Kenya in 1894 by the colonial government. Initially, prisons were under the supervision of the provincial Administration.In 1963 the Prisons Act was enacted to harmonize the treatment and conditions of offenders in Kenya’s penal institutions. The Act’s milestone provisions were;

  1. a) Youth corrective training centres
  2. b) Extra-mural and penal employment
  3. c) Provision for organization, discipline, power and duties of prisons officers.

Correctional services in Kenya are provided by the former Kenya Prisons Service.

The Kenya Prisons Reform Programmee in 2001 adopted The Open Door Policy under which the following reforms were initiated.

  1. a) Interactive collaboration with all stakeholders in the administration of criminal justice such as courts of law and members of the National Police Service.
  2. b) Improvement in the management and conditions of the prisons, including rehabilitation programmes, with a view to empower prisoners with knowledge and skill, hasten their reintegration into society and empower them to be law abiding citizens upon release.

The functions of Correctional Services in Kenya.      

  1. a) They Rehabilitate/correct criminals through counseling.
  2. b) They deter known criminals from committing other crimes.
  3. c) They administer Punishment to sentenced criminals as prescribed by the court rulingsimplement the decisions of the courts regarding treatment of prisoners.
  4. d) They confine prisoners convicted by the courts of law to ensure that the rights and freedoms of the public are protected.
  5. e) They provide vocational training for prisoners in fields that they make them productive citizens of the country at the end of their jail term.
  6. f) They keep watch over he behaviors of suspected criminals whose cases are still pending in the law courts.
  7. g) They take care of the welfare of prisoners by providing them with the necessary medical attention.
  8. h) They confine suspected dissidents who are a threat to state security.

Challenges facing correctional services in Kenya

  1. a) The challenge of overcrowding in prisoners on the rise, overcrowding in correctional facilities has been inevitable. This results in poor living and sanitation conditions for inmates.
  2. b) Disease outbreak is a very common problem in our prisons mainly caused by inadequate and congested facilities. HIV and AIDS is rampant in prisons
  3. c) Mistreatment of inmates by warders. This has once happened at Kingongo when some inmates were allegedly tortured and killed by warders when they attempted to escape.
  4. d) Food shortage, inadequate medical facilities and poor clothing further compound the situation in prisons.

The following reforms have been undertaken to improve the conditions of correctional services in Kenya.

  1. a) Improvement in the quality of food, medical services and living conditions for prisoners.
  2. b) Provision of sufficient beddings and clothing.
  3. c) Introduction of extra-mural Penal employment for petty offenders to ease congestion in the prisons.
  4. d) There has been supply of new and comfortable motor vehicles for efficient transport in the correctional services department.
  5. e) Petty offenders have been constantly released to ease congestion in prisons. For example the release of a record 11,500 prisoners in December 2003. Death row inmates who have also been in jail for over ten years have been released.
  6. f) Easing of access to prisons/visits by members of the public/relatives.
  7. g) Introduction of public Relations office to disseminate information.
  8. h) Streamlining the hearing of cases with a view of keeping prisoners in remand for a short period before sentencing them.
  9. i) The national government has also become directly involved the affairs of those receiving correction services.

THE JUDICIARY.

Judicial authority and legal system.

Judicial Authority is derived from the people and is vested in courts and tribunals established by the constitution.

Principles that guide Judicial Authority in Courts and Tribunals in Kenya.

  1. a) Justice must be done to all, irrespective of status.
  2. b) Justice shall not be delayed.
  3. c) Alternative forms of dispute resolution must be pursued including reconciliation,

mediation, arbitration and even traditional dispute resolution mechanism.

  1. d) Justice shall be administered without undue regard to procedural technicalities.
  2. e) The purposes and principles of the constitution must be protected and promoted.

Ways in which the traditional Dispute resolution is limited in Kenya.

  1. a) The mechanisms used in traditional dispute resolution should not contravene the Bill of RIGHTS.
  2. b) The traditional court should not operate in a way that is repugnant to justice and

morality or results in outcomes that are regnant to justice or morality.

  1. c) The operations of the traditional courts should not be inconsistent with the constitution.

The structure of the judicial system in Kenya.

The Hierarchy of the court system in the Kenyan judiciary is in accordance with;

  1. a) The seriousness of the cases the courts handle.
  2. b) The punishment they give out
  3. c) The geographical area of operation.

The courts have either original or appellate jurisdiction.

Difference between original and appellate jurisdictions.           

~  Original jurisdiction refers to the ability of a court to hear cases brought to a court for the first time.

~  Appellate jurisdiction is the powers of a court to hear appeals brought in from a lower court.The Judiciary consists of the judges of the superior courts, magistrates, other judicial officers and staff. The Head of the Judiciary is the Chief Justice with the Deputy Chief Justice as the Deputy Head of the Judiciary.Chief Registrar of the Judiciary is the chief administrator and accounting officer of the Judiciary.

The System of courts is as follows

  1. Superior Courts

Supreme Court consisting of the Chief Justice who is the president of the court, the Deputy Chief Justice-the vice-president of the court; and five other judges.

Appointment to the Supreme Court requires the following qualifications;

  1. Degree in law from a recognized university or an advocate of the high Court of

Kenya.

  1. Atleast fifteen years experience as a superior court judge or a distinguished

academic, judicial officer, legal practioner and or other relevant legal field.

  1. High moral character, integrity and impartiality.

Supreme Court Judges retire at the age of seventy Five Years.

Functions of the Supreme Court of Kenya.

  1. a) The Supreme Court has exclusive original jurisdiction to hear and determine disputes relating to the elections to the office of President.
  2. b) It has appellate jurisdiction to hear and determine appeals from the Court of Appeal; and any other court or tribunal.
  3. c) The Supreme Court gives an advisory opinion at the request of the national government, any State organ, or any county government with respect to any matter concerning county government.
  4. d) It has of right in any case involving the interpretation or application of the Constitution.
  5. e) All courts, other than the Supreme Court, are bound by the decisions of the Supreme Court
  6. Court of Appeal consisting of judges, not fewer than twelve, a president of the Court of Appeal elected by the judges of the Court of Appeal from among themselves. (The court of Appeal has membership of 30 Judges currently). Each judge to be appointed to the court of Appeal should have ten years experience as a superior court judge or atleast ten years as a distinguished academic or legal practioner.The court of appeal does not have original jurisdiction except on an application for a stay of execution pending appeal to it on contempt proceedings.

Function of the Court of Appeal in Kenya.

The Court of Appeal has jurisdiction to hear appeals from the High Court; and any other court or tribunal as prescribed by an Act of Parliament.

  1. High Court headed by a Principal Judge of the High Court, who shall be elected by the judges of the High Court from among themselves.

Functions of the high court of Kenya.

  1. a) The High Court has unlimited original jurisdiction in criminal and civil Matters.
  2. b) It has jurisdiction to determine the question whether a right or fundamental freedom in the Bill of Rights has been denied, violated, infringed or threatened.
  3. c) It has jurisdiction to hear an appeal from a decision of a tribunal appointed to consider the removal of a person from office. For example, appeals from the courts martial, Business and rental Tribunals on matters related to the constitution.
  4. d) It has jurisdiction to hear any question respecting the interpretation of the Constitution including the determination of the question whether any law is inconsistent with or in contravention of this Constitution;
  5. e) It determines any matter relating to constitutional powers of State organs in respect of county governments and any matter relating to the constitutional relationship between the levels of government.
  6. f) The High Court has supervisory jurisdiction over the subordinate courts and over any person, body or authority exercising a judicial or quasi-judicial function, but not over a superior court
  7. g) It listens to appeals from the lower courts when the parties involved are not satisfied.
  8. h) It deals with disputes that take place outside Kenya’s territorial wate rs/maritime.
  9. i) It hears appeals from decisions made by professional disciplinary tribunals involving advocates of the high court and other members of the profession.
  10. j) It acts as a constitution court by determining whether a case brought before it is

constitutional or unconstitutional.

  1. k) It listens to appeals from special courts when the parties are not satisfied with the decision made.
  2. l) It corrects/amends the irregularities in decisions made by lower courts.
  3. m) It hears cases that carry death sentences / involve large sums of money.
  4. n) It deals with cases that concern land/succession disputes.
  5. o) It hears election petitions.
  6. p) It exercises divorce jurisdictions in matrimonial matters,
  7. q) It hears appeals from tribunals E.g. Rent Restrictions, Business Premises Rent Tribunal.

Termination of the services of a judge from office.

A judge can be dismissed from service on the following grounds.

  1. a) Inability to perform the functions of the office arising from mental or physical

incapacity.

  1. b) A breach of a code of conduct prescribed for judges or superior courts by an act of parliament.
  2. c)
  3. d)
  4. e) Gross misconduct or misbehavior.

The process of removal of a judge from office.

Such a process is initiated by the Judicial Service Commission on its own initiative or on petition of any person to it based on any of the dismissal grounds.The commission, if satisfied with the petition or initiative, forwards the matter to the president, who will suspend the said Judge, within Fourteen Days after receiving the petition and on advice of the Judicial Service Commission.A tribunal is then appointed to determine the case. If the Judge is aggrieved by the decision of the Tribunal, he/she may appeal to the Supreme Court within ten days after the tribunal has made its recommendation. The president will finally act in accordance with the recommendation of the tribunal.

  1. Subordinate courts.
  2. a) The Magistrates courts.

Its jurisdiction in both Civil and criminal cases is limited to geographical areas.

However the courts have unlimited Jurisdiction in proceedings concerning claims under customary law such as dowry, divorce, legitimacy, inheritance and the administration of estates of the deceased person.They have unlimited jurisdiction in dealing with matters related to land, adultery and inheritance. These are the courts responsible for sentencing persons who have broken law of the land.

Reasons why a person who has broken the law should be sentenced by a court.

  1. To deter the criminal from future crimes.
  2. To deter others from committing similar offences since they would have known the punishment for breaking the law.

iii.  To secure for the public a period o protection from the offender who is in prison.

  1. To reform the criminal through counseling and corrective training
  2. To satisfy the demands of the people for retribution through punitive justice.
  3. b) The Kadhis’ courts.

The courts are headed by a Chief Kadhi and not fewer than three Kadhis

Qualifications for appointment as a Kadhi.

  1. One must profess the Muslim religion.
  2. One must possess such knowledge of the Muslim law applicable to any sects of Muslims.

The jurisdiction of the Kadhis Court is limited to the determination of questions of Muslim Law relating to personal status, marriage, divorce or inheritance in proceedings in which all concerned parties profess to the Muslim religion.

  1. c) The Courts Martial.

This is a subordinate court that was established under the Armed Forces Act after the abortive ’82 Air force coup. It has penal or disciplinary powers to ensure discipline within the armed forces. they try cases involving assisting an enemy, cowardice, desertion, insubordination, neglect of duty, drunkenness, malingering and absence without leave.

There is no right to appeal to the high court against the decisions of the courts martial unless they involve constitutional cases.

Industrial Court

Juvenile Court

The Judicial Service Commission.

Membership of the JSC is as follows.

  1. a) The Chief Justice who is the Chairperson of the Commission.
  2. b) One Supreme Court judge elected by the judges of the Supreme Court.
  3. c) One court of appeal judge elected by the judges of the court of appeal.
  4. d) One High Court Judge and one magistrate, of whom one must be a woman and one a man elected by members of the association of judges and magistrates.
  5. e) The attorney General.
  6. f) Two advocates , one woman and one man each with atleast fifteen years of experience, elected by members of the statutory body responsible for the professional regulation of advocates (LSK)
  7. g) One person nominated by the public Service Commission.
  8. h) One woman and one man to represent the public, not being a lawyer, appointed by the president with the approval of the national assembly.
  9. i) The chief registrar of the Judiciary, who will be secretary to the commission.

Members, except the AG and Chief Justice hold office for a term of 5 years and can be reappointed for one further term

Functions of the Judicial Service Commission

  1. a) The Judicial Service Commission promotes and facilitates the independence and

accountability of the judiciary and the efficient, effective and transparent administration of justice.

  1. b) It recommends to the President persons for appointment as
  2. c) It reviews and makes recommendations on the conditions of service of judges and judicial officers, other than their remuneration; and the staff of the Judiciary.
  3. d) It appoints, receives complaints against, investigates and removes from office or otherwisediscipline registrars, magistrates, other judicial officers and other staff of the Judiciary.
  4. e) It prepares and implements programmes for the continuing education and training of judges and judicial officers.
  5. f) It advises the national government on improving the efficiency of the administration of justice.

The concept of “Independence of the Judiciary” in Kenya.

  1. a) In the exercise of judicial authority, the Judiciary is subject only to the Constitution and the law and not to the control or direction of any person or authority.
  2. b) The office of a judge of a superior court cannot be abolished while there is a substantive holder of the office.
  3. c) A member of the Judiciary is not liable in an action or suit in respect of anything done or omitted to be done in good faith in the lawful performance of a judicial function. The Judicial Act protects Judges and Magistrates against any form of victimization and molestation.
  4. d) There is a separate system of command for the judiciary unlike other government

departments.

  1. e) Appointment of the magistrates is done independently by JSC, which is independent of PSC.

The president in consultation with the Judicial Service Commission appoints the Judges.

  1. f) The judges are bound by the Oath of Allegiance to perform their duties without fear or favour.
  2. g) Judges enjoy security of tenure.
  3. h) Statutes fix salaries and allowances of Judges.

Challenges facing the judiciary in Kenya.

  1. a) There is constant Conflict between the three arms of government. This hinders the just operation of the judiciary. Too much interference from the Executive has undermined the independence of the Judiciary.
  2. b) The long court processes have always delayed dispensation of justice in Kenya.
  3. c) This is common among the Judges who sometimes compromise their integrity due to greed/ Public doubts of its impartiality due to rampant corruption
  4. d) Inadequate personnel. There are few qualified judges. For example in 2002, there were 47 judges serving a population of 30 million people. This causes delay in hearing of cases.
  5. e) There is constant termination of cases by the Attorney General thereby denying justice to some genuine cases.
  6. f) Poor co-ordination within the court system
  7. g) Incompetence of some judicial officers. E.g. poor and inconsistent judgments. This has been attributed to flawed appointments and promotion procedures.
  8. h) Lack of adequate funds to cater for the needs of the judiciary. This has led to inadequate court structures and facilities such as equipment, chairs, libraries etc.
  9. i) Lack of continuous legal education to keep them a breast of the latest legal development and skills in information technology.
  10. j) There is a lot of ignorance among the public in Kenya on judicial affairs and their legal rights/ignorance on the legal rights. Members of the public fear the courts and the court language.
  11. k) Information on the judiciary has not been made available to the public and it appears to be a preserve of a few.
  12. l) Litigation fees are high limits public’s access to the courts.

Solutions to the problems facing Kenya’s Judiciary.

  1. a) There has been increased legal education given to officers and members of the public by the judiciary and other bodies like Kituo Cha Sheria, which releases information booklets and offers free legal advice to people.
  2. b) The terms and conditions of service for judges and other officers were improved in 2002 in order to make them work better.
  3. c) The government also set up a committee led by Justice Aaron Ringera in what was famously referred to as Judicial Surgery, to investigate the conduct of judges. Those who were adversely mentioned in the report were suspended.
  4. d) The government has recruited more legal officers to reduce the backlog of cases in courts.
  5. e) The passing of the Vetting of Judges and Magistrates Act, 2011 (VJM Act) In March 2011, established the Judges and Magistrates Vetting Board, chaired by Sharad Rao ,which is carrying out the vetting exercise to restore public confidence in the Judiciary.

Some of the mile stone decisions undertaken to restore public confidence in the judiciary include;

~  The suspension of Deputy CJ Nancy Baraza and her final resignation for harrassing an innocent security guard.

~  Dropping of President of the Kenyan Appellate Court Justice Riaga Omollo for political bias and authoritarian demeanor while carrying out his activities on the bench.

~  Dropping Judge Samuel Bosire for condoning torture of suspects during Coup trial in 1982.

~  Dropping of Court of Appeal Judge Emmanuel Okubasu for being unsuitable to continue holding office. Joseph Nyamu

~  Justice Mohammed Ibrahim, though Praised as impartial and immune to corruption,  was dropped for having an overflowing in-tray of cases

~  Appellate judge Roselyn Nambuye was kicked out due to delays in delivering more than 270 judgements and being too wordy in her ruling.

However Nambuye and Mohammed Ibrahim successfully appealed against the decision which once more saw their reinstatement on 21at September 2012 pending further investigations.

The Rule of Law.

Meaning of ‘the Rule of Law’.

This is the absolute supremacy or predominance of regular law as opposed to arbitrary power.The concept is associated with the view of Albert Venn Dicey who published a book, The Law of the Constitution in 1895, in which he presupposes the supremacy of the law. That all persons whether individual or in government, are subject to the law.

In Kenya, all citizens and residents are subject to and governed by the same law irrespective of their status, race and religion

Elements of the rule of law.

  1. a) The principle of legality. The state can only exercise those powers granted to it by the law. It should be a government of laws and not of men.
  2. b) Separation of powers of the three arms of government. This refers to the practice of dividing the powers of government into the executive, legislature and judicial functions equally and putting in place a system of checks and balances to ensure they control each other. The three functions are to be independent of each other.
  3. c) Equality before the law. Everyone should be treated equally under the law.
  4. d) The judiciary must work without favour or the fear of intimidation in the administration of justice.

The principles of the Rule of Law.

Joseph Raz in an article titled, The Rule of Law and its Virtues outlines the following eight principles of the rule of law.

  1. a) All laws should be prospective and open. A new law should only apply in future.
  2. b) Laws should be durable and not changing every other day.
  3. c) No centre of power, and specifically parliament, should enjoy monopoly right in making laws for citizens of a country, the judiciary should scrutinize parliament.
  4. d) The independence of the judiciary should be protected.
  5. e) The principal of natural justice should form an important element in the judicial system of a country.
  6. f) There must be easy accessibility to the courts of law. They should neither be expensive nor intimidating.
  7. g) The security forces should not use force in contravention of the law.

Meaning of the concept of Natural Justice.

it refers to the requirement that the bodies that resolve disputes adhere to at least minimum standard of fair decision making

Two principles govern the Concept of Natural Justice.

  1. The person affected by an impending decision must have the right to a fair hearing prior to the decision being made.
  2. The person or body hearing the case should act in good faith and without Bias.

The right to fair hearing

  1. a) The accused must be given prior notice of the case against him and given a chance to respond.
  2. b) The accused must be given chance of knowing the case against him and stating his own case.
  3. c) The person charged should have opportunity to consider, challenge and contradict any evidence, being fully aware of the allegations leveled against him.
  4. d) The person has a right to legal representation by a legally qualified person.
  5. e) All legal decisions should have reasons within the law..

The rule against Bias.

Full inquiry must be conducted into the circumstances involved before the Arbitrator makes a decision.  The decision made should be impartial with the adjudicator lacking interest in the outcome.A person is presumed innocent until proven otherwise and the police have no right to beat up suspects.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

HISTORY FORM FOUR NOTES

 

World War

World War I or the First World War was a war fought by many countries, which is why it is called a “world” war. It started in 1914 and ended in 1918. 135 countries took part in World War I, and more than 15,000,000 people died in the war.

World War One – Causes

The First World War, which began in August 1914, was directly triggered by the

assassination of the Austrian archduke, Franz Ferdinand and his wife, on 28 June 1914 by Bosnian revolutionary, Gavrilo Princip. This event was, however, simply the trigger that set off declarations of war.

The actual causes of the war were;

1)  The system of Alliances

An alliance is an agreement made between two or more countries to give  each other help if it is needed.  A number of alliances had been signed by countries between the years 1879 and 1914.  For example, the Dual Alliance signed by Germany with Austria

Hungary in 1879 and later joined by Italy in 1882 to become the triple Alliance. This system led to the division of Europe into two antagonistic power blocs. It led to fear and suspicion between nations. It transformed local disputes into a general conflict. The Triple Alliance of Germany, Austria-Hungary and Italy were directly opposed by the Entente powers of France and Russia and later included Great Britain to form the Triple Entente in 1907.

2)  Imperialism

Imperialism  is  when  a  country  takes  over  new  lands  or  countries  and  makes  them subject  to  their  rule.  By  1900,  the  British  Empire  extended over five  continents and France  had  control  of  large  areas  of  Africa. With  the  rise  of  industrialism,  countr-ies needed new markets. The amount of lands ‘owned’ by Britain and France increased their rivalry with Germany who had entered the scramble to acquire colonies late and only had small areas of Africa.

3)  Economic rivalry.

According to Marxism, the highest form of capitalism would ultimately lead to an

inevitable war through economic rivalry. In the late 19th century, all European powers had industrialized or had started. Therefore, to match the needs of economy and industry, nations sought to expand their territory through imperialism in order to gain raw mater-ials and markets. This then led to the clash of imperial interest between nations and ultimately led to conflict and war.

4)  Militarism

Militarism  means  that  the  army  and  military  forces  are  given  a  high  profile by  the government. The growing European divide had led to an arms race between the main countries. The armies of both France and Germany had more than doubled between 1870  and  1914  and  there  was  fierce  competition  between  Britain  and  Germany  for mastery  of  the  seas.  The  British  had  introduced  the ‘Dreadnought’,  an  effective battleship,  in  1906.  The  Germans  soon  followed  suit  introducing  their  own battle-ships. The German, Von Schlieffen also drew up a plan of action that involved attacking France through Belgium if Russia made an attack on Germany.

5)  Nationalism

Nationalism  means  being  a  strong  supporter  of  the  rights  and  interests  of  one’s country.  The  Congress  of  Vienna,  held  after  Napoleon’s  exile  to  Elba,  aimed  to  sort out problems in Europe. Delegates from Britain, Austria, Prussia and Russia decided upon  a  new  Europe  that  left  both  Germany  and  Italy  as  divided  states.  Strong nationalist  elements led  to the  re-unification of Italy  in 1861  and  Germany in  1871.

The settlement at the end of the Franco-Prussian war left France angry at the loss of

Alsace-Lorraine to Germany and keen to regain their lost territory. Large areas of both Austria-Hungary  and  Serbia  were  home  to  differing  nationalist  groups,  all  of  whom wanted freedom from the states in which they lived.

6)  Moroccan Crisis

In  1904  Morocco  had  been  given  to  France  by  Britain,  but  the  Moroccans  wanted their  independence.  In  1905,  Germany  announced  her  support  for  Moroccan indepe-ndence. War was narrowly  avoided by a conference which allowed France to retain possession of Morocco. However, in 1911, the Germans were again protesting against  French  possession  of  Morocco.  Britain  supported  France  and  Germany  was persuaded to back down for part of French Congo.

7)  Bosnian Crisis

In  1908,  Austria-Hungary  took  over  the  former  Turkish  province  of  Bosnia.  This angered Serbians who felt the province should be theirs. Serbia threatened Austria Hungary  with  war.  Russia,  allied  to  Serbia,  mobilized  its  forces.  Germany,  allied  to Austria-Hungary  mobilized  its  forces  and  prepared  to  threaten  Russia.  War  was avoided when Russia backed down. There was, however, war in the Balkans between

SPECIAL COVERAGE

The First Moroccan Crisis

The First Moroccan Crisis clearly indicated that Germany’s relation with France was at best fragile. In 1905 Morocco was one of the few African states not occupied by a European power. In May 1905 it was agreed that an international conference should be held on Morocco  in Algeciras.

The Algeciras Conference of 1906

The main aim was to decide what was to be done with regards to Morocco. The two main protagonists at Algeciras were France and Germany.

However, it soon became very clear to Germany that other European powers had sided with France – Britain, Spain and Italy. The Algeciras Conference ended on April 7th 1906.The Germans got very little out of the conference. The plan to create a triple alliance or even a quadruple alliance to isolate Great Britain failed. Arguably, by the end of the conference, Britain and France had even closer ties to one another. A German presence in North Africa had also failed to materialize. The French media portrayed Germany as an inferior nation, much to the concern of the more experienced politicians in Paris. The Algeciras Conference may have ‘resolved’ the crisis in Morocco but the outcome clearly defined Europe into certain camps. At this conference Germany publicly lost out .

The Agadir Crisis of 1911 (the Second Moroccan Crisis.)

The Agadir Crisis occurred in 1911 just four years after the First Moroccan Crisis. Germany’s attention was diverted after the 1905-06 crises by other issues, mainly building up her navy so that it rivaled the Royal Navy. As a result France spent five years having far more influence in Morocco than Germany. They backed the corrupt Sultan, Abdul Aziz, who was accused by some of his countrymen of selling out Morocco to the

French. The half-brother of Aziz, Mulay Hafid, took a stand on behalf of the Moroccan people who proclaimed him Sultan in January 1908. Fez also came under attack. In April 1911 a decision was made in Germany to send troops to Fez to support the foreign contingent living there. The plan was to send German warships to Agadir and Mogador ostensibly to defend German citizens in Morocco. A gunboat, the ‘Panther’, was sent to Agadir on July 1st 1911.

What part did the Agadir Crisis play in the outbreak of World War One?

The episode proved that Germany was hell-bent on trying to dominate Europe as a whole. Winston Churchill and David Lloyd George were among those who believed this.

1911 and 1912 when the Balkan states drove Turkey out of the area. The  states then fought  each  other  over  which  area  should  belong  to  which  state.  Austria -Hungary then  intervened  and  forced  Serbia  to  give  up  some  of  its  acquisitions.  Tension between Serbia and Austria-Hungary was high.

8)  The Assassination of Archduke Franz Ferdinand

A secret society called Ujedinjenje Ili Smrt, (‘Union or Death’) or Black Hand was founded in Belgrade, an outgrowth of an older Serb nationalist group:  Narodna Odbrana. When it was learned that the Heir-Apparent to the Austrian throne, Franz Ferdinand, was scheduled to visit Sarajevo in June of 1914, the Black Hand decided to assassinate him.

Three young Bosnians were recruited, trained and equipped: Gavrilo Princip, Nedjelko Cabrinovic and Trifko Grabez. The murders of Franz Ferdinand and Sophie brought Austro-Serbian tensions to a head. As Vienna took a hard line against Serbia, the other powers in Europe took sides. The wheels of war gained speed. The Crisis of July turned into world war, just over thirty days after Franz Ferdinand and his wife Sophie were shot.

System of Alliances.

By 1914, Europe had divided into two camps.

1)  The Triple Alliance was Germany, Italy and Austria-Hungary.

2)  The Triple Entente was Britain, France and Russia.

1)  The Triple Alliance

The alliance between Germany and Austria was natural. Both spoke the same language -German – and had a similar culture. Austria was in political trouble in the south-east of Europe – the Balkans. She needed the might of Germany to back her up if trouble got worse. Italy had joined these countries as she feared their power on her northern border.

Each member of the Triple Alliance (Germany, Austria and Italy) promised to help the others if they were attacked by another country. By the close of the war the Central Powers had been extended to incorporate Bulgaria and Turkey

2)  The Triple Entente

The Entente Powers comprised a military alliance – driven by a variety of inter-related treaties – of France, Great Britain and Russia.The Entente alliance sprang from the military concerns of Germany’s neighbours to east and west. Russia and France; accordingly in 1894 they signed an alliance based upon fears of growing German power. Britain subsequently forged alliances with both Russia and France once it became clear that Germany intended to construct a navy to match the Royal Navy in the late 1890s. Thus the Entente Alliance was not a formal alliance. The term was later replaced by the more general ‘Allies’ to include other nations

including Italy and Japan.

THE COURSE OF THE WAR.

The war was fought in three continents; Europe, Africa and Asia and both on land and on the sea. In Europe, the war was fought in two fronts

  1. The Western Front was where most of the fighting between Germany and the Allies happened. The war in western front was fought in Belgium and France as per the Schlieffen plan. Count Alfred von Schlieffen, mastermind of the Schlieffen Plan, served as Germany’s Chief of the Imperial General Staff from 1891 to 1905. It was Schlieffen’s plan, long after he retired fro army (1906) that was used for the August 1914 attack on France that was to trigger World War One.

The Schlieffen Plan entailed an attack on France (while Russia mobilised her army)

followed by an attack on Russia. The plan meant that Germany could place the bulk of her military might on one frontier and then move it to another.

The basic mechanics of Von Schlieffen’s plan were;

  1. a) A devastating attack on France via neutral Belgium as soon as Russia had

announced her intention to mobilise, which would take six weeks.

  1. b) A holding operation on the Russian/German border to be carried out if necessary

and if required.

  1. c) Germany was to use 6 weeks to defeat France. a massive and successful surprise

attack against France would be enough to put off Britain becoming involved in a

continental war

  1. d) Germany would then use her modernised rail system to move troops quickly from the French operation to the Russian front. Russia would then be attacked and

defeated.

The Schlieffen Plan was daring but it had a number of glaring weaknesses:

  1. a) The actions of Russia determined when Germany would have to start her attack

on France even if she was ready or not.

  1. b) It assumed that Russia would need six weeks to mobilise. But she mobilized

faster than it was assumed.

  1. c) It assumed that Germany would defeat France in less than six weeks.

Early on July 31, Russia began a full mobilization of its forces in preparation for war with Austria-Hungary. On August 1, Germany declared war on Russia and German troops began moving into Luxembourg in preparation for invading Belgium and France.

On August 2, Germany contacted the Belgian government requesting free passage

through Belgium for its troops. This was refused by King Albert and Germany declared war on both Belgium and France on August 3.The German Army went into Belgium on the 4 August. On the same day, Great Britain started a war on Germany, because Britain was a friend of Belgium. When the Germans got to the Belgian city of Liège, they did finally push the Belgians out of the city, but it had taken longer than the German generals had planned.On December 24-25, 1914, there was a temporary halt to the fighting on parts of the Western Front. This was the Christmas truce.The initial force behind the Christmas Truce came from the Germans. Christmas was celebrated in full, with men visiting across the lines and gifts of food and tobacco being exchanged.  As Christmas ended, both sides reluctantly returned to war, the bonds forged at Christmas slowly eroded as units rotated out and the fighting became more ferocious.By 1915, the Western Front had become a stalemate as both sides engaged in trench warfare.The men on both sides took spades and dug lines of trenches went all the way from Switzerland to the North Sea, because they did not want to be killed. In front of the trenches, there was barbed wire that cut anyone who tried to climb over it, and mines that blew up anyone who tried to run across the “no man’s land” that was in between the trenches. Gas was also an important weapon used.The war in the west was static in the next three years and attempts by the military commanders on both sides to break the stalemate led to deaths of many soldiers. At the battle of the Somme in 1916 60,000 British men died in a single day. It was one of the bloodiest days in the history of the British army. Seeking to shatter the Anglo-French lines, the German Chief of Staff, Erich von Falkenhayn, began planning a massive assault on the French city of Verdun. The Battle of Verdun lasted from February 21, 1916 until December 18, 1916 and was one of the longest and bloodiest battles of World War I. A brutal battle of attrition, Verdun cost the French an estimated 161,000 dead, 101,000 missing and 216,000 wounded. German losses were approximately 142,000 killed and 187,000 wounded.

  1. The Eastern Front was fought in Central and Eastern Europe and was one of the

main places where World War I took place. The start of the war on the eastern front

involved an attack on Russia on 1st of august 1914. On August 6, Austria-Hungary

declared war on Russia and six days later entered into hostilities with France and

Britain. The Russians were decisively defeated by allied forces of Austria and

Germany at the battle of Tanneberg in august 1914 and at the battle of Missourian

Lakes in September 1914.

War in the seas

Some of the fiercest battles between the Allies and the central powers took place in the sea.By May 1916, Germany’s main fleet was stationed in the North Sea to attack Britain’s fleet. However, the British intelligence decoded the German wireless code and was able to prepare the royal navy to fully counter Germany’s challenge. Both sides suffered causalities in the war that followed. 11 german ships and 14 British ships were lost.

Importance of Britain’s supremacy at sea

  1. a) The British naval forces assisted in blocking the central powers particularly the

Germans from accessing food and raw materials from other parts of the world.

This derailed their war plans.

  1. b) Her naval supremacy enabled the allies to capture colonies of the central

powers.

  1. c) The sea blockade enabled the allies to maintain uninterrupted communication

with other allied forces, as well as safeguard the british food and raw material

supplies from other parts of the world.

The final phase of World War 1

The final phase of the war was a second Germany onslaught on France in 1918 where the Germans were decisively defeated in the hands of USA soldiers.

End of World War I.

Two events that led to the end of World War I were:

1)  Russia’s withdrawal from the war after the Great Russian revolution.

2)  The declaration of war by the United States of America against the central

powers.

The First Russian Revolution

In 1917, there was a revolution in Russia. The Russian people didn’t want to fight

anymore, because the war had been putting burdens on them, and many of them were poor and hungry.

The Second Russian Revolution

Two factions fought to rule over Russia. The passive Mensheviks lost against radical Bolsheviks. The leader of the Bolsheviks was Vladimir Lenin (1870-1924) which was Communist who followed the ideas of Karl Marx. The new government sued the Germans for peace, and signed a peace treaty called Brest-Litvosk with the Central Powers in March 1918 at the city of Brest Litovsk.

The Germans and Russians stopped fighting. This gave Germany lots of land in Eastern Europe and the Baltic Sea

USA entry into the war.

The German generals using submarines named U-boats (underwater boats) attacked

American ships (Lusitania) that were carrying food and weapons to Great Britain. Some Americans were killed by the submarines.Germany also wrote a secret telegram note to Mexico suggesting that the two countries work together to attack the United States (the Zimmerman Telegram- because the person who sent it was named Arthur Zimmerman-the german foreign minister).

Other reasons why USA entered the war on the side of the Allies were;

  1. a) America was concerned with safeguarding her trade with Britain. (US– Anglo

relationship was strong). USA was fully aware that the a defeat of Allied powers

would cost her financial and industrial institutions

  1. b) The USA and British intelligence were able to link some Germany sympathizers

with the industrial sabotage in factories and trade unions in the USA.

  1. c) Cruelty of the Germans led to the growth of anti-Germany feelings in the United

States. Many of the Allies sympathizers had relatives in either France or Britain.

American people decided that they wanted their country to enter the war to punish

Germany. On April 6, 1917 the United States declared war against Germany and became part of the Allies.The socialist politicians declared Germany a republic and met with the Supreme Commander of the allied forces on 7th November 1918, Ferdinand Foch, to negotiate for end of the war with very stiff terms to the Germans.

The stiff terms given to the Germans included;

  1. a) Germany to withdraw from all occupied territories, including overseas colonies.
  2. b) All German forces west of the Rhine to be withdrawn.
  3. c) All German warships to surrender to the Allies.
  4. d) Occupation of some parts of Germany by the Allies.
  5. e) All Allied prisoners of war to be released.

The Germans were given 72 hours to either accept or reject these stiff conditions.

Protesting bitterly, they signed an armistice on 9th November 1918.

At 11:00 AM on 9th November 1918, the war ended.

Reasons why the allies won World War I.

  1. a) Allied powers had many supporters drawn from 25 states some of which were

Britain, France, Belgium, Russia, Italy, USA, Japan and Portugal. They had more

manpower than the central powers.

  1. b) Germany failure to effectively control her expensive colonies and others turned

against her.

  1. c) USA entry into war on the side of the allies accelerated the defeat of the central

powers. The industrial might of USA and her economic wealth helped the Allies to

force the central powers to their knees.

  1. d) The Allies had able and focussed political leaders like Lloyd George-the British

Premier and Georges Clemenceau, the French Premier.

  1. e) Germans/axis powers made serious technical mistakes like invasion of the neutral Belgium by Germany which turned the world opinion against the central powers.
  2. f) Superior naval power of the Allies. The superiority of the British Royal Navy enabled the Allies to enforce a naval Blockade that caused severe food shortages among the central powers.
  3. g) Germany fought the war on many fronts.
  4. h) Germany was badly led down by her colleagues like Italy who decamped and

Bulgaria and Austria-Hungary who had to be assisted all the time. Turkey on her part easily accepted defeat.

  1. i) The Allies had financial and industrial resources in Europe and in their colonies

which were used to great advantage during the war.

  1. j) The Allies had powerful weapons e.g. they used Tankers, Aircraft and Battleships.
  2. k) The allies were united under the Command of General Foch which disadvantaged the central powers. German also used young and inexperienced soldiers after 1918 due to heavy causalities.
  3. l) The central powers were surrounded by the Allies as they lay in the centre of

Europe. They also lacked an extensive coastline and thus were easily blockaded.

The Peace Treaties.

In January 1918, Woodrow Wilson, President of the USA, outlined, in his speech to the congress, the ‘fourteen points’ that were essential in maintenance of world peace.

Among these were three great principles that formed the basis of world peace namely;

  1. Self-determination of all peoples, i.e, the right of peoples all over the world to

determine their own fate.

  1. The need to make public all diplomatic and international agreements.
  2. The need to establish a League of Nations which would provide an avenue for

discussing all international problems, protect small states from aggression by

large ones.In January 1919, statesmen from the 27 Allied powers converged at  Paris, France to determine the fate of the defeated central powers. The central powers were not party to the discussions but were required to sign on the final draft. The Key personalities at the conference were;

  1. a) Lloyd George( PM of Britain)
  2. b) George Clemenceau (PM of France)
  3. c) Woodrow Wilson (President of USA)
  4. d) Vittorio Orlando (PM of Italy)

Five treaties were signed with each of the central powers separately as follows;

  1. a) The Treaty of Versailles with Germany (28th June 1919)
  2. b) Treaty of St. Germaine with Austria (10th September 1919)
  3. c) Treaty of Neuilly with Bulgaria (27th November 1919)
  4. d) Treaty of Trianon with Hungary (4th June 1920)
  5. e) Treaty of Sevres in 1920 and Lausanne in 1923 with Turkey.

The Treaty of Versailles.

It should be noted that all the above treaties were generally referred to as the Treaty of Versailles.

Terms of the Versailles Treaty of 1919.

  1. a) The treaty declared Germany an aggressor who was supposed to pay reparations

and whose military capability was to be reduced.

  1. b) She lost all her colonial passions with the African colonies being taken from her and put under supervision of the League of Nations.
  2. c) The treaty of St. Germaine provided for the creation of Yugoslavia, Bosnia,

Herzegovina and Malta as mandated territories.

  1. d) Germany was totally disarmed and only allowed to retain a force of 100,000 soldiers and her navy was disbanded. Military conscription was banned in Germany.
  2. e) Germany’s population and size was reduced as Austria, with a large German

population was allowed to remain independent. Italy acquired Stria, the Italianspeaking region of Austria.

  1. f) Rhineland was to be permanently demilitarized. Germany troops were not allowed in the region.
  2. h) By the treaty of Versailles, Germany lost the provinces of Alsace and Lorraine to France.
  3. i) The treaty established the League of Nation.

Failures of the treaty of Versailles.

  1. a) The treaty handed Germany a heavy punishment as if she was the only one to blame for World War 1. This provoked deep resentment and bitterness among the German nationals.
  2. b) The treaty ignored the interests of the colonial people. The former colonial

possessions of Germany and turkey were handed over to France and Britain in total

disregard to the African grievances during the Versailles conference

  1. c) The treaty failed to carter for the interests of the minority in Europe. The new

republic of Austria was forbidden from merging with Germany though a national

vote was for the merger.

  1. d) Italy was given a raw deal in the settlement. She was only given Stria, an Italian speaking region formerly belonging to Austria.
  2. e) Though the treaty proposal for the formation of the League of Nations came from the USA president Wilson, the US constitution prohibited commitment to such an organization, whose membership required a nation to help a future victim of

aggression.

 

RESULTS OF WORLD WAR I

  1. a) Nationalist movements in Asia and Africa grew in strength and number after the war and a sense of patriotism arose.
  2. b) USA gained an upper hand in the post war European affairs. She emerged as a

leading world power.

  1. c) German military capability was reduced on land and sea and heavy indemnity

imposed on her. She lost all her colonies, which were made mandated territ ories of

the League of Nations.

  1. d) The end of the war marked the beginning of the decline of western imperialism. As early as 1920, there was a possibility of independence for colonial countries. The war encouraged imperial powers to give more freedom to their subjects.
  2. e) The end of the war witnessed the creation of new states e.g. Yugoslavia,

Czechoslovakia, Poland and Finland.

  1. f) Germany and Italy fell in the hands of dictators e.g. Mussolini and Hitler.
  2. g) The war Created bitter feelings and mistrust among the countries that fought in the war. This continued until the outbreak of the Second World War.
  3. h) It led to the Bolshevik Revolution of 1917 in Russia as radicals took over government there.
  4. i) It led to a change of government in Britain.
  5. j) There was greater use of motor vehicles and aircraft, which facilitated transport.
  6. k) The art of surgery improved.
  7. l) Between 1914 and 1918, European factories were destroyed and business brought down hence heavy losses.
  8. m) There was massive destruction of property and infrastructure.
  9. n) It led to the great depression 1920 to 1921, which affected economies worldwide.
  10. o) It led to increased taxation by he colonial authorities to meet war and post -war

demands.

THE LEAGUE OF NATIONS

Origin and organization of the League of Nations.

The League of Nations was established by the victors of the First World War in 1920 at the treaty of Versailles with the main aim of preventing the occurrence of another war.

The idea of its formation was mooted by Woodrow Wilson, the US president who was supported by Lord Robert Cecil of Britain, Jan Smuts of South Africa and Leon Bourgeois of France.The League of Nation came into force during the first meeting in London Britain,on 10th January 1920.

Reasons for the formation of the League of Nations in 1920.

  1. a) It was formed for the Maintenance of world peace / It was specifically created to

prevent the outbreak of another world war

  1. b) The League of Nations was meant to foster international cooperation in solving

problems as they arise.

  1. c) It was formed to jointly take instant action against an agreed aggressor by economic and possibly by military means.
  2. d) Members were to secure and maintain fair and humane conditions of labour as one way of maintaining peace in the world.
  3. e) It was formed to oversee development of territories lost to central powers during

the First World War. E.g. Tanganyika, Togo, South West Africa etc.

The main organs of the League of Nations were;

The Council.

It was made up of permanent and Non-permanent members. The permanent members were France, Britain, Italy and Japan. Non permanent members were four, elected by the general assembly.The main role of the council which sat in Geneva was to appoint committees and secretary General with the approval of the majority of the Assembly. It also dealt with disputes amongst member states, reduction of armament, execution of arbitral awards and admittance and expulsion of members.

The Assembly.

It met once a year at Geneva and was comprised of three delegates from each member state. It elected non-permanent members to the council. The functions of the Assembly included;

  1. a) Control of the Budget of the organization (including contributions and

expenditure).

  1. b) Admission of new members after approval of a two-thirds majority.
  2. c) Appointment of non-permanent members of the League of Nations

Council.

  1. d) Consideration of treaties.
  2. e) Supervision of the work of the League of Nations council.
  3. f) Appointment of the 15 judges of the permanent Court of International

Justice.

  1. g) Giving approval to the appointment of Secretary-General.

The Secretariat.

The Secretariat, based in Geneva, consisted of the secretary general and his staff. It was the administrative body of the League of Nations. It kept records of the organization and conducted correspondences including treaties by member states. It implemented the decisions of the League of Nations. It provided continuity between one meeting of the council or the assembly and the next,

The International Court of Justice.

Set up between 1920 and 1922, it comprised of eleven judges and four deputy judges elected for nine years by the assembly and the council. It was based at the HagueHolland. Decisions made by the court were binding on all parties in dispute.

International Labour Organization.It consisted of 4 delegates- two for member states and two for workers from each member state. Its main aim was to maintain good working conditions for men, women and children.

The Mandates Commission.

It had then responsibility of supervising the administration of the trustee colonies.

The League of Nations also had several specialized agencies.

Achievements of the League of Nations.

  1. a) The League of Nations, through the Permanent Court of International Justice,

maintained international peace and security. E.g. in the city of Danzig in spite of the

hostility between the poles and the Germans.

  1. b) The League of Nations achieved its objective of treating the minority with humane. The International Office for Refugees, for example, assisted refugees. Victims of the Nazi persecutions were also assisted.
  2. c) The league assisted in the administration of the trust territories, through the

Mandates Commission. E.g. in Togo, Tanganyika Cameroon and Rwanda-urundi. In addition, the territories acquired from turkey. E.g. Iraq and Palestine.

  1. d) The league was able to solve several interstate disputes in a peaceful manner. E.g the frontier dispute between turkey and Iraq over the Mosul province (1924 -1926), the dispute between Poland and Germany over northern Silesia.
  2. e) The league successfully restored financial stability in Austria following the economic slump in the country after the World War 1.
  3. f) It successfully enforced control over the manufacture and sale of arms. It also held disarmament meetings.
  4. g) The league ensured signing of peace treaties to promote security in the world. For example, the Locarno treaties of 1925 that settled boundary disputes between

Germany and France.

Failures of the League of Nations.

The League of Nations failed its Prime objective of maintaining world peace in the

following ways;

  1. a) It failed to solve the Sino-Japanese dispute after Japan invaded Manchuria in

China in 1931. Japan after refusing to abide by the League’s demands that it

withdraws from the Chinese territory, even pulled out of the league in 1933.

  1. b) The Italian invasion of Ethiopia in 1935. Benito Mussolini, rather than accept the League’s verdict that he withdraws Italian troops from Ethiopia, pulled out of the League.
  2. c) The League failed to stop German Violation of the terms of the Versailles Treaty.

She embarked on a remilitarization programme and established a navy and an

airbase.

  1. d) Nations continued to make many defensive pacts in total disregard of the Treaty

of Versailles.

  1. e) Germany invaded other regions such as Poland and Austria between 1936 and

1939, while Russia invaded Finland in 1939 in violation of the League of Nations.

Factors that undermined the effectiveness of the League of Nations.

  1. a) Member countries were not willing to take disputes to the international court of

justice.

  1. b) German was still determined to increase its military strength and continue with its aggression policy.
  2. c) Individual nations were more pre-occupied with national interests and pride, at the expense of the organization’s interests.
  3. d) The Versailles peace settlement resolutions were too harsh to Germany thus leaving the Germans aggrieved and refuse to cooperate with the League of Nations.
  4. e) The League of Nations lacked the executive authority to implement its resolutions.
  5. f) USA congress refused to ratify the treaty of the League of Nations. This denied the organization diplomatic and economic strength.
  6. g) There was shortage of funds to implement the functions of the League of Nations.
  7. h) The Appeasement Policy of Britain and France forced them to stand aside and avoid taking a firm action against Japan when she invaded china, Germany when she invaded and occupied Rhineland, and Italy when she attacked Ethiopia.

The Second World War.

The 1930’s witnessed the rise of dictators in Europe like Adolf Hitler of Germany, Benito Mussolini of Italy and General Francisco Franco of Spain who intentionally defied international opinion and disregarded the Versailles Treaty and League of Nations. Their activities and those of Japan began to interfere with prevailing peace in the world. This happened at the time when USA had retreated into isolation leaving the task of maintaining world peace only to Britain and France.The Second World War involved most countries in the world with millions of people conscripted for service in both the military and war related industries.

Causes of the Second World War.

  1. a) Germany’s dissatisfaction based on territorial grievances.

The Versailles treaty of 1919 imposed harsh and humiliating conditions on Germany, which aggrieved the Germans to the level of being ready to go to war again.

  1. b) The rise of nationalism in Europe.

In Germany, the chancellor, Adolf Hitler who had the desire to dominate the whole

world, fuelled it. For example, he encouraged German speakers in Sudetenland,

Czechoslovakia to demand independence from Czechoslovakia. Italy under Mussolini invaded Ethiopia, in 1939 to regain her lost glory and national pride after the Adowa defeat I 1896. Syria rose up against France.

  1. c) Political developments in Europe.

In Italy in 1922, the fascist government under Benito Mussolini came to power. In

Germany, Hitler’s Nazi government assumed power in 1933. The Fascist government in Italy emphasized on the regaining of lost glory. The Nazi government began a fresh new policy of aggression.

  1. d) The economic problems caused by the great depression of 1929 to 1931.

The great slump led to widespread unemployment, declining wages, poverty etc. these led to social discontent and political unrest in many countries of the world.

  1. e) The failure of Germany to pay reparations.

This was followed by the French invasion of the Ruhr industrial region- a German

territory. This led to increased tension.

  1. f) Weakening of the League of Nations.

Japan left the League of Nations after protest over Manchuria, which she had grabbed, from china. Italy left the League of Nations after Mussolini had grabbed Abyssinia and annexed it against the will of the allies and Ethiopians. Russia invaded Finland in 1939 and the league was unable to intervene. There were many secret treaties among members of the league.

  1. g) The Spanish civil war (1936-1939).

The republican revolution of 1931 ended the Spanish monarchy. The struggle between the royalists and socialists, however, continued. The European powers took sides in the civil war. France, Britain and Russia supported the royalists. Germany and Italy supported General Franco who was fighting from exile in Morocco.

  1. h) Growth of military alliances.

Hitler and Mussolini established a military pact in 1936 (The Berlin-Rome Axis). it

became the Berlin-Rome-Tokyo Axis with the joining of Italy. The alliance between Russia and German to divide Poland widened the gap between them and the allied forces. It created fear and suspicion.

  1. i) The invasion of Poland by Germany.

This happened in September 1939 was the immediate cause of the war. This upset

Britain and France, who stated their intensions of assisting Poland. They declared war on Germany in October 1939.

COURSE OF WORLD WAR 2

The invasion of Poland by German forces on 1St of September 1939 and the subsequent declaration of war against Germany by Britain and France on 3rd of September 1939 marked the beginning of the Second World War. Meanwhile on 17 th September 1939,

the USSR attacked Poland from the East, as per the secret clause in the Nazi -Soviet act of August 1939. Poland had been overrun by German and Russian forces by 27

th September 1939. The country was divided between Russia and Germany.

The phoney war.

This was a period during world war two when no major military operations were

undertaken on the western front although war had been declared on Germany by

France and Britain. The period lasted eight months from 3rd of September 1939. It was used by the Allied countries to fully mobilise their forces for an attack on Germany since they had not initially been prepared. Hitler on his part did not want to be involved in war in the west since his armies had not fully recovered from the consequents in the east.

During this period, two unsuccessful attempts were made to bring peace;

  1. a) On 6th October 1939, Hitler and Stalin of Russia made an attempt to convince the

to accept the Nazi Occupation of Poland and make peace.

  1. b) On 7th October, King Leopold of Belgium and Queen Wilhelmina of Netherlands appealed to the Axis powers and the Western Allies to make peace.

War in Western Europe.On 9th April 1940, Hitler launched a sea-borne invasion against Norway after attacking Denmark via land. They were assisted by a Norwegian Nazi sympathiser Vidkund Quisling. The prime minister of Norway and his Ministers fled to London and Hitler established a puppet government in the country. The defeat of British and French forces in Norway sparked off a parliamentary revolution in Britain forcing the PM Neville Chamberlain to resign to be replaced by Sir Winston Churchill.

Germany extended their attack on Luxembourg, Netherlands and Belgium. The Allies were unable to contain the German advance and even retreated to the French port of Dunkirk, marking a major defeat of the allies in Europe.On 14th June 1940, the Germans captured Paris forcing the new Prime Minister Paul Reynaud to sue for peace with Hitler on 22nd June 1940. Under the peace agreement, The Germans took over Alsace –Lorraine, Northern France and the Atlantic coastline. the French government fled to Vichy, southern France.

Why the French were defeated so quickly.

  1. a) The French forces were not psychologically prepared for the war and thus were

found divided.

  1. b) The French forces were not as well organized as the Germans thus exposing

various military weaknesses. For example, the Germans were supported by

combat planes which the French did not use.

  1. c) Poor communication between the army and the airforce. The French generals

failed to coordinate the war properly to the extend of ignoring the fact that the

Airforce could have been used to drive German Bombers off.

Having succeeded in their Paris onslaught, the Germans attacked Britain in July 1940.

However, Winston Churchill, the British Premier, had mobilized forces to resist this

attack successfully he even obtained reinforcement from USA.

The battle of Britain determined the future of World War II. It forced Hitler to delay his attacks.

War in North Africa.

WWII in Africa was marked by the Italian successful attack on French and British

Somaliland. Under Marshal Graziani, the Italian forces advanced to Egypt though

unsuccessful. In June1942, German forces moved to North Africa to reinforce the

Italians.However, British forces led by General Bernard Montgomery moved quickly and

captured Malta which would have been used as a base for attack by the Germans.

General Montgomery attacked the Germans at El Alamein in Egypt, forcing them to

move to west. On 8thNovember 1942, British and American forces invaded Morocco and Algeria.Although the Germans continued fighting in Tunisia, by May 1943, their Army under General Rommel had surrendered.

War in the Balkans.

In August 1940, Hitler Attacked and captured Romania and Bulgaria. In April 1941,

Yugoslavia and Greece were taken. Crete was taken in May 1941.On 22nd June 1941, Hitler attacked USSR forcing the Russian troops to retreat. However, he failed to capture Moscow before the onset of winter. In June 1942, the Germans resumed their offensive. They were finally defeated at the battle of Stalingrad on 31st January 1943 by the Russian Red Army led by Marshal Zhukov. The Germans lost 300,000 men while 100,000 survivors surrendered. By May 1944, the Russians had pushed the Germans from their territory and were approaching Germany itself.

Why the Germans were defeated during the Russian Invasion.

  1. a) The Germany army was fighting in several fronts at the same time as compared

to the allies. This lack of concentration in one area allowed the other Russian

army to defeat them.

  1. b) The soviet forces employed the scorched earth policy which left very little for the German forces.
  2. c) The Germans ill-treated the soviet people and exploited their economic

resources causing resentment and unity to fight with determination.

  1. d) Weak leadership by the German military leaders contributed to their defeat.

USA entry into World War I.

The Japanese attack on the American great Naval Base at Pearl Harbour on the Hawaiian island is the one incident that dragged USA into WWII.On 8th December 1941, the USA, Britain and the Netherlands declared war on Japan. The Germans and Italians also declared war on the USA. Russia kept off the war in Asia having signed a treaty with Japan.Japan resisted fiercely. Her airforce sank two British battleships on 10th December 1941.She captured Hong Kong, Malaya in Malaysia and took over the great naval base at Singapore. She also occupied Burma, Dutch East Indies, the Philippines and parts of the western pacific islands.The Japanese forces were repulsed while on their way to Port Moresby, New Guinea in may 1942.In 1942, Britain used her bases in India to attack Japan. Japan attacked India in 1944, but the strong and large allied forces defeated the Japanese at the battle of Kohima.

The defeat of Germany.

After 1942, the tide of success began to turn against Hitler. German forces were

defeated by the allies in North Africa and France. By March 1945, the Allies had crossed the Rhine, pushed the Germans out of France in June 1944.The Germans were meanwhile facing the Russian attack from the East. Hitler accepted defeated and handed over power to one of the Military Generals to retreat to an underground Bunker in Berlin.On 29th April 1945, Hitler married his long term Mistress Eva Braun. On the following day, he committed suicide by shooting himself while Eva Braun took Poison. On 7th May 1945, the Germans surrendered unconditionally

Why the Germans were defeated.

  1. a) Germany had acquired far too many territories and she was unable to effectively

control them.

  1. b) The USSR recovered from her losses and began to rearm in a bid to fight against

Germany.

  1. c) The USA entry into the war in 1941 on the side of the allies contributed to the

eventual defeat of the Germans.

  1. d) Germany’s Axis powers were only four, fighting against more than 27 allies. Even among the Germany collaborators, Italy surrendered while Bulgaria and Romania also were a burden to the Germans.

The defeat of Japan.

After Germany surrender, Japan continued with fierce fighting sometimes employing the services of suicide bombers known as Kamikaze. The allies were able to liberate the territories captured by Japan

After the defeat at Okinawa, Japan was certain of defeat, but her PM , Admiral Suzuki Kantaro, did not believe in unconditional defeat. On 6th August 1945, a bomber Aeroplane, Enola Gay, commanded by Colonel Paul Tibbets, flew over Hiroshima dropping a 4535.15kg atomic bomb. About 78,000 people died. On 8th August 1945,

Russia attacked Japan. On 9th August 1945, an even larger Bomb was dropped on

Nagasaki killing more than 40,000 people.

Japan surrendered unconditionally on 15th August 1945 bringing WWII to an end.

Factors that enabled the allied powers to win the Second World War.

  1. a) Allies had more wealth in terms of food, raw materials and equipments.
  2. b) Allies controlled the North Sea, which ensured safe transportation of troops and

equipment. They were also able to block the central powers in the sea.

  1. c) Entry of USA in the war led to defeat of Germany. America had strong American air force and war resources,
  2. d) Germany’s inability to control her expansive territories and some turned against her and in favour of the allied powers.
  3. e) The unity, morale and determination of the allied leaders and fighters.
  4. f) Popular sentiment was for allied victory and Hitler’s defeat.
  5. g) Hitler’s over-confidence and craziness did not allow him to comprehend the

enormity of opposition up against him and the axis forces.

  1. h) External support especially from the colonial people in Africa, Asia and elsewhere.
  2. i) Axis powers dropped out of war one by one.
  3. j) Allies had better industries and financial resources/ superior economy, war tactics and superior diplomacy by all the allied powers.
  4. k) The axis powers made serious tactical mistakes e.g. Hitler failed to prepare for a

winter campaign in Russia and was obsessed with the idea that Germans must not

retreat.

  1. l) When the USSR recovered from her losses, she rearmed her self and attacked

Germany.

Social results of Second World War

  1. a) Depopulation and great suffering as Millions of people perished either in war or due to famine and diseases.
  2. b) People suffered psychologically and emotionally from the loss of loved ones and

torture of the war.

  1. c) The end of the war witnessed change in the status of women. Women started doing work, which was initially monopolized by men. E.g. military and management.
  2. d) There was permanent ill health and shortening of life for millions of peoples because of years of under- nourishment or captivity.
  3. e) There was massive Destruction of property such as homes, houses, buildings, roads and bridges.
  4. f) A large number of people were displaced as people moved to look for peaceful areas and this led to great suffering. The new refugees included the Jews, Slavs and the poles.
  5. g) The war fomented bitter feelings and mistrust among the countries that fought
  6. h) The war helped to shade off the myth popularized by Europeans that they were a

superior race to Africans as European causalities in the war proved that they were

mortals

Identify the political effects of the World War II.

  1. a) Defeat of axis powers led to government changes in Germany, Italy and Japan.
  2. b) The division of Europe into two opposing blocks led to the cold war, which was

followed by an arms race between USA and USSR.

  1. c) Germany was divided into two. The communist East and the capitalist West. The city of Berlin was also divided between the east and the west.
  2. d) Germany and Italy were weakened especially with the loss of their colonies.
  3. e) S.A & U.S.S.R emerged as superpowers. The pre-war balance of power was

destroyed and the power vacuum was filled by two new superpowers, the USA and

USSR

  1. f) A weakness of the League of Nations to prevent the outbreak of war was

demonstrated. This Led to UNO formation.

  1. g) There was rise of nationalism in Asia and Africa. It led to Africans struggle for

independence because they were confident knowing that Europeans were no

superior to them. Nationalists among the Asians leading to attainment of

independence in Pakistan and India in 1947, in Burma (Myanmar) in 1948, and in

Ceylon (Sri Lanka.) in 1949.

  1. h) The Japanese destroyed the myth of European military superiority due to the defeat of British and American forces in the Far East.
  2. i) New states were created. In 1948, the state of Israel was established in the Middle East, to settle the Jews who were displaced during the war.

Economic effects of World War 2.

  1. a) Agriculture and industries were disrupted due to lack of equipment, raw materials and human resources.
  2. b) External trade almost came to a standstill because of fear and insecurity.
  3. c) It led to increased dependency on colonies by European powers. There was need of raw materials to reconstruct the destroyed industries.
  4. d) Some Industries were established in the colonies to manufacture goods because of the difficulties faced in running them during the war.
  5. e) It led to the rise of European economic cooperation. The post war economic

destructions led to the need for cooperation. This paved way for formation of the

European Economic Community in 1957.

INTERNATIONAL RELATIONS

International Relations refers to the cooperation or interaction between individuals or groups of nations of the world

Benefits of international relations.

  1. a) Enhance peace and security in the world the diplomatic policies of nations call for peaceful settlement of disputes, thus reducing war incidences.
  2. b) Promote understanding and unity. This done through Encouraging cultural exchange between nations.
  3. c) Help in getting collectives solutions to world problems. Problems of global concern like desertification, global warming, armament and environmental pol lution, are dealt with collectively.
  4. d) Promote economic growth through trade. Due to good relations , there is expanded international trade which enables countries to acquire goods they don’t produce
  5. e) Developing countries get financial assistance. Developed nations have continued to provide financial and technical assistance to developing nations

Ways in which nations relate internationally.

  1. a) Economic relations. This is through trade and commercial activities among nations.

For example, developed nations giving loans and grants to developing nations.

  1. b) Diplomatic relations. This is a peaceful means of relationship between nations in

which there is exchange of Ambassadors or High Commissioners.

  1. c) Political relations. This involves cooperation between countries with similar political systems or ideologies. E.g. USA and Western Europe, in 1964, Tanganyika united with the island of Zanzibar to form the United Republic of Tanzania.
  2. d) Socio-cultural relations. This takes place in form of exchange and competition

between dance troops, musicians, acrobats, sports teams, theatre groups etc, e.g.

participation in Commonwealth Games.

International Organizations

There are two types of international organizations;

  1. International Governmental Organizations (IGOs) for example UN,

Commonwealth, NAM and African Union.( formed by two or more sovereign

states).

  1. International Non-Governmental Organizations (NGOs) created by individuals or private organizations. E.g. International Red cross, Amnesty International and Transparency International.

Role played by International Governmental Organizations.

  1. a) The provide member states with a forum to consult and tackle problems of

concern.

  1. b) They act as regulators in their fields to ensure the welfare of Humankind e.g

World Health Organization (WHO) regulates health sector through immunization, vaccination and other prevention campaigns.

  1. c) They enhance peace and security through peace-keeping missions and response

to disasters.

  1. d) They contribute to charity and facilitate equitable distribution of resources in the

world. For example, the International Monetary Fund (IMF) and World Bank

advance loans to developing nations.

THE UNITED NATIONS.

The UN was founded after world war Two as an organization of independent states

with the following objectives;

  1. a) To promote and maintain international peace and security and prevent the

occurrence of another world war.

  1. b) To foster friendly relations among nations of the world.
  2. c) To promote respect for fundamental human rights and freedoms.
  3. d) To promote social progress and better living standards of the people.
  4. e) To protect the interests of minority groups such as women and children.
  5. f) To promote economic growth among member states who are working towards

reconstructing the world economy that was destroyed by the World War 2.

  1. g) To replace the league of nations which had collapsed before the outbreak of

world war 2

Formation of the United Nations.

The signing of the Allied declaration in London on 12th  June 1941 marked the first step in the formation of the UN. On 14th August 1941, Franklin Delano Roosevelt of USA and Winston Churchill of Britain, meeting in USA, proposed a set of principles for international collaboration in maintaining peace and security.  This was the Atlantic Charter. The charter pledged respect for human Freedom, Allowed all nations the freedom to choose the form of government they preferred and provided that no territory should change hands after war without consent of its people.On 1st January 1942, representatives of Allied nations meeting in Washington signed the ‘Declaration by United Nations’ and proclaimed support for the Atlantic Charter. This marked the first official use of the term ‘United Nations’ as suggested by President Roosevelt in reference to the 26 nations. The first Blueprint of the UN was prepared at a conference held at Dumbarton Oaks Estate, Washington from 21st September to 7th October 1944. Representatives of USSR, USA, UK and China agreed on the aims, structure and functions of a world organization.On 11th February 1945, the Yalta Conference held by US president Roosevelt, UK PM Churchill and Russian PM Stalin declared the resolve to establish an international organization to maintain peace and security.On 25th April 1945, the United Nations Conference on International Organization began in San Francisco, USA attended by delegates from 50 nations. It drew a 111 Article Charter which was adopted on 25th June 1945.The UN began its official functions on 24th October 1945 after ratification of the charter by USSR, USA, Britain, China and France.

Organization of the UNO.

Membership to the UN is open to all peace-loving nations that accept the obligations of the charter. By 1945, only 51 states had signed the charter. Kenya Joined on 16th December 1963By April 2003 membership had grown to 191 states.

To achieve its aims, the UN spelt out in its charter the following principles;

  1. a) It is based on the sovereign equality of all its members.
  2. b) All member states must fulfil, in good faith, their charter obligations.
  3. c) All member states must settle international disputes by peaceful means and

without endangering peace, security and justice.

  1. d) They must refrain, in their international relations, from the threat or use of force

against others.

  1. e) They must give the United Nations every assistance to any action it takes in

accordance with the charte`r, and shall not assist states against which the United

Nations is taking preventive or enforcement action.

  1. f) The United Nations must ensure that states which are not members act in

accordance with these principles insofar as necessary for maintenance of

international peace and security.

The UNO structure comprises six principal organs as follows;

THE GENERAL ASSEMBLY

This is the main deliberative organ of the UNO, but which cannot enforce action on

members. It comprises all member states.

Functions of the UN General Assembly.

To help in its operation, the general assembly has the following committees;

The political and security committee, the special political committee, the economic and financial committee, the committee on social ,humanitarian and cultural issues, the trusteeship committee , the administration/budget committee and the legal affairs committee.

THE SECURITY COUNCIL

It has 15 members from 15 countries. Ten of these are non -permanent. It also has five permanent members namely china, France, USA, Russia and UK.Its main function is to maintain world peace and security.

ECONOMIC AND SOCIAL COUNCIL

Its membership is 54. 18 are elected each year for a term of three years.Its function is to coordinate the economic and social work of UN and its specialized agencies. E.g. in trade, status of women. Population, science and technology.

TRUSTEESHIP COUNCIL.

It inherited the work of the Mandates Commission of the former League of Nations.

It had responsibility over the territories under colonial rule-. – To promote social,

economic, political and educational advancement of the inhabitants of the trust

territories.Consists of five permanent members and six additional ones appointed by the General Assembly.

THE SECRETARIAT.

The head of the secretariat is the secretary general. It has its headquarters in New York.

Its staff members come from 139 countries. Its work covers all areas outlined in the UN Charter.

THE INTERNATIONAL COURT OF JUSTICE.

It has its headquarters at Hague. It is the principal judicial body of the UN. It gives

advisory opinions on legal questions. It has 15 judges.

SPECIALIZED AGENCIES.

These are separate specialized agencies which are autonomous organizations related to the UN by special agreements. (REF TO PAGE 49 OF EVOLVING WORLD)

Past Secretary Generals of the United Nations Organization since its inception.

  1. a) Trygve lie of Norway (1946-1953).
  2. b) Dag Hammarskjöld of Sweden (1953-1961)
  3. c) U Thant of Burma (1961-1971)
  4. d) Kurt Waldheim of Austria (1972-1982)
  5. e) Javier Perez de Cueller of Peru (1982-1991)
  6. f) Boutros Ghali Boutros. Of Egypt (1992-1996)
  7. g) Kofi Annan of Ghana (1997-2000)
  8. h) Ban Ki Moon.(2000 up to present)

Achievements  of the United Nations Organization.

  1. a) The organization has succeeded in keeping peace amid the threats of nuclear war

and seemingly endless regional conflicts in the world. UNO has developed more than 35 peacekeeping missions and observer nations.

  1. b) The UN specialized agencies are engaged in a vast array of social work, affecting positively, every aspect of people’s lives around the world. E.g., child survival and development, environmental protection, medical research, agricultural

development, education etc.

  1. c) The organization has helped in promoting democracy around the world. It has

enabled people in more than 45 countries to participate in free and fair elections,

e.g. in Namibia, Cambodia, El Salvador, Eritrea, Mozambique, South Africa etc.

  1. d) The UNO has promoted development of skills and potentials vital for all aspects of development. The UNDP, in close co-operation with over 170 member states and

the UN agencies designs and implements projects for agriculture, industry, education and environment.

  1. e) It has helped in promotion of Human Rights. Since the adoption of the u niversal

declaration of human rights in 1948, the UN has helped to enact more than 80

agreements on political, civil, economic, social and cultural rights.

  1. f) It has played a vital role in environmental protection. ‘The Earth Summit’, the UN Conference On Environment and Development held in Rio De Janeiro in 1992,

resulted in treaties on biodiversity and climate change

  1. g) Promoting self-determination and independence. The organization has brought

about independence of 80 countries that are now among its member states.

  1. h) Providing humanitarian aid to victims of conflicts. More than 30 million refugees fleeing war, famine or persecution have received aid from the UN high commission for refugees since 1951.

Problems facing the United Nations Organization in its operation.

  1. a) National sovereignty. Many countries disregard the UNO resolutions in favour of their sovereignty.
  2. b) It is unable to stop aggressions and conflicts between individual countries when

super powers are involved.

  1. c) Lacks sufficient funds to carry out its work efficiently. E.g it has not always been able to send enough peacekeeping forces due to lack of sufficient funds.
  2. d) It lacks an effective machinery to affect its decisions. It also lacks a standing army to implement and effect its resolutions.
  3. e) The permanent members with veto powers often adopt policies that promote their own national interests at the expense of the collective interests of most countries in the world.
  4. f) Loyalty to other organizations. UNO members are also members of other

organizations; the interests of these organizations are not in accord with those of

the UNO.

  1. g) Ideological disputes among member states have hampered the work of UNO in

promoting world peace. This was manifested in the cold war period.

  1. h) The arms race. The UNO has found it difficult to achieve world peace because of the arms race in different parts of the world. The arms race generates and sustains conflict rather than peace.
  2. i) Differences in economic development levels of member states militate against cooperation.
  3. j) The increased occurrence of natural disasters such as famine, floods and epidemics has created an unexpected demand for economic resources. This automatically the UN’s resources.

THE COMMONWEALTH.

Origin and structure of Commonwealth of Nations.

It is a voluntary association of 54 sovereign countries around the world, which were

initially part of the British Empire.The commonwealth origin is the British Empire

comprising the British protectorates, colonies and dominions, which included Australia, New Zealand, Canada, Newfoundland, Irish Free State and South Africa. The idea to launch the association is traced back to 1839, with the publication of the Durham report.The modern commonwealth began in 1947 with the end of the British rule in India.

In 1949, India and Pakistan joined the commonwealth.The commonwealth secretariat is based in London. It deals with day to day running of the organization and organizes meetings. The head of the commonwealth is the Queen/King of England. The Commonwealth has the Heads of State Summit which meets for a week every two years to discuss political and economic issues.There are also the Ministerial meetings once after every three years to deal with different issues.

The commonwealth has specialized agencies dealing with various areas of concern.

Membership to commonwealth.

It comprised 54 developed and developing nations. The members are categorized as

follows;

  1. Britain and her Dominions of Canada, Australia and New Zealand.
  2. African Nations.
  3. Asian nations.
  4. Islands from the Caribbean, Pacific and Mediterranean.

Characteristics of commonwealth states.

  1. a) Members of the commonwealth use English as a common language.
  2. b) Members maintain cultural ties. For instance, they participate in the commonwealth games every four years.
  3. c) Members co-operate in the field of education.
  4. d) Members recognize the queen of England as the head of commonwealth.
  5. e) Members have a common military tradition based on the British military system.

They also promote military exchange programmes.

  1. f) Members share common democratic institutions from Britain such as parliamentary system of government.
  2. g) Members have adopted constitutions that are almost similar.

Objectives that led to the formation of the commonwealth nations.

  1. a) To promote world peace and international understanding. Members are expected to abide by the UN Peace programmes.
  2. b) To promote development of poor member states.
  3. c) To intensify co-operation between member states, in matters of education, sport

and economic development.

  1. d) To ensure personal liberty and equality of rights to all citizens regardless of race,

colour, creed or political beliefs.

  1. e) To oppose all forms of colonial dominion by being committed to the principles of human dignity and equality, self-determination and non-racism.
  2. f) To promote the exchange of knowledge, professionalism and cultural, economic,

legal and political issues.

  1. g) T fights poverty, ignorance and disease to remove wealth disparities and raise the living standards, and achieve a more equitable international soci ety.
  2. h) To enhance free international trade by removing trade barriers, bur tat the same

time, giving due consideration to the special requirements of the developing

countries.

Organization of the Commonwealth.

The structure of the commonwealth comprises of three organs;

  1. The Head of state Summit. It meets once in every two years for a week for

extensive decisions and consultations. Decisions are reached by consensus.

  1. Ministerial Meetings. The commonwealth ministers of Finance, Foreign Affairs

and defence hold regular meetings once every year. Ministers of Health,

Education and Law hold meetings once every three years

  1. The Commonwealth Secretariat: headed by the secretary general and with a

staff of 350 drawn from member countries. It co-ordinates co-operation among

members. The first secretary General was Arnold Smith of Canada. In 1990, Chief

Emeka Anyaoku of Nigeria became the first African Secretary General.

  1. Specialized Agencies.
  2. a) The Commonwealth Fund for Technical Co-Operation; supplies funds,

finance, experts and advisers for projects carried out in member states.

  1. b) The Commonwealth Agricultural Bureau; it provides co-operation in the

field of agriculture.

  1. c) The Commonwealth Parliamentary Association; helps to improve relations

between parliamentarians of member states.

  1. d) The Commonwealth Regional Health Secretariat for East, Central and

Southern Africa; promotes co-operation in health.

benefits of  membership to  Commonwealth.

  1. a) Member states have received technical expertise through the provision of experts

and advisers in various fields e.g. agriculture.

  1. b) The developing member states of the organization have acquired skilled manpower through the provision of scholarship and setting up of training programmes by nations like Britain and Canada.
  2. c) Member states have been able to interact with one another through activities such as the commonwealth games and cultural exchange programmes.
  3. d) Member states have conducted trade among themselves with relative ease and this has helped them to develop their economies.
  4. e) The organization has promoted friendship and understanding among member states through conferences such as The Heads of Government meetings.
  5. f) It has enhanced democratization process in developing member states of the

organization

Functions of commonwealth (REF to evolving world page 60)

Problems facing Commonwealth of Nations.

  1. a) Differences in economic development levels of member states militate against cooperation. Members coming from developing world have very different outlook

from those coming from the developed world.

  1. b) Ideological disputes among member states have hampered the operations of the

Commonwealth of Nations.

  1. c) Lacks sufficient funds to carry out its work efficiently. Poor members normally owe many debts to their foreign masters and would therefore toe to their demands.
  2. d) The problem of sovereignty. Many countries disregard the commonwealth

resolutions in favour of their sovereignty.

  1. e) It lacks an effective machinery to affect its decisions. It also lacks a standing army to implement and effect its resolutions.
  2. f) Loyalty to other organizations. commonwealth members are also members of other organizations; the interests of these organizations are not in accord with those of the commonwealth
  3. g) The colonial legacy. Many problems arising from past colonial policies have rocked the organization. E.g. the land issue in Zimbabwe.
  4. h) The influence of other organizations like NATO who weaken the commonwealth by wooing members to their regions.
  5. i) Race and colour problem. The conflict between white and black people or other

color has become another setback.

  1. j) Dominance by the big powers. This has caused dismay to the organization. Serious inner tension still undermines the commonwealth activities.

THE NON-ALIGNED MOVEMENT

NAM STRUCTURE AND ORGANIZATION

NAM was an organization that did not have formal structures like UNO and

Commonwealth. It did not have a secretariat or a constitution. The movement had a

unique administrative style as follows.

Coordination

The administration is non-hierarchical, rotational and inclusive, providing all member states, regardless of size and importance with an opportunity to participate in global decision making and world politics.The country that hosts the summit holds office until the next summit. Non-aligned countries place the onus of an administrative structure on the country assuming the chair. The country is required to create or designate an entire section of the ministry of foreign affairs to deal specifically with the Non-Aligned Movement. The chair’s ambassador in the United Nations essentially functions as the ‘minister of Non-Aligned Affairs’.NAM has also created contact groups, task forces and committees to facilitate the chair’s responsibility as follows;

The Coordinating Bureau.

This is the focal point for coordination. It reviews and facilitates the harmonization of the NAM working groups, contact groups, task forces and committees. Working Groups, Contact Groups, Task Forces and Committees.They include NAM High-level working group for the restructuring of the United Nations, NAM working group on Human Rights, Disarmament, Committee on Palestine, Contact Groups on Cyprus, and Task Force on Somalia etc. these groupings meet often.

Non-Aligned security Caucus.

The countries that make up the NAM council caucus are expected to constantly strive to adopt unified positions so that the decisions and positions of NAM are reflected in the Security Council decisions without prejudice to their sovereignty.

Joint coordinating committee

This is a coordinating committee established in 1994 and sitting in New York, whose main mandate is to promote cooperation and coordination between the NAM and the Group of 77 in promoting the interests of developing countries in international fora.

Coordination of non-aligned countries in the UN centres.

This is aimed at facilitating coordination and cooperation with the coordinating bureau and enhances the role of NAM in the international Fora.

The Troika.

The concept of Troika emerged on 6th April 1997 in New Delhi, India, during the meeting of foreign ministers of NAM representing past, present and future chairs. The concept simply implies a meeting of past, present and future chairs who began to meet in September 1997 as a discussion forum.

Panel of economists

This is an ad hoc panel of economists formed from Non-Aligned countries to assess the current international economic situation from the perspective of developing countries and to identify and analyze their major issues of concern.

Documentation.

This is the responsibility of the host country but after wide consultation. The host

country must circulate the First Draft not later than one month before the meeting.

Decision making.

The movement makes all its decisions by consensus. This concept presupposes

understanding of and respect for different points of view, including disagreement and mutual accommodation. This promotes solidarity and unity of the movement.

NAM Meetings

They include the following

  1. a) Conference of Heads of State and Government. This is NAM’s highest decisionmaking authority and meets once every three years. It has two committees, one on political issues and another on economic and social issues. The summit is held atleast one month before the regular session of the UN General Assembly. During the summit, there is a formal ceremony for handing over the chair.
  2. b) Ministerial conference. Its task is to review developments and implement decisions of the preceding summit and also discuss matters of urgency. The conference meets 18 months after the summit.
  3. c) Ministerial meeting in New York during a session of the UN General Assembly. This is a meeting of foreign ministers annually in New York at the beginning of the regular session of the UN Assembly. The purpose of the meeting is to deliberate on the items of the Agenda of the General Assembly that are of major importance to the movement.
  4. d) Ministerial Meeting of the Coordinating Bureau. The main task is to prepare for the summits, and where necessary, to consider issues of major importance to the

movement.

  1. e) Meeting of the Ministerial Committee on Methodology. The attendance is by all

NAM members and its meetings are held by the decision of the summit or the

ministerial conference. The meetings are chaired by the chair of NAM.

  1. f) Meeting of the standing ministerial committee on economic cooperation. These

meetings are meant to strengthen south-south cooperation, reactivate the dialogue

between the developing and developed countries and enhance the role of the UN

General Assembly, in international cooperation for development. The meetings are

held frequently upon recommendation of the coordinating Bureau.

  1. g) Ministerial Meetings in various fields of international cooperation. They discuss

issues like agriculture, information and external debt.

  1. h) Extraordinary Meetings of the Coordinating Bureau. They address exceptional

cases that call for urgent consideration.

  1. i) Meetings of the Working Groups, Task Forces, Contact Groups and Committees.

The meetings are held as often as necessary.

The growth of NAM.

After the Bandung Conference of 1955 which established the movement, NAM has

attracted many developing counties. . A number of conferences have been held since then;

  1. a) The first summit, Belgrade, 1961. The attendance was by 25 non-aligned countries who met at a time when world peace was threatened seriously by the looming nuclear war. The meeting’s objective was to prevent the outbreak of a nuclear war in the world.
  2. b) The second summit, Cairo, 1964. The summit of October 1964 was attended by 47 Nations and 10 observers. There were 28 representatives from Africa. The

conference mainly focused on problems facing NAM countries due to colonial

inheritance, policies of former colonial powers and the rivalry between the great

powers..

  1. c) The third summit, Lusaka, 1970. The attendance was by 53 members the meeting resolved that time was ripe for declaration on peace, independence, cooperation and democratization. The members were out to fight colonialism and racism. The main resolution was the members’ determination to achieve economic

emancipation.

  1. d) The Fourth Summit, Algiers, 1973. It was attended by 75 members, eight observers, three guest nations and 15 liberation movements. The meeting was an attempt to transform the existing system of economic and financial relations in a manner that would liberate developing countries from a subordinate role into an equal position with industrialized countries. The members developed an action programme in the interest of economic cooperation.
  2. e) The fifth Summit, Colombo, 1976. It was attended by 86 members, who focused on the liberation of Zimbabwe and Namibia, the abolition of apartheid in South Africa as a way of promoting world peace.
  3. f) The sixth Summit, Havana, 1979. The conference was attended by 93 members, 12 observers, 8 guest nations and seven new members. The meeting declared that

imperialism, colonialism, neo-colonialism, apartheid, racism, foreign aggression,

expansion, occupation, domination, interference or hegemony, Great power bloc,

Subjugation, dependency and pressures in international relations as enemies of nonalignment. The chairman of the summit was Fidel Castro who put forth his ideas that the socialist bloc is a natural ally of the movement.

  1. g) The seventh summit, New Delhi, 1983. It was attended by 96 members, 16

observers and 20 guest nations. The summit took place at a time when there was

intense confrontation as the great powers continued to amass nuclear weapons. .

Indra Gandhi appeared to be the moderate leader to host the conference and soften

the impact of Cuban radicalism. The conference discussed peace, nuclear

disarmament, development strategies for north-south Dialogue on a new world

economic order, and the south-south cooperation for collective self-reliance.

  1. h) The eighth summit, Harare, 1986. It marked NAM’s silver Jubilee. The main concern was Namibia’s independence and apartheid in south Africa.. NAM emphasized its sanctions against the Pretoria (South Africa) regime. It drew an action plan to deal with the threat posed by South Africa. The summit came up with a special solidarity fund to help the frontline states.
  2. i) The Ninth summit, Belgrade, 1989.
  3. j) The tenth Summit, Jakarta, 1992.
  4. k) The eleventh Summit, Cartagena de Indias, 1995.
  5. l) The twelfth Summit, Durban 1998.
  6. m) The thirteenth Summit, Kuala Lumpar, 2003.

Performance of the Non-Aligned Movement.

Though critics have questioned the relevance of NAM after dismantling apartheid and achieving independence, and after end of cold war, there still exist situations that require NAM’s participation.

Reasons why NAM is still relevant.

  1. a) NAM is the only forum that can articulate the voice of justice and sanity in the

world in view of the unending Arms Race.

  1. b) NAM is the only forum through which the demand for a less unjust world economic order can be raised given the kind of hold the developed nations still have on developing nations.
  2. c) NAM remains the third world’s shield against the pressures of the superpower

elephants that can easily trample on the grass of the lesser animals even after end

of cold war.

  1. d) NAM can still play a role in addressing emerging world issues such as terrorism,

environmental degradation, HIV/AIDS and racism.

Achievements of NAM.

  1. a) It has helped speed up the attainment of freedom in states that were under colonial bondage.
  2. b) NAM has assisted its members in safeguarding their national security and territorial integrity.
  3. c) Nan-aligned nations also worked to eliminate conflict between the superpowers.

This helped in the promotion of peace and security for the non-aligned world. India

for example played a role in solving the Korean War, the Suez crisis and IndoChinese conflict.

  1. d) NAM created a conducive environment for peace, justice, equality and international cooperation by contributing to the relaxation of international tension by keeping clear of the two military blocs, USA and USSR.
  2. e) The movement has strengthened African and Asian Countries diplomatically at a

time when they lacked necessary physical strength. They were able to exert their

voting power as Afro-Asian bloc to influence world affairs.

  1. f) NAM provided an international forum where members’ voices could be heard. It was able to work to dismantle apartheid by its two-third world community membership despite the Reagan administration’s opposition to sanctions against South Africa.
  2. g) The movement has given members freedom to put their national interests before

those of the great power blocs.

  1. h) The NAM through the Cairo and Colombo Summits termed as World Disarmament conferences, played a key role in the disarmament process. The 1967 Treaty of Tlatelolco, signed by 22 states, set up a weapon Free Zone in Latin America.
  2. i) The Non-aligned states have helped in international crisis management since they are not committed to any course of military action. For example during the 1961 Berlin crisis, Nehru of India and Kwame Nkrumah of Ghana went to Moscow for a peace mission, while Achmad Sukarno of Indonesia and Modibo Keita of Mali went to Washington DC to try and create a conducive atmosphere for managing the crisis.
  3. j) NAM has worked towards creation of new international economic order. Members of the movement are able to trade with both the great power blocs. Membership to the Group of 77 in the United Nations Conference on Trade and Development (UNCTAD) is drawn from the non-aligned nations. The non-aligned nations were open to aid from both blocs and also ready to expand their trade with both sides of the ideological divide.
  4. k) The Solidarity fund established during the Harare Summit of 1986 cushioned the

frontline states against the economic sanctions imposed on apartheid South Africa.

  1. l) NAM has worked to create the new scientific and technological order. The members have demanded a new scientific and technological order by favouring access to the most advanced technology and scientific research available as a means of bridging the technological gap between the developed countries and developing ones.

Factors which have undermined the activities of the Non-Aligned Movement.

  1. a) Political instability is frequently experienced by some member states. For example, civil wars  and  military  coups  in  DRC,  the  Sudan,  Rwanda,  Burundi,  interstate  wars like  in  the  case  of  Iran  and    This  has  undermined  their  contribution  to  the movement.
  2. b) Economic ties  between  the  third  world  countries  and  their  colonial  masters  had made it difficult for the member states to pursue an independent line.
  3. c) Border disputes between neighboring member countries has weakened the course of the movement. E.g. between morocco and Algeria, North Korea and South Korea, Vietnam and Cambodia, Ethiopia and Somalia, Uganda and Tanzania etc.
  4. d) Economic backwardness of some of the member states has made it difficult for them to meet their obligation in the movement as national needs come first in view of the meager resources of some of the nations.
  5. e) Ideological differences  between  member  states  have  undermined  their  co operation.  Its  large  size  of  116  members  by  2004  has  frustrated  its  ideological coherence  and  organizational    Whereas  some  countries  are  inclined towards the west, others are inclined to the east.
  6. f) Membership to  other  organizations  like  AU,  commonwealth  and  the  French

community, has made it  difficult for some states to participate actively in the affairs of the movement.

  1. g) Breakup of  the  Soviet  Union  and  the  end  of  the  Cold  War  has  destabilized  the movement. As power bloc rivalry subsided, NAM appeared to become irrelevant.
  2. h) Conflicting national interests. Individual national interests have failed to agree with the objectives of the movement.
  3. i) Personality differences  between  leaders  of  member  states  have  undermined  the

. For example, several leaders rejected the radical views of Fidel Catron of Cuba.

  1. j) Differences unrelated  to  the  principles  of  NAM  have  developed  among  For example at the Colombo Summit of 1978, several Arab states were keen to see Egypt expelled from the movement on grounds that she had signed a separate peace treaty with Israel. This was not an agreement with a superpower and therefore had nothing to do with NAM.
  2. k) NAM lacks a permanent Army or a permanent institutional framework or machinery that can  enable  it  carry  out  its  activities    For  example,  it  fai led  to persuade irag and Iran to end the 8 year long war from 1980.

THE COLD WAR.

The Cold War refers to the strained relations that existed between the western world

led principally by the United States and the communist East led by the USSR, after the Second World War.

It was so called because it was fought not with weapons, but with words, propaganda, military and financial aid to enemies of the opposing sides.

Although there was no actual physical confrontation, Cold War was characterized by a conflict of the most serious and deadly kind.

Causes of the Cold War.

  1. a) Ideological differences. There was deep-seated fear and mutual suspicion between USA and USSR over the spread of their ideologies–capitalism and communism. E.g The establishment of the Soviet Union through acquisition of satellite states was a measure to contain capitalism.
  2. b) Disagreement over the issue of disarmament. The use of atomic bomb on Japan by USA towards the end of World War II alarmed USSR. The two sides failed to agree on an arms reduction plan and continued to stockpile atomic bombs.
  3. c) Economic rivalry. In 1947, the USA President Harry S. Truman introduced the

Marshal Plan, a scheme to assist western European countries that had been

devastated by war. The USSR in turn formed Council for Mutual Economic Assistance (COMECON), an economic cooperative plan for Eastern Europe. This further heightened the hostility between the west and the east.

  1. d) Formation of military alliances. In April 1949, the USA, western European countries and Canada formed a military alliance through the signing of the North Atlantic Treaty in Washington D.C. (NATO). The formation of NATO ended USA’s isolationist policy. Russians responded by signing the Warsaw Pact, in May 1955, a military alliance of communist countries. These alliances fostered hostility between countries.
  2. e) The use of Russian veto powers in the UN. Russia used her veto powers to defeat UN proposals, which she accused of being pro-USA. The struggle by the two powers to dominate the UN increased tension between them.
  3. f) Disagreement over the future of Germany as a whole. Western allies wanted a

strong Germany to assist in the economic prosperity of other nations. Russia was

keen on a politically and economically weak Germany to safeguard against another

invasion.

NB- in 1961, the USSR built the Berlin Wall, thus dividing East Berlin from West

Berlin.

  1. g) USA’s military advancement. By 1945, the USA was the only country that possessed atomic weapons. This created fear.

COURSE OF THE COLD WAR.

The cold war was fought in Europe Asia, Latin America and Africa,

The course of the Cold War in Europe

The cold war in Europe involved a conflict between the West and the East. The

highlights of this conflict included Russia’s overwhelming encroachment and dominance of Eastern Europe. Russia used her military might to impose communist governments on many states like Poland and Romania. They also fanned civil wars. E.g the Greek civil war of 1946. There were widespread outbreaks of violence and demands of freedoms in Poland and Romania, based on western ideologies, in politics and economy.In Czechoslovakia, communist Russia orchestrated protests against reforms based on western ideologies, by the Dubcek Government, which was supported by the west. Dubcek was arrested and flown to Moscow. Dr. Husak, a Russian ally was installed.

The following are the major developments that characterized cold war in Europe.

  1. a) In March 1947, the US president Harry Truman, through ‘The Truman Doctrine’

declared that the USA would support free people resisting subjugation by armed

minorities. In 1947, USA took over Britain’s commitment in Greece and turkey to

support the anti-communist regimes.

  1. b) In 1947, the US Secretary of state, George Marshall came up with a proposal which was to become the Marshall Plan. This was a plan through which the US would make a major contribution to the economic recovery of Europe. The plan was rejected by USSR terming it an American interference in the internal affairs of

other nations.

  1. c) Stalin set up the Communist Information Bureau (COMINFORM) to coordinate the work of communist parties in Europe and the Council for Mutual Economic

Assistance (COMECON) to counter the US Marshal Plan.

  1. d) The NATO and Warsaw Pact. By the treaty of Brussels in March 1948, Britain,

France, Belgium, Netherlands and Luxembourg formed a defensive alliance against

any form of aggression (It became the North Atlantic Treaty Organization-NATO, in April 1949 when other European Nations joined it.

In response to NATO, the Soviet Union signed the Warsaw Pact in Poland on 14th  May 1955 with East \Germany and six Eastern European countries. The existence

of NATO and Warsaw Pact only intensified the hostilities.

  1. e) The Berlin Blockade. Germany was divided into two zones, East and West. Russia treated East Germany as a satellite state thus curtailing trade between east and west. This move almost led to starvation in the west as East Germany was the

main producer.

In May 1948, all roads and rail routes into West Berlin were sealed off by Russian

troops. For over two years, food, coal medical supplies and other necessities to the

2 million people in West Berlin were airlifted since there was no land linkage. The

blockade ended in may 1949 with diverstating consequences.

  1. f) Partition of Germany. The west was prepared to give freedom to the Germans as a whole to decide their own fate. Russia was determined to ensure that East

Germany remained dominated by communism under Russian control.

On 23rd may 1949, the western occupation zone in Germany became the Federal

Republic of Germany with Konrad Adenauer as the chancellor in September

elections. On 7th October 1949, the soviet zone formed the Germany Democratic Republic.In August 1961, the East Germans built the Berlin Wall, curtailing communication and flow of refugees from the west.

The cold war was fought in Asia.

In Asia, China was the first front of Cold War. She embraced communism, following the successful takeover of the country by the forces of Mao Tse-tung in October 1949, assisted by the Russians. The Sino-Soviet Treaty of friendship was signed in 1950.

Korea, formerly controlled by Japan, was another front for cold war in Asia. When Japan was defeated in 1945, Korea was occupied from the south by American forces, from the north by Russians, placing the country under joint control. The occupying powers failed to unite the two Korea sections when she became independent.In 1948, the USA announced the formation of the Independent Democratic Republic of Korea in the South. The Russians formed the Peoples Republic of Korea in the north.On 25th June 1950, North Korea Forces invaded South Korea in an attempt to unite. UN condemned this and An American General, Douglas MacArthur led the UN forced that repulsed the invaders.

The cold war spread to Vietnam, with USSR and USA clashing over Vietnam, formerly a colony of France that had been seized by Japan. The two super powers supported different nationalist leaders in the struggle for independence from France.The Russians supported Ho Chi-Minh who led a revolt by the Vietnamese, against the French. USA supported Ngo Dinh Diem. The Vietnam War erupted as a resultThe Vietnam War was the heaviest cost of containing communism by Americans in a distant country. Americans were humiliatingly defeated in 1975 with a causality of 53,000, despite employing over 400,000 troops. The communist guerillas, the Viet Cong, established a communist government in South Vietnam. The war strengthened American hostility towards Russia

There was an armed conflict between the super powers in Afghanistan from 1978. The height of the conflict in Afghanistan was the Boycott of the Moscow Olympic Games in 1980 as a protest against USSR’s involvement in Afghanistan. The conflict took the form of a civil war which was only eased in 1989 when the USSR began to withdraw its troops.

The cold war in Latin America (the Cuban Missile Crisis)

Cuba became the theatre of cold war when USA unsuccessfully supported the Cuban dictator, General Fulgencio Batista against Fidel Castro who was fighting to end Batista’s regime. Fidel Castro overthrew the Batista regime in 1958. The new government immediately gained recognition from many world nations including USA and USSR

In 1960, Fidel began a communist nationalization programme of American oil refineries and sugar plantations. This strained relations between him and the US who attempted unsuccessfully to invade Cuba in 1961 at Bay of Pigs. In January 1962, Cuba was expelled from the Organization of American States.In May 1962, USSR leader Nikita Khrushchev secretly built missile installations in Cuba as a means of countering any future American invasion, in exchange for sugar. The discovery, by American president J. F. Kennedy in October 1962, of the Russian missile installations in Cuba was the beginning of the most serious cold war crisis. He declared that any nuclear missile attack from Cuba would be taken to be an attack by the USSR and USA would respond accordingly.USA declared a Naval Quarantine on Cuba to blockade any Russian Vessels

This most serious cold war crisis was only ended when the Russian leader Khrushchev removed the missiles from Cuba and dismantled Russia’s bases in Cuba.

The Cold War in Africa.

The cold war in Africa was majorly witnessed in Ethiopia and Angola.

In Ethiopia, Mengistu Haile – Mariam, overthrew Emperor Haile Selassie in 1974, with the assistance of USSR. Haile Mariam introduced socialist programmes, However, they were short-lived up to the end of his rule in May 1991, when Russians withdrew their assistance.In Angola, on 11th November 1975, Angola attained her independence from Portugal, with the assistance of the Soviet Union and Cuba.Soon after, a bruising civil war broke out. USA supported the rebels, led by Jonas Savimbi and his UNITA movement based in Ovimbudu. Cuba and Russia supported the MPLA government based in Luanda. Democratic elections were held in Angola in 1989, when USSR eased their aid to MPLA.

FACTORS that led to the Cold War détente by world powers.

  1. a) The death of Stalin and the flexibility of Stalin’s successor, Nikita Khrushchev. The successor of Joseph Stalin, after his death in 1953, Nikita Khrushchev, was more flexible and willing to relax both cold war abroad and Authoritarianism at home. He announced the policy of peaceful coexistence in 1956.
  2. b) The willingness of David Dwight Eisenhower, Truman’s successor, to reach

compromise with the Soviet Union over a number of issues. For example he

convened the Camp David Summit in 1959, with Khrushchev in which a cooperative spirit emerged between the east and the west. However this happened against the backdrop of the Cuban missile crisis.

  1. c) The signing of the Strategic Arms Limitation Treaty (The SALT Treaty) in 1972. The treaty, signed between USA and Russia limited strategic arms to certain quantities.

This was followed by the Improvement of the Chinese –American relations in 1972

and American relations with Russia. In 1972. President Nixon visited Beijing and

Moscow

  1. d) The introduction of reforms in Russia by Mikhail Gorbachev. In 1985, Gorbachev introduced the Glasnost (openness policy) and the perestroika reforms (economic restructuring that appealed favourably to the west) which won him the Nobel peace Prize in 1990.
  2. e) The adoption of President Reagan’s Strategic Defence Initiative (SDI) in 1983. This initiative led to setting up of space stations that would destroy every missile in the sky. This was Star Wars.
  3. f) The collapse of the Communist rule in Europe. Russia’s president recognized the

independence of other republics of USSR in 1989 thus weakening Russia’s position.

Western democracy was introduced in Romania, Bulgaria, Czechoslovakia and

Poland.

  1. g) The successful re-unification of Germany under Helmut Kohl in 1990. The nations united to form the republic of Germany. This was a clear indicator of the joint commitment of the superpowers in maintaining their spheres of influence had been weakened.
  2. h) The dissolution of the Warsaw Pact. With the fall of communism in Eastern Europe, the Warsaw pact started to fall apart. In November 1990, the Paris Charter was signed, effectively dissolving the Warsaw Pact.
  3. i) The collapse of the Soviet Union in 1990. Several of its states seceded. Russia

officially became an aid receiver instead of an aid donor.

  1. j) The signing of the START Treaty in 1991 by Gorbachev and George Bush, after the Strategic Arms Reduction Talks. The treaty officially ended the cold war. Destruction of weapons of mass destruction commenced.

Effects of the cold war

  1. It brought immense divisions and conflict to people of the same continent, region

and countries based on pro-west or pro-east ideologies. E.g. in Angola

  1. Oppressive regimes found their way to power, supported by either the west or the east.
  2. There was untold suffering to the people. Disease, poverty and refugee camps

became common sights.

  1. There was destruction of the economy as infrastructure was destroyed by war. As communist systems failed to produce wealth, unemployment and poverty set in.
  2. It created mistrust and suspicion amongst nations.
  3. It led to arms race. It led to militarization of regions and countries.
  4. It led to political crises and actual war e.g. civil wars in Korea and Vietnam, the Suez Canal crisis of 1956 and the Hungarian Revolution of 1956.
  5. It threatened international peace and security. Insecurity in the world increased.
  6. Led to formation of Non-Aligned Movement by third world countries.
  7. Led to formation of economic alliances and military alliances like NATO (1949) and the Warsaw pact (1955). COMECON (1949) and the European Economic Union (1957.
  8. The cold war led to development in science and technology. The war Stimulated

space science/space race.

Effects of the end of Cold War on Africa.

  1. a) Some African countries that were formerly socialist are in problems following

collapse of USSR in 1990. E.g. Somalia, Ethiopia, Angola and Mozambique.

  1. b) The end of the cold war has led to the removal of financial aid and military support for some African countries. Military or food aid is no longer rushed to countries experiencing problems because there is no more superpower competition. E.g failure to prevent the Rwanda genocide and failure to assist in the Somali crisis and the current Al-shabaab crisis.
  2. c) There was emergence of new world political and economic order. The end of war has led to emergence of USA as a ‘world policeman’ over developing nations. The countries must act according to USA wishes or suffer lack of aid and receive

harassment from superpowers.

  1. d) It has led to marginalization of Africa in international affairs.
  2. e) There are conditionalties for getting aid from the western powers. Besides, Africa no longer has a choice of donors who comprise mainly of western world countries.

COOPERATION IN AFRICA

Cooperation in Africa refers to the way African countries relate to each other. It is

stimulated by the economic exploitation and political domination by Western Eu rope.

The cooperation has been in form of;

  1. a) Pan-African Movement
  2. b) Organization of African Unity (African Union)
  3. c) The East African Community
  4. d) Economic Community of Western African States.
  5. e) Common Markets for Eastern and Southern Africa.

 

 

 

 

PAN-AFRICANISM.

Meaning of Pan-Africanism.

“Pan” means “all” and “Africa” refers to the continent. “Africanism” refers to those of African Origin.Pan-Africanism is a belief in the uniqueness and spiritual Unity of Black people acknowledging their right to self determination.It is a movement aimed at unifying all the people of African descent in the world. It stands for economic, political and social advancement for all peoples of African descent throughout the world.

Origin and Development of pan-Africanism.

The movement has roots in the trans-Atlantic slave trade that took place between 15th and 19th c. the trade was responsible for the dispersal of black people all over the world.

The suffering the slaves underwent made them become conscious of their colour and origin. The Africans viewed themselves as having a common destiny. Even those who remained in Africa were later subjected to the colonial experience including forced

labour, land alienation, taxation, poor wages, discrimination corporal punishment rape and murder.The movement first started as the Pan Black Movement for the American and Caribbean black only. Several African Americans wanted to uplift the lives of fellow Africans in USA and in Africa. They included Martin Delaney, Alexander Cromwell, Bishop James Johnson, Wilmot Blyden and Bishop Turner. The leading pan -Africanists in America were Booker T Washington, Marcus Moziah Garvey, Dr. William Edward Burghardt Du Bois and George Padmore.The pioneer African pan-Africanists included Kwegyir Aggrey from Gold Coast, Wilmot Blyden from Liberia, Kwame Nkrumah from Ghana and Leopold Sedar Senghor.The Pan Black Movements enlisted all blacks worldwide. It sometimes was called Pan Negro Movement and was pitted against the evils of racism.Pan Black Movement gave birth to Pan-African Movement, which had its first meeting in London in 1900 attended by 32 delegates, drawn from USA, Africa, Canada, West Indies and Britain.Sylvester Williams, a lawyer from Trinidad, coined the term Pan-Africanism.  By 1920, an all-African idea had been developed.The first pan-African congress for Africans was held in Manchester –England in 1945, also attended by Jomo Kenyatta.

Causes of pan-Africanism.

  1. a) The Trans-Atlantic slave trade. It took place between 15th and 18th

centuries. Africans who were forced into slavery in America during this period suffered a lot under the white people. The Africans in Diaspora, through humiliation and sadness

realized they had a common destiny.

  1. b) Colonization of Africa. The division of Africa into 50 colonies separated some

communities. It also put together various people of different history and culture.

The divide and rule tactics of colonialists brought deep divisions among same

communities. The Africans realized later on that there was need to find a common

ground to bring about change.

  1. c) The need to correct the negative ideas about Africa and Africans held by Europeans.

The whites held a popular belief that Africans belonged to an inferior race without

ability to run their own affairs.

  1. d) Pan-Africanism was a fight against Racism-Africans were despised and ridiculed on the ground of colour and hair texture.
  2. e) The evolution of leadership cadre of educated class of Africans- leaders like Kwame Nkrumah, Sedar Senghor, Jomo Kenyatta and Blyden wanted to prove that Africans were a civilized people with a rich history and culture.
  3. f) European missionaries had discriminated against the Africans /Africans formed independent churches contributing to the rise of Pan -Africanism.

Objectives of the Pan-African movement

  1. a) To unite all the peoples of African origin in the struggle for emancipation from social discrimination and colonial rule.
  2. b) To challenge the ideology of white supremacy on which European colonization was based.
  3. c) To improve the African living conditions in the Diaspora and in the African continent.
  4. d) To secure democratic rights for all African peoples e.g. right to vote. Form political associations etc.
  5. e) To restore the dignity of the black people and liberate them from the bondage of

slavery.

  1. f) To create a forum through which protests against European colonization and racial discrimination could be channeled.
  2. g) To find better ways of establishing better relations between the Europeans and

Africans on the one hand and among Africans on the other hand.

  1. h) To appeal to missions and humanitarians to protect Africans against colonial

aggression and exploitation as well as land alienation.

  1. i) To fight neo-colonialism

LEADING PAN-AFRICANISTS.

  1. Marcus Garvey (1887-1940)

He was born on 17th August 1887 in the West Indies island of Jamaica to a family offreed slaves. The fact that Marcus was very dark is what shaped his philosophy of Pan Africanism. While a young man, he witnessed great European and Mullato discrimination on account of his complexion.He arrived in USA in 1916 after widely travelling in south and Central America and Britain. While in England, he was greatly encouraged by Mohammed Duse to lead the peoples of African descent all over the world in the struggle for liberation.He developed the Pan-African philosophy in USA through which he sought to make Africans take pride in their blackness and cultural heritage. He founded the Negro Empire in New York in 1920. He organized a black convention in 1924 in New York during which he launched the Universal Negro Improvement Association (UNIA) whose HQs were to be at Harlem, New York. UNIA had the following objectives;

~  To create universal fraternity among the Black Race.

~  To assist uplift the civilization of African communities.

~  To establish a central nation for the black race.

~  To establish academies for African children.

~  To promote African cultures.

Garvey founded a Journal “The Negro World” and the African Orthodox Church under a black Patriarch or chief Bishop and a Black Madonna as the symbol of his church.

He advocated for the return to Africa by the Africans. To Garvey, freedom was to be gained through economic empowerment of Africans. To this end, he mobilized African Americans to contribute funds to establish black businesses like the Black Starline Shopping Company. The project however collapsed due to mismanagement. He was arrested, tried and convicted of fraud (collecting funds unlawfully) and imprisoned for five years. He was deported to his home country Jamaica after two years in Jail where he died in 1940.He is credited for succeeding in mobilizing Africans to take pride in their cultures and complexion.

  1. Booker T. Washington.(1856-1915)

He was born in 1856 in USA to a poor slave family. He acquired a university degree in Agriculture at Hampton Institute.He is credited for promoting African Education.

He started a model institute for training blacks in agricultural and industrial skills (the Tuskegee Institute in Alabama).Unfortunately, Washington adopted a policy of cooperation with the government as a means of winning acceptance by the European community. To him, Africans ought to gain wealth in order to attain equal status with Europeans and end racial discrimination.He began the National Negro Business League with the help of a European Andrew Carnegie.He died in 1915.

  1. Dr. William Edward Burghardt Du Bois.

He was born in great Barrington, Massachusetts, USA on 23rd February 1868.  He was the first black to receive a PHD Degree and become a professor of History, Economics and Sociology. He was also a renowned journalist.He greatly disagreed with Booker T. Washington’s policy of accommodation and cooperation. In 1905, he established the Niagara Movement to protest against racial discrimination. In 1900, he was one of the founder members of the National Association for the advancement of Coloured Peoples (NAACP) an association that championed for the struggle for Negroes’ civil rights in America.He prepared the pan-African conferences that were held between 1900 and 1945 to fight against slavery, colonial exploitation and repression of Af rican peoples. He was the chairman of the Manchester Conference of 1945..In 1961, he relocated to Ghana where he became a citizen, on invitation of Nkrumah. He died in 1963 in Ghana.

THE PAN-AFRICAN CONGRESSES (1900-1945)

  1. a) The 1st pan-African conference, London, 1900. It was held at the Westminster

Townhall from 23rd to 25th July with 32 participants from Africa, USA, Canada and

West Indies. The conference was sponsored by a Trinidad lawyer Henry Sylvester

Williams who coined the term Pan-Africanism. The conference marked the entry of

Du Bois into Pan Africanism where he made his famous statement “The problem of

the 20th c is the problem of colourline”.

Objectives of the conference.

~  To unite people of African origin in all parts of the world.

~  To appeal for the end of European colonization and exploitation of Africa.

~  To look for ways of establishing better relations between the Caucasian and African races.

~  To initiate a movement for securing the full rights for all Africans in and outside

Africa and promote the economic rights.

~  To appeal to missionaries and philanthropists in Britain to protect Africans against aggression by colonizers.

Conference Agenda

~  Human Rights Violation against blacks in South Africa.

~  Living conditions of blacks in different parts of the world.

~  Racial discrimination against Africans all over the world.

The conference sent a Memorandum to the Queen of England demanding respect for the rights of Black People especially in the British Empire.

  1. b) The 2nd Pan-African Conference, Paris, 1919. The conference coincided with the

Paris Peace conference. The conference was convened by William Du bois who had

been sent to Paris by NAACP to investigate the allegations that African American

troops stationed in France during world war I experienced racial discrimination and

to represent the interest of the black peoples at the Paris peace conference.

The conference made the following recommendations;

~  The need for international laws to protect Black people.

~  African land to be held in trust for Africans.

~  The prevention of exploitation of African nations by foreign companies.

~  The rights of Africans to be educated.

~  That slavery and capital punishment were to be abolished.

~  The right of Africans to participate in their government as fast as their development permitted.

  1. c) The 3rd Pan-African Conference 1921. The conference was held in three sessions in London, Brussels and Paris. The London session was attended by 41 Africans, 35

American coloureds, 7 West Indies and 24 Africans living in Europe at that time. It

was patronaged by Du Bois. The conference demanded for the establishment of

political organizations among the suppressed blacks. It emphasized international and interracial harmony and democracy.

  1. d) The 4th mPan-African congress (London and Lisbon 1923.) it reiterated earlier

resolutions and also demanded that black people be treated like human beings.

  1. e) The 5th Pan-African Conference, New York 1927. It was mainly attended by African Americans and was partly sponsored by European Philanthropists. It discussed the attitude of the communists towards pan-Africanism.
  2. f) The 6th Pan African conference, Manchester 1945.it coincided with the end of the World War II. It was convened by the Pan African Federation which had been formed in 1944 by 13 organizations representing students’ welfare and political groupings.

Leaders of the federation were George Padmore, Ras Makonnen (Ethiopia). C.L.R

Wallace Johnson and Jomo Kenyatta. The conference was greatly inspired by the

liberation of Ethiopia in 1941 and Clause three of the Atla ntic Charter (1941) (that

USA and British governments would respect the right of all people to choose the form of government under which to live) which Winston Churchill claimed was not

applicable to the Africans.The conference was convened on 15th oct. 1945 and was attended by 90 delegates who included Du Bois(West Indies), Nkrumah(Ghana), Kenyatta(kenya), Padmore(Trinidad), peter Abrahams(south Africa), Ras Makonnen(Ethiopia) , Magnus Williams representing Azikiwa Nnamdi (Nigeria), Obafemi Owolowo(Nigeria) and Kamuzu Banda (Malawi) and 11 observer nations

Du bois chaired the conference while Nkrumah and Padmore were joint secretaries.

Uniqueness of the conference.

  1. a) The conference was mainly organized by Africans from the continent unlike earlier ones which were organized by the Africans in Diaspora. The only exceptions were W.E.B Du Bois and Padmore.
  2. b) Representatives of white philanthropists were absent. Neither did they finance the conference.
  3. c) Many African trade unions were represented. These included the trade Unions from Sierra Leone, Nigeria, Ghana and Gambia. Most of West Indies was also represented.

Key Resolution of the Manchester Conference

  1. Africans should concentrate on winning political power through non-violent means e.g strikes and boycotts.
  2. African intellectuals should play an important role in mobilizing the masses to fight for political liberation. Pursuant to the conference resolutions, Kwame Nkrumah established the West African National Secretariat (WANS) on 15th December 1945 in England to act as a regional body for Pan African Federation, promote unity in West Africa. WANS published a newsletter, The New African, whose main aim was to inspire the youth in Africa to resist imperialism.

Why the 1945 Manchester (Pan-African) Congress was a landmark in the history of

Africa.

  1. a) For the first time leading African representatives in the continent attended e.g.

Jomo Kenyatta, Kwame Nkrumah, Kamuzu Banda, Haile Sellasie etc. on coming back , they all adopted radical nationalistic demands for independen ce of their states.

  1. b) It was the first congress that strongly condemned European colonization of Africa and demanded the autonomy and liberty of African states.
  2. c) The congress was instrumental in granting of independence to Ghana in 1957 and to Egypt soon after.
  3. d) It set the pace for organization of similar conferences in the African continent like; the 1958 All African Congress and the 1960 Tunis-Pan African People’s Conference.
  4. e) During the conference, the solidarity and unity among Africans began to develop

and paved way to the formation of Organization of African Unity.

  1. f) It marked the establishment of the movement’s activities in Africa.

Why pan-African movement was not active in Africa before 1945

  1. a) There was lack of adequate African representation in the movement before 1945.

Africans in the movement were few and were staying outside Africa as political

exiles or students.

  1. b) Colonial authorities could not allow Africans to organize a movement that was

against their policies. Such movements were outlawed.

  1. c) The ‘divide and rule’ policy used by the Europeans made it impossible for Africans to communicate and cooperate.
  2. d) Africans in each colony were mainly concerned with issues that affected them

directly e.g. Land alienation, forced labour and taxation.

  1. e) The only Countries that were independent (Liberia and Ethiopia) could not champion pan-Africanism since they had their own internal problems and paid little attention to international matters e.g. Ethiopia and Liberia.
  2. f) Lack of venue to hold meetings on the African soil since the colonial government would not have allowed such meetings.
  3. g) Poor state of transport and communication at the time did not permit fast spread

of Pan-Africanism.

  1. h) Few people were educated and only a minority in Africa had higher education hence there was widespread illiteracy and ignorance.
  2. i) Africans were too poor to contribute to pan-African efforts.

The role of Kwame Nkrumah in Pan-Africanism.

  1. a) He participated in the 1945 Manchester Conference as the secretary during which he proposed that delegates go back to their countries and spearhead the nationaliststruggle for political independence.
  2. b) He established the West African National Secretariat (WANS) in England to

coordinated pan African federation activities in West Africa and promote pan Africanism.

  1. c) He founded the Convention People’s Party (CPP) in 1949which led Ghana to Independence in 1957.
  2. d) As president of Ghana, Nkrumah inspired many African countries to struggle for

political independence, and the black civil rights movement in the USA to fight for

their rights.

  1. e) In 1958, he hosted the first pan-African conference of independent states in Accra which pledged to assist fellow Africans to fight for political independence.
  2. f) He funded nationalists in other countries e.g. Ghana and Algeria.
  3. g) He supported other African leaders who faced political threats from their former

colonial masters. For example he assisted the Guinean leader, Sekou Toure , with

Loans following the withdrawal of French support to the country after

independence

  1. h) He championed trade unionism in Africa as a means of promoting pan-Africanism.

During the Manchester conference as a joint secretary with George Padmore, he

allowed participation of trade Unions from Sierra Leone, Nigeria, Ghana and

Gambia.

  1. i) He participated in convening various pan-African conferences that led to the

formation of O.A.U, an association of independent African states.

NB- it is most probably because of his fight against western domination that Nkrumah was eventually overthrown in 1966 in a military coup that forced him into exile. He died on 27th April 1972 in Bucharest, Romania, where he had gone to seek treatment for cancer.

Reasons why the pan-African movement became active in Africa after 1945.

  1. a) World War II strengthened nationalism in the continent. The Africans’ quest for

political independence received a boost with support from UNO, USA and USSR.

  1. b) The 1945 Pan-African Conference in Manchester, brought many African elites

together. They later inspired their colleagues back home to join the movement.

  1. c) The attainment of political independence in India in 1947 and Burma (now

Myanmar) in 1948 encouraged many nationalists in Africa.

  1. d) The slowing down of the pan0africanism activities in America during the cold war period activated the same in Africa. USA tried to control activities of people like Padmore who had links with USSR.
  2. e) The attainment of independence by Ghana in 1957 inspired other African nations to focus on the liberation of their respective countries rather than fight for the betterment of fellow Africans outside the continent.

Performance of the Pan-African Movement..

Achievements of Pan-Africanism.

  1. a) The movement created political awareness among people of African origin and a

sense of deep concern for suffering of blacks all over the world.

  1. b) It put in place Steps towards the restoration of status and dignity to the African

people, which had been eroded by slave trade, colonialism and racism.

  1. c) The movement provided an important forum where the people of African origin

could discuss their problems. It promoted brotherhood among Africans.

  1. d) The movement led to the Development of the spirit of solidarity among the African people when dealing with issues that concern the continent.
  2. e) It laid the basis for the Formation of OAU, which later became the African Union (AU).
  3. f) The movement enabled African leaders to be more committed to African issues. For example the black caucus in the USA played an important role in pressurizing the US congress to take drastic measures against the Apartheid regime in South Africa.
  4. g) The movement laid the foundation for the interest in research on African culture,

history, literature, music, religion, medicine, art, etc. this empowered Africans by

enabling them to understand the status quo.

  1. h) The movement played an important role in the advancement of African nationalism by encouraging peoples of African origin to take pride in their ancestry and demand their rights.
  2. i) The movement condemned Mussolini’s attempt to colonize Ethiopia in 1935 by

organizing protests in major towns like New York, London, Brussels and Paris.

Challenges encountered by the pan African movement.

  1. a) Many European groups fought the activities of the pan Africanists. The fact that

Marcus Garvey was arrested, tried and convicted of fraud (collecting funds

unlawfully) and imprisoned for five years is a clear manifestation of this.

  1. b) It was difficult for the Africans to participate in African affairs since majority of

Africans were still under colonialism.

  1. c) Due to lack of economic empowerment and lack of education, many of the pan

African projects did not succeed. The Marcus Garvey project for instance collapsed

due to mismanagement.

  1. d) Illiteracy and ignorance amongst some people of African origin hindered them from offering constructive support.
  2. e) The movement was restricted to the African continent after independence in 1960s.

The absence of African-Americans in the continents affairs dealt a big to its progress.

  1. f) Division among Africans after independence e.g. Radical and the conservative

leaders and between the francophone and the Anglophone countries.

  1. g) The European powers domination of the international media was used to water

down the importance of pan-Africans by spreading negative propaganda.

  1. h) Some of the pan-African leaders could not agree on the best strategy of uplifting the welfare of the African origin peoples.
  2. i) The deep economic connection between colonies and the mother countries

hindered any meaningful cooperation.

  1. j) Lack of venues to hold conferences in Africa especially before 1957 meant that the movement could not take root in Africa quickly. The far-away venues were

inconveniencing.

The Pan-African movement activities after 1950.

Despite the challenges mentioned, the movement was still active in Africa after 1950 as manifested in the political developments that took place in the 1950s and 1960s.

The following conferences were convened during that period.

1)  The 1st Conference of Independent African States, Accra, Ghana April 1958. In

attendance were the eight independent African states of Ghana, Egypt, Morocco,

Ethiopia, Liberia, Tunisia Sudan and Libya. the delegates pledged to assist fellow

African countries who were fighting for political independence..

2)  The All-African Peoples conference, (Accra De. 1958) the conference was attended by freedom fighters and trade unionists from all over Africa. It was chaired by Tom Mboya of Kenya The conference’s main resolution was to use all means to acquire political independence and to encourage unity between the African leaders.

3)  The All-African Peoples Conference, Tunis, January 1960. It strengthened the desire for unity among African states.

4)  The 2nd Conference of Independent African States, Addis Ababa, Ethiopia, June

  1. The conference was the forerunner to the formation of a continental Body,

OAU. The conference exposed sharp division among African states over the situation in Congo, where Patrice Lumumba was facing problems with his former colonial masters.

5)  The Brazzaville Conference December 1960

Attended exclusively by the 12 francophone conservative African states, the

conference emphasized the need to respect international Frontiers and noninterference in the internal affairs of any African state. They promised political

support for Mauritania in her boundary disputes with morocco.

6)  The Casablanca conference, January 1961.

It was a reaction to the resolutions of the Brazzaville conference by the radicals who supported Morocco in her dispute with Mauritania. They advocated for the removal of foreign troops in Congo.

7)  The Monrovia conference, May 1961. It attracted both moderates and

conservatives and aimed at uniting the antagonistic groups. The conference

emphasized the absolute equality of all states. The conference succeeded in uniting

the hostile groups through the undertaking of two crucial events;

~  The Algerian Referendum of 1961, which passed that the Algerians wanted

political independence from France.

~  The situation in Congo stabilized after 1961.

ORGANIZATION OF AFRICAN UNITY (OAU)

What was the OAU?

It was an association of independent African states that existed between 1963 and

2002, when it was renamed the African Union (AU)

Origin and development of OAU.

It was formed as a climax of a series of pan- Africanism congresses up to 1963.

In January 1961, several African independent states, i.e. Egypt, Ghana, morocco, Libya and Algeria, met in Casablanca and pledged to help Patrice Lumumba of Congo against the secessionist Tsombe. In May 1961, another group of African states, i.e. Liberia, Tunisia and Togo met in Monrovia and agreed to work in unity to solve the Congo crisis.

In august 1961, a bigger group made up of former French colonies met in Brazzaville to find a solution to the Congo crisis.In 1963, the regional groupings compromised and joined with others to form one organization. In May 1963, foreign ministers of 32 independent African states met in Addis Ababa, Ethiopia, to prepare the agenda for the heads of state meeting.The heads of states met under chair of Emperor Haile Selassie and gave birth to OAU, with Selassie as its first chairperson. Its membership grew from 32 at the time of its inception to 54

NB; when the Saharan Arab Democratic Republic was admitted to the OAU in 1984, Morocco withdrew since she claimed that SADR was part of her territory.

The Charter of OAU.

Objectives of the OAU.

  1. a) To provide African countries it a permanent organization through which they could discuss issues affecting them and lay strategies for solving them.
  2. b) To provide identity for the newly independent countries of Africa in a world

dominated and controlled by the white race.

  1. c) To co-ordinate and assist in the speedy decolonization of the rest of Africa.
  2. d) To improve the living standards and conditions of African people as a group and as individual states.
  3. e) To help in the Defence of the independence of African states and maintenance of

the sovereignty of these countries.

  1. f) To promote cooperation among the African states in economic, social and political fields so as to improve living standards.
  2. g) To promote and enhance African solidarity and unity.
  3. h) To support world, peace organizations like the UN and the Non-Aligned Movement.
  4. i) To promote peaceful settlement of disputes.
  5. j) To promote non-interference in the internal matters of member states.

The fundamental principles of OAU as outlined in the charter.

  1. a) Recognition of the sovereign equality of member states.
  2. b) Non-interference in the internal affairs of member countries.
  3. c) Respect for the sovereign and territorial integrity of each country and its inalienable right to independent existence.
  4. d) Peaceful settlement of disputes.
  5. e) Condemnation of political assassination or any form of subversion by one country in another member country.
  6. f) Dedication to the emancipation of territories under colonial rule.
  7. g) Adherence to the principle of non-alignment.

 

 

The structure of the former OAU.

The OAU charter borrowed heavily from that of the United Nations Organization. The only difference is that no member of OAU enjoys veto powers. All members have equal privileges and vote. The charter outlined the structure of OAU as follows;The Assembly of Heads of State and Government. This was the supreme organ of OAU meeting once a year to discuss specific urgent matters and electing a chairperson every year. A two-third majority vote was used to decide critical issues.The Council of Ministers. It was made up of all foreign ministers of OAU member states and met twice a year to prepare agenda for the meeting of heads of state and government. It implemented decisions passed by heads and prepared the OAU budget.The General Secretariat. Headed by the secretary general elected by the Assembly of Heads of state, it offered the administrative services to the organization on daily basis. The past secretaries were Kifle Wodajo of Ethiopia (1963-1964), Diallo Telli Boubaker of Guinea (1964-1972), Nzo Ekangaki of Cameroon (1972-1974), Eteki Mboumoua of Cameroon (1974-1978), Edem Kodjo of Togo (1978-1983), Peter Onu of Nigeria (1983-1985), Ide Oumarou of Niger(1985-1989). The last was Salim Ahmed Salim from Tanzania.The Commission of Mediation, Conciliation and Arbitration. It was charged with the task of settling disputes involving members. It had membership of 21 states and served for a term of five years.Specialized Agencies. The OAU also comprised specialized agencies and committees that handled the technical business of the organization. E.g. the OAU Liberation Committee-to co-ordinate activities of liberation movements. The Economic and Social Commission, the Commission on Education, Science and Culture, the Defence Commission, the Supreme Council of Sports Etc.

Achievements of OAU.

  1. a) It offered solution to border disputes between member states like Kenya vs.

Somalia, Ethiopia vs. Somalia, Libya vs. Chad, morocco vs. Algeria, Chad vs. Nigeria and the Rwanda –Burundi conflict.

  1. b) The OAU achieved total liberation of African countries, with South Africa being the last one. It offered military support to the nationalistic struggles in Mozambique, Angola, Rhodesia, Namibia and South Africa.
  2. c) It condemned human rights violation in countries like Namibia and South Africa. It encouraged economic sanctions against the apartheid regime of South Africa.
  3. d) Through the OAU, African governments were able to speak with one voice on

matters affecting Africa and they even attempted to formulate a common foreign

policy.

  1. e) It provided a forum for discussing Africa’s common problems like desertific ation, foreign interference, and dependency and at the same time sought for solutions to the problems.
  2. f) The organization embarked on common economic ventures for Africa. For example creation of the African Development Bank (ADB) which represented the collective contribution by all Africans towards emancipation of Africans from economic backwardness.
  3. g) It encouraged construction of roads and railways to link different regions. E.g.

Tanzam, the Great North Road and the Trans-African Highway. This improved

economic co-operation between member states.

  1. h) It created a cultural identity for African countries sports and the All -African Games, which provided Africans with the opportunity to meet and socialize.
  2. i) Through its refugee agency, it addressed itself to the refugee problem in the

continent. E.g. refugees from countries like Rwanda, Burundi, Chad, Gambia,

Ethiopia, Sudan and Somalia have been assisted.

  1. j) It was instrumental in the formation of regional organizations like ECOWAS, SADDC

and COMESA.

Problems that faced OAU during its operation.

  1. a) Differences in economic development levels and in history of member states

militated against co-operation.

  1. b) Ideological differences among member states, especially during the Cold war period, hampered the operations of the OAU.
  2. c) It lacked sufficient funds to carry out its work efficiently. The members were poor given that all of them were third world countries.
  3. d) The problem of sovereignty. Many countries disregarded the OAU resolutions in

favour of their sovereignty and national interests.

  1. e) It lacked an effective machinery to effect its decisions. It also lacked a standing army to implement and effect its resolutions hence the term ‘Toothless Bulldog’ coined by Gadaffi to refer to it.
  2. f) Loyalty to other organizations. OAU members also belonged to other organizations like ECOWAS, COMESA, The Arab League etc; the interests of these organizations were not always in accord with those of the OAU.
  3. g) The colonial legacy. Many problems arising from past colonial policies have rocked the organization. E.g. The land issue in Zimbabwe. There is also the problem of NeoColonialism in trade.
  4. h) Interference by the big powers. This has caused dismay to the organization.
  5. i) Emergence of dictators like Amin Dada of Uganda, Bakassa Jean Bedel of Central African Republic, And Mobutu of Congo.
  6. j) Civil strife in various countries remained unresolved for a long time. E.g in Sudan, Rwanda, Ethiopia, Nigeria. This made cooperation difficult.

THE AFRICAN UNION

Origin of the African Union.

On 9th September 1999, the Heads of State and Government met in Libya and made the Sirte Declaration calling for the establishment of an African Union and a pan-African parliament.On 29th may 2000, the document for the formation of African Union and Pan-African Parliament was adopted by the joint sitting of legal experts and parliamentarians.

On 2nd June 2000, heads of state and government meeting in Lome, Togo adopted the Constitutive Act of the African Union drafted by the council of ministers. The AU was born in 2002, at a Summit held in Durban, South Africa, where the first Assembly of Heads of State of African Union was convened.

Differences between the former Organization of African Unity and the present African Union.

  1. a) Unlike the O.A.U, the A.U challenges the principle of non-interference in the internal affairs of member states. It allows for intervention whenever a member state experiences conflict or widespread human rights violation.
  2. b) A.U was like an Association of African Heads of State, but A.U is like a Union of African Peoples. Increased participation of all African people is manifested in the proposed Pan-African Parliament and an economic, social and cultural council.
  3. c) Unlike the O.A.U the African Union has an accountability mechanism. An African Peer Review Mechanism (APRM) has been developed as a means through which countries can be held accountable on matters of security, development, stability and cooperation.
  4. d) Unlike the O.A.U, the A.U has a broader development plan for Africa e.g. through the New Partnership for Africa’s Development-NEPAD whose main objectives include to promote accelerated growth and sustainable development, to eradicate the widespread poverty in the continent and to halt the marginalization of Africa in the globalization process.
  5. e) Unlike OAU, AU presupposes the establishment of a security council and the African Court of Justice with law enforcement powers(A standing military)

The AU Charter.

Objectives of AU.

  1. a) To accelerate the political, social and economic integration of the continent.
  2. b) To promote and defend the African common positions on issues of interest.
  3. c) To defend the independence and territorial integrity of African states and maintain the sovereignty of these countries.
  4. d) To promote democratic principles and institutions, popular participation and good governance.
  5. e) To establish the necessary conditions which enable the continent to play its rightful role in the global economy and in international negotiations.
  6. f) To promote cooperation among the African states in economic, social and political fields so as to improve living standards.
  7. g) To achieve and enhance greater African solidarity and unity.
  8. h) To promote peace, security and stability in the continent through peaceful settlement of disputes.
  9. i) To advance the development of the continent by promoting research in all fields,

particularly in science and technology.

  1. j) To encourage international cooperation, taking into account the Charter of the

United Nations and the Universal Declaration of Human Rights.

  1. k) To work with relevant international partners in the eradication of preventable

diseases and promotion o good health on the continent.

The structure of African Union

The AU charter outlined the structure of AU as follows;

  1. The Assembly. This is the supreme organ of AU meeting once a year to elect a

chairperson and determine the common policies of the union, consider requests for

admission, monitor implementation of policies and decisions, appoint and terminate

the judges of the court of Justice among other functions.(students to make

additions) Decisions are either by consensus or by two-thirds majority vote.

  1. The Executive Council. It is made up of Foreign Ministers or the authorities

designated by the member states. Its core function is to co-ordinate union policies

ion areas of common interest like foreign trade, ener gy, industry, water resources

and environmental protection. Such functions can be delegated to specialized

technical committees.

  1. The Commission/Secretariat. Comprises a chairperson, deputy chairperson and

eight commissioners and staff members. It deals with the administrative issues and

implements decisions of the Union.

  1. The Permanent Representatives Committee. It comprises the Ambassadors to the AU. Its main responsibility to prepare for the executive council and run the

association daily. It seats permanently in Addis Ababa.

  1. Specialized committees and Agencies. The AU also comprised specialized agencies and committees that handled the technical business of the organization. E.g the Committee on Rural Economy and Agricultural Matters, the Committee on Monetary and Financial Affairs, the Committee on Trade, Customs and Immigrations Matters, the Committee on Transport and Communication, the Committee on Education, Human Resource and Culture, the Committee on Health, Labour, and Social Affairs.
  2. The economic and social council. It performs advisory functions
  3. Specialized technical committees. E.g the Committee on Rural Economy and

Agricultural matters, the Committee on Trade , Customs and Immigration Matters,

The Committee on Industry, Science and Technology, the Committee on Transport,

Communication and Tourism, the Committee on Health, Labour and Social Affairs,

the Committee on Education, Culture and Human Resources.

They perform the following roles;

  1. a) Prepare projects and programmes of the Union and submit them to the

executive council.

  1. b) Ensure supervision, follow-up and evaluation of the implementation of

decisions taken by the organs of the Union.

  1. c) Ensure co-ordination and harmonization of projects and programmes of the

Union.

  1. d) Submit to the Executive council, their reports and recommendations on

implementation of the African Union’s Act.

  1. Other proposed structures though not yet in place are;

~  The peace and Security Council to comprise 15 members to monitor and

intervene in conflicts.

~  The Pan-African Parliament responsible for ensuring civil society participation in

AU matters.

~  The Court of Justice to deal with human rights abuses in Africa.

~   Financial Institutions like The African Central Bank, the African Monetary Fund

and the African Investment Bank.

THE EAST AFRICAN COMMUNITY

Founded on 6th June 1967, it comprises Kenya Uganda and Tanzania.

Origin of the East African Community.

Its origin can be traced back to 1902- the efforts of the British and German colonial

governments’ to establish a unified administration over the East African territories.For example, the East African Court of Appeal was established in 1902, The East African Postal Union in 1911, East African Customs Union in 1917, East African Currency Board in 1920 And East African High Commission in 1948.On 9th December 1961, the East African High Commission was replaced with the East African Common Services Organization with the headquarters in Nairobi.The treaty to establish the East African Community was signed on 6th June 1967. The organization came into force on 1st December 1967.

Objectives of the East African Community.

  1. a) To maintain a common markets for the member states and promote balanced

economic cooperation.

  1. b) To provide common services to the three member states especially in the areas of transport and communication.
  2. c) To promote political co-operation between the three countries and hence peace and security.
  3. d) To facilitate the movement of the people within the region to foster greater cooperation and understanding among them.
  4. e) To expand the market in a region where population and incomes are low.

Challenges that faced the East African Community up to 1977.

  1. a) Suspicion over perceived dominance among members. Tanzania and Uganda

accused Kenya of acquiring the lion’s share of benefits from the community. Kenyan industries for example were protected more by the common external tariffs.

  1. b) Personality differences. This was between individual leaders of the three countries, making it more difficult for them to hold meetings.
  2. c) Ideological differences. Each of the three countries pursued different economies.

Kenya followed capitalism and Tanzania socialism. Uganda had a mixed economy.

  1. d) Political instability in Uganda. The coup d’état, which overthrew Milton Obote,

undermined the unity that was desired for the organization. Nyerere for example

refused to recognize Amin as the president of Uganda.

  1. e) National pride and interests. National interests were given more priority than the

regional interests were. E.g Tanzania favoured railway transport while Kenya

favoured road transport.

  1. f) Boundary closures .Tanzania closed its common border with Kenya in 1977, thereby halting the community activities. There was also boundary closure between Tanzania and Uganda during the war between the two in 1978.
  2. g) Financial constraints resulting from failure by member states to remit funds to meet the organization’s needs.
  3. h) The use of different currencies by the three nations made transaction difficult.

The Rebirth of the East African Community-2001

Reasons that led to the rebirth of the East African Community in 1996.

  1. a) There was need to maintain a common market for the member states in order to

promote balanced economic cooperation.

  1. b) There was increasing need to provide common services to the three Member states especially in the areas of transport and communication as well as research.
  2. c) There was a strong desire to promote political cooperation between the three

countries in a world that was becoming a global village.

  1. d) There was need to facilitate free movement of people in the region.
  2. e) A greater lesson had been learnt following the great losses and costs incurred by the East African countries following the collapse of the Community in 1977.

Milestones in the Formation of the East African Community-2001.

  1. a) The full East African cooperation was started on March 14, 1996, when the

Secretariat of the Permanent Tripartite Commission was launched at the

headquarters of EAC in Arusha, Tanzania. Ambassador Francis Muthaura was

appointed the first secretary general.

  1. b) On 19th November 1996, the agreement for the establishment of the East African

Business Council was signed in Nairobi.

  1. f) On 29th April 1997, the second summit of heads of state was held in Arusha. It

launched the first East African Cooperation development strategy (1997 -2000).

  1. g) On 30th April 1998, the ninth meeting of the Permanent Tripartite Commission in Arusha launched the treaty for the establishment of the East African Community.
  2. h) On 24th November 1998, the first East African Ministerial meeting on the Lake

Victoria hyacinth was held in Arusha. A regional strategy was developed for control

of the lake hyacinth.

  1. i) On 22nd January 1999, the third summit met in Arusha and directed the Permanent Tripartite Commission to complete the treaty –making process by 30th July 1999.
  2. j) The treaty establishing the East African Community-2001 was signed on 30th November 1999 in Arusha by the three heads of state.

The structure of the New East African Community.

In the november30, 1999 treaty, the following organs were established to coordinate

the activities and the direction of the community.

  1. The Summit of Heads of State. It had the responsibility of giving direction towards realization of the goals and objectives of the community. It was the community’s supreme organ, consisting of the three heads of state with the chair being rotational.
  2. The Council of Ministers. The main decision –making organ of the heads of

governments of the member states. It comprised the designated ministers from

member states.

  1. The Coordinating Committee. Made up of permanent secretaries. It reports to the

council of ministers. It coordinates the activities of the sectoral committees.

  1. The Sectoral Committees. These are committees created by the council on

recommendation of the respective coordinating committee.

  1. The East African Legislative Assembly. It provides a democratic forum for debate. It is also a watchdog of the activities of the community. It is a 30 -member assembly whose members are drawn from the member state.
  2. The Secretariat. Based in Arusha, it carried out the day-to-day administrative duties of the community.
  3. The Court of justice of East Africa. This was the highest appellate court in the

region.

Other autonomous institutions established by the Council include;

~  The East African Development Bank (EADB).

~  Lake Victoria Fisheries Organization (LVFO)

~  Inter-University Council for East Africa (IUCEA)

Challenges that have faced the EAC-2001.

  1. a) Suspicion still exists over perceived dominance of Kenya in the community affairs.
  2. b) Despite signing the treaty in 1999, Tanzania customs are still taxing Kenyan

products.

  1. c) Increased cross-border smuggling. The freedom of movement within the region

sometimes results in smuggling of illegal arms and spread of crime and insecurity.

E.g. the smuggling of a vehicle belonging to Kenya’s Chief of Staff, General Joseph Kibwana to Tanzania in 2004.

  1. d) Cattle rustling across the borders. This is common on the Kenya Uganda border with the Pokot and Karamojong attacking each other
  2. e) Arrest of Kenyan fishermen on Lake Victoria by either Tanzania or Ugandan

policemen/navy accusing them of fishing in their waters.

  1. f) Membership to other regional bodies e.g. COMESA, SADDC. This complicates the work of the EAC.
  2. g) The recent wrangles between Kenya and Uganda over ownership of Migingo Island.

Although this problem was resolved by Uganda conceding Kenya’s ownership of the Island, it raised tension between the two countries.

  1. h) The use of different currencies by the three nations has made transaction difficult.
  2. i) Political squabbles in the individual countries slow down the progress of the

community

  1. j) Individual national interests have slowed down the implementation of the activities of the community the deep-seated differences between the member states over the proposed taxes on imports from countries outside the region.

Achievements of the East African Community-2001.

  1. a) It has boosted movement of citizens within the three member states of East Africa.

An East African passport has been introduced.

  1. b) It has provided a forum for the East African Leaders to discuss issues harmoniously.
  2. c) It has facilitated the improvement and expansion of transport and communication networks between the three East African countries.
  3. d) Tariffs for industrial goods produced in East Africa have been reduced.
  4. e) Investment procedures have been eased to enable all citizens to invest more easily within the community.
  5. f) It has enhanced cooperation of the civil society leading to formation of the Law

Society of East Africa and the Business Council of East Africa.

  1. g) The community has promoted trade among member states by encouraging citizensto conduct trade in all the countries.

THE ECONOMIC COMMUNITY OF WEST AFRICAN STATES.

Formation of ECOWAS.

This is a regional group comprising of 15 West African countries.The treaty establishing ECOWAS was signed in Lagos, Nigeria on 28thmay 1975 by Gambia, Mali, Cape Verde, Burkina Faso, Niger, Benin, Togo, Cote d’Ivoire, Sierra Leone, Ghana, Senegal, Guinea–Bissau, Nigeria and Guinea.

Objectives of ECOWAS.

  1. a) To provide economic co-operation among West African states in specialized

fields such as transport, communication, agriculture, trade industry etc.

  1. b) To liberalize trade between member states.
  2. c) To improve relations between the member states.
  3. d) To improve living standards of people in the member states.
  4. e) To create a customs union in the region.
  5. f) To promote industrial development among member states.
  6. g) To promote cultural interaction among the member states.

Organization of ECOWAS.

The following are organs that were established to coordinate the activities and the

direction of ECOWAS.

  1. The Authority of Heads of State and government. The authority meets once a

year, with the chair being rotational.

  1. The Council of Ministers. It comprises the designated ministers from member

states. It meets twice a year. It manages the affairs of the community.

  1. The Tribunal. Acting as the industrial court, it was established for settling disputes arising from the community.
  2. The Executive Secretariat. Based in Lagos, Nigeria, it carries out the day-to-day

administrative duties of the community.

  1. Specialized commissions and Agencies. E.g the Committee on industry, natural

resources and Agricultural Matters, the Committee on Trade, Customs and

Immigrations Matters, the Committee on Transport and Communication, the

Committee on Culture and Social Affairs.

Achievements of ECOWAS.

  1. a) The defence Act adopted by ECOWAS in 1981 provided military support to any

Member state attacked by outsiders. Their defence force known as ECOMOG was

instrumental in quelling civil wars in Liberia and Sierra Leone.

  1. b) Economically, Member states benefit from ECOWAS. For example, Nigeria provides her oil to member states at a reduced price.
  2. c) The community has enabled regular meeting of the Heads of State to tackle

problems facing the region.

  1. d) Socio-cultural exchanges within the West African region have promoted good

relations among the people.

  1. e) Improvement has been realized in transport, trade, agriculture and communication.
  2. f) The organization has resolved political problems facing member states.
  3. g) ECOWAS has enabled citizens of member states to move freely from one country to another through waiver of visa requirements.
  4. h) There has been progress in education through the establishment of a Joint

examination Syllabus for West African States.

Challenges that ECOWAS has faced in its operation.

  1. a) Political instability in member states. Countries like Nigeria and Ghana have

witnessed Military coups. Civil wars have been fought in Sierra Leone, Liberia and

Ivory Coast. These have been a hindrance to cooperation.

  1. b) Nationalistic issues. Most member states give priority to their own domestic issues at the expense of the organization.
  2. c) Language barrier. Countries in West Africa inherited the languages of their former colonial masters. The problem in communication has hindered the efficient

operation of the organization.

  1. d) Infrastructural problems. The state of roads, railway and communication linkages are poor. This has hampered economic progress of member states.
  2. e) Ideological differences. The leaders of the member states view each other with

suspicion and mistrust due to differences in ideologies.

  1. f) Lack of uniform currency. Each country has its own currency. This creates a problem of rates of exchange thus hindering trade.
  2. g) Foreign interference. The presence of Israeli and French soldiers in Cote D’Ivoire was viewed suspiciously by guinea.
  3. h) Border closures. For example between Ghana and Togo and between Burkina Faso and Mali.

THE COMMON MARKETS FOR EASTERN AND SOUTHERN AFRICA

It is an economic organization comprising 19 states and which was established on 8th December 1994 to replace the Preferential Trade Area.

Aims and objectives of COMESA.

  1. a) To attain sustainable growth and development of the member states by promoting a more balanced and harmonious development of its production and marketing.
  2. b) To promote cooperation in all fields of economic activity and joint adoption of

macro-economic policies and programmes.

  1. c) To cooperate in the promotion of peace, security and stability among member states in order to enhance economic development in the region.
  2. d) To cooperate in the creation of an enabling environment for foreign, cross-border and domestic investment.
  3. e) To cooperate in strengthening the relations between the common market and the

rest of the world.

  1. f) To contribute towards the establishment, progress and realization of the objectives of the African Economic Community.

Principles that govern the operation of COMESA.

  1. a) Equality and interdependence of member states.
  2. b) Solidarity and collective self-reliance among member states.
  3. c) Inter-state cooperation, harmonization of policies and integration of programmes.
  4. d) Non-aggression.
  5. e) Recognition , promotion and protection of human and peoples’ rights in accordance with the provisions of the African Charter on human and peoples’ rights.
  6. f) Accountability, economic justice and popular participation in development.
  7. g) The recognition and observance of the rule of law.
  8. h) The promotion and sustenance of a democratic system of governance in each

member state.

  1. i) The maintenance of regional peace and stability through the promotion and

strengthening of good neighbourliness.

  1. j) The peaceful settlement of disputes among member states and active cooperation

between neighbouring countries

Organization of COMESA.

COMESA is made up of the following organs;

  1. The Authority of Heads of State and government. It is the supreme-policy making organ of COMESA. The authority meets once a year, but may hold an extra-ordinary meeting on request of any member of the authority.
  2. The Council of Ministers. It comprises the designated ministers from member

states. It meets once a year. It manages the affairs of the community. It monitors

and ensures the proper functioning and development of COMESA.

  1. The Court of Justice. It ensures proper interpretation and application of the

provisions of the treaty. it was established for settling disputes arising from the

community. E.g between Kenya and Egypt over export of cement in 2004

  1. The committee of Governors of Central Banks. Governors of banks of member

states form a committee to manage COMESA clearing house and ensure

implementation of the monetary and financial co -operation programmes.

  1. The Inter-Governmental Committee. A committee of permanent secretaries from

member states which develops and manages programmes and action plans in all

areas of cooperation except in the financial sector.

  1. The Secretariat. Based in Lusaka, Zambia, it provides technical support and advisory services to the member states and coordinates the activities of COMESA. The current secretary general is Erastus Mwencha since 1997
  2. The Technical Committees. E.g the Committee on natural resources and

Environment, the Committee on Agricultural Matters, the Committee on Trade,

Customs and Immigrations Matters, the Committee on Transport and

Communication, the Committee on Labour, Culture and Social Affairs.

  1. The consultative committee. This comprises the business community and other

stakeholders. It provides a link between the business community and other COMESA stakeholders, monitors implementation of the necessary provisions of the treaty, consults and receives reports from other interested groups and  Participates in the technical committees and makes recommendation.

  1. Specialized independent institutions. The Eastern and Southern African Trade and Development Bank (PTA Bank) based in Nairobi, Kenya, the PTA reinsurance

company, Nairobi, Kenya, The COMESA clearing house, Harare, Zimbabwe, COMESA association of Commercial Banks, Harare, Zimbabwe, COMESA leather institute, Addis Ababa, Ethiopia.

Achievements of COMESA.

  1. a) It provides its members a wide, harmonized and more competitive market for

internal and external trading.

  1. b) It provides member states with a rational way of exploiting natural resources for their welfare.
  2. c) COMESA has established harmonized monetary, banking and financial policies in the region.
  3. d) It has improved the administration of transport and communicat ion to ease

movement of goods, services and people.

  1. e) It has ensured cooperation in the promotion of peace, security and stability among member states in order to enhance economic development in the region.
  2. f) COMESA has strengthened relations between the Common Market and the rest of the world while ensuring that the members adopt a common position in

international fora.

  1. g) Through the Authority of Heads of State and Government, COMESA directs and controls the affairs of the common market.
  2. h) Customs cooperation has been achieved through a unified computerized customs

network that operates across the region. The harmonization of macro-economic

and monetary policies throughout the region has been achieved.

  1. i) It has provided room for greater industrial productivity and competitiveness due to its large market.
  2. j) It has encouraged member states to practice good governance, accountability and

respect for human rights. Burundi and Rwanda were subjected to these demands

before they were admitted to COMESA.

  1. k) It has contributed to employment of many people in the region.
  2. l) COMESA has promoted increased agricultural production and exploitation of natural resources.
  3. m) The organization has ensured a more efficient and reliable transport and

communication infrastructure.

Challenges that face COMESA in its operations.

  1. a) Membership to other bodies. Members of COMESA are also members of EAC and SADC. This leads to divided loyalty.
  2. b) Personality differences. For example, presidents Museveni of Uganda and El Bashir of Sudan were involved in disagreements in 2004 over rebel activities.
  3. c) Boundary conflicts. This has been witnessed between Ethiopia and Eritrea.
  4. d) Civil wars. Wars have been witnessed in DRC, Uganda, Sudan, Rwanda and Burundi.

Such inevitable wars undermine the operations of the common markets.

  1. e) Constant quarrels among member states over trading rights. For example Kenya and Egypt quarreled over duty-free cement dumped in Kenya by Egypt, on which Kenya wanted to charge duty.
  2. f) Poor transport between member states. This hampers movement of goods in the

region.

  1. g) Pulling out of Tanzania and Namibia. The two founder members have opted for

the South African Development Cooperation (SADC). This has undermined COMESA.

  1. h) Some members undermine their neighbours. For example Uganda and Rwanda have been accused of participating in the civil wars in the DRC.

Reasons why Africa has been unable to achieve full economic integration.

  1. a) The problem of poor transport and communication has impeded flow of trade. This has affected all previous and existing economic groupings.
  2. b) There is uneven distribution of resources in Africa. Some countries are endowed

with strategic natural resources like oil and fertile soils while others are

impoverished with no resources. This hinders integration.

  1. c) All member states of economic co-operations suffer from budgetary deficit and

balance of payment problems. They therefore lack adequate foreign exchange

required for international trade.

  1. d) There is constant political interference by unenlightened leaders
  2. e) There has been rivalry among member states of trading co-operations.
  3. f) Africa has had a poor share from world trade as prices on world market are dictated by industrialized countries.
  4. g) The advent of multi-partism after the end of the cold war and the subsequent

introduction of Structural Adjustment Programmes has crippled the performance of

economic integration in Africa.

  1. h) Inability of member states to interfere in the internal affairs of other states even

where there is need.

  1. i) Failure by member states to contribute fully to the organizations.
  2. j) The colonial legacy. Many member states still depend heavily on the West for

manufactured goods, machinery, technology, donations and ideas.

NATIONAL PHILOSPHIES (KENYA)

AFRICAN SOCIALISM

Meaning and origin of African Socialism.

The Sessional paper No.10 of 1965 defines African socialism as an African political, economic system that is positively African, and capable of incorporating useful and compatible techniques from whatever source.

African socialism was born out of the desire by our leaders to create a new society,

different from the colonial society and which embraced equity devoid of racism,

oppression and other social injustices.

Main features that characterized African socialism in Kenya.

  1. a) Political Democracy where all people are politically free and equal
  2. b) Various forms of ownership of wealth. E.g. free enterprise allowing private ownership of property, nationalization policy for key industries, partnership with private sector
  3. c) Mutual social responsibility. That the spirit of service and not greed for personal gain motivate Kenyans.
  4. d) A range of control to ensure that property is used in mutual interests of society and its members.
  5. e) Progressive taxation to ensure an equitable distribution of wealth and income.
  6. f) Diffusion of ownership to avoid concentration of economic power on a few people in the society.

Achievements of African socialism as a National Philosophy.

  1. a) It has led to promotion of democratic process in governance. Multi-partism has been established in Kenya due to African socialism policies. Kenya has also witnessed the growth of the civil society.
  2. b) Since the philosophy is built on African traditions, it has promoted African cultures Kenya pursued African values consistent with her traditions.
  3. c) The philosophy has promoted national unity and coexistence among Kenyan

communities.

  1. d) There has been a greater effort to achieve fairness and justice through progressive taxation and a range of other controls. The government has tried to achieve fair distribution of resources through the activities of the District Focus for Rural Development.
  2. e) The philosophy led to establishment of cooperative societies in Kenya. This has

promoted social and economic development in Kenya.

  1. f) African socialism has promoted agricultural development through the land tenure

system that was undertaken to ensure settlement of the landless in settlement

schemes like Bura.

  1. g) Social development in education and health has been achieved. Discrimination in schools, hospitals and residential areas stopped. Uniform systems were adopted.
  2. h) The philosophy gave Africans the right to participate in their economy. This was

through the policy of Africanization in which industrial enterprises hitherto owned

by Asians and Europeans, changed ownership.

  1. i) African socialism has encouraged rapid development in Kenya. The policy of mutual social responsibility through self-help promotes a sense of patriotism and service to the nation as Kenyans work together to build the nation.

Problems that faced African socialism.

  1. a) Progressive taxation has put an additional burden of taxation on the poor thus

discouraging development.

  1. b) Political interference in public projects and wrangles among leaders retards

development.

  1. c) The spirit of unity and co-operation and self-help has been discouraged by

misappropriation of funds.

  1. d) Corruption leads to negative attitude from people towards contributing to national development.

HARAMBEE PHILOSOPHY

Meaning and origin of Harambee philosophy.

Harambee is a Kiswahili slogan, which means pulling together or working together. It was a development strategy in which, people supplemented government efforts

through voluntary contribution.Mzee Jomo Kenyatta made it a national Motto in 1963 when he aptly advanced it as unity in all causes of national integrity and human progress.

The Harambee spirit embodies ideals of assistance, joint effort, mutual social

responsibility and community self-reliance.

Harambee projects are categorized as;

  1. Social Projects. Educational institutions and facilities, medical centres,

recreational facilities and religious institutions.

  1. Economic projects. Construction of rural access roads, bridges and culverts,

agricultural and livestock activities.

Principles that guide the Harambee spirit.

  1. a) It is a development strategy that is aimed at mobilizing the people at local level to participate in their development
  2. b) Participation is guided by the principles of collective good as opposed to individual gain. Harambee efforts should be directed towards community projects rather than individual projects.
  3. c) The choice of project is supposed to be guided by the felt needs of the majority.

Participants should be involved in decision making.

  1. d) In the implementation of projects, there should be maximum utilization of the local resources such as labour, materials and money.

Contribution of Harambee movement to the development of Kenya.

  1. a) Harambee movement has led to development of education in Kenya through

Harambee fundraising to construct schools and colleges.

  1. b) Funds have been collected through Harambee to improve infrastructural facilities such as roads, rural electrification and provision of water.
  2. c) Collective participation in development programmes by people from different

groups has promoted national unity.

  1. d) It has helped inculcate hard work in the people of Kenya. This has in turn

encouraged various ethnic groups to develop their respective areas.

  1. e) Harambee projects especially in rural areas have attracted foreign donors especially the NGO’S
  2. f) Has led to re-distribution of resources as people with more funds have participated in the development projects in the less developed areas.
  3. g) Funds have been raised through Harambee to help the less fortunate members of

the society. For example, President Moi 8th April 1989 held a Mammoth Rally where KSH 70Million was raised to help the disabled.

  1. h) Harambee movement has promoted agricultural development e.g., through

construction of cattle dips and purchase of farms through Harambee.

  1. i) Funds raised through Harambee have been used to purchase buses and Matatus to provide transport.

Ways in which the Harambee philosophy has promoted the development of education in Kenya.

  1. a) Many education institutions have been constructed using funds raised through

Harambee effort. Thus enabling many children to attend school.

  1. b) Many students have been assisted to pay school fees/thus it enables the needy to go on learning.
  2. c) Physical facilities have been constructed/improved through Harambee. This enables learning in a conducive environment.
  3. d) Teaching/learning materials have been purchased/ donated to schools to improve

the quality of education.

  1. e) Additional staff/workers in schools have been paid through Harambee contributions by the parents to offset inadequacy.
  2. f) Through Harambee spirit, well-wishers, thus helping the learners to exploit their

talents, have supported co-curricular activities.

  1. g) Scholl furniture has been bought through Harambee effort thus making learning

/teaching comfortable.

  1. h) Parents have contributed funds to supplement the government’s school feeding

programmes thus improving enrolment.

problems that face Harambee movement in Kenya.

  1. a) Misuse of Harambee funds/diverting its use and lack of commitment by leaders.
  2. b) It puts an additional burden of taxation on the poor.
  3. c) Embezzlement of public funds.
  4. d) Political interference and wrangles among leaders.
  5. e) The spirit of unity and co-operation and self-help may be killed by misappropriation of funds.
  6. f) Poor co-ordination and supervision of Harambee projects.
  7. g) Use of force or extortion of Harambee funds from the people/dictatorial tendencies.
  8. h) Corruption and negative attitude from people.
  9. i) Use of Harambee for political gains.

NYAYOISM.

Meaning and origin of Nyayoism.

Nyayoism originally meant footsteps i.e. following the footsteps of Mzee Jomo Kenyatta.

This was a phrase coined by the former president of Kenya Daniel Arap Moi, in reference to his Endeavour to follow the foot steps of his predecessor.Today, Nyayoism means peace, love and unity that form the pillars of the development philosophy.It stresses the concept of being mindful of other people’s welfare.It is closely related to the principal of mutual  social responsibility as embodied in African socialism.

 

Sources of Nyayoism.

1)  Sessional Paper No. 10 of 1965 that articulated African socialism, which is based on collective responsibility and on being mindful of other people’s welfare.

2)  The Biblical teaching of the Ten Commandments, summarized as Love for God,

fellow man and oneself.

3)  Moi’s long political career inspired him to develop the philosophy when he realized that national building required love.

Pillars of Nyayoism

1)  Peace: – the state of being free from war and disorder. Peace is the beginning of

sustainable and cumulative progress. Peace promotes development. According to

Nyayoism, peace discourages political stability.

2)  Love: – Love brings about trust and readiness to cooperate by working together tofoster national development. Lack of love disturbs peace, creates disorder and

destroys progress. Love encourages the African culture of sharing through the

extended family (communalism).

3)  Unity: – the state of being one, being in harmony or in agreement in objectives and feelings. The diversity of Kenya’s culture, religion, races and language requires that there must be unity for nation-building.

Role played by Nyayoism in national development.

  1. a) The philosophy formed the basis for solving national development problems. The philosophy perpetuated the Harambee spirit.
  2. b) The philosophy helped in unifying different communities. The philosophy enhanced cooperation and unity of all.
  3. c) Nyayoism was used as the rallying spirit for the collective contribution and approach to national development.
  4. d) Nyayoism discouraged societal evils since it preached love, unity and peace.

Corruption was discouraged through the philosophy.

  1. e) It discouraged all forms of discrimination based on religion, tribe, race, and social status.
  2. f) The philosophy created respect for public property and functions.
  3. g) It enabled the creation of a welfare state since everyone became mindful of others welfare.
  4. h) It created a sense of nationalism and patriotism necessary for national development.

Impact of National Philosophies

Social Impact of National Philosophies.

  1. a) Education has been promoted through philosophies like the Harambee that have

assisted in construction of schools, laboratories and libraries.

  1. b) Medical services have been improved
  2. c) Cooperation, understanding and unity have been encouraged since the philosophies emphasized togetherness for nation-building.
  3. d) The philosophies have promoted the spiritual and social welfare of people by raising their living standards. African socialism encourages people to assist others are share with others.
  4. e) Through the Harambee spirit, the plight of persons with disabilities and other

disadvantaged groups has been looked into.

  1. f) The philosophies have promoted African cultures, since they are drawn from African traditions.

Economic impacts.

  1. a) Self-reliance and The Africanization process through which the people of Kenya were able to take over from foreigners was made possible by the philosophies.
  2. b) Due to the policy of pooling together resources and the spirit of cooperation derived from African socialism, cooperative societies have been formed in agriculture and other sectors, thus contributing to the country’s development.
  3. c) Transport and communication has been improved through African socialism and

Harambee spirit. Rural access roads have been constructed; Nyayo buses were

bought though the scheme failed due to mismanagement.

  1. d) The agricultural sector has been boosted by the philosophies. Kenyans are

encouraged to work hard to increase food production.

  1. e) The pillars of Nyayoism have created a conducive atmosphere for growth of tourism and foreign investment in the country.

Political impacts.

  1. a) The philosophies have promoted nationalism and patriotism in the country.
  2. b) African socialism has encouraged the democratization process as it champions for political equality.
  3. c) It has promoted international cooperation and understanding

SOCIAL, ECONOMIC AND POLITICAL DEVELOPMENTS AND

CHALLENGES IN KENYA SINCE INDEPENDENCE  POLITICAL

DEVELOPMENT AND CHALLENGES

It must be noted that Kenya inherited a number of political problems from the colonial government. For example;

  1. a) Lack of African technocrats who could give political direction to the country.
  2. b) Suspicion and jealousy between different communities due to the divide-andrule tactic employed by the colonial administration for many years.
  3. c) An illiterate population, ignorant of its political obligations

Political developments in Kenya between 1963 and 1991

On 12th December 1963, Kenya became independent under KANU led by Jomo Kenyatta.In 1964, there was voluntary disbanding of KADU and APP making Kenya a de facto one party state. There was abolition of Federal Constitution in favour of a Unitary or Republican Constitution. The post of an executive president was created to replace the post of Prime Minister.In 1966, the Limuru conference presided over replacement of the Vice -President of KANU With seven Provincial Vice Presidents and one for Nairobi Area. On 14th April 1966, Oginga Odinga resigned from KANU and Government and formed Kenya People’s Union (KPU) where Bildad Kaggia, Achieng Oneko and Tom Odongo joined him.In 1966, the bicameral legislature (the senate and the House of Representatives) was disbanded. A single –chamber parliament was established.

In 1966, Joseph Murumbi was appointed the country’s vice-president to replace Oginga.

He resigned in 1967to pave way for Moi’s appointment.1969 witnessed the political assassination of the flamboyant Tom Mboya in the hands of one, Nahashon Njenga on 5th July on Nairobi’s Moi Avenue.1n 1969, KPU was banned following riots in Kisumu.

In 1975, Josiah Mwangi Kariuki. MP for Kinangop was found brutally murdered in Ngong Forest.In October 1975 martin Shikuku and the deputy speaker, Jean Marie Seroney, were arrested and detained for making claims in the house that KANU and parliament were dead. In 1976, Chelagat Mutai, MP for Eldoret North was arrested and jailed for 2½ years for inciting his constituents to violence. In 1977, George Anyona, MP for Kitutu was also arrested after he accused the government of corruption.In 1976, the change the constitution campaign was began by Kihika Kimani, Dr. Njoroge Mungai, Jackson Angaine, Paul Ngei and Njenga Karume with the objective of making sure that the then vice president, Daniel Arap Moi would not succeeded the president.On 22nd august 1978, Jomo Kenyatta died and Moi assumed presidency for 90 days and was finally elected as second president of Kenya.In July 1980, Moi banned all tribal organizations, the Kenya Civil Servants Union and the Nairobi University Staff Union.

In June 1982, after an attempt by Anyona to form a political party, section 2A was

introduced in the Kenyan constitution makin g it a de jure one party state.On 2nd august 982, Kenya experienced a coup d’etat by some air force servicemen. Charles Njonjo, the Constitutional Affairs Minister was accused of masterminding the coup.

In 1988, KANU introduced the infamous Queue voting method (mlolongo) that was open to abuse.In February 1990, Dr, Robert Ouko, minister of foreign affairs and international

cooperation was murdered.  The better part of 1991 witnessed a series of tribal clashes involving Kalenjin and Kikuyu, Kalenjin and Luhyia and Luos.

Kenya’s political developments from 1991 up to 2011.

In December 1991, a parliamentary act repealed the one-party system provisions of the constitution and effectively established a multiparty system. The first political party to be formed under the repealed act was Forum for the Restoration of Democracy (FORD)

In august 1992, one of the leaders of FORD Masind e Muliro died mysteriously.

The first multiparty elections were held in 1992 in December.KANU won against a disjointed opposition.In 1994, the official leader of the opposition and MP of Bondo, Jaramogi Oginga Odinga died.After 1997 elections, the Inter-Parliamentary Parties Group ((IPPG) passed the reforms that marked the genesis of the constitutional review process.In 2002, several opposition parties formed a coalition that overwhelmingly defeated KANU in the general elections.

In January 2003, the National Rainbow Coalition formed the new government with

Mwai Kibaki as the president.In august 2003, Wamalwa Kijana, the vice president of the coalition government died after a short illness. Mood Awori was appointed the next Vice president.In 2005, a new political movement, the Orange Democratic Movement (ODM) was formed as a campaign tool against the proposed new constitution. Raila Odinga was its leader.The general Elections of 2007 resulted in a political crisis that provoked an

unprecedented wave of political violence and killing across Kenya.On 28th February 2008 the former UN Secretary-General Kofi Annan succeeded in brokering a power sharing deal between the incumbent President, Mwai Kibaki, and the opposition leader, Raila Odinga thus bringing to end the political violence. On April 17, 2008, Raila Odinga, from Orange Democratic Movement, was sworn as Prime Minister of Kenya, after more than forty years of the abolition of office.On 28th august 2010 Kenya promulgated a new constitution thus making it the first independent African state to depart from the independence constitution.In 2011, the International Criminal Court seating at the Hague, begun criminal proceedings against Uhuru Kenyatta, William Ruto, former police Commissioner Hussein Ali, Henry Kosgei, the head of public service Francis Muthaura and a journalist Joshua Arap Sang over their involvement in the 2008 post-Election Violence.In June 2011, Dr. Willy Mutunga became the first Kenya’s Chief Justice and Nancy Makokha Barasa, his deputy under the new constitution.The Electoral Commission of Kenya (ECK) was also replaced with the Independent Elections and Boundaries Commission (IEBC). The constitutional changes in Kenya in the period between 1963 and 1991.The first meeting in Lancaster in 1960 resulted in an interim constitution that failed to grant any substantial autonomy to Kenya. The second Lancaster conference in 1962 negotiated a framework for self government. The third and final conference in 1963 resulted in the drafting and adoption of Kenya’s first independent Constitution by the British Parliament. The 1963 constitution marked the end of colonial rule and transformed the colony into a dominion.It established a parliamentary system with executive powers vested in a cabinet  headed by a Prime Minister.The Constitution was changed in 1964 and Kenya became a republic and the executive becamepresidential. The senate and regions were also abolished.In 1966, the voting majority to change the Constitution was lowered to two -thirds of the MPs. The term ‘region’ was replaced with ‘province.’In 1966, a constitutional amendment abolished the Bicameral Legislature and replaced it with a Unicameral Legislature, chosen directly by the electorate.On 28th April 1966, an amendment was passed to compel MPs who defected from sponsoring party, to resign from parliament and seek re-election.In May 1966, the Public Security Act was passed empowering the president to detain a citizen without trial on grounds of being a threat to state security.In 1968, the president was empowered to alter provincial and district boundaries.In 1968, the procedure for presidential elections and succession in the event of his death was laid down. The age qualification for presidential candidates was also lowered to 35 from 40 years.In 1974, an amendment of the constitution empowered the president to pardon any election offender at his own discretion. This was done to favour Paul Ngei. In 1975, Kiswahili was declared the national language of the national assembl y.In 1977, the Kenya court of appeal was established after the breakup of the East African Community. Voting age was lowered from 21 to 18. In 1979, both Kiswahili and English were declared languages of the national assembly.In 1982, Kenya became a de jure one party state. KANU became the only lawful party in Kenya.In 1987, the security of tenure of the Attorney General, Chief Secretary, The Comptroller and Auditor–General was removed. Office of chief secretary was abolished.In 1988, the security of tenure of Puisine Judges and Chairman of Public Service Commission was removed.A parliamentary act in December 1991 repealed the one-party system provisions of the constitution and effectively established a multiparty system. Multiparty elections were held the following year in December.

Steps towards realization of a new constitution in Kenya since 1997

  In 1997, Parliament passed the Constitution of Kenya Review Act that set the

pace for comprehensive constitutional reforms. The Constitution of Kenya

Review Commission (CKRC) was established to provide civic education, seek

public input and prepare a draft constitution).

  In 2005, after many years of struggle, the draft constitution was ultimately

rejected by Kenyans at the constitutional referendum because of  disagreements

amongst various stakeholders.

  28 February 2008The National Accord and Reconciliation Act (NARA) signed by President Kibaki and Prime Minister Raila Odinga put in place arrangement for a

new process to finalize the long awaited constitution of Kenya

  In 2008 the Constitution of Kenya Review Act 2008 was passed and a Committee of Experts (CoE) was established as the main technical constitutional review organ to drive the process. The CoE was chaired by Nzamba Kitonga, the deputy chair was Ms Atsango Chesoni, other members were Ms Njoki Ndung’u, Mr Otiende Amolo,Mr Abdirashid Hussein Mr Bobby Mkangi Professor Christina Murray (South Africa) Dr Chaloka Beyani (Zambia) and Dr Frederick Ssempebwav (Uganda.

  23 February 2009 Members of the CoE were appointed by the President were

later on sworn in

  On 17 November 2009 CoE released the draft to the public and invited views and comments on the draft constitution,

  By 23rd February 2010. CoE had submitted the final draft of constitution to the

Parliamentary Select Committee.

  On 4th august 2010 Kenya held a Constitutional Referendum where the new

constitution was overwhelmingly endorsed.

  On 28th august 2010, the new constitution was promulgated and became

operational making Kenya the first independent African state to depart from the

independence constitution.

MULTI-PARTY DEMOCRACY IN KENYA SINCE 1991.

Factors that led to the development of multi-party democracy in Kenya after 1991

  1. a) International pressure from multilateral and bilateral donors. The western donors

took advantage of the collapse of the Soviet Union to set the stringiest conditionalties for aid on the government, for democratic reforms.

  1. b) Disunity in KANU. There was pressure from individuals who had been expelled from KANU without political alternatives.
  2. c) Existence of people who were ready to push democratic agenda ahead. This

included the civil society, the lawyers and intellectuals. E.g the Law Society of Kenya led by Paul Muite and Gitobu Imanyara put pressure on the government for reforms.

  1. d) Success of multi-party in other African countries. In Zambia for example, Chiluba’s Movement for Multiparty Democracy defeated Kaunda’s United National

Independence Party.

  1. e) Pressure from the church. Several church leaders, among them Alexander Muge,

Bishop Henry Okullu and Rev. Timothy Njoya called upon the government to create an en environment in which Kenyans could participate in governance.

  1. f) Massive rigging of the elections. The most notorious of all was the 1988 general

elections, which were marred with widespread rigging.

  1. g) The developments in Eastern Europe. Due to Gorbachev’s liberal reforms, one party dictatorship in Eastern Europe was replaced by regimes that were more liberal.
  2. h) Rampant corruption in particular, embezzlement and misappropriation of public

funds and grabbing of public assets. Those who criticized were punished through

detention, arbitrary arrests and other forms of intimidation.

  1. i) Repeal of section 2A of the constitution in December 1991

Role played by political parties in government and national building in Kenya.

  1. a) The party that gunners majority of seats and votes forms the government either

alone or in coalition with other parties.

  1. b) Political parties influence government affairs and development through participation in legislation process.
  2. c) Political parties through the elected members of parliament decide on national

development policies and development projects.

  1. d) Political parties provide exemplary leadership founded on freedom , justice, fair play and African socialism.
  2. e) Opposition parties provide a system of scrutinizing government expenditure through public accounts committee and public investment committee.
  3. f) Opposition parties make the government more accountable to the people through

constant criticism.

  1. g) Opposition parties provide checks and balances to abuse and misuse of powers and privileges by those in the government.

 

Challenges of multi-party democracy in Kenya.

  1. a) Since many politicians and senior government officials were not ready for

Multipartism, they often incited their supporters to kick out opposition supporters

from certain regions. This has been common in the Rift Valley region.

  1. b) The executive arm and the ruling party have many a times misused the members of the civil service to frustrate the opposition. In case of flawed elections, the provincial administration has always been used in rigging.
  2. c) Many of the parties formed failed to attain a national outlook. They mainly were tribal based.
  3. d) The multi party democracy has been hampered with defection of greedy politicians who become preys to bribes. This has weakened some parties.
  4. e) The former KANU for a long time retained control of the government

machinery,,(the police force, the radio and television.) these were utilized for the

advantage of KANU for al long time.

  1. f) There has been a problem of lack of funding from the government. Most of the

political parties have been unable to sustain competition for political power due to

inadequate funds.

  1. g) Interference by the international community in the running of the country. Some

members of the diplomatic community openly side with certain political parties.

  1. h) Many political parties have been embroiled in wrangles. For example the Orange Democratic Movement has been bedevilled with a number of desertions due to wrangles between Ruto and his supporters and Raila Odinga. Ford Kenya has split into New Ford Kenya and Ford Kenya due to wrangles between Eugene Wamalwa and Moses Wetangula.

Identify the disadvantages of multiparty system.

  1. a) Multipartism tends to divide the people on tribal, regional and sectarian line.
  2. b) It tends to sharpen the struggle for personality and group dominance rather than

policy implementation.

  1. c) Multipartism is a foreign system, which does not conform to the aspirations of

independent Africa.

  1. d) It encourages the politics of destabilization.
  2. e) Political statements deadlocks on debates and tensions become too common.
  3. f) Decisions take too long to be made and implemented.
  4. g) Encourages use of violence in a state since opposition party members will be

regarded as traitors by the government. The government will be regarded as

oppressors by the opposition.

ECONOMIC DEVELOPMENTS AND CHALLENGES

Economic challenges that have faced Kenya since independence.

  1. a) Stagnation of investment in the first years of independence due to massive transfer of capita from the country by the white settlers. The government faced the

challenge of cultivating investor confidence.

  1. b) The problem of landlessness among many Africans whose arable land had been

alienated. There was an urgent need for redistribution.

  1. c) Serious economic disparity in the country with the former white highlands having adequate provision of water, electricity and roads while the rest lacked enough of the same.
  2. d) Overpopulation in urban areas as result of rural-urban migration, putting facilities under pressure and creating unemployment.
  3. e) Problem of control of economy by the Europeans prior to independence and after independence. E.g. farm ownership and key industries.
  4. f) Lack of qualified manpower to run the technical sectors of the economy.

These were issues that were addressed by session paper number 10 of 1965.

Types of landholding in Kenya.

Land tenure refers to the terms and conditions under which land is acquired, used or

transferred At independence the type of landholding in Kenya was mainly communal, where land belonged to the whole community. Access to land was open every member of a social group. Community elders, clan heads or kings were empowered to control and give advice on land use.Land alienation during the colonial period transformed land into a commodity th at could be disinherited from an individual. Such colonial land policies leading to alienation of African land resulted in the following;

  1. a) Widespread landlessness as Africans lost ancestral lands.
  2. b) Reduction in land available to Africans leading to land pressure as population

increased.

  1. c) Deterioration of the quality of land due to fragmentation.
  2. d) Overstocking because of limited land, leading to soil erosion.
  3. e) Displacement of pastoral and agricultural communities, leading to problems such as famine and livestock diseases.
  4. f) Disintegration of social and cultural institutions in the reserves due to ethnic

boundaries being fixed, thus separating African communities.

The Mau Mau wars which were a consequent of the bitterness arising from land

alienation resulted in a number of land reforms under the Swynnerton Plan of 1954. The plan put in place a programmee for land consolidation, adjudication and registration.

This was whet the Kenya government inherited at independence.

Land Adjudication: – verification of individual or group rights to land within a given area.

Land consolidation: – merging of fragmented land into single economic units.

Land registration: – recording of rights to land and the consequent issuance of a title

deed.The post-colonial land holding system in Kenya.The land tenure system in Kenya after independence was categorized as private or modern, communal or customary, public or state and open accessPrivate land; comprised of 6% of the total land areaGovernment-owned; former crown land, comprised 20% of the land area. It included the national parks, government or public forests, alienated (land acquired from customary land owners by government for own use or private development) and  unlalienated land

(land that has not been leased or allocated by the  government).Trust land comprised 64% of the total land area as at 1990. This comprised the former native areas and was awaiting small holder registration to transform it into private tenure system.Land ownership in Kenya has been a source of bitter conflict as manifested in the post election violence after the 2007 elections. The historical injustices in Kenya have always been related to land.

In 2010, land ownership in Kenya was classified as follows under the new constitution.

  1. a) Public land
  2. b) Community land
  3. c) Private land
  4. a) Public land

Public land is the land held by the central or local government.

It consists of;

~  Land not set aside for any purpose (unlalienated land).

~  Land set aside for public utility use or land that is occupied by the State organ

as lessee.

~  land transferred to the State by way of sale, reversion or surrender;

~  Land to which no individual or community ownership is traceable.

~  Land which no heir can be identified.

~  All minerals and mineral ores.

~  government forests, game reserves, water catchment areas, national parks,

government animal sanctuaries, and specially protected areas;

~  All roads and thoroughfares.

~  All rivers, lakes and other water bodies.

~  The territorial sea, the exclusive economic zone and the sea bed.

~  The continental shelf.

~  All land between the high and low water marks.

~  Any other land declared to be public land by an Act of Parliament.

Community land

Community land is land which is implied as owned by a group of people on the basis of customary norms, not through formal registration.

It consists of:

~  Land registered in the name of group representatives.

~  Land transferred to a specific community through a legal process.

~  Any other land declared to be community land by an Act of Parliament.

~  land that is held, managed or used by specific communities as community

forests, grazing areas or shrines;

~  Ancestral lands and lands traditionally occupied by hunter gatherer

communities;

~  Land held as trust land by the county governments, but not including any

public land held in trust by the county government.

Private land

Private land is land (and houses and buildings) held under registered entitlement

(freehold or leasehold).

It consists of:

~  Registered land held by any person under freehold tenure.

~  Land held by any person under leasehold tenure.

~  Any other land declared private land under an Act of Parliament.

Note:

~  Landholding by non-citizens is allowed only through lease for a period not

exceeding ninety-nine years.

~   A corporate body, for the purpose of land ownership can only be recognized as a

citizen if it is wholly owned by one or more citizens.

~  Property held in trust will only be recognized as being held by a citizen if all the

beneficial interest of the trust is held by the persons who are citizens.

Land policies since independence.

Two type of programme that characterized land reforms exercise that commenced in 1963 in Kenya were;

1)  Transfer of land from European large scale farmers to Africans.

2)  Land consolidation and registration in which the government purchased several

farms from the Europeans and sub-divided them among African holders.

In the former European farms, the government established settlement schemes as

follows;

1)  The Million Acre Scheme which was began in 1963 and involved settling African

families on 13.5 hectares each.

2)  The Harambee Scheme started in 1969, involved settling families on 16.25 hectares each.

3)  The Haraka Scheme where squatters were settled in small plots of land in Central, Coast, Eastern and Rift Valley Provinces.

4)  Shirika Scheme started in 1971 to settle the landless and unemployed on the former European lands. Under this scheme, the individual farmers would own a small plot each while the rest of the farm would be managed by a cooperative. This scheme did not succeed since people wished to have their own pieces of land.However, these schemes failed to adequately solve the problems of landlessness in the country. A few politically-connected people acquired large tracts of land, most of which remained underutilized. Some of the schemes are located in areas of harsh climatic conditions and are unviable without irrigation.Several commissions have addressed land issues in Kenya. For example, in 2001, President Moi appointed the Njonjo Commission to investigate the main problems of land ownership and distribution in Kenya. In 2003,  the NARC government set up the Ndung’u Commission on land. Its Recommendations are yet to be implemented.By 1983, 29 districts in Kenya had benefitted from Land adjudication and registration, a process which began in the 1950s in Central Kenya then spread to other parts of the country after 1963.

Benefits of the land reforms in Kenya.

  1. a) Farmers could use their land title deeds to get loans from banks in order to expand farming on their land.
  2. b) Land titles enabled people to purchase land with confidence. No one would alienate them from their land.
  3. c) The reforms enabled thousands of landless people to own land.
  4. d) Dairy and cash crop production increased.

Land ownership by non-citizens.

A non-citizen can only own land in the country on the basis of leasehold tenure not

exceeding 99 years.

Principles that govern utilization of land in Kenya.

  1. a) Equitable access to land. All members of the society must have equal access to land since it is an important resource.
  2. b) Transparent and cost effective administration of land. State institutions should be given powers and responsibilities of ensuring transparent and accountable

administration of land.

  1. c) Elimination of gender discrimination. in line with protection of human rights, for all,

discrimination against women on issues of land ownership and access to land need

be eliminated.

  1. d) Sustainable and productive management of land resources. Since land is an

economic resource, it should be managed well to ensure maximum productivity.

  1. e) Sound conservation and protection of ecologically sensitive areas. Conservation

measures like prohibiting settlement and agricultural activities in water catchment

areas and zoning of forest lands to protect them from further degradation.

  1. f) Encouragement of communities to settle land disputes. This should happen as long as they are consistent with the constitution.

Ways in which the Kenya government has solved land related problems since

independence.

  1. a) The problems related to Communal Land ownership have been solved through land demarcation and adjudication by the government. This saw the conversion from traditional system of land ownership to modern freeload tenure.
  2. b) Landlessness was solved through creation of resettlement schemes. Large-scale

farms and former European farms were divided into smaller ones and given  to the

landless. E.g Mwea Tebere, Bura, Shirika etc.

  1. c) The government has put marginal lands to more productive use through

establishment of irrigation schemes and drainage schemes.

  1. d) The government removed restriction of movements from the reserves that were

created by the colonial government. This decongested the reserves and gave chance

to arable farming.

  1. e) At independence, the t government embarked on land consolidation policy through which scattered plots were put into one holding.
  2. f) The government also embarked on land reclamation measure to bring previously

unused land to productive use.

  1. g) The Government has established the National Land Commission which manages

public land

The National Land Commission.

Functions of the National Land Commission.

  1. a) It manages public land on behalf of the national and county governments.
  2. b) It advises the national government on a comprehensive programme for land

registration throughout the country.

  1. c) It investigates present and past historical injustices, as a result of a complaint or

on its on initiative, and recommends appropriate action.

  1. d) It has a duty to encourage the use of traditional methods of dispute resolution in

land conflicts.

  1. e) It recommends the national land policy to the national government.
  2. f) It assesses tax on land and premiums on immovable property in any area

designated by law.

  1. g) It monitors land use planning throughout the country.

Development in agriculture since independence.

After independence, the government encouraged small scale farming of coffee and tea as opposed to large scale farming that existed during the colonial period.

The Agricultural development corporation (ADC) was set up to manage large scale farms that were established by the government in western, Rift Valley and Coast provinces.

Such farms specialize in production of seeds to be used by farmers for planting. They also specialize in production of high quality dairy and beef cattle in Kenya.The government also established the Kenya Agricultural Research Institute (KARI) in Muguga near Kikuyu to assist in identifying good crop breeds for different types of soils.

Irrigation Schemes were expanded in the marginal areas. For example. Mea (central), Bura (coast), Ahero (Nyanza) and Perkerra (central).The government created development authorities to effectively manage water catchment areas. For example, TARDA, KVDA and LBDA.

Challenges facing Kenya’s agricultural sector.

  1. a) The 1984 drought and famine in various parts of the country occasioning supply of relief food to the affected regions.
  2. b) Rapid increase in population which is not at pace with the rate of increase in

agricultural production.

  1. c) From the late 1970s, the world market prices of agricultural commodities fell

drastically yet the inputs remained expensive.

  1. d) Corruption and mismanagement of the cooperatives leading to meager earnings for key cash crops in Kenya.
  2. e) Grabbing of research land by corrupt government officials has affected the

operations of the research institutes.

  1. f) The problem of poor infrastructure in the country sometimes discourages farmers

especially during the rainy season.

  1. g) Ethnic clashes in Molo in 1991-1992, Likoni in 1997 and Mahi Mahiu in 2005 plus the post election violence in 2008 discouraged farmers from intense farming due to insecurity.
  2. h) Poor technology hassled to low yields. People in Kenya still rely on natural rains for agriculture instead of using irrigation. Others use primitive traditional tools in

cultivation.

  1. i) The problem of pests that destroy the farm yields before reaching the factory.
  2. j) Competition from COMESA member states and from the more industrialized powers such as the European Union and USA often frustrate Kenyan farmers.

Industrial developments in Kenya since independence.

Kenya’s industrial sector was shaped by the long period of colonization. At

independence, industry was characterized by dominance of foreign capital and

dominance of the agricultural sector.

Factors that facilitated industrial development in Kenya since the colonial era.

  1. a) The existence of raw materials, such as trona (soda ash) at lake Magadi, fluorspar at Kerio Valley and lime in several parts of the country.
  2. b) Existence of fish resource from numerous water bodies has promoted the fishprocessing industry.
  3. c) Existence of expansive forests which provide timber needed in the furniture

industry.

  1. d) The rich scenary, e.g Mt. Kenya, Mt. Elgon, the Aberdares and rich wildlife have promoted the tourism industry.
  2. e) Kenya’s rivers have enough water for production of HEP.
  3. f) Increase in population since the colonial period ensured supply of labour and the

market required for industries to flourish.

  1. g) The transport and communication infrastructure have provided the necessary link

between the material producing zones , industries and markets..

  1. h) Existence of rich agricultural lands producing raw materials such as coffee, tea,

sugarcane, sisal and fruits

Measures taken by the Kenyan government to promote industrial development since

independence.

  1. a) The government engaged on decentralization programmes to spur development

in new areas. Industries were established in rural areas.

  1. b) The government has embarked on the programmes of funding new markets for

industrial products.

  1. c) Infrastructure was improved through establishment of more roads, railways and

improvement of water transport, to-transport raw materials labour and goods.

  1. d) Power concerns were addressed through construction of the Seven Forks Dam to

supplement power from neighboring Uganda.

  1. e) Favourable government policies have been put in place to attract investors.
  2. f) The government has put in place measures to reduce imports in order to protect

local infant industries. E.g discriminative tariffs were introduced.

  1. g) The government encouraged and assisted in giving capital for industrial

development through development of the co-operative movement, funding through

Industrial and Commercial Development Corporation(ICDC) , the Development

Finance Company of Kenya.(DFCK) and the Industrial Development Bank.

  1. h) The government has ensured political stability in the country, which is an

important factor in industrial development.

Factors that have hindered industrial development in Kenya.

  1. a) The problem  of  multi  nationals  whose  interests  do  not  favour  Kenya’s

Multi-national co-operation repatriate capital to their own home countries

  1. b) There is shortage  of  strategic raw materials  g. petroleum, diamond. Cotton for textile industries. Many industrial companies use imported raw materials.
  2. c) Foreigners, who pass policies not friendly to the country, hold managerial positions in industries.
  3. d) Mismanagement of major industries and lack of transparency I parastatals.
  4. e) Over concentration of industries in few areas leading to negligence of other areas.

It also has led to related problems of industrial concentration like the social ills.

  1. f) Competition from the industrialized nations who dominate the market and produce high quality goods.
  2. g) Poverty limits industrialization. A poor population means a small domestic market thus hindering industrial development.
  3. h) Products are produced with low technology hence small quantities.

Further reading on industrial development should be done with reference to evolving world book 4 pages 162-164

Social Development and challenges since independence.

Education.

To solve the problems inherited at independence in the education sector (poor quality education and poor facilities available the Kenya children), the government undertook the following measures;

  1. a) Constitutional amendments  were  made  in  1975  to  give  Kiswahili  a  respectable position in the country.
  2. b) Several educational Commissions were set up to streamline education.
  3. c) The Harambee strategy was employed to expand educational facilities.

Education Commissions.

  1. a) The Kenya Education Commission (1964) (The Ominde commission) that

recommended overhaul of curriculum to make it relevant.

  1. b) The National Committee on Education Objectives and policies- Gachathi commission(1976) that looked into he possibility of setting up a second university.
  2. c) Presidential Working Party on the Second University- The Mackey commission

(1982) that established the 8-4-4 system and proposed emphasis of vocational

subjects such as art and craft, music, agriculture and Home science.

  1. d) The Kamunge commission (1988) which recommended cost-sharing in education
  2. e) The Koech commission (1999) which recommended reintroduction of A-level

system in form of Totally Integrated Quality Edu cation and Training.

Main developments in education in Kenya since independence.

In 1975, Kiswahili was made the official languages of parliament and learning in schools.

The ministry of education established structures right from the district level to national level to help in fulfilling the national objectives of education.Several education commissions were set up to streamline education. The harambee strategy was employed to expand education facilities. Many schools were built.In 1980, the government took over the responsibility of providing pre-primary education.In the 1990s, the government in collaboration with UNICEF launched a programme to promote early childhood education.By 1998, the total number of students in the various universities was over 40,000.In 1969, the ministry of education took over the administration of primary education from local government, this witnessed increased enrolment.In 1978, the government introduced the school milk programme to encourage children especially in drought prone areas to go to school.The programme stalled in 1990 but had achieved higher enrolment in schools.The Ministry of education launched school feeding programme, targeting dry areas.In 2002, the NARC government introduced the ‘Free Primary Education ’ policy.Further reading be done from evolving world on Elementary education and Tertiary education in Kenya.

Health.

Measures taken to improve the health sector in postcolonial Kenya.

  1. a) The ministry of health was created to oversee health matters.
  2. b) Expansion of health facilities through harambee and donor funds e.g. Nyanza

Provincial hospital (Russian Hospital)

  1. c) Many health training institutions were started e.g. Medical training colleges
  2. d) Improvement in hygiene through provision of piped water.
  3. e) Establishment of several research institutions on human diseases e.g. KEMRI
  4. f) Provision of more basic education in order to uplift hygiene standards in the society.
  5. g) Provision of free anti-retroviral and anti-malaria drugs.

Major challenges facing the Health sector in Kenya.

  1. a) Increase in population has posed major challenges to the government in the

provision of healthcare services to its citizens. There has been a challenge of

inadequate doctors and medical facilities.

  1. b) The cost- sharing policy introduced in the 1980s to help buy medicine and other

equipment has prevented the poor from going to the hospitals.

  1. c) The spread of HIV and AIDS and other diseases such as Diabetes and Heart diseases has worsened the situation.
  2. d) Cultural practices like Female mutilation have made provision of medical services more challenging.
  3. e) Pollution of the environment has increased allergy-related ailments, many of which have no cure.
  4. f) Poverty and malnutrition render many people vulnerable to diseases.
  5. g) Illegal abortion and early pregnancies endanger the lives of mothers.
  6. h) High rate of accidents and injuries , especially on roads.

ways through which the government has encouraged the preservation of African culture since independence.

  1. a) Creation of the ministry of culture and social services. The ministry promotes

cultural and social values.

  1. b) The syllabus has been tailored to include cultural studies.
  2. c) Inclusion of music as a subject in the national curriculum.
  3. d) The government has encouraged music/drama festivals on an annual basis as way of promoting cultural exchange.
  4. e) The government has encouraged intermarriage between different ethnic groups.
  5. f) The government has developed cultural heritage centre at the Bomas of Kenya,

National Archives and Museums.

  1. g) Schools have been encouraged to admit people from different communities.
  2. h) Allowing the media houses to play traditional music/dance..

Students  Read on sports, literature, theatre, music and dance from evolving world page 174.

SOCIAL, ECONOMIC AND POLITICAL DEVELOPMENT AND CHALLENGES IN

AFRICA SINCE INDEPENDENCE.

THE DEMOCRATIC REPUBLIC OF CONGO.

Political developments in Democratic Republic of Congo since independence

The Belgians relinquished their political dominion of Congo by granting them autonomy on 30th June 1960. Patrice Lumumba (Prime Minister) of Congolese National Movement Party and Joseph Kasavubu of Abako Party (Head of State) formed a fragile coalition government. The two leaders differed ideologically.The period between 1960 and 196 witnessed power struggle between Kasavubu and Lumumba on one side and Secessionist Moise Tsombe of Katanga and Albert Kalonji of Kasai on the other side. In 1961, Patrice Lumumba was assassinated. This led to withdrawal of his supporters from government.

In 1961, the UN Secretary General Dag Hammarskjöld perished in a plane crash in the Congo while attempting to bring a peaceful political solution to the Congo crisis.In 1964, a new constitution was formulated as a way of solving the political problems that plagued Zaire soon after independence. Zaire became a federal state with a federal president and separate assemblies for each state.On 23rd November 1965, Joseph Desire Mobutu organized a bloodless military coup, which removed the civilian government of president Kasavubu and Prime Minister Sylvester Kimba.In November 1965, Mobutu took over power after a bloodless coup.In the same year, , Mobutu banned all political parties. He suspended the constitution and parliament. He abolished the federal system and local assemblies and reduced the number of provinces to eight.In 1967, He formed the Peoples’ Revolution Movement (MPR), which became theonly legal party in Congo. He in effect-replaced democracy with one-party dictatorship leaned to the west during the cold war.1n 1970, Mobutu declared himself the life president of Congo, after winning the

presidential election.In 1971, he outlawed the use of European names for people, places and physical features as a way of removing colonial legacy. The country was renamed Zaire. His own name changed to Mobutu Sese Seko. Leopoldville was renamed Kinshasa.In 1973, Mobutu announced the nationalization of all foreign enterprises.

In 1977-1978, the Shaba Rebellion broke out mainly after an attack by the Congolese National Liberation Front from their base in Angola. The Belgian troops were called to silence the rebels.In 1990 and 1991, multiparty activists stepped up pressure for change. In September 1991, dissatisfied soldiers and civilians held demonstrations, which led to death of 117 people. In 1997, Laurent Kabila successfully ousted Mobutu, assisted by Rwanda and Uganda. Mobutu fled to exile in Morocco where he died.

In January 2001, Laurent Kabila was assassinated in mysterious circumstances. His son took over power.In April 2002, through a power–sharing agreement presided over by Thabo Mbeki and a UN envoy, Mustapha Niasse, a government of national unity was formed.

Economic developments in DRC since independence.

The political chaos inn DRC up to 1965 did not favour any economic progress. During the reign of the Belgians in Congo, no viable economic development was initiated. Little development was done in infrastructure in order to facilitate transportation of raw materials to the ports of Matadi etc.At independence, the country was faced with the problems of shortage of manpower, skills and entrepreneurship.When Mobutu took over, there was some slight economic progress. Transport and communication improved as more roads and railway were constructed to link major towns of Matadi, Kinshasa, Lubumbashi and Kisangani. Navigation on the river Congo was improved, which led go expansion of mining and agricultural sectors.Mining of diamonds resumed after the turbulent years and resulted in reduced inflation.Mobutu encouraged foreign investment in the mining sector.However, the fall of world copper prices in 1970s again began to derail the economic growth in DRC.In the 70s, the government nationalized foreign firms employed inexperienced people to control them.In 197, Mobutu enacted a law that placed state finances and expenditure under him, thus reducing the flow of capital to the provinces.In 1976, he encouraged mutual cooperation between private firms and the government in the extraction of minerals such as copper, oil, diamond, cobalt and manganese in a bid to create employment opportunities.He also emphasized on diversification of the economy which greatly boosted food production.The entertainment industry has also grown to become an invisible export through repatriation of profits back home by the foreign based musicians. Energy supply has been increased through the construction of the Luga hydro-electric power station.

Social developments and challenges in DRC since independence.

Between 1961 and 1965, there was little improvement in the field of health and

education in DRC due to constant power struggles and civil strife.When Mobutu took over in 1965, he strived to expand schools and universities. For example, by 1970, he had established three universities. He also improved on the provision of health facilities. He banned religious education in schools. In 1971, attempted to revive indigenous culture through the Authenticity programme that involved renaming places that had foreign names.In the 1970’s, in an effort to improve the welfare of citizens, a national insurance

programme was established. Mobutu also gave prominence to music as part of the Congolese curriculum.The independent government supported sporting activities through construction of stadium and other sporting facilities.However, living standards in Zaire continued to fall as health services, water and sanitation continued to be inadequate.

The steady rise in population was without a commensurate growth of social services.

In summary, the common challenges socially were illiteracy, extreme poverty, famine and diseases caused by civil strife, massive unemployment, refugee problem and religious persecutions by Mobutu.

Political challenges that the democratic republic of Congo has faced since

independence.

  1. a) There was general lack of preparedness of the people for independence. Foreigners controlled even the army and the police.
  2. b) The assassination of Patrice Lumumba in 1961, which plunged the country into the Congo crisis.
  3. c) Political instability/military coup d’état. In November 1965, Mobutu organized a

military coup. In 1997, Kabila ousted Mobutu

  1. d) Ethnic differences/tribal clashes/civil wars, which split the country into two parts at independence. One controlled by Lumumba and another controlled by Kasavubu.
  2. e) The problem of Secession. Secessionist movement of the Katanga region (Shaba) led by Tsombe and Kasai under Kilonji seceded.
  3. f) Foreign interference/intrigues. Belgium constantly interfered and intervened in

Zaire’s internal matters. France and Britain also began to interfere from 1977 during

the cold war period.

  1. g) Mutinies in the army were common.

Economic challenges that Democratic Republic Of Congo (D.R.C) faced in 1970’s.

  1. a) Corruption and mismanagement of the economy. Mobutu was the richest president in the world while Zairians became the poorest people in the world.
  2. b) Inflation due to power struggle and corruption. By 1980, the country’s currency was not worthy the paper on which it was printed.
  3. c) There was also a problem of heavy foreign debt. The country was unable to service her debts. By 1980, Zaire had become the world’s third biggest debtor nation.
  4. d) There was a standstill in the economic activities and disruption of railway transport due to civil wars in the country and neighbouring Angola.
  5. e) The period also witnessed fall in world copper prices and increase in oil prices
  6. f) Lack of a sound economic policy

TANZANIA.

Political developments in Tanzania since independence.At the time of independence, Tanzania comprised of two countries. I.e. Tanganyika and Zanzibar. Tanzania became independent in 1961 under Julius Nyerere while Zanzibar became independent in 1963 under the Sultan Seyyid Abdullah.In 1962, Tanzania became a one-party state with a republican constitution and an executive president. Tanganyika African National Union (TANU) became the sole political party.On 22ndApril 1964, Julius Nyerere and Sheikh Abeid Karume signed a union document. Nyerere became the executive head of state and government while Karume as the first vice-president.In 1967, president Nyerere adopted the ideology of African Socialism through the Arusha Declaration In 1972, the first Vice-president, Sheikh Abeid Karume, was assassinated. Aboud Jumbe succeeded him as Zanzibar’s president and the vice-president of Tanzania.In 1973, the capital of Tanzania was transferred from Dar-es-Salam to Dodoma.In 1967, the ruling party in the Mainland Tanganyika-TANU and Afro-Shirazi Party in Zanzibar merged to form Chama cha Mapinduzi (CCM). Nyerere became the party chairman.In 1978-1979, president Idi Amin invaded Tanzania to annex the Kagera Province, which he claimed, was a Ugandan territory. Nyerere swiftly repulsed Ugandan soldiers.In 1985, Nyerere retired as president and was replaced by Ali Hassan Mwinyi who had succeeded Jumbe as head of Zanzibar and Tanzania’s first vice president.In May 1992, Tanzania adopted multi-partism after the 8th constitutional Amendment Act.In 1995, Tanzania conducted the first multi-party election, where Benjamin Mkapa was elected president.

Social developments in Tanzania since independence.

The major highlight in the social development of an independent Tanzania was an

attempt to create a classless society with e reduced gap, between the rich and the poor.

Through the Ujamaa policy, president Nyerere tried to turn Tanzania into a country that had political and economic policies based on African traditions and aspirations.

Under the policy, communal farms were created.Primary education was made free in 1977 and became compulsory in 1978.At present, Tanzania boasts of the highest number of literate persons in eastern Africa.Upto late 1980s, government provided free health services, until the introduction of the Structural Adjustment Programmes by the Donor community.Kiswahili was adopted as a national language and a major medium of instruction in schools.

Economic developments in Tanzania since independence.

The main landmark in Tanzania’s economic the launch of Ujamaa as a development

policy in 1967 during the Arusha declaration..Ujamaa was meant to transform production in rural areas and to increase labour productivity and even allow specialization introduction.The government nationalized all the major means of production and essential services in order to empower people economically.The Tanzam railway was constructed with the help of china and was completed in 1975.In 1976, cooperative societies were abolished and replaced with centralized corporations owned by the government.The period between 1979 and 1985 witnessed economic stagnation in Tanzania as investors pulled out of the country.The collapse of the East African Community also affected the economy of the country.After 1985, Nyerere’s economic policies began to be challenged openly by scholars and economistsWhen president Mwinyi took over, he undertook to reform the economy of Tanzania.

Political challenges that Tanzania has faced since independence.

  1. a) There was an Army mutiny in Tanzania 1964, which threatened her political

stability.

  1. b) The socialism policy (The Arusha Declaration) received stiff opposition from many both internally and externally. People favoured capitalism.
  2. c) The assassination of Abeid Karume in 1972 and the resignation of Aboud Jumbe in 1984 appeared to threaten the unity of the two members of the Union Declaration.
  3. d) The invasion of Tanzania by Uganda in 1978.and the consequent war with Uganda was costly to the country. It also threatened her cooperation with neighbours.
  4. e) There was an escalation of corruption among leading members of Tanzania’s

political elite, including claims that President Hassan Mwinyi and his family

capitalized on liberalization to amass a lot of wealth.

  1. f) the re-introduction of multiparty democracy tended to awaken tribalism and

regionalism although this problem was contained.

Social problems, which Tanzania faced since independence.

  1. a) Famine and shortage of health services as the government adopted the Structural

Adjustment Policies of IMF.

  1. b) Poverty and a general drop in living standards as production dropped due to

socialism.

  1. c) Lack of social amenities, like clean water in rural areas.
  2. d) High illiteracy level.
  3. e) In Tanzania, industries closed after the Arusha declaration.
  4. f) Population explosion which outstripped the country’s resources
  5. g) Tanzania was under terrorist attacks in 1997 targeting the American

embassy.

  1. h) Environmental pollution.
  2. i) Over-crowding in urban areas.

Economic challenges.

  1. a) In the early years of independence, the proliferation of African enterprises led to the widening of the gap between the rich and the poor.
  2. b) Under the ujamaa policy, the forced villagization programme did not satisfy

communities in areas with favourable climate. They therefore strongly resisted it.

  1. c) There was rampant rural-urban migration affecting mainly able-bodied men who felt exploited by the new system of production.
  2. d) The abolition of cooperatives was met with stiff resistance with many farmers

cutting down heir production. Other producers reverted to the black market.

  1. e) The Tanzanian shilling became unstable due to price fluctuations of some

commodities.

  1. f) There was shortage of donor funds caused by the nationalization programme that

was opposed by many donor countries.

  1. g) The collapse of the East African Community in 1977 denied Tanzania a large

common market for her goods

SOCIAL, ECONOMIC AND POLITICAL CHALLENGES IN AFRICA IN GENERAL.

Political challenges that have faced African countries since independence

  1. a) The political systems that were inherited from the colonial governments seemed to be unworkable in many independent African states.
  2. b) Sharp ideological difference arose among the pioneer leaders of African states. Such differences internally exploded into civil strife in countries like Mozambique, Angola and DRC.
  3. c) The cold war had diverstating effects on Africa. it left many African nations divided and locked in border conflicts that continue up to date.
  4. d) Political instability was quite common in African states. Coups d’tat and military takeover was witnessed in Somalia, Zaire, Nigeria, Chad etc Human rights were violated with the rise of dictatorship.
  5. e) There were strained relations between African leaders caused by personal and

ideological differences. Some ended in border closure, which greatly undermined

international cooperation.

  1. f) Many national interests in Africa countries have been in conflict with global and

continental interests. Nigeria and Zimbabwe, for example had to be expelled from

the Commonwealth of Nations for alleged disregard of human rights and personal

property.

  1. g) Neo-colonialism. Most countries retain the colonial structures of parliament

although they have difficulties in sustaining them. Multinational peacekeeping

forces are still common in Africa, many African leaders inherited the divide and rule colonial strategy that precipitates anarchy.

  1. h) The existence of different ethnic groups has contributed to ethnic wars as witnessed in Rwanda, Burundi, Sudan, Nigeria and Kenya.
  2. i) Most African government seemed ill prepared and in experienced in administration.

This resulted in rise of rebel movements, as was the case of Mozambique and

Angola.

economic challenges facing independent African states today.

  1. a) Unemployment and socio-economic inequalities both among individuals and

between regions are common in may African nations.

  1. b) Overdependence on primary exports. The African economy is an extractive one

rather than a manufacturing economy. Many countries depend on agriculture and

foreign nations for manufactured goods.

  1. c) World trade terms are not fair for African nations. Africa countries find themselves trading with former colonial powers that give low prices fort raw material from Africa and charge high process for the manufactured goods.
  2. d) There has been the problem of unfavourable climatic conditions. This has curtailed food production, particularly among agricultural communities.
  3. e) Population pressure has led to overstretching of social services. There is a high

dependency ratio since the population is largely youthful and unemployed.

  1. f) Poor economic planning. Some economic policies have destabilized the economies.

For the Ujamaa policy in Tanzania, the expelling of foreign investors in Uganda and the massive printing of money in Zaire.

  1. g) The tough conditions given by donor agencies have sometimes led to deterioration of social welfare. Retrenchment for example was a key prescription of the Structural Adjustment Programme.
  2. h) Corruption and embezzlement of public funds is common in African countries. There is also general lack of transparency among many leaders.

Social challenges that have faced African states since independence.

  1. a) Inaccessibility to clean water by majority of the people. Most African peoples rely on water fetched from sometimes contaminated streams across long distances.
  2. b) The challenge of HIV/AIDS pandemic. This has had a toll on productive members of

the society.

  1. c) Poor housing facilities.. in urban areas, majority of the population live in slums

without sanitation facilities.

  1. d) The challenge of high population growth rate. This affects the quality of the services provided by governments.
  2. e) Language problem. Language development and use has been a challenge in Africa. In many countries, conflict tends to arise over the language to adopt- local or the inherited one.
  3. f) Religious differences. This challenge has been the main cause of the splitting of the once largest country in Africa-Sudan in 2011. The predominantly Christian southern Sudan has become the youngest African state thanks to religious differences.
  4. g) Absence of practical systems of education. Many countries rely on theoretical

education with little emphasis in technical skills.

DEVOLVED GOVERNMENT.

Devolution This refers to the granting of power from the central government to a lower level such as a region or a local level.A ‘Devolved Government’ is a system of government where there is a transfer or allocation of authority from a central government to a regional government. In a devolved government, power and resources are decentralized with part of the political and economic decision making transferred to the people through the locally established assemblies.

Origin of devolution in Kenya.

The Lancaster House Conference of 1962 forms the basis of devolution in Kenya. When the independent constitution was drawn during the conference, a federal system of government as proposed by the KADU delegates was adopted in Kenya. It made provisions for six regions. The legislature was to comprise two chambers (the Senate or upper House and the Lower House. However after independence in 1963, the Kenyatta Government began plans to scuttle the system of government. By December 1964, KANU and KADU merged to form a unitary government of the republic of Kenya.

The enactment of the new constitution on 27th August 2010 reintroduced the concept of devolution in Kenya.Kenya is divided into 47 Counties each governed by A County Governor with theassistance of the County Executive Assembly. The National Government seats in Nairobi.

To change County Boundaries, the Following must be considered;

  1. a) Population density and demographic trends.
  2. b) Physical and Human infrastructure.
  3. c) Historical and Cultural Ties.
  4. d) The cost of administration.
  5. e) The Views of the communities affected.
  6. f) The objectives of devolution of government.
  7. g) Geographical features.

Reasons why devolved governments were established in Kenya.

  1. a) They were established as a means of promoting democratic and accountable exercise of power.
  2. b) To Foster national unity by recognizing diversity.
  3. c) To give powers of self-governance to the people and enhance the participation of

the people in the exercise of the powers of the State and in making decisions

affecting them.

  1. d) To recognize the right of communities to manage their own affairs and to further

their development.

  1. e) To protect and promote the interests and rights of minorities and marginalized

communities.

  1. f) To promote social and economic development and the provision of services

throughout Kenya.

  1. g) To ensure equitable sharing of national and local resources throughout Kenya.
  2. h) To facilitate the decentralization of State organs, their functions and services, from the capital of Kenya;
  3. i) To enhance checks, balances and the separation of powers.

Principles of devolution of government in Kenya.

  1. a) County governments shall be based on the democratic principles and separation of power.
  2. b) County governments shall have reliable sources of revenue to enable them to

govern and deliver services effectively.

  1. c) No more than two-thirds of the members of representative bodies in each county

government shall be of the same gender.

Structure and Functions of a county government in Kenya.

The county government is composed of County assemblies, county executive

committees and county public service.

County Assembly in Kenya.

A county assembly consists of Members (one member per ward) elected by the

registered voters of the wards in a general election.Members of special seats (no more than two-thirds of the membership of the assembly is of the same gender.)Members of marginalized groups, including persons with disabilities and the youth.The Speaker, who is an ex officio member. Nb-The members for special seats and marginalized communities are nominated by political parties in proportion to the seats received in the election in a particular county.

Conditions for seeking election to a County Assembly.

  1. a) The person must be a registered as a voter in his/her county.
  2. b) The person must have been a Kenyan citizen for atleast ten years before the

elections.

  1. c) The person must be able to read and write in English and Kiswahili.
  2. d) He or she must be of sound mind.
  3. e) The person must be of unquestionable morals and ethics
  4. f) If a public officer, he/she must relinquish his/her public work.
  5. g) The person must be nominated by a political party
  6. h) If he/she is an independent candidate, must b e supported by at least five hundred registered voters in the Ward concerned.
  7. i) The person must not have been declared bankrupt.
  8. j) The person must not have served a sentence of imprisonment of more than six

months.

  1. k) Must not have been a member of IBEC within five years before the date of election.
  2. l) The person must not have misused or abused a State or public office.

Functions of a county assembly.

  1. a) County assemblies make laws for the effective performance of the county

government.

  1. b) It acts as a watch dog over the county executive committee.
  2. c) It receives and approves plans and policies for managing and exploiting the county’s resources,
  3. d) It approves policies for developing and managing the infrastructure and institutions in the county.
  4. e) It enhances legislation that may set out the structure and framework for the better administration and management of county governments.
  5. f) It approves oversight budgets and development projects within the county.
  6. g) It approves investment decisions and loans.
  7. h) It supervises other units within the county through political authority, guidance and direction.
  8. i) Monitors the execution of projects under approved development plans, and

assesses and evaluates their impact on development in the county.

The process of law making in a county government.

It is the duty of the County Executive committee, comprising of the governor, the

deputy governor and ten other members to draft the details of the proposed legislation with no bias.The public servants in the county governor’s office participate in preparation of the proposed law.The county executive committee then presents the proposed legislation to the county assembly.The members of the county assembly are then free to make their contributions to the bill during the discussion and debate that follows.

Amendments and improvements may be proposed to the bill at this stage.The recommendations are incorporatedIf the members are in favour of the bill, and if it is in conformity with the National Government legislation, then it is approved to become a by-law of the county government

The structure of The County Executive Committee.

The executive authority of the county is vested in the county executive committee.

The committee consists of The county Governor and the Deputy County Governor.

Not more than ten other Members appointed by the County Governor, with the

approval of the assembly, who are not members of the assembly.If the assembly has less than thirty members, the members should be One-third of the number of members of the county assembly.The county governor and the deputy county governor are the chief executive and deputy chief executive of the county respectively.Members of a county executive committee are accountable to the county governor for the performance of their functions and exercise of their powers.The members of the county executive committee cease to hold office once the office of the county governor falls vacant.

Functions of a County Executive Committee.

  1. a) It implements county legislation.
  2. b) It implements, within the county, national legislation.
  3. c) It manages and coordinates the functions of the county administration and its

departments.

  1. d) It prepares proposed legislation for consideration by the county assembly.
  2. e) It provides the county assembly with full and regular reports on matters relating to the county.

Powers and functions of a governor in a county government.

  1. a) The Governor is the chief executive officer of the county. The Executive Branch of government, headed by the Governor, includes executive departments and advisory boards.
  2. b) The Governor is the Chairman of county executive committee.
  3. c) he/ she is in charge of implementing , within the county, national legislation to the extent that the legislation so requires;
  4. d) He ensures, through the county executive committee, the implementation of county legislation.
  5. e) He manages and coordinates the functions of the county administration and its

departments.

  1. f) He provides the county assembly with full and regular reports on matters relating to the county.
  2. g) He appoints with the approval of the assembly members, members to the county

executive committee.

  1. h) He ensures that Members of a county executive committee perform their functions and exercise of their powers fully.
  2. i) He handles on behalf of the county, all external affairs with other counties in

consultation with the central government. (Excluding any which have been

delegated to cabinet secretaries.).

  1. j) The Governor prepares and submits a budget of the county for the following fiscal year.
  2. k) He sets the terms and conditions of service of persons holding or acting in public

offices in the county.

  1. l) By virtue of his office, the Governor serves on certain boards and special

commissions in the county. The Governor chairs the Board of Public Works.

 

Election of a county governor.

The county governor is directly elected by the voters registered in the county at a

general election for a term of 5 years.To be eligible for election as county governor, a person must be eligible for election as a member of the county assembly.Each candidate for election as county governor nominates a person as his/her running mate to be the deputy governor.If re-elected, can serve for another final term of 5 years.

Each candidate for election as county governor nominates a person as his/her running mate to be the deputy governor.

A County Governor can be removed from office under the following circumstances.

  1. a) Gross violation of the Constitution or any other law.
  2. b) When the county governor commits a crime under national or international law.
  3. c) When the governor abuses office or is accused of gross misconduct.
  4. d) When he/she suffers from Physical or mental incapacity that hinders

performance of the functions of office.

Functions of a deputy governor.

  1. a) As the deputy chief executive of the county, he or she assists the governor in the

management and coordination of the functions of the county administration.

  1. b) He or she acts as the governor of the county when the governor is absent.
  2. c) The deputy assists the governor in the supervision of work of the county executive committee.
  3. d) Since he/she is a member of the county executive committee, he participates in

legislation by also preparing proposals for county legislation.

  1. e) He assumes governorship of the county incase the governor is incapacitated or is

removed from authority for various reasons.

Functions and powers of a county government.

  1. a) County governments have the duty to assist in promotion of agriculture by initiating development in specific areas like crop and animal husbandry, livestock sale yards, slaughterhouses control of plant and animal diseases and development of fisheries.
  2. b) It provides and supervises county health services, both public health and personal health of county members.
  3. c) It assists in control of environmental pollution by putting in place legislation to

regulate and control air pollution, noise pollution and outdoor advertising.

  1. d) It promotes cultural activities, public entertainment and public amenities ion the

county by putting in place structures such as libraries, museums, sporting facilities,

casinos, beaches and county parks.

  1. e) It has a duty to promote and regulate education at the pre-primary, polytechnic,

craft and childcare levels.

  1. f) It has a duty to develop transport facilities in the county through road construction, street lighting, developing ferries and harbours and parking areas.
  2. g) The county government regulates county planning and development through land survey and mapping, boundaries, housing, electricity, gas and energy regulation.
  3. h) It implements specific national government policies on natural resources and

environmental conservation.

  1. i) It also puts in place measures to control drug abuse and access to pornography.

Relationship between national and county government.

  1. a) Governments at either level must exercise their powers and functions in a manner that respects the functional and institutional integrity of government at the other level.
  2. b) Each of the two governments must assist, support, consult and implement the

legislation of the other level of government.

  1. c) Either of the two governments must liaise with government at the other level for the purpose of exchanging information, coordinating policies and administration and enhancing capacity.
  2. d) Governments at each level or different level should co-operate in the performance of functions and exercise of powers.
  3. e) In any dispute between governments, reasonable efforts to settle dispute should be made.
  4. f) County governments rely on Procedures provided under national legislation in

settling intergovernmental disputes between them.

  1. g) Parliament at national level has the role of ensuring that county governments have adequate support to enable them to perform their functions.
  2. h) County governments must operate financial management systems that comply with any requirements prescribed by national legislation.
  3. i) National government is permitted to take any measure on county government

provided that Notice must be given to county government.

  1. j) Where a county government is unable to perform its functions, or does not operate a financial management system that complies with national legislation

requirements, the national government may intervene.

Challenges facing county governments in Kenya.

  1. a) County governments have inadequate funds. Some are located in areas of limited

resources. This impedes provision of essential services. Some are too small to

operate efficiently.

  1. b) Corruption and misappropriation of funds is common in most counties. This is

because those vested with the management powers do not have experience since

the appointment of governors is through popular vote.

  1. c) Rural –urban migration is likely to generate population pressure in urban based

counties like Nairobi city and Mombasa. urban problems like mushrooming of slums, poor garbage disposal and insufficient sanitary facilities arise.

  1. d) There is likely to be national government interference in the affairs and

management of county legislation. This hinders free decision-making.

  1. e) Election of ward members to manage ward affairs may hamper operations of the

counties especially in legislation.

Possible solutions to the challenges that may face county governments in Kenya.

  1. a) The National governments through the Equalization Fund should be able to provide adequate financial support to County governments located in areas of limited resources. This will assist in provision of essential services.
  2. b) Those counties that are too small to operate efficiently should be merged with others in terms of social service delivery.
  3. c) There should be stricter vetting of candidates to vie for positions of county

Governors and deputy county Governors in order the possible challenge of financial

management and corruption.

  1. d) Urban-based counties should be given more funding by the National Government to enable them solve urban related problems.
  2. e) The National government should come up with means on how to curb Rural –urban migration. This may be done through creation of employment generating

opportunities in rural counties.

  1. f) The county governments, especially those that are in economically viable areas

should be given financial autonomy and a free-hand in decision making, by the

national government.

PUBLIC REVENUE AND EXPENDITURE IN KENYA.

SOURCES OF PUBLIC REVENUE.

Public finance refers to revenue and expenditure of the national and county

government.

Principles that govern the use of public finance in Kenya.

  1. a) The principle of openness and accountability. There shall be public participation in financial matters.
  2. b) The public finance system should promote an equitable society, and in particular the burden of taxation should be shared fairly.
  3. c) Revenue raised nationally should be shared equitably among national and county

governments.

  1. d) Expenditure of public finance should promote the equitable development of the

country, including making special provision for marginalized groups and areas.

  1. e) The burdens and benefits of the use of resources and public borrowing should be

shared equitably between present and future generations.

  1. f) Public money should be used in a prudent and responsible way.
  2. g) There should be responsible financial management accompanied by clear fiscal

reporting to ensure effective use of public funds.

NATIONAL BUDGET.

The national budget is a comprehensive statement that gives an estimate of public

revenue, expenditure and financial plans for a given financial year for a government.

Components of the national and county governments’ budgets in Kenya.

  1. a) Estimates of revenue and expenditure, differentiating between recurrent and

development expenditure.

  1. b) Proposals for financing any anticipated deficit for the period to which they apply.
  2. c) Proposals regarding borrowing and other forms of public liability that will increase public debt during the following year.

The process of Budget preparation and implementation in Kenya.

Three months before the end of each financial year, the head of each department or

State organ submits estimates of revenues and expenditures for the following year to the secretary for finance. Two months before the end of each financial year, the Cabinet Secretary for finance submits to the National Assembly estimates of the revenue and expenditure of the national government for the following financial year.He also submits a detailed national fiscal, monetary and development plan for a period of three years prepared by him in collaboration with the Secretary responsible for planning and national development.The estimates include estimates for expenditure from the Equalization Fund.The National Assembly then considers the estimates submitted together with the estimates submitted by the Parliamentary Service Commission and the Chief Registrar of the Judiciary.Before the National Assembly considers the estimates of revenue and expenditure, a committee of the Assembly will discuss and review the estimates and make recommendations to the Assembly.Committee makes its recommendations to the National Assembly. When the estimates have been approved by the National Assembly, there will be an Appropriation Bill, introduced into the National Assembly to authorize the withdrawal from the Consolidated Fund of the money needed for the expenditure.

The Appropriation Bill will not include expenditures that are charged on the

Consolidated Fund.The process of Budget preparation and implementation in a county government.Further reading about this is encouraged.

Sources of public revenue for national government in Kenya.

Domestic Revenue Sources.

These are the taxes levied on citizens, private and public organizations, foreign investors and business people.

There are two main groups of taxes;

  1. Direct taxes.
  2. Indirect taxes.
  3. Direct taxes. (Income tax)

These are taxes derived from people’s salaries in form of income tax.

  1. Indirect taxes.

These are taxes levied on goods and services but with parliamentary approval. They

include;

  1. a) Value-added tax; an indirect sales tax paid on specific goods such as sugar, bread, petroleum products, clothes, electronic equipment and motor vehicles.
  2. b) Customs duties:- there are duties on imported goods such as motor vehicles,

machinery, fertilizer, sugar, wheat, electronics, luxury goods, etc.

  1. c) Excise tax; this is charged on locally produced goods that are sold within the country .
  2. d) Export Duty; the duty charged on locally produced goods such as textiles, coffee, tea, soda ash and pyrethrum which are exported.
  3. e) Trading Licenses;
  4. f) Sales Stamp Duty; on entertainment services, betting, casino and premium bonds.
  5. g) Traffic Revenue tax; levied on various categories of traffic services. E.g., the Road Maintenance Levy, the driver’s licence, Airport tax by air passengers.
  6. h) Investment Revenue; earned from parastatal and other profit making bodies that

remit profits through the treasury.

  1. i) Loan interest receipts. Collection of taxes from parastatals like AFC, KTDA, KPC, NCPB and KCB.
  2. j) Land Rates.
  3. k) House rates.
  4. l) Fees; paid in terms of timber levies, CO2 levies and mining fees.
  5. m) Court Fines
  6. n) Borrowing (under laid down law or procedure).
  7. o) Tourism fess

External Revenue Sources

There are two main sources of external assistance;

  1. Bilateral Aid; where two friendly nations assist each other. E.g. Kenya and Japan
  2. Multilateral Aid; many countries form trading blocs or global institutions like World Bank, IMF, European Union and commonwealth for this purpose.

Sources of finance for county governments.

  1. a) The main source of funding for many counties is their equitable share from 15%

of the national budget.

  1. b) Conditional and unconditional grants. Unconditional Grants are funds allocated by the national government without conditions regarding their use. Conditional grantsare the funds allocated by the national government for funding of specific projects and programmes. They include;

~  The Equalization Fund for provision of basic services like water, health

services, electricity and roads in marginalized areas.

~  The Contingencies Fund to carter for urgent and unforeseen circumstances

  1. c) Counties’ own revenues. Counties have the power to collect property rates, impose taxes on entertainment, and impose fees and charges for services they render to people and any other tax that Parliament permits them to impose.
  2. d) Borrowing, where the national government guarantees the loan or with the approval of the county assembly.
  3. e) Grants and donations

Factors that determine equitable sharing of public finance.

  1. a) The national interest.
  2. b) Any provision that must be made in respect of the public debt and other national

obligations.

  1. c) The needs of the national government, determined by objective criteria.
  2. d) The need to ensure that county governments are able to perform the functions

allocated to them.

  1. e) The fiscal capacity and efficiency of county governments.
  2. f) Developmental and other needs of counties.
  3. g) Economic disparities within and among counties and the need to remedy them.
  4. h) The need for affirmative action in respect of disadvantaged areas and groups.
  5. i) The need for economic optimization of each county and to provide incentives for

each county to optimize its capacity to raise revenue.

  1. j) The desirability of stable and predictable allocations of revenue.
  2. k) The need for flexibility in responding to emergencies and other temporary needs.

Regulations that govern imposition of taxes and charges in Kenya.

  1. a) Only the national government may impose Income tax, Value-added tax, Customs duties and other duties on import and export goods; and excise tax.
  2. b) An Act of Parliament may authorize the national government to impose any other tax or duty.
  3. c) A county may impose property rates, entertainment taxes, and any other tax that it is authorized to impose by an Act of Parliament.
  4. d) The national and county governments may impose charges for services.
  5. e) The taxation and other revenue-raising powers of a county should not be exercised in a way that prejudices national economic policies, economic activities across county boundaries or the national mobility of goods, services, capital or labour.
  6. f) No tax or licensing fee may be imposed, waived or varied except as provided by

legislation.

  1. g) If permitted, a public record of each waiver shall be maintained together with the reason for the waiver; and each waiver, and the reason for it, should be reported to the Auditor-General.
  2. h) No law may exclude or authorize the exclusion of a State officer from payment of tax.

The revenue collected by the government is deposited into the following funds;

  1. Equalization Fund; This is a Fund specially established by the National

government, to provide basic services including water, roads, health facilities and

electricity to marginalized areas to the extent necessary to bring the quality of

those services in those areas to the level generally enjoyed by the rest of the

nation.

  1. Consolidated Fund; this is the fund into which all the money raised or received by

the national government is paid. Money set aside by parliament for specific

purpose and money set aside by state organs to take care of their expenses is

however not deposited in this fund.

  1. Contingencies Fund; this is a fund from which advances will be made if the

secretary for finance is convinced that there is an urgent matter that needs

funding and for which there is no other provisions.

  1. Revenue Funds; this is a fund for each county into which all the money raised or received by the county government is paid.

Expenditure of Public Revenue.

There are two ways in which the national government spends its revenue.

  1. Capital expenditure. – The money set aside in the national budget for

development projects.

  1. Recurrent expenditure. – The money used by the government to sustain and

maintain the existing facilities.

How the national government spends its money under recurrent expenditure.

  1. a) The government remunerates its employees through regular payment of salaries

and wages.

  1. b) The expenditure is also used to maintain public property throughout the country by allocating necessary funds to roads, airports, colleges, school text book provision

and bridge maintenance.

  1. c) The money is also used to service debts from international donor agencies and local financial institutions.
  2. d) The money is also used to contribute to regional and international organizations like COMESA, AU, UN and Commonwealth.
  3. e) It is used to provide grants to counties and parastatals, and bursaries to schools and colleges.
  4. f) The money is also used to maintain Kenyan embassies abroad.

County government expenditure.

County governments spend their monies in the following ways;

  1. a) Provision of basic social services like water, health facilities, electricity and

cemeteries.

  1. b) The money from its recurrent expenditure is used to pay wages and salaries to its

employees.

  1. c) The counties spend their money to some extend to control air and noise pollution, and also on refuse removal and solid waste disposal.
  2. d) Money is used to finance development of roads, parking facilities, ferries and street lighting, develop entertainment, sporting, trading and cultural facilities.
  3. e) In repair maintenance and improvement of public facilities like roads, health

facilities, markets, libraries, housing etc.

  1. f) Some money is set aside as emergency utility for fire fighting services and disaster management.
  2. g) The counties use their money to service the borrowed funds plus the interest

accrued.

  1. h) They also use money to provide early childhood education through development of nursery schools. They also develop village polytechnics and home craft training

centres.

Ways through which proper management of public finances by national government is ensured in Kenya.

  1. a) Any national governments expenditure by state departments or state organs must

be approved by parliament which acts as the public watchdog.

  1. b) The controller of budget oversees the implementation of the national budget by

authorizing legal withdrawals from public funds such as the equalization fund,

consolidated fund and contingencies fund

  1. c) The controller of budget submits to each house of parliament report on the

implantation of the budget of the nationa l government.

  1. d) Where a state organ or any other public body fails to adhere to the laid down

procedures of expenditure, the cabinet secretary for finance, with the approval of

parliament, may stop the transfer of funds to the body.

  1. e) There is constant auditing of accounts and financial records of all government and other public bodies.
  2. f) Every public body has a n accounting officer who is accountable to the national

assembly for the financial management of the public body.

  1. g) The auditor general audits all accounts of all government and state organs.
  2. h) The government has put up policies related to procurement which is supposed to be fair, transparent, competitive and cost effective. to regulate public procurement,

various bodies have been set up. e.g the public procurement oversight authority

(PPOA), the public procurement administrative review board (PPARB)

  1. i) The government has also imposed sanctions against contractors who fail to fulfil

their contractual agreements either by failing to complete jobs or by doing sh oddy

work.

  1. j) Sanctions are to be imposed against those persons who fail to pay their taxes, or

engage in corrupt practices.

  1. k) All government contracts are publicly advertised for awarding of tenders and

awards.

  1. l) The government established the Kenya Anti-Corruption Commission (KACC) in 2004 which has the function of investigating corrupt cases in a non-partisan manner.

Management and expenditure of public finances in county governments.

  1. a) In every county, there is established a revenue fund where all funds, (includ ing the county’s own revenues, transfers from national revenues, grants and borrowed

funds) are consolidated.

  1. b) Money from this fund is only withdrawn following specific procedures authorized by parliament or by county laws.
  2. c) County governments must operate financial management systems that comply with all requirements of national legislation.
  3. d) The county assembly must vote on the budget and approve expenditure by various departments of the county.
  4. e) The county treasury must seek quarterly approvals from the controller of budget for withdrawal from the revenue fund based on the needs of the county.
  5. f) The accounting officer of a county organ or public body is accountable to the county assembly for the financial management of the public body.
  6. g) Each county has a county accountant general who maintains financial records of all the funds withdrawn from the revenue fund, and expenditure incurred.
  7. h) Apart from the internal audits in every county, the auditor general audits the

accounts of the county governments and submits reports to the relevant county assembly.

The controller of Budget.

Role of the controller of budget.

  1. a) He or she oversees the implementation of the budgets of the national and county

governments.

  1. b) He or she authorizes withdrawals from the public funds such as the Equalization,

Consolidated and Revenue Funds.

  1. c) he or she submits to each house of parliament, every four months, a report on the

implementation of the budgets of both national and county government

Auditor General.

Read on this

The Commission on Revenue Allocation.

The Commission consists of;

  1. a) A chairperson.
  2. b) One nominee of each regional assembly.
  3. c) Two persons to represent county governments.
  4. d) Two persons nominated by the National Assembly.
  5. e) The Principal Secretary in the Ministry responsible for finance.
  6. f) The Controller of Budget.

Functions of the commission of Revenue Allocation.

  1. a) He is responsible for determining the basis for the equitable sharing of revenue from national resources between the national government and the various levels of

devolved government.

  1. b) It makes recommendations on matters concerning the financing, and financial

management by county governments

  1. c) It determines and regularly reviews a policy that set out the criteria by which to

identify the marginalized areas.

  1. d) It defines and enhances the revenue sources of the national and county

governments.

  1. e) It submits its recommendations to the senate, national assembly, the national

executive, county assemblies and county executives.

  1. f) It mediates in and determines disputes relating to financial arrangem ents between the national government and devolved governments.

Functions of Central Bank.

  1. a) Promote and maintain the stability of the value of the currency of the Republic.
  2. b) Issue notes and coins.
  3. c) Act as banker and financial adviser of the Government.
  4. d) Conduct the monetary policy of the Government in a manner consistent with the

relevant provisions of the law in the interest of the balanced and sustainable

economic growth of the Republic.

  1. e) Encourage and promote economic development and the efficient utilization of the resources of the Republic, through effective and efficient operation of a banking and credit system.

Why the Economic and Social Council established in Kenya.

  1. a) To advise the national government and Parliament on matters of economic and

social concern to the people of the Republic.

  1. b) To advise the national government on the formulation, implementation, monitoring and evaluation of strategic economic and social policies.
  2. c) To consider and report to Parliament on the economic and social implications of all Bills and budgetary proposals introduced in Parliament.
  3. d) To monitor progress in the improvement of the living standards of the people of

Kenya, particularly those of the poor and the disadvantaged.

THE ELECTORAL PROCESS, FUNCTIONS OF GOVERNMENTS IN OTHER

PARTS OF THE WORLD.

BRITAIN

Britain comprises England, Wales, Scotland and Northern Ireland. The country has evolved a parliamentary system of government over the years.The Saxon Kings who invaded Britain in the 5th Century AD had absolute powers- ruling without consulting the citizens, and there positions were hereditary.However, in the 12th century AD,

they introduced the parliamentary system. They agreed that the kings/queens could only rule according to the laws of the land that should be made by the representatives of the people. This was what came to known as a constitutional monarchy.

The electoral process in Britain

The British government is based on the party system. Elections for party leaders are held separately before the general elections. The three main parties are the Conservative Party,

Liberal Party and Labour Party.

Unlike USA and other major democratic states outside commonwealth, there is no fixed date for British parliamentary elections. The date of a general election is decided upon by the prime Minister.

The Choice of a date of elections is influenced by the following factors;

  1. The economic situation that is the availability of funds.
  2. The state of the government’s legislative programme in the House of Commons.
  3. The desire to increase government support in parliament.

The electoral system for the House of Commons is based on the principal of ‘one person, one vote’

There are two types of elections for the House of Commons.

~  General elections where members of the House of Commons are elected for a 5-year term.

~  By elections in the event of resignation, death or resignation of a member of parliament.

There are also local elections in which representatives of local authorities (councillors) are voted for are held every 4 years. The local authorities include the District Councils, London Boroughs, Metropolitan districts and Regional and island councils.

In Britain, there are also euro-elections, first introduced in 1979, in which representatives to the European Union parliament are chosen.81 MPs were elected in 1979.

Voter Registration.

It is the local authorities that hold the responsibility of registering voters. Since 1948, a postal vote is possible for citizens who are away from their constituencies during the voting period, either on business or other reasons.

The following categories of people qualify to vote in Britain;

  1. a) British Citizens over the age of 18 years.
  2. b) Citizens from commonwealth countries who have resided in Britain for periods stipulated by law.
  3. c) Citizens of the republic of Ireland who have been residents for periods stipulated by law.

The following are ineligible to vote in Britain.

  1. a) Persons of unsound mind.
  2. b) Convicts detained in a prison.
  3. c) Persons convicted of corrupt or illegal practices in connection with elections cannot vote

for five years from the date of conviction.

  1. d) Adults whose names do not appear on the register of voters.
  2. e) Peers or members of the House of Lords

A candidate who wishes to contest for a parliamentary seat in Britain must fulfil the following conditions;

  1. a) He/she must be a British citizen or a common subject or a citizen of the republic of Ireland.
  2. b) He/she must be of a minimum age of 21 years.
  3. c) He/ she must be nominated by a political party or be an independent candidate.

The following are disqualified from vying for a parliamentary seat in Britain.

  1. a) English/Scottish peers who have the right to sit in the House of Lords.
  2. b) Clergy of the Church of England, or the Church of Ireland, Ministers of the church of Scotland, and Roman Catholic priests.
  3. c)
  4. d) Certified Lunatics.
  5. e) Undisputed bankrupts.
  6. f) Convicted persons.
  7. g) Persons who have committed illegal practices during elections like corruption.
  8. h) Members of the armed forces.

Candidates vie for 650 parliamentary seats.

The candidates are either nominated by respective parties or stand as independent candidates and need not reside in the constituencies as long as they register as voters in that constituency. Once nomination of candidates has taken place, campaigns are allowed for two weeks before voting. Each candidate appoints an election agent to manage the finances and protect the interests of the candidate during he campaign. The agent also explains the candidate’s party policies and identifies party supporters within the constituency. He/she familiarizes the candidate’s name toprospective voters.Election officials work hand in hand with party agents during Election Day.Each candidate must deposit 500 sterling pounds with the registrar, which is returned in the event that the candidate garners over 5% of the total vote in the constituency.Elections in Britain are by plurality. Candidates who get the highest of votes win the elections.The party that secures most parliamentary seats is declared winner and is asked to form the next government. Emphasis is on number of seats not votes cast.The House of Lords members are drawn from people with high offices. E.g. bishops, distinguished scientists and artists, great sportsmen, retired judges etc

Functions of Government in Britain.

The British government operates around four basic institutions;

  1. a) The Monarchy.
  2. b) The Legislature.
  3. c) The Executive.
  4. d) The Judiciary.

The Monarchy.

In Britain, the Monarchy is represented by the queen. The Monarch assent to all legislations.The Monarch appoints the PM and approves the cabinet

 

Other Functions of the Monarchy.

  1. a) The monarch as head of state advises government
  2. b) The monarch summons, prorogues and dissolve parliament in consultation with the Prime Minister.
  3. c) The Monarch gives royal assent to bills passed by parliament to become law.
  4. d) Management of the country’s foreign policy including enactment of treaties.
  5. e) It confers honours to persons who have rendered distinguished services. For example, the peerages to become Lords or knights and will be referred to as LADY OR ‘Sir’
  6. f) The Monarch approves appointment s to important state offices such as judges, senior members of the armed forces and civil service.
  7. g) The monarch pardons and gives reprieve to people who have been accused of

committing various offences.

  1. h) The Monarch appoints Bishops and Archbishops of the Anglican Church.

NB; At the beginning of each new session of parliament, the monarch addresses both Houses together in the House of Lords to mark the formal opening of parliament. In the address, the monarch outlines government proposed legislations for the coming session.

Importance of the monarchy to the British people.

  1. a) The presence of the monarchy helps to give some continuity to executive policy.
  2. b) It inspires the head of government with a sense of responsibility and dignity.
  3. c) It acts as a useful counsellor to the head of government.
  4. d) It is the symbol of commonwealth unity.
  5. e) It sets standards for social life. The presence of members of the royalty at the inauguration of scientific, artistic and charitable works ensures nationwide support.
  6. f) The royal family pays state visits to foreign government and undertakes tours in other countries of the commonwealth, hence contributing to better understanding between Britain and other nations.

The Legislature/parliament.

It is made up of the monarchy, House of Lords and House of  commons.

The following are ways through which one can gain membership to parliament in Britain;

  1. a)
  2. b) Nominations
  3. c)
  4. d) By Virtue of office. E.g. members of the House of Lords maintain their parliamentary seat whenever a new parliament is constituted.Parliament is a supreme institution in Britain. It passes changes or repeals laws without being vetoed by the courts of law.

How parliamentary supremacy is demonstrated in Britain.

  1. a) Parliament makes amends and abolishes laws. No other institution can do that.
  2. b) Branches of government operate under the laws passed by parliament. /parliament is the supreme institution in Britain and all other institutions derive their power from it.
  3. c) Parliament can pass a vote of no confidence in the executive. / has powers to remove any unpopular government from office.
  4. d) It approves government revenue and expenditure. / It is the only institution empowered to approve government budget.
  5. e) Decisions of parliament are binding to all. They cannot be overruled or nullified by a court of law.

The House of Lords.

Membership to The House of Lords is based on nomination by the monarch or by hereditary principle. Some membership is through holding senior positions within the Church of England Consists of 1200 members 800 of whom are heredity peers, 26 are Bishops and 21 are Lords of Appeal

One can become a member of the House of Lords in the following ways;

  1. Through nomination by the monarch.
  2. When one holds hereditary parentage position. Normally the eldest male member of the family inherits the position.
  3. Through holding some senior position in the society e.g. within the Church of England -Archbishop of Canterbury.

Members of the House of Lords only receive sitting allowances. Only the Lords of Appeal receive annual salaries.

Role played by the House of Lords in the British parliamentary system.

  1. a) The house of lords checks the powers of the House of Commons and therefore prevents nasty legislation. Bills from the House of Commons have to go to the House of Lords for debate and approval.
  2. b) It addresses non-controversial bills that the lower house has no time to address.
  3. c) The house of lords holds bills from the lower hose long enough to seek public approval
  4. d) The House of Lords questions ministers about the activities of government and stages debates on general issues of national policy.
  5. e) It seats as a court of appeal for criminal cases. on such occasions , the court is presided over by the lord chancellor (speaker of the house)
  6. f) It provides a forum for utilization of the talents of people who coul d not win a general election. These people are created peers by the queen and become members of the House of Lords.
  7. g) It enhances unity in the country as newcomers are created lords by the queen and then become members of the House of Lords.
  8. h) It provides continuity in operation of parliament. Old experienced peers retain their seats in the House of Lords until they die, so provide guidance to new and young politicians.

House of Commons.

It is the major legislative arm of the government. It comprises 650 elected members

representing constituencies. The leader of the House is the P.M. The chief officer is the speaker who is elected at the start of a new parliamentary session.

Functions of the House of Commons.

  1. a) Discusses makes and amends laws. However, the monarchy and the house of Lords have powers to veto such laws.
  2. b) Approves government revenue and expenditure. It controls finances. No taxes can be imposed without the consent of the House of Commons.
  3. c) It has powers to pass a vote of No confidence in the executive (Check the powers of the executive to ensure that the rule of law is maintained.
  4. d) Debates on matters of national interest.
  5. e) It directs government policy and keeps development programmes on track.
  6. f) It is a training ground for future leaders.

Factors which influence the activities of Parliament in Britain.

  1. a) Members of the House of Commons must consider the moral values of the British society before making any decision.
  2. b) Parliamentarians are always sensitive to public opinion because any unpopular

government or party risks not being re-elected.

  1. c) Local authorities are empowered to make by-laws even without consulting parliament.
  2. d) Interests of the institutions under the spotlight are always taken into account before legislation is done in parliament. E.g. the Church, Un iversities, Farmers, trade Unions etc.
  3. e) Legislation passed by one parliament can be changed by another future one.
  4. f) International law is also taken into account when laws are made.

NB; these are the factors that limit the parliamentary supremacy in Britain.

The executive.

The executive is made up of the Prime Minister, the cabinet and the civil service.

The Prime Minister.

Appointed by the monarch, being the leader of the political party that controls an absolute majority, He/she is the Chief executive of the country.

He performs the following functions;

  1. a) Appoints and dismisses Cabinet ministers with the consent of the monarch.
  2. b) He/she recommends to the sovereign the appointment of senior civil servants such as the chief Justice, High Commissioners.
  3. c) He/she represents Britain in international fora.
  4. d) He/she controls the cabinet secretariat and oversees the execution of cabinet decisions by various departments.
  5. e) He/she is the leader of the party that nominates him/her.
  6. f) He/she settles disputes between various departments.
  7. g) He/she is the leader of the House of Commons.
  8. h) He/she initiates both domestic and foreign policies.

The Cabinet.

The cabinet is made of the ministers appointed by the P.M with the approval of the monarch and nominated from the party with the majority of seats.

The cabinet performs the following functions;

  1. a) The cabinet ministers institute policies that guide the operations in the various departments of the ministry.
  2. b) Cabinet determines the policy to present to parliament for consideration.
  3. c) Cabinet is responsible for the coordination of government activity. E.g. all ministers must implement cabinet decisions with regard to their department.

The following conventions provide guidance on the operation of the cabinet;

  1. a) Once a government is defeated, on a major issue or on a vote of no confidence, it is expected to resign. A government whose party is defeated in General elections is expected to resign.
  2. b) The cabinet is drawn from the House of Commons and the House of Lords.
  3. c) The entire cabinet comes from the same political party of majority seats except during a crisis like war. Since 1945, Britain has never embraced a coalition.
  4. d) The advice offered by the cabinet must be accepted by the monarch, failure to which a crisis can occur.
  5. e) All members of the cabinet take the Oath of the Privy councillors and are bound to Secrecy by this oath and the official secrets Act.
  6. f) Members of the cabinet are collectively responsible for all decisions and actions as well as individually responsible of the departments they head.

The Civil Service

The British law stipulates the civil servants are servants of the crown. A civil servant is expected to non-partisan and to serve the government of the day without favour. Civil service staff does not change with change of government.

Recruitment In the civil service is based on merit.

Functions of the civil Service in Britain.

  1. a) It implements ministerial policies as agreed by parliament.
  2. b) It assists in formulation of policies and generation of policy proposals.
  3. c) It manages government administrative machinery.
  4. d) It carries out normal duties that public administration demands.

Principles that characterize the British civil service.

  1. a) The tradition of anonymity. Civil servants are taken to be carrying out the instructions of minister. Ministers get all the credit for all good, as well as censure for all that is criticized.
  2. b) The principal of civil service impartiality. Those civil services are expected to serve whichever minister is in office without partiality. Senior civil servants are not permitted to take part in national politics except voting.
  3. c) Ministers make policies and civil servants execute the policies.
  4. d) The tradition of assumption that it is not the task of the civil service to initiate change or take responsibility for planning future lines of social an d economic development.

The Judiciary.

The judiciary in Britain is based on the supremacy of the law. To safeguard the rule of law, the British Judiciary has an independent court system.

How judicial independence is ensured in Britain.

  1. a) The salaries of judges are not open to discussion by parliament.
  2. b) Since 1701, judges have always bee appointed on good behaviour until retirement.
  3. c) A Judge can only be dismissed by a resolution from both houses.

The structure of the British Court System.

(Further reading encouraged)

components of the British constitution.

  1. e) Statutes or acts of parliament e.g. act of union with Scotland of 1707.
  2. f) Customs-the accepted traditions e.g. the first-born of the sovereign succeeds the king /queen.
  3. g) Law of precedence-judges applies accepted principles to new set of facts.
  4. h) Custom of parliament e.g. the procedures of the two houses.
  5. i) Historical documents e.g. the Magna Carta.

THE USA

The origin of USA dates back to 1776, when the thirteen British Colonies declared their independence from Britain. USA is a federal government, a form of representative democracy comprising a union of 50 states

The adopted a new constitution in 1787 and has the following features.

  1. a) It is Federal in nature.
  2. b) A written constitution.
  3. c) Bill of rights is contained in it.
  4. d) The Supreme Court can only interpret it.
  5. e) Legislature is Bi-cameral i.e. the senate & the House of Representatives forming the congress/two houses.
  6. f) It caters for the separation of powers.
  7. g) Does not provide for secession of a member state.
  8. h) Federal government and individual states share power through their senators in congress i.e. in making laws.
  9. i) The president is the head of the federal government and governors are heads of state.
  10. j) It is the supreme law of the land.
  11. k) Amendment can only be done through a clearly laid down procedure.

The electoral process in USA.

There are three types of election held in USA.

  1. a) The election of the president.
  2. b) Congressional elections
  3. c) The state election involving election of state governors and state legislatures.

All candidates vying for various seats must be American citizens and must be residents in the area they aspire to represent. Age limit is 25 years for the representatives and 35 years for the president.During the lection year party primaries are held between March and May to choose presidential candidates.Party conventions are held in July to confirm winners of the primary elections.Each presidential candidate picks a running mate who becomes the vice president if the presidential candidate wins.Presidential elections are held after every 4 years (on 2nd November).The election of the president is determined indirectly by the Electoral College that comprises electors appointed by each state.

When a presidential candidate wins the popular vote in a state, he automatically wins all the state’s electors.Direct elections are done through popular vote of one man one vote.

Senators and members of the House of Representatives are elected after every two years.

Senators serve for a period of six years with a third of them elected after every 2 years.

Members of the House of Representatives serve for four years and are elected on party basis.Each state elects 2 representatives to the senate making a total of 100 senators for the 50 states.Election of House of Representatives is on the basis of state population. For example, the largest state, California has 52 representatives while Wyoming, the smallest has only one representative.State governors and legislators are elected after every 4 years.

Features of the US system of government.

  1. a) The federal government is made up of the legislature, executive and the judiciary.
  2. b) Each state within the federal government functions as a republic and enjoys equal status.
  3. c) The federal government and independent states share the power of formulating and enforcing laws.
  4. d) All states have their constitutions but they should not be contradicting to the Federal Constitution.
  5. e) The Supreme Court interprets the constitution.
  6. f) The congress (Senate and the House of Representatives) is the body entrusted with legislative powers.
  7. g) Senate membership is through popular vote of two members from each state for a period of six years.
  8. h) The House of Representatives members are elected for a period of two years based on the size of the population. However, each state has to have at least one representative.
  9. i) All treaties and appointments by the president have to be ratified by the senate.
  10. j) Presidential vote must be supported by two thirds of the votes of the house.
  11. k) The Supreme Court made up of the chief justice and eight associate judges heads federal judiciary.
  12. l) The president appoints federal judges with the approval of the senate.
  13. m) Courts in the judiciary include the court of appeal, the district courts and other special courts, all formed by the congress.
  14. n) All criminal cases are handled in the courts except the cases of impeachment, which are voted by the house with the approval of the senate.
  15. o) Foreign policy and Defence is the preserve of the Federal Government.

features of the state governments of U.S.A.

  1. a) Each state has a governor.
  2. b) Each state has a law court those carters for internal affairs.
  3. c) Each state provides educational, health facilities and public amenities for the welfare of the residents.
  4. d) Each state is responsible for its own development.
  5. e) Each state generates its own revenue necessary for discharging its responsibility.
  6. f) Each state has a bicameral legislature.
  7. g) Each state has a state police that maintains law and order.

Limitations of state governments in USA.

  1. a) No state is permitted to enter any treaty, alliance or confederation with other states or countries.
  2. b) No state may make her own currency.
  3. c) States are forbidden, unless congress approves, to levy duties on imports or exports.
  4. d) States are prohibited from maintaining armed forces.
  5. e) States are prohibited from entering into any agreement with foreign powers or engaging in war.

how the conduct of USA president is checked

  1. a) The senate approves presidential appointees to executive positions.
  2. b) Congress can refuse to approve the use of government funds for a foreign policy it disagrees with. E.g. war.
  3. c) The congress can impeach a sitting president if his conduct while in office is wanting.
  4. d) The Supreme Court has powers to declare that the president has acted unconstitutionally, a verdict which can damage his status.
  5. e) Any president is limited by the constitution to two four-year terms in office.
  6. f) Opinion polls normally reflect the wishes and feelings of the American people, which the sitting president cannot ignore.
  7. g) The mass media monitors and reports to the general public every action or speech of the president.

functions of the political parties in USA’

  1. a) Make electoral policies coherent.
  2. b) The party level helps voters to sort out through the candidates as parties usually stand for different policies.
  3. c) Parties help to put the desire of the people on the government policy agenda.
  4. d) Parties provide outlets for citizens to express their sentiments about nominees.
  5. e) Political party system provides accountability when the policies of the party fails/ voters hold candidates accountable.

differences existing between the House of Representatives and the senate in terms of membership.

  1. a) The house of representatives is larger with more than 436 members whereas the senate has only 100 members.
  2. b) The house of representatives has short period of office (2 years) but the senate is on for a long period of office (6 years)
  3. c) Members of the House of Representatives arte elected by constituencies whereas the senate is elected by the state.
  4. d) Easier qualification for candidates for membership to the House of Representatives. The senate demands stricter qualifications.
  5. e) The house of representatives is less prestigious than the senate.
  6. f) Rules of the House of Representatives are more rigid than the rules governing the senate.

functions of the USA president.

  1. a) He is the head of state.
  2. b) He appoints cabinet ministers and senior civil servants with approval of the congress.
  3. c) He is the commander-in-chief of the armed forces.
  4. d) He is the head of the federal government of USA and the defender of of its constitution.
  5. e) The president formulates the public policy.
  6. f) He can veto or override bills passed by the congress.
  7. g) As a head of the party in power, the president influences public opinion and thereby guides the course of the congress.
  8. h) He guides and controls foreign affairs and makes treaties.

India.

Describe the Indian electoral process.

  1. a) India’s parliament is composed of the Lower Chamber or House of The People (lok Sabha) and the Upper House or the Council of States (Rajya Sabha).
  2. b) The term of lok sabha is five years while that of rajya sabha is six years.
  3. c) Lok sabha consists of 545 elected members, 543 elected from each constituency created based on population size. The president nominates two.
  4. d) Political parties field candidates in each constituency.
  5. e) India’s universal adult suffrage is 18 years. Qualification age for vying is 25 years and above.
  6. f) The election commission, a constitution arm of the Indian electoral process oversees the elections.
  7. g) Candidates are required to declare their assets, age, educational qualifications and criminal history before being cleared to vie.
  8. h) Campaigning ends a day before the voting day. Government schools and colleges are chosen to be polling stations. Government servants are employed to man the polling stations.
  9. i) There is the use of electronic voting machines instead of ballot boxes.
  10. j) The candidate who gunners the most number of votes is declared the winner of the constituency.
  11. k) The party or coalition that has won the most number of seats is invited by the president to form the new government. The leader of the party becomes the prime minister.
  12. l) Rayja sabha consists of 250 members; the electoral college of India elects 248. The president nominates twelve members from among distinguished people.
  13. m) Every state is allotted a certain number of members.
  14. n) Candidate age limit is 30 years and above.

functions of a prime minister in India.

  1. a) He is the head of the federal government
  2. b) He is the leader of the house to which he belongs. (he can be either a member of the rajya sabha (upper house) or lok sabha.
  3. c) As head of the council of ministers, the prime minister oversees the work o all the ministries.
  4. d) Chairs cabinet meetings, which are normally held in the cabinet room of the prime ministers’ office.
  5. e) Guides the president on appointment to the cabinet.
  6. f) Participates in the law-making process as a member of the lok sabha.
  7. g) The prime minister has traditionally been the minister-in-charge of the department of space, atomic energy and the ministry of personnel, public governance and pensions
  8. h) Recommends persons for presidential awards.

functions of the Electoral Commission of India.

  1. a) Prepares electoral registers
  2. b) Setting dates for polling.
  3. c) Establishing and operating polling station.
  4. d) Allocation party symbols.
  5. e) Publishing electoral report.
  6. f) Accepting or rejecting nominations as per the law.
  7. g) Counting the votes.
  8. h) Drawing constituency boundary.

What conditions must one fulfill to be elected president in India

  1. a) He/she must be a citizen of India.
  2. b) He/she must have attained the age of 35 and above.
  3. c) He/she should not hold any office.
  4. d) He/she should be qualified to be elected as a member of the house of the people. (the lok sabha)

functions of the cabinet in the government of India.

  1. a) Formulation of policy issues affecting the management of the government of India.
  2. b) Defends the government policy.
  3. c) Ensures that the civil servants implement government policy.
  4. d) Advises the president.
  5. e) Gives approval to the budget and estimates of the expenditure.
  6. f) The cabinet exercises general direction and control of government departments.

Tumbo lisiloshiba questions and answers

Get free Tumbo lisiloshiba questions and answers pdf and Tumbo lisiloshiba na hadithi nyingine notes pdf free, here.

TUMBO LISILOSHIBA FREE NOTES, QUESTIONS & ANSWERS

See also;


DOWNLOAD FREE PRIMARY & HIGH SCHOOL MATERIALS


FREE PRIMARY & SECONDARY RESOURCES (OVER 300,000 DOWNLOADS)

FREE UPDATED NOTES

Click on the links below

FORM ONE NOTES

FORM ONE NOTES

FORM TWO NOTES

FORM THREE NOTES

FORM FOUR NOTES

FREE LATEST EXAMS WITH MARKING SCHEMES

Click on the links below;

FORM ONE EXAMS

FORM TWO EXAMS

FORM THREE EXAMS

FORM FOUR EXAMS

FORM 1-4 FREE EXAMS

SCHEMES OF WORK

KCSE REVISION MATERIALS

FREE PRIMARY SCHOOL RESOURCES

FREE CLASS 8 RESOURCES

LOWER PRIMARY RESOURCES (PP1-2 & GRADE 1-6)

Great readings